Provided by: rclone_1.60.1+dfsg-2_amd64 bug

NAME

       Rclone - syncs your files to cloud storage

DESCRIPTION

       • About rclone

       • What can rclone do for you?

       • What features does rclone have?

       • What providers does rclone support?

       • Download (https://rclone.org/downloads/)

       • Install (https://rclone.org/install/)

       • Donate. (https://rclone.org/donate/)

   About rclone
       Rclone  is  a command-line program to manage files on cloud storage.  It is a feature-rich
       alternative to cloud vendors’ web storage interfaces.   Over  40  cloud  storage  products
       support  rclone  including S3 object stores, business & consumer file storage services, as
       well as standard transfer protocols.

       Rclone has powerful cloud equivalents to the unix commands rsync, cp, mv, mount, ls, ncdu,
       tree,  rm,  and cat.  Rclone’s familiar syntax includes shell pipeline support, and --dry-
       run protection.  It is used at the command line, in scripts or via its API.

       Users  call  rclone  “The  Swiss  army  knife   of   cloud   storage”,   and   “Technology
       indistinguishable from magic”.

       Rclone  really  looks  after your data.  It preserves timestamps and verifies checksums at
       all times.  Transfers over limited bandwidth;  intermittent  connections,  or  subject  to
       quota   can   be   restarted,  from  the  last  good  file  transferred.   You  can  check
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/) the integrity of your files.  Where  possible,
       rclone  employs  server-side  transfers to minimise local bandwidth use and transfers from
       one provider to another without using local disk.

       Virtual   backends   wrap   local   and   cloud   file   systems   to   apply   encryption
       (https://rclone.org/crypt/),    compression    (https://rclone.org/compress/),    chunking
       (https://rclone.org/chunker/),   hashing    (https://rclone.org/hasher/)    and    joining
       (https://rclone.org/union/).

       Rclone  mounts  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/)  any  local,  cloud or virtual
       filesystem as a disk on Windows, macOS, linux and FreeBSD, and also serves these over SFTP
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/),                                     HTTP
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/),                                   WebDAV
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/),                                    FTP
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/)                  and                  DLNA
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_dlna/).

       Rclone  is  mature,  open-source  software  originally inspired by rsync and written in Go
       (https://golang.org).  The friendly support community is familiar with varied  use  cases.
       Official  Ubuntu,  Debian,  Fedora,  Brew  and Chocolatey repos.  include rclone.  For the
       latest version downloading from rclone.org (https://rclone.org/downloads/) is recommended.

       Rclone is widely used on Linux, Windows and Mac.  Third-party developers create innovative
       backup, restore, GUI and business process solutions using the rclone command line or API.

       Rclone does the heavy lifting of communicating with cloud storage.

   What can rclone do for you?
       Rclone helps you:

       • Backup (and encrypt) files to cloud storage

       • Restore (and decrypt) files from cloud storage

       • Mirror cloud data to other cloud services or locally

       • Migrate data to the cloud, or between cloud storage vendors

       • Mount multiple, encrypted, cached or diverse cloud storage as a disk

       • Analyse    and    account    for    data    held    on    cloud    storage   using   lsf
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsf/),                                         ljson
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/),                                       size
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/),                                         ncdu
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/)

       • Union (https://rclone.org/union/) file systems together to present multiple local and/or
         cloud file systems as one

   Features
       • Transfers

         • MD5, SHA1 hashes are checked at all times for file integrity

         • Timestamps are preserved on files

         • Operations can be restarted at any time

         • Can be to and from network, e.g. two different cloud providers

         • Can use multi-threaded downloads to local disk

       • Copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) new or changed files to cloud storage

       • Sync (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/) (one way) to make a directory identical

       • Move (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) files  to  cloud  storage  deleting  the
         local after verification

       • Check (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/) hashes and for missing/extra files

       • Mount (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) your cloud storage as a network disk

       • Serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  local  or  remote  files  over  HTTP
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/)/WebDav
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/)/FTP
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/)/SFTP
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/)/DLNA
         (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_dlna/)

       • Experimental Web based GUI (https://rclone.org/gui/)

   Supported providers
       (There are many others, built on standard protocols such as WebDAV or S3, that work out of
       the box.)

       • 1Fichier

       • Akamai Netstorage

       • Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)

       • Amazon Drive

       • Amazon S3

       • Backblaze B2

       • Box

       • Ceph

       • China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

       • Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

       • Citrix ShareFile

       • Cloudflare R2

       • DigitalOcean Spaces

       • Digi Storage

       • Dreamhost

       • Dropbox

       • Enterprise File Fabric

       • FTP

       • Google Cloud Storage

       • Google Drive

       • Google Photos

       • HDFS

       • Hetzner Storage Box

       • HiDrive

       • HTTP

       • Internet Archive

       • Jottacloud

       • IBM COS S3

       • IDrive e2

       • IONOS Cloud

       • Koofr

       • Mail.ru Cloud

       • Memset Memstore

       • Mega

       • Memory

       • Microsoft Azure Blob Storage

       • Microsoft OneDrive

       • Minio

       • Nextcloud

       • OVH

       • OpenDrive

       • OpenStack Swift

       • Oracle Cloud Storage Swift

       • Oracle Object Storage

       • ownCloud

       • pCloud

       • premiumize.me

       • put.io

       • QingStor

       • Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)

       • Rackspace Cloud Files

       • rsync.net

       • Scaleway

       • Seafile

       • Seagate Lyve Cloud

       • SeaweedFS

       • SFTP

       • Sia

       • SMB / CIFS

       • StackPath

       • Storj

       • SugarSync

       • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

       • Uptobox

       • Wasabi

       • WebDAV

       • Yandex Disk

       • Zoho WorkDrive

       • The local filesystem

   Virtual providers
       These backends adapt or modify other storage providers:

       • Alias: Rename existing remotes

       • Cache: Cache remotes (DEPRECATED)

       • Chunker: Split large files

       • Combine: Combine multiple remotes into a directory tree

       • Compress: Compress files

       • Crypt: Encrypt files

       • Hasher: Hash files

       • Union: Join multiple remotes to work together

   Links
       • Home page (https://rclone.org/)

       • GitHub project page for source and bug tracker (https://github.com/rclone/rclone)

       • Rclone Forum (https://forum.rclone.org)

       • Downloads (https://rclone.org/downloads/)

Usage

       Rclone  is  a  command  line  program  to  manage  files on cloud storage.  After download
       (https://rclone.org/downloads/) and install, continue here to learn how to use it: Initial
       configuration,  what  the  basic syntax looks like, describes the various subcommands, the
       various options, and more.

   Configure
       First, you’ll need to  configure  rclone.   As  the  object  storage  systems  have  quite
       complicated  authentication  these are kept in a config file.  (See the --config entry for
       how to find the config file and choose its location.)

       The easiest way to make the config is to run rclone with the config option:

              rclone config

       See the following for detailed instructions for

       • 1Fichier (https://rclone.org/fichier/)

       • Akamai Netstorage (https://rclone.org/netstorage/)

       • Alias (https://rclone.org/alias/)

       • Amazon Drive (https://rclone.org/amazonclouddrive/)

       • Amazon S3 (https://rclone.org/s3/)

       • Backblaze B2 (https://rclone.org/b2/)

       • Box (https://rclone.org/box/)

       • Chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) -  transparently  splits  large  files  for  other
         remotes

       • Citrix ShareFile (https://rclone.org/sharefile/)

       • Compress (https://rclone.org/compress/)

       • Combine (https://rclone.org/combine/)

       • Crypt (https://rclone.org/crypt/) - to encrypt other remotes

       • DigitalOcean Spaces (https://rclone.org/s3/#digitalocean-spaces)

       • Digi Storage (https://rclone.org/koofr/#digi-storage)

       • Dropbox (https://rclone.org/dropbox/)

       • Enterprise File Fabric (https://rclone.org/filefabric/)

       • FTP (https://rclone.org/ftp/)

       • Google Cloud Storage (https://rclone.org/googlecloudstorage/)

       • Google Drive (https://rclone.org/drive/)

       • Google Photos (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/)

       • Hasher (https://rclone.org/hasher/) - to handle checksums for other remotes

       • HDFS (https://rclone.org/hdfs/)

       • HiDrive (https://rclone.org/hidrive/)

       • HTTP (https://rclone.org/http/)

       • Internet Archive (https://rclone.org/internetarchive/)

       • Jottacloud (https://rclone.org/jottacloud/)

       • Koofr (https://rclone.org/koofr/)

       • Mail.ru Cloud (https://rclone.org/mailru/)

       • Mega (https://rclone.org/mega/)

       • Memory (https://rclone.org/memory/)

       • Microsoft Azure Blob Storage (https://rclone.org/azureblob/)

       • Microsoft OneDrive (https://rclone.org/onedrive/)

       • OpenStack Swift / Rackspace Cloudfiles / Memset Memstore (https://rclone.org/swift/)

       • OpenDrive (https://rclone.org/opendrive/)

       • Oracle Object Storage (https://rclone.org/oracleobjectstorage/)

       • Pcloud (https://rclone.org/pcloud/)

       • premiumize.me (https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/)

       • put.io (https://rclone.org/putio/)

       • QingStor (https://rclone.org/qingstor/)

       • Seafile (https://rclone.org/seafile/)

       • SFTP (https://rclone.org/sftp/)

       • Sia (https://rclone.org/sia/)

       • SMB (https://rclone.org/smb/)

       • Storj (https://rclone.org/storj/)

       • SugarSync (https://rclone.org/sugarsync/)

       • Union (https://rclone.org/union/)

       • Uptobox (https://rclone.org/uptobox/)

       • WebDAV (https://rclone.org/webdav/)

       • Yandex Disk (https://rclone.org/yandex/)

       • Zoho WorkDrive (https://rclone.org/zoho/)

       • The local filesystem (https://rclone.org/local/)

   Basic syntax
       Rclone syncs a directory tree from one storage system to another.

       Its syntax is like this

              Syntax: [options] subcommand <parameters> <parameters...>

       Source  and destination paths are specified by the name you gave the storage system in the
       config file then the sub path, e.g.  “drive:myfolder” to  look  at  “myfolder”  in  Google
       drive.

       You can define as many storage paths as you like in the config file.

       Please  use  the  -i  /  --interactive flag while learning rclone to avoid accidental data
       loss.

   Subcommands
       rclone uses a system of subcommands.  For example

              rclone ls remote:path # lists a remote
              rclone copy /local/path remote:path # copies /local/path to the remote
              rclone sync -i /local/path remote:path # syncs /local/path to the remote

rclone config

       Enter an interactive configuration session.

   Synopsis
       Enter an interactive configuration session where you can  setup  new  remotes  and  manage
       existing ones.  You may also set or remove a password to protect your configuration.

              rclone config [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for config

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

       • rclone config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) - Create a  new
         remote with name, type and options.

       • rclone  config  delete  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_delete/)  - Delete an
         existing remote.

       • rclone  config  disconnect   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_disconnect/)   -
         Disconnects user from remote

       • rclone  config  dump (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/) - Dump the config
         file as JSON.

       • rclone config file  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_file/)  -  Show  path  of
         configuration file in use.

       • rclone  config  password  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_password/) - Update
         password in an existing remote.

       • rclone config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) - Show paths used
         for configuration, cache, temp etc.

       • rclone config providers (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_providers/) - List in
         JSON format all the providers and options.

       • rclone config  reconnect  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_reconnect/)  -  Re-
         authenticates user with remote.

       • rclone config show (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_show/) - Print (decrypted)
         config file, or the config for a single remote.

       • rclone  config   touch   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_touch/)   -   Ensure
         configuration file exists.

       • rclone   config   update  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_update/)  -  Update
         options in an existing remote.

       • rclone config userinfo  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_userinfo/)  -  Prints
         info about logged in user of remote.

rclone copy

       Copy files from source to dest, skipping identical files.

   Synopsis
       Copy  the source to the destination.  Does not transfer files that are identical on source
       and destination, testing by size and modification time or MD5SUM.   Doesn’t  delete  files
       from the destination.  If you want to also delete files from destination, to make it match
       source, use the sync (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/) command instead.

       Note that it is always the contents of the directory that is  synced,  not  the  directory
       itself.   So  when  source:path  is a directory, it’s the contents of source:path that are
       copied, not the directory name and contents.

       To copy single files, use the copyto (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyto/)  command
       instead.

       If dest:path doesn’t exist, it is created and the source:path contents go there.

       For example

              rclone copy source:sourcepath dest:destpath

       Let’s say there are two files in sourcepath

              sourcepath/one.txt
              sourcepath/two.txt

       This copies them to

              destpath/one.txt
              destpath/two.txt

       Not to

              destpath/sourcepath/one.txt
              destpath/sourcepath/two.txt

       If  you  are familiar with rsync, rclone always works as if you had written a trailing / -
       meaning “copy the contents of this directory”.  This applies to all commands  and  whether
       you are talking about the source or destination.

       See the –no-traverse (https://rclone.org/docs/#no-traverse) option for controlling whether
       rclone lists the destination directory or not.  Supplying this option when copying a small
       number of files into a large destination can speed transfers up greatly.

       For  example,  if  you have many files in /path/to/src but only a few of them change every
       day, you can copy all the files which have changed recently very efficiently like this:

              rclone copy --max-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/src remote:

       Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

       Note: Use the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag to test without copying anything.

              rclone copy source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                    --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after copy
                -h, --help                    help for copy

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone sync

       Make source and dest identical, modifying destination only.

   Synopsis
       Sync the source to the destination, changing the destination only.  Doesn’t transfer files
       that are identical on source and destination, testing by size  and  modification  time  or
       MD5SUM.   Destination  is  updated  to match source, including deleting files if necessary
       (except  duplicate  objects,  see  below).   If  you  don’t  want  to  delete  files  from
       destination, use the copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command instead.

       Important:  Since  this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run or the
       --interactive/-i flag.

              rclone sync -i SOURCE remote:DESTINATION

       Note that files in the destination won’t be deleted if there were any errors at any point.
       Duplicate  objects (files with the same name, on those providers that support it) are also
       not yet handled.

       It is always the contents of the directory that is synced, not the directory  itself.   So
       when source:path is a directory, it’s the contents of source:path that are copied, not the
       directory   name   and   contents.     See    extended    explanation    in    the    copy
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command if unsure.

       If dest:path doesn’t exist, it is created and the source:path contents go there.

       It  is not possible to sync overlapping remotes.  However, you may exclude the destination
       from the sync with a filter rule or by  putting  an  exclude-if-present  file  inside  the
       destination directory and sync to a destination that is inside the source directory.

       Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

       Note:  Use  the  rclone  dedupe  command to deal with “Duplicate object/directory found in
       source/destination     -     ignoring”     errors.      See      this      forum      post
       (https://forum.rclone.org/t/sync-not-clearing-duplicates/14372) for more info.

              rclone sync source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                    --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after sync
                -h, --help                    help for sync

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone move

       Move files from source to dest.

   Synopsis
       Moves the contents of the source directory to  the  destination  directory.   Rclone  will
       error  if the source and destination overlap and the remote does not support a server-side
       directory move operation.

       To move single files, use the moveto (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_moveto/)  command
       instead.

       If  no  filters  are  in  use  and if possible this will server-side move source:path into
       dest:path.  After this source:path will no longer exist.

       Otherwise for each file in source:path selected by the filters (if any) this will move  it
       into  dest:path.   If  possible a server-side move will be used, otherwise it will copy it
       (server-side if possible) into dest:path then delete the original (if no errors  on  copy)
       in source:path.

       If you want to delete empty source directories after move, use the --delete-empty-src-dirs
       flag.

       See the –no-traverse (https://rclone.org/docs/#no-traverse) option for controlling whether
       rclone  lists the destination directory or not.  Supplying this option when moving a small
       number of files into a large destination can speed transfers up greatly.

       Important: Since this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run  or  the
       --interactive/-i flag.

       Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

              rclone move source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                    --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after move
                    --delete-empty-src-dirs   Delete empty source dirs after move
                -h, --help                    help for move

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone delete

       Remove the files in path.

   Synopsis
       Remove the files in path.   Unlike  purge  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/)  it
       obeys include/exclude filters so can be used to selectively delete files.

       rclone delete only deletes files but leaves the directory structure alone.  If you want to
       delete    a    directory    and    all    of    its     contents     use     the     purge
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

       If  you supply the --rmdirs flag, it will remove all empty directories along with it.  You
       can also use the separate  command  rmdir  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/)  or
       rmdirs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/) to delete empty directories only.

       For  example,  to  delete  all files bigger than 100 MiB, you may first want to check what
       would be deleted (use either):

              rclone --min-size 100M lsl remote:path
              rclone --dry-run --min-size 100M delete remote:path

       Then proceed with the actual delete:

              rclone --min-size 100M delete remote:path

       That reads “delete everything with a minimum size of 100  MiB”,  hence  delete  all  files
       bigger than 100 MiB.

       Important:  Since  this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run or the
       --interactive/-i flag.

              rclone delete remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help     help for delete
                    --rmdirs   rmdirs removes empty directories but leaves root intact

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone purge

       Remove the path and all of its contents.

   Synopsis
       Remove  the  path  and  all of its contents.  Note that this does not obey include/exclude
       filters     -     everything     will      be      removed.       Use      the      delete
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/)  command  if  you  want to selectively delete
       files.     To     delete     empty     directories     only,     use     command     rmdir
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/)                    or                   rmdirs
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/).

       Important: Since this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run  or  the
       --interactive/-i flag.

              rclone purge remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for purge

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone mkdir

       Make the path if it doesn’t already exist.

              rclone mkdir remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for mkdir

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone rmdir

       Remove the empty directory at path.

   Synopsis
       This  removes  empty  directory  given  by  path.   Will not remove the path if it has any
       objects   in   it,    not    even    empty    subdirectories.     Use    command    rmdirs
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/)                   (or                  delete
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) with option --rmdirs) to do that.

       To     delete     a     path     and     any     objects     in     it,     use      purge
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

              rclone rmdir remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for rmdir

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone check

       Checks the files in the source and destination match.

   Synopsis
       Checks the files in the source and destination match.  It compares sizes and  hashes  (MD5
       or  SHA1)  and  logs  a  report of files that don’t match.  It doesn’t alter the source or
       destination.

       For the crypt (https://rclone.org/crypt/) remote there is a dedicated command,  cryptcheck
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cryptcheck/),  that are able to check the checksums of
       the crypted files.

       If you supply the --size-only flag, it will only compare the sizes not the hashes as well.
       Use this for a quick check.

       If  you  supply the --download flag, it will download the data from both remotes and check
       them against each other on the fly.  This can be useful for  remotes  that  don’t  support
       hashes or if you really want to check all the data.

       If you supply the --checkfile HASH flag with a valid hash name, the source:path must point
       to a text file in the SUM format.

       If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the  source  match  the
       files  in  the  destination, not the other way around.  This means that extra files in the
       destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

       The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match and --error flags  write  paths,
       one  per  line,  to  the  file  name  (or stdout if it is -) supplied.  What they write is
       described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are  present
       on both the source and destination but different.

       The  --combined  flag  will  write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a
       symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what  happened  to  it.   These  are
       reminiscent of diff files.

       • = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

       • - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

       • + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

       • * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

       • ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

         rclone check source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                -C, --checkfile string        Treat source:path as a SUM file with hashes of given type
                    --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                    --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                    --download                Check by downloading rather than with hash
                    --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
                -h, --help                    help for check
                    --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                    --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                    --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                    --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone ls

       List the objects in the path with size and path.

   Synopsis
       Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human  readable  format  with
       size and path.  Recurses by default.

       Eg

              $ rclone ls swift:bucket
                  60295 bevajer5jef
                  90613 canole
                  94467 diwogej7
                  37600 fubuwic

       Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

       There are several related list commands

       • ls to list size and path of objects only

       • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

       • lsd to list directories only

       • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

       • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

       ls,lsl,lsd  are  designed  to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-
       readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

       Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use  -R  to  make  them
       recurse.

       Listing  a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can’t have
       empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based remotes).

              rclone ls remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for ls

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone lsd

       List all directories/containers/buckets in the path.

   Synopsis
       Lists the directories in the source path to standard output.  Does not recurse by default.
       Use the -R flag to recurse.

       This command lists the total size of the directory (if known, -1 if not), the modification
       time  (if  known,  the  current  time  if not), the number of objects in the directory (if
       known, -1 if not) and the name of the directory, Eg

              $ rclone lsd swift:
                    494000 2018-04-26 08:43:20     10000 10000files
                        65 2018-04-26 08:43:20         1 1File

       Or

              $ rclone lsd drive:test
                        -1 2016-10-17 17:41:53        -1 1000files
                        -1 2017-01-03 14:40:54        -1 2500files
                        -1 2017-07-08 14:39:28        -1 4000files

       If you just want the directory names use rclone lsf --dirs-only.

       Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

       There are several related list commands

       • ls to list size and path of objects only

       • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

       • lsd to list directories only

       • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

       • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

       ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be  human  and  machine-
       readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

       Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       The  other  list  commands  lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them
       recurse.

       Listing a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can’t  have
       empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based remotes).

              rclone lsd remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help        help for lsd
                -R, --recursive   Recurse into the listing

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone lsl

       List the objects in path with modification time, size and path.

   Synopsis
       Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human  readable  format  with
       modification time, size and path.  Recurses by default.

       Eg

              $ rclone lsl swift:bucket
                  60295 2016-06-25 18:55:41.062626927 bevajer5jef
                  90613 2016-06-25 18:55:43.302607074 canole
                  94467 2016-06-25 18:55:43.046609333 diwogej7
                  37600 2016-06-25 18:55:40.814629136 fubuwic

       Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

       There are several related list commands

       • ls to list size and path of objects only

       • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

       • lsd to list directories only

       • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

       • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

       ls,lsl,lsd  are  designed  to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be human and machine-
       readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

       Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use  -R  to  make  them
       recurse.

       Listing  a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can’t have
       empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based remotes).

              rclone lsl remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for lsl

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone md5sum

       Produces an md5sum file for all the objects in the path.

   Synopsis
       Produces  an  md5sum  file for all the objects in the path.  This is in the same format as
       the standard md5sum tool produces.

       By default, the hash is requested from the remote.  If MD5 is not supported by the remote,
       no  hash  will  be returned.  With the download flag, the file will be downloaded from the
       remote and hashed locally enabling MD5 for any remote.

       For  other  algorithms,  see  the  hashsum   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/)
       command.   Running  rclone  md5sum remote:path is equivalent to running rclone hashsum MD5
       remote:path.

       This command can also hash data received on standard  input  (stdin),  by  not  passing  a
       remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to read (if not, the
       hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

              rclone md5sum remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
                -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                    --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
                -h, --help                 help for md5sum
                    --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone sha1sum

       Produces an sha1sum file for all the objects in the path.

   Synopsis
       Produces  an  sha1sum file for all the objects in the path.  This is in the same format as
       the standard sha1sum tool produces.

       By default, the hash is requested from the remote.  If  SHA-1  is  not  supported  by  the
       remote,  no  hash  will  be returned.  With the download flag, the file will be downloaded
       from the remote and hashed locally enabling SHA-1 for any remote.

       For  other  algorithms,  see  the  hashsum   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/)
       command.   Running rclone sha1sum remote:path is equivalent to running rclone hashsum SHA1
       remote:path.

       This command can also hash data received on standard  input  (stdin),  by  not  passing  a
       remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to read (if not, the
       hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

       This command can also hash data received on STDIN, if not passing a remote:path.

              rclone sha1sum remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
                -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                    --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
                -h, --help                 help for sha1sum
                    --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone size

       Prints the total size and number of objects in remote:path.

   Synopsis
       Counts  objects  in the path and calculates the total size.  Prints the result to standard
       output.

       By default the output is in human-readable format, but shows values in both human-readable
       format as well as the raw numbers (global option --human-readable is not considered).  Use
       option --json to format output as JSON instead.

       Recurses by default, use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       Some  backends  do  not  always  provide  file  sizes,  see  for  example  Google   Photos
       (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/#size)             and            Google            Drive
       (https://rclone.org/drive/#limitations-of-google-docs).  Rclone will then show a notice in
       the  log indicating how many such files were encountered, and count them in as empty files
       in the output of the size command.

              rclone size remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for size
                    --json   Format output as JSON

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone version

       Show the version number.

   Synopsis
       Show  the rclone version number, the go version, the build target OS and architecture, the
       runtime OS and kernel version and bitness, build tags and the type of  executable  (static
       or dynamic).

       For example:

              $ rclone version
              rclone v1.55.0
              - os/version: ubuntu 18.04 (64 bit)
              - os/kernel: 4.15.0-136-generic (x86_64)
              - os/type: linux
              - os/arch: amd64
              - go/version: go1.16
              - go/linking: static
              - go/tags: none

       Note:  before  rclone  version  1.55  the  os/type  and os/arch lines were merged, and the
       “go/version” line was tagged as “go version”.

       If you supply the –check flag, then it will do an online check  to  compare  your  version
       with the latest release and the latest beta.

              $ rclone version --check
              yours:  1.42.0.6
              latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
              beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)

       Or

              $ rclone version --check
              yours:  1.41
              latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
                upgrade: https://downloads.rclone.org/v1.42
              beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)
                upgrade: https://beta.rclone.org/v1.42-005-g56e1e820

              rclone version [flags]

   Options
                    --check   Check for new version
                -h, --help    help for version

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone cleanup

       Clean up the remote if possible.

   Synopsis
       Clean up the remote if possible.  Empty the  trash  or  delete  old  file  versions.   Not
       supported by all remotes.

              rclone cleanup remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for cleanup

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone dedupe

       Interactively find duplicate filenames and delete/rename them.

   Synopsis
       By default dedupe interactively finds files with duplicate names and offers to delete  all
       but one or rename them to be different.  This is known as deduping by name.

       Deduping  by  name  is  only  useful  with  a  small group of backends (e.g. Google Drive,
       Opendrive) that can have duplicate file  names.   It  can  be  run  on  wrapping  backends
       (e.g. crypt) if they wrap a backend which supports duplicate file names.

       However  if  --by-hash  is  passed  in  then  dedupe will find files with duplicate hashes
       instead which will work on any backend which supports at least one hash.  This can be used
       to find files with duplicate content.  This is known as deduping by hash.

       If  deduping  by name, first rclone will merge directories with the same name.  It will do
       this iteratively until all the identically named directories have been merged.

       Next, if deduping by name, for every group of duplicate  file  names  /  hashes,  it  will
       delete all but one identical file it finds without confirmation.  This means that for most
       duplicated files the dedupe command will not be interactive.

       dedupe considers files to be identical if they have the same file path and the same  hash.
       If  the  backend does not support hashes (e.g. crypt wrapping Google Drive) then they will
       never be found to be identical.  If you use  the  --size-only  flag  then  files  will  be
       considered  identical  if they have the same size (any hash will be ignored).  This can be
       useful on crypt backends which do not support hashes.

       Next rclone will resolve the remaining duplicates.  Exactly which action is taken  depends
       on the dedupe mode.  By default, rclone will interactively query the user for each one.

       Important:  Since  this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run or the
       --interactive/-i flag.

       Here is an example run.

       Before - with duplicates

              $ rclone lsl drive:dupes
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:11.775000000 one.txt
                 564374 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000 one.txt
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:18:26.092000000 one.txt
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two.txt
                1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two.txt
                 564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two.txt

       Now the dedupe session

              $ rclone dedupe drive:dupes
              2016/03/05 16:24:37 Google drive root 'dupes': Looking for duplicates using interactive mode.
              one.txt: Found 4 files with duplicate names
              one.txt: Deleting 2/3 identical duplicates (MD5 "1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36")
              one.txt: 2 duplicates remain
                1:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
                2:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
              s) Skip and do nothing
              k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
              r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
              s/k/r> k
              Enter the number of the file to keep> 1
              one.txt: Deleted 1 extra copies
              two.txt: Found 3 files with duplicate names
              two.txt: 3 duplicates remain
                1:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
                2:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
                3:      1744073 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000, MD5 851957f7fb6f0bc4ce76be966d336802
              s) Skip and do nothing
              k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
              r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
              s/k/r> r
              two-1.txt: renamed from: two.txt
              two-2.txt: renamed from: two.txt
              two-3.txt: renamed from: two.txt

       The result being

              $ rclone lsl drive:dupes
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
                 564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two-1.txt
                6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two-2.txt
                1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two-3.txt

       Dedupe can be run non interactively using the --dedupe-mode flag  or  by  using  an  extra
       parameter with the same value

       • --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive as above.

       • --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.

       • --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.

       • --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.

       • --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.

       • --dedupe-mode largest - removes identical files then keeps the largest one.

       • --dedupe-mode smallest - removes identical files then keeps the smallest one.

       • --dedupe-mode rename - removes identical files then renames the rest to be different.

       • --dedupe-mode list - lists duplicate dirs and files only and changes nothing.

       For  example,  to rename all the identically named photos in your Google Photos directory,
       do

              rclone dedupe --dedupe-mode rename "drive:Google Photos"

       Or

              rclone dedupe rename "drive:Google Photos"

              rclone dedupe [mode] remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --by-hash              Find identical hashes rather than names
                    --dedupe-mode string   Dedupe mode interactive|skip|first|newest|oldest|largest|smallest|rename (default "interactive")
                -h, --help                 help for dedupe

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone about

       Get quota information from the remote.

   Synopsis
       rclone  about  prints  quota information about a remote to standard output.  The output is
       typically used, free, quota and trash contents.

       E.g.  Typical output from rclone about remote: is:

              Total:   17 GiB
              Used:    7.444 GiB
              Free:    1.315 GiB
              Trashed: 100.000 MiB
              Other:   8.241 GiB

       Where the fields are:

       • Total: Total size available.

       • Used: Total size used.

       • Free: Total space available to this user.

       • Trashed: Total space used by trash.

       • Other: Total amount in other storage (e.g. Gmail, Google Photos).

       • Objects: Total number of objects in the storage.

       All sizes are in number of bytes.

       Applying a --full flag to the command prints the bytes in full, e.g.

              Total:   18253611008
              Used:    7993453766
              Free:    1411001220
              Trashed: 104857602
              Other:   8849156022

       A --json flag generates conveniently machine-readable output, e.g.

              {
                  "total": 18253611008,
                  "used": 7993453766,
                  "trashed": 104857602,
                  "other": 8849156022,
                  "free": 1411001220
              }

       Not all backends print all fields.  Information is not included if it is not provided by a
       backend.  Where the value is unlimited it is omitted.

       Some  backends  does  not  support  the  rclone about command at all, see complete list in
       documentation (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features).

              rclone about remote: [flags]

   Options
                    --full   Full numbers instead of human-readable
                -h, --help   help for about
                    --json   Format output as JSON

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone authorize

       Remote authorization.

   Synopsis
       Remote authorization.  Used to authorize a remote or headless rclone from a machine with a
       browser - use as instructed by rclone config.

       Use the –auth-no-open-browser to prevent rclone to  open  auth  link  in  default  browser
       automatically.

              rclone authorize [flags]

   Options
                    --auth-no-open-browser   Do not automatically open auth link in default browser
                -h, --help                   help for authorize

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone backend

       Run a backend-specific command.

   Synopsis
       This runs a backend-specific command.  The commands  themselves  (except  for  “help”  and
       “features”)  are  defined  by  the  backends  and  you  should  see  the  backend docs for
       definitions.

       You can discover what commands a backend implements by using

              rclone backend help remote:
              rclone backend help <backendname>

       You  can  also  discover  information  about  the  backend  using  (see  operations/fsinfo
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#operations-fsinfo) in the remote control docs for more info).

              rclone backend features remote:

       Pass options to the backend command with -o.  This should be key=value or key, e.g.:

              rclone backend stats remote:path stats -o format=json -o long

       Pass arguments to the backend by placing them on the end of the line

              rclone backend cleanup remote:path file1 file2 file3

       Note   to   run   these   commands   on   a   running  backend  then  see  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command) in the rc docs.

              rclone backend <command> remote:path [opts] <args> [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help                 help for backend
                    --json                 Always output in JSON format
                -o, --option stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone bisync

       Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.

   Synopsis
       Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.

       Bisync  (https://rclone.org/bisync/)  provides  a  bidirectional  cloud  sync  solution in
       rclone.  It retains the Path1 and Path2 filesystem listings from the prior run.   On  each
       successive  run  it  will:  - list files on Path1 and Path2, and check for changes on each
       side.  Changes include New, Newer, Older, and Deleted files.  - Propagate changes on Path1
       to Path2, and vice-versa.

       See full bisync description (https://rclone.org/bisync/) for details.

              rclone bisync remote1:path1 remote2:path2 [flags]

   Options
                    --check-access            Ensure expected RCLONE_TEST files are found on both Path1 and Path2 filesystems, else abort.
                    --check-filename string   Filename for --check-access (default: RCLONE_TEST)
                    --check-sync string       Controls comparison of final listings: true|false|only (default: true) (default "true")
                    --filters-file string     Read filtering patterns from a file
                    --force                   Bypass --max-delete safety check and run the sync. Consider using with --verbose
                -h, --help                    help for bisync
                    --localtime               Use local time in listings (default: UTC)
                    --no-cleanup              Retain working files (useful for troubleshooting and testing).
                    --remove-empty-dirs       Remove empty directories at the final cleanup step.
                -1, --resync                  Performs the resync run. Path1 files may overwrite Path2 versions. Consider using --verbose or --dry-run first.
                    --workdir string          Use custom working dir - useful for testing. (default: $HOME/.cache/rclone/bisync)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone cat

       Concatenates any files and sends them to stdout.

   Synopsis
       rclone cat sends any files to standard output.

       You can use it like this to output a single file

              rclone cat remote:path/to/file

       Or like this to output any file in dir or its subdirectories.

              rclone cat remote:path/to/dir

       Or like this to output any .txt files in dir or its subdirectories.

              rclone --include "*.txt" cat remote:path/to/dir

       Use the --head flag to print characters only at the start, --tail for the end and --offset
       and  --count  to  print  a section in the middle.  Note that if offset is negative it will
       count from the end, so --offset -1 --count 1 is equivalent to --tail 1.

              rclone cat remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --count int    Only print N characters (default -1)
                    --discard      Discard the output instead of printing
                    --head int     Only print the first N characters
                -h, --help         help for cat
                    --offset int   Start printing at offset N (or from end if -ve)
                    --tail int     Only print the last N characters

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone checksum

       Checks the files in the source against a SUM file.

   Synopsis
       Checks  that  hashsums of source files match the SUM file.  It compares hashes (MD5, SHA1,
       etc) and logs a report of files which don’t match.  It doesn’t alter the file system.

       If you supply the --download flag, it will download the data from remote and calculate the
       contents  hash on the fly.  This can be useful for remotes that don’t support hashes or if
       you really want to check all the data.

       Note that hash values in the SUM file are treated as case insensitive.

       If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the  source  match  the
       files  in  the  destination, not the other way around.  This means that extra files in the
       destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

       The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match and --error flags  write  paths,
       one  per  line,  to  the  file  name  (or stdout if it is -) supplied.  What they write is
       described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are  present
       on both the source and destination but different.

       The  --combined  flag  will  write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a
       symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what  happened  to  it.   These  are
       reminiscent of diff files.

       • = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

       • - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

       • + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

       • * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

       • ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

         rclone checksum <hash> sumfile src:path [flags]

   Options
                    --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                    --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                    --download                Check by hashing the contents
                    --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
                -h, --help                    help for checksum
                    --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                    --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                    --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                    --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone completion

       Generate the autocompletion script for the specified shell

   Synopsis
       Generate the autocompletion script for rclone for the  specified  shell.   See  each  sub-
       command’s help for details on how to use the generated script.

   Options
                -h, --help   help for completion

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

       • rclone completion bash (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_bash/) -  Generate
         the autocompletion script for bash

       • rclone  completion fish (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_fish/) - Generate
         the autocompletion script for fish

       • rclone completion powershell (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_powershell/)
         - Generate the autocompletion script for powershell

       • rclone  completion  zsh  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion_zsh/) - Generate
         the autocompletion script for zsh

rclone completion bash

       Generate the autocompletion script for bash

   Synopsis
       Generate the autocompletion script for the bash shell.

       This script depends on the `bash-completion' package.  If it is not installed already, you
       can install it via your OS’s package manager.

       To load completions in your current shell session:

              source <(rclone completion bash)

       To load completions for every new session, execute once:

   Linux:
              rclone completion bash > /etc/bash_completion.d/rclone

   macOS:
              rclone completion bash > $(brew --prefix)/etc/bash_completion.d/rclone

       You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

              rclone completion bash

   Options
                -h, --help              help for bash
                    --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   completion   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/)  -  Generate  the
         autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion fish

       Generate the autocompletion script for fish

   Synopsis
       Generate the autocompletion script for the fish shell.

       To load completions in your current shell session:

              rclone completion fish | source

       To load completions for every new session, execute once:

              rclone completion fish > ~/.config/fish/completions/rclone.fish

       You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

              rclone completion fish [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help              help for fish
                    --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  completion  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/)  -   Generate   the
         autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion powershell

       Generate the autocompletion script for powershell

   Synopsis
       Generate the autocompletion script for powershell.

       To load completions in your current shell session:

              rclone completion powershell | Out-String | Invoke-Expression

       To  load  completions  for  every new session, add the output of the above command to your
       powershell profile.

              rclone completion powershell [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help              help for powershell
                    --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  completion  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/)  -   Generate   the
         autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone completion zsh

       Generate the autocompletion script for zsh

   Synopsis
       Generate the autocompletion script for the zsh shell.

       If shell completion is not already enabled in your environment you will need to enable it.
       You can execute the following once:

              echo "autoload -U compinit; compinit" >> ~/.zshrc

       To load completions in your current shell session:

              source <(rclone completion zsh); compdef _rclone rclone

       To load completions for every new session, execute once:

   Linux:
              rclone completion zsh > "${fpath[1]}/_rclone"

   macOS:
              rclone completion zsh > $(brew --prefix)/share/zsh/site-functions/_rclone

       You will need to start a new shell for this setup to take effect.

              rclone completion zsh [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help              help for zsh
                    --no-descriptions   disable completion descriptions

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  completion  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_completion/)  -   Generate   the
         autocompletion script for the specified shell

rclone config create

       Create a new remote with name, type and options.

   Synopsis
       Create  a new remote of name with type and options.  The options should be passed in pairs
       of key value or as key=value.

       For example, to make a swift remote of name myremote using auto config you would do:

              rclone config create myremote swift env_auth true
              rclone config create myremote swift env_auth=true

       So for example if you  wanted  to  configure  a  Google  Drive  remote  but  using  remote
       authorization you would do this:

              rclone config create mydrive drive config_is_local=false

       Note that if the config process would normally ask a question the default is taken (unless
       --non-interactive is used).  Each time that happens rclone will print or DEBUG  a  message
       saying how to affect the value taken.

       If  any  of  the  parameters  passed  is  a password field, then rclone will automatically
       obscure them if they aren’t already obscured before putting them in the config file.

       NB If the password parameter is 22 characters  or  longer  and  consists  only  of  base64
       characters  then rclone can get confused about whether the password is already obscured or
       not and put unobscured passwords into the config file.  If you want  to  be  100%  certain
       that  the  passwords  get obscured then use the --obscure flag, or if you are 100% certain
       you are already passing obscured passwords  then  use  --no-obscure.   You  can  also  set
       obscured passwords using the rclone config password command.

       The  flag  --non-interactive  is  for  use  by  applications that wish to configure rclone
       themselves, rather than using rclone’s text based configuration questions.  If  this  flag
       is set, and rclone needs to ask the user a question, a JSON blob will be returned with the
       question in it.

       This will look something like (some irrelevant detail removed):

              {
                  "State": "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,,",
                  "Option": {
                      "Name": "config_is_local",
                      "Help": "Use auto config?\n * Say Y if not sure\n * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine\n",
                      "Default": true,
                      "Examples": [
                          {
                              "Value": "true",
                              "Help": "Yes"
                          },
                          {
                              "Value": "false",
                              "Help": "No"
                          }
                      ],
                      "Required": false,
                      "IsPassword": false,
                      "Type": "bool",
                      "Exclusive": true,
                  },
                  "Error": "",
              }

       The format of Option is the same as returned by rclone  config  providers.   The  question
       should  be  asked to the user and returned to rclone as the --result option along with the
       --state parameter.

       The keys of Option are used as follows:

       • Name - name of variable - show to user

       • Help - help text.  Hard wrapped at 80 chars.  Any URLs should be clicky.

       • Default - default value - return this if the user just wants the default.

       • Examples - the user should be able to choose one of these

       • Required - the value should be non-empty

       • IsPassword - the value is a password and should be edited as such

       • Type - type of value, eg bool, string, int and others

       • Exclusive - if set no free-form entry allowed only the Examples

       • Irrelevant keys Provider, ShortOpt, Hide, NoPrefix, Advanced

       If Error is set then it should be shown to the user at the same time as the question.

              rclone config update name --continue --state "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,," --result "true"

       Note that when using  --continue  all  passwords  should  be  passed  in  the  clear  (not
       obscured).   Any  default  config  values  should  be  passed  in  with each invocation of
       --continue.

       At the end of the non interactive process, rclone will return a result with State as empty
       string.

       If --all is passed then rclone will ask all the config questions, not just the post config
       questions.  Any parameters are used as defaults for questions as usual.

       Note that bin/config.py in the rclone  source  implements  this  protocol  as  a  readable
       demonstration.

              rclone config create name type [key value]* [flags]

   Options
                    --all               Ask the full set of config questions
                    --continue          Continue the configuration process with an answer
                -h, --help              help for create
                    --no-obscure        Force any passwords not to be obscured
                    --non-interactive   Don't interact with user and return questions
                    --obscure           Force any passwords to be obscured
                    --result string     Result - use with --continue
                    --state string      State - use with --continue

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config delete

       Delete an existing remote.

              rclone config delete name [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for delete

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config disconnect

       Disconnects user from remote

   Synopsis
       This disconnects the remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

       This normally means revoking the oauth token.

       To reconnect use “rclone config reconnect”.

              rclone config disconnect remote: [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for disconnect

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config dump

       Dump the config file as JSON.

              rclone config dump [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for dump

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config edit

       Enter an interactive configuration session.

Synopsis

       Enter  an  interactive  configuration  session  where you can setup new remotes and manage
       existing ones.  You may also set or remove a password to protect your configuration.

              rclone config edit [flags]

Options

                -h, --help   help for edit

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config file

       Show path of configuration file in use.

              rclone config file [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for file

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config password

       Update password in an existing remote.

   Synopsis
       Update an existing remote’s password.  The password should  be  passed  in  pairs  of  key
       password or as key=password.  The password should be passed in in clear (unobscured).

       For example, to set password of a remote of name myremote you would do:

              rclone config password myremote fieldname mypassword
              rclone config password myremote fieldname=mypassword

       This  command  is  obsolete  now  that  “config  update”  and “config create” both support
       obscuring passwords directly.

              rclone config password name [key value]+ [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for password

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config paths

       Show paths used for configuration, cache, temp etc.

              rclone config paths [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for paths

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config providers

       List in JSON format all the providers and options.

              rclone config providers [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for providers

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config reconnect

       Re-authenticates user with remote.

   Synopsis
       This reconnects remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

       To disconnect the remote use “rclone config disconnect”.

       This normally means going through the interactive oauth flow again.

              rclone config reconnect remote: [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for reconnect

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config show

       Print (decrypted) config file, or the config for a single remote.

              rclone config show [<remote>] [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for show

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config touch

       Ensure configuration file exists.

              rclone config touch [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for touch

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config update

       Update options in an existing remote.

   Synopsis
       Update an existing remote’s options.  The options should be passed in pairs of  key  value
       or as key=value.

       For example, to update the env_auth field of a remote of name myremote you would do:

              rclone config update myremote env_auth true
              rclone config update myremote env_auth=true

       If the remote uses OAuth the token will be updated, if you don’t require this add an extra
       parameter thus:

              rclone config update myremote env_auth=true config_refresh_token=false

       Note that if the config process would normally ask a question the default is taken (unless
       --non-interactive  is  used).  Each time that happens rclone will print or DEBUG a message
       saying how to affect the value taken.

       If any of the parameters passed is  a  password  field,  then  rclone  will  automatically
       obscure them if they aren’t already obscured before putting them in the config file.

       NB  If  the  password  parameter  is  22  characters or longer and consists only of base64
       characters then rclone can get confused about whether the password is already obscured  or
       not  and  put  unobscured  passwords into the config file.  If you want to be 100% certain
       that the passwords get obscured then use the --obscure flag, or if you  are  100%  certain
       you  are  already  passing  obscured  passwords  then  use --no-obscure.  You can also set
       obscured passwords using the rclone config password command.

       The flag --non-interactive is for use  by  applications  that  wish  to  configure  rclone
       themselves,  rather  than using rclone’s text based configuration questions.  If this flag
       is set, and rclone needs to ask the user a question, a JSON blob will be returned with the
       question in it.

       This will look something like (some irrelevant detail removed):

              {
                  "State": "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,,",
                  "Option": {
                      "Name": "config_is_local",
                      "Help": "Use auto config?\n * Say Y if not sure\n * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine\n",
                      "Default": true,
                      "Examples": [
                          {
                              "Value": "true",
                              "Help": "Yes"
                          },
                          {
                              "Value": "false",
                              "Help": "No"
                          }
                      ],
                      "Required": false,
                      "IsPassword": false,
                      "Type": "bool",
                      "Exclusive": true,
                  },
                  "Error": "",
              }

       The  format  of  Option  is the same as returned by rclone config providers.  The question
       should be asked to the user and returned to rclone as the --result option along  with  the
       --state parameter.

       The keys of Option are used as follows:

       • Name - name of variable - show to user

       • Help - help text.  Hard wrapped at 80 chars.  Any URLs should be clicky.

       • Default - default value - return this if the user just wants the default.

       • Examples - the user should be able to choose one of these

       • Required - the value should be non-empty

       • IsPassword - the value is a password and should be edited as such

       • Type - type of value, eg bool, string, int and others

       • Exclusive - if set no free-form entry allowed only the Examples

       • Irrelevant keys Provider, ShortOpt, Hide, NoPrefix, Advanced

       If Error is set then it should be shown to the user at the same time as the question.

              rclone config update name --continue --state "*oauth-islocal,teamdrive,," --result "true"

       Note  that  when  using  --continue  all  passwords  should  be  passed  in the clear (not
       obscured).  Any default config  values  should  be  passed  in  with  each  invocation  of
       --continue.

       At the end of the non interactive process, rclone will return a result with State as empty
       string.

       If --all is passed then rclone will ask all the config questions, not just the post config
       questions.  Any parameters are used as defaults for questions as usual.

       Note  that  bin/config.py  in  the  rclone  source  implements this protocol as a readable
       demonstration.

              rclone config update name [key value]+ [flags]

   Options
                    --all               Ask the full set of config questions
                    --continue          Continue the configuration process with an answer
                -h, --help              help for update
                    --no-obscure        Force any passwords not to be obscured
                    --non-interactive   Don't interact with user and return questions
                    --obscure           Force any passwords to be obscured
                    --result string     Result - use with --continue
                    --state string      State - use with --continue

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an   interactive
         configuration session.

rclone config userinfo

       Prints info about logged in user of remote.

   Synopsis
       This prints the details of the person logged in to the cloud storage system.

              rclone config userinfo remote: [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for userinfo
                    --json   Format output as JSON

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone   config  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/)  -  Enter  an  interactive
         configuration session.

rclone copyto

       Copy files from source to dest, skipping identical files.

   Synopsis
       If source:path is a file or directory then it copies it  to  a  file  or  directory  named
       dest:path.

       This  can  be used to upload single files to other than their current name.  If the source
       is     a     directory     then     it      acts      exactly      like      the      copy
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command.

       So

              rclone copyto src dst

       where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or /path/to/local or C:.

       This will:

              if src is file
                  copy it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
              if src is directory
                  copy it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
                  see copy command for full details

       This  doesn’t  transfer  files  that  are  identical  on  src and dst, testing by size and
       modification time or MD5SUM.  It doesn’t delete files from the destination.

       Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

              rclone copyto source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for copyto

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone copyurl

       Copy url content to dest.

   Synopsis
       Download  a  URL’s  content  and copy it to the destination without saving it in temporary
       storage.

       Setting --auto-filename will attempt to automatically determine the filename from the  URL
       (after any redirections) and used in the destination path.  With --auto-filename-header in
       addition, if a specific filename is set in HTTP headers, it will be used  instead  of  the
       name  from  the  URL.   With --print-filename in addition, the resulting file name will be
       printed.

       Setting --no-clobber will prevent overwriting file on the destination if there is one with
       the same name.

       Setting  --stdout  or making the output file name - will cause the output to be written to
       standard output.

              rclone copyurl https://example.com dest:path [flags]

   Options
                -a, --auto-filename     Get the file name from the URL and use it for destination file path
                    --header-filename   Get the file name from the Content-Disposition header
                -h, --help              help for copyurl
                    --no-clobber        Prevent overwriting file with same name
                -p, --print-filename    Print the resulting name from --auto-filename
                    --stdout            Write the output to stdout rather than a file

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone cryptcheck

       Cryptcheck checks the integrity of a crypted remote.

   Synopsis
       rclone  cryptcheck  checks  a remote against a crypted (https://rclone.org/crypt/) remote.
       This       is       the       equivalent       of       running        rclone        check
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_check/),  but  able  to  check  the  checksums  of the
       crypted remote.

       For it to work the underlying remote of  the  cryptedremote  must  support  some  kind  of
       checksum.

       It  works  by  reading  the  nonce  from each file on the cryptedremote: and using that to
       encrypt each file on the remote:.  It then checks the checksum of the underlying  file  on
       the cryptedremote: against the checksum of the file it has just encrypted.

       Use it like this

              rclone cryptcheck /path/to/files encryptedremote:path

       You  can  use  it  like  this  also,  but  that  will involve downloading all the files in
       remote:path.

              rclone cryptcheck remote:path encryptedremote:path

       After it has run it will log the status of the encryptedremote:.

       If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in the  source  match  the
       files  in  the  destination, not the other way around.  This means that extra files in the
       destination that are not in the source will not be detected.

       The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match and --error flags  write  paths,
       one  per  line,  to  the  file  name  (or stdout if it is -) supplied.  What they write is
       described in the help below.  For example --differ will write all paths which are  present
       on both the source and destination but different.

       The  --combined  flag  will  write a file (or stdout) which contains all file paths with a
       symbol and then a space and then the path to tell you what  happened  to  it.   These  are
       reminiscent of diff files.

       • = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical

       • - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination

       • + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source

       • * path means path was present in source and destination but different.

       • ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.

         rclone cryptcheck remote:path cryptedremote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
                    --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
                    --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
                -h, --help                    help for cryptcheck
                    --match string            Report all matching files to this file
                    --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
                    --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
                    --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone cryptdecode

       Cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names.

   Synopsis
       rclone cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names when provided with a list  of  encrypted
       file names.  List limit is 10 items.

       If you supply the --reverse flag, it will return encrypted file names.

       use it like this

              rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename1 encryptedfilename2

              rclone cryptdecode --reverse encryptedremote: filename1 filename2

       Another  way to accomplish this is by using the rclone backend encode (or decode) command.
       See the documentation on the crypt (https://rclone.org/crypt/) overlay for more info.

              rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help      help for cryptdecode
                    --reverse   Reverse cryptdecode, encrypts filenames

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone deletefile

       Remove a single file from remote.

   Synopsis
       Remove  a  single file from remote.  Unlike delete it cannot be used to remove a directory
       and it doesn’t obey include/exclude filters - if the specified file exists, it will always
       be removed.

              rclone deletefile remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for deletefile

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone genautocomplete

       Output completion script for a given shell.

   Synopsis
       Generates a shell completion script for rclone.  Run with --help  to  list  the  supported
       shells.

   Options
                -h, --help   help for genautocomplete

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

       • rclone genautocomplete bash (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_bash/) -
         Output bash completion script for rclone.

       • rclone genautocomplete fish (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_fish/) -
         Output fish completion script for rclone.

       • rclone genautocomplete zsh  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete_zsh/)  -
         Output zsh completion script for rclone.

rclone genautocomplete bash

       Output bash completion script for rclone.

   Synopsis
       Generates a bash shell autocompletion script for rclone.

       This  writes  to  /etc/bash_completion.d/rclone by default so will probably need to be run
       with sudo or as root, e.g.

              sudo rclone genautocomplete bash

       Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

              . /etc/bash_completion

       If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

       If output_file is “-”, then the output will be written to stdout.

              rclone genautocomplete bash [output_file] [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for bash

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone genautocomplete  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/)  -  Output
         completion script for a given shell.

rclone genautocomplete fish

       Output fish completion script for rclone.

   Synopsis
       Generates a fish autocompletion script for rclone.

       This  writes  to  /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish by default so will probably need to be
       run with sudo or as root, e.g.

              sudo rclone genautocomplete fish

       Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

              . /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish

       If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

       If output_file is “-”, then the output will be written to stdout.

              rclone genautocomplete fish [output_file] [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for fish

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone genautocomplete  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/)  -  Output
         completion script for a given shell.

rclone genautocomplete zsh

       Output zsh completion script for rclone.

   Synopsis
       Generates a zsh autocompletion script for rclone.

       This  writes to /usr/share/zsh/vendor-completions/_rclone by default so will probably need
       to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

              sudo rclone genautocomplete zsh

       Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source them directly

              autoload -U compinit && compinit

       If you supply a command line argument the script will be written there.

       If output_file is “-”, then the output will be written to stdout.

              rclone genautocomplete zsh [output_file] [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for zsh

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone genautocomplete  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_genautocomplete/)  -  Output
         completion script for a given shell.

rclone gendocs

       Output markdown docs for rclone to the directory supplied.

   Synopsis
       This  produces markdown docs for the rclone commands to the directory supplied.  These are
       in a format suitable for hugo to render into the rclone.org website.

              rclone gendocs output_directory [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for gendocs

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone hashsum

       Produces a hashsum file for all the objects in the path.

   Synopsis
       Produces  a hash file for all the objects in the path using the hash named.  The output is
       in the same format as the standard md5sum/sha1sum tool.

       By default, the hash is requested from the remote.  If the hash is not  supported  by  the
       remote,  no  hash  will  be returned.  With the download flag, the file will be downloaded
       from the remote and hashed locally enabling any hash for any remote.

       For  the  MD5  and  SHA1  algorithms   there   are   also   dedicated   commands,   md5sum
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_md5sum/)                  and                  sha1sum
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sha1sum/).

       This command can also hash data received on standard  input  (stdin),  by  not  passing  a
       remote:path, or by passing a hyphen as remote:path when there is data to read (if not, the
       hyphen will be treated literally, as a relative path).

       Run without a hash to see the list of all supported hashes, e.g.

              $ rclone hashsum
              Supported hashes are:
                * md5
                * sha1
                * whirlpool
                * crc32
                * sha256
                * dropbox
                * hidrive
                * mailru
                * quickxor

       Then

              $ rclone hashsum MD5 remote:path

       Note that hash names are case insensitive and values are output in lower case.

              rclone hashsum <hash> remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
                -C, --checkfile string     Validate hashes against a given SUM file instead of printing them
                    --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
                -h, --help                 help for hashsum
                    --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone link

       Generate public link to file/folder.

   Synopsis
       rclone link will create, retrieve or remove a public link to the given file or folder.

              rclone link remote:path/to/file
              rclone link remote:path/to/folder/
              rclone link --unlink remote:path/to/folder/
              rclone link --expire 1d remote:path/to/file

       If  you supply the –expire flag, it will set the expiration time otherwise it will use the
       default (100 years).  Note not all backends support the –expire  flag  -  if  the  backend
       doesn’t support it then the link returned won’t expire.

       Use  the –unlink flag to remove existing public links to the file or folder.  Note not all
       backends support “–unlink” flag - those that don’t will just ignore it.

       If successful, the last line of the output will  contain  the  link.   Exact  capabilities
       depend  on  the  remote,  but  the  link  will always by default be created with the least
       constraints – e.g. no expiry, no password protection, accessible without account.

              rclone link remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --expire Duration   The amount of time that the link will be valid (default off)
                -h, --help              help for link
                    --unlink            Remove existing public link to file/folder

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone listremotes

       List all the remotes in the config file.

   Synopsis
       rclone listremotes lists all the available remotes from the config file.

       When used with the --long flag it lists the types too.

              rclone listremotes [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for listremotes
                    --long   Show the type as well as names

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone lsf

       List directories and objects in remote:path formatted for parsing.

   Synopsis
       List the contents of the source path (directories and objects) to  standard  output  in  a
       form  which  is  easy  to parse by scripts.  By default this will just be the names of the
       objects and directories, one per line.  The directories will have a / suffix.

       Eg

              $ rclone lsf swift:bucket
              bevajer5jef
              canole
              diwogej7
              ferejej3gux/
              fubuwic

       Use the --format option to control what gets listed.  By default this is  just  the  path,
       but you can use these parameters to control the output:

              p - path
              s - size
              t - modification time
              h - hash
              i - ID of object
              o - Original ID of underlying object
              m - MimeType of object if known
              e - encrypted name
              T - tier of storage if known, e.g. "Hot" or "Cool"
              M - Metadata of object in JSON blob format, eg {"key":"value"}

       So  if  you  wanted the path, size and modification time, you would use --format "pst", or
       maybe --format "tsp" to put the path last.

       Eg

              $ rclone lsf  --format "tsp" swift:bucket
              2016-06-25 18:55:41;60295;bevajer5jef
              2016-06-25 18:55:43;90613;canole
              2016-06-25 18:55:43;94467;diwogej7
              2018-04-26 08:50:45;0;ferejej3gux/
              2016-06-25 18:55:40;37600;fubuwic

       If you specify “h” in the format you will get the MD5 hash by default, use the --hash flag
       to  change  which  hash you want.  Note that this can be returned as an empty string if it
       isn’t available on the object (and for directories), “ERROR” if there was an error reading
       it from the object and “UNSUPPORTED” if that object does not support that hash type.

       For example, to emulate the md5sum command you can use

              rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only .

       Eg

              $ rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only swift:bucket
              7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3  bevajer5jef
              cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc  canole
              03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91  diwogej7
              8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d  fubuwic
              99713e14a4c4ff553acaf1930fad985b  gixacuh7ku

       (Though “rclone md5sum .” is an easier way of typing this.)

       By  default the separator is “;” this can be changed with the --separator flag.  Note that
       separators aren’t escaped in the path so putting it last is a good strategy.

       Eg

              $ rclone lsf  --separator "," --format "tshp" swift:bucket
              2016-06-25 18:55:41,60295,7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3,bevajer5jef
              2016-06-25 18:55:43,90613,cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc,canole
              2016-06-25 18:55:43,94467,03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91,diwogej7
              2018-04-26 08:52:53,0,,ferejej3gux/
              2016-06-25 18:55:40,37600,8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d,fubuwic

       You can output in CSV standard format.  This will escape things in ” if they contain ,

       Eg

              $ rclone lsf --csv --files-only --format ps remote:path
              test.log,22355
              test.sh,449
              "this file contains a comma, in the file name.txt",6

       Note that the --absolute parameter is useful for making lists  of  files  to  pass  to  an
       rclone copy with the --files-from-raw flag.

       For  example,  to  find all the files modified within one day and copy those only (without
       traversing the whole directory structure):

              rclone lsf --absolute --files-only --max-age 1d /path/to/local > new_files
              rclone copy --files-from-raw new_files /path/to/local remote:path

       Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

       There are several related list commands

       • ls to list size and path of objects only

       • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

       • lsd to list directories only

       • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

       • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

       ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be  human  and  machine-
       readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

       Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       The  other  list  commands  lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them
       recurse.

       Listing a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can’t  have
       empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based remotes).

              rclone lsf remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --absolute           Put a leading / in front of path names
                    --csv                Output in CSV format
                -d, --dir-slash          Append a slash to directory names (default true)
                    --dirs-only          Only list directories
                    --files-only         Only list files
                -F, --format string      Output format - see  help for details (default "p")
                    --hash h             Use this hash when h is used in the format MD5|SHA-1|DropboxHash (default "md5")
                -h, --help               help for lsf
                -R, --recursive          Recurse into the listing
                -s, --separator string   Separator for the items in the format (default ";")

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone lsjson

       List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

   Synopsis
       List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

       The output is an array of Items, where each Item looks like this

              {
                "Hashes" : {
                   "SHA-1" : "f572d396fae9206628714fb2ce00f72e94f2258f",
                   "MD5" : "b1946ac92492d2347c6235b4d2611184",
                   "DropboxHash" : "ecb65bb98f9d905b70458986c39fcbad7715e5f2fcc3b1f07767d7c83e2438cc"
                },
                "ID": "y2djkhiujf83u33",
                "OrigID": "UYOJVTUW00Q1RzTDA",
                "IsBucket" : false,
                "IsDir" : false,
                "MimeType" : "application/octet-stream",
                "ModTime" : "2017-05-31T16:15:57.034468261+01:00",
                "Name" : "file.txt",
                "Encrypted" : "v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
                "EncryptedPath" : "kja9098349023498/v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
                "Path" : "full/path/goes/here/file.txt",
                "Size" : 6,
                "Tier" : "hot",
              }

       If --hash is not specified the Hashes property won’t be emitted.  The types of hash can be
       specified  with  the --hash-type parameter (which may be repeated).  If --hash-type is set
       then it implies --hash.

       If --no-modtime is specified then ModTime will be blank.  This  can  speed  things  up  on
       remotes where reading the ModTime takes an extra request (e.g. s3, swift).

       If  --no-mimetype  is  specified then MimeType will be blank.  This can speed things up on
       remotes where reading the MimeType takes an extra request (e.g. s3, swift).

       If --encrypted is not specified the Encrypted won’t be emitted.

       If --dirs-only is not specified files in addition to directories are returned

       If --files-only is not specified directories in addition to the files will be returned.

       If --metadata is set then an additional Metadata key will be  returned.   This  will  have
       metadata in rclone standard format as a JSON object.

       if --stat is set then a single JSON blob will be returned about the item pointed to.  This
       will return an error if the item isn’t found.  However on bucket based backends (like  s3,
       gcs,  b2,  azureblob  etc) if the item isn’t found it will return an empty directory as it
       isn’t possible to tell empty directories from missing directories there.

       The  Path  field  will  only  show  folders  below  the  remote  path  being  listed.   If
       “remote:path”  contains  the  file  “subfolder/file.txt”,  the Path for “file.txt” will be
       “subfolder/file.txt”, not “remote:path/subfolder/file.txt”.  When used without --recursive
       the Path will always be the same as Name.

       If  the  directory  is  a bucket in a bucket-based backend, then “IsBucket” will be set to
       true.  This key won’t be present unless it is “true”.

       The time is in RFC3339 format with up to nanosecond  precision.   The  number  of  decimal
       digits  in the seconds will depend on the precision that the remote can hold the times, so
       if times are accurate to the nearest millisecond (e.g. Google Drive) then  3  digits  will
       always be shown (“2017-05-31T16:15:57.034+01:00”) whereas if the times are accurate to the
       nearest   second   (Dropbox,   Box,   WebDav,   etc.)    no   digits   will    be    shown
       (“2017-05-31T16:15:57+01:00”).

       The  whole  output  can  be processed as a JSON blob, or alternatively it can be processed
       line by line as each item is written one to a line.

       Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

       There are several related list commands

       • ls to list size and path of objects only

       • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only

       • lsd to list directories only

       • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format

       • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

       ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human-readable.  lsf is designed to be  human  and  machine-
       readable.  lsjson is designed to be machine-readable.

       Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

       The  other  list  commands  lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them
       recurse.

       Listing a nonexistent directory will produce an error except for remotes which can’t  have
       empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs - the bucket-based remotes).

              rclone lsjson remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --dirs-only               Show only directories in the listing
                    --encrypted               Show the encrypted names
                    --files-only              Show only files in the listing
                    --hash                    Include hashes in the output (may take longer)
                    --hash-type stringArray   Show only this hash type (may be repeated)
                -h, --help                    help for lsjson
                    --no-mimetype             Don't read the mime type (can speed things up)
                    --no-modtime              Don't read the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --original                Show the ID of the underlying Object
                -R, --recursive               Recurse into the listing
                    --stat                    Just return the info for the pointed to file

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone mount

       Mount the remote as file system on a mountpoint.

   Synopsis
       rclone mount allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows  to  mount  any  of  Rclone’s  cloud
       storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

       First set up your remote using rclone config.  Check it works with rclone ls etc.

       On  Linux  and  macOS,  you  can run mount in either foreground or background (aka daemon)
       mode.  Mount runs in  foreground  mode  by  default.   Use  the  --daemon  flag  to  force
       background mode.  On Windows you can run mount in foreground only, the flag is ignored.

       In  background  mode rclone acts as a generic Unix mount program: the main program starts,
       spawns background rclone process to setup and maintain the mount, waits until  success  or
       timeout and exits with appropriate code (killing the child process if it fails).

       On  Linux/macOS/FreeBSD  start the mount like this, where /path/to/local/mount is an empty
       existing directory:

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files /path/to/local/mount

       On Windows you can start a mount in different ways.  See below for details.  If foreground
       mount  is used interactively from a console window, rclone will serve the mount and occupy
       the console so another window should be used to  work  with  the  mount  until  rclone  is
       interrupted e.g. by pressing Ctrl-C.

       The  following  examples  will mount to an automatically assigned drive, to specific drive
       letter X:, to path C:\path\parent\mount (where parent directory or drive must  exist,  and
       mount must not exist, and is not supported when mounting as a network drive), and the last
       example will mount as network share \\cloud\remote and map it to an automatically assigned
       drive:

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\parent\mount
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote

       When the program ends while in foreground mode, either via Ctrl+C or receiving a SIGINT or
       SIGTERM signal, the mount should be automatically stopped.

       When running in background mode the user will have to stop the mount manually:

              # Linux
              fusermount -u /path/to/local/mount
              # OS X
              umount /path/to/local/mount

       The umount operation can fail, for  example  when  the  mountpoint  is  busy.   When  that
       happens, it is the user’s responsibility to stop the mount manually.

       The  size  of  the mounted file system will be set according to information retrieved from
       the     remote,     the     same     as     returned     by     the      rclone      about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)  command.   Remotes with unlimited storage may
       report the used size only, then an additional 1 PiB of free  space  is  assumed.   If  the
       remote does not support (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features) the about feature
       at all, then 1 PiB is set as both the total and the free size.

   Installing on Windows
       To  run  rclone  mount  on  Windows,  you  will  need  to  download  and  install   WinFsp
       (http://www.secfs.net/winfsp/).

       WinFsp  (https://github.com/winfsp/winfsp)  is  an  open-source  Windows File System Proxy
       which makes it easy to write user space file systems for  Windows.   It  provides  a  FUSE
       emulation      layer      which      rclone      uses     combination     with     cgofuse
       (https://github.com/winfsp/cgofuse).  Both of these packages are by Bill Zissimopoulos who
       was very helpful during the implementation of rclone mount for Windows.

   Mounting modes on windows
       Unlike other operating systems, Microsoft Windows provides a different filesystem type for
       network and fixed drives.  It optimises access on the assumption  fixed  disk  drives  are
       fast and reliable, while network drives have relatively high latency and less reliability.
       Some settings can also be differentiated between the two types, for example  that  Windows
       Explorer  should  just display icons and not create preview thumbnails for image and video
       files on network drives.

       In most cases, rclone will mount the remote as a normal,  fixed  disk  drive  by  default.
       However,  you  can also choose to mount it as a remote network drive, often described as a
       network share.  If you mount an rclone remote using the  default,  fixed  drive  mode  and
       experience  unexpected  program  errors,  freezes  or other issues, consider mounting as a
       network drive instead.

       When mounting as a fixed disk drive you can either mount to an unused drive letter, or  to
       a  path  representing a nonexistent subdirectory of an existing parent directory or drive.
       Using the special value * will tell rclone to  automatically  assign  the  next  available
       drive letter, starting with Z: and moving backward.  Examples:

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\parent\mount
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:

       Option --volname can be used to set a custom volume name for the mounted file system.  The
       default is to use the remote name and path.

       To mount as network drive, you can  add  option  --network-mode  to  your  mount  command.
       Mounting  to  a  directory  path is not supported in this mode, it is a limitation Windows
       imposes on junctions, so the remote must always be mounted to a drive letter.

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode

       A volume name specified with --volname will be used to create the network share  path.   A
       complete     UNC     path,     such    as    \\cloud\remote,    optionally    with    path
       \\cloud\remote\madeup\path, will be used as is.  Any other string  will  be  used  as  the
       share  part,  after  a  default  prefix  \\server\.   If  no volume name is specified then
       \\server\share will be used.  You must make sure the volume name is unique  when  you  are
       mounting  more  than  one drive, or else the mount command will fail.  The share name will
       treated as the volume label for the mapped drive, shown in Windows Explorer etc, while the
       complete  \\server\share will be reported as the remote UNC path by net use etc, just like
       a normal network drive mapping.

       If you specify a full network share UNC path with --volname, this will implicitly set  the
       --network-mode option, so the following two examples have same result:

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --volname \\server\share

       You  may  also  specify  the network share UNC path as the mountpoint itself.  Then rclone
       will automatically assign a drive letter, same as with * and use that as  mountpoint,  and
       instead  use  the  UNC path specified as the volume name, as if it were specified with the
       --volname option.  This will also implicitly set the --network-mode  option.   This  means
       the following two examples have same result:

              rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote
              rclone mount remote:path/to/files * --volname \\cloud\remote

       There is yet another way to enable network mode, and to set the share path, and that is to
       pass     the      “native”      libfuse/WinFsp      option      directly:      --fuse-flag
       --VolumePrefix=\server\share.   Note  that  the  path must be with just a single backslash
       prefix in this case.

       Note: In previous versions of rclone this was the only supported method.

       Read more about drive mapping (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Drive_mapping)

       See also Limitations section below.

   Windows filesystem permissions
       The FUSE emulation layer on Windows must convert between the POSIX-based permission  model
       used  in  FUSE,  and  the  permission model used in Windows, based on access-control lists
       (ACL).

       The mounted filesystem will normally get three entries in its access-control  list  (ACL),
       representing  permissions  for  the  POSIX permission scopes: Owner, group and others.  By
       default, the owner and group will be taken from the current user, and the  built-in  group
       “Everyone”  will  be used to represent others.  The user/group can be customized with FUSE
       options “UserName” and “GroupName”, e.g. -o UserName=user123  -o  GroupName="Authenticated
       Users".   The  permissions  on each entry will be set according to options --dir-perms and
       --file-perms,    which    takes    a    value    in    traditional    numeric     notation
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/File-system_permissions#Numeric_notation).

       The  default  permissions corresponds to --file-perms 0666 --dir-perms 0777, i.e. read and
       write permissions to everyone.  This means you will not be able to start any programs from
       the mount.  To be able to do that you must add execute permissions, e.g. --file-perms 0777
       --dir-perms 0777 to add it to everyone.  If the program needs to write files, chances  are
       you will have to enable VFS File Caching as well (see also limitations).

       Note  that  the  mapping  of  permissions is not always trivial, and the result you see in
       Windows Explorer may not be exactly like you expected.  For example, when setting a  value
       that  includes  write  access,  this  will  be  mapped  to  individual  permissions “write
       attributes”, “write data” and “append data”, but not “write extended attributes”.  Windows
       will  then  show  this  as  basic permission “Special” instead of “Write”, because “Write”
       includes the “write extended attributes” permission.

       If you set POSIX permissions for only allowing access to  the  owner,  using  --file-perms
       0600  --dir-perms  0700,  the  user  group and the built-in “Everyone” group will still be
       given some special permissions, such as  “read  attributes”  and  “read  permissions”,  in
       Windows.   This  is done for compatibility reasons, e.g. to allow users without additional
       permissions to be able to read basic metadata about files like in UNIX.  One case that may
       arise is that other programs (incorrectly) interprets this as the file being accessible by
       everyone.  For example an SSH client may warn about “unprotected private key file”.

       WinFsp 2021 (version 1.9) introduces a new FUSE option  “FileSecurity”,  that  allows  the
       complete     specification     of     file     security     descriptors     using     SDDL
       (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/secauthz/security-descriptor-string-
       format).   With this you can work around issues such as the mentioned “unprotected private
       key file” by specifying -o FileSecurity="D:P(A;;FA;;;OW)", for file all access (FA) to the
       owner (OW).

   Windows caveats
       Drives  created  as  Administrator  are not visible to other accounts, not even an account
       that was elevated to Administrator with the User Account Control (UAC) feature.  A  result
       of this is that if you mount to a drive letter from a Command Prompt run as Administrator,
       and then try to access the same drive  from  Windows  Explorer  (which  does  not  run  as
       Administrator), you will not be able to see the mounted drive.

       If  you  don’t  need  to  access  the  drive from applications running with administrative
       privileges, the easiest way around this is to always create the mount from a  non-elevated
       command prompt.

       To  make  mapped  drives  available  to  the  user account that created them regardless if
       elevated  or  not,  there  is  a  special  Windows  setting  called   linked   connections
       (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/troubleshoot/windows-client/networking/mapped-drives-
       not-available-from-elevated-command#detail-to-configure-the-enablelinkedconnections-
       registry-entry) that can be enabled.

       It  is also possible to make a drive mount available to everyone on the system, by running
       the process creating it as the built-in SYSTEM account.  There  are  several  ways  to  do
       this:  One  is  to  use  the  command-line  utility PsExec (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-
       us/sysinternals/downloads/psexec), from Microsoft’s Sysinternals suite, which  has  option
       -s  to  start  processes  as  the SYSTEM account.  Another alternative is to run the mount
       command from a Windows Scheduled Task, or a Windows Service,  configured  to  run  as  the
       SYSTEM  account.   A  third  alternative  is  to  use  the  WinFsp.Launcher infrastructure
       (https://github.com/winfsp/winfsp/wiki/WinFsp-Service-Architecture)).   Note   that   when
       running  rclone  as another user, it will not use the configuration file from your profile
       unless you tell it  to  with  the  --config  (https://rclone.org/docs/#config-config-file)
       option.  Read more in the install documentation (https://rclone.org/install/).

       Note that mapping to a directory path, instead of a drive letter, does not suffer from the
       same limitations.

   Limitations
       Without the use of --vfs-cache-mode this can only write files sequentially,  it  can  only
       seek  when  reading.   This means that many applications won’t work with their files on an
       rclone mount without --vfs-cache-mode writes or --vfs-cache-mode full.  See the  VFS  File
       Caching section for more info.

       The  bucket-based  remotes (e.g. Swift, S3, Google Compute Storage, B2) do not support the
       concept of empty directories, so empty directories will have a tendency to disappear  once
       they fall out of the directory cache.

       When rclone mount is invoked on Unix with --daemon flag, the main rclone program will wait
       for the background mount to become ready or until the timeout specified by  the  --daemon-
       wait  flag.   On  Linux  it  can  check mount status using ProcFS so the flag in fact sets
       maximum time to wait, while the real wait can be less.  On macOS / BSD the time to wait is
       constant  and  the  check is performed only at the end.  We advise you to set wait time on
       macOS reasonably.

       Only supported on Linux, FreeBSD, OS X and Windows at the moment.

   rclone mount vs rclone sync/copy
       File systems expect things to be 100% reliable, whereas cloud storage systems are  a  long
       way  from  100%  reliable.   The  rclone  sync/copy  commands  cope with this with lots of
       retries.  However rclone mount can’t use retries in the  same  way  without  making  local
       copies  of  the  uploads.   Look  at the VFS File Caching for solutions to make mount more
       reliable.

   Attribute caching
       You can use the flag --attr-timeout to set the  time  the  kernel  caches  the  attributes
       (size, modification time, etc.)  for directory entries.

       The  default  is  1s  which  caches  files just long enough to avoid too many callbacks to
       rclone from the kernel.

       In theory 0s should be the correct value for filesystems  which  can  change  outside  the
       control  of the kernel.  However this causes quite a few problems such as rclone using too
       much memory (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2157), rclone not  serving  files  to
       samba (https://forum.rclone.org/t/rclone-1-39-vs-1-40-mount-issue/5112) and excessive time
       listing directories (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2095#issuecomment-371141147).

       The kernel can cache the info about a file for the time given by --attr-timeout.  You  may
       see  corruption  if the remote file changes length during this window.  It will show up as
       either a truncated file or a file with garbage on the end.  With --attr-timeout 1s this is
       very  unlikely  but  not impossible.  The higher you set --attr-timeout the more likely it
       is.  The default setting of “1s” is the lowest setting which mitigates the problems above.

       If you set it higher (10s or 1m say) then the kernel will call back to rclone  less  often
       making it more efficient, however there is more chance of the corruption issue above.

       If  files  don’t  change  on  the remote outside of the control of rclone then there is no
       chance of corruption.

       This is the same as setting the attr_timeout option in mount.fuse.

   Filters
       Note that all the rclone filters can be used to select a subset of the files to be visible
       in the mount.

   systemd
       When  running  rclone  mount  as a systemd service, it is possible to use Type=notify.  In
       this case the service  will  enter  the  started  state  after  the  mountpoint  has  been
       successfully  set  up.   Units  having the rclone mount service specified as a requirement
       will see all files and folders immediately in this mode.

       Note that systemd runs mount units without any environment  variables  including  PATH  or
       HOME.   This  means that tilde (~) expansion will not work and you should provide --config
       and --cache-dir explicitly  as  absolute  paths  via  rclone  arguments.   Since  mounting
       requires  the  fusermount  program,  rclone will use the fallback PATH of /bin:/usr/bin in
       this scenario.  Please ensure that fusermount is present on this PATH.

   Rclone as Unix mount helper
       The core Unix program /bin/mount normally takes the  -t  FSTYPE  argument  then  runs  the
       /sbin/mount.FSTYPE helper program passing it mount options as -o key=val,... or --opt=....
       Automount (classic or systemd) behaves in a similar way.

       rclone by default expects GNU-style flags --key val.  To run it  as  a  mount  helper  you
       should  symlink  rclone  binary  to  /sbin/mount.rclone  and optionally /usr/bin/rclonefs,
       e.g. ln -s /usr/bin/rclone  /sbin/mount.rclone.   rclone  will  detect  it  and  translate
       command-line arguments appropriately.

       Now you can run classic mounts like this:

              mount sftp1:subdir /mnt/data -t rclone -o vfs_cache_mode=writes,sftp_key_file=/path/to/pem

       or create systemd mount units:

              # /etc/systemd/system/mnt-data.mount
              [Unit]
              After=network-online.target
              [Mount]
              Type=rclone
              What=sftp1:subdir
              Where=/mnt/data
              Options=rw,allow_other,args2env,vfs-cache-mode=writes,config=/etc/rclone.conf,cache-dir=/var/rclone

       optionally accompanied by systemd automount unit

              # /etc/systemd/system/mnt-data.automount
              [Unit]
              After=network-online.target
              Before=remote-fs.target
              [Automount]
              Where=/mnt/data
              TimeoutIdleSec=600
              [Install]
              WantedBy=multi-user.target

       or add in /etc/fstab a line like

              sftp1:subdir /mnt/data rclone rw,noauto,nofail,_netdev,x-systemd.automount,args2env,vfs_cache_mode=writes,config=/etc/rclone.conf,cache_dir=/var/cache/rclone 0 0

       or  use  classic  Automountd.   Remember to provide explicit config=...,cache-dir=... as a
       workaround for mount units being run without HOME.

       Rclone in the mount helper mode will split -o argument(s) by comma, replace  _  by  -  and
       prepend  --  to  get  the  command-line flags.  Options containing commas or spaces can be
       wrapped in single or double quotes.  Any inner quotes inside outer quotes of the same type
       should be doubled.

       Mount option syntax includes a few extra options treated specially:

       • env.NAME=VALUE  will set an environment variable for the mount process.  This helps with
         Automountd and Systemd.mount which don’t allow  setting  custom  environment  for  mount
         helpers.  Typically you will use env.HTTPS_PROXY=proxy.host:3128 or env.HOME=/rootcommand=cmount  can  be  used  to run cmount or any other rclone command rather than the
         default mount.

       • args2env will pass  mount  options  to  the  mount  helper  running  in  background  via
         environment  variables  instead  of command line arguments.  This allows to hide secrets
         from such commands as ps or pgrep.

       • vv... will be transformed into appropriate --verbose=N

       • standard mount options like x-systemd.automount, _netdev, nosuid and alike are  intended
         only for Automountd and ignored by rclone.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This  command  uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren’t like disk  files  -  you  can’t
       extend  them  or  write  to  the  middle  of them, so the VFS layer has to deal with that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The VFS layer also implements a directory  cache  -  this  caches  info  about  files  and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS  will  appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different
       copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory  cache  expires  if  the  backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how  old  they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use  rclone  rc  to  flush  the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The  --buffer-size  flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data
       in advance.

       Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.   The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This  flag  is  a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use
       memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty,  only  a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These  flags  control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the
       VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost  of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you  need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with  --cache-dir  or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The  cache  has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note that files are written back to the remote only when  they  are  closed  and  if  they
       haven’t  been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with files
       that haven’t been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with  the  same
       flags.

       If  using  --vfs-cache-max-size  note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You  should  not  run  two  copies  of  rclone  using  the same VFS cache with the same or
       overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.   This  can  potentially  cause  data
       corruption  if  you  do.   You  can  work  around this by giving each rclone its own cache
       hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don’t need to worry about this  if  the  remotes  in  use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to  disk.   This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible, but uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly  from  the  remote,  write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If  an  upload  fails  it  will  be  retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is  read  from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In  this  mode  the  files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer  the
       start  of  the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache, but they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise  identical  to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and  --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT  not  all  file  systems  support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.
       Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on  a  filesystem  which  doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various  parts  of  the  VFS  use  fingerprinting  to see if a local file copy has changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an  extra  API  call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For  example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire
       file and hash it, and modtime is slow with  the  s3,  swift,  ftp  and  qinqstor  backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If  you  use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include the slow
       operations in the fingerprint.  This makes  the  fingerprinting  less  accurate  but  much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If  you  are  running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When  rclone  reads  files  from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download  quota  for  some  remotes  by  requesting  only  chunks from the remote that are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the  size
       for  each  read.   When  --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and greater than --vfs-
       read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each  open  file  will  get  doubled  only  until  the
       specified  value  is  reached.   If the value is “off”, which is the default, the limit is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be  downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit  500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,   300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These  flags  may  be  used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime  for  a  slightly  different effect) as each read of the modification time takes a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather  than  seeking  rclone
       will  wait  a  short  time for the in sequence read or write to come in.  These flags only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case,  and  the  exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create the  file  is  preserved
       and  available  for  programs  to  query.   It  is  not  allowed for two files in the same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible  to  make  macOS  file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The  --vfs-case-insensitive  VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears  without  a  value on the command line), rclone may perform a “fixup” as explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is  stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the same
       name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.   However,  if  a  file
       name  with  exactly  the  same name is not found but a name differing only by case exists,
       rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an  existing  file
       is  requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the
       underlying remote.

       Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may  differ
       from  case  sensitivity  of  a  file  system  presented  by rclone (the source).  The flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default  value  depends  on  the
       operating  system  where  rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS, “false” otherwise.  If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.   It  can  be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some  backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this
       information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the  flag  --vfs-
       used-is-size  to  rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING.  Contrary  to  rclone  size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so that the result is
       accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls  resulting  in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

              rclone mount remote:path /path/to/mountpoint [flags]

   Options
                    --allow-non-empty                        Allow mounting over a non-empty directory (not supported on Windows)
                    --allow-other                            Allow access to other users (not supported on Windows)
                    --allow-root                             Allow access to root user (not supported on Windows)
                    --async-read                             Use asynchronous reads (not supported on Windows) (default true)
                    --attr-timeout duration                  Time for which file/directory attributes are cached (default 1s)
                    --daemon                                 Run mount in background and exit parent process (as background output is suppressed, use --log-file with --log-format=pid,... to monitor) (not supported on Windows)
                    --daemon-timeout duration                Time limit for rclone to respond to kernel (not supported on Windows)
                    --daemon-wait duration                   Time to wait for ready mount from daemon (maximum time on Linux, constant sleep time on OSX/BSD) (not supported on Windows) (default 1m0s)
                    --debug-fuse                             Debug the FUSE internals - needs -v
                    --default-permissions                    Makes kernel enforce access control based on the file mode (not supported on Windows)
                    --devname string                         Set the device name - default is remote:path
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --fuse-flag stringArray                  Flags or arguments to be passed direct to libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for mount
                    --max-read-ahead SizeSuffix              The number of bytes that can be prefetched for sequential reads (not supported on Windows) (default 128Ki)
                    --network-mode                           Mount as remote network drive, instead of fixed disk drive (supported on Windows only)
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --noappledouble                          Ignore Apple Double (._) and .DS_Store files (supported on OSX only) (default true)
                    --noapplexattr                           Ignore all "com.apple.*" extended attributes (supported on OSX only)
                -o, --option stringArray                     Option for libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)
                    --volname string                         Set the volume name (supported on Windows and OSX only)
                    --write-back-cache                       Makes kernel buffer writes before sending them to rclone (without this, writethrough caching is used) (not supported on Windows)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone moveto

       Move file or directory from source to dest.

   Synopsis
       If source:path is a file or directory then it moves  it  to  a  file  or  directory  named
       dest:path.

       This can be used to rename files or upload single files to other than their existing name.
       If   the   source   is   a   directory   then   it   acts   exactly    like    the    move
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) command.

       So

              rclone moveto src dst

       where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or /path/to/local or C:.

       This will:

              if src is file
                  move it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
              if src is directory
                  move it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
                  see move command for full details

       This  doesn’t  transfer  files  that  are  identical  on  src and dst, testing by size and
       modification time or MD5SUM.  src will be deleted on successful transfer.

       Important: Since this  can  cause  data  loss,  test  first  with  the  --dry-run  or  the
       --interactive/-i flag.

       Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

              rclone moveto source:path dest:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for moveto

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone ncdu

       Explore a remote with a text based user interface.

   Synopsis
       This displays a text based user interface allowing the navigation of a remote.  It is most
       useful for answering the question - “What is using all my disk space?”.

       To  make the user interface it first scans the entire remote given and builds an in memory
       representation.  rclone ncdu can be used during this scanning phase and you  will  see  it
       building up the directory structure as it goes along.

       You  can  interact with the user interface using key presses, press `?' to toggle the help
       on and off.  The supported keys are:

               ↑,↓ or k,j to Move
               →,l to enter
               ←,h to return
               c toggle counts
               g toggle graph
               a toggle average size in directory
               u toggle human-readable format
               n,s,C,A sort by name,size,count,average size
               d delete file/directory
               v select file/directory
               V enter visual select mode
               D delete selected files/directories
               y copy current path to clipboard
               Y display current path
               ^L refresh screen (fix screen corruption)
               ? to toggle help on and off
               q/ESC/^c to quit

       Listed files/directories may be prefixed by a one-character flag, some  of  them  combined
       with a description in brackets at end of line.  These flags have the following meaning:

              e means this is an empty directory, i.e. contains no files (but
                may contain empty subdirectories)
              ~ means this is a directory where some of the files (possibly in
                subdirectories) have unknown size, and therefore the directory
                size may be underestimated (and average size inaccurate, as it
                is average of the files with known sizes).
              . means an error occurred while reading a subdirectory, and
                therefore the directory size may be underestimated (and average
                size inaccurate)
              ! means an error occurred while reading this directory

       This  an  homage to the ncdu tool (https://dev.yorhel.nl/ncdu) but for rclone remotes.  It
       is missing lots of features at the moment but is useful as it stands.

       Note that it might take some time to delete big files/directories.  The UI  won’t  respond
       in the meantime since the deletion is done synchronously.

       For     a     non-interactive     listing     of     the     remote,    see    the    tree
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_tree/) command.  To just get the  total  size  of  the
       remote you can also use the size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) command.

              rclone ncdu remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for ncdu

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone obscure

       Obscure password for use in the rclone config file.

   Synopsis
       In the rclone config file, human-readable passwords are obscured.  Obscuring them is  done
       by encrypting them and writing them out in base64.  This is not a secure way of encrypting
       these passwords as rclone can decrypt them - it  is  to  prevent  “eyedropping”  -  namely
       someone seeing a password in the rclone config file by accident.

       Many  equally  important  things (like access tokens) are not obscured in the config file.
       However it is very hard to shoulder surf a 64 character hex token.

       This command can also accept a password through STDIN instead of an argument by passing  a
       hyphen  as  an  argument.   This  will  use  the  first  line of STDIN as the password not
       including the trailing newline.

              echo "secretpassword" | rclone obscure -

       If there is no data on STDIN to read, rclone  obscure  will  default  to  obfuscating  the
       hyphen itself.

       If you want to encrypt the config file then please use config file encryption - see rclone
       config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config/) for more info.

              rclone obscure password [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for obscure

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone rc

       Run a command against a running rclone.

   Synopsis
       This  runs  a  command  against  a  running  rclone.  Use the --url flag to specify an non
       default URL to connect on.   This  can  be  either  a  “:port”  which  is  taken  to  mean
       “http://localhost:port” or a “host:port” which is taken to mean “http://host:port”

       A username and password can be passed in with --user and --pass.

       Note that --rc-addr, --rc-user, --rc-pass will be read also for --url, --user, --pass.

       Arguments should be passed in as parameter=value.

       The result will be returned as a JSON object by default.

       The  --json  parameter can be used to pass in a JSON blob as an input instead of key=value
       arguments.  This is the only way of passing in more complicated values.

       The -o/--opt option can be used to set a key “opt” with key, value options in the form  -o
       key=value or -o key.  It can be repeated as many times as required.  This is useful for rc
       commands which take the “opt” parameter which by convention is a dictionary of strings.

              -o key=value -o key2

       Will place this in the “opt” value

              {"key":"value", "key2","")

       The -a/--arg option can be used to set strings in the “arg” value.  It can be repeated  as
       many  times  as  required.   This is useful for rc commands which take the “arg” parameter
       which by convention is a list of strings.

              -a value -a value2

       Will place this in the “arg” value

              ["value", "value2"]

       Use --loopback to connect to the rclone instance running rclone rc.  This is  very  useful
       for testing commands without having to run an rclone rc server, e.g.:

              rclone rc --loopback operations/about fs=/

       Use rclone rc to see a list of all possible commands.

              rclone rc commands parameter [flags]

   Options
                -a, --arg stringArray   Argument placed in the "arg" array
                -h, --help              help for rc
                    --json string       Input JSON - use instead of key=value args
                    --loopback          If set connect to this rclone instance not via HTTP
                    --no-output         If set, don't output the JSON result
                -o, --opt stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name placed in the "opt" array
                    --pass string       Password to use to connect to rclone remote control
                    --url string        URL to connect to rclone remote control (default "http://localhost:5572/")
                    --user string       Username to use to rclone remote control

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone rcat

       Copies standard input to file on remote.

   Synopsis
       rclone rcat reads from standard input (stdin) and copies it to a single remote file.

              echo "hello world" | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file
              ffmpeg - | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file

       If the remote file already exists, it will be overwritten.

       rcat will try to upload small files in a single request, which is usually  more  efficient
       than the streaming/chunked upload endpoints, which use multiple requests.  Exact behaviour
       depends on the remote.  What is considered a small file may be  set  through  --streaming-
       upload-cutoff.   Uploading  only  starts  after  the cutoff is reached or if the file ends
       before that.  The data must fit into RAM.  The cutoff needs to be small enough  to  adhere
       the  limits of your remote, please see there.  Generally speaking, setting this cutoff too
       high will decrease your performance.

       Use the --size flag to preallocate the file in advance at  the  remote  end  and  actually
       stream it, even if remote backend doesn’t support streaming.

       --size  should  be the exact size of the input stream in bytes.  If the size of the stream
       is different in length to the --size passed in then the transfer will likely fail.

       Note that the upload can also not be retried because the data is not kept around until the
       upload succeeds.  If you need to transfer a lot of data, you’re better off caching locally
       and then rclone move it to the destination.

              rclone rcat remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help       help for rcat
                    --size int   File size hint to preallocate (default -1)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone rcd

       Run rclone listening to remote control commands only.

   Synopsis
       This runs rclone so that it only listens to remote control commands.

       This is useful if you are controlling rclone via the rc API.

       If you pass in a path to a directory, rclone will serve that directory for GET requests on
       the URL passed in.  It will also open the URL in the browser when rclone is run.

       See the rc documentation (https://rclone.org/rc/) for more info on the rc flags.

              rclone rcd <path to files to serve>* [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for rcd

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone rmdirs

       Remove empty directories under the path.

   Synopsis
       This  recursively  removes  any empty directories (including directories that only contain
       empty directories), that it finds under the path.  The  root  path  itself  will  also  be
       removed if it is empty, unless you supply the --leave-root flag.

       Use  command  rmdir  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/)  to delete just the empty
       directory given by path, not recurse.

       This is useful for tidying up remotes that rclone has left a lot of empty directories  in.
       For  example  the  delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) command will delete
       files but leave the directory structure (unless used with option --rmdirs).

       To     delete     a     path     and     any     objects     in     it,     use      purge
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command.

              rclone rmdirs remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help         help for rmdirs
                    --leave-root   Do not remove root directory if empty

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone selfupdate

       Update the rclone binary.

   Synopsis
       This command downloads the latest release of rclone and  replaces  the  currently  running
       binary.  The download is verified with a hashsum and cryptographically signed signature.

       If  used  without  flags  (or  with  implied --stable flag), this command will install the
       latest stable release.  However, some issues may be fixed (or features added) only in  the
       latest  beta  release.   In  such  cases  you should run the command with the --beta flag,
       i.e. rclone selfupdate --beta.  You can check in advance what version would  be  installed
       by adding the --check flag, then repeat the command without it when you are satisfied.

       Sometimes  the  rclone  team may recommend you a concrete beta or stable rclone release to
       troubleshoot your issue or add a bleeding edge feature.  The --version VER flag, if given,
       will  update to the concrete version instead of the latest one.  If you omit micro version
       from VER (for example 1.53), the latest matching micro version will be used.

       Upon successful update rclone will print  a  message  that  contains  a  previous  version
       number.  You will need it if you later decide to revert your update for some reason.  Then
       you’ll have to note the previous version and run the following command: rclone  selfupdate
       [--beta]  OLDVER.   If the old version contains only dots and digits (for example v1.54.0)
       then it’s a stable release so you won’t need the  --beta  flag.   Beta  releases  have  an
       additional  information  similar  to v1.54.0-beta.5111.06f1c0c61.  (if you are a developer
       and use a locally built rclone, the version number will end with -DEV, you  will  have  to
       rebuild it as it obviously can’t be distributed).

       If  you  previously  installed rclone via a package manager, the package may include local
       documentation or configure services.  You may wish to update with the flag  --package  deb
       or  --package  rpm  (whichever  is correct for your OS) to update these too.  This command
       with the default --package zip will update only the rclone executable so the local  manual
       may become inaccurate after it.

       The  rclone  mount  command  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/)  may  or  may not
       support extended FUSE options depending on the build and OS.  selfupdate  will  refuse  to
       update if the capability would be discarded.

       Note:  Windows  forbids  deletion  of  a currently running executable so this command will
       rename the old executable to `rclone.old.exe' upon success.

       Please note that this command was not available before rclone version 1.55.  If  it  fails
       for  you  with  the  message  unknown  command  "selfupdate"  then you will need to update
       manually following the install instructions located at https://rclone.org/install/

              rclone selfupdate [flags]

   Options
                    --beta             Install beta release
                    --check            Check for latest release, do not download
                -h, --help             help for selfupdate
                    --output string    Save the downloaded binary at a given path (default: replace running binary)
                    --package string   Package format: zip|deb|rpm (default: zip)
                    --stable           Install stable release (this is the default)
                    --version string   Install the given rclone version (default: latest)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

rclone serve

       Serve a remote over a protocol.

   Synopsis
       Serve  a  remote  over  a given protocol.  Requires the use of a subcommand to specify the
       protocol, e.g.

              rclone serve http remote:

       Each subcommand has its own options which you can see in their help.

              rclone serve <protocol> [opts] <remote> [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for serve

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

       • rclone  serve  dlna (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_dlna/) - Serve remote:path
         over DLNA

       • rclone  serve  docker  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/)  -  Serve  any
         remote on docker’s volume plugin API.

       • rclone  serve  ftp  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_ftp/)  - Serve remote:path
         over FTP.

       • rclone serve http (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_http/) -  Serve  the  remote
         over HTTP.

       • rclone  serve  restic  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_restic/)  -  Serve  the
         remote for restic’s REST API.

       • rclone serve sftp (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/) -  Serve  the  remote
         over SFTP.

       • rclone   serve   webdav   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_webdav/)   -   Serve
         remote:path over WebDAV.

rclone serve dlna

       Serve remote:path over DLNA

   Synopsis
       Run a DLNA media server for media stored in an rclone remote.  Many devices, such  as  the
       Xbox  and  PlayStation,  can  automatically  discover  this  server  in  the  LAN and play
       audio/video from it.  VLC is also supported.  Service discovery uses UDP multicast packets
       (SSDP) and will thus only work on LANs.

       Rclone will list all files present in the remote, without filtering based on media formats
       or file extensions.  Additionally, there is no media transcoding support.  This means that
       some players might show files that they are not able to play back correctly.

   Server options
       Use  --addr  to specify which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g. --addr
       1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all IPs.

       Use --name to choose the friendly server name, which is by default “rclone (hostname)”.

       Use --log-trace in conjunction with -vv to enable additional debug  logging  of  all  UPNP
       traffic.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This  command  uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren’t like disk  files  -  you  can’t
       extend  them  or  write  to  the  middle  of them, so the VFS layer has to deal with that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The VFS layer also implements a directory  cache  -  this  caches  info  about  files  and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS  will  appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different
       copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory  cache  expires  if  the  backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how  old  they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use  rclone  rc  to  flush  the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The  --buffer-size  flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data
       in advance.

       Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.   The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This  flag  is  a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use
       memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty,  only  a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These  flags  control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the
       VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost  of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you  need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with  --cache-dir  or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The  cache  has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note that files are written back to the remote only when  they  are  closed  and  if  they
       haven’t  been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with files
       that haven’t been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with  the  same
       flags.

       If  using  --vfs-cache-max-size  note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You  should  not  run  two  copies  of  rclone  using  the same VFS cache with the same or
       overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.   This  can  potentially  cause  data
       corruption  if  you  do.   You  can  work  around this by giving each rclone its own cache
       hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don’t need to worry about this  if  the  remotes  in  use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to  disk.   This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible, but uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly  from  the  remote,  write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If  an  upload  fails  it  will  be  retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is  read  from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In  this  mode  the  files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer  the
       start  of  the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache, but they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise  identical  to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and  --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT  not  all  file  systems  support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.
       Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on  a  filesystem  which  doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various  parts  of  the  VFS  use  fingerprinting  to see if a local file copy has changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an  extra  API  call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For  example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire
       file and hash it, and modtime is slow with  the  s3,  swift,  ftp  and  qinqstor  backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If  you  use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include the slow
       operations in the fingerprint.  This makes  the  fingerprinting  less  accurate  but  much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If  you  are  running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When  rclone  reads  files  from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download  quota  for  some  remotes  by  requesting  only  chunks from the remote that are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the  size
       for  each  read.   When  --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and greater than --vfs-
       read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each  open  file  will  get  doubled  only  until  the
       specified  value  is  reached.   If the value is “off”, which is the default, the limit is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be  downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit  500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,   300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These  flags  may  be  used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime  for  a  slightly  different effect) as each read of the modification time takes a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather  than  seeking  rclone
       will  wait  a  short  time for the in sequence read or write to come in.  These flags only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case,  and  the  exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create the  file  is  preserved
       and  available  for  programs  to  query.   It  is  not  allowed for two files in the same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible  to  make  macOS  file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The  --vfs-case-insensitive  VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears  without  a  value on the command line), rclone may perform a “fixup” as explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is  stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the same
       name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.   However,  if  a  file
       name  with  exactly  the  same name is not found but a name differing only by case exists,
       rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an  existing  file
       is  requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the
       underlying remote.

       Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may  differ
       from  case  sensitivity  of  a  file  system  presented  by rclone (the source).  The flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default  value  depends  on  the
       operating  system  where  rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS, “false” otherwise.  If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.   It  can  be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some  backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this
       information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the  flag  --vfs-
       used-is-size  to  rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING.  Contrary  to  rclone  size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so that the result is
       accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls  resulting  in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

              rclone serve dlna remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                            The ip:port or :port to bind the DLNA http server to (default ":7879")
                    --announce-interval duration             The interval between SSDP announcements (default 12m0s)
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for dlna
                    --interface stringArray                  The interface to use for SSDP (repeat as necessary)
                    --log-trace                              Enable trace logging of SOAP traffic
                    --name string                            Name of DLNA server
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve docker

       Serve any remote on docker’s volume plugin API.

   Synopsis
       This command implements the Docker volume plugin API allowing docker to use  rclone  as  a
       data  storage mechanism for various cloud providers.  rclone provides docker volume plugin
       based on it.

       To create a docker plugin, one must create a Unix or TCP socket that Docker will look  for
       when  you  use the plugin and then it listens for commands from docker daemon and runs the
       corresponding code when necessary.  Docker plugins can  run  as  a  managed  plugin  under
       control  of  the  docker daemon or as an independent native service.  For testing, you can
       just run it directly from the command line, for example:

              sudo rclone serve docker --base-dir /tmp/rclone-volumes --socket-addr localhost:8787 -vv

       Running rclone serve docker will create the  said  socket,  listening  for  commands  from
       Docker  to  create  the  necessary  Volumes.  Normally you need not give the --socket-addr
       flag.  The API will listen on the unix domain socket  at  /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock.
       In   the   example   above   rclone   will   create   a   TCP  socket  and  a  small  file
       /etc/docker/plugins/rclone.spec containing the socket address.  We use sudo  because  both
       paths are writeable only by the root user.

       If  you  later  decide  to change listening socket, the docker daemon must be restarted to
       reconnect to /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock or parse new /etc/docker/plugins/rclone.spec.
       Until  you  restart,  any volume related docker commands will timeout trying to access the
       old socket.  Running directly is supported on Linux only, not on Windows or  MacOS.   This
       is  not  a problem with managed plugin mode described in details in the full documentation
       (https://rclone.org/docker).

       The command will create volume mounts under the  path  given  by  --base-dir  (by  default
       /var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone  available  only  to  root) and maintain the JSON formatted
       file docker-plugin.state in the  rclone  cache  directory  with  book-keeping  records  of
       created and mounted volumes.

       All  mount  and  VFS  options are submitted by the docker daemon via API, but you can also
       provide defaults on the command line as well as set path to  the  config  file  and  cache
       directory or adjust logging verbosity.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This  command  uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren’t like disk  files  -  you  can’t
       extend  them  or  write  to  the  middle  of them, so the VFS layer has to deal with that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The VFS layer also implements a directory  cache  -  this  caches  info  about  files  and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS  will  appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different
       copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory  cache  expires  if  the  backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how  old  they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use  rclone  rc  to  flush  the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The  --buffer-size  flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data
       in advance.

       Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.   The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This  flag  is  a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use
       memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty,  only  a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These  flags  control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the
       VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost  of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you  need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with  --cache-dir  or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The  cache  has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note that files are written back to the remote only when  they  are  closed  and  if  they
       haven’t  been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with files
       that haven’t been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with  the  same
       flags.

       If  using  --vfs-cache-max-size  note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You  should  not  run  two  copies  of  rclone  using  the same VFS cache with the same or
       overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.   This  can  potentially  cause  data
       corruption  if  you  do.   You  can  work  around this by giving each rclone its own cache
       hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don’t need to worry about this  if  the  remotes  in  use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to  disk.   This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible, but uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly  from  the  remote,  write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If  an  upload  fails  it  will  be  retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is  read  from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In  this  mode  the  files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer  the
       start  of  the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache, but they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise  identical  to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and  --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT  not  all  file  systems  support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.
       Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on  a  filesystem  which  doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various  parts  of  the  VFS  use  fingerprinting  to see if a local file copy has changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an  extra  API  call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For  example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire
       file and hash it, and modtime is slow with  the  s3,  swift,  ftp  and  qinqstor  backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If  you  use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include the slow
       operations in the fingerprint.  This makes  the  fingerprinting  less  accurate  but  much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If  you  are  running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When  rclone  reads  files  from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download  quota  for  some  remotes  by  requesting  only  chunks from the remote that are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the  size
       for  each  read.   When  --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and greater than --vfs-
       read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each  open  file  will  get  doubled  only  until  the
       specified  value  is  reached.   If the value is “off”, which is the default, the limit is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be  downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit  500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,   300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These  flags  may  be  used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime  for  a  slightly  different effect) as each read of the modification time takes a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather  than  seeking  rclone
       will  wait  a  short  time for the in sequence read or write to come in.  These flags only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case,  and  the  exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create the  file  is  preserved
       and  available  for  programs  to  query.   It  is  not  allowed for two files in the same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible  to  make  macOS  file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The  --vfs-case-insensitive  VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears  without  a  value on the command line), rclone may perform a “fixup” as explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is  stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the same
       name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.   However,  if  a  file
       name  with  exactly  the  same name is not found but a name differing only by case exists,
       rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an  existing  file
       is  requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the
       underlying remote.

       Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may  differ
       from  case  sensitivity  of  a  file  system  presented  by rclone (the source).  The flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default  value  depends  on  the
       operating  system  where  rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS, “false” otherwise.  If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.   It  can  be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some  backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this
       information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the  flag  --vfs-
       used-is-size  to  rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING.  Contrary  to  rclone  size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so that the result is
       accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls  resulting  in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

              rclone serve docker [flags]

   Options
                    --allow-non-empty                        Allow mounting over a non-empty directory (not supported on Windows)
                    --allow-other                            Allow access to other users (not supported on Windows)
                    --allow-root                             Allow access to root user (not supported on Windows)
                    --async-read                             Use asynchronous reads (not supported on Windows) (default true)
                    --attr-timeout duration                  Time for which file/directory attributes are cached (default 1s)
                    --base-dir string                        Base directory for volumes (default "/var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone")
                    --daemon                                 Run mount in background and exit parent process (as background output is suppressed, use --log-file with --log-format=pid,... to monitor) (not supported on Windows)
                    --daemon-timeout duration                Time limit for rclone to respond to kernel (not supported on Windows)
                    --daemon-wait duration                   Time to wait for ready mount from daemon (maximum time on Linux, constant sleep time on OSX/BSD) (not supported on Windows) (default 1m0s)
                    --debug-fuse                             Debug the FUSE internals - needs -v
                    --default-permissions                    Makes kernel enforce access control based on the file mode (not supported on Windows)
                    --devname string                         Set the device name - default is remote:path
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --forget-state                           Skip restoring previous state
                    --fuse-flag stringArray                  Flags or arguments to be passed direct to libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for docker
                    --max-read-ahead SizeSuffix              The number of bytes that can be prefetched for sequential reads (not supported on Windows) (default 128Ki)
                    --network-mode                           Mount as remote network drive, instead of fixed disk drive (supported on Windows only)
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --no-spec                                Do not write spec file
                    --noappledouble                          Ignore Apple Double (._) and .DS_Store files (supported on OSX only) (default true)
                    --noapplexattr                           Ignore all "com.apple.*" extended attributes (supported on OSX only)
                -o, --option stringArray                     Option for libfuse/WinFsp (repeat if required)
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --socket-addr string                     Address <host:port> or absolute path (default: /run/docker/plugins/rclone.sock)
                    --socket-gid int                         GID for unix socket (default: current process GID) (default 1000)
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)
                    --volname string                         Set the volume name (supported on Windows and OSX only)
                    --write-back-cache                       Makes kernel buffer writes before sending them to rclone (without this, writethrough caching is used) (not supported on Windows)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve ftp

       Serve remote:path over FTP.

   Synopsis
       Run a basic FTP server to serve a remote over FTP protocol.  This can be viewed with a FTP
       client or you can make a remote of type FTP to read and write it.

   Server options
       Use  –addr  to  specify  which IP address and port the server should listen on, e.g. –addr
       1.2.3.4:8000 or –addr :8080 to  listen  to  all  IPs.   By  default  it  only  listens  on
       localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

       If  you  set  –addr  to  listen  on  a  public  or  LAN  accessible  IP address then using
       Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

   Authentication
       By default this will serve files without needing a login.

       You can set a single username and password with the –user and –pass flags.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that  rclone  uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud  storage  objects  have  lots of properties which aren’t like disk files - you can’t
       extend them or write to the middle of them, so the  VFS  layer  has  to  deal  with  that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The  VFS  layer  also  implements  a  directory  cache  - this caches info about files and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up  to  date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS will appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface  or  a  different
       copy  of  rclone  will  only  be picked up once the directory cache expires if the backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset  the  cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If  you  configure  rclone  with  a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to  buffer  data
       in advance.

       Each  open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer  will  only  use
       memory  for  data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty, only a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to  make  the
       VFS  layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note  that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the  user  cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with --cache-dir or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the  cache  mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note  that  files  are  written  back  to the remote only when they are closed and if they
       haven’t been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with  files
       that  haven’t  been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
       flags.

       If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size  for  two  reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You should not run two copies of rclone  using  the  same  VFS  cache  with  the  same  or
       overlapping  remotes  if  using  --vfs-cache-mode  > off.  This can potentially cause data
       corruption if you do.  You can work around this  by  giving  each  rclone  its  own  cache
       hierarchy  with  --cache-dir.   You  don’t  need to worry about this if the remotes in use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible,  but  uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In  this  mode  files  opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If an upload fails it will be retried  at  exponentially  increasing  intervals  up  to  1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In  this  mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone  will  keep  track  of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So  if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the
       start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache,  but  they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This  mode  should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When  using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.   In  particular  FAT/exFAT  do  not.
       Rclone  will  perform  very  badly if the cache directory is on a filesystem which doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see  if  a  local  file  copy  has  changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On  some  backends  some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the  entire
       file  and  hash  it,  and  modtime  is  slow with the s3, swift, ftp and qinqstor backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If you use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include  the  slow
       operations  in  the  fingerprint.   This  makes  the fingerprinting less accurate but much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using  this  flag  is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.   This  means  that  rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download quota for some remotes by  requesting  only  chunks  from  the  remote  that  are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size
       for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and  greater  than  --vfs-
       read-chunk-size,  the  chunk  size  for  each  open  file  will get doubled only until the
       specified value is reached.  If the value is “off”, which is the  default,  the  limit  is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When  --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit   500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,  300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS  for  performance  or  other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modification  time  takes  a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes  rclone  is  delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone
       will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.   These  flags  only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux  file  systems  are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files  can  be  opened using any case, the exact case used to create the file is preserved
       and available for programs to query.  It  is  not  allowed  for  two  files  in  the  same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually  file  systems  on  macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.   If  its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a  “fixup”  as  explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the  same
       name,  then  the  case  of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file
       name with exactly the same name is not found but a name differing  only  by  case  exists,
       rclone  will  transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file
       is requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by  the
       underlying remote.

       Note  that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ
       from case sensitivity of a file  system  presented  by  rclone  (the  source).   The  flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If  the  flag  is  not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the
       operating system where rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS,  “false”  otherwise.   If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This  flag  allows  you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need  this
       information  to  be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the flag --vfs-
       used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend  to  report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING. Contrary to rclone size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so  that  the  result  is
       accurate.   However,  this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls resulting in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

   Auth Proxy
       If you supply the parameter  --auth-proxy  /path/to/program  then  rclone  will  use  that
       program  to  generate  backends  on  the  fly which then are used to authenticate incoming
       requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol  with  input  on  STDIN  and  output  on
       STDOUT.

       PLEASE  NOTE:  --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy
       is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

       There          is          an          example          program          bin/test_proxy.py
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

       The  program’s  job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config
       for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will have any default parameters  for
       the  backend  added,  but it won’t use configuration from environment variables or command
       line options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete config.

       This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

       And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma  separated  strings  for  parameters  to
       obscure

       If  password  authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword"
              }

       If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
              }

       And as an example return this on STDOUT

              {
                  "type": "sftp",
                  "_root": "",
                  "_obscure": "pass",
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword",
                  "host": "sftp.example.com"
              }

       This  would  mean  that  an  SFTP  backend  would  be  created on the fly for the user and
       pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that since _obscure is set
       to  pass,  rclone  will  obscure  the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is
       required for sftp backends).

       The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many
       different sftp backends, you could make the user be user@example.com and then set the host
       to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you’d  probably  want  to
       restrict the host to a limited list.

       Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don’t use
       pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user’s password or  public-key  is  changed
       the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

       This  can  be  used  to  build  general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone
       supports.

              rclone serve ftp remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:2121")
                    --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                    --cert string                            TLS PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for ftp
                    --key string                             TLS PEM Private key
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --pass string                            Password for authentication (empty value allow every password)
                    --passive-port string                    Passive port range to use (default "30000-32000")
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --public-ip string                       Public IP address to advertise for passive connections
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --user string                            User name for authentication (default "anonymous")
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve http

       Serve the remote over HTTP.

   Synopsis
       Run  a  basic web server to serve a remote over HTTP.  This can be viewed in a web browser
       or you can make a remote of type http read from it.

       You can use the filter flags (e.g. --include, --exclude) to control what is served.

       The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

       --bwlimit will be respected  for  file  transfers.   Use  --stats  to  control  the  stats
       printing.

   Server options
       Use  --addr  to  specify  which IP address and port the server should listen on, eg --addr
       1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen  to  all  IPs.   By  default  it  only  listens  on
       localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

       If  you  set  --addr  to  listen  on  a  public  or  LAN  accessible IP address then using
       Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

       --server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to control  the  timeouts  on
       the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

       --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP
       header.

       --baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone  will  serve
       from  the  root.   If  you  used  --baseurl  "/rclone"  then rclone would serve from a URL
       starting with “/rclone/”.  This is useful if you  wish  to  proxy  rclone  serve.   Rclone
       automatically  inserts  leading  and  trailing  “/”  on  --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone",
       --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

   SSL/TLS
       By default this will serve over http.  If you want you can serve  over  https.   You  will
       need  to  supply  the  --cert  and --key flags.  If you wish to do client side certificate
       validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

       --cert should be a either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA
       certificate.   --key  should  be the PEM encoded private key and --client-ca should be the
       PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

       –min-tls-version is minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid  values  are  “tls1.0”,
       “tls1.1”, “tls1.2” and “tls1.3” (default “tls1.0”).

   Template
       --template  allows  a  user  to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve
       functions.  The server exports the following markup to be  used  within  the  template  to
       server pages:

       Parameter                             Description
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
       .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
       .Sort                                 The  current  sort  used.   This is
                                             changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                             Sort                       Options:
                                             namedirfirst,name,size,time
                                             (default namedirfirst)
       .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                             changeable via ?order= parameter
                                             Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                             asc)
       .Query                                Currently unused.
       .Breadcrumb                           Allows  for  creating  a   relative
                                             navigation
       – .Link                               The  relative  to  the root link of
                                             the Text.
       – .Text                               The Name of the directory.
       .Entries                              Information   about   a    specific
                                             file/directory.
       – .URL                                The `url' of an entry.
       – .Leaf                               Currently   same   as   `URL'   but
                                             intended to be `just' the name.
       – .IsDir                              Boolean  for  if  an  entry  is   a
                                             directory or not.
       – .Size                               Size in Bytes of the entry.
       – .ModTime                            The UTC timestamp of an entry.

   Authentication
       By default this will serve files without needing a login.

       You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username
       and password with the --user and --pass flags.

       Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard  apache
       format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic authentication.  Bcrypt is recommended.

       To create an htpasswd file:

              touch htpasswd
              htpasswd -B htpasswd user
              htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

       The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

       Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

       Use --salt to change the password hashing salt from the default.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This  command  uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that rclone uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren’t like disk  files  -  you  can’t
       extend  them  or  write  to  the  middle  of them, so the VFS layer has to deal with that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The VFS layer also implements a directory  cache  -  this  caches  info  about  files  and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up to date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS  will  appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However,  changes  made  directly on the cloud storage by the web interface or a different
       copy of rclone will only be picked up once the directory  cache  expires  if  the  backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how  old  they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use  rclone  rc  to  flush  the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The  --buffer-size  flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to buffer data
       in advance.

       Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.   The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This  flag  is  a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer will only use
       memory for data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty,  only  a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These  flags  control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to make the
       VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost  of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you  need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the user cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with  --cache-dir  or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The  cache  has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the cache mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note that files are written back to the remote only when  they  are  closed  and  if  they
       haven’t  been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with files
       that haven’t been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with  the  same
       flags.

       If  using  --vfs-cache-max-size  note that the cache may exceed this size for two reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You  should  not  run  two  copies  of  rclone  using  the same VFS cache with the same or
       overlapping remotes if using --vfs-cache-mode > off.   This  can  potentially  cause  data
       corruption  if  you  do.   You  can  work  around this by giving each rclone its own cache
       hierarchy with --cache-dir.  You don’t need to worry about this  if  the  remotes  in  use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to  disk.   This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible, but uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly  from  the  remote,  write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If  an  upload  fails  it  will  be  retried at exponentially increasing intervals up to 1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is  read  from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In  this  mode  the  files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone will keep track of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer  the
       start  of  the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache, but they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise  identical  to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and  --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT  not  all  file  systems  support sparse files.  In particular FAT/exFAT do not.
       Rclone will perform very badly if the cache directory is on  a  filesystem  which  doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various  parts  of  the  VFS  use  fingerprinting  to see if a local file copy has changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On some backends some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an  extra  API  call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For  example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the entire
       file and hash it, and modtime is slow with  the  s3,  swift,  ftp  and  qinqstor  backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If  you  use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include the slow
       operations in the fingerprint.  This makes  the  fingerprinting  less  accurate  but  much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If  you  are  running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using this flag is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When  rclone  reads  files  from a remote it reads them in chunks.  This means that rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download  quota  for  some  remotes  by  requesting  only  chunks from the remote that are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the  size
       for  each  read.   When  --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified, and greater than --vfs-
       read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each  open  file  will  get  doubled  only  until  the
       specified  value  is  reached.   If the value is “off”, which is the default, the limit is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be  downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit  500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,   300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These  flags  may  be  used to enable/disable features of the VFS for performance or other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime  for  a  slightly  different effect) as each read of the modification time takes a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather  than  seeking  rclone
       will  wait  a  short  time for the in sequence read or write to come in.  These flags only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case,  and  the  exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files can be opened using any case, the exact case used to create the  file  is  preserved
       and  available  for  programs  to  query.   It  is  not  allowed for two files in the same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible  to  make  macOS  file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The  --vfs-case-insensitive  VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.  If its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears  without  a  value on the command line), rclone may perform a “fixup” as explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is  stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the same
       name, then the case of the existing file on the disk will be used.   However,  if  a  file
       name  with  exactly  the  same name is not found but a name differing only by case exists,
       rclone will transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an  existing  file
       is  requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by the
       underlying remote.

       Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may  differ
       from  case  sensitivity  of  a  file  system  presented  by rclone (the source).  The flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default  value  depends  on  the
       operating  system  where  rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS, “false” otherwise.  If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This flag allows you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.   It  can  be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some  backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need this
       information to be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the  flag  --vfs-
       used-is-size  to  rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend to report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING.  Contrary  to  rclone  size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so that the result is
       accurate.  However, this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls  resulting  in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

              rclone serve http remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "127.0.0.1:8080")
                    --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                    --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                    --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for http
                    --htpasswd string                        A htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                    --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
                    --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                    --min-tls-version string                 Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --pass string                            Password for authentication
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --realm string                           Realm for authentication
                    --salt string                            Password hashing salt (default "dlPL2MqE")
                    --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --template string                        User-specified template
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --user string                            User name for authentication
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve restic

       Serve the remote for restic’s REST API.

   Synopsis
       Run a basic web server to serve a remove over restic’s REST backend API over  HTTP.   This
       allows  restic  to  use rclone as a data storage mechanism for cloud providers that restic
       does not support directly.

       Restic (https://restic.net/) is a command-line program for doing backups.

       The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

       --bwlimit will be respected  for  file  transfers.   Use  --stats  to  control  the  stats
       printing.

   Setting up rclone for use by restic
       First set up a remote for your chosen cloud provider (https://rclone.org/docs/#configure).

       Once  you  have  set  up  the  remote,  check  it is working with, for example “rclone lsd
       remote:”.  You may have called the remote something other than “remote:” - just substitute
       whatever you called it in the following instructions.

       Now start the rclone restic server

              rclone serve restic -v remote:backup

       Where  you  can  replace  “backup” in the above by whatever path in the remote you wish to
       use.

       By default this will serve on “localhost:8080” you can change this with use of the  --addr
       flag.

       You might wish to start this server on boot.

       Adding  --cache-objects=false  will cause rclone to stop caching objects returned from the
       List call.  Caching is normally desirable as  it  speeds  up  downloading  objects,  saves
       transactions and uses very little memory.

   Setting up restic to use rclone
       Now         you         can         follow         the         restic         instructions
       (http://restic.readthedocs.io/en/latest/030_preparing_a_new_repo.html#rest-server)      on
       setting up restic.

       Note that you will need restic 0.8.2 or later to interoperate with rclone.

       For  the  example  above  you will want to use “http://localhost:8080/” as the URL for the
       REST server.

       For example:

              $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/
              $ export RESTIC_PASSWORD=yourpassword
              $ restic init
              created restic backend 8b1a4b56ae at rest:http://localhost:8080/

              Please note that knowledge of your password is required to access
              the repository. Losing your password means that your data is
              irrecoverably lost.
              $ restic backup /path/to/files/to/backup
              scan [/path/to/files/to/backup]
              scanned 189 directories, 312 files in 0:00
              [0:00] 100.00%  38.128 MiB / 38.128 MiB  501 / 501 items  0 errors  ETA 0:00
              duration: 0:00
              snapshot 45c8fdd8 saved

   Multiple repositories
       Note that you can use the endpoint to host multiple repositories.  Do  this  by  adding  a
       directory name or path after the URL.  Note that these must end with /.  Eg

              $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user1repo/
              # backup user1 stuff
              $ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user2repo/
              # backup user2 stuff

   Private repositories
       The--private-repos flag can be used to limit users to repositories starting with a path of
       /<username>/.

   Server options
       Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should listen  on,  e.g. --addr
       1.2.3.4:8000  or  --addr  :8080  to  listen  to  all  IPs.   By default it only listens on
       localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

       If you set --addr to  listen  on  a  public  or  LAN  accessible  IP  address  then  using
       Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

       --server-read-timeout  and  --server-write-timeout  can be used to control the timeouts on
       the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

       --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP
       header.

       --baseurl  controls  the URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone will serve
       from the root.  If you used --baseurl  "/rclone"  then  rclone  would  serve  from  a  URL
       starting  with  “/rclone/”.   This  is  useful  if you wish to proxy rclone serve.  Rclone
       automatically inserts leading and  trailing  “/”  on  --baseurl,  so  --baseurl  "rclone",
       --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

       --template  allows  a  user  to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve
       functions.  The server exports the following markup to be  used  within  the  template  to
       server pages:

       Parameter                             Description
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
       .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
       .Sort                                 The  current  sort  used.   This is
                                             changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                             Sort                       Options:
                                             namedirfirst,name,size,time
                                             (default namedirfirst)
       .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                             changeable via ?order= parameter

                                             Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                             asc)
       .Query                                Currently unused.
       .Breadcrumb                           Allows  for  creating  a   relative
                                             navigation
       – .Link                               The  relative  to  the root link of
                                             the Text.
       – .Text                               The Name of the directory.
       .Entries                              Information   about   a    specific
                                             file/directory.
       – .URL                                The `url' of an entry.
       – .Leaf                               Currently   same   as   `URL'   but
                                             intended to be `just' the name.
       – .IsDir                              Boolean  for  if  an  entry  is   a
                                             directory or not.
       – .Size                               Size in Bytes of the entry.
       – .ModTime                            The UTC timestamp of an entry.

   Authentication
       By default this will serve files without needing a login.

       You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username
       and password with the --user and --pass flags.

       Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard  apache
       format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic authentication.  Bcrypt is recommended.

       To create an htpasswd file:

              touch htpasswd
              htpasswd -B htpasswd user
              htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

       The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

       Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

   SSL/TLS
       By  default  this  will  serve over HTTP.  If you want you can serve over HTTPS.  You will
       need to supply the --cert and --key flags.  If you wish  to  do  client  side  certificate
       validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

       --cert  should  be either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA
       certificate.  --key should be the PEM encoded private key and --client-ca  should  be  the
       PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

       –min-tls-version  is  minimum  TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are “tls1.0”,
       “tls1.1”, “tls1.2” and “tls1.3” (default “tls1.0”).

              rclone serve restic remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                     IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:8080")
                    --append-only                     Disallow deletion of repository data
                    --baseurl string                  Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                    --cache-objects                   Cache listed objects (default true)
                    --cert string                     SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                    --client-ca string                Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                -h, --help                            help for restic
                    --htpasswd string                 htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                    --key string                      SSL PEM Private key
                    --max-header-bytes int            Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                    --min-tls-version string          Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                    --pass string                     Password for authentication
                    --private-repos                   Users can only access their private repo
                    --realm string                    Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                    --server-read-timeout duration    Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --server-write-timeout duration   Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --stdio                           Run an HTTP2 server on stdin/stdout
                    --template string                 User-specified template
                    --user string                     User name for authentication

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve sftp

       Serve the remote over SFTP.

   Synopsis
       Run  an  SFTP server to serve a remote over SFTP.  This can be used with an SFTP client or
       you can make a remote of type sftp to use with it.

       You can use the filter flags (e.g. --include, --exclude) to control what is served.

       The server will respond to a small number of shell commands, mainly  md5sum,  sha1sum  and
       df,  which  enable it to provide support for checksums and the about feature when accessed
       from an sftp remote.

       Note that this server uses standard 32 KiB packet payload size, which means you  must  not
       configure   the   client   to   expect   anything   else,   e.g.    with   the  chunk_size
       (https://rclone.org/sftp/#sftp-chunk-size) option on an sftp remote.

       The server will log errors.  Use -v to see access logs.

       --bwlimit will be respected  for  file  transfers.   Use  --stats  to  control  the  stats
       printing.

       You  must  provide  some means of authentication, either with --user/--pass, an authorized
       keys file (specify location with --authorized-keys - the default is the same as  ssh),  an
       --auth-proxy, or set the --no-auth flag for no authentication when logging in.

       If  you  don’t  supply  a  host  --key  then  rclone  will generate rsa, ecdsa and ed25519
       variants, and cache them for later use in rclone’s cache directory (see rclone help  flags
       cache-dir) in the “serve-sftp” directory.

       By  default the server binds to localhost:2022 - if you want it to be reachable externally
       then supply --addr :2022 for example.

       Note that the default of --vfs-cache-mode off is fine for the rclone sftp backend, but  it
       may not be with other SFTP clients.

       If  --stdio  is  specified, rclone will serve SFTP over stdio, which can be used with sshd
       via ~/.ssh/authorized_keys, for example:

              restrict,command="rclone serve sftp --stdio ./photos" ssh-rsa ...

       On the client you need to set  --transfers  1  when  using  --stdio.   Otherwise  multiple
       instances  of  the  rclone  server  are started by OpenSSH which can lead to “corrupted on
       transfer” errors.  This is the case because  the  client  chooses  indiscriminately  which
       server  to send commands to while the servers all have different views of the state of the
       filing system.

       The “restrict”  in  authorized_keys  prevents  SHA1SUMs  and  MD5SUMs  from  beeing  used.
       Omitting  “restrict” and using --sftp-path-override to enable checksumming is possible but
       less secure and you could use the SFTP server provided by OpenSSH in this case.

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that  rclone  uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud  storage  objects  have  lots of properties which aren’t like disk files - you can’t
       extend them or write to the middle of them, so the  VFS  layer  has  to  deal  with  that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The  VFS  layer  also  implements  a  directory  cache  - this caches info about files and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up  to  date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS will appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface  or  a  different
       copy  of  rclone  will  only  be picked up once the directory cache expires if the backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset  the  cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If  you  configure  rclone  with  a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to  buffer  data
       in advance.

       Each  open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer  will  only  use
       memory  for  data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty, only a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to  make  the
       VFS  layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note  that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the  user  cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with --cache-dir or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the  cache  mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note  that  files  are  written  back  to the remote only when they are closed and if they
       haven’t been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with  files
       that  haven’t  been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
       flags.

       If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size  for  two  reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You should not run two copies of rclone  using  the  same  VFS  cache  with  the  same  or
       overlapping  remotes  if  using  --vfs-cache-mode  > off.  This can potentially cause data
       corruption if you do.  You can work around this  by  giving  each  rclone  its  own  cache
       hierarchy  with  --cache-dir.   You  don’t  need to worry about this if the remotes in use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible,  but  uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In  this  mode  files  opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If an upload fails it will be retried  at  exponentially  increasing  intervals  up  to  1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In  this  mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone  will  keep  track  of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So  if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the
       start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache,  but  they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This  mode  should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When  using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.   In  particular  FAT/exFAT  do  not.
       Rclone  will  perform  very  badly if the cache directory is on a filesystem which doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see  if  a  local  file  copy  has  changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On  some  backends  some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the  entire
       file  and  hash  it,  and  modtime  is  slow with the s3, swift, ftp and qinqstor backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If you use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include  the  slow
       operations  in  the  fingerprint.   This  makes  the fingerprinting less accurate but much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using  this  flag  is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.   This  means  that  rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download quota for some remotes by  requesting  only  chunks  from  the  remote  that  are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size
       for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and  greater  than  --vfs-
       read-chunk-size,  the  chunk  size  for  each  open  file  will get doubled only until the
       specified value is reached.  If the value is “off”, which is the  default,  the  limit  is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When  --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit   500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,  300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS  for  performance  or  other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modification  time  takes  a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes  rclone  is  delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone
       will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.   These  flags  only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux  file  systems  are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files  can  be  opened using any case, the exact case used to create the file is preserved
       and available for programs to query.  It  is  not  allowed  for  two  files  in  the  same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually  file  systems  on  macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.   If  its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a  “fixup”  as  explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the  same
       name,  then  the  case  of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file
       name with exactly the same name is not found but a name differing  only  by  case  exists,
       rclone  will  transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file
       is requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by  the
       underlying remote.

       Note  that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ
       from case sensitivity of a file  system  presented  by  rclone  (the  source).   The  flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If  the  flag  is  not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the
       operating system where rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS,  “false”  otherwise.   If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This  flag  allows  you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need  this
       information  to  be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the flag --vfs-
       used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend  to  report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING. Contrary to rclone size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so  that  the  result  is
       accurate.   However,  this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls resulting in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

   Auth Proxy
       If you supply the parameter  --auth-proxy  /path/to/program  then  rclone  will  use  that
       program  to  generate  backends  on  the  fly which then are used to authenticate incoming
       requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol  with  input  on  STDIN  and  output  on
       STDOUT.

       PLEASE  NOTE:  --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy
       is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

       There          is          an          example          program          bin/test_proxy.py
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

       The  program’s  job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config
       for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will have any default parameters  for
       the  backend  added,  but it won’t use configuration from environment variables or command
       line options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete config.

       This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

       And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma  separated  strings  for  parameters  to
       obscure

       If  password  authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword"
              }

       If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
              }

       And as an example return this on STDOUT

              {
                  "type": "sftp",
                  "_root": "",
                  "_obscure": "pass",
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword",
                  "host": "sftp.example.com"
              }

       This  would  mean  that  an  SFTP  backend  would  be  created on the fly for the user and
       pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that since _obscure is set
       to  pass,  rclone  will  obscure  the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is
       required for sftp backends).

       The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many
       different sftp backends, you could make the user be user@example.com and then set the host
       to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you’d  probably  want  to
       restrict the host to a limited list.

       Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don’t use
       pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user’s password or  public-key  is  changed
       the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

       This  can  be  used  to  build  general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone
       supports.

              rclone serve sftp remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:2022")
                    --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                    --authorized-keys string                 Authorized keys file (default "~/.ssh/authorized_keys")
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for sftp
                    --key stringArray                        SSH private host key file (Can be multi-valued, leave blank to auto generate)
                    --no-auth                                Allow connections with no authentication if set
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --pass string                            Password for authentication
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --stdio                                  Run an sftp server on stdin/stdout
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --user string                            User name for authentication
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone serve webdav

       Serve remote:path over WebDAV.

   Synopsis
       Run  a  basic WebDAV server to serve a remote over HTTP via the WebDAV protocol.  This can
       be viewed with a WebDAV client, through a web browser, or you can make a  remote  of  type
       WebDAV to read and write it.

   WebDAV options
   –etag-hash
       This  controls  the  ETag header.  Without this flag the ETag will be based on the ModTime
       and Size of the object.

       If this flag is set to “auto” then rclone will choose the  first  supported  hash  on  the
       backend  or  you  can  use  a  named  hash  such  as  “MD5”  or  “SHA-1”.  Use the hashsum
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_hashsum/) command to see the full list.

   Server options
       Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should listen  on,  e.g. --addr
       1.2.3.4:8000  or  --addr  :8080  to  listen  to  all  IPs.   By default it only listens on
       localhost.  You can use port :0 to let the OS choose an available port.

       If you set --addr to  listen  on  a  public  or  LAN  accessible  IP  address  then  using
       Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

       --server-read-timeout  and  --server-write-timeout  can be used to control the timeouts on
       the server.  Note that this is the total time for a transfer.

       --max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will accept in the HTTP
       header.

       --baseurl  controls  the URL prefix that rclone serves from.  By default rclone will serve
       from the root.  If you used --baseurl  "/rclone"  then  rclone  would  serve  from  a  URL
       starting  with  “/rclone/”.   This  is  useful  if you wish to proxy rclone serve.  Rclone
       automatically inserts leading and  trailing  “/”  on  --baseurl,  so  --baseurl  "rclone",
       --baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated identically.

       --template  allows  a  user  to specify a custom markup template for HTTP and WebDAV serve
       functions.  The server exports the following markup to be  used  within  the  template  to
       server pages:

       Parameter                             Description
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       .Name                                 The full path of a file/directory.
       .Title                                Directory listing of .Name
       .Sort                                 The  current  sort  used.   This is
                                             changeable via ?sort= parameter
                                             Sort                       Options:
                                             namedirfirst,name,size,time
                                             (default namedirfirst)
       .Order                                The current ordering used.  This is
                                             changeable via ?order= parameter
                                             Order  Options:  asc,desc  (default
                                             asc)
       .Query                                Currently unused.
       .Breadcrumb                           Allows  for  creating  a   relative
                                             navigation
       – .Link                               The  relative  to  the root link of
                                             the Text.
       – .Text                               The Name of the directory.
       .Entries                              Information   about   a    specific
                                             file/directory.

       – .URL                                The `url' of an entry.
       – .Leaf                               Currently   same   as   `URL'   but
                                             intended to be `just' the name.
       – .IsDir                              Boolean  for  if  an  entry  is   a
                                             directory or not.
       – .Size                               Size in Bytes of the entry.
       – .ModTime                            The UTC timestamp of an entry.

   Authentication
       By default this will serve files without needing a login.

       You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or set a single username
       and password with the --user and --pass flags.

       Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file.  This is in standard  apache
       format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic authentication.  Bcrypt is recommended.

       To create an htpasswd file:

              touch htpasswd
              htpasswd -B htpasswd user
              htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

       The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

       Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

   SSL/TLS
       By  default  this  will  serve over HTTP.  If you want you can serve over HTTPS.  You will
       need to supply the --cert and --key flags.  If you wish  to  do  client  side  certificate
       validation then you will need to supply --client-ca also.

       --cert  should  be either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation of that with the CA
       certificate.  --key should be the PEM encoded private key and --client-ca  should  be  the
       PEM encoded client certificate authority certificate.

       –min-tls-version  is  minimum  TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are “tls1.0”,
       “tls1.1”, “tls1.2” and “tls1.3” (default “tls1.0”).

   VFS - Virtual File System
       This command uses the VFS layer.  This adapts the cloud storage objects that  rclone  uses
       into something which looks much more like a disk filing system.

       Cloud  storage  objects  have  lots of properties which aren’t like disk files - you can’t
       extend them or write to the middle of them, so the  VFS  layer  has  to  deal  with  that.
       Because there is no one right way of doing this there are various options explained below.

       The  VFS  layer  also  implements  a  directory  cache  - this caches info about files and
       directories (but not the data) in memory.

   VFS Directory Cache
       Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a directory should be considered
       up  to  date and not refreshed from the backend.  Changes made through the VFS will appear
       immediately or invalidate the cache.

              --dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
              --poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable (default 1m0s)

       However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web interface  or  a  different
       copy  of  rclone  will  only  be picked up once the directory cache expires if the backend
       configured does not support polling for changes.  If the backend supports polling, changes
       will be picked up within the polling interval.

       You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all directory caches, regardless of
       how old they are.  Assuming only one rclone instance is running, you can reset  the  cache
       like this:

              kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

       If  you  configure  rclone  with  a remote control then you can use rclone rc to flush the
       whole directory cache:

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Or individual files or directories:

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

   VFS File Buffering
       The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory, that will be used to  buffer  data
       in advance.

       Each  open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory at all times.  The
       buffered data is bound to one open file and won’t be shared.

       This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file.  The buffer  will  only  use
       memory  for  data that is downloaded but not not yet read.  If the buffer is empty, only a
       small amount of memory will be used.

       The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to --buffer-size * open files.

   VFS File Caching
       These flags control the VFS file caching options.  File caching is necessary to  make  the
       VFS  layer appear compatible with a normal file system.  It can be disabled at the cost of
       some compatibility.

       For example you’ll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and write simultaneously
       to a file.  See below for more details.

       Note  that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may find that you need
       one or the other or both.

              --cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
              --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
              --vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
              --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
              --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
              --vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)

       If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache.  The files are stored in
       the  user  cache file area which is OS dependent but can be controlled with --cache-dir or
       setting the appropriate environment variable.

       The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.  The higher the  cache  mode
       the more compatible rclone becomes at the cost of using disk space.

       Note  that  files  are  written  back  to the remote only when they are closed and if they
       haven’t been accessed for --vfs-write-back seconds.  If rclone is quit or dies with  files
       that  haven’t  been uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
       flags.

       If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size  for  two  reasons.
       Firstly because it is only checked every --vfs-cache-poll-interval.  Secondly because open
       files cannot be evicted from the cache.

       You should not run two copies of rclone  using  the  same  VFS  cache  with  the  same  or
       overlapping  remotes  if  using  --vfs-cache-mode  > off.  This can potentially cause data
       corruption if you do.  You can work around this  by  giving  each  rclone  its  own  cache
       hierarchy  with  --cache-dir.   You  don’t  need to worry about this if the remotes in use
       don’t overlap.

   –vfs-cache-mode off
       In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write directly
       to the remote without caching anything on disk.

       This will mean some operations are not possible

       • Files can’t be opened for both read AND write

       • Files opened for write can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only

       • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied

       • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode minimal
       This is very similar to “off” except that files opened for read AND write will be buffered
       to disk.  This means that files opened for write will be a lot more compatible,  but  uses
       the minimal disk space.

       These operations are not possible

       • Files opened for write only can’t be seeked

       • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set

       • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC

       • If an upload fails it can’t be retried

   –vfs-cache-mode writes
       In  this  mode  files  opened for read only are still read directly from the remote, write
       only and read/write files are buffered to disk first.

       This mode should support all normal file system operations.

       If an upload fails it will be retried  at  exponentially  increasing  intervals  up  to  1
       minute.

   –vfs-cache-mode full
       In  this  mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk.  When data is read from
       the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

       In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone  will  keep  track  of
       which bits of the files it has downloaded.

       So  if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone will only buffer the
       start of the file.  These files will appear to be their full size in the cache,  but  they
       will be sparse files with only the data that has been downloaded present in them.

       This  mode  should support all normal file system operations and is otherwise identical to
       --vfs-cache-mode writes.

       When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus --vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead.  The
       --buffer-size is buffered in memory whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

       When  using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set too large and --vfs-
       read-ahead is set large if required.

       IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files.   In  particular  FAT/exFAT  do  not.
       Rclone  will  perform  very  badly if the cache directory is on a filesystem which doesn’t
       support sparse files and it will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

   Fingerprinting
       Various parts of the VFS use fingerprinting to see  if  a  local  file  copy  has  changed
       relative to a remote file.  Fingerprints are made from:

       • size

       • modification time

       • hash

       where available on an object.

       On  some  backends  some of these attributes are slow to read (they take an extra API call
       per object, or extra work per object).

       For example hash is slow with the local and sftp backends as they have to read the  entire
       file  and  hash  it,  and  modtime  is  slow with the s3, swift, ftp and qinqstor backends
       because they need to do an extra API call to fetch it.

       If you use  the  --vfs-fast-fingerprint  flag  then  rclone  will  not  include  the  slow
       operations  in  the  fingerprint.   This  makes  the fingerprinting less accurate but much
       faster and will improve the opening time of cached files.

       If you are running a vfs cache over local, s3 or swift backends then using  this  flag  is
       recommended.

       Note that if you change the value of this flag, the fingerprints of the files in the cache
       may be invalidated and the files will need to be downloaded again.

   VFS Chunked Reading
       When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks.   This  means  that  rather
       than requesting the whole file rclone reads the chunk specified.  This can reduce the used
       download quota for some remotes by  requesting  only  chunks  from  the  remote  that  are
       actually read, at the cost of an increased number of requests.

       These flags control the chunking:

              --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks (default 128M)
              --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default off)

       Rclone  will start reading a chunk of size --vfs-read-chunk-size, and then double the size
       for each read.  When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is specified,  and  greater  than  --vfs-
       read-chunk-size,  the  chunk  size  for  each  open  file  will get doubled only until the
       specified value is reached.  If the value is “off”, which is the  default,  the  limit  is
       disabled and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

       With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0 the following parts will
       be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.  When  --vfs-read-chunk-
       size-limit   500M  is  specified,  the  result  would  be  0-100M,  100M-300M,  300M-700M,
       700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

       Setting --vfs-read-chunk-size to 0 or “off” disables chunked reading.

   VFS Performance
       These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS  for  performance  or  other
       reasons.  See also the chunked reading feature.

       In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag (or use --use-server-
       modtime for a slightly different effect) as each read of the  modification  time  takes  a
       transaction.

              --no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
              --no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
              --no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
              --read-only       Only allow read-only access.

       Sometimes  rclone  is  delivered reads or writes out of order.  Rather than seeking rclone
       will wait a short time for the in sequence read or write to come  in.   These  flags  only
       come into effect when not using an on disk cache file.

              --vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
              --vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full), the global flag
       --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of modified files from the
       cache (the related global flag --checkers has no effect on the VFS).

              --transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)

   VFS Case Sensitivity
       Linux  file  systems  are case-sensitive: two files can differ only by case, and the exact
       case must be used when opening a file.

       File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving: although existing
       files  can  be  opened using any case, the exact case used to create the file is preserved
       and available for programs to query.  It  is  not  allowed  for  two  files  in  the  same
       directory to differ only by case.

       Usually  file  systems  on  macOS are case-insensitive.  It is possible to make macOS file
       systems case-sensitive but that is not the default.

       The --vfs-case-insensitive VFS flag controls how rclone handles these two cases.   If  its
       value is “false”, rclone passes file names to the remote as-is.  If the flag is “true” (or
       appears without a value on the command line), rclone may perform a  “fixup”  as  explained
       below.

       The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case different than what
       is stored on the remote.  If an argument refers to an existing file with exactly the  same
       name,  then  the  case  of the existing file on the disk will be used.  However, if a file
       name with exactly the same name is not found but a name differing  only  by  case  exists,
       rclone  will  transparently fixup the name.  This fixup happens only when an existing file
       is requested.  Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is controlled by  the
       underlying remote.

       Note  that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target) may differ
       from case sensitivity of a file  system  presented  by  rclone  (the  source).   The  flag
       controls whether “fixup” is performed to satisfy the target.

       If  the  flag  is  not provided on the command line, then its default value depends on the
       operating system where rclone runs: “true” on Windows and macOS,  “false”  otherwise.   If
       the flag is provided without a value, then it is “true”.

   VFS Disk Options
       This  flag  allows  you to manually set the statistics about the filing system.  It can be
       useful when those statistics cannot be read correctly automatically.

              --vfs-disk-space-total-size    Manually set the total disk space size (example: 256G, default: -1)

   Alternate report of used bytes
       Some backends, most notably S3, do not report the amount of bytes used.  If you need  this
       information  to  be available when running df on the filesystem, then pass the flag --vfs-
       used-is-size to rclone.  With this flag set, instead of relying on the backend  to  report
       this information, rclone will scan the whole remote similar to rclone size and compute the
       total used space itself.

       WARNING. Contrary to rclone size,  this  flag  ignores  filters  so  that  the  result  is
       accurate.   However,  this is very inefficient and may cost lots of API calls resulting in
       extra charges.  Use it as a last resort and only with caching.

   Auth Proxy
       If you supply the parameter  --auth-proxy  /path/to/program  then  rclone  will  use  that
       program  to  generate  backends  on  the  fly which then are used to authenticate incoming
       requests.  This uses a simple JSON based protocol  with  input  on  STDIN  and  output  on
       STDOUT.

       PLEASE  NOTE:  --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used together, if --auth-proxy
       is set the authorized keys option will be ignored.

       There          is          an          example          program          bin/test_proxy.py
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/test_proxy.py) in the rclone source code.

       The  program’s  job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn those into the config
       for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format.  This config will have any default parameters  for
       the  backend  added,  but it won’t use configuration from environment variables or command
       line options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete config.

       This config generated must have this extra parameter - _root - root to use for the backend

       And it may have this parameter - _obscure - comma  separated  strings  for  parameters  to
       obscure

       If  password  authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword"
              }

       If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy process (on STDIN)
       would look similar to this:

              {
                  "user": "me",
                  "public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
              }

       And as an example return this on STDOUT

              {
                  "type": "sftp",
                  "_root": "",
                  "_obscure": "pass",
                  "user": "me",
                  "pass": "mypassword",
                  "host": "sftp.example.com"
              }

       This  would  mean  that  an  SFTP  backend  would  be  created on the fly for the user and
       pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given.  Note that since _obscure is set
       to  pass,  rclone  will  obscure  the pass parameter before creating the backend (which is
       required for sftp backends).

       The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example to make proxy to many
       different sftp backends, you could make the user be user@example.com and then set the host
       to example.com in the output and the user to user.  For security you’d  probably  want  to
       restrict the host to a limited list.

       Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for configuration, don’t use
       pass or public_key.  This also means that if a user’s password or  public-key  is  changed
       the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins) before it takes effect.

       This  can  be  used  to  build  general purpose proxies to any kind of backend that rclone
       supports.

              rclone serve webdav remote:path [flags]

   Options
                    --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:8080")
                    --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth
                    --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                    --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                    --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                    --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for (default 5m0s)
                    --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
                    --disable-dir-list                       Disable HTML directory list on GET request for a directory
                    --etag-hash string                       Which hash to use for the ETag, or auto or blank for off
                    --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
                    --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                -h, --help                                   help for webdav
                    --htpasswd string                        htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                    --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
                    --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                    --min-tls-version string                 Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                    --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download
                    --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up)
                    --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files
                    --pass string                            Password for authentication
                    --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes, must be smaller than dir-cache-time and only on supported remotes (set 0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --read-only                              Only allow read-only access
                    --realm string                           Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                    --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --template string                        User-specified template
                    --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 1000)
                    --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem (not supported on Windows) (default 2)
                    --user string                            User name for authentication
                    --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache (default 1h0m0s)
                    --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
                    --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects (default 1m0s)
                    --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match
                    --vfs-disk-space-total-size SizeSuffix   Specify the total space of disk (default off)
                    --vfs-fast-fingerprint                   Use fast (less accurate) fingerprints for change detection
                    --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks (default 128Mi)
                    --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached ('off' is unlimited) (default off)
                    --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking (default 20ms)
                    --vfs-used-is-size rclone size           Use the rclone size algorithm for Used size
                    --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache (default 5s)
                    --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error (default 1s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  serve  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/)  -  Serve  a  remote  over  a
         protocol.

rclone settier

       Changes storage class/tier of objects in remote.

   Synopsis
       rclone  settier  changes  storage tier or class at remote if supported.  Few cloud storage
       services provides different storage classes on objects, for example AWS  S3  and  Glacier,
       Azure  Blob  storage  -  Hot,  Cool  and  Archive, Google Cloud Storage, Regional Storage,
       Nearline, Coldline etc.

       Note that, certain tier changes make objects not available  to  access  immediately.   For
       example  tiering  to archive in azure blob storage makes objects in frozen state, user can
       restore  by  setting  tier  to  Hot/Cool,   similarly   S3   to   Glacier   makes   object
       inaccessible.true

       You can use it to tier single object

              rclone settier Cool remote:path/file

       Or use rclone filters to set tier on only specific files

              rclone --include "*.txt" settier Hot remote:path/dir

       Or just provide remote directory and all files in directory will be tiered

              rclone settier tier remote:path/dir

              rclone settier tier remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for settier

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone test

       Run a test command

   Synopsis
       Rclone test is used to run test commands.

       Select which test comand you want with the subcommand, eg

              rclone test memory remote:

       Each subcommand has its own options which you can see in their help.

       NB Be careful running these  commands,  they  may  do  strange  things  so  reading  their
       documentation first is recommended.

   Options
                -h, --help   help for test

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

       • rclone test changenotify (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_changenotify/)  -  Log
         any change notify requests for the remote passed in.

       • rclone  test  histogram  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_histogram/)  - Makes a
         histogram of file name characters.

       • rclone test info (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_info/) - Discovers  file  name
         or other limitations for paths.

       • rclone  test  makefile  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefile/) - Make files
         with random contents of the size given

       • rclone test  makefiles  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefiles/)  -  Make  a
         random file hierarchy in a directory

       • rclone  test  memory  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_memory/)  -  Load all the
         objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

rclone test changenotify

       Log any change notify requests for the remote passed in.

              rclone test changenotify remote: [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help                     help for changenotify
                    --poll-interval duration   Time to wait between polling for changes (default 10s)

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test histogram

       Makes a histogram of file name characters.

   Synopsis
       This command outputs JSON which shows the histogram of characters used in filenames in the
       remote:path specified.

       The  data  doesn’t  contain  any  identifying  information  but  is  useful for the rclone
       developers when developing filename compression.

              rclone test histogram [remote:path] [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for histogram

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test info

       Discovers file name or other limitations for paths.

   Synopsis
       rclone info discovers what filenames and upload methods are possible to write to the paths
       passed in and how long they can be.  It can take some time.  It will write test files into
       the remote:path passed in.  It outputs a bit of go code for each one.

       NB this can create undeletable files and other hazards - use with care

              rclone test info [remote:path]+ [flags]

   Options
                    --all                    Run all tests
                    --check-control          Check control characters
                    --check-length           Check max filename length
                    --check-normalization    Check UTF-8 Normalization
                    --check-streaming        Check uploads with indeterminate file size
                -h, --help                   help for info
                    --upload-wait duration   Wait after writing a file
                    --write-json string      Write results to file

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test makefile

       Make files with random contents of the size given

              rclone test makefile <size> [<file>]+ [flags]

   Options
                    --ascii      Fill files with random ASCII printable bytes only
                    --chargen    Fill files with a ASCII chargen pattern
                -h, --help       help for makefile
                    --pattern    Fill files with a periodic pattern
                    --seed int   Seed for the random number generator (0 for random) (default 1)
                    --sparse     Make the files sparse (appear to be filled with ASCII 0x00)
                    --zero       Fill files with ASCII 0x00

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test makefiles

       Make a random file hierarchy in a directory

              rclone test makefiles <dir> [flags]

   Options
                    --ascii                      Fill files with random ASCII printable bytes only
                    --chargen                    Fill files with a ASCII chargen pattern
                    --files int                  Number of files to create (default 1000)
                    --files-per-directory int    Average number of files per directory (default 10)
                -h, --help                       help for makefiles
                    --max-file-size SizeSuffix   Maximum size of files to create (default 100)
                    --max-name-length int        Maximum size of file names (default 12)
                    --min-file-size SizeSuffix   Minimum size of file to create
                    --min-name-length int        Minimum size of file names (default 4)
                    --pattern                    Fill files with a periodic pattern
                    --seed int                   Seed for the random number generator (0 for random) (default 1)
                    --sparse                     Make the files sparse (appear to be filled with ASCII 0x00)
                    --zero                       Fill files with ASCII 0x00

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone test memory

       Load all the objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

              rclone test memory remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help   help for memory

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone test (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/) - Run a test command

rclone touch

       Create new file or change file modification time.

   Synopsis
       Set the modification time on file(s) as specified by remote:path to have the current time.

       If remote:path does not exist then a zero sized file will be created,  unless  --no-create
       or --recursive is provided.

       If  --recursive  is used then recursively sets the modification time on all existing files
       that is found under the path.  Filters are supported, and you can test with the  --dry-run
       or the --interactive flag.

       If --timestamp is used then sets the modification time to that time instead of the current
       time.  Times may be specified as one of:

       • `YYMMDD' - e.g. 17.10.30

       • `YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS' - e.g. 2006-01-02T15:04:05

       • `YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS.SSS' - e.g. 2006-01-02T15:04:05.123456789

       Note that value of --timestamp is in UTC.  If you want local time then add the --localtime
       flag.

              rclone touch remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -h, --help               help for touch
                    --localtime          Use localtime for timestamp, not UTC
                -C, --no-create          Do not create the file if it does not exist (implied with --recursive)
                -R, --recursive          Recursively touch all files
                -t, --timestamp string   Use specified time instead of the current time of day

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags and
         backends.

rclone tree

       List the contents of the remote in a tree like fashion.

   Synopsis
       rclone tree lists the contents of a remote in a similar way to the unix tree command.

       For example

              $ rclone tree remote:path
              /
              ├── file1
              ├── file2
              ├── file3
              └── subdir
                  ├── file4
                  └── file5

              1 directories, 5 files

       You can use any of the filtering options  with  the  tree  command  (e.g.   --include  and
       --exclude.  You can also use --fast-list.

       The  tree  command  has many options for controlling the listing which are compatible with
       the tree command, for example you can include file sizes with --size.  Note that  not  all
       of them have short options as they conflict with rclone’s short options.

       For    a    more    interactive    navigation    of    the    remote    see    the    ncdu
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/) command.

              rclone tree remote:path [flags]

   Options
                -a, --all             All files are listed (list . files too)
                -C, --color           Turn colorization on always
                -d, --dirs-only       List directories only
                    --dirsfirst       List directories before files (-U disables)
                    --full-path       Print the full path prefix for each file
                -h, --help            help for tree
                    --level int       Descend only level directories deep
                -D, --modtime         Print the date of last modification.
                    --noindent        Don't print indentation lines
                    --noreport        Turn off file/directory count at end of tree listing
                -o, --output string   Output to file instead of stdout
                -p, --protections     Print the protections for each file.
                -Q, --quote           Quote filenames with double quotes.
                -s, --size            Print the size in bytes of each file.
                    --sort string     Select sort: name,version,size,mtime,ctime
                    --sort-ctime      Sort files by last status change time
                -t, --sort-modtime    Sort files by last modification time
                -r, --sort-reverse    Reverse the order of the sort
                -U, --unsorted        Leave files unsorted
                    --version         Sort files alphanumerically by version

       See the global flags page (https://rclone.org/flags/) for global options not listed here.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone/) - Show help for rclone commands, flags  and
         backends.

   Copying single files
       rclone  normally  syncs  or copies directories.  However, if the source remote points to a
       file, rclone will just copy that file.  The destination remote must point to a directory -
       rclone will give the error Failed to create file system for "remote:file": is a file not a
       directory if it isn’t.

       For example, suppose you have a remote with a file in called test.jpg, then you could copy
       just that file like this

              rclone copy remote:test.jpg /tmp/download

       The file test.jpg will be placed inside /tmp/download.

       This is equivalent to specifying

              rclone copy --files-from /tmp/files remote: /tmp/download

       Where /tmp/files contains the single line

              test.jpg

       It  is  recommended to use copy when copying individual files, not sync.  They have pretty
       much the same effect but copy will use a lot less memory.

   Syntax of remote paths
       The syntax of the paths passed to the rclone command are as follows.

   /path/to/dir
       This refers to the local file system.

       On Windows \ may be used instead of / in local paths only, non local  paths  must  use  /.
       See  local  filesystem (https://rclone.org/local/#paths-on-windows) documentation for more
       about Windows-specific paths.

       These paths needn’t start with a leading / - if they don’t then they will be  relative  to
       the current directory.

   remote:path/to/dir
       This  refers  to  a  directory  path/to/dir  on  remote:  as  defined  in  the config file
       (configured with rclone config).

   remote:/path/to/dir
       On most backends this is refers to the  same  directory  as  remote:path/to/dir  and  that
       format  should  be  preferred.   On a very small number of remotes (FTP, SFTP, Dropbox for
       business) this will refer to a different directory.  On these, paths without a  leading  /
       will refer to your “home” directory and paths with a leading / will refer to the root.

   :backend:path/to/dir
       This  is  an advanced form for creating remotes on the fly.  backend should be the name or
       prefix of a backend (the type in the config  file)  and  all  the  configuration  for  the
       backend should be provided on the command line (or in environment variables).

       Here are some examples:

              rclone lsd --http-url https://pub.rclone.org :http:

       To list all the directories in the root of https://pub.rclone.org/.

              rclone lsf --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir

       To list files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir/

              rclone copy --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

       To copy files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir to /tmp/dir.

              rclone copy --sftp-host example.com :sftp:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

       To  copy  files  and directories from example.com in the relative directory path/to/dir to
       /tmp/dir using sftp.

   Connection strings
       The above examples can also be written using a connection string  syntax,  so  instead  of
       providing  the arguments as command line parameters --http-url https://pub.rclone.org they
       are provided as part of the remote specification as a kind of connection string.

              rclone lsd ":http,url='https://pub.rclone.org':"
              rclone lsf ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir"
              rclone copy ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir" /tmp/dir
              rclone copy :sftp,host=example.com:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

       These can apply to modify existing remotes as well as create new remotes with the  on  the
       fly  syntax.  This example is equivalent to adding the --drive-shared-with-me parameter to
       the remote gdrive:.

              rclone lsf "gdrive,shared_with_me:path/to/dir"

       The major advantage to using the connection string style syntax is that it only applies to
       the  remote,  not to all the remotes of that type of the command line.  A common confusion
       is this attempt to copy a file shared on google drive to the normal drive which  does  not
       work  because  the  --drive-shared-with-me  flag  applies  to  both  the  source  and  the
       destination.

              rclone copy --drive-shared-with-me gdrive:shared-file.txt gdrive:

       However using the connection string syntax, this does work.

              rclone copy "gdrive,shared_with_me:shared-file.txt" gdrive:

       Note that the connection string only affects the options of the immediate backend.  If for
       example  gdriveCrypt  is a crypt based on gdrive, then the following command will not work
       as intended, because shared_with_me is ignored by the crypt backend:

              rclone copy "gdriveCrypt,shared_with_me:shared-file.txt" gdriveCrypt:

       The connection strings have the following syntax

              remote,parameter=value,parameter2=value2:path/to/dir
              :backend,parameter=value,parameter2=value2:path/to/dir

       If the parameter has a : or , then it must be placed in quotes " or ', so

              remote,parameter="colon:value",parameter2="comma,value":path/to/dir
              :backend,parameter='colon:value',parameter2='comma,value':path/to/dir

       If a quoted value needs to include that quote, then it should be doubled, so

              remote,parameter="with""quote",parameter2='with''quote':path/to/dir

       This will make parameter be with"quote and parameter2 be with'quote.

       If you leave off the =parameter then rclone will substitute =true which  works  very  well
       with flags.  For example, to use s3 configured in the environment you could use:

              rclone lsd :s3,env_auth:

       Which is equivalent to

              rclone lsd :s3,env_auth=true:

       Note  that  on the command line you might need to surround these connection strings with "
       or ' to stop the shell interpreting any special characters within them.

       If you are a shell master then you’ll know which strings are OK and which aren’t,  but  if
       you  aren’t  sure then enclose them in " and use ' as the inside quote.  This syntax works
       on all OSes.

              rclone copy ":http,url='https://example.com':path/to/dir" /tmp/dir

       On Linux/macOS some characters are  still  interpreted  inside  "  strings  in  the  shell
       (notably \ and $ and ") so if your strings contain those you can swap the roles of " and '
       thus.  (This syntax does not work on Windows.)

              rclone copy ':http,url="https://example.com":path/to/dir' /tmp/dir

   Connection strings, config and logging
       If you supply extra configuration to a backend by command line flag, environment  variable
       or  connection string then rclone will add a suffix based on the hash of the config to the
       name of the remote, eg

              rclone -vv lsf --s3-chunk-size 20M s3:

       Has the log message

              DEBUG : s3: detected overridden config - adding "{Srj1p}" suffix to name

       This is so rclone can tell the modified remote  apart  from  the  unmodified  remote  when
       caching the backends.

       This should only be noticeable in the logs.

       This means that on the fly backends such as

              rclone -vv lsf :s3,env_auth:

       Will get their own names

              DEBUG : :s3: detected overridden config - adding "{YTu53}" suffix to name

   Valid remote names
       Remote  names  are  case  sensitive,  and  must  adhere to the following rules: - May only
       contain 0-9, A-Z, a-z, _, -, . and space.  - May not start with - or space.

   Quoting and the shell
       When you are typing commands to your computer you are using something called  the  command
       line shell.  This interprets various characters in an OS specific way.

       Here are some gotchas which may help users unfamiliar with the shell rules

   Linux / OSX
       If  your  names  have  spaces or shell metacharacters (e.g. *, ?, $, ', ", etc.)  then you
       must quote them.  Use single quotes ' by default.

              rclone copy 'Important files?' remote:backup

       If you want to send a ' you will need to use ", e.g.

              rclone copy "O'Reilly Reviews" remote:backup

       The rules for quoting metacharacters are complicated and if  you  want  the  full  details
       you’ll have to consult the manual page for your shell.

   Windows
       If your names have spaces in you need to put them in ", e.g.

              rclone copy "E:\folder name\folder name\folder name" remote:backup

       If  you  are  using  the  root  directory  on  its  own  then  don’t  quote  it  (see #464
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/464) for why), e.g.

              rclone copy E:\ remote:backup

   Copying files or directories with : in the names
       rclone uses : to mark a remote name.  This is, however, a valid filename component in non-
       Windows OSes.  The remote name parser will only search for a : up to the first / so if you
       need to act on a file or directory like this then use the full path starting with a /,  or
       use ./ as a current directory prefix.

       So to sync a directory called sync:me to a remote called remote: use

              rclone sync -i ./sync:me remote:path

       or

              rclone sync -i /full/path/to/sync:me remote:path

   Server Side Copy
       Most  remotes  (but  not  all  -  see the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-
       features)) support server-side copy.

       This means if you want to copy one folder to another then rclone won’t  download  all  the
       files and re-upload them; it will instruct the server to copy them in place.

       Eg

              rclone copy s3:oldbucket s3:newbucket

       Will copy the contents of oldbucket to newbucket without downloading and re-uploading.

       Remotes which don’t support server-side copy will download and re-upload in this case.

       Server  side  copies  are  used  with sync and copy and will be identified in the log when
       using the -v flag.  The move command may also use them if remote doesn’t  support  server-
       side  move  directly.   This  is done by issuing a server-side copy then a delete which is
       much quicker than a download and re-upload.

       Server side copies will only be attempted if the remote names are the same.

       This can be used when scripting to make aged backups efficiently, e.g.

              rclone sync -i remote:current-backup remote:previous-backup
              rclone sync -i /path/to/files remote:current-backup

   Metadata support
       Metadata is data about a file which isn’t the contents of the file.  Normally rclone  only
       preserves the modification time and the content (MIME) type where possible.

       Rclone  supports  preserving  all  the  available metadata on files (not directories) when
       using the --metadata or -M flag.

       Exactly what metadata is supported and what that support means  depends  on  the  backend.
       Backends that support metadata have a metadata section in their docs and are listed in the
       features       table       (https://rclone.org/overview/#features)        (Eg        local
       (https://rclone.org/local/#metadata), s3)

       Rclone only supports a one-time sync of metadata.  This means that metadata will be synced
       from the source object to the destination object only when the source object  has  changed
       and  needs  to  be re-uploaded.  If the metadata subsequently changes on the source object
       without changing the object itself then it won’t be  synced  to  the  destination  object.
       This is in line with the way rclone syncs Content-Type without the --metadata flag.

       Using  --metadata  when  syncing from local to local will preserve file attributes such as
       file mode, owner, extended attributes (not Windows).

       Note that arbitrary metadata may be added to objects using  the  --metadata-set  key=value
       flag  when  the  object  is  first  uploaded.   This flag can be repeated as many times as
       necessary.

   Types of metadata
       Metadata is divided into two type.  System metadata and User metadata.

       Metadata which the backend uses itself is called system  metadata.   For  example  on  the
       local  backend  the  system metadata uid will store the user ID of the file when used on a
       unix based platform.

       Arbitrary metadata is called user metadata and this can be set however is desired.

       When objects are copied from backend to backend, they will  attempt  to  interpret  system
       metadata  if  it  is  supplied.   Metadata  may  change from being user metadata to system
       metadata as objects are copied between different backends.  For example copying an  object
       from  s3  sets  the  content-type  metadata.   In  a  backend which understands this (like
       azureblob) this will become the Content-Type of the object.  In a  backend  which  doesn’t
       understand  this  (like the local backend) this will become user metadata.  However should
       the local object be copied back to s3, the Content-Type will be set correctly.

   Metadata framework
       Rclone implements a metadata framework which can read metadata from an object and write it
       to the object when (and only when) it is being uploaded.

       This metadata is stored as a dictionary with string keys and string values.

       There  are  some  limits  on  the names of the keys (these may be clarified further in the
       future).

       • must be lower case

       • may be a-z 0-9 containing . - or _

       • length is backend dependent

       Each backend can provide system metadata that it  understands.   Some  backends  can  also
       store arbitrary user metadata.

       Where  possible  the  key  names are standardized, so, for example, it is possible to copy
       object metadata from  s3  to  azureblob  for  example  and  metadata  will  be  translated
       appropriately.

       Some  backends  have  limits  on  the  size of the metadata and rclone will give errors on
       upload if they are exceeded.

   Metadata preservation
       The goal of the implementation is to

       1. Preserve metadata if at all possible

       2. Interpret metadata if at all possible

       The consequences of 1 is that you can copy an S3 object to a local disk then  back  to  S3
       losslessly.  Likewise you can copy a local file with file attributes and xattrs from local
       disk to s3 and back again losslessly.

       The consequence of 2 is that you can copy an S3 object with metadata  to  Azureblob  (say)
       and have the metadata appear on the Azureblob object also.

   Standard system metadata
       Here  is  a  table  of  standard  system  metadata  which,  if  appropriate, a backend may
       implement.

       key                                  description             example
       ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       mode                                 File type  and  mode:   0100664
                                            octal, unix style
       uid                                  User   ID  of  owner:   500
                                            decimal number
       gid                                  Group  ID  of  owner:   500
                                            decimal number
       rdev                                 Device ID (if special   0
                                            file) => hexadecimal
       atime                                Time of last  access:   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                            RFC 3339
       mtime                                Time     of      last   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                            modification:     RFC
                                            3339
       btime                                Time of file creation   2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00
                                            (birth): RFC 3339
       cache-control                        Cache-Control header    no-cache
       content-disposition                  Content-Disposition     inline
                                            header
       content-encoding                     Content-Encoding        gzip
                                            header
       content-language                     Content-Language        en-US
                                            header
       content-type                         Content-Type header     text/plain

       The metadata keys mtime and content-type will take precedence if supplied in the  metadata
       over reading the Content-Type or modification time of the source object.

       Hashes are not included in system metadata as there is a well defined way of reading those
       already.

   Options
       Rclone has a number of options to control its behaviour.

       Options that take parameters can have the values passed in  two  ways,  --option=value  or
       --option  value.   However boolean (true/false) options behave slightly differently to the
       other options in that --boolean sets the option to true and the absence of the  flag  sets
       it to false.  It is also possible to specify --boolean=false or --boolean=true.  Note that
       --boolean false is not valid - this is parsed as --boolean and the false is parsed  as  an
       extra command line argument for rclone.

   Time or duration options
       TIME or DURATION options can be specified as a duration string or a time string.

       A  duration  string  is  a possibly signed sequence of decimal numbers, each with optional
       fraction and a unit suffix, such as  “300ms”,  “-1.5h”  or  “2h45m”.   Default  units  are
       seconds or the following abbreviations are valid:

       • ms - Milliseconds

       • s - Seconds

       • m - Minutes

       • h - Hours

       • d - Days

       • w - Weeks

       • M - Months

       • y - Years

       These can also be specified as an absolute time in the following formats:

       • RFC3339 - e.g. 2006-01-02T15:04:05Z or 2006-01-02T15:04:05+07:00

       • ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - 2006-01-02T15:04:05

       • ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - 2006-01-02 15:04:05

       • ISO8601 Date - 2006-01-02 (YYYY-MM-DD)

   Size options
       Options which use SIZE use KiB (multiples of 1024 bytes) by default.  However, a suffix of
       B for Byte, K for KiB, M for MiB, G for GiB, T for TiB and P for PiB may be  used.   These
       are the binary units, e.g. 1, 2**10, 2**20, 2**30 respectively.

   –backup-dir=DIR
       When  using  sync, copy or move any files which would have been overwritten or deleted are
       moved in their original hierarchy into this directory.

       If --suffix is set, then the moved files will have the suffix added to them.  If there  is
       a  file  with  the  same  path  (after  the suffix has been added) in DIR, then it will be
       overwritten.

       The remote in use must support server-side move or copy and you must use the  same  remote
       as  the  destination  of  the sync.  The backup directory must not overlap the destination
       directory without it being excluded by a filter rule.

       For example

              rclone sync -i /path/to/local remote:current --backup-dir remote:old

       will sync /path/to/local to remote:current, but  for  any  files  which  would  have  been
       updated or deleted will be stored in remote:old.

       If  running  rclone from a script you might want to use today’s date as the directory name
       passed to --backup-dir to store the old files, or you might want  to  pass  --suffix  with
       today’s date.

       See --compare-dest and --copy-dest.

   –bind string
       Local address to bind to for outgoing connections.  This can be an IPv4 address (1.2.3.4),
       an IPv6 address (1234::789A) or host name.  If the host name doesn’t resolve  or  resolves
       to more than one IP address it will give an error.

   –bwlimit=BANDWIDTH_SPEC
       This option controls the bandwidth limit.  For example

              --bwlimit 10M

       would  mean  limit  the  upload  and download bandwidth to 10 MiB/s.  NB this is bytes per
       second not bits per second.  To use a single  limit,  specify  the  desired  bandwidth  in
       KiB/s, or use a suffix B|K|M|G|T|P.  The default is 0 which means to not limit bandwidth.

       The upload and download bandwidth can be specified separately, as --bwlimit UP:DOWN, so

              --bwlimit 10M:100k

       would mean limit the upload bandwidth to 10 MiB/s and the download bandwidth to 100 KiB/s.
       Either limit can be “off” meaning no limit, so to just  limit  the  upload  bandwidth  you
       would use

              --bwlimit 10M:off

       this  would  limit  the  upload  bandwidth to 10 MiB/s but the download bandwidth would be
       unlimited.

       When specified as above the bandwidth limits last for the duration of run  of  the  rclone
       binary.

       It is also possible to specify a “timetable” of limits, which will cause certain limits to
       be applied at certain times.  To specify a timetable,  format  your  entries  as  WEEKDAY-
       HH:MM,BANDWIDTH WEEKDAY-HH:MM,BANDWIDTH... where: WEEKDAY is optional element.

       • BANDWIDTH  can  be  a  single number, e.g.100k or a pair of numbers for upload:download,
         e.g.10M:1M.

       • WEEKDAY can be written as the whole word or only using the first 3  characters.   It  is
         optional.

       • HH:MM is an hour from 00:00 to 23:59.

       An  example  of  a typical timetable to avoid link saturation during daytime working hours
       could be:

       --bwlimit "08:00,512k 12:00,10M 13:00,512k 18:00,30M 23:00,off"

       In this example, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512 KiB/s at  8am  every  day.   At
       noon,  it  will  rise  to  10  MiB/s,  and  drop  back to 512 KiB/sec at 1pm.  At 6pm, the
       bandwidth limit will be set to 30 MiB/s, and at 11pm it will be completely disabled  (full
       speed).  Anything between 11pm and 8am will remain unlimited.

       An example of timetable with WEEKDAY could be:

       --bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 Fri-23:59,10M Sat-10:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

       It means that, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512 KiB/s on Monday.  It will rise to
       10 MiB/s before the end of Friday.  At 10:00 on Saturday it will be set to 1 MiB/s.   From
       20:00 on Sunday it will be unlimited.

       Timeslots without WEEKDAY are extended to the whole week.  So this example:

       --bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

       Is equivalent to this:

       --bwlimit  "Mon-00:00,512Mon-12:00,1M  Tue-12:00,1M Wed-12:00,1M Thu-12:00,1M Fri-12:00,1M
       Sat-12:00,1M Sun-12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

       Bandwidth limit apply to the data transfer  for  all  backends.   For  most  backends  the
       directory listing bandwidth is also included (exceptions being the non HTTP backends, ftp,
       sftp and storj).

       Note that the units are Byte/s, not bit/s.  Typically connections are measured in bit/s  -
       to  convert  divide  by 8.  For example, let’s say you have a 10 Mbit/s connection and you
       wish rclone to use half of it - 5 Mbit/s.  This is 5/8 = 0.625 MiB/s so you  would  use  a
       --bwlimit 0.625M parameter for rclone.

       On  Unix  systems  (Linux,  macOS, ...)  the bandwidth limiter can be toggled by sending a
       SIGUSR2 signal to rclone.  This allows to remove the limitations of a long running  rclone
       transfer and to restore it back to the value specified with --bwlimit quickly when needed.
       Assuming there is only one rclone instance running, you can toggle the limiter like this:

              kill -SIGUSR2 $(pidof rclone)

       If you configure rclone with a  remote  control  then  you  can  use  change  the  bwlimit
       dynamically:

              rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M

   –bwlimit-file=BANDWIDTH_SPEC
       This option controls per file bandwidth limit.  For the options see the --bwlimit flag.

       For example use this to allow no transfers to be faster than 1 MiB/s

              --bwlimit-file 1M

       This can be used in conjunction with --bwlimit.

       Note  that if a schedule is provided the file will use the schedule in effect at the start
       of the transfer.

   –buffer-size=SIZE
       Use this sized buffer to speed up file transfers.  Each  --transfer  will  use  this  much
       memory for buffering.

       When  using  mount  or  cmount  each  open  file  descriptor will use this much memory for
       buffering.   See  the   mount   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#file-buffering)
       documentation for more details.

       Set to 0 to disable the buffering for the minimum memory usage.

       Note that the memory allocation of the buffers is influenced by the –use-mmap flag.

   –cache-dir=DIR
       Specify the directory rclone will use for caching, to override the default.

       Default  value  is  depending  on  operating  system:  - Windows %LocalAppData%\rclone, if
       LocalAppData is defined.  - macOS $HOME/Library/Caches/rclone if HOME is defined.  -  Unix
       $XDG_CACHE_HOME/rclone  if  XDG_CACHE_HOME is defined, else $HOME/.cache/rclone if HOME is
       defined.  - Fallback (on all OS) to $TMPDIR/rclone, where TMPDIR is the value from  –temp-
       dir.

       You can use the config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) command to
       see the current value.

       Cache    directory     is     heavily     used     by     the     VFS     File     Caching
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#vfs-file-caching)  mount  feature,  but also by
       serve (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve/), GUI and other parts of rclone.

   –check-first
       If this flag is set then in a sync, copy or move, rclone will do all  the  checks  to  see
       whether  files  need to be transferred before doing any of the transfers.  Normally rclone
       would start running transfers as soon as possible.

       This flag can be useful on IO limited systems where transfers interfere with checking.

       It can also be useful to ensure perfect ordering when using --order-by.

       Using this flag can use more memory as it  effectively  sets  --max-backlog  to  infinite.
       This  means  that  all  the  info  on the objects to transfer is held in memory before the
       transfers start.

   –checkers=N
       Originally controlling just the number of file checkers to run in parallel, e.g. by rclone
       copy.  Now a fairly universal parallelism control used by rclone in several places.

       Note:  checkers do the equality checking of files during a sync.  For some storage systems
       (e.g. S3, Swift, Dropbox) this can take a significant amount of time so they  are  run  in
       parallel.

       The  default is to run 8 checkers in parallel.  However, in case of slow-reacting backends
       you may need to lower (rather than increase) this default by setting --checkers  to  4  or
       less  threads.   This is especially advised if you are experiencing backend server crashes
       during file checking phase (e.g. on subsequent or top-up backups where little or  no  file
       copying  is done and checking takes up most of the time).  Increase this setting only with
       utmost care, while monitoring your server health and file checking throughput.

   -c, –checksum
       Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.
       If  you  set this flag then rclone will check the file hash and size to determine if files
       are equal.

       This is useful when the remote doesn’t support setting modified time and a  more  accurate
       sync is desired than just checking the file size.

       This  is  very  useful when transferring between remotes which store the same hash type on
       the object, e.g. Drive and Swift.  For details of which remotes support  which  hash  type
       see the table in the overview section (https://rclone.org/overview/).

       Eg rclone --checksum sync s3:/bucket swift:/bucket would run much quicker than without the
       --checksum flag.

       When using this flag, rclone won’t update mtimes of remote files if they are incorrect  as
       it would normally.

   –compare-dest=DIR
       When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the destination for files.  If
       a file identical to the source is found that file is NOT  copied  from  source.   This  is
       useful to copy just files that have changed since the last backup.

       You  must  use the same remote as the destination of the sync.  The compare directory must
       not overlap the destination directory.

       See --copy-dest and --backup-dir.

   –config=CONFIG_FILE
       Specify the location of the rclone configuration file,  to  override  the  default.   E.g.
       rclone config --config="rclone.conf".

       The  exact  default  is  a  bit  complex  to  describe,  due to changes introduced through
       different versions of rclone while preserving backwards compatibility, but in  most  cases
       it is as simple as:

       • %APPDATA%/rclone/rclone.conf on Windows

       • ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf on other

       The  complete  logic is as follows: Rclone will look for an existing configuration file in
       any of the following locations, in priority order:

       1. rclone.conf (in program directory, where rclone executable is)

       2. %APPDATA%/rclone/rclone.conf (only on Windows)

       3. $XDG_CONFIG_HOME/rclone/rclone.conf (on all systems, including Windows)

       4. ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf (see below for explanation of ~ symbol)

       5. ~/.rclone.conf

       If no existing configuration file is found,  then  a  new  one  will  be  created  in  the
       following location:

       • On  Windows:  Location  2 listed above, except in the unlikely event that APPDATA is not
         defined, then location 4 is used instead.

       • On Unix: Location 3 if XDG_CONFIG_HOME is defined, else location 4.

       • Fallback to location 5 (on all OS), when the rclone directory cannot be created, but  if
         also  a  home directory was not found then path .rclone.conf relative to current working
         directory will be used as a final resort.

       The ~ symbol in paths above represent the home directory of the current user  on  any  OS,
       and the value is defined as following:

       • On Windows: %HOME% if defined, else %USERPROFILE%, or else %HOMEDRIVE%\%HOMEPATH%.

       • On  Unix: $HOME if defined, else by looking up current user in OS-specific user database
         (e.g. passwd file), or else use the result from shell command cd && pwd.

       If you run rclone config file you will see where the default location is for you.

       The fact that an existing file rclone.conf in the same directory as the rclone  executable
       is always preferred, means that it is easy to run in “portable” mode by downloading rclone
       executable to a writable directory and then create an empty file rclone.conf in  the  same
       directory.

       If  the location is set to empty string "" or path to a file with name notfound, or the os
       null device represented by value NUL on Windows and /dev/null on Unix systems, then rclone
       will keep the config file in memory only.

       The  file format is basic INI (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/INI_file#Format): Sections of
       text, led by a [section] header and followed by key=value entries on separate  lines.   In
       rclone  each  remote is represented by its own section, where the section name defines the
       name of the remote.  Options are specified as the key=value entries, where the key is  the
       option  name  without  the  --backend- prefix, in lowercase and with _ instead of -.  E.g.
       option --mega-hard-delete corresponds to key hard_delete.  Only  backend  options  can  be
       specified.    A   special,   and   required,   key  type  identifies  the  storage  system
       (https://rclone.org/overview/), where the value is the internal lowercase name as returned
       by  command  rclone help backends.  Comments are indicated by ; or # at the beginning of a
       line.

       Example:

              [megaremote]
              type = mega
              user = you@example.com
              pass = PDPcQVVjVtzFY-GTdDFozqBhTdsPg3qH

       Note that passwords are in  obscured  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/)  form.
       Also,  many storage systems uses token-based authentication instead of passwords, and this
       requires additional steps.  It is easier, and safer, to use the interactive command rclone
       config instead of manually editing the configuration file.

       The configuration file will typically contain login information, and should therefore have
       restricted permissions so that only the current user can read it.  Rclone tries to  ensure
       this when it writes the file.  You may also choose to encrypt the file.

       When token-based authentication are used, the configuration file must be writable, because
       rclone needs to update the tokens inside it.

   –contimeout=TIME
       Set the connection timeout.  This should be in go time format which looks like  5s  for  5
       seconds, 10m for 10 minutes, or 3h30m.

       The  connection  timeout  is  the  amount  of time rclone will wait for a connection to go
       through to a remote object storage system.  It is 1m by default.

   –copy-dest=DIR
       When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the destination for files.  If
       a  file  identical  to the source is found that file is server-side copied from DIR to the
       destination.  This is useful for incremental backup.

       The remote in use must support server-side copy and you must use the same  remote  as  the
       destination  of  the  sync.   The  compare  directory  must  not  overlap  the destination
       directory.

       See --compare-dest and --backup-dir.

   –dedupe-mode MODE
       Mode to run dedupe command in.  One of interactive, skip, first, newest,  oldest,  rename.
       The default is interactive.
       See the dedupe command for more information as to what these options mean.

   –disable FEATURE,FEATURE,...
       This disables a comma separated list of optional features.  For example to disable server-
       side move and server-side copy use:

              --disable move,copy

       The features can be put in any case.

       To see a list of which features can be disabled use:

              --disable help

       See the overview features (https://rclone.org/overview/#features)  and  optional  features
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)  to  get  an  idea  of which feature does
       what.

       This flag can be useful for debugging and in exceptional circumstances (e.g. Google  Drive
       limiting the total volume of Server Side Copies to 100 GiB/day).

   –disable-http2
       This  stops  rclone  from  trying to use HTTP/2 if available.  This can sometimes speed up
       transfers     due     to     a     problem     in     the     Go     standard      library
       (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/37373).

   –dscp VALUE
       Specify  a  DSCP  value  or  name  to  use  in connections.  This could help QoS system to
       identify traffic class.  BE, EF, DF, LE, CSx and AFxx are allowed.

       See         the          description          of          differentiated          services
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Differentiated_services)  to  get  an  idea  of this field.
       Setting this to 1 (LE) to identify the flow to SCAVENGER class  can  avoid  occupying  too
       much     bandwidth     in     a     network    with    DiffServ    support    (RFC    8622
       (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc8622)).

       For example, if you configured QoS on router to handle LE properly.  Running:

              rclone copy --dscp LE from:/from to:/to

       would make the priority lower than usual internet flows.

       This     option     has     no     effect     on     Windows     (see      golang/go#42728
       (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/42728)).

   -n, –dry-run
       Do  a  trial  run with no permanent changes.  Use this to see what rclone would do without
       actually doing it.  Useful when setting up the sync command which  deletes  files  in  the
       destination.

   –expect-continue-timeout=TIME
       This  specifies  the  amount  of  time to wait for a server’s first response headers after
       fully writing the request headers if the request has  an  “Expect:  100-continue”  header.
       Not all backends support using this.

       Zero  means no timeout and causes the body to be sent immediately, without waiting for the
       server to approve.  This time does not include the time to send the request header.

       The default is 1s.  Set to 0 to disable.

   –error-on-no-transfer
       By default, rclone will exit with return code 0 if there were no errors.

       This option allows rclone to return exit code 9 if no files were transferred  between  the
       source  and  destination.   This  allows using rclone in scripts, and triggering follow-on
       actions if data was copied, or skipping if not.

       NB: Enabling this option turns a usually non-fatal error into a potentially  fatal  one  -
       please check and adjust your scripts accordingly!

   –fs-cache-expire-duration=TIME
       When  using  rclone  via the API rclone caches created remotes for 5 minutes by default in
       the “fs cache”.  This means that if you do repeated actions on the same remote then rclone
       won’t have to build it again from scratch, which makes it more efficient.

       This flag sets the time that the remotes are cached for.  If you set it to 0 (or negative)
       then rclone won’t cache the remotes at all.

       Note that if you use some flags, eg --backup-dir and if this is set to 0 rclone may  build
       two  remotes  (one for the source or destination and one for the --backup-dir where it may
       have only built one before.

   –fs-cache-expire-interval=TIME
       This controls how often rclone checks for cached remotes to expire.  See  the  --fs-cache-
       expire-duration  documentation  above  for  more  info.   The  default is 60s, set to 0 to
       disable expiry.

   –header
       Add an HTTP header for all transactions.   The  flag  can  be  repeated  to  add  multiple
       headers.

       If  you  want  to  add headers only for uploads use --header-upload and if you want to add
       headers only for downloads use --header-download.

       This flag is supported for all HTTP based backends even those not supported  by  --header-
       upload and --header-download so may be used as a workaround for those with care.

              rclone ls remote:test --header "X-Rclone: Foo" --header "X-LetMeIn: Yes"

   –header-download
       Add  an  HTTP  header  for  all  download  transactions.   The flag can be repeated to add
       multiple headers.

              rclone sync -i s3:test/src ~/dst --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test: Foo" --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test2: Bar"

       See the  GitHub  issue  here  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/59)  for  currently
       supported backends.

   –header-upload
       Add  an HTTP header for all upload transactions.  The flag can be repeated to add multiple
       headers.

              rclone sync -i ~/src s3:test/dst --header-upload "Content-Disposition: attachment; filename='cool.html'" --header-upload "X-Amz-Meta-Test: FooBar"

       See the  GitHub  issue  here  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/59)  for  currently
       supported backends.

   –human-readable
       Rclone  commands output values for sizes (e.g. number of bytes) and counts (e.g. number of
       files) either as raw numbers, or in human-readable format.

       In human-readable format the values are scaled to larger units, indicated  with  a  suffix
       shown  after  the  value,  and rounded to three decimals.  Rclone consistently uses binary
       units (powers of 2) for sizes and decimal units (powers  of  10)  for  counts.   The  unit
       prefix  for  size is according to IEC standard notation, e.g. Ki for kibi.  Used with byte
       unit, 1 KiB means 1024 Byte.  In list type of output, only the unit prefix appended to the
       value  (e.g. 9.762Ki),  while  in  more  textual output the full unit is shown (e.g. 9.762
       KiB).  For counts the SI standard notation is used, e.g. prefix k  for  kilo.   Used  with
       file counts, 1k means 1000 files.

       The  various  list (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ls/) commands output raw numbers by
       default.  Option --human-readable will make them output values  in  human-readable  format
       instead (with the short unit prefix).

       The  about  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)  command outputs human-readable by
       default, with a command-specific option --full to output the raw numbers instead.

       Command size (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) outputs  both  human-readable  and
       raw numbers in the same output.

       The   tree  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_tree/)  command  also  considers  --human-
       readable, but it will not use the exact same notation as the other commands: It rounds  to
       one  decimal, and uses single letter suffix, e.g. K instead of Ki.  The reason for this is
       that it relies on an external library.

       The  interactive  command  ncdu  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_ncdu/)  shows  human-
       readable by default, and responds to key u for toggling human-readable format.

   –ignore-case-sync
       Using  this option will cause rclone to ignore the case of the files when synchronizing so
       files will not be copied/synced when the existing filenames are  the  same,  even  if  the
       casing is different.

   –ignore-checksum
       Normally  rclone  will  check  that  the checksums of transferred files match, and give an
       error “corrupted on transfer” if they don’t.

       You can use this option to skip that check.  You should only use it if you  have  had  the
       “corrupted  on  transfer”  error  message  and  you  are  sure  you might want to transfer
       potentially corrupted data.

   –ignore-existing
       Using this option will make rclone unconditionally  skip  all  files  that  exist  on  the
       destination, no matter the content of these files.

       While  this  isn’t  a  generally  recommended option, it can be useful in cases where your
       files change due to encryption.  However, it cannot correct partial transfers  in  case  a
       transfer was interrupted.

       When  performing  a  move/moveto command, this flag will leave skipped files in the source
       location unchanged when a file with the same name exists on the destination.

   –ignore-size
       Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.
       If  you set this flag then rclone will check only the modification time.  If --checksum is
       set then it only checks the checksum.

       It will also cause rclone to skip verifying the sizes are the same after transfer.

       This can be useful  for  transferring  files  to  and  from  OneDrive  which  occasionally
       misreports the size of image files (see #399 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/399)
       for more info).

   -I, –ignore-times
       Using this option will cause rclone to unconditionally upload all files regardless of  the
       state of files on the destination.

       Normally rclone would skip any files that have the same modification time and are the same
       size (or have the same checksum if using --checksum).

   –immutable
       Treat source and destination files as immutable and disallow modification.

       With this option set, files will be created and deleted as requested, but  existing  files
       will  never  be  updated.   If  an  existing  file  does  not match between the source and
       destination, rclone will give the error Source and destination exist  but  do  not  match:
       immutable file modified.

       Note  that only commands which transfer files (e.g. sync, copy, move) are affected by this
       behavior, and only modification is disallowed.  Files  may  still  be  deleted  explicitly
       (e.g. delete,  purge)  or  implicitly  (e.g. sync,  move).   Use copy --immutable if it is
       desired to avoid deletion as well as modification.

       This can be useful as an additional layer of protection for immutable or append-only  data
       sets  (notably  backup  archives), where modification implies corruption and should not be
       propagated.

   -i / –interactive
       This flag can be  used  to  tell  rclone  that  you  wish  a  manual  confirmation  before
       destructive operations.

       It  is  recommended  that  you  use this flag while learning rclone especially with rclone
       sync.

       For example

              $ rclone delete -i /tmp/dir
              rclone: delete "important-file.txt"?
              y) Yes, this is OK (default)
              n) No, skip this
              s) Skip all delete operations with no more questions
              !) Do all delete operations with no more questions
              q) Exit rclone now.
              y/n/s/!/q> n

       The options mean

       • y: Yes, this operation should go ahead.  You can also press Return for this  to  happen.
         You’ll be asked every time unless you choose s or !.

       • n: No, do not do this operation.  You’ll be asked every time unless you choose s or !.

       • s:  Skip  all  the following operations of this type with no more questions.  This takes
         effect until rclone exits.  If there are any different  kind  of  operations  you’ll  be
         prompted for them.

       • !:  Do  all  the  following operations with no more questions.  Useful if you’ve decided
         that you don’t mind rclone doing that kind of operation.  This takes effect until rclone
         exits .  If there are any different kind of operations you’ll be prompted for them.

       • q: Quit rclone now, just in case!

   –leave-root
       During rmdirs it will not remove root directory, even if it’s empty.

   –log-file=FILE
       Log  all  of  rclone’s output to FILE.  This is not active by default.  This can be useful
       for tracking down problems with syncs in combination with the -v flag.   See  the  Logging
       section for more info.

       If FILE exists then rclone will append to it.

       Note  that if you are using the logrotate program to manage rclone’s logs, then you should
       use the copytruncate option as rclone doesn’t have a signal to rotate logs.

   –log-format LIST
       Comma  separated  list  of  log  format  options.   Accepted  options  are   date,   time,
       microseconds, pid, longfile, shortfile, UTC.  Any other keywords will be silently ignored.
       pid will tag log messages with process identifier which useful with rclone mount --daemon.
       Other  accepted options are explained in the go documentation (https://pkg.go.dev/log#pkg-
       constants).  The default log format is “date,time”.

   –log-level LEVEL
       This sets the log level for rclone.  The default log level is NOTICE.

       DEBUG is equivalent to -vv.  It outputs lots of debug info - useful for  bug  reports  and
       really finding out what rclone is doing.

       INFO  is  equivalent  to  -v.  It outputs information about each transfer and prints stats
       once a minute by default.

       NOTICE is the default log level if no logging flags are supplied.  It outputs very  little
       when things are working normally.  It outputs warnings and significant events.

       ERROR is equivalent to -q.  It only outputs error messages.

   –use-json-log
       This  switches  the log format to JSON for rclone.  The fields of json log are level, msg,
       source, time.

   –low-level-retries NUMBER
       This controls the number of low level retries rclone does.

       A low level retry is used to retry a failing operation - typically one HTTP request.  This
       might  be  uploading a chunk of a big file for example.  You will see low level retries in
       the log with the -v flag.

       This shouldn’t need to be changed from the default in normal operations.  However, if  you
       get  a  lot  of low level retries you may wish to reduce the value so rclone moves on to a
       high level retry (see the --retries flag) quicker.

       Disable low level retries with --low-level-retries 1.

   –max-backlog=N
       This is the maximum allowable backlog of  files  in  a  sync/copy/move  queued  for  being
       checked or transferred.

       This  can  be  set  arbitrarily  large.  It will only use memory when the queue is in use.
       Note that it will use in the order of N KiB of memory when the backlog is in use.

       Setting this large allows rclone to calculate how many files are pending more  accurately,
       give a more accurate estimated finish time and make --order-by work more accurately.

       Setting  this  small will make rclone more synchronous to the listings of the remote which
       may be desirable.

       Setting this to a negative number will make the backlog as large as possible.

   –max-delete=N
       This tells rclone not to delete more than N files.  If that limit is exceeded then a fatal
       error will be generated and rclone will stop the operation in progress.

   –max-depth=N
       This modifies the recursion depth for all the commands except purge.

       So  if  you  do rclone --max-depth 1 ls remote:path you will see only the files in the top
       level directory.  Using --max-depth 2 means you will  see  all  the  files  in  first  two
       directory levels and so on.

       For  historical  reasons  the  lsd  command defaults to using a --max-depth of 1 - you can
       override this with the command line flag.

       You can use this command to disable recursion (with --max-depth 1).

       Note that if you use this with sync and --delete-excluded the files not  recursed  through
       are considered excluded and will be deleted on the destination.  Test first with --dry-run
       if you are not sure what will happen.

   –max-duration=TIME
       Rclone will stop scheduling new transfers when it has run for the duration specified.

       Defaults to off.

       When the limit is reached any existing transfers will complete.

       Rclone won’t exit with an error if the transfer limit is reached.

   –max-transfer=SIZE
       Rclone will stop transferring when it has reached the size specified.  Defaults to off.

       When the limit is reached all transfers will stop immediately.

       Rclone will exit with exit code 8 if the transfer limit is reached.

   –metadata / -M
       Setting this flag enables rclone to copy the metadata from the source to the  destination.
       For  local backends this is ownership, permissions, xattr etc.  See the #metadata for more
       info.

   –metadata-set key=value
       Add metadata key = value when uploading.  This can be repeated as many times as  required.
       See the #metadata for more info.

   –cutoff-mode=hard|soft|cautious
       This modifies the behavior of --max-transfer Defaults to --cutoff-mode=hard.

       Specifying  --cutoff-mode=hard  will stop transferring immediately when Rclone reaches the
       limit.

       Specifying --cutoff-mode=soft will stop starting new transfers  when  Rclone  reaches  the
       limit.

       Specifying --cutoff-mode=cautious will try to prevent Rclone from reaching the limit.

   –modify-window=TIME
       When  checking  whether  a  file  has  been  modified,  this  is  the maximum allowed time
       difference that a file can have and still be considered equivalent.

       The default is 1ns unless this is overridden by a remote.  For example OS  X  only  stores
       modification  times  to  the  nearest  second so if you are reading and writing to an OS X
       filing system this will be 1s by default.

       This command line flag allows you to override that computed default.

   –multi-thread-cutoff=SIZE
       When downloading files to the local backend above this  size,  rclone  will  use  multiple
       threads to download the file (default 250M).

       Rclone   preallocates   the   file   (using   fallocate(FALLOC_FL_KEEP_SIZE)  on  unix  or
       NTSetInformationFile on Windows both of which takes  no  time)  then  each  thread  writes
       directly  into  the  file  at  the  correct  place.   This  means that rclone won’t create
       fragmented or sparse files and there won’t  be  any  assembly  time  at  the  end  of  the
       transfer.

       The number of threads used to download is controlled by --multi-thread-streams.

       Use -vv if you wish to see info about the threads.

       This  will  work with the sync/copy/move commands and friends copyto/moveto.  Multi thread
       downloads will be used with rclone mount and rclone serve if --vfs-cache-mode  is  set  to
       writes or above.

       NB that this only works for a local destination but will work with any source.

       NB  that  multi  thread  copies  are disabled for local to local copies as they are faster
       without unless --multi-thread-streams is set explicitly.

       NB on Windows using multi-thread downloads will cause the resulting  files  to  be  sparse
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sparse_file).   Use  --local-no-sparse  to  disable  sparse
       files (which may cause long delays at the start  of  downloads)  or  disable  multi-thread
       downloads with --multi-thread-streams 0

   –multi-thread-streams=N
       When  using multi thread downloads (see above --multi-thread-cutoff) this sets the maximum
       number of streams to use.  Set to 0 to disable multi thread downloads (Default 4).

       Exactly how many streams rclone uses for the download depends on the size of the file.  To
       calculate  the  number  of  download  streams  Rclone  divides the size of the file by the
       --multi-thread-cutoff and rounds up, up to the maximum set with --multi-thread-streams.

       So  if  --multi-thread-cutoff  250M  and  --multi-thread-streams  4  are  in  effect  (the
       defaults):

       • 0..250 MiB files will be downloaded with 1 stream

       • 250..500 MiB files will be downloaded with 2 streams

       • 500..750 MiB files will be downloaded with 3 streams

       • 750+ MiB files will be downloaded with 4 streams

   –no-check-dest
       The  --no-check-dest  can  be used with move or copy and it causes rclone not to check the
       destination at all when copying files.

       This means that:

       • the destination is not listed minimising the API calls

       • files are always transferred

       • this can cause duplicates on remotes which allow it (e.g. Google Drive)

       • --retries 1 is recommended otherwise you’ll transfer everything again on a retry

       This flag is useful to minimise the transactions if you know that none of the files are on
       the destination.

       This is a specialized flag which should be ignored by most users!

   –no-gzip-encoding
       Don’t  set  Accept-Encoding:  gzip.   This  means  that  rclone  won’t  ask the server for
       compressed files automatically.  Useful if you’ve set the  server  to  return  files  with
       Content-Encoding: gzip but you uploaded compressed files.

       There  is  no need to set this in normal operation, and doing so will decrease the network
       transfer efficiency of rclone.

   –no-traverse
       The --no-traverse flag controls whether the destination  file  system  is  traversed  when
       using  the  copy  or move commands.  --no-traverse is not compatible with sync and will be
       ignored if you supply it with sync.

       If you are only copying a small number of files (or  are  filtering  most  of  the  files)
       and/or have a large number of files on the destination then --no-traverse will stop rclone
       listing the destination and save time.

       However, if you are copying a large number of files, especially if you are  doing  a  copy
       where  lots  of  the files under consideration haven’t changed and won’t need copying then
       you shouldn’t use --no-traverse.

       See rclone copy (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) for an example of  how  to  use
       it.

   –no-unicode-normalization
       Don’t normalize unicode characters in filenames during the sync routine.

       Sometimes,  an  operating  system  will  store filenames containing unicode parts in their
       decomposed form (particularly macOS).  Some cloud storage systems will then recompose  the
       unicode,  resulting  in  duplicate  files  if  the  data  is  ever  copied back to a local
       filesystem.

       Using this flag will disable  that  functionality,  treating  each  unicode  character  as
       unique.   For  example,  by  default  é and é will be normalized into the same character.
       With --no-unicode-normalization they will be treated as unique characters.

   –no-update-modtime
       When using this flag, rclone won’t update modification times of remote files if  they  are
       incorrect as it would normally.

       This  can  be  used  if the remote is being synced with another tool also (e.g. the Google
       Drive client).

   –order-by string
       The --order-by flag controls the order in which files in  the  backlog  are  processed  in
       rclone sync, rclone copy and rclone move.

       The  order  by  string  is constructed like this.  The first part describes what aspect is
       being measured:

       • size - order by the size of the files

       • name - order by the full path of the files

       • modtime - order by the modification date of the files

       This can have a modifier appended with a comma:

       • ascending or asc - order so that the smallest (or oldest) is processed first

       • descending or desc - order so that the largest (or newest) is processed first

       • mixed - order so that the smallest is processed first for some threads and  the  largest
         for others

       If  the  modifier is mixed then it can have an optional percentage (which defaults to 50),
       e.g. size,mixed,25 which means that 25% of the threads should be taking the smallest items
       and  75%  the  largest.   The  threads  which take the smallest first will always take the
       smallest first and likewise the largest first threads.  The mixed mode can  be  useful  to
       minimise  the transfer time when you are transferring a mixture of large and small files -
       the large files are guaranteed upload threads and bandwidth and the small  files  will  be
       processed continuously.

       If no modifier is supplied then the order is ascending.

       For example

       • --order-by size,desc - send the largest files first

       • --order-by modtime,ascending - send the oldest files first

       • --order-by name - send the files with alphabetically by path first

       If  the  --order-by  flag  is not supplied or it is supplied with an empty string then the
       default ordering will be used which is as scanned.   With  --checkers  1  this  is  mostly
       alphabetical, however with the default --checkers 8 it is somewhat random.

   Limitations
       The  --order-by  flag  does  not do a separate pass over the data.  This means that it may
       transfer some files out of the order specified if

       • there are no files in the backlog or the source has not been fully scanned yet

       • there are more than –max-backlog files in the backlog

       Rclone will do its best to transfer the best file it has so in practice  this  should  not
       cause  a  problem.  Think of --order-by as being more of a best efforts flag rather than a
       perfect ordering.

       If you want perfect ordering then you will need to specify –check-first  which  will  find
       all the files which need transferring first before transferring any.

   –password-command SpaceSepList
       This flag supplies a program which should supply the config password when run.  This is an
       alternative to rclone  prompting  for  the  password  or  setting  the  RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS
       variable.

       The argument to this should be a command with a space separated list of arguments.  If one
       of the arguments has a space in then enclose it in ", if  you  want  a  literal  "  in  an
       argument   then   enclose  the  argument  in  "  and  double  the  ".   See  CSV  encoding
       (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) for more info.

       Eg

              --password-command echo hello
              --password-command echo "hello with space"
              --password-command echo "hello with ""quotes"" and space"

       See the Configuration Encryption for more info.

       See       a       Windows       PowerShell        example        on        the        Wiki
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/wiki/Windows-Powershell-use-rclone-password-command-for-
       Config-file-password).

   -P, –progress
       This flag makes rclone update the stats in a static block  in  the  terminal  providing  a
       realtime overview of the transfer.

       Any  log  messages  will scroll above the static block.  Log messages will push the static
       block down to the bottom of the terminal where it will stay.

       Normally this is updated every 500mS but this period can be overridden  with  the  --stats
       flag.

       This can be used with the --stats-one-line flag for a simpler display.

       Note:  On Windows until this bug (https://github.com/Azure/go-ansiterm/issues/26) is fixed
       all non-ASCII characters will be replaced with . when --progress is in use.

   –progress-terminal-title
       This flag, when used with -P/--progress, will print the string ETA:  %s  to  the  terminal
       title.

   -q, –quiet
       This flag will limit rclone’s output to error messages only.

   –refresh-times
       The  --refresh-times  flag can be used to update modification times of existing files when
       they are out of sync on backends which don’t support hashes.

       This is useful if you uploaded files with the incorrect timestamps and  you  now  wish  to
       correct them.

       This flag is only useful for destinations which don’t support hashes (e.g. crypt).

       This can be used any of the sync commands sync, copy or move.

       To  use this flag you will need to be doing a modification time sync (so not using --size-
       only or --checksum).  The flag will have no effect when using --size-only or --checksum.

       If this flag is used when rclone comes to upload a file it will check to see if  there  is
       an  existing  file  on  the  destination.   If this file matches the source with size (and
       checksum if available) but has a differing timestamp  then  instead  of  re-uploading  it,
       rclone  will update the timestamp on the destination file.  If the checksum does not match
       rclone will upload the new file.  If the checksum is absent (e.g.   on  a  crypt  backend)
       then rclone will update the timestamp.

       Note  that  some  remotes can’t set the modification time without re-uploading the file so
       this flag is less useful on them.

       Normally if you are doing a modification time sync rclone will update  modification  times
       without  --refresh-times  provided  that  the  remote supports checksums and the checksums
       match on the file.  However if the checksums are absent then rclone will upload  the  file
       rather than setting the timestamp as this is the safe behaviour.

   –retries int
       Retry the entire sync if it fails this many times it fails (default 3).

       Some  remotes  can be unreliable and a few retries help pick up the files which didn’t get
       transferred because of errors.

       Disable retries with --retries 1.

   –retries-sleep=TIME
       This sets the interval between each retry specified by --retries

       The default is 0.  Use 0 to disable.

   –server-side-across-configs
       Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy or move) to work across different configurations.

       This can be useful if you wish to do a server-side copy or move between two remotes  which
       use the same backend but are configured differently.

       Note  that  this  isn’t  enabled by default because it isn’t easy for rclone to tell if it
       will work between any two configurations.

   –size-only
       Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to see if they are equal.
       If you set this flag then rclone will check only the size.

       This can be useful transferring files from Dropbox which have been modified by the desktop
       sync client which doesn’t set checksums of modification times in the same way as rclone.

   –stats=TIME
       Commands which transfer data (sync, copy, copyto, move, moveto) will print  data  transfer
       stats at regular intervals to show their progress.

       This sets the interval.

       The default is 1m.  Use 0 to disable.

       If  you  set the stats interval then all commands can show stats.  This can be useful when
       running other commands, check or mount for example.

       Stats are logged at INFO level by default which means they won’t show at default log level
       NOTICE.   Use  --stats-log-level  NOTICE or -v to make them show.  See the Logging section
       for more info on log levels.

       Note that on macOS you can send a SIGINFO (which is normally ctrl-T in  the  terminal)  to
       make the stats print immediately.

   –stats-file-name-length integer
       By  default,  the  --stats  output  will  truncate  file  names  and  paths longer than 40
       characters.  This is equivalent to providing --stats-file-name-length  40.   Use  --stats-
       file-name-length 0 to disable any truncation of file names printed by stats.

   –stats-log-level string
       Log  level  to  show  --stats  output at.  This can be DEBUG, INFO, NOTICE, or ERROR.  The
       default is INFO.  This means at the default level of logging which  is  NOTICE  the  stats
       won’t  show  -  if  you  want  them to then use --stats-log-level NOTICE.  See the Logging
       section for more info on log levels.

   –stats-one-line
       When this is specified, rclone condenses the stats into a single  line  showing  the  most
       important stats only.

   –stats-one-line-date
       When this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends the display with
       a date string.  The default is 2006/01/02 15:04:05 -

   –stats-one-line-date-format
       When this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends the display with
       a  user-supplied  date string.  The date string MUST be enclosed in quotes.  Follow golang
       specs (https://golang.org/pkg/time/#Time.Format) for date formatting syntax.

   –stats-unit=bits|bytes
       By default, data transfer rates will be printed in bytes per second.

       This option allows the data rate to be printed in bits per second.

       Data transfer volume will still be reported in bytes.

       The rate is reported as a binary unit, not SI unit.  So 1 Mbit/s  equals  1,048,576  bit/s
       and not 1,000,000 bit/s.

       The default is bytes.

   –suffix=SUFFIX
       When  using sync, copy or move any files which would have been overwritten or deleted will
       have the suffix added to them.  If there is a file with the same path  (after  the  suffix
       has been added), then it will be overwritten.

       The  remote  in use must support server-side move or copy and you must use the same remote
       as the destination of the sync.

       This is for use with files to add the suffix in the current directory  or  with  --backup-
       dir.  See --backup-dir for more info.

       For example

              rclone copy -i /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak

       will  copy  /path/to/local  to  remote:current,  but  for  any files which would have been
       updated or deleted have .bak added.

       If using rclone sync with --suffix and without --backup-dir then it is recommended to  put
       a filter rule in excluding the suffix otherwise the sync will delete the backup files.

              rclone sync -i /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak --exclude "*.bak"

   –suffix-keep-extension
       When using --suffix, setting this causes rclone put the SUFFIX before the extension of the
       files that it backs up rather than after.

       So let’s say we had --suffix -2019-01-01, without the flag file.txt would be backed up  to
       file.txt-2019-01-01  and with the flag it would be backed up to file-2019-01-01.txt.  This
       can be helpful to make sure the suffixed files can still be opened.

   –syslog
       On capable OSes (not Windows or Plan9) send all log output to syslog.

       This can be useful for running rclone in a script or rclone mount.

   –syslog-facility string
       If using --syslog this sets the syslog facility (e.g. KERN, USER).  See man syslog  for  a
       list of possible facilities.  The default facility is DAEMON.

   –temp-dir=DIR
       Specify  the directory rclone will use for temporary files, to override the default.  Make
       sure the directory exists and have accessible permissions.

       By default the operating system’s temp directory will be used: - On Unix systems,  $TMPDIR
       if  non-empty,  else  /tmp.   -  On Windows, the first non-empty value from %TMP%, %TEMP%,
       %USERPROFILE%, or the Windows directory.

       When overriding the default with this option, the specified path will be set as  value  of
       environment variable TMPDIR on Unix systems and TMP and TEMP on Windows.

       You can use the config paths (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_paths/) command to
       see the current value.

   –tpslimit float
       Limit transactions per second to this  number.   Default  is  0  which  is  used  to  mean
       unlimited transactions per second.

       A  transaction  is  roughly  defined  as an API call; its exact meaning will depend on the
       backend.  For HTTP based backends it is an HTTP PUT/GET/POST/etc and  its  response.   For
       FTP/SFTP it is a round trip transaction over TCP.

       For  example,  to  limit  rclone  to 10 transactions per second use --tpslimit 10, or to 1
       transaction every 2 seconds use --tpslimit 0.5.

       Use this when the number of transactions per second from rclone is causing a problem  with
       the cloud storage provider (e.g. getting you banned or rate limited).

       This  can  be  very useful for rclone mount to control the behaviour of applications using
       it.

       This limit applies to all HTTP based backends and to the FTP and SFTP backends.   It  does
       not apply to the local backend or the Storj backend.

       See also --tpslimit-burst.

   –tpslimit-burst int
       Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit (default 1).

       Normally  --tpslimit  will  do  exactly  the  number  of transaction per second specified.
       However if you supply --tps-burst then rclone can save up some transactions from  when  it
       was idle giving a burst of up to the parameter supplied.

       For  example if you provide --tpslimit-burst 10 then if rclone has been idle for more than
       10*--tpslimit then it can do 10 transactions very quickly before they are limited again.

       This may be used to increase performance of --tpslimit  without  changing  the  long  term
       average number of transactions per second.

   –track-renames
       By  default,  rclone  doesn’t keep track of renamed files, so if you rename a file locally
       then sync it to a remote, rclone will delete the old file on the remote and upload  a  new
       copy.

       An  rclone  sync  with --track-renames runs like a normal sync, but keeps track of objects
       which exist in the destination but not in the source (which would  normally  be  deleted),
       and  which  objects  exist  in the source but not the destination (which would normally be
       transferred).  These objects are then candidates for renaming.

       After the sync, rclone matches up the source only and destination only objects  using  the
       --track-renames-strategy  specified and either renames the destination object or transfers
       the source and deletes the destination object.  --track-renames is stateless like  all  of
       rclone’s syncs.

       To use this flag the destination must support server-side copy or server-side move, and to
       use a hash based --track-renames-strategy (the default) the  source  and  the  destination
       must have a compatible hash.

       If the destination does not support server-side copy or move, rclone will fall back to the
       default behaviour and log an error level message to the console.

       Encrypted destinations are not currently supported by --track-renames if  --track-renames-
       strategy includes hash.

       Note that --track-renames is incompatible with --no-traverse and that it uses extra memory
       to keep track of all the rename candidates.

       Note also that --track-renames  is  incompatible  with  --delete-before  and  will  select
       --delete-after instead of --delete-during.

   –track-renames-strategy (hash,modtime,leaf,size)
       This option changes the file matching criteria for --track-renames.

       The matching is controlled by a comma separated selection of these tokens:

       • modtime - the modification time of the file - not supported on all backends

       • hash - the hash of the file contents - not supported on all backends

       • leaf - the name of the file not including its directory name

       • size - the size of the file (this is always enabled)

       The default option is hash.

       Using  --track-renames-strategy modtime,leaf would match files based on modification time,
       the leaf of the file name and the size only.

       Using --track-renames-strategy modtime or leaf  can  enable  --track-renames  support  for
       encrypted destinations.

       Note that the hash strategy is not supported with encrypted destinations.

   –delete-(before,during,after)
       This option allows you to specify when files on your destination are deleted when you sync
       folders.

       Specifying the value --delete-before will delete all files present on the destination, but
       not on the source before starting the transfer of any new or updated files.  This uses two
       passes through the file systems, one for the deletions and one for the copies.

       Specifying --delete-during will delete files while checking and uploading files.  This  is
       the fastest option and uses the least memory.

       Specifying  --delete-after  (the  default  value)  will  delay deletion of files until all
       new/updated files have been  successfully  transferred.   The  files  to  be  deleted  are
       collected  in  the  copy pass then deleted after the copy pass has completed successfully.
       The files to be deleted are held in memory so this mode may use more memory.  This is  the
       safest  mode as it will only delete files if there have been no errors subsequent to that.
       If there have been errors before the deletions start then you will  get  the  message  not
       deleting files as there were IO errors.

   –fast-list
       When  doing  anything  which  involves  a directory listing (e.g. sync, copy, ls - in fact
       nearly every command), rclone normally lists a directory and  processes  it  before  using
       more  directory  lists  to process any subdirectories.  This can be parallelised and works
       very quickly using the least amount of memory.

       However, some remotes have a way of listing all files beneath a directory  in  one  (or  a
       small  number)  of  transactions.  These tend to be the bucket-based remotes (e.g. S3, B2,
       GCS, Swift).

       If you use the --fast-list flag then rclone will use this method for listing  directories.
       This will have the following consequences for the listing:

       • It will use fewer transactions (important if you pay for them)

       • It will use more memory.  Rclone has to load the whole listing into memory.

       • It may be faster because it uses fewer transactions

       • It may be slower because it can’t be parallelized

       rclone should always give identical results with and without --fast-list.

       If  you pay for transactions and can fit your entire sync listing into memory then --fast-
       list is recommended.  If you have a very  big  sync  to  do  then  don’t  use  --fast-list
       otherwise you will run out of memory.

       If  you use --fast-list on a remote which doesn’t support it, then rclone will just ignore
       it.

   –timeout=TIME
       This sets the IO idle timeout.  If a transfer has started but then becomes idle  for  this
       long it is considered broken and disconnected.

       The default is 5m.  Set to 0 to disable.

   –transfers=N
       The  number  of file transfers to run in parallel.  It can sometimes be useful to set this
       to a smaller number if the remote is giving a lot of timeouts or bigger if you  have  lots
       of bandwidth and a fast remote.

       The default is to run 4 file transfers in parallel.

       Look at –multi-thread-streams if you would like to control single file transfers.

   -u, –update
       This  forces  rclone  to skip any files which exist on the destination and have a modified
       time that is newer than the source file.

       This can be useful in avoiding needless transfers when  transferring  to  a  remote  which
       doesn’t  support  modification times directly (or when using --use-server-modtime to avoid
       extra API calls) as it is more accurate than a --size-only check  and  faster  than  using
       --checksum.  On such remotes (or when using --use-server-modtime) the time checked will be
       the uploaded time.

       If an existing destination file has a modification time older than the source  file’s,  it
       will be updated if the sizes are different.  If the sizes are the same, it will be updated
       if the checksum is different or not available.

       If an existing destination file has a modification time equal (within the computed  modify
       window) to the source file’s, it will be updated if the sizes are different.  The checksum
       will not be checked in this case unless the --checksum flag is provided.

       In all other cases the file will not be updated.

       Consider using the --modify-window flag to compensate for time skews  between  the  source
       and  the  backend,  for  backends  that do not support mod times, and instead use uploaded
       times.  However, if the backend does not support checksums, note that syncing  or  copying
       within the time skew window may still result in additional transfers for safety.

   –use-mmap
       If  this flag is set then rclone will use anonymous memory allocated by mmap on Unix based
       platforms and VirtualAlloc on  Windows  for  its  transfer  buffers  (size  controlled  by
       --buffer-size).  Memory allocated like this does not go on the Go heap and can be returned
       to the OS immediately when it is finished with.

       If this flag is not set then rclone will allocate and free the buffers using the Go memory
       allocator  which may use more memory as memory pages are returned less aggressively to the
       OS.

       It is possible this does not work well on all platforms so it is disabled by  default;  in
       the future it may be enabled by default.

   –use-server-modtime
       Some  object-store  backends  (e.g,  Swift,  S3)  do  not preserve file modification times
       (modtime).  On these backends, rclone stores the original modtime as  additional  metadata
       on  the  object.   By  default  it will make an API call to retrieve the metadata when the
       modtime is needed by an operation.

       Use this flag to disable the extra API call and rely  instead  on  the  server’s  modified
       time.   In  cases such as a local to remote sync using --update, knowing the local file is
       newer than the time it was last uploaded to the remote is  sufficient.   In  those  cases,
       this flag can speed up the process and reduce the number of API calls necessary.

       Using  this  flag  on  a  sync operation without also using --update would cause all files
       modified at any time other than the last upload  time  to  be  uploaded  again,  which  is
       probably not what you want.

   -v, -vv, –verbose
       With  -v  rclone  will  tell you about each file that is transferred and a small number of
       significant events.

       With -vv rclone will become very verbose telling you about every  file  it  considers  and
       transfers.  Please send bug reports with a log with this setting.

       When   setting   verbosity   as   an   environment   variable,   use  RCLONE_VERBOSE=1  or
       RCLONE_VERBOSE=2 for -v and -vv respectively.

   -V, –version
       Prints the version number

   SSL/TLS options
       The outgoing SSL/TLS connections rclone makes can be controlled with these  options.   For
       example  this  can  be  very useful with the HTTP or WebDAV backends.  Rclone HTTP servers
       have their own set of configuration for SSL/TLS which you can find in their documentation.

   –ca-cert string
       This loads the PEM encoded certificate authority certificate and uses  it  to  verify  the
       certificates of the servers rclone connects to.

       If  you have generated certificates signed with a local CA then you will need this flag to
       connect to servers using those certificates.

   –client-cert string
       This loads the PEM encoded client side certificate.

       This         is         used         for         mutual         TLS         authentication
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mutual_authentication).

       The --client-key flag is required too when using this.

   –client-key string
       This  loads  the  PEM  encoded client side private key used for mutual TLS authentication.
       Used in conjunction with --client-cert.

   –no-check-certificate=true/false
       --no-check-certificate controls whether a client verifies the server’s  certificate  chain
       and  host  name.  If --no-check-certificate is true, TLS accepts any certificate presented
       by the server and any host name in that certificate.  In this mode, TLS is susceptible  to
       man-in-the-middle attacks.

       This option defaults to false.

       This should be used only for testing.

   Configuration Encryption
       Your  configuration file contains information for logging in to your cloud services.  This
       means that you should keep your rclone.conf file in a secure location.

       If you are in an environment where that isn’t possible, you can add  a  password  to  your
       configuration.   This means that you will have to supply the password every time you start
       rclone.

       To add a password to your rclone configuration, execute rclone config.

              >rclone config
              Current remotes:

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/s/q>

       Go into s, Set configuration password:

              e/n/d/s/q> s
              Your configuration is not encrypted.
              If you add a password, you will protect your login information to cloud services.
              a) Add Password
              q) Quit to main menu
              a/q> a
              Enter NEW configuration password:
              password:
              Confirm NEW password:
              password:
              Password set
              Your configuration is encrypted.
              c) Change Password
              u) Unencrypt configuration
              q) Quit to main menu
              c/u/q>

       Your configuration is now encrypted, and every time you start  rclone  you  will  have  to
       supply  the  password.   See  below  for  details.   In  the same menu, you can change the
       password or completely remove encryption from your configuration.

       There is no way to recover the configuration if you lose your password.

       rclone uses nacl secretbox (https://godoc.org/golang.org/x/crypto/nacl/secretbox) which in
       turn  uses  XSalsa20  and  Poly1305  to  encrypt  and authenticate your configuration with
       secret-key cryptography.  The password is SHA-256  hashed,  which  produces  the  key  for
       secretbox.  The hashed password is not stored.

       While  this provides very good security, we do not recommend storing your encrypted rclone
       configuration in public if it contains sensitive information, maybe except if  you  use  a
       very strong password.

       If it is safe in your environment, you can set the RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS environment variable
       to contain your password, in which case it will be used for decrypting the configuration.

       You can set this for a session from a script.  For unix like systems save this to  a  file
       called set-rclone-password:

              #!/bin/echo Source this file don't run it

              read -s RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS
              export RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS

       Then  source  the  file  when you want to use it.  From the shell you would do source set-
       rclone-password.  It will then ask you for the password and  set  it  in  the  environment
       variable.

       An  alternate  means  of supplying the password is to provide a script which will retrieve
       the password and print on standard output.  This script should have a fully specified path
       name  and  not  rely  on  any  environment  variables.   The script is supplied either via
       --password-command="..."  command  line  argument  or  via   the   RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND
       environment variable.

       One  useful  example  of  this  is  using  the  passwordstore  application to retrieve the
       password:

              export RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND="pass rclone/config"

       If the passwordstore password manager holds the password  for  the  rclone  configuration,
       using  the  script  method  means the password is primarily protected by the passwordstore
       system, and is never embedded in the clear in scripts, nor available for examination using
       the  standard  commands available.  It is quite possible with long running rclone sessions
       for copies of passwords to be innocently captured in log files or terminal scroll buffers,
       etc.   Using  the  script  method  of  supplying the password enhances the security of the
       config password considerably.

       If you are running rclone inside a script, unless you  are  using  the  --password-command
       method, you might want to disable password prompts.  To do that, pass the parameter --ask-
       password=false to rclone.  This will make rclone fail instead of asking for a password  if
       RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS  doesn’t  contain a valid password, and --password-command has not been
       supplied.

       Whenever running commands that may be affected by options in a configuration file,  rclone
       will  look  for  an  existing file according to the rules described above, and load any it
       finds.  If an encrypted file is found, this includes  decrypting  it,  with  the  possible
       consequence  of  a  password  prompt.  When executing a command line that you know are not
       actually using anything from such a configuration file, you can avoid it being  loaded  by
       overriding  the  location,  e.g. with one of the documented special values for memory-only
       configuration.  Since only backend options can be stored in configuration files,  this  is
       normally  unnecessary  for commands that do not operate on backends, e.g. genautocomplete.
       However, it will be relevant for commands that do operate on backends in general, but  are
       used  without  referencing  a  stored  remote,  e.g.   listing  local filesystem paths, or
       connection strings: rclone --config="" ls .

   Developer options
       These options are useful when developing or debugging rclone.  There are  also  some  more
       remote  specific  options  which aren’t documented here which are used for testing.  These
       start with remote name e.g.   --drive-test-option  -  see  the  docs  for  the  remote  in
       question.

   –cpuprofile=FILE
       Write CPU profile to file.  This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

   –dump flag,flag,flag
       The --dump flag takes a comma separated list of flags to dump info about.

       Note  that  some  headers  including  Accept-Encoding  as  shown may not be correct in the
       request and the response may not show Content-Encoding if the go standard  libraries  auto
       gzip  encoding  was  in  effect.   In  this case the body of the request will be gunzipped
       before showing it.

       The available flags are:

   –dump headers
       Dump HTTP headers with Authorization: lines removed.  May still  contain  sensitive  info.
       Can be very verbose.  Useful for debugging only.

       Use --dump auth if you do want the Authorization: headers.

   –dump bodies
       Dump  HTTP  headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info.  Can be very verbose.  Useful
       for debugging only.

       Note that the bodies are buffered in memory so don’t use this for enormous files.

   –dump requests
       Like --dump bodies but dumps the request bodies and  the  response  headers.   Useful  for
       debugging download problems.

   –dump responses
       Like  --dump  bodies  but  dumps  the response bodies and the request headers.  Useful for
       debugging upload problems.

   –dump auth
       Dump HTTP headers - will contain sensitive info  such  as  Authorization:  headers  -  use
       --dump  headers  to dump without Authorization: headers.  Can be very verbose.  Useful for
       debugging only.

   –dump filters
       Dump the filters to the output.  Useful to see exactly what include  and  exclude  options
       are filtering on.

   –dump goroutines
       This dumps a list of the running go-routines at the end of the command to standard output.

   –dump openfiles
       This  dumps  a list of the open files at the end of the command.  It uses the lsof command
       to do that so you’ll need that installed to use it.

   –memprofile=FILE
       Write memory profile to file.  This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

   Filtering
       For the filtering options

       • --delete-excluded--filter--filter-from--exclude--exclude-from--exclude-if-present--include--include-from--files-from--files-from-raw--min-size--max-size--min-age--max-age--dump filters

       See the filtering section (https://rclone.org/filtering/).

   Remote control
       For the remote control options and for instructions on how to remote control rclone

       • --rc


       • and anything starting with --rc-
       See the remote control section (https://rclone.org/rc/).

   Logging
       rclone has 4 levels of logging, ERROR, NOTICE, INFO and DEBUG.

       By default, rclone logs to standard error.  This means you can redirect standard error and
       still see the normal output of rclone commands (e.g.  rclone ls).

       By default, rclone will produce Error and Notice level messages.

       If you use the -q flag, rclone will only produce Error messages.

       If you use the -v flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice and Info messages.

       If you use the -vv flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice, Info and Debug messages.

       You can also control the log levels with the --log-level flag.

       If you use the --log-file=FILE option, rclone will redirect Error, Info and Debug messages
       along with standard error to FILE.

       If you use the --syslog flag then rclone will log  to  syslog  and  the  --syslog-facility
       control which facility it uses.

       Rclone  prefixes  all  log messages with their level in capitals, e.g. INFO which makes it
       easy to grep the log file for different kinds of information.

   Exit Code
       If any errors occur during the command execution, rclone will exit with  a  non-zero  exit
       code.  This allows scripts to detect when rclone operations have failed.

       During  the  startup  phase,  rclone  will exit immediately if an error is detected in the
       configuration.  There will always be a log message immediately before exiting.

       When rclone is running it will accumulate errors as it goes along, and only  exit  with  a
       non-zero  exit code if (after retries) there were still failed transfers.  For every error
       counted there will be a high priority log message (visible with -q)  showing  the  message
       and  which file caused the problem.  A high priority message is also shown when starting a
       retry so the user can see that any previous error messages may  not  be  valid  after  the
       retry.   If  rclone  has done a retry it will log a high priority message if the retry was
       successful.

   List of exit codes0 - success

       • 1 - Syntax or usage error

       • 2 - Error not otherwise categorised

       • 3 - Directory not found

       • 4 - File not found

       • 5 - Temporary error (one that more retries might fix) (Retry errors)

       • 6 - Less serious errors (like 461 errors from dropbox) (NoRetry errors)

       • 7 - Fatal error (one that more retries won’t fix, like account suspended) (Fatal errors)

       • 8 - Transfer exceeded - limit set by –max-transfer reached

       • 9 - Operation successful, but no files transferred

   Environment Variables
       Rclone can be configured entirely using environment variables.  These can be used  to  set
       defaults for options or config file entries.

   Options
       Every option in rclone can have its default set by environment variable.

       To  find the name of the environment variable, first, take the long option name, strip the
       leading --, change - to _, make upper case and prepend RCLONE_.

       For example, to always set --stats 5s, set the environment variable  RCLONE_STATS=5s.   If
       you set stats on the command line this will override the environment variable setting.

       Or to always use the trash in drive --drive-use-trash, set RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH=true.

       Verbosity is slightly different, the environment variable equivalent of --verbose or -v is
       RCLONE_VERBOSE=1, or for -vv, RCLONE_VERBOSE=2.

       The same parser is used for the options and the environment variables so they take exactly
       the same form.

       The  options  set  by  environment  variables  can  be seen with the -vv flag, e.g. rclone
       version -vv.

   Config file
       You can set defaults for values in the config file on an  individual  remote  basis.   The
       names of the config items are documented in the page for each backend.

       To  find the name of the environment variable, you need to set, take RCLONE_CONFIG_ + name
       of remote + _ + name of config file option and make it all uppercase.

       For example, to configure an S3 remote named mys3: without a config file (using unix  ways
       of setting environment variables):

              $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_TYPE=s3
              $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_ACCESS_KEY_ID=XXX
              $ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY=XXX
              $ rclone lsd mys3:
                        -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket
              $ rclone listremotes | grep mys3
              mys3:

       Note  that  if you want to create a remote using environment variables you must create the
       ..._TYPE variable as above.

       Note that the name of a remote created using environment variable is case insensitive,  in
       contrast to regular remotes stored in config file as documented above.  You must write the
       name in uppercase in the environment variable, but as seen from example above it  will  be
       listed  and  can  be accessed in lowercase, while you can also refer to the same remote in
       uppercase:

              $ rclone lsd mys3:
                        -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket
              $ rclone lsd MYS3:
                        -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket

       Note  that   you   can   only   set   the   options   of   the   immediate   backend,   so
       RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3CRYPT_ACCESS_KEY_ID  has no effect, if myS3Crypt is a crypt remote based
       on an S3 remote.  However RCLONE_S3_ACCESS_KEY_ID will set the access key of  all  remotes
       using S3, including myS3Crypt.

       Note  also  that  now  rclone  has  connection strings, it is probably easier to use those
       instead which makes the above example

              rclone lsd :s3,access_key_id=XXX,secret_access_key=XXX:

   Precedence
       The various different methods of backend configuration are read  in  this  order  and  the
       first one with a value is used.

       • Parameters in connection strings, e.g. myRemote,skip_links:

       • Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g. --skip-links

       • Remote specific environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_SKIP_LINKS (see above).

       • Backend-specific environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS.

       • Backend generic environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_SKIP_LINKS.

       • Config file, e.g. skip_links = true.

       • Default values, e.g. false - these can’t be changed.

       So  if  both  --skip-links  is  supplied  on  the command line and an environment variable
       RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS is set, the command line flag will take preference.

       The backend configurations set by environment variables can be seen  with  the  -vv  flag,
       e.g. rclone about myRemote: -vv.

       For non backend configuration the order is as follows:

       • Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g. --stats 5s.

       • Environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_STATS=5s.

       • Default values, e.g. 1m - these can’t be changed.

   Other environment variablesRCLONE_CONFIG_PASS   set  to  contain  your  config  file  password  (see  Configuration
         Encryption section)

       • HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY and NO_PROXY (or the lowercase versions thereof).

         • HTTPS_PROXY takes precedence over HTTP_PROXY for https requests.

         • The environment values may be either a complete URL or a “host[:port]” for,  in  which
           case the “http” scheme is assumed.

       • USER  and LOGNAME values are used as fallbacks for current username.  The primary method
         for looking up username is  OS-specific:  Windows  API  on  Windows,  real  user  ID  in
         /etc/passwd  on  Unix  systems.   In  the  documentation  the current username is simply
         referred to as $USER.

       • RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR - rclone sets this variable for use in config files and sub  processes
         to point to the directory holding the config file.

       The  options  set  by environment variables can be seen with the -vv and --log-level=DEBUG
       flags, e.g. rclone version -vv.

Configuring rclone on a remote / headless machine

       Some of the configurations (those involving oauth2)  require  an  Internet  connected  web
       browser.

       If  you  are trying to set rclone up on a remote or headless box with no browser available
       on it (e.g. a NAS or a server in a datacenter) then you will need to  use  an  alternative
       means of configuration.  There are two ways of doing it, described below.

   Configuring using rclone authorize
       On the headless box run rclone config but answer N to the Use auto config? question.

              ...
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes (default)
              n) No
              y/n> n
              For this to work, you will need rclone available on a machine that has
              a web browser available.

              For more help and alternate methods see: https://rclone.org/remote_setup/

              Execute the following on the machine with the web browser (same rclone
              version recommended):

                  rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"

              Then paste the result below:
              result>

       Then on your main desktop machine

              rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              Paste the following into your remote machine --->
              SECRET_TOKEN
              <---End paste

       Then back to the headless box, paste in the code

              result> SECRET_TOKEN
              --------------------
              [acd12]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = SECRET_TOKEN
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

   Configuring by copying the config file
       Rclone stores all of its config in a single configuration file.  This can easily be copied
       to configure a remote rclone.

       So first configure rclone on your desktop machine with

              rclone config

       to set up the config file.

       Find the config file by running rclone config file, for example

              $ rclone config file
              Configuration file is stored at:
              /home/user/.rclone.conf

       Now transfer it to the remote box (scp, cut paste, ftp, sftp, etc.)  and place it  in  the
       correct place (use rclone config file on the remote box to find out where).

   Configuring using SSH Tunnel
       Linux  and  MacOS  users can utilize SSH Tunnel to redirect the headless box port 53682 to
       local machine by using the following command:

              ssh -L localhost:53682:localhost:53682 username@remote_server

       Then on the headless box run rclone config and answer Y to the Use auto config? question.

              ...
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes (default)
              n) No
              y/n> y

       Then copy and paste the auth  url  http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=xxxxxxxxxxxx  to  the
       browser on your local machine, complete the auth and it is done.

Filtering, includes and excludes

       Filter  flags  determine  which  files  rclone sync, move, ls, lsl, md5sum, sha1sum, size,
       delete, check and similar commands apply to.

       They are specified in terms of path/file name patterns;  path/file  lists;  file  age  and
       size,  or  presence of a file in a directory.  Bucket based remotes without the concept of
       directory apply filters to object key, age and size in an analogous way.

       Rclone purge does not obey filters.

       To test filters without risk of damage to data, apply them  to  rclone  ls,  or  with  the
       --dry-run and -vv flags.

       Rclone  filter  patterns  can  only  be  used  in  filter command line options, not in the
       specification of a remote.

       E.g.  rclone copy "remote:dir*.jpg" /path/to/dir does not have a  filter  effect.   rclone
       copy remote:dir /path/to/dir --include "*.jpg" does.

       Important  Avoid  mixing  any two of --include..., --exclude... or --filter... flags in an
       rclone command.  The results may not be what you expect.  Instead use a --filter... flag.

   Patterns for matching path/file names
   Pattern syntax
       Here is a formal definition of the pattern syntax, examples are below.

       Rclone matching rules follow a glob style:

              *         matches any sequence of non-separator (/) characters
              **        matches any sequence of characters including / separators
              ?         matches any single non-separator (/) character
              [ [ ! ] { character-range } ]
                        character class (must be non-empty)
              { pattern-list }
                        pattern alternatives
              {{ regexp }}
                        regular expression to match
              c         matches character c (c != *, **, ?, \, [, {, })
              \c        matches reserved character c (c = *, **, ?, \, [, {, }) or character class

       character-range:

              c         matches character c (c != \, -, ])
              \c        matches reserved character c (c = \, -, ])
              lo - hi   matches character c for lo <= c <= hi

       pattern-list:

              pattern { , pattern }
                        comma-separated (without spaces) patterns

       character       classes       (see       Go       regular       expression       reference
       (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/)) include:

              Named character classes (e.g. [\d], [^\d], [\D], [^\D])
              Perl character classes (e.g. \s, \S, \w, \W)
              ASCII character classes (e.g. [[:alnum:]], [[:alpha:]], [[:punct:]], [[:xdigit:]])

       regexp for advanced users to insert a regular expression - see below for more info:

              Any re2 regular expression not containing `}}`

       If  the  filter  pattern  starts  with  a  /  then it only matches at the top level of the
       directory tree, relative to the root of the  remote  (not  necessarily  the  root  of  the
       drive).   If  it  does  not  start  with  /  then it is matched starting at the end of the
       path/file name but it only matches a complete path element  -  it  must  match  from  a  /
       separator or the beginning of the path/file.

              file.jpg   - matches "file.jpg"
                         - matches "directory/file.jpg"
                         - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
                         - doesn't match "directory/afile.jpg"
              /file.jpg  - matches "file.jpg" in the root directory of the remote
                         - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
                         - doesn't match "directory/file.jpg"

       The top level of the remote may not be the top level of the drive.

       E.g.  for a Microsoft Windows local directory structure

              F:
              ├── bkp
              ├── data
              │   ├── excl
              │   │   ├── 123.jpg
              │   │   └── 456.jpg
              │   ├── incl
              │   │   └── document.pdf

       To  copy  the  contents of folder data into folder bkp excluding the contents of subfolder
       exclthe following command treats F:\data and F:\bkp as top level for filtering.

       rclone copy F:\data\ F:\bkp\ --exclude=/excl/**

       Important Use / in path/file name patterns and not \ even if running on Microsoft Windows.

       Simple patterns are case sensitive unless the --ignore-case flag is used.

       Without --ignore-case (default)

              potato - matches "potato"
                     - doesn't match "POTATO"

       With --ignore-case

              potato - matches "potato"
                     - matches "POTATO"

   Using regular expressions in filter patterns
       The syntax of filter patterns is glob style matching (like bash uses) to make things  easy
       for  users.   However  this  does  not  provide absolute control over the matching, so for
       advanced users rclone also provides a regular expression syntax.

       The regular expressions used are  as  defined  in  the  Go  regular  expression  reference
       (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/).  Regular expressions should be enclosed in {{ }}.
       They will match only the last path segment if the glob doesn’t start with / or  the  whole
       path  name  if  it  does.  Note that rclone does not attempt to parse the supplied regular
       expression, meaning that using any regular expression  filter  will  prevent  rclone  from
       using  directory  filter  rules,  as it will instead check every path against the supplied
       regular expression(s).

       Here is how the {{regexp}} is transformed into an full regular  expression  to  match  the
       entire path:

              {{regexp}}  becomes (^|/)(regexp)$
              /{{regexp}} becomes ^(regexp)$

       Regexp syntax can be mixed with glob syntax, for example

              *.{{jpe?g}} to match file.jpg, file.jpeg but not file.png

       You can also use regexp flags - to set case insensitive, for example

              *.{{(?i)jpg}} to match file.jpg, file.JPG but not file.png

       Be  careful  with  wildcards  in  regular  expressions - you don’t want them to match path
       separators normally.  To match any file name starting with start and ending with end write

              {{start[^/]*end\.jpg}}

       Not

              {{start.*end\.jpg}}

       Which will match a directory called start with a file called end.jpg in it as the .*  will
       match / characters.

       Note  that  you  can use -vv --dump filters to show the filter patterns in regexp format -
       rclone implements the glob patters by transforming them into regular expressions.

   Filter pattern examples
       Description           Pattern          Matches                         Does not match
       ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       Wildcard              *.jpg            /file.jpg                       /file.png
                                              /dir/file.jpg                   /dir/file.png
       Rooted                /*.jpg           /file.jpg                       /file.png
                                              /file2.jpg                      /dir/file.jpg
       Alternates            *.{jpg,png}      /file.jpg                       /file.gif
                                              /dir/file.png                   /dir/file.gif
       Path Wildcard         dir/**           /dir/anyfile                    file.png
                                              /subdir/dir/subsubdir/anyfile   /subdir/file.png
       Any Char              *.t?t            /file.txt                       /file.qxt
                                              /dir/file.tzt                   /dir/file.png
       Range                 *.[a-z]          /file.a                         /file.0
                                              /dir/file.b                     /dir/file.1
       Escape                *.\?\?\?         /file.???                       /file.abc
                                              /dir/file.???                   /dir/file.def
       Class                 *.\d\d\d         /file.012                       /file.abc
                                              /dir/file.345                   /dir/file.def
       Regexp                *.{{jpe?g}}      /file.jpeg                      /file.png
                                              /dir/file.jpg                   /dir/file.jpeeg
       Rooted Regexp         /{{.*\.jpe?g}}   /file.jpeg                      /file.png
                                              /file.jpg                       /dir/file.jpg

   How filter rules are applied to files
       Rclone path/file name filters are made up of one or more of the following flags:

       • --include--include-from--exclude--exclude-from--filter--filter-from

       There can be more than one instance of individual flags.

       Rclone internally uses a combined list of all the include and exclude rules.  The order in
       which rules are processed can influence the result of the filter.

       All  flags  of the same type are processed together in the order above, regardless of what
       order the different types of flags are included on the command line.

       Multiple instances of the same flag are processed from left to right  according  to  their
       position in the command line.

       To mix up the order of processing includes and excludes use --filter... flags.

       Within --include-from, --exclude-from and --filter-from flags rules are processed from top
       to bottom of the referenced file.

       If there is an --include or --include-from flag specified, rclone  implies  a  -  **  rule
       which  it  adds  to  the  bottom  of  the  internal rule list.  Specifying a + rule with a
       --filter... flag does not imply that rule.

       Each path/file name passed through rclone is matched against the combined filter list.  At
       first  match  to  a  rule the path/file name is included or excluded and no further filter
       rules are processed for that path/file.

       If rclone does not find a match, after testing against all rules  (including  the  implied
       rule if appropriate), the path/file name is included.

       Any path/file included at that stage is processed by the rclone command.

       --files-from and --files-from-raw flags over-ride and cannot be combined with other filter
       options.

       To see the internal combined rule list, in regular expression form, for a command add  the
       --dump  filters  flag.   Running an rclone command with --dump filters and -vv flags lists
       the internal filter elements and shows how they are  applied  to  each  source  path/file.
       There  is  not  currently  a means provided to pass regular expression filter options into
       rclone directly though character class filter rules contain character classes.  Go regular
       expression reference (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/)

   How filter rules are applied to directories
       Rclone  commands are applied to path/file names not directories.  The entire contents of a
       directory can be matched to  a  filter  by  the  pattern  directory/*  or  recursively  by
       directory/**.

       Directory filter rules are defined with a closing / separator.

       E.g.  /directory/subdirectory/ is an rclone directory filter rule.

       Rclone  commands  can  use  directory  filter rules to determine whether they recurse into
       subdirectories.  This potentially  optimises  access  to  a  remote  by  avoiding  listing
       unnecessary directories.  Whether optimisation is desirable depends on the specific filter
       rules and source remote content.

       If any regular expression filters are in use, then no directory recursion optimisation  is
       possible, as rclone must check every path against the supplied regular expression(s).

       Directory recursion optimisation occurs if either:

       • A  source  remote  does  not support the rclone ListR primitive.  local, sftp, Microsoft
         OneDrive and WebDAV do not support ListR.  Google Drive and most bucket type storage do.
         Full list (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)

       • On  other  remotes  (those  that  support ListR), if the rclone command is not naturally
         recursive, and provided it is not run with the --fast-list flag.  ls, lsf  -R  and  size
         are naturally recursive but sync, copy and move are not.

       • Whenever the --disable ListR flag is applied to an rclone command.

       Rclone  commands  imply  directory  filter rules from path/file filter rules.  To view the
       directory filter rules rclone has implied for a command specify the --dump filters flag.

       E.g.  for an include rule

              /a/*.jpg

       Rclone implies the directory include rule

              /a/

       Directory filter rules specified in an rclone command can limit the  scope  of  an  rclone
       command but path/file filters still have to be specified.

       E.g.   rclone ls remote: --include /directory/ will not match any files.  Because it is an
       --include option the --exclude ** rule is implied, and the /directory/ pattern serves only
       to optimise access to the remote by ignoring everything outside of that directory.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-list.txt with a file filter-list.txt:

              - /dir1/
              - /dir2/
              + *.pdf
              - **

       All files in directories dir1 or dir2 or their subdirectories are completely excluded from
       the listing.  Only files of suffix pdf in the root of remote: or  its  subdirectories  are
       listed.   The  -  ** rule prevents listing of any path/files not previously matched by the
       rules above.

       Option exclude-if-present creates a directory exclude rule based on the presence of a file
       in a directory and takes precedence over other rclone directory filter rules.

       When  using  pattern  list  syntax, if a pattern item contains either / or **, then rclone
       will not able to imply a directory filter rule from this pattern list.

       E.g.  for an include rule

              {dir1/**,dir2/**}

       Rclone will match files below directories dir1 or dir2 only, but will not be able  to  use
       this filter to exclude a directory dir3 from being traversed.

       Directory recursion optimisation may affect performance, but normally not the result.  One
       exception to this is  sync  operations  with  option  --create-empty-src-dirs,  where  any
       traversed   empty   directories   will   be   created.   With  the  pattern  list  example
       {dir1/**,dir2/**} above, this would create an empty directory dir3 on destination (when it
       exists  on  source).   Changing  the  filter  to  {dir1,dir2}/**, or splitting it into two
       include rules --include dir1/** --include dir2/**, will match the same  files  while  also
       filtering  directories,  with  the  result  that an empty directory dir3 will no longer be
       created.

   --exclude - Exclude files matching pattern
       Excludes path/file names from an rclone command based on a single exclude rule.

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       --exclude should not be used with --include,  --include-from,  --filter  or  --filter-from
       flags.

       --exclude has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --exclude *.bak excludes all .bak files from listing.

       E.g.   rclone  size  remote:  "--exclude  /dir/**"  returns the total size of all files on
       remote: excluding those in root directory dir and sub directories.

       E.g.  on Microsoft Windows rclone ls remote: --exclude "*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*" lists the  files
       in  remote:  with  [JP]  or  [KR]  or  [HK]  in their name.  Quotes prevent the shell from
       interpreting the \ characters.\ characters escape the [ and ] so an rclone  filter  treats
       them  literally  rather  than  as a character-range.  The { and } define an rclone pattern
       list.  For other operating systems  single  quotes  are  required  ie  rclone  ls  remote:
       --exclude '*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*'

   --exclude-from - Read exclude patterns from file
       Excludes  path/file names from an rclone command based on rules in a named file.  The file
       contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

       For an example exclude-file.txt:

              # a sample exclude rule file
              *.bak
              file2.jpg

       rclone ls remote: --exclude-from exclude-file.txt lists the files on remote: except  those
       named  file2.jpg or with a suffix .bak.  That is equivalent to rclone ls remote: --exclude
       file2.jpg --exclude "*.bak".

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       The --exclude-from flag is useful where multiple exclude filter rules are  applied  to  an
       rclone command.

       --exclude-from  should  not  be used with --include, --include-from, --filter or --filter-
       from flags.

       --exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

       --exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

   --include - Include files matching pattern
       Adds a single include rule based on path/file names to an rclone command.

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       --include has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

       --include implies --exclude ** at the end of an rclone internal filter list.  Therefore if
       you  mix  --include  and  --include-from flags with --exclude, --exclude-from, --filter or
       --filter-from, you must use include rules for all  the  files  you  want  in  the  include
       statement.  For more flexibility use the --filter-from flag.

       E.g.   rclone  ls  remote:  --include "*.{png,jpg}" lists the files on remote: with suffix
       .png and .jpg.  All other files are excluded.

       E.g.  multiple rclone copy commands can be combined with --include and a pattern-list.

              rclone copy /vol1/A remote:A
              rclone copy /vol1/B remote:B

       is equivalent to:

              rclone copy /vol1 remote: --include "{A,B}/**"

       E.g.   rclone  ls  remote:/wheat  --include  "??[^[:punct:]]*"  lists  the  files  remote:
       directory  wheat  (and  subdirectories)  whose  third  character is not punctuation.  This
       example uses an ASCII character class (https://golang.org/pkg/regexp/syntax/).

   --include-from - Read include patterns from file
       Adds path/file names to an rclone command based on  rules  in  a  named  file.   The  file
       contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

       For an example include-file.txt:

              # a sample include rule file
              *.jpg
              file2.avi

       rclone  ls  remote:  --include-from  include-file.txt lists the files on remote: with name
       file2.avi or suffix .jpg.  That is equivalent to rclone  ls  remote:  --include  file2.avi
       --include "*.jpg".

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       The  --include-from  flag  is useful where multiple include filter rules are applied to an
       rclone command.

       --include-from implies --exclude **  at  the  end  of  an  rclone  internal  filter  list.
       Therefore  if  you  mix --include and --include-from flags with --exclude, --exclude-from,
       --filter or --filter-from, you must use include rules for all the files you  want  in  the
       include statement.  For more flexibility use the --filter-from flag.

       --exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

       --exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

   --filter - Add a file-filtering rule
       Specifies path/file names to an rclone command, based on a single include or exclude rule,
       in + or - format.

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       --filter + differs from --include.  In the case of --include rclone implies an --exclude *
       rule  which  it adds to the bottom of the internal rule list.  --filter...+ does not imply
       that rule.

       --filter has no effect when combined with --files-from or --files-from-raw flags.

       --filter should not be used with --include, --include-from,  --exclude  or  --exclude-from
       flags.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --filter "- *.bak" excludes all .bak files from a list of remote:.

   --filter-from - Read filtering patterns from a file
       Adds  path/file  names  to  an  rclone  command  based on rules in a named file.  The file
       contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.  Include rules  start  with  +  and  exclude
       rules  with  -.   !  clears  existing  rules.   Rules  are processed in the order they are
       defined.

       This flag can be repeated.  See above for the order filter flags are processed in.

       Arrange the order of filter rules with the most restrictive first and work down.

       E.g.  for filter-file.txt:

              # a sample filter rule file
              - secret*.jpg
              + *.jpg
              + *.png
              + file2.avi
              - /dir/Trash/**
              + /dir/**
              # exclude everything else
              - *

       rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-file.txt lists the path/files on remote:  including
       all  jpg  and  png  files, excluding any matching secret*.jpg and including file2.avi.  It
       also  includes  everything  in  the  directory  dir  at  the  root   of   remote,   except
       remote:dir/Trash which it excludes.  Everything else is excluded.

       E.g.  for an alternative filter-file.txt:

              - secret*.jpg
              + *.jpg
              + *.png
              + file2.avi
              - *

       Files  file1.jpg, file3.png and file2.avi are listed whilst secret17.jpg and files without
       the suffix .jpgor.png` are excluded.

       E.g.  for an alternative filter-file.txt:

              + *.jpg
              + *.gif
              !
              + 42.doc
              - *

       Only file 42.doc is listed.  Prior rules are cleared by the !.

   --files-from - Read list of source-file names
       Adds path/files to an rclone command from a list in a named file.   Rclone  processes  the
       path/file names in the order of the list, and no others.

       Other  filter  flags  (--include,  --include-from, --exclude, --exclude-from, --filter and
       --filter-from) are ignored when --files-from is used.

       --files-from expects a list of files as its input.   Leading  or  trailing  whitespace  is
       stripped from the input lines.  Lines starting with # or ; are ignored.

       Rclone  commands  with  a  --files-from  flag  traverse  the remote, treating the names in
       --files-from as a set of filters.

       If the --no-traverse and --files-from flags are used together an rclone command  does  not
       traverse  the remote.  Instead it addresses each path/file named in the file individually.
       For each path/file name, that requires typically 1 API call.  This can be efficient for  a
       short --files-from list and a remote containing many files.

       Rclone  commands  do  not error if any names in the --files-from file are missing from the
       source remote.

       The --files-from flag can be repeated in a single rclone command to read  path/file  names
       from more than one file.  The files are read from left to right along the command line.

       Paths  within the --files-from file are interpreted as starting with the root specified in
       the rclone command.  Leading / separators are ignored.  See –files-from-raw  if  you  need
       the input to be processed in a raw manner.

       E.g.  for a file files-from.txt:

              # comment
              file1.jpg
              subdir/file2.jpg

       rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home/me/pics remote:pics copies the following, if
       they exist, and only those files.

              /home/me/pics/file1.jpg        → remote:pics/file1.jpg
              /home/me/pics/subdir/file2.jpg → remote:pics/subdir/file2.jpg

       E.g.  to copy the following files referenced by their absolute paths:

              /home/user1/42
              /home/user1/dir/ford
              /home/user2/prefect

       First find a common subdirectory - in this case /home  and  put  the  remaining  files  in
       files-from.txt with or without leading /, e.g.

              user1/42
              user1/dir/ford
              user2/prefect

       Then copy these to a remote:

              rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home remote:backup

       The three files are transferred as follows:

              /home/user1/42       → remote:backup/user1/important
              /home/user1/dir/ford → remote:backup/user1/dir/file
              /home/user2/prefect  → remote:backup/user2/stuff

       Alternatively if / is chosen as root files-from.txt will be:

              /home/user1/42
              /home/user1/dir/ford
              /home/user2/prefect

       The copy command will be:

              rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt / remote:backup

       Then there will be an extra home directory on the remote:

              /home/user1/42       → remote:backup/home/user1/42
              /home/user1/dir/ford → remote:backup/home/user1/dir/ford
              /home/user2/prefect  → remote:backup/home/user2/prefect

   --files-from-raw - Read list of source-file names without any processing
       This  flag  is  the same as --files-from except that input is read in a raw manner.  Lines
       with leading / trailing whitespace, and lines starting with ; or # are  read  without  any
       processing.   rclone lsf (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsf/) has a compatible format
       that can be used to export file lists from remotes for input to --files-from-raw.

   --ignore-case - make searches case insensitive
       By default, rclone filter patterns are case sensitive.  The --ignore-case flag  makes  all
       of the filters patterns on the command line case insensitive.

       E.g.  --include "zaphod.txt" does not match a file Zaphod.txt.  With --ignore-case a match
       is made.

   Quoting shell metacharacters
       Rclone commands with filter patterns containing shell metacharacters may not  as  work  as
       expected in your shell and may require quoting.

       E.g.  linux, OSX (* metacharacter)

       • --include \*.jpg--include '*.jpg'--include='*.jpg'

       Microsoft Windows expansion is done by the command, not shell, so --include *.jpg does not
       require quoting.

       If the rclone error Command .... needs .... arguments maximum: you provided .... non  flag
       arguments:  is  encountered,  the  cause is commonly spaces within the name of a remote or
       flag value.  The fix then is to quote values containing spaces.

   Other filters
   --min-size - Don’t transfer any file smaller than this
       Controls the minimum size file within the scope of an rclone command.  Default  units  are
       KiB but abbreviations K, M, G, T or P are valid.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --min-size 50k lists files on remote: of 50 KiB size or larger.

       See the size option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#size-option) for more info.

   --max-size - Don’t transfer any file larger than this
       Controls  the  maximum size file within the scope of an rclone command.  Default units are
       KiB but abbreviations K, M, G, T or P are valid.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --max-size 1G lists files on remote: of 1 GiB size or smaller.

       See the size option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#size-option) for more info.

   --max-age - Don’t transfer any file older than this
       Controls the maximum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.

       --max-age applies only to files and not to directories.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --max-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days old or less.

       See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

   --min-age - Don’t transfer any file younger than this
       Controls the minimum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.   (see  --max-age
       for valid formats)

       --min-age applies only to files and not to directories.

       E.g.  rclone ls remote: --min-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days old or more.

       See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

   Other flags
   --delete-excluded - Delete files on dest excluded from sync
       Important this flag is dangerous to your data - use with --dry-run and -v first.

       In  conjunction  with  rclone sync, --delete-excluded deletes any files on the destination
       which are excluded from the command.

       E.g.  the scope of rclone sync -i A: B: can be restricted:

              rclone --min-size 50k --delete-excluded sync A: B:

       All files on B: which are less than 50 KiB are deleted because they are excluded from  the
       rclone sync command.

   --dump filters - dump the filters to the output
       Dumps the defined filters to standard output in regular expression format.

       Useful for debugging.

   Exclude directory based on a file
       The  --exclude-if-present  flag  controls  whether  a  directory is within the scope of an
       rclone command based on the presence of a named file within it.  The flag can be  repeated
       to check for multiple file names, presence of any of them will exclude the directory.

       This flag has a priority over other filter flags.

       E.g.  for the following directory structure:

              dir1/file1
              dir1/dir2/file2
              dir1/dir2/dir3/file3
              dir1/dir2/dir3/.ignore

       The  command  rclone  ls  --exclude-if-present  .ignore  dir1 does not list dir3, file3 or
       .ignore.

   Common pitfalls
       The most frequent filter support issues on the  rclone  forum  (https://forum.rclone.org/)
       are:

       • Not using paths relative to the root of the remote

       • Not using / to match from the root of a remote

       • Not using ** to match the contents of a directory

GUI (Experimental)

       Rclone  can  serve  a  web  based  GUI  (graphical  user  interface).   This  is  somewhat
       experimental at the moment so things may be subject to change.

       Run this command in a terminal and rclone will download and then display the GUI in a  web
       browser.

              rclone rcd --rc-web-gui

       This will produce logs like this and rclone needs to continue to run to serve the GUI:

              2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: A new release for gui is present at https://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/download/v0.0.6/currentbuild.zip
              2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: Downloading webgui binary. Please wait. [Size: 3813937, Path :  /home/USER/.cache/rclone/webgui/v0.0.6.zip]
              2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Unzipping
              2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Serving remote control on http://127.0.0.1:5572/

       This  assumes  you are running rclone locally on your machine.  It is possible to separate
       the rclone and the GUI - see below for details.

       If you wish to check for updates then you can add --rc-web-gui-update to the command line.

       If you find your GUI broken, you may force it to update by add --rc-web-gui-force-update.

       By default, rclone will open your browser.  Add  --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser  to  disable
       this feature.

   Using the GUI
       Once the GUI opens, you will be looking at the dashboard which has an overall overview.

       On the left hand side you will see a series of view buttons you can click on:

       • Dashboard - main overview

       • Configs - examine and create new configurations

       • Explorer - view, download and upload files to the cloud storage systems

       • Backend - view or alter the backend config

       • Log out

       (More docs and walkthrough video to come!)

   How it works
       When you run the rclone rcd --rc-web-gui this is what happens

       • Rclone starts but only runs the remote control API (“rc”).

       • The API is bound to localhost with an auto-generated username and password.

       • If the API bundle is missing then rclone will download it.

       • rclone will start serving the files from the API bundle over the same port as the API

       • rclone will open the browser with a login_token so it can log straight in.

   Advanced use
       The   rclone   rcd   may   use   any   of   the   flags   documented   on   the   rc  page
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#supported-parameters).

       The flag --rc-web-gui is shorthand for

       • Download the web GUI if necessary

       • Check we are using some authentication

       • --rc-user gui--rc-pass <random password>--rc-serve

       These flags can be overridden as desired.

       See also the rclone rcd documentation (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rcd/).

   Example: Running a public GUI
       For example the GUI could be served on a public port over SSL using an htpasswd file using
       the following flags:

       • --rc-web-gui--rc-addr :443--rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd--rc-cert /path/to/ssl.crt--rc-key /path/to/ssl.key

   Example: Running a GUI behind a proxy
       If you want to run the GUI behind a proxy at /rclone you could use these flags:

       • --rc-web-gui--rc-baseurl rclone--rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd

       Or instead of htpasswd if you just want a single user and password:

       • --rc-user me--rc-pass mypassword

   Project
       The    GUI    is    being   developed   in   the:   rclone/rclone-webui-react   repository
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react).

       Bug reports and contributions are very welcome :-)

       If   you   have   questions   then   please    ask    them    on    the    rclone    forum
       (https://forum.rclone.org/).

Remote controlling rclone with its API

       If  rclone  is  run  with the --rc flag then it starts an HTTP server which can be used to
       remote control rclone using its API.

       You can either use the rc command to access the API or use HTTP directly.

       If   you   just   want    to    run    a    remote    control    then    see    the    rcd
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rcd/) command.

   Supported parameters
   –rc
       Flag to start the http server listen on remote requests

   –rc-addr=IP
       IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to.  (default “localhost:5572”)

   –rc-cert=KEY
       SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)

   –rc-client-ca=PATH
       Client certificate authority to verify clients with

   –rc-htpasswd=PATH
       htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done

   –rc-key=PATH
       SSL PEM Private key

   –rc-max-header-bytes=VALUE
       Maximum size of request header (default 4096)

   –rc-min-tls-version=VALUE
       The minimum TLS version that is acceptable.  Valid values are “tls1.0”, “tls1.1”, “tls1.2”
       and “tls1.3” (default “tls1.0”).

   –rc-user=VALUE
       User name for authentication.

   –rc-pass=VALUE
       Password for authentication.

   –rc-realm=VALUE
       Realm for authentication (default “rclone”)

   –rc-server-read-timeout=DURATION
       Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)

   –rc-server-write-timeout=DURATION
       Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)

   –rc-serve
       Enable the serving of remote objects via the HTTP interface.  This means objects  will  be
       accessible    at    http://127.0.0.1:5572/    by   default,   so   you   can   browse   to
       http://127.0.0.1:5572/ or  http://127.0.0.1:5572/*  to  see  a  listing  of  the  remotes.
       Objects      may      be      requested     from     remotes     using     this     syntax
       http://127.0.0.1:5572/[remote:path]/path/to/object

       Default Off.

   –rc-files /path/to/directory
       Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server.

       If this is set then rclone will serve the files in that directory.  It will also open  the
       root  in  the  web  browser if specified.  This is for implementing browser based GUIs for
       rclone functions.

       If --rc-user or --rc-pass is set then the URL that is opened will have  the  authorization
       in the URL in the http://user:pass@localhost/ style.

       Default Off.

   –rc-enable-metrics
       Enable OpenMetrics/Prometheus compatible endpoint at /metrics.

       Default Off.

   –rc-web-gui
       Set this flag to serve the default web gui on the same port as rclone.

       Default Off.

   –rc-allow-origin
       Set the allowed Access-Control-Allow-Origin for rc requests.

       Can be used with –rc-web-gui if the rclone is running on different IP than the web-gui.

       Default is IP address on which rc is running.

   –rc-web-fetch-url
       Set the URL to fetch the rclone-web-gui files from.

       Default https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest.

   –rc-web-gui-update
       Set this flag to check and update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

       Default Off.

   –rc-web-gui-force-update
       Set this flag to force update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

       Default Off.

   –rc-web-gui-no-open-browser
       Set this flag to disable opening browser automatically when using web-gui.

       Default Off.

   –rc-job-expire-duration=DURATION
       Expire finished async jobs older than DURATION (default 60s).

   –rc-job-expire-interval=DURATION
       Interval duration to check for expired async jobs (default 10s).

   –rc-no-auth
       By  default  rclone  will require authorisation to have been set up on the rc interface in
       order to use any methods which access any rclone remotes.  Eg operations/list is denied as
       it involved creating a remote as is sync/copy.

       If  this is set then no authorisation will be required on the server to use these methods.
       The alternative is to use --rc-user  and  --rc-pass  and  use  these  credentials  in  the
       request.

       Default Off.

   –rc-baseurl
       Prefix for URLs.

       Default is root

   –rc-template
       User-specified template.

   Accessing the remote control via the rclone rc command
       Rclone itself implements the remote control protocol in its rclone rc command.

       You can use it like this

              $ rclone rc rc/noop param1=one param2=two
              {
                  "param1": "one",
                  "param2": "two"
              }

       Run rclone rc on its own to see the help for the installed remote control commands.

   JSON input
       rclone  rc  also  supports  a --json flag which can be used to send more complicated input
       parameters.

              $ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 } }' rc/noop
              {
                  "p1": [
                      1,
                      "2",
                      null,
                      4
                  ],
                  "p2": {
                      "a": 1,
                      "b": 2
                  }
              }

       If the parameter being passed is an object then it can be passed as a JSON  string  rather
       than using the --json flag which simplifies the command line.

              rclone rc operations/list fs=/tmp remote=test opt='{"showHash": true}'

       Rather than

              rclone rc operations/list --json '{"fs": "/tmp", "remote": "test", "opt": {"showHash": true}}'

   Special parameters
       The  rc  interface  supports  some  special parameters which apply to all commands.  These
       start with _ to show they are different.

   Running asynchronous jobs with _async = true
       Each rc call is classified as a job and it is assigned its own id.  By  default  jobs  are
       executed immediately as they are created or synchronously.

       If  _async  has  a  true value when supplied to an rc call then it will return immediately
       with a job id and the task will be run in the background.  The job/status call can be used
       to get information of the background job.  The job can be queried for up to 1 minute after
       it has finished.

       It  is  recommended  that  potentially  long  running  jobs,  e.g. sync/sync,   sync/copy,
       sync/move,  operations/purge  are run with the _async flag to avoid any potential problems
       with the HTTP request and response timing out.

       Starting a job with the _async flag:

              $ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 }, "_async": true }' rc/noop
              {
                  "jobid": 2
              }

       Query the status to see if the job has finished.  For more information on the  meaning  of
       these return parameters see the job/status call.

              $ rclone rc --json '{ "jobid":2 }' job/status
              {
                  "duration": 0.000124163,
                  "endTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911245881+01:00",
                  "error": "",
                  "finished": true,
                  "id": 2,
                  "output": {
                      "_async": true,
                      "p1": [
                          1,
                          "2",
                          null,
                          4
                      ],
                      "p2": {
                          "a": 1,
                          "b": 2
                      }
                  },
                  "startTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911121728+01:00",
                  "success": true
              }

       job/list can be used to show the running or recently completed jobs

              $ rclone rc job/list
              {
                  "jobids": [
                      2
                  ]
              }

   Setting config flags with _config
       If  you  wish to set config (the equivalent of the global flags) for the duration of an rc
       call only then pass in the _config parameter.

       This should be in the same format as the config key returned by options/get.

       For example, if you wished to run a sync with the --checksum  parameter,  you  would  pass
       this parameter in your JSON blob.

              "_config":{"CheckSum": true}

       If using rclone rc this could be passed as

              rclone rc operations/sync ... _config='{"CheckSum": true}'

       Any  config  parameters you don’t set will inherit the global defaults which were set with
       command line flags or environment variables.

       Note that it is possible to set some values as strings or integers - see  data  types  for
       more  info.   Here  is  an  example  setting  the equivalent of --buffer-size in string or
       integer format.

              "_config":{"BufferSize": "42M"}
              "_config":{"BufferSize": 44040192}

       If you wish to check the _config assignment has worked properly then calling options/local
       will show what the value got set to.

   Setting filter flags with _filter
       If  you  wish  to set filters for the duration of an rc call only then pass in the _filter
       parameter.

       This should be in the same format as the filter key returned by options/get.

       For example, if you wished to run a sync with these flags

              --max-size 1M --max-age 42s --include "a" --include "b"

       you would pass this parameter in your JSON blob.

              "_filter":{"MaxSize":"1M", "IncludeRule":["a","b"], "MaxAge":"42s"}

       If using rclone rc this could be passed as

              rclone rc ... _filter='{"MaxSize":"1M", "IncludeRule":["a","b"], "MaxAge":"42s"}'

       Any filter parameters you don’t set will inherit the global defaults which were  set  with
       command line flags or environment variables.

       Note  that  it  is possible to set some values as strings or integers - see data types for
       more info.  Here is an example setting  the  equivalent  of  --buffer-size  in  string  or
       integer format.

              "_filter":{"MinSize": "42M"}
              "_filter":{"MinSize": 44040192}

       If you wish to check the _filter assignment has worked properly then calling options/local
       will show what the value got set to.

   Assigning operations to groups with _group = value
       Each rc call has its own stats group for tracking its metrics.   By  default  grouping  is
       done by the composite group name from prefix job/ and id of the job like so job/1.

       If  _group has a value then stats for that request will be grouped under that value.  This
       allows caller to group stats under their own name.

       Stats for specific group can be accessed by passing group to core/stats:

              $ rclone rc --json '{ "group": "job/1" }' core/stats
              {
                  "speed": 12345
                  ...
              }

   Data types
       When the API returns types, these will mostly  be  straight  forward  integer,  string  or
       boolean types.

       However  some  of  the types returned by the options/get call and taken by the options/set
       calls as well as the vfsOpt, mountOpt and the _config parameters.

       • Duration - these are returned as an integer duration in nanoseconds.  They may be set as
         an  integer,  or  they  may  be  set with time string, eg “5s”.  See the options section
         (https://rclone.org/docs/#options) for more info.

       • Size - these are returned as an integer number of bytes.  They may be set as an  integer
         or  they  may  be  set  with  a  size  suffix string, eg “10M”.  See the options section
         (https://rclone.org/docs/#options) for more info.

       • Enumerated type (such as CutoffMode, DumpFlags, LogLevel, VfsCacheMode - these  will  be
         returned  as  an  integer and may be set as an integer but more conveniently they can be
         set as a string, eg “HARD” for CutoffMode or DEBUG for LogLevel.

       • BandwidthSpec - this will be set and returned as a string, eg “1M”.

   Specifying remotes to work on
       Remotes are specified with the fs=, srcFs=, dstFs= parameters  depending  on  the  command
       being used.

       The  parameters  can  be  a  string  as  per  the  rest  of  rclone,  eg s3:bucket/path or
       :sftp:/my/dir.  They can also be specified as JSON blobs.

       If specifying a JSON blob it should be a object mapping strings to strings.  These  values
       will be used to configure the remote.  There are 3 special values which may be set:

       • type - set to type to specify a remote called :type:_name - set to name to specify a remote called name:_root - sets the root of the remote - may be empty

       One  of  _name  or type should normally be set.  If the local backend is desired then type
       should be set to local.  If _root isn’t specified then it defaults  to  the  root  of  the
       remote.

       For example this JSON is equivalent to remote:/tmp

              {
                  "_name": "remote",
                  "_path": "/tmp"
              }

       And this is equivalent to :sftp,host='example.com':/tmp

              {
                  "type": "sftp",
                  "host": "example.com",
                  "_path": "/tmp"
              }

       And this is equivalent to /tmp/dir

              {
                  type = "local",
                  _ path = "/tmp/dir"
              }

   Supported commands
   backend/command: Runs a backend command.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • command - a string with the command name

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • arg - a list of arguments for the backend command

       • opt - a map of string to string of options

       Returns:

       • result - result from the backend command

       Example:

              rclone rc backend/command command=noop fs=. -o echo=yes -o blue -a path1 -a path2

       Returns

              {
                  "result": {
                      "arg": [
                          "path1",
                          "path2"
                      ],
                      "name": "noop",
                      "opt": {
                          "blue": "",
                          "echo": "yes"
                      }
                  }
              }

       Note that this is the direct equivalent of using this “backend” command:

              rclone backend noop . -o echo=yes -o blue path1 path2

       Note that arguments must be preceded by the “-a” flag

       See   the   backend   (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/)   command   for   more
       information.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   cache/expire: Purge a remote from cache
       Purge a remote from the cache backend.  Supports either a directory or a file.  Params:  -
       remote  = path to remote (required) - withData = true/false to delete cached data (chunks)
       as well (optional)

       Eg

              rclone rc cache/expire remote=path/to/sub/folder/
              rclone rc cache/expire remote=/ withData=true

   cache/fetch: Fetch file chunks
       Ensure the specified file chunks are cached on disk.

       The chunks= parameter specifies the file chunks to check.  It takes a comma separated list
       of array slice indices.  The slice indices are similar to Python slices: start[:end]

       start  is the 0 based chunk number from the beginning of the file to fetch inclusive.  end
       is 0 based chunk number from the beginning of the file to fetch  exclusive.   Both  values
       can  be  negative,  in  which  case they count from the back of the file.  The value “-5:”
       represents the last 5 chunks of a file.

       Some valid examples are: “:5,-5:” -> the first and last five chunks “0,-2”  ->  the  first
       and the second last chunk “0:10” -> the first ten chunks

       Any  parameter  with  a key that starts with “file” can be used to specify files to fetch,
       e.g.

              rclone rc cache/fetch chunks=0 file=hello file2=home/goodbye

       File names will automatically be encrypted when the a crypt remote is used on top  of  the
       cache.

   cache/stats: Get cache stats
       Show statistics for the cache remote.

   config/create: create the config for a remote.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • name - name of remote

       • parameters - a map of { “key”: “value” } pairs

       • type - type of the new remote

       • opt - a dictionary of options to control the configuration

         • obscure - declare passwords are plain and need obscuring

         • noObscure - declare passwords are already obscured and don’t need obscuring

         • nonInteractive - don’t interact with a user, return questions

         • continue - continue the config process with an answer

         • all - ask all the config questions not just the post config ones

         • state - state to restart with - used with continue

         • result - result to restart with - used with continue

       See the config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) command for more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/delete: Delete a remote in the config file.
       Parameters:

       • name - name of remote to delete

       See the config delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_delete/) command for more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/dump: Dumps the config file.
       Returns a JSON object: - key: value

       Where keys are remote names and values are the config parameters.

       See  the  config  dump  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/) command for more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/get: Get a remote in the config file.
       Parameters:

       • name - name of remote to get

       See the config dump  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_dump/)  command  for  more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/listremotes: Lists the remotes in the config file.
       Returns - remotes - array of remote names

       See  the  listremotes  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_listremotes/)  command for more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/password: password the config for a remote.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • name - name of remote

       • parameters - a map of { “key”: “value” } pairs

       See the config password (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_password/) command  for
       more information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/providers: Shows how providers are configured in the config file.
       Returns a JSON object: - providers - array of objects

       See  the  config  providers (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_providers/) command
       for more information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   config/update: update the config for a remote.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • name - name of remote

       • parameters - a map of { “key”: “value” } pairs

       • opt - a dictionary of options to control the configuration

         • obscure - declare passwords are plain and need obscuring

         • noObscure - declare passwords are already obscured and don’t need obscuring

         • nonInteractive - don’t interact with a user, return questions

         • continue - continue the config process with an answer

         • all - ask all the config questions not just the post config ones

         • state - state to restart with - used with continue

         • result - result to restart with - used with continue

       See the config update (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_update/) command for more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   core/bwlimit: Set the bandwidth limit.
       This  sets the bandwidth limit to the string passed in.  This should be a single bandwidth
       limit entry or a pair of upload:download bandwidth.

       Eg

              rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=off
              {
                  "bytesPerSecond": -1,
                  "bytesPerSecondTx": -1,
                  "bytesPerSecondRx": -1,
                  "rate": "off"
              }
              rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M
              {
                  "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
                  "rate": "1M"
              }
              rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M:100k
              {
                  "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondRx": 131072,
                  "rate": "1M"
              }

       If the rate parameter is not supplied then the bandwidth is queried

              rclone rc core/bwlimit
              {
                  "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
                  "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
                  "rate": "1M"
              }

       The format of the parameter is exactly the same as passed  to  –bwlimit  except  only  one
       bandwidth may be specified.

       In  either  case  “rate”  is  returned as a human-readable string, and “bytesPerSecond” is
       returned as a number.

   core/command: Run a rclone terminal command over rc.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • command - a string with the command name.

       • arg - a list of arguments for the backend command.

       • opt - a map of string to string of options.

       • returnType   -    one    of    (“COMBINED_OUTPUT”,    “STREAM”,    “STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT”,
         “STREAM_ONLY_STDERR”).

         • Defaults to “COMBINED_OUTPUT” if not set.

         • The STREAM returnTypes will write the output to the body of the HTTP message.

         • The COMBINED_OUTPUT will write the output to the “result” parameter.

       Returns:

       • result - result from the backend command.

         • Only set when using returnType “COMBINED_OUTPUT”.

       • error - set if rclone exits with an error code.

       • returnType    -    one    of    (“COMBINED_OUTPUT”,    “STREAM”,   “STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT”,
         “STREAM_ONLY_STDERR”).

       Example:

              rclone rc core/command command=ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1
              rclone rc core/command -a ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1

       Returns:

              {
                  "error": false,
                  "result": "<Raw command line output>"
              }

              OR
              {
                  "error": true,
                  "result": "<Raw command line output>"
              }

       Authentication is required for this call.

   core/gc: Runs a garbage collection.
       This tells the go runtime to do a garbage collection run.  It isn’t necessary to call this
       normally, but it can be useful for debugging memory problems.

   core/group-list: Returns list of stats.
       This returns list of stats groups currently in memory.

       Returns the following values:

              {
                  "groups":  an array of group names:
                      [
                          "group1",
                          "group2",
                          ...
                      ]
              }

   core/memstats: Returns the memory statistics
       This  returns  the  memory  statistics  of  the running program.  What the values mean are
       explained in the go docs: https://golang.org/pkg/runtime/#MemStats

       The most interesting values for most people are:

       • HeapAlloc - this is the amount of memory rclone is actually using

       • HeapSys - this is the amount of memory rclone has obtained from the OS

       • Sys - this is the total amount of memory requested from the OS

         • It is virtual memory so may include unused memory

   core/obscure: Obscures a string passed in.
       Pass a clear string and rclone will obscure it for the config file: - clear - string

       Returns: - obscured - string

   core/pid: Return PID of current process
       This returns PID of current process.  Useful for stopping rclone process.

   core/quit: Terminates the app.
       (Optional) Pass an exit code to be used for terminating the app: - exitCode - int

   core/stats: Returns stats about current transfers.
       This returns all available stats:

              rclone rc core/stats

       If group is not provided then summed up stats for all groups will be returned.

       Parameters

       • group - name of the stats group (string)

       Returns the following values:

              {
                  "bytes": total transferred bytes since the start of the group,
                  "checks": number of files checked,
                  "deletes" : number of files deleted,
                  "elapsedTime": time in floating point seconds since rclone was started,
                  "errors": number of errors,
                  "eta": estimated time in seconds until the group completes,
                  "fatalError": boolean whether there has been at least one fatal error,
                  "lastError": last error string,
                  "renames" : number of files renamed,
                  "retryError": boolean showing whether there has been at least one non-NoRetryError,
                  "speed": average speed in bytes per second since start of the group,
                  "totalBytes": total number of bytes in the group,
                  "totalChecks": total number of checks in the group,
                  "totalTransfers": total number of transfers in the group,
                  "transferTime" : total time spent on running jobs,
                  "transfers": number of transferred files,
                  "transferring": an array of currently active file transfers:
                      [
                          {
                              "bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
                              "eta": estimated time in seconds until file transfer completion
                              "name": name of the file,
                              "percentage": progress of the file transfer in percent,
                              "speed": average speed over the whole transfer in bytes per second,
                              "speedAvg": current speed in bytes per second as an exponentially weighted moving average,
                              "size": size of the file in bytes
                          }
                      ],
                  "checking": an array of names of currently active file checks
                      []
              }

       Values for “transferring”, “checking”  and  “lastError”  are  only  assigned  if  data  is
       available.  The value for “eta” is null if an eta cannot be determined.

   core/stats-delete: Delete stats group.
       This deletes entire stats group.

       Parameters

       • group - name of the stats group (string)

   core/stats-reset: Reset stats.
       This  clears counters, errors and finished transfers for all stats or specific stats group
       if group is provided.

       Parameters

       • group - name of the stats group (string)

   core/transferred: Returns stats about completed transfers.
       This returns stats about completed transfers:

              rclone rc core/transferred

       If group is not provided then completed transfers for all groups will be returned.

       Note only the last 100 completed transfers are returned.

       Parameters

       • group - name of the stats group (string)

       Returns the following values:

              {
                  "transferred":  an array of completed transfers (including failed ones):
                      [
                          {
                              "name": name of the file,
                              "size": size of the file in bytes,
                              "bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
                              "checked": if the transfer is only checked (skipped, deleted),
                              "timestamp": integer representing millisecond unix epoch,
                              "error": string description of the error (empty if successful),
                              "jobid": id of the job that this transfer belongs to
                          }
                      ]
              }

   core/version: Shows the current version of rclone and the go runtime.
       This shows the current version of go and the go runtime:

       • version - rclone version, e.g. “v1.53.0”

       • decomposed - version number as [major, minor, patch]

       • isGit - boolean - true if this was compiled from the git version

       • isBeta - boolean - true if this is a beta version

       • os - OS in use as according to Go

       • arch - cpu architecture in use according to Go

       • goVersion - version of Go runtime in use

       • linking - type of rclone executable (static or dynamic)

       • goTags - space separated build tags or “none”

   debug/set-block-profile-rate: Set runtime.SetBlockProfileRate for blocking profiling.
       SetBlockProfileRate controls the fraction of goroutine blocking events that  are  reported
       in the blocking profile.  The profiler aims to sample an average of one blocking event per
       rate nanoseconds spent blocked.

       To include every blocking event in the profile, pass rate =  1.   To  turn  off  profiling
       entirely, pass rate <= 0.

       After calling this you can use this to see the blocking profile:

              go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block

       Parameters:

       • rate - int

   debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction: Set runtime.SetMutexProfileFraction for mutex profiling.
       SetMutexProfileFraction controls the fraction of mutex contention events that are reported
       in the mutex profile.  On average 1/rate  events  are  reported.   The  previous  rate  is
       returned.

       To  turn  off profiling entirely, pass rate 0.  To just read the current rate, pass rate <
       0.  (For n>1 the details of sampling may change.)

       Once this is set you can look use this to profile the mutex contention:

              go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

       Parameters:

       • rate - int

       Results:

       • previousRate - int

   fscache/clear: Clear the Fs cache.
       This clears the fs cache.  This is where remotes created from backends are  cached  for  a
       short while to make repeated rc calls more efficient.

       If  you  change  the  parameters  of  a backend then you may want to call this to clear an
       existing remote out of the cache before re-creating it.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   fscache/entries: Returns the number of entries in the fs cache.
       This returns the number of entries in the fs cache.

       Returns - entries - number of items in the cache

       Authentication is required for this call.

   job/list: Lists the IDs of the running jobs
       Parameters: None.

       Results:

       • jobids - array of integer job ids.

   job/status: Reads the status of the job ID
       Parameters:

       • jobid - id of the job (integer).

       Results:

       • finished - boolean

       • duration - time in seconds that the job ran for

       • endTime - time the job finished (e.g. “2018-10-26T18:50:20.528746884+01:00”)

       • error - error from the job or empty string for no error

       • finished - boolean whether the job has finished or not

       • id - as passed in above

       • startTime - time the job started (e.g. “2018-10-26T18:50:20.528336039+01:00”)

       • success - boolean - true for success false otherwise

       • output - output of the job as would have been returned if called synchronously

       • progress - output of the progress related to the underlying job

   job/stop: Stop the running job
       Parameters:

       • jobid - id of the job (integer).

   job/stopgroup: Stop all running jobs in a group
       Parameters:

       • group - name of the group (string).

   mount/listmounts: Show current mount points
       This shows currently mounted points, which can be used for performing an unmount.

       This takes no parameters and returns

       • mountPoints: list of current mount points

       Eg

              rclone rc mount/listmounts

       Authentication is required for this call.

   mount/mount: Create a new mount point
       rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any  of  Rclone’s  cloud  storage
       systems as a file system with FUSE.

       If no mountType is provided, the priority is given as follows: 1.  mount 2.cmount 3.mount2

       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote path to be mounted (required)

       • mountPoint: valid path on the local machine (required)

       • mountType:  one of the values (mount, cmount, mount2) specifies the mount implementation
         to use

       • mountOpt: a JSON object with Mount options in.

       • vfsOpt: a JSON object with VFS options in.

       Example:

              rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint
              rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint mountType=mount
              rclone rc mount/mount fs=TestDrive: mountPoint=/mnt/tmp vfsOpt='{"CacheMode": 2}' mountOpt='{"AllowOther": true}'

       The vfsOpt are as described in options/get and can be seen in the the “vfs”  section  when
       running and the mountOpt can be seen in the “mount” section:

              rclone rc options/get

       Authentication is required for this call.

   mount/types: Show all possible mount types
       This shows all possible mount types and returns them as a list.

       This takes no parameters and returns

       • mountTypes: list of mount types

       The  mount  types  are  strings  like  “mount”,  “mount2”,  “cmount”  and can be passed to
       mount/mount as the mountType parameter.

       Eg

              rclone rc mount/types

       Authentication is required for this call.

   mount/unmount: Unmount selected active mount
       rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any  of  Rclone’s  cloud  storage
       systems as a file system with FUSE.

       This takes the following parameters:

       • mountPoint: valid path on the local machine where the mount was created (required)

       Example:

              rclone rc mount/unmount mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint

       Authentication is required for this call.

   mount/unmountall: Unmount all active mounts
       rclone  allows  Linux,  FreeBSD,  macOS and Windows to mount any of Rclone’s cloud storage
       systems as a file system with FUSE.

       This takes no parameters and returns error if unmount does not succeed.

       Eg

              rclone rc mount/unmountall

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/about: Return the space used on the remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       The result is as returned from rclone about –json

       See the about (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command for more information  on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/cleanup: Remove trashed files in the remote or path
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       See the cleanup (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cleanup/) command for more information
       on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/copyfile: Copy a file from source remote to destination remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:” for the source

       • srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g. “file.txt” for the source

       • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive2:” for the destination

       • dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g. “file2.txt” for the destination

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/copyurl: Copy the URL to the object
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       • url - string, URL to read from

       • autoFilename - boolean, set to true to retrieve destination file name from url

       See the copyurl (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyurl/) command for more information
       on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/delete: Remove files in the path
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       See  the  delete (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_delete/) command for more information
       on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/deletefile: Remove the single file pointed to
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       See  the  deletefile  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_deletefile/)  command  for  more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       This returns info about the remote passed in;

              {
                      // optional features and whether they are available or not
                      "Features": {
                              "About": true,
                              "BucketBased": false,
                              "BucketBasedRootOK": false,
                              "CanHaveEmptyDirectories": true,
                              "CaseInsensitive": false,
                              "ChangeNotify": false,
                              "CleanUp": false,
                              "Command": true,
                              "Copy": false,
                              "DirCacheFlush": false,
                              "DirMove": true,
                              "Disconnect": false,
                              "DuplicateFiles": false,
                              "GetTier": false,
                              "IsLocal": true,
                              "ListR": false,
                              "MergeDirs": false,
                              "MetadataInfo": true,
                              "Move": true,
                              "OpenWriterAt": true,
                              "PublicLink": false,
                              "Purge": true,
                              "PutStream": true,
                              "PutUnchecked": false,
                              "ReadMetadata": true,
                              "ReadMimeType": false,
                              "ServerSideAcrossConfigs": false,
                              "SetTier": false,
                              "SetWrapper": false,
                              "Shutdown": false,
                              "SlowHash": true,
                              "SlowModTime": false,
                              "UnWrap": false,
                              "UserInfo": false,
                              "UserMetadata": true,
                              "WrapFs": false,
                              "WriteMetadata": true,
                              "WriteMimeType": false
                      },
                      // Names of hashes available
                      "Hashes": [
                              "md5",
                              "sha1",
                              "whirlpool",
                              "crc32",
                              "sha256",
                              "dropbox",
                              "mailru",
                              "quickxor"
                      ],
                      "Name": "local",        // Name as created
                      "Precision": 1,         // Precision of timestamps in ns
                      "Root": "/",            // Path as created
                      "String": "Local file system at /", // how the remote will appear in logs
                      // Information about the system metadata for this backend
                      "MetadataInfo": {
                              "System": {
                                      "atime": {
                                              "Help": "Time of last access",
                                              "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                              "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                      },
                                      "btime": {
                                              "Help": "Time of file birth (creation)",
                                              "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                              "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                      },
                                      "gid": {
                                              "Help": "Group ID of owner",
                                              "Type": "decimal number",
                                              "Example": "500"
                                      },
                                      "mode": {
                                              "Help": "File type and mode",
                                              "Type": "octal, unix style",
                                              "Example": "0100664"
                                      },
                                      "mtime": {
                                              "Help": "Time of last modification",
                                              "Type": "RFC 3339",
                                              "Example": "2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00"
                                      },
                                      "rdev": {
                                              "Help": "Device ID (if special file)",
                                              "Type": "hexadecimal",
                                              "Example": "1abc"
                                      },
                                      "uid": {
                                              "Help": "User ID of owner",
                                              "Type": "decimal number",
                                              "Example": "500"
                                      }
                              },
                              "Help": "Textual help string\n"
                      }
              }

       This command does not have a command line equivalent so use this instead:

              rclone rc --loopback operations/fsinfo fs=remote:

   operations/list: List the given remote and path in JSON format
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       • opt - a dictionary of options to control the listing (optional)

         • recurse - If set recurse directories

         • noModTime - If set return modification time

         • showEncrypted - If set show decrypted names

         • showOrigIDs - If set show the IDs for each item if known

         • showHash - If set return a dictionary of hashes

         • noMimeType - If set don’t show mime types

         • dirsOnly - If set only show directories

         • filesOnly - If set only show files

         • metadata - If set return metadata of objects also

         • hashTypes - array of strings of hash types to show if showHash set

       Returns:

       • list

         • This is an array of objects as described in the lsjson command

       See  the  lsjson (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/) command for more information
       on the above and examples.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/mkdir: Make a destination directory or container
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       See the mkdir (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mkdir/) command for more information  on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/movefile: Move a file from source remote to destination remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:” for the source

       • srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g. “file.txt” for the source

       • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive2:” for the destination

       • dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g. “file2.txt” for the destination

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/publiclink: Create or retrieve a public link to the given file or folder.
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       • unlink - boolean - if set removes the link rather than adding it (optional)

       • expire - string - the expiry time of the link e.g. “1d” (optional)

       Returns:

       • url - URL of the resource

       See  the  link  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_link/) command for more information on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/purge: Remove a directory or container and all of its contents
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       See the purge (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_purge/) command for more information  on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/rmdir: Remove an empty directory or container
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       See  the rmdir (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdir/) command for more information on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/rmdirs: Remove all the empty directories in the path
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       • leaveRoot - boolean, set to true not to delete the root

       See the rmdirs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_rmdirs/) command for  more  information
       on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/size: Count the number of bytes and files in remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:path/to/dir”

       Returns:

       • count - number of files

       • bytes - number of bytes in those files

       See  the  size  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_size/) command for more information on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/stat: Give information about the supplied file or directory
       This takes the following parameters

       • fs - a remote name string eg “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote eg “dir”

       • opt - a dictionary of options to control the listing (optional)

         • see operations/list for the options

       The result is

       • item - an object as described in the lsjson command.  Will be null if not found.

       Note that if you are only interested in files then it is much more efficient  to  set  the
       filesOnly flag in the options.

       See  the  lsjson (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_lsjson/) command for more information
       on the above and examples.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   operations/uploadfile: Upload file using multiform/form-data
       This takes the following parameters:

       • fs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:”

       • remote - a path within that remote e.g. “dir”

       • each part in body represents a file to be uploaded

       See  the  uploadfile  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_uploadfile/)  command  for  more
       information on the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   options/blocks: List all the option blocks
       Returns: - options - a list of the options block names

   options/get: Get all the global options
       Returns  an  object  where  keys  are option block names and values are an object with the
       current option values in.

       Note that these are the global options which are unaffected by  use  of  the  _config  and
       _filter  parameters.   If  you  wish  to  read  the  parameters  set  in  _config then use
       options/config and for _filter use options/filter.

       This shows the internal names of the option within rclone which should map to the external
       options very easily with a few exceptions.

   options/local: Get the currently active config for this call
       Returns  an  object  with  the  keys “config” and “filter”.  The “config” key contains the
       local config and the “filter” key contains the local filters.

       Note that these are the local options specific to  this  rc  call.   If  _config  was  not
       supplied then they will be the global options.  Likewise with “_filter”.

       This call is mostly useful for seeing if _config and _filter passing is working.

       This shows the internal names of the option within rclone which should map to the external
       options very easily with a few exceptions.

   options/set: Set an option
       Parameters:

       • option block name containing an object with

         • key: value

       Repeated as often as required.

       Only supply the options you wish to change.  If an option is unknown it will  be  silently
       ignored.  Not all options will have an effect when changed like this.

       For example:

       This sets DEBUG level logs (-vv) (these can be set by number or string)

              rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "DEBUG"}}'
              rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": 8}}'

       And this sets INFO level logs (-v)

              rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "INFO"}}'

       And this sets NOTICE level logs (normal without -v)

              rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": "NOTICE"}}'

   pluginsctl/addPlugin: Add a plugin using url
       Used for adding a plugin to the webgui.

       This takes the following parameters:

       • url    -    http    url    of   the   github   repo   where   the   plugin   is   hosted
         (http://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react).

       Example:

       rclone rc pluginsctl/addPlugin

       Authentication is required for this call.

   pluginsctl/getPluginsForType: Get plugins with type criteria
       This shows all possible plugins by a mime type.

       This takes the following parameters:

       • type - supported mime type by a loaded plugin e.g. (video/mp4, audio/mp3).

       • pluginType  -  filter  plugins  based  on  their  type  e.g. (DASHBOARD,   FILE_HANDLER,
         TERMINAL).

       Returns:

       • loadedPlugins - list of current production plugins.

       • testPlugins  -  list  of  temporarily  loaded  development plugins, usually running on a
         different server.

       Example:

       rclone rc pluginsctl/getPluginsForType type=video/mp4

       Authentication is required for this call.

   pluginsctl/listPlugins: Get the list of currently loaded plugins
       This allows you to get the currently enabled plugins and their details.

       This takes no parameters and returns:

       • loadedPlugins - list of current production plugins.

       • testPlugins - list of temporarily loaded  development  plugins,  usually  running  on  a
         different server.

       E.g.

       rclone rc pluginsctl/listPlugins

       Authentication is required for this call.

   pluginsctl/listTestPlugins: Show currently loaded test plugins
       Allows  listing  of  test  plugins with the rclone.test set to true in package.json of the
       plugin.

       This takes no parameters and returns:

       • loadedTestPlugins - list of currently available test plugins.

       E.g.

              rclone rc pluginsctl/listTestPlugins

       Authentication is required for this call.

   pluginsctl/removePlugin: Remove a loaded plugin
       This allows you to remove a plugin using it’s name.

       This takes parameters:

       • name - name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name.

       E.g.

       rclone rc pluginsctl/removePlugin name=rclone/video-plugin

       Authentication is required for this call.

   pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin: Remove a test plugin
       This allows you to remove a plugin using it’s name.

       This takes the following parameters:

       • name - name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name.

       Example:

              rclone rc pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin name=rclone/rclone-webui-react

       Authentication is required for this call.

   rc/error: This returns an error
       This returns an error with the input as part of its  error  string.   Useful  for  testing
       error handling.

   rc/list: List all the registered remote control commands
       This  lists  all  the  registered  remote  control  commands as a JSON map in the commands
       response.

   rc/noop: Echo the input to the output parameters
       This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing purposes.  It can be
       used  to  check  that rclone is still alive and to check that parameter passing is working
       properly.

   rc/noopauth: Echo the input to the output parameters requiring auth
       This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing purposes.  It can be
       used  to  check  that rclone is still alive and to check that parameter passing is working
       properly.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   sync/bisync: Perform bidirectional synchronization between two paths.
       This takes the following parameters

       • path1 - a remote directory string e.g. drive:path1

       • path2 - a remote directory string e.g. drive:path2

       • dryRun - dry-run mode

       • resync - performs the resync run

       • checkAccess - abort if RCLONE_TEST files are not found on both filesystems

       • checkFilename - file name for checkAccess (default: RCLONE_TEST)

       • maxDelete - abort sync if percentage of deleted files is above this threshold  (default:
         50)

       • force - maxDelete safety check and run the sync

       • checkSync - true by default, false disables comparison of final listings, only will skip
         sync, only compare listings from the last run

       • removeEmptyDirs - remove empty directories at the final cleanup step

       • filtersFile - read filtering patterns from a file

       • workdir - server directory for history files (default: /home/ncw/.cache/rclone/bisync)

       • noCleanup - retain working files

       See bisync  command  help  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_bisync/)  and  full  bisync
       description (https://rclone.org/bisync/) for more information.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   sync/copy: copy a directory from source remote to destination remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:src” for the source

       • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:dst” for the destination

       • createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

       See  the  copy  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copy/) command for more information on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   sync/move: move a directory from source remote to destination remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:src” for the source

       • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:dst” for the destination

       • createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

       • deleteEmptySrcDirs - delete empty src directories if set

       See the move (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_move/) command for  more  information  on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   sync/sync: sync a directory from source remote to destination remote
       This takes the following parameters:

       • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:src” for the source

       • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. “drive:dst” for the destination

       • createEmptySrcDirs - create empty src directories on destination if set

       See  the  sync  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sync/) command for more information on
       the above.

       Authentication is required for this call.

   vfs/forget: Forget files or directories in the directory cache.
       This forgets the paths in the directory cache causing them to be re-read from  the  remote
       when needed.

       If no paths are passed in then it will forget all the paths in the directory cache.

              rclone rc vfs/forget

       Otherwise pass files or dirs in as file=path or dir=path.  Any parameter key starting with
       file will forget that file and any starting with dir will forget that dir, e.g.

              rclone rc vfs/forget file=hello file2=goodbye dir=home/junk

       This command takes an “fs” parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if  there  is
       only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more than one VFS in use then
       the “fs” parameter must be supplied.

   vfs/list: List active VFSes.
       This lists the active VFSes.

       It returns a list under the key “vfses” where the values are the VFS names that  could  be
       passed to the other VFS commands in the “fs” parameter.

   vfs/poll-interval: Get the status or update the value of the poll-interval option.
       Without any parameter given this returns the current status of the poll-interval setting.

       When  the  interval=duration  parameter is set, the poll-interval value is updated and the
       polling function is notified.  Setting interval=0 disables poll-interval.

              rclone rc vfs/poll-interval interval=5m

       The timeout=duration parameter can be used to specify a time to wait for the current  poll
       function  to  apply  the  new value.  If timeout is less or equal 0, which is the default,
       wait indefinitely.

       The new poll-interval value will only be active when the timeout is not reached.

       If poll-interval is updated or disabled temporarily, some changes might not get picked  up
       by the polling function, depending on the used remote.

       This  command  takes an “fs” parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is
       only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more than one VFS in use then
       the “fs” parameter must be supplied.

   vfs/refresh: Refresh the directory cache.
       This reads the directories for the specified paths and freshens the directory cache.

       If no paths are passed in then it will refresh the root directory.

              rclone rc vfs/refresh

       Otherwise  pass  directories  in  as  dir=path.   Any parameter key starting with dir will
       refresh that directory, e.g.

              rclone rc vfs/refresh dir=home/junk dir2=data/misc

       If the parameter recursive=true is given the whole  directory  tree  will  get  refreshed.
       This refresh will use –fast-list if enabled.

       This  command  takes an “fs” parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is
       only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more than one VFS in use then
       the “fs” parameter must be supplied.

   vfs/stats: Stats for a VFS.
       This returns stats for the selected VFS.

              {
                  // Status of the disk cache - only present if --vfs-cache-mode > off
                  "diskCache": {
                      "bytesUsed": 0,
                      "erroredFiles": 0,
                      "files": 0,
                      "hashType": 1,
                      "outOfSpace": false,
                      "path": "/home/user/.cache/rclone/vfs/local/mnt/a",
                      "pathMeta": "/home/user/.cache/rclone/vfsMeta/local/mnt/a",
                      "uploadsInProgress": 0,
                      "uploadsQueued": 0
                  },
                  "fs": "/mnt/a",
                  "inUse": 1,
                  // Status of the in memory metadata cache
                  "metadataCache": {
                      "dirs": 1,
                      "files": 0
                  },
                  // Options as returned by options/get
                  "opt": {
                      "CacheMaxAge": 3600000000000,
                      // ...
                      "WriteWait": 1000000000
                  }
              }

       This  command  takes an “fs” parameter.  If this parameter is not supplied and if there is
       only one VFS in use then that VFS will be used.  If there is more than one VFS in use then
       the “fs” parameter must be supplied.

   Accessing the remote control via HTTP
       Rclone implements a simple HTTP based protocol.

       Each  endpoint  takes  an  JSON  object  and  returns a JSON object or an error.  The JSON
       objects are essentially a map of string names to values.

       All calls must made using POST.

       The input objects can be supplied using URL parameters, POST parameters  or  by  supplying
       “Content-Type: application/json” and a JSON blob in the body.  There are examples of these
       below using curl.

       The response will be a JSON blob in the body of the response.  This  is  formatted  to  be
       reasonably human-readable.

   Error returns
       If  an error occurs then there will be an HTTP error status (e.g. 500) and the body of the
       response will contain a JSON encoded error object, e.g.

              {
                  "error": "Expecting string value for key \"remote\" (was float64)",
                  "input": {
                      "fs": "/tmp",
                      "remote": 3
                  },
                  "status": 400
                  "path": "operations/rmdir",
              }

       The keys in the error response are - error - error string - input - the  input  parameters
       to the call - status - the HTTP status code - path - the path of the call

   CORS
       The  sever implements basic CORS support and allows all origins for that.  The response to
       a preflight OPTIONS request will echo the requested “Access-Control-Request-Headers” back.

   Using POST with URL parameters only
              curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?potato=1&sausage=2'

       Response

              {
                  "potato": "1",
                  "sausage": "2"
              }

       Here is what an error response looks like:

              curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'

              {
                  "error": "arbitrary error on input map[potato:1 sausage:2]",
                  "input": {
                      "potato": "1",
                      "sausage": "2"
                  }
              }

       Note that curl doesn’t return errors to the shell unless you use the -f option

              $ curl -f -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'
              curl: (22) The requested URL returned error: 400 Bad Request
              $ echo $?
              22

   Using POST with a form
              curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

       Response

              {
                  "potato": "1",
                  "sausage": "2"
              }

       Note that you can combine these with URL parameters too with the  POST  parameters  taking
       precedence.

              curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" "http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&sausage=4"

       Response

              {
                  "potato": "1",
                  "rutabaga": "3",
                  "sausage": "4"
              }

   Using POST with a JSON blob
              curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

       response

              {
                  "password": "xyz",
                  "username": "xyz"
              }

       This can be combined with URL parameters too if required.  The JSON blob takes precedence.

              curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&potato=4'

              {
                  "potato": 2,
                  "rutabaga": "3",
                  "sausage": 1
              }

   Debugging rclone with pprof
       If  you  use  the --rc flag this will also enable the use of the go profiling tools on the
       same port.

       To use these, first install go (https://golang.org/doc/install).

   Debugging memory use
       To profile rclone’s memory use you can run:

              go tool pprof -web http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap

       This should open a page in your browser showing what is using what memory.

       You can also use the -text flag to produce a textual summary

              $ go tool pprof -text http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap
              Showing nodes accounting for 1537.03kB, 100% of 1537.03kB total
                    flat  flat%   sum%        cum   cum%
               1024.03kB 66.62% 66.62%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.addDecoderNode
                   513kB 33.38%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.newBufioWriterSize
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/all.init
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve.init
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve/restic.init
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2.init
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init.0
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  main.init
                       0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).readRequest
                       0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).serve
                       0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  runtime.main

   Debugging go routine leaks
       Memory leaks are most often caused by go routine leaks keeping memory alive  which  should
       have been garbage collected.

       See all active go routines using

              curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1

       Or go to http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1 in your browser.

   Other profiles to look at
       You can see a summary of profiles available at http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/

       Here is how to use some of them:

       • Memory: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap

       • Go routines: curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1

       • 30-second CPU profile: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/profile

       • 5-second execution trace: wget http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/trace?seconds=5

       • Goroutine blocking profile

         • Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-block-profile-rate rate=1 (docs)

         • go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block

       • Contended mutexes:

         • Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction rate=1 (docs)

         • go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

       See  the net/http/pprof docs (https://golang.org/pkg/net/http/pprof/) for more info on how
       to use the profiling and for a general overview see the Go team’s blog post  on  profiling
       go programs (https://blog.golang.org/profiling-go-programs).

       The      profiling     hook     is     zero     overhead     unless     it     is     used
       (https://stackoverflow.com/q/26545159/164234).

Overview of cloud storage systems

       Each cloud storage system is slightly different.  Rclone attempts  to  provide  a  unified
       interface to them, but some underlying differences show through.

   Features
       Here is an overview of the major features of each cloud storage system.

       Name                     Hash      ModTime    Case           Duplicate     MIME    Metadata
                                                     Insensitive    Files         Type
       ────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       1Fichier              Whirlpool       -           No            Yes         R          -
       Akamai Netstorage    MD5, SHA256     R/W          No            No          R          -
       Amazon Drive             MD5          -           Yes           No          R          -
       Amazon S3  (or  S3       MD5         R/W          No            No         R/W        RWU
       compatible)
       Backblaze B2             SHA1        R/W          No            No         R/W         -
       Box                      SHA1        R/W          Yes           No          -          -
       Citrix ShareFile         MD5         R/W          Yes           No          -          -
       Dropbox                DBHASH ¹       R           Yes           No          -          -
       Enterprise    File        -          R/W          Yes           No         R/W         -
       Fabric
       FTP                       -         R/W ¹⁰        No            No          -          -
       Google       Cloud       MD5         R/W          No            No         R/W         -
       Storage
       Google Drive             MD5         R/W          No            Yes        R/W         -
       Google Photos             -           -           No            Yes         R          -
       HDFS                      -          R/W          No            No          -          -
       HiDrive               HiDrive ¹²     R/W          No            No          -          -
       HTTP                      -           R           No            No          R          -
       Internet Archive     MD5,  SHA1,    R/W ¹¹        No            No          -         RWU
                            CRC32
       Jottacloud               MD5         R/W          Yes           No          R          -
       Koofr                    MD5          -           Yes           No          -          -
       Mail.ru Cloud          Mailru ⁶      R/W          Yes           No          -          -
       Mega                      -           -           No            Yes         -          -
       Memory                   MD5         R/W          No            No          -          -
       Microsoft    Azure       MD5         R/W          No            No         R/W         -
       Blob Storage
       Microsoft OneDrive      SHA1 ⁵       R/W          Yes           No          R          -
       OpenDrive                MD5         R/W          Yes        Partial ⁸      -          -
       OpenStack Swift          MD5         R/W          No            No         R/W         -
       Oracle      Object       MD5         R/W          No            No         R/W         -
       Storage
       pCloud               MD5, SHA1 ⁷      R           No            No          W          -
       premiumize.me             -           -           Yes           No          R          -
       put.io                  CRC-32       R/W          No            Yes         R          -
       QingStor                 MD5         - ⁹          No            No         R/W         -
       Seafile                   -           -           No            No          -          -
       SFTP                 MD5, SHA1 ²     R/W        Depends         No          -          -
       Sia                       -           -           No            No          -          -
       SMB                       -           -           Yes           No          -          -
       SugarSync                 -           -           No            No          -          -
       Storj                     -           R           No            No          -          -
       Uptobox                   -           -           No            Yes         -          -
       WebDAV               MD5, SHA1 ³     R ⁴        Depends         No          -          -
       Yandex Disk              MD5         R/W          No            No          R          -
       Zoho WorkDrive            -           -           No            No          -          -
       The          local       All         R/W        Depends         No          -         RWU
       filesystem

   Notes
       ¹          Dropbox          supports          its          own         custom         hash
       (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/reference/content-hash).  This is an SHA256 sum of all
       the 4 MiB block SHA256s.

       ² SFTP supports checksums if the same login has shell access and md5sum or sha1sum as well
       as echo are in the remote’s PATH.

       ³ WebDAV supports hashes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

       ⁴ WebDAV supports modtimes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

       ⁵ Microsoft OneDrive Personal supports SHA1 hashes,  whereas  OneDrive  for  business  and
       SharePoint  server  support  Microsoft’s  own QuickXorHash (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-
       us/onedrive/developer/code-snippets/quickxorhash).

       ⁶ Mail.ru uses its own modified SHA1 hash

       ⁷ pCloud only supports SHA1 (not MD5) in its EU region

       ⁸ Opendrive does not support creation of duplicate files using their web client  interface
       or  other  stock clients, but the underlying storage platform has been determined to allow
       duplicate files, and it is possible to create them with rclone.  It may be that this is  a
       mistake or an unsupported feature.

       ⁹ QingStor does not support SetModTime for objects bigger than 5 GiB.

       ¹⁰  FTP  supports  modtimes  for the major FTP servers, and also others if they advertised
       required protocol extensions.  See this (https://rclone.org/ftp/#modified-time)  for  more
       details.

       ¹¹  Internet  Archive  requires option wait_archive to be set to a non-zero value for full
       modtime support.

       ¹²  HiDrive  supports  its  own  custom  hash  (https://static.hidrive.com/dev/0001).   It
       combines SHA1 sums for each 4 KiB block hierarchically to a single top-level sum.

   Hash
       The  cloud storage system supports various hash types of the objects.  The hashes are used
       when transferring data as an integrity  check  and  can  be  specifically  used  with  the
       --checksum flag in syncs and in the check command.

       To  use  the  verify  checksums  when transferring between cloud storage systems they must
       support a common hash type.

   ModTime
       Almost all cloud storage systems store some sort of timestamp on objects, but  several  of
       them  not something that is appropriate to use for syncing.  E.g.  some backends will only
       write a timestamp that represent the time of the upload.  To be relevant  for  syncing  it
       should  be  able  to store the modification time of the source object.  If this is not the
       case, rclone will only check the file size by default, though can be configured  to  check
       the  file  hash  (with the --checksum flag).  Ideally it should also be possible to change
       the timestamp of an existing file without having to re-upload it.

       Storage systems with a - in the ModTime column, means the modification read on objects  is
       not  the modification time of the file when uploaded.  It is most likely the time the file
       was uploaded, or possibly something else (like the time the picture was  taken  in  Google
       Photos).

       Storage  systems  with  a  R  (for  read-only)  in  the ModTime column, means the it keeps
       modification times on objects, and updates them when uploading objects, but  it  does  not
       support  changing  only the modification time (SetModTime operation) without re-uploading,
       possibly not even without deleting existing first.  Some operations  in  rclone,  such  as
       copy  and  sync commands, will automatically check for SetModTime support and re-upload if
       necessary to keep the modification times in sync.  Other commands will  not  work  without
       SetModTime  support,  e.g. touch  command  on  an  existing file will fail, and changes to
       modification time only on a files in a mount will be silently ignored.

       Storage systems with R/W (for read/write) in  the  ModTime  column,  means  they  do  also
       support modtime-only operations.

   Case Insensitive
       If  a  cloud storage systems is case sensitive then it is possible to have two files which
       differ only in case, e.g. file.txt and FILE.txt.   If  a  cloud  storage  system  is  case
       insensitive then that isn’t possible.

       This  can  cause  problems  when  syncing  between  a  case  insensitive system and a case
       sensitive system.  The symptom of this is that no matter how many times you run  the  sync
       it never completes fully.

       The local filesystem and SFTP may or may not be case sensitive depending on OS.

       • Windows - usually case insensitive, though case is preserved

       • OSX - usually case insensitive, though it is possible to format case sensitive

       • Linux  -  usually  case sensitive, but there are case insensitive file systems (e.g. FAT
         formatted USB keys)

       Most of the time this doesn’t cause any problems as people tend to avoid files whose  name
       differs only by case even on case sensitive systems.

   Duplicate files
       If  a  cloud  storage  system allows duplicate files then it can have two objects with the
       same name.

       This confuses rclone greatly when syncing - use the rclone dedupe  command  to  rename  or
       remove duplicates.

   Restricted filenames
       Some  cloud  storage  systems might have restrictions on the characters that are usable in
       file or directory names.  When rclone detects such a name during a file  upload,  it  will
       transparently  replace  the restricted characters with similar looking Unicode characters.
       To handle the different sets of restricted characters for different backends, rclone  uses
       something it calls encoding.

       This  process  is  designed to avoid ambiguous file names as much as possible and allow to
       move files between many cloud storage systems transparently.

       The name shown by rclone to the user or during log output will only contain a minimal  set
       of  replaced  characters  to ensure correct formatting and not necessarily the actual name
       used on the cloud storage.

       This transformation is reversed when downloading a file or parsing rclone arguments.   For
       example,  when uploading a file named my file?.txt to Onedrive, it will be displayed as my
       file?.txt on the console, but stored as my file?.txt to Onedrive (the ?  gets replaced by
       the  similar  looking  character, the so-called “fullwidth question mark”).  The reverse
       transformation allows to read a file unusual/name.txt from Google Drive,  by  passing  the
       name  unusual/name.txt  on  the  command  line (the / needs to be replaced by the similar
       looking  character).

   Caveats
       The filename encoding system works well in most cases,  at  least  where  file  names  are
       written in English or similar languages.  You might not even notice it: It just works.  In
       some cases it may lead to issues, though.  E.g.  when file names are written  in  Chinese,
       or  Japanese,  where  it is always the Unicode fullwidth variants of the punctuation marks
       that are used.

       On Windows, the characters :, * and ? are examples of restricted characters.  If these are
       used  in filenames on a remote that supports it, Rclone will transparently convert them to
       their fullwidth Unicode variants ,  and  when downloading to Windows, and back again
       when  uploading.   This  way files with names that are not allowed on Windows can still be
       stored.

       However, if you have files on your Windows  system  originally  with  these  same  Unicode
       characters in their names, they will be included in the same conversion process.  E.g.  if
       you create a file in your Windows filesystem  with  name  Test:1.jpg,  where    is  the
       Unicode  fullwidth  colon  symbol,  and  use  rclone  to  upload it to Google Drive, which
       supports regular : (halfwidth question mark), rclone will replace the fullwidth : with the
       halfwidth  :  and  store  the  file as Test:1.jpg in Google Drive.  Since both Windows and
       Google Drive allows the name Test:1.jpg, it would probably be better if rclone just  kept
       the name as is in this case.

       With  the  opposite  situation; if you have a file named Test:1.jpg, in your Google Drive,
       e.g. uploaded from a Linux system where : is valid in file names.  Then later  use  rclone
       to copy this file to your Windows computer you will notice that on your local disk it gets
       renamed to Test:1.jpg.  The original filename is not legal on Windows, due to the :,  and
       rclone  therefore  renames it to make the copy possible.  That is all good.  However, this
       can also lead to an issue: If you already  had  a  different  file  named  Test:1.jpg  on
       Windows,  and  then  use  rclone  to  copy  either  way.   Rclone will then treat the file
       originally named Test:1.jpg on Google Drive and the file originally named  Test:1.jpg  on
       Windows as the same file, and replace the contents from one with the other.

       Its  virtually  impossible to handle all cases like these correctly in all situations, but
       by customizing the encoding option, changing the set  of  characters  that  rclone  should
       convert,  you  should  be able to create a configuration that works well for your specific
       situation.  See also the  example  (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding-example-windows)
       below.

       (Windows  was  used  as  an  example of a file system with many restricted characters, and
       Google drive a storage system with few.)

   Default restricted characters
       The table below shows the characters that are replaced by default.

       When a replacement character is found in a filename, this character will be  escaped  with
       the    character  to avoid ambiguous file names.  (e.g. a file named ␀.txt would shown as
       ‛␀.txt)

       Each cloud storage backend can use a different set of characters, which will be  specified
       in the documentation for each backend.

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       SOH         0x01         ␁
       STX         0x02         ␂
       ETX         0x03         ␃
       EOT         0x04         ␄
       ENQ         0x05         ␅
       ACK         0x06         ␆
       BEL         0x07         ␇
       BS          0x08         ␈
       HT          0x09         ␉
       LF          0x0A         ␊
       VT          0x0B         ␋
       FF          0x0C         ␌
       CR          0x0D         ␍
       SO          0x0E         ␎
       SI          0x0F         ␏
       DLE         0x10         ␐
       DC1         0x11         ␑
       DC2         0x12         ␒
       DC3         0x13         ␓
       DC4         0x14         ␔
       NAK         0x15         ␕
       SYN         0x16         ␖
       ETB         0x17         ␗
       CAN         0x18         ␘
       EM          0x19         ␙
       SUB         0x1A         ␚
       ESC         0x1B         ␛
       FS          0x1C         ␜
       GS          0x1D         ␝
       RS          0x1E         ␞
       US          0x1F         ␟
       /           0x2F        /
       DEL         0x7F         ␡

       The  default  encoding will also encode these file names as they are problematic with many
       cloud storage systems.

       File name   Replacement
       ────────────────────────
       .               .
       ..             ..

   Invalid UTF-8 bytes
       Some backends only support a sequence of well formed UTF-8  bytes  as  file  or  directory
       names.

       In  this case all invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced with a quoted representation of the
       byte value to allow uploading a file to such a backend.  For  example,  the  invalid  byte
       0xFE will be encoded as ‛FE.

       A  common  source  of  invalid  UTF-8  bytes  are local filesystems, that store names in a
       different  encoding  than  UTF-8  or  UTF-16,  like  latin1.   See  the  local   filenames
       (https://rclone.org/local/#filenames) section for details.

   Encoding option
       Most  backends  have  an  encoding  option,  specified  as a flag --backend-encoding where
       backend is the name of the backend, or as a config  parameter  encoding  (you’ll  need  to
       select the Advanced config in rclone config to see it).

       This  will  have  default  value  which encodes and decodes characters in such a way as to
       preserve the maximum number of characters (see above).

       However this can be incorrect in some scenarios, for example if you have  a  Windows  file
       system  with  Unicode  fullwidth characters ,  or , that you want to remain as those
       characters on the remote rather than being translated to regular (halfwidth) *, ? and :.

       The --backend-encoding flags allow you to change  that.   You  can  disable  the  encoding
       completely with --backend-encoding None or set encoding = None in the config file.

       Encoding  takes a comma separated list of encodings.  You can see the list of all possible
       values by passing an invalid  value  to  this  flag,  e.g. --local-encoding  "help".   The
       command rclone help flags encoding will show you the defaults for the backends.

       Encoding                 Characters                 Encoded as
       ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       Asterisk                 *                          
       BackQuote                `                          
       BackSlash                \                          
       Colon                    :                          
       CrLf                     CR 0x0D, LF 0x0A           , 
       Ctl                      All  control  characters   ␀␁␂␃␄␅␆␇␈␉␊␋␌␍␎␏␐␑␒␓␔␕␖␗␘␙␚␛␜␝␞␟
                                0x00-0x1F
       Del                      DEL 0x7F                   
       Dollar                   $                          
       Dot                      . or .. as entire string   , ..
       DoubleQuote              "                          
       Hash                     #                          
       InvalidUtf8              An     invalid     UTF-8   
                                character (e.g. latin1)
       LeftCrLfHtVt             CR  0x0D,  LF  0x0A,  HT   , , , 
                                0x09,  VT  0x0B  on  the
                                left of a string
       LeftPeriod               .  on  the  left  of   a   .
                                string
       LeftSpace                SPACE  on  the left of a   
                                string
       LeftTilde                ~  on  the  left  of   a   
                                string
       LtGt                     <, >                       , 
       None                     No     characters    are
                                encoded
       Percent                  %                          
       Pipe                     |                          
       Question                 ?                          
       RightCrLfHtVt            CR  0x0D,  LF  0x0A,  HT   , , , 
                                0x09,  VT  0x0B  on  the
                                right of a string
       RightPeriod              .  on  the  right  of  a   .
                                string
       RightSpace               SPACE  on the right of a   
                                string
       Semicolon                ;                          
       SingleQuote              '                          
       Slash                    /                          
       SquareBracket            [, ]                       , 

   Encoding example: FTP
       To take a specific example, the FTP backend’s default encoding is

              --ftp-encoding "Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot"

       However, let’s say the FTP server is running on Windows and can’t have any of the  invalid
       Windows  characters  in  file  names.  You are backing up Linux servers to this FTP server
       which do have those characters in file names.  So you would add the Windows set which are

              Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

       to the existing ones, giving:

              Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot,Del,RightSpace

       This can be specified using the --ftp-encoding flag or using an encoding parameter in  the
       config file.

   Encoding example: Windows
       As  a  nother  example, take a Windows system where there is a file with name Test:1.jpg,
       where  is the Unicode fullwidth colon symbol.  When using  rclone  to  copy  this  to  a
       remote  which  supports  :, the regular (halfwidth) colon (such as Google Drive), you will
       notice that the file gets renamed to Test:1.jpg.

       To avoid this you can change the set of characters rclone should  convert  for  the  local
       filesystem,  using  command-line  argument --local-encoding.  Rclone’s default behavior on
       Windows corresponds to

              --local-encoding "Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot"

       If you want to use fullwidth characters ,  and  in  your  filenames  without  rclone
       changing  them  when  uploading  to  a  remote, then set the same as the default value but
       without Colon,Question,Asterisk:

              --local-encoding "Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot"

       Alternatively, you can disable the conversion  of  any  characters  with  --local-encoding
       None.

       Instead  of  using  command-line  argument  --local-encoding,  you  may  also  set  it  as
       environment           variable            (https://rclone.org/docs/#environment-variables)
       RCLONE_LOCAL_ENCODING,  or configure (https://rclone.org/docs/#configure) a remote of type
       local in your config, and set the encoding option there.

       The risk by doing this is that if you have a filename with the regular  (halfwidth)  :,  *
       and  ?  in your cloud storage, and you try to download it to your Windows filesystem, this
       will fail.  These characters are not valid in filenames on  Windows,  and  you  have  told
       rclone not to work around this by converting them to valid fullwidth variants.

   MIME Type
       MIME  types  (also  known  as media types) classify types of documents using a simple text
       classification, e.g. text/html or application/pdf.

       Some cloud storage systems support reading (R) the MIME type of objects and  some  support
       writing (W) the MIME type of objects.

       The  MIME type can be important if you are serving files directly to HTTP from the storage
       system.

       If you are copying from a remote which supports reading (R) to  a  remote  which  supports
       writing (W) then rclone will preserve the MIME types.  Otherwise they will be guessed from
       the extension, or the remote itself may assign the MIME type.

   Metadata
       Backends may or may support reading or writing metadata.  They  may  support  reading  and
       writing system metadata (metadata intrinsic to that backend) and/or user metadata (general
       purpose metadata).

       The levels of metadata support are

       Key                   Explanation
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       R                     Read only System Metadata
       RW                    Read and write System Metadata
       RWU                   Read and write System Metadata and read  and  write
                             User Metadata

       See the metadata docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) for more info.

   Optional Features
       All  rclone  remotes  support  a  base  command  set.  Other features depend upon backend-
       specific capabilities.

       Name                Purge   Copy   Move   DirMove   CleanUp   ListR   StreamUpload   LinkSharing   About   EmptyDir
       ────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       1Fichier             No     Yes    Yes      No        No       No          No            Yes        No       Yes
       Akamai Netstorage    Yes     No     No      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         No       Yes
       Amazon Drive         Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No          No            No         No       Yes
       Amazon S3 (or  S3    No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes        Yes            Yes        No        No
       compatible)
       Backblaze B2         No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes        Yes            Yes        No        No
       Box                  Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes     Yes ‡‡     No         Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Citrix ShareFile     Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         No       Yes
       Dropbox              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Enterprise   File    Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No          No            No         No       Yes
       Fabric
       FTP                  No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         No       Yes
       Google      Cloud    Yes    Yes     No      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         No        No
       Storage
       Google Drive         Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes        Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Google Photos        No      No     No      No        No       No          No            No         No        No
       HDFS                 Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         Yes      Yes
       HiDrive              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         No       Yes
       HTTP                 No      No     No      No        No       No          No            No         No       Yes
       Internet Archive     No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes         No            Yes        Yes       No
       Jottacloud           Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes         No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Koofr                Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Mail.ru Cloud        Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No          No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Mega                 Yes     No    Yes      Yes       Yes      No          No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Memory               No     Yes     No      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         No        No
       Microsoft   Azure    Yes    Yes     No      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         No        No
       Blob Storage
       Microsoft            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No          No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       OneDrive
       OpenDrive            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No          No            No         No       Yes
       OpenStack Swift     Yes †   Yes     No      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         Yes       No
       Oracle     Object    No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes        Yes            No         No        No
       Storage
       pCloud               Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No          No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       premiumize.me        Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No          No            Yes        Yes      Yes
       put.io               Yes     No    Yes      Yes       Yes      No         Yes            No         Yes      Yes
       QingStor             No     Yes     No      No        Yes      Yes         No            No         No        No
       Seafile              Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      Yes        Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       SFTP                 No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         Yes      Yes
       Sia                  No      No     No      No        No       No         Yes            No         No       Yes
       SMB                  No      No    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         No       Yes
       SugarSync            Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            Yes        No       Yes
       Storj               Yes †    No    Yes      No        No       Yes        Yes            No         No        No
       Uptobox              No     Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No          No            No         No        No
       WebDAV               Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No        Yes ‡           No         Yes      Yes
       Yandex Disk          Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       Yes      No         Yes            Yes        Yes      Yes
       Zoho WorkDrive       Yes    Yes    Yes      Yes       No       No          No            No         Yes      Yes
       The         local    Yes     No    Yes      Yes       No       No         Yes            No         Yes      Yes
       filesystem

   Purge
       This deletes a directory quicker than just deleting all the files in the directory.

       †  Note Swift and Storj implement this in order to delete directory markers but they don’t
       actually have a quicker way of deleting files other than deleting them individually.

       ‡ StreamUpload is not supported with Nextcloud

   Copy
       Used when copying an object to and from the same remote.  This known as a server-side copy
       so  you  can copy a file without downloading it and uploading it again.  It is used if you
       use rclone copy or rclone move if the remote doesn’t support Move directly.

       If the server doesn’t  support  Copy  directly  then  for  copy  operations  the  file  is
       downloaded then re-uploaded.

   Move
       Used  when  moving/renaming  an object on the same remote.  This is known as a server-side
       move of a file.  This is used in rclone move if the server doesn’t support DirMove.

       If the server isn’t capable of Move then rclone simulates it with Copy  then  delete.   If
       the server doesn’t support Copy then rclone will download the file and re-upload it.

   DirMove
       This  is  used to implement rclone move to move a directory if possible.  If it isn’t then
       it will use Move on each file (which falls back to Copy then download  and  upload  -  see
       Move section).

   CleanUp
       This is used for emptying the trash for a remote by rclone cleanup.

       If the server can’t do CleanUp then rclone cleanup will return an error.

       ‡‡ Note that while Box implements this it has to delete every file individually so it will
       be slower than emptying the trash via the WebUI

   ListR
       The remote supports a recursive list to list all the contents beneath a directory quickly.
       This    enables    the    --fast-list    flag    to    work.     See   the   rclone   docs
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more details.

   StreamUpload
       Some remotes allow files to be uploaded without knowing the file size  in  advance.   This
       allows  certain  operations  to  work  without  spooling  the  file  to  local disk first,
       e.g. rclone rcat.

   LinkSharing
       Sets the necessary permissions on a file or folder and prints a link that allows others to
       access them, even if they don’t have an account on the particular cloud provider.

   About
       Rclone  about  prints quota information for a remote.  Typical output includes bytes used,
       free, quota and in trash.

       If a remote lacks about capability rclone about remote:returns an error.

       Backends without about capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount, or  use
       policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See rclone about command (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

   EmptyDir
       The       remote       supports       empty       directories.        See      Limitations
       (https://rclone.org/bugs/#limitations) for details.  Most Object/Bucket-based  remotes  do
       not support this.

Global Flags

       This  describes  the global flags available to every rclone command split into two groups,
       non backend and backend flags.

   Non Backend Flags
       These flags are available for every command.

                    --ask-password                         Allow prompt for password for encrypted configuration (default true)
                    --auto-confirm                         If enabled, do not request console confirmation
                    --backup-dir string                    Make backups into hierarchy based in DIR
                    --bind string                          Local address to bind to for outgoing connections, IPv4, IPv6 or name
                    --buffer-size SizeSuffix               In memory buffer size when reading files for each --transfer (default 16Mi)
                    --bwlimit BwTimetable                  Bandwidth limit in KiB/s, or use suffix B|K|M|G|T|P or a full timetable
                    --bwlimit-file BwTimetable             Bandwidth limit per file in KiB/s, or use suffix B|K|M|G|T|P or a full timetable
                    --ca-cert string                       CA certificate used to verify servers
                    --cache-dir string                     Directory rclone will use for caching (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone")
                    --check-first                          Do all the checks before starting transfers
                    --checkers int                         Number of checkers to run in parallel (default 8)
                -c, --checksum                             Skip based on checksum (if available) & size, not mod-time & size
                    --client-cert string                   Client SSL certificate (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
                    --client-key string                    Client SSL private key (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
                    --compare-dest stringArray             Include additional comma separated server-side paths during comparison
                    --config string                        Config file (default "$HOME/.config/rclone/rclone.conf")
                    --contimeout duration                  Connect timeout (default 1m0s)
                    --copy-dest stringArray                Implies --compare-dest but also copies files from paths into destination
                    --cpuprofile string                    Write cpu profile to file
                    --cutoff-mode string                   Mode to stop transfers when reaching the max transfer limit HARD|SOFT|CAUTIOUS (default "HARD")
                    --delete-after                         When synchronizing, delete files on destination after transferring (default)
                    --delete-before                        When synchronizing, delete files on destination before transferring
                    --delete-during                        When synchronizing, delete files during transfer
                    --delete-excluded                      Delete files on dest excluded from sync
                    --disable string                       Disable a comma separated list of features (use --disable help to see a list)
                    --disable-http-keep-alives             Disable HTTP keep-alives and use each connection once.
                    --disable-http2                        Disable HTTP/2 in the global transport
                -n, --dry-run                              Do a trial run with no permanent changes
                    --dscp string                          Set DSCP value to connections, value or name, e.g. CS1, LE, DF, AF21
                    --dump DumpFlags                       List of items to dump from: headers,bodies,requests,responses,auth,filters,goroutines,openfiles
                    --dump-bodies                          Dump HTTP headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info
                    --dump-headers                         Dump HTTP headers - may contain sensitive info
                    --error-on-no-transfer                 Sets exit code 9 if no files are transferred, useful in scripts
                    --exclude stringArray                  Exclude files matching pattern
                    --exclude-from stringArray             Read exclude patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
                    --exclude-if-present stringArray       Exclude directories if filename is present
                    --expect-continue-timeout duration     Timeout when using expect / 100-continue in HTTP (default 1s)
                    --fast-list                            Use recursive list if available; uses more memory but fewer transactions
                    --files-from stringArray               Read list of source-file names from file (use - to read from stdin)
                    --files-from-raw stringArray           Read list of source-file names from file without any processing of lines (use - to read from stdin)
                -f, --filter stringArray                   Add a file-filtering rule
                    --filter-from stringArray              Read filtering patterns from a file (use - to read from stdin)
                    --fs-cache-expire-duration duration    Cache remotes for this long (0 to disable caching) (default 5m0s)
                    --fs-cache-expire-interval duration    Interval to check for expired remotes (default 1m0s)
                    --header stringArray                   Set HTTP header for all transactions
                    --header-download stringArray          Set HTTP header for download transactions
                    --header-upload stringArray            Set HTTP header for upload transactions
                    --human-readable                       Print numbers in a human-readable format, sizes with suffix Ki|Mi|Gi|Ti|Pi
                    --ignore-case                          Ignore case in filters (case insensitive)
                    --ignore-case-sync                     Ignore case when synchronizing
                    --ignore-checksum                      Skip post copy check of checksums
                    --ignore-errors                        Delete even if there are I/O errors
                    --ignore-existing                      Skip all files that exist on destination
                    --ignore-size                          Ignore size when skipping use mod-time or checksum
                -I, --ignore-times                         Don't skip files that match size and time - transfer all files
                    --immutable                            Do not modify files, fail if existing files have been modified
                    --include stringArray                  Include files matching pattern
                    --include-from stringArray             Read include patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
                -i, --interactive                          Enable interactive mode
                    --kv-lock-time duration                Maximum time to keep key-value database locked by process (default 1s)
                    --log-file string                      Log everything to this file
                    --log-format string                    Comma separated list of log format options (default "date,time")
                    --log-level string                     Log level DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "NOTICE")
                    --log-systemd                          Activate systemd integration for the logger
                    --low-level-retries int                Number of low level retries to do (default 10)
                    --max-age Duration                     Only transfer files younger than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
                    --max-backlog int                      Maximum number of objects in sync or check backlog (default 10000)
                    --max-delete int                       When synchronizing, limit the number of deletes (default -1)
                    --max-depth int                        If set limits the recursion depth to this (default -1)
                    --max-duration duration                Maximum duration rclone will transfer data for
                    --max-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files smaller than this in KiB or suffix B|K|M|G|T|P (default off)
                    --max-stats-groups int                 Maximum number of stats groups to keep in memory, on max oldest is discarded (default 1000)
                    --max-transfer SizeSuffix              Maximum size of data to transfer (default off)
                    --memprofile string                    Write memory profile to file
                -M, --metadata                             If set, preserve metadata when copying objects
                    --metadata-set stringArray             Add metadata key=value when uploading
                    --min-age Duration                     Only transfer files older than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
                    --min-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files bigger than this in KiB or suffix B|K|M|G|T|P (default off)
                    --modify-window duration               Max time diff to be considered the same (default 1ns)
                    --multi-thread-cutoff SizeSuffix       Use multi-thread downloads for files above this size (default 250Mi)
                    --multi-thread-streams int             Max number of streams to use for multi-thread downloads (default 4)
                    --no-check-certificate                 Do not verify the server SSL certificate (insecure)
                    --no-check-dest                        Don't check the destination, copy regardless
                    --no-console                           Hide console window (supported on Windows only)
                    --no-gzip-encoding                     Don't set Accept-Encoding: gzip
                    --no-traverse                          Don't traverse destination file system on copy
                    --no-unicode-normalization             Don't normalize unicode characters in filenames
                    --no-update-modtime                    Don't update destination mod-time if files identical
                    --order-by string                      Instructions on how to order the transfers, e.g. 'size,descending'
                    --password-command SpaceSepList        Command for supplying password for encrypted configuration
                -P, --progress                             Show progress during transfer
                    --progress-terminal-title              Show progress on the terminal title (requires -P/--progress)
                -q, --quiet                                Print as little stuff as possible
                    --rc                                   Enable the remote control server
                    --rc-addr string                       IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to (default "localhost:5572")
                    --rc-allow-origin string               Set the allowed origin for CORS
                    --rc-baseurl string                    Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root
                    --rc-cert string                       SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
                    --rc-client-ca string                  Client certificate authority to verify clients with
                    --rc-enable-metrics                    Enable prometheus metrics on /metrics
                    --rc-files string                      Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server
                    --rc-htpasswd string                   htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
                    --rc-job-expire-duration duration      Expire finished async jobs older than this value (default 1m0s)
                    --rc-job-expire-interval duration      Interval to check for expired async jobs (default 10s)
                    --rc-key string                        SSL PEM Private key
                    --rc-max-header-bytes int              Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
                    --rc-min-tls-version string            Minimum TLS version that is acceptable (default "tls1.0")
                    --rc-no-auth                           Don't require auth for certain methods
                    --rc-pass string                       Password for authentication
                    --rc-realm string                      Realm for authentication (default "rclone")
                    --rc-serve                             Enable the serving of remote objects
                    --rc-server-read-timeout duration      Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --rc-server-write-timeout duration     Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
                    --rc-template string                   User-specified template
                    --rc-user string                       User name for authentication
                    --rc-web-fetch-url string              URL to fetch the releases for webgui (default "https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest")
                    --rc-web-gui                           Launch WebGUI on localhost
                    --rc-web-gui-force-update              Force update to latest version of web gui
                    --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser           Don't open the browser automatically
                    --rc-web-gui-update                    Check and update to latest version of web gui
                    --refresh-times                        Refresh the modtime of remote files
                    --retries int                          Retry operations this many times if they fail (default 3)
                    --retries-sleep duration               Interval between retrying operations if they fail, e.g. 500ms, 60s, 5m (0 to disable)
                    --server-side-across-configs           Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different configs
                    --size-only                            Skip based on size only, not mod-time or checksum
                    --stats duration                       Interval between printing stats, e.g. 500ms, 60s, 5m (0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
                    --stats-file-name-length int           Max file name length in stats (0 for no limit) (default 45)
                    --stats-log-level string               Log level to show --stats output DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "INFO")
                    --stats-one-line                       Make the stats fit on one line
                    --stats-one-line-date                  Enable --stats-one-line and add current date/time prefix
                    --stats-one-line-date-format string    Enable --stats-one-line-date and use custom formatted date: Enclose date string in double quotes ("), see https://golang.org/pkg/time/#Time.Format
                    --stats-unit string                    Show data rate in stats as either 'bits' or 'bytes' per second (default "bytes")
                    --streaming-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload if file size is unknown, upload starts after reaching cutoff or when file ends (default 100Ki)
                    --suffix string                        Suffix to add to changed files
                    --suffix-keep-extension                Preserve the extension when using --suffix
                    --syslog                               Use Syslog for logging
                    --syslog-facility string               Facility for syslog, e.g. KERN,USER,... (default "DAEMON")
                    --temp-dir string                      Directory rclone will use for temporary files (default "/tmp")
                    --timeout duration                     IO idle timeout (default 5m0s)
                    --tpslimit float                       Limit HTTP transactions per second to this
                    --tpslimit-burst int                   Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit (default 1)
                    --track-renames                        When synchronizing, track file renames and do a server-side move if possible
                    --track-renames-strategy string        Strategies to use when synchronizing using track-renames hash|modtime|leaf (default "hash")
                    --transfers int                        Number of file transfers to run in parallel (default 4)
                -u, --update                               Skip files that are newer on the destination
                    --use-cookies                          Enable session cookiejar
                    --use-json-log                         Use json log format
                    --use-mmap                             Use mmap allocator (see docs)
                    --use-server-modtime                   Use server modified time instead of object metadata
                    --user-agent string                    Set the user-agent to a specified string (default "rclone/v1.60.1")
                -v, --verbose count                        Print lots more stuff (repeat for more)

   Backend Flags
       These flags are available for every command.  They control the backends and may be set  in
       the config file.

                    --acd-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                    --acd-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                    --acd-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                    --acd-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --acd-templink-threshold SizeSuffix            Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink (default 9Gi)
                    --acd-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --acd-token-url string                         Token server url
                    --acd-upload-wait-per-gb Duration              Additional time per GiB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears (default 3m0s)
                    --alias-remote string                          Remote or path to alias
                    --azureblob-access-tier string                 Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive
                    --azureblob-account string                     Storage Account Name
                    --azureblob-archive-tier-delete                Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting
                    --azureblob-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Upload chunk size (default 4Mi)
                    --azureblob-disable-checksum                   Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                    --azureblob-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8)
                    --azureblob-endpoint string                    Endpoint for the service
                    --azureblob-key string                         Storage Account Key
                    --azureblob-list-chunk int                     Size of blob list (default 5000)
                    --azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time Duration    How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                    --azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap               Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                    --azureblob-msi-client-id string               Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                    --azureblob-msi-mi-res-id string               Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                    --azureblob-msi-object-id string               Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any
                    --azureblob-no-head-object                     If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects
                    --azureblob-public-access string               Public access level of a container: blob or container
                    --azureblob-sas-url string                     SAS URL for container level access only
                    --azureblob-service-principal-file string      Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal
                    --azureblob-upload-concurrency int             Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 16)
                    --azureblob-upload-cutoff string               Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256 MiB) (deprecated)
                    --azureblob-use-emulator                       Uses local storage emulator if provided as 'true'
                    --azureblob-use-msi                            Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure)
                    --b2-account string                            Account ID or Application Key ID
                    --b2-chunk-size SizeSuffix                     Upload chunk size (default 96Mi)
                    --b2-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                    Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4Gi)
                    --b2-disable-checksum                          Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files
                    --b2-download-auth-duration Duration           Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d (default 1w)
                    --b2-download-url string                       Custom endpoint for downloads
                    --b2-encoding MultiEncoder                     The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --b2-endpoint string                           Endpoint for the service
                    --b2-hard-delete                               Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files
                    --b2-key string                                Application Key
                    --b2-memory-pool-flush-time Duration           How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                    --b2-memory-pool-use-mmap                      Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                    --b2-test-mode string                          A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging
                    --b2-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                  Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                    --b2-version-at Time                           Show file versions as they were at the specified time (default off)
                    --b2-versions                                  Include old versions in directory listings
                    --box-access-token string                      Box App Primary Access Token
                    --box-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                    --box-box-config-file string                   Box App config.json location
                    --box-box-sub-type string                       (default "user")
                    --box-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                    --box-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                    --box-commit-retries int                       Max number of times to try committing a multipart file (default 100)
                    --box-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --box-list-chunk int                           Size of listing chunk 1-1000 (default 1000)
                    --box-owned-by string                          Only show items owned by the login (email address) passed in
                    --box-root-folder-id string                    Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point
                    --box-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --box-token-url string                         Token server url
                    --box-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                 Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50 MiB) (default 50Mi)
                    --cache-chunk-clean-interval Duration          How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage (default 1m0s)
                    --cache-chunk-no-memory                        Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming
                    --cache-chunk-path string                      Directory to cache chunk files (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
                    --cache-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  The size of a chunk (partial file data) (default 5Mi)
                    --cache-chunk-total-size SizeSuffix            The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk (default 10Gi)
                    --cache-db-path string                         Directory to store file structure metadata DB (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
                    --cache-db-purge                               Clear all the cached data for this remote on start
                    --cache-db-wait-time Duration                  How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited (default 1s)
                    --cache-info-age Duration                      How long to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.) (default 6h0m0s)
                    --cache-plex-insecure string                   Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server
                    --cache-plex-password string                   The password of the Plex user (obscured)
                    --cache-plex-url string                        The URL of the Plex server
                    --cache-plex-username string                   The username of the Plex user
                    --cache-read-retries int                       How many times to retry a read from a cache storage (default 10)
                    --cache-remote string                          Remote to cache
                    --cache-rps int                                Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable) (default -1)
                    --cache-tmp-upload-path string                 Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded
                    --cache-tmp-wait-time Duration                 How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded (default 15s)
                    --cache-workers int                            How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks (default 4)
                    --cache-writes                                 Cache file data on writes through the FS
                    --chunker-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks (default 2Gi)
                    --chunker-fail-hard                            Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks
                    --chunker-hash-type string                     Choose how chunker handles hash sums (default "md5")
                    --chunker-remote string                        Remote to chunk/unchunk
                    --combine-upstreams SpaceSepList               Upstreams for combining
                    --compress-level int                           GZIP compression level (-2 to 9) (default -1)
                    --compress-mode string                         Compression mode (default "gzip")
                    --compress-ram-cache-limit SizeSuffix          Some remotes don't allow the upload of files with unknown size (default 20Mi)
                    --compress-remote string                       Remote to compress
                -L, --copy-links                                   Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item
                    --crypt-directory-name-encryption              Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact (default true)
                    --crypt-filename-encoding string               How to encode the encrypted filename to text string (default "base32")
                    --crypt-filename-encryption string             How to encrypt the filenames (default "standard")
                    --crypt-no-data-encryption                     Option to either encrypt file data or leave it unencrypted
                    --crypt-password string                        Password or pass phrase for encryption (obscured)
                    --crypt-password2 string                       Password or pass phrase for salt (obscured)
                    --crypt-remote string                          Remote to encrypt/decrypt
                    --crypt-server-side-across-configs             Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different crypt configs
                    --crypt-show-mapping                           For all files listed show how the names encrypt
                    --drive-acknowledge-abuse                      Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded
                    --drive-allow-import-name-change               Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs
                    --drive-auth-owner-only                        Only consider files owned by the authenticated user
                    --drive-auth-url string                        Auth server URL
                    --drive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  Upload chunk size (default 8Mi)
                    --drive-client-id string                       Google Application Client Id
                    --drive-client-secret string                   OAuth Client Secret
                    --drive-copy-shortcut-content                  Server side copy contents of shortcuts instead of the shortcut
                    --drive-disable-http2                          Disable drive using http2 (default true)
                    --drive-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default InvalidUtf8)
                    --drive-export-formats string                  Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs (default "docx,xlsx,pptx,svg")
                    --drive-formats string                         Deprecated: See export_formats
                    --drive-impersonate string                     Impersonate this user when using a service account
                    --drive-import-formats string                  Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs
                    --drive-keep-revision-forever                  Keep new head revision of each file forever
                    --drive-list-chunk int                         Size of listing chunk 100-1000, 0 to disable (default 1000)
                    --drive-pacer-burst int                        Number of API calls to allow without sleeping (default 100)
                    --drive-pacer-min-sleep Duration               Minimum time to sleep between API calls (default 100ms)
                    --drive-resource-key string                    Resource key for accessing a link-shared file
                    --drive-root-folder-id string                  ID of the root folder
                    --drive-scope string                           Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive
                    --drive-server-side-across-configs             Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different drive configs
                    --drive-service-account-credentials string     Service Account Credentials JSON blob
                    --drive-service-account-file string            Service Account Credentials JSON file path
                    --drive-shared-with-me                         Only show files that are shared with me
                    --drive-size-as-quota                          Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size
                    --drive-skip-checksum-gphotos                  Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only
                    --drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts                If set skip dangling shortcut files
                    --drive-skip-gdocs                             Skip google documents in all listings
                    --drive-skip-shortcuts                         If set skip shortcut files
                    --drive-starred-only                           Only show files that are starred
                    --drive-stop-on-download-limit                 Make download limit errors be fatal
                    --drive-stop-on-upload-limit                   Make upload limit errors be fatal
                    --drive-team-drive string                      ID of the Shared Drive (Team Drive)
                    --drive-token string                           OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --drive-token-url string                       Token server url
                    --drive-trashed-only                           Only show files that are in the trash
                    --drive-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix               Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 8Mi)
                    --drive-use-created-date                       Use file created date instead of modified date
                    --drive-use-shared-date                        Use date file was shared instead of modified date
                    --drive-use-trash                              Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently (default true)
                    --drive-v2-download-min-size SizeSuffix        If Object's are greater, use drive v2 API to download (default off)
                    --dropbox-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                    --dropbox-batch-commit-timeout Duration        Max time to wait for a batch to finish committing (default 10m0s)
                    --dropbox-batch-mode string                    Upload file batching sync|async|off (default "sync")
                    --dropbox-batch-size int                       Max number of files in upload batch
                    --dropbox-batch-timeout Duration               Max time to allow an idle upload batch before uploading (default 0s)
                    --dropbox-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Upload chunk size (< 150Mi) (default 48Mi)
                    --dropbox-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                    --dropbox-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                    --dropbox-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --dropbox-impersonate string                   Impersonate this user when using a business account
                    --dropbox-shared-files                         Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files
                    --dropbox-shared-folders                       Instructs rclone to work on shared folders
                    --dropbox-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --dropbox-token-url string                     Token server url
                    --fichier-api-key string                       Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
                    --fichier-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --fichier-file-password string                 If you want to download a shared file that is password protected, add this parameter (obscured)
                    --fichier-folder-password string               If you want to list the files in a shared folder that is password protected, add this parameter (obscured)
                    --fichier-shared-folder string                 If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter
                    --filefabric-encoding MultiEncoder             The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --filefabric-permanent-token string            Permanent Authentication Token
                    --filefabric-root-folder-id string             ID of the root folder
                    --filefabric-token string                      Session Token
                    --filefabric-token-expiry string               Token expiry time
                    --filefabric-url string                        URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
                    --filefabric-version string                    Version read from the file fabric
                    --ftp-ask-password                             Allow asking for FTP password when needed
                    --ftp-close-timeout Duration                   Maximum time to wait for a response to close (default 1m0s)
                    --ftp-concurrency int                          Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited
                    --ftp-disable-epsv                             Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support
                    --ftp-disable-mlsd                             Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support
                    --ftp-disable-tls13                            Disable TLS 1.3 (workaround for FTP servers with buggy TLS)
                    --ftp-disable-utf8                             Disable using UTF-8 even if server advertises support
                    --ftp-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot)
                    --ftp-explicit-tls                             Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
                    --ftp-force-list-hidden                        Use LIST -a to force listing of hidden files and folders. This will disable the use of MLSD
                    --ftp-host string                              FTP host to connect to
                    --ftp-idle-timeout Duration                    Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                    --ftp-no-check-certificate                     Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server
                    --ftp-pass string                              FTP password (obscured)
                    --ftp-port int                                 FTP port number (default 21)
                    --ftp-shut-timeout Duration                    Maximum time to wait for data connection closing status (default 1m0s)
                    --ftp-tls                                      Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
                    --ftp-tls-cache-size int                       Size of TLS session cache for all control and data connections (default 32)
                    --ftp-user string                              FTP username (default "$USER")
                    --ftp-writing-mdtm                             Use MDTM to set modification time (VsFtpd quirk)
                    --gcs-anonymous                                Access public buckets and objects without credentials
                    --gcs-auth-url string                          Auth server URL
                    --gcs-bucket-acl string                        Access Control List for new buckets
                    --gcs-bucket-policy-only                       Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies
                    --gcs-client-id string                         OAuth Client Id
                    --gcs-client-secret string                     OAuth Client Secret
                    --gcs-decompress                               If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects
                    --gcs-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --gcs-endpoint string                          Endpoint for the service
                    --gcs-location string                          Location for the newly created buckets
                    --gcs-no-check-bucket                          If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                    --gcs-object-acl string                        Access Control List for new objects
                    --gcs-project-number string                    Project number
                    --gcs-service-account-file string              Service Account Credentials JSON file path
                    --gcs-storage-class string                     The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage
                    --gcs-token string                             OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --gcs-token-url string                         Token server url
                    --gphotos-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                    --gphotos-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                    --gphotos-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                    --gphotos-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --gphotos-include-archived                     Also view and download archived media
                    --gphotos-read-only                            Set to make the Google Photos backend read only
                    --gphotos-read-size                            Set to read the size of media items
                    --gphotos-start-year int                       Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year (default 2000)
                    --gphotos-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --gphotos-token-url string                     Token server url
                    --hasher-auto-size SizeSuffix                  Auto-update checksum for files smaller than this size (disabled by default)
                    --hasher-hashes CommaSepList                   Comma separated list of supported checksum types (default md5,sha1)
                    --hasher-max-age Duration                      Maximum time to keep checksums in cache (0 = no cache, off = cache forever) (default off)
                    --hasher-remote string                         Remote to cache checksums for (e.g. myRemote:path)
                    --hdfs-data-transfer-protection string         Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy
                    --hdfs-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --hdfs-namenode string                         Hadoop name node and port
                    --hdfs-service-principal-name string           Kerberos service principal name for the namenode
                    --hdfs-username string                         Hadoop user name
                    --hidrive-auth-url string                      Auth server URL
                    --hidrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                Chunksize for chunked uploads (default 48Mi)
                    --hidrive-client-id string                     OAuth Client Id
                    --hidrive-client-secret string                 OAuth Client Secret
                    --hidrive-disable-fetching-member-count        Do not fetch number of objects in directories unless it is absolutely necessary
                    --hidrive-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Dot)
                    --hidrive-endpoint string                      Endpoint for the service (default "https://api.hidrive.strato.com/2.1")
                    --hidrive-root-prefix string                   The root/parent folder for all paths (default "/")
                    --hidrive-scope-access string                  Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive (default "rw")
                    --hidrive-scope-role string                    User-level that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive (default "user")
                    --hidrive-token string                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --hidrive-token-url string                     Token server url
                    --hidrive-upload-concurrency int               Concurrency for chunked uploads (default 4)
                    --hidrive-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix             Cutoff/Threshold for chunked uploads (default 96Mi)
                    --http-headers CommaSepList                    Set HTTP headers for all transactions
                    --http-no-head                                 Don't use HEAD requests
                    --http-no-slash                                Set this if the site doesn't end directories with /
                    --http-url string                              URL of HTTP host to connect to
                    --internetarchive-access-key-id string         IAS3 Access Key
                    --internetarchive-disable-checksum             Don't ask the server to test against MD5 checksum calculated by rclone (default true)
                    --internetarchive-encoding MultiEncoder        The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,CrLf,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --internetarchive-endpoint string              IAS3 Endpoint (default "https://s3.us.archive.org")
                    --internetarchive-front-endpoint string        Host of InternetArchive Frontend (default "https://archive.org")
                    --internetarchive-secret-access-key string     IAS3 Secret Key (password)
                    --internetarchive-wait-archive Duration        Timeout for waiting the server's processing tasks (specifically archive and book_op) to finish (default 0s)
                    --jottacloud-encoding MultiEncoder             The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --jottacloud-hard-delete                       Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                    --jottacloud-md5-memory-limit SizeSuffix       Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required (default 10Mi)
                    --jottacloud-no-versions                       Avoid server side versioning by deleting files and recreating files instead of overwriting them
                    --jottacloud-trashed-only                      Only show files that are in the trash
                    --jottacloud-upload-resume-limit SizeSuffix    Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail's (default 10Mi)
                    --koofr-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --koofr-endpoint string                        The Koofr API endpoint to use
                    --koofr-mountid string                         Mount ID of the mount to use
                    --koofr-password string                        Your password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password) (obscured)
                    --koofr-provider string                        Choose your storage provider
                    --koofr-setmtime                               Does the backend support setting modification time (default true)
                    --koofr-user string                            Your user name
                -l, --links                                        Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a '.rclonelink' extension
                    --local-case-insensitive                       Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive
                    --local-case-sensitive                         Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive
                    --local-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Dot)
                    --local-no-check-updated                       Don't check to see if the files change during upload
                    --local-no-preallocate                         Disable preallocation of disk space for transferred files
                    --local-no-set-modtime                         Disable setting modtime
                    --local-no-sparse                              Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads
                    --local-nounc                                  Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows
                    --local-unicode-normalization                  Apply unicode NFC normalization to paths and filenames
                    --local-zero-size-links                        Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead) (deprecated)
                    --mailru-check-hash                            What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid (default true)
                    --mailru-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --mailru-pass string                           Password (obscured)
                    --mailru-speedup-enable                        Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash (default true)
                    --mailru-speedup-file-patterns string          Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash) (default "*.mkv,*.avi,*.mp4,*.mp3,*.zip,*.gz,*.rar,*.pdf")
                    --mailru-speedup-max-disk SizeSuffix           This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files (default 3Gi)
                    --mailru-speedup-max-memory SizeSuffix         Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk (default 32Mi)
                    --mailru-user string                           User name (usually email)
                    --mega-debug                                   Output more debug from Mega
                    --mega-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --mega-hard-delete                             Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                    --mega-pass string                             Password (obscured)
                    --mega-user string                             User name
                    --netstorage-account string                    Set the NetStorage account name
                    --netstorage-host string                       Domain+path of NetStorage host to connect to
                    --netstorage-protocol string                   Select between HTTP or HTTPS protocol (default "https")
                    --netstorage-secret string                     Set the NetStorage account secret/G2O key for authentication (obscured)
                -x, --one-file-system                              Don't cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only)
                    --onedrive-access-scopes SpaceSepList          Set scopes to be requested by rclone (default Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All Sites.Read.All offline_access)
                    --onedrive-auth-url string                     Auth server URL
                    --onedrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix               Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes) (default 10Mi)
                    --onedrive-client-id string                    OAuth Client Id
                    --onedrive-client-secret string                OAuth Client Secret
                    --onedrive-drive-id string                     The ID of the drive to use
                    --onedrive-drive-type string                   The type of the drive (personal | business | documentLibrary)
                    --onedrive-encoding MultiEncoder               The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --onedrive-expose-onenote-files                Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings
                    --onedrive-link-password string                Set the password for links created by the link command
                    --onedrive-link-scope string                   Set the scope of the links created by the link command (default "anonymous")
                    --onedrive-link-type string                    Set the type of the links created by the link command (default "view")
                    --onedrive-list-chunk int                      Size of listing chunk (default 1000)
                    --onedrive-no-versions                         Remove all versions on modifying operations
                    --onedrive-region string                       Choose national cloud region for OneDrive (default "global")
                    --onedrive-root-folder-id string               ID of the root folder
                    --onedrive-server-side-across-configs          Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different onedrive configs
                    --onedrive-token string                        OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --onedrive-token-url string                    Token server url
                    --oos-chunk-size SizeSuffix                    Chunk size to use for uploading (default 5Mi)
                    --oos-compartment string                       Object storage compartment OCID
                    --oos-config-file string                       Path to OCI config file (default "~/.oci/config")
                    --oos-config-profile string                    Profile name inside the oci config file (default "Default")
                    --oos-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                   Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4.656Gi)
                    --oos-copy-timeout Duration                    Timeout for copy (default 1m0s)
                    --oos-disable-checksum                         Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                    --oos-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --oos-endpoint string                          Endpoint for Object storage API
                    --oos-leave-parts-on-error                     If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery
                    --oos-namespace string                         Object storage namespace
                    --oos-no-check-bucket                          If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                    --oos-provider string                          Choose your Auth Provider (default "env_auth")
                    --oos-region string                            Object storage Region
                    --oos-upload-concurrency int                   Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 10)
                    --oos-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                 Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                    --opendrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Files will be uploaded in chunks this size (default 10Mi)
                    --opendrive-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --opendrive-password string                    Password (obscured)
                    --opendrive-username string                    Username
                    --pcloud-auth-url string                       Auth server URL
                    --pcloud-client-id string                      OAuth Client Id
                    --pcloud-client-secret string                  OAuth Client Secret
                    --pcloud-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --pcloud-hostname string                       Hostname to connect to (default "api.pcloud.com")
                    --pcloud-password string                       Your pcloud password (obscured)
                    --pcloud-root-folder-id string                 Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point (default "d0")
                    --pcloud-token string                          OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --pcloud-token-url string                      Token server url
                    --pcloud-username string                       Your pcloud username
                    --premiumizeme-encoding MultiEncoder           The encoding for the backend (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --putio-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --qingstor-access-key-id string                QingStor Access Key ID
                    --qingstor-chunk-size SizeSuffix               Chunk size to use for uploading (default 4Mi)
                    --qingstor-connection-retries int              Number of connection retries (default 3)
                    --qingstor-encoding MultiEncoder               The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                    --qingstor-endpoint string                     Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API
                    --qingstor-env-auth                            Get QingStor credentials from runtime
                    --qingstor-secret-access-key string            QingStor Secret Access Key (password)
                    --qingstor-upload-concurrency int              Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 1)
                    --qingstor-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix            Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                    --qingstor-zone string                         Zone to connect to
                    --s3-access-key-id string                      AWS Access Key ID
                    --s3-acl string                                Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects
                    --s3-bucket-acl string                         Canned ACL used when creating buckets
                    --s3-chunk-size SizeSuffix                     Chunk size to use for uploading (default 5Mi)
                    --s3-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                    Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4.656Gi)
                    --s3-decompress                                If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects
                    --s3-disable-checksum                          Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
                    --s3-disable-http2                             Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends
                    --s3-download-url string                       Custom endpoint for downloads
                    --s3-encoding MultiEncoder                     The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --s3-endpoint string                           Endpoint for S3 API
                    --s3-env-auth                                  Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars)
                    --s3-force-path-style                          If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style (default true)
                    --s3-leave-parts-on-error                      If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery
                    --s3-list-chunk int                            Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request) (default 1000)
                    --s3-list-url-encode Tristate                  Whether to url encode listings: true/false/unset (default unset)
                    --s3-list-version int                          Version of ListObjects to use: 1,2 or 0 for auto
                    --s3-location-constraint string                Location constraint - must be set to match the Region
                    --s3-max-upload-parts int                      Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload (default 10000)
                    --s3-memory-pool-flush-time Duration           How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed (default 1m0s)
                    --s3-memory-pool-use-mmap                      Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool
                    --s3-might-gzip Tristate                       Set this if the backend might gzip objects (default unset)
                    --s3-no-check-bucket                           If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
                    --s3-no-head                                   If set, don't HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity
                    --s3-no-head-object                            If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects
                    --s3-no-system-metadata                        Suppress setting and reading of system metadata
                    --s3-profile string                            Profile to use in the shared credentials file
                    --s3-provider string                           Choose your S3 provider
                    --s3-region string                             Region to connect to
                    --s3-requester-pays                            Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket
                    --s3-secret-access-key string                  AWS Secret Access Key (password)
                    --s3-server-side-encryption string             The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
                    --s3-session-token string                      An AWS session token
                    --s3-shared-credentials-file string            Path to the shared credentials file
                    --s3-sse-customer-algorithm string             If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
                    --s3-sse-customer-key string                   To use SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data
                    --s3-sse-customer-key-base64 string            If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key encoded in base64 format to encrypt/decrypt your data
                    --s3-sse-customer-key-md5 string               If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional)
                    --s3-sse-kms-key-id string                     If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key
                    --s3-storage-class string                      The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3
                    --s3-upload-concurrency int                    Concurrency for multipart uploads (default 4)
                    --s3-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                  Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200Mi)
                    --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint                   If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint
                    --s3-use-multipart-etag Tristate               Whether to use ETag in multipart uploads for verification (default unset)
                    --s3-use-presigned-request                     Whether to use a presigned request or PutObject for single part uploads
                    --s3-v2-auth                                   If true use v2 authentication
                    --s3-version-at Time                           Show file versions as they were at the specified time (default off)
                    --s3-versions                                  Include old versions in directory listings
                    --seafile-2fa                                  Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
                    --seafile-create-library                       Should rclone create a library if it doesn't exist
                    --seafile-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                    --seafile-library string                       Name of the library
                    --seafile-library-key string                   Library password (for encrypted libraries only) (obscured)
                    --seafile-pass string                          Password (obscured)
                    --seafile-url string                           URL of seafile host to connect to
                    --seafile-user string                          User name (usually email address)
                    --sftp-ask-password                            Allow asking for SFTP password when needed
                    --sftp-chunk-size SizeSuffix                   Upload and download chunk size (default 32Ki)
                    --sftp-concurrency int                         The maximum number of outstanding requests for one file (default 64)
                    --sftp-disable-concurrent-reads                If set don't use concurrent reads
                    --sftp-disable-concurrent-writes               If set don't use concurrent writes
                    --sftp-disable-hashcheck                       Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available
                    --sftp-host string                             SSH host to connect to
                    --sftp-idle-timeout Duration                   Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                    --sftp-key-file string                         Path to PEM-encoded private key file
                    --sftp-key-file-pass string                    The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file (obscured)
                    --sftp-key-pem string                          Raw PEM-encoded private key
                    --sftp-key-use-agent                           When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent
                    --sftp-known-hosts-file string                 Optional path to known_hosts file
                    --sftp-md5sum-command string                   The command used to read md5 hashes
                    --sftp-pass string                             SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent (obscured)
                    --sftp-path-override string                    Override path used by SSH shell commands
                    --sftp-port int                                SSH port number (default 22)
                    --sftp-pubkey-file string                      Optional path to public key file
                    --sftp-server-command string                   Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host
                    --sftp-set-env SpaceSepList                    Environment variables to pass to sftp and commands
                    --sftp-set-modtime                             Set the modified time on the remote if set (default true)
                    --sftp-sha1sum-command string                  The command used to read sha1 hashes
                    --sftp-shell-type string                       The type of SSH shell on remote server, if any
                    --sftp-skip-links                              Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files
                    --sftp-subsystem string                        Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host (default "sftp")
                    --sftp-use-fstat                               If set use fstat instead of stat
                    --sftp-use-insecure-cipher                     Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods
                    --sftp-user string                             SSH username (default "$USER")
                    --sharefile-chunk-size SizeSuffix              Upload chunk size (default 64Mi)
                    --sharefile-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --sharefile-endpoint string                    Endpoint for API calls
                    --sharefile-root-folder-id string              ID of the root folder
                    --sharefile-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix           Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (default 128Mi)
                    --sia-api-password string                      Sia Daemon API Password (obscured)
                    --sia-api-url string                           Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980 (default "http://127.0.0.1:9980")
                    --sia-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --sia-user-agent string                        Siad User Agent (default "Sia-Agent")
                    --skip-links                                   Don't warn about skipped symlinks
                    --smb-case-insensitive                         Whether the server is configured to be case-insensitive (default true)
                    --smb-domain string                            Domain name for NTLM authentication (default "WORKGROUP")
                    --smb-encoding MultiEncoder                    The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --smb-hide-special-share                       Hide special shares (e.g. print$) which users aren't supposed to access (default true)
                    --smb-host string                              SMB server hostname to connect to
                    --smb-idle-timeout Duration                    Max time before closing idle connections (default 1m0s)
                    --smb-pass string                              SMB password (obscured)
                    --smb-port int                                 SMB port number (default 445)
                    --smb-user string                              SMB username (default "$USER")
                    --storj-access-grant string                    Access grant
                    --storj-api-key string                         API key
                    --storj-passphrase string                      Encryption passphrase
                    --storj-provider string                        Choose an authentication method (default "existing")
                    --storj-satellite-address string               Satellite address (default "us-central-1.storj.io")
                    --sugarsync-access-key-id string               Sugarsync Access Key ID
                    --sugarsync-app-id string                      Sugarsync App ID
                    --sugarsync-authorization string               Sugarsync authorization
                    --sugarsync-authorization-expiry string        Sugarsync authorization expiry
                    --sugarsync-deleted-id string                  Sugarsync deleted folder id
                    --sugarsync-encoding MultiEncoder              The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --sugarsync-hard-delete                        Permanently delete files if true
                    --sugarsync-private-access-key string          Sugarsync Private Access Key
                    --sugarsync-refresh-token string               Sugarsync refresh token
                    --sugarsync-root-id string                     Sugarsync root id
                    --sugarsync-user string                        Sugarsync user
                    --swift-application-credential-id string       Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID)
                    --swift-application-credential-name string     Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME)
                    --swift-application-credential-secret string   Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET)
                    --swift-auth string                            Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL)
                    --swift-auth-token string                      Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
                    --swift-auth-version int                       AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
                    --swift-chunk-size SizeSuffix                  Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container (default 5Gi)
                    --swift-domain string                          User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
                    --swift-encoding MultiEncoder                  The encoding for the backend (default Slash,InvalidUtf8)
                    --swift-endpoint-type string                   Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE) (default "public")
                    --swift-env-auth                               Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form
                    --swift-key string                             API key or password (OS_PASSWORD)
                    --swift-leave-parts-on-error                   If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure
                    --swift-no-chunk                               Don't chunk files during streaming upload
                    --swift-no-large-objects                       Disable support for static and dynamic large objects
                    --swift-region string                          Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
                    --swift-storage-policy string                  The storage policy to use when creating a new container
                    --swift-storage-url string                     Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
                    --swift-tenant string                          Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
                    --swift-tenant-domain string                   Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
                    --swift-tenant-id string                       Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
                    --swift-user string                            User name to log in (OS_USERNAME)
                    --swift-user-id string                         User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID)
                    --union-action-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category (default "epall")
                    --union-cache-time int                         Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds) (default 120)
                    --union-create-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category (default "epmfs")
                    --union-min-free-space SizeSuffix              Minimum viable free space for lfs/eplfs policies (default 1Gi)
                    --union-search-policy string                   Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category (default "ff")
                    --union-upstreams string                       List of space separated upstreams
                    --uptobox-access-token string                  Your access token
                    --uptobox-encoding MultiEncoder                The encoding for the backend (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,BackQuote,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --webdav-bearer-token string                   Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
                    --webdav-bearer-token-command string           Command to run to get a bearer token
                    --webdav-encoding string                       The encoding for the backend
                    --webdav-headers CommaSepList                  Set HTTP headers for all transactions
                    --webdav-pass string                           Password (obscured)
                    --webdav-url string                            URL of http host to connect to
                    --webdav-user string                           User name
                    --webdav-vendor string                         Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using
                    --yandex-auth-url string                       Auth server URL
                    --yandex-client-id string                      OAuth Client Id
                    --yandex-client-secret string                  OAuth Client Secret
                    --yandex-encoding MultiEncoder                 The encoding for the backend (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
                    --yandex-hard-delete                           Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash
                    --yandex-token string                          OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --yandex-token-url string                      Token server url
                    --zoho-auth-url string                         Auth server URL
                    --zoho-client-id string                        OAuth Client Id
                    --zoho-client-secret string                    OAuth Client Secret
                    --zoho-encoding MultiEncoder                   The encoding for the backend (default Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
                    --zoho-region string                           Zoho region to connect to
                    --zoho-token string                            OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob
                    --zoho-token-url string                        Token server url

Docker Volume Plugin

   Introduction
       Docker      1.9      has      added     support     for     creating     named     volumes
       (https://docs.docker.com/storage/volumes/)        via        command-line        interface
       (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/volume_create/) and mounting them in
       containers as a way to share data between them.  Since Docker 1.10 you  can  create  named
       volumes  with Docker Compose (https://docs.docker.com/compose/) by descriptions in docker-
       compose.yml         (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v2/#volume-
       configuration-reference) files for use by container groups on a single host.  As of Docker
       1.12 volumes are  supported  by  Docker  Swarm  (https://docs.docker.com/engine/swarm/key-
       concepts/)  included  with Docker Engine and created from descriptions in swarm compose v3
       (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v3/#volume-configuration-
       reference) files for use with swarm stacks across multiple cluster nodes.

       Docker  Volume Plugins (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/plugins_volume/) augment the
       default local volume driver  included  in  Docker  with  stateful  volumes  shared  across
       containers  and  hosts.   Unlike  local  volumes,  your data will not be deleted when such
       volume is removed.  Plugins can run managed by the  docker  daemon,  as  a  native  system
       service (under systemd, sysv or upstart) or as a standalone executable.  Rclone can run as
       docker volume plugin in all these modes.  It interacts with the local  docker  daemon  via
       plugin  API  (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/plugin_api/)  and  handles mounting of
       remote file systems into docker containers so it must run on the same host as  the  docker
       daemon or on every Swarm node.

   Getting started
       In  the  first  example we will use the SFTP (https://rclone.org/sftp/) rclone volume with
       Docker engine on a standalone Ubuntu machine.

       Start from installing Docker (https://docs.docker.com/engine/install/) on the host.

       The FUSE driver is a prerequisite for rclone mounting and should be installed on host:

              sudo apt-get -y install fuse

       Create two directories required by rclone docker plugin:

              sudo mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config
              sudo mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache

       Install the managed rclone docker plugin for your architecture (here amd64):

              docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 args="-v" --alias rclone --grant-all-permissions
              docker plugin list

       Create your SFTP volume (https://rclone.org/sftp/#standard-options):

              docker volume create firstvolume -d rclone -o type=sftp -o sftp-host=_hostname_ -o sftp-user=_username_ -o sftp-pass=_password_ -o allow-other=true

       Note that since all options are static, you don’t even have to run rclone config or create
       the  rclone.conf file (but the config directory should still be present).  In the simplest
       case you can use localhost as hostname and your SSH credentials as username and  password.
       You  can  also  change  the remote path to your home directory on the host, for example -o
       path=/home/username.

       Time to create a test container and mount the volume into it:

              docker run --rm -it -v firstvolume:/mnt --workdir /mnt ubuntu:latest bash

       If all goes well, you will enter the new container and change right to  the  mounted  SFTP
       remote.   You  can  type ls to list the mounted directory or otherwise play with it.  Type
       exit when you are done.  The container will stop but the volume will  stay,  ready  to  be
       reused.  When it’s not needed anymore, remove it:

              docker volume list
              docker volume remove firstvolume

       Now  let  us try something more elaborate: Google Drive (https://rclone.org/drive/) volume
       on multi-node Docker Swarm.

       You should start  from  installing  Docker  and  FUSE,  creating  plugin  directories  and
       installing    rclone    plugin    on   every   swarm   node.    Then   setup   the   Swarm
       (https://docs.docker.com/engine/swarm/swarm-mode/).

       Google Drive volumes need an access token which can be setup via web browser and  will  be
       periodically  renewed by rclone.  The managed plugin cannot run a browser so we will use a
       technique    similar     to     the     rclone     setup     on     a     headless     box
       (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/).

       Run  rclone  config (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/) on another machine
       equipped with web browser and graphical user interface.  Create the  Google  Drive  remote
       (https://rclone.org/drive/#standard-options).    When   done,   transfer   the   resulting
       rclone.conf    to    the    Swarm     cluster     and     save     as     /var/lib/docker-
       plugins/rclone/config/rclone.conf  on  every node.  By default this location is accessible
       only to the root user so you will need appropriate privileges.  The resulting config  will
       look like this:

              [gdrive]
              type = drive
              scope = drive
              drive_id = 1234567...
              root_folder_id = 0Abcd...
              token = {"access_token":...}

       Now create the file named example.yml with a swarm stack description like this:

              version: '3'
              services:
                heimdall:
                  image: linuxserver/heimdall:latest
                  ports: [8080:80]
                  volumes: [configdata:/config]
              volumes:
                configdata:
                  driver: rclone
                  driver_opts:
                    remote: 'gdrive:heimdall'
                    allow_other: 'true'
                    vfs_cache_mode: full
                    poll_interval: 0

       and run the stack:

              docker stack deploy example -c ./example.yml

       After  a  few seconds docker will spread the parsed stack description over cluster, create
       the example_heimdall service on port 8080, run service containers on one or  more  cluster
       nodes  and  request  the  example_configdata volume from rclone plugins on the node hosts.
       You can use the following commands to confirm results:

              docker service ls
              docker service ps example_heimdall
              docker volume ls

       Point your browser to http://cluster.host.address:8080 and play with the service.  Stop it
       with  docker  stack  remove  example  when you are done.  Note that the example_configdata
       volume(s) created on demand at  the  cluster  nodes  will  not  be  automatically  removed
       together  with  the  stack  but  stay  for  future reuse.  You can remove them manually by
       invoking the docker volume remove example_configdata command on every node.

   Creating Volumes via CLI
       Volumes       can       be       created       with       docker       volume       create
       (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/volume_create/).   Here  are  a  few
       examples:

              docker volume create vol1 -d rclone -o remote=storj: -o vfs-cache-mode=full
              docker volume create vol2 -d rclone -o remote=:storj,access_grant=xxx:heimdall
              docker volume create vol3 -d rclone -o type=storj -o path=heimdall -o storj-access-grant=xxx -o poll-interval=0

       Note the -d rclone flag that tells docker to request volume from the rclone driver.   This
       works  even  if  you installed managed driver by its full name rclone/docker-volume-rclone
       because you provided the --alias rclone option.

       Volumes can be inspected as follows:

              docker volume list
              docker volume inspect vol1

   Volume Configuration
       Rclone flags and volume options are set via the  -o  flag  to  the  docker  volume  create
       command.  They include backend-specific parameters as well as mount and VFS options.  Also
       there are a few special -o options: remote, fs, type, path, mount-type and persist.

       remote determines an existing remote name from the config file, with  trailing  colon  and
       optionally  with  a  remote  path.   See  the  full  syntax  in  the  rclone documentation
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#syntax-of-remote-paths).  This option can be aliased  as  fs  to
       prevent confusion with the remote parameter of such backends as crypt or alias.

       The  remote=:backend:dir/subdir  syntax  can  be  used  to create on-the-fly (config-less)
       remotes (https://rclone.org/docs/#backend-path-to-dir), while the type  and  path  options
       provide a simpler alternative for this.  Using two split options

              -o type=backend -o path=dir/subdir

       is equivalent to the combined syntax

              -o remote=:backend:dir/subdir

       but is arguably easier to parameterize in scripts.  The path part is optional.

       Mount  and  VFS options (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/#options) as well
       as backend parameters (https://rclone.org/flags/#backend-flags) are named like their  twin
       command-line  flags without the -- CLI prefix.  Optionally you can use underscores instead
       of dashes in option names.  For  example,  --vfs-cache-mode  full  becomes  -o  vfs-cache-
       mode=full  or  -o vfs_cache_mode=full.  Boolean CLI flags without value will gain the true
       value, e.g.  --allow-other becomes -o allow-other=true or -o allow_other=true.

       Please note that you can provide parameters only for the backend immediately referenced by
       the  backend type of mounted remote.  If this is a wrapping backend like alias, chunker or
       crypt, you cannot provide options for the referred to remote or backend.  This  limitation
       is  imposed by the rclone connection string parser.  The only workaround is to feed plugin
       with rclone.conf or configure plugin arguments (see below).

   Special Volume Options
       mount-type determines the mount method and in general can be one  of:  mount,  cmount,  or
       mount2.   This  can  be aliased as mount_type.  It should be noted that the managed rclone
       docker plugin currently does not support the cmount method and mount2  is  rarely  needed.
       This  option  defaults  to the first found method, which is usually mount so you generally
       won’t need it.

       persist is a reserved boolean (true/false) option.  In future it will allow to persist on-
       the-fly remotes in the plugin rclone.conf file.

   Connection Strings
       The      remote      value     can     be     extended     with     connection     strings
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings) as an  alternative  way  to  supply  backend
       parameters.   This  is equivalent to the -o backend options with one syntactic difference.
       Inside connection string the backend prefix must be dropped from parameter  names  but  in
       the  -o  param=value array it must be present.  For instance, compare the following option
       array

              -o remote=:sftp:/home -o sftp-host=localhost

       with equivalent connection string:

              -o remote=:sftp,host=localhost:/home

       This difference exists because flag options -o key=val include not only backend parameters
       but  also mount/VFS flags and possibly other settings.  Also it allows to discriminate the
       remote option from the crypt-remote (or similarly named backend parameters)  and  arguably
       simplifies scripting due to clearer value substitution.

   Using with Swarm or Compose
       Both        Docker        Swarm        and       Docker       Compose       use       YAML
       (http://yaml.org/spec/1.2/spec.html)-formatted text files to describe groups  (stacks)  of
       containers,  their  properties,  networks  and  volumes.   Compose  uses  the  compose  v2
       (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-file-v2/#volume-configuration-
       reference)  format,  Swarm  uses  the compose v3 (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-
       file/compose-file-v3/#volume-configuration-reference) format.  They  are  mostly  similar,
       differences        are       explained       in       the       docker       documentation
       (https://docs.docker.com/compose/compose-file/compose-versioning/#upgrading).

       Volumes are described by the children of the top-level volumes: node.  Each of them should
       be  named  after  its  volume and have at least two elements, the self-explanatory driver:
       rclone value and the driver_opts: structure playing the same role as -o key=val CLI flags:

              volumes:
                volume_name_1:
                  driver: rclone
                  driver_opts:
                    remote: 'gdrive:'
                    allow_other: 'true'
                    vfs_cache_mode: full
                    token: '{"type": "borrower", "expires": "2021-12-31"}'
                    poll_interval: 0

       Notice a few important details: - YAML prefers _ in option names instead  of  -.   -  YAML
       treats  single and double quotes interchangeably.  Simple strings and integers can be left
       unquoted.  - Boolean values must be quoted like 'true' or "false" because these two  words
       are  reserved  by  YAML.   -  The  filesystem  string  is  keyed with remote (or with fs).
       Normally you can omit quotes here, but if the string ends with colon, you  must  quote  it
       like  remote:  "storage_box:".  - YAML is picky about surrounding braces in values as this
       is       in       fact       another       syntax       for       key/value       mappings
       (http://yaml.org/spec/1.2/spec.html#id2790832).   For  example, JSON access tokens usually
       contain double quotes and surrounding braces, so you must put them in single quotes.

   Installing as Managed Plugin
       Docker daemon can install plugins from  an  image  registry  and  run  them  managed.   We
       maintain  the docker-volume-rclone (https://hub.docker.com/p/rclone/docker-volume-rclone/)
       plugin image on Docker Hub (https://hub.docker.com).

       Rclone volume plugin requires Docker Engine >= 19.03.15

       The plugin requires presence of two directories on the host before it  can  be  installed.
       Note  that  plugin will not create them automatically.  By default they must exist on host
       at  the  following  locations  (though  you  can  tweak  the  paths):  -  /var/lib/docker-
       plugins/rclone/config  is  reserved for the rclone.conf config file and must exist even if
       it’s empty and the config file is  not  present.   -  /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache
       holds the plugin state file as well as optional VFS caches.

       You                can                install                managed                plugin
       (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/plugin_install/)    with     default
       settings as follows:

              docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 --grant-all-permissions --alias rclone

       The  :amd64 part of the image specification after colon is called a tag.  Usually you will
       want to install the latest plugin for your architecture.  In this case the tag  will  just
       name  it, like amd64 above.  The following plugin architectures are currently available: -
       amd64 - arm64 - arm-v7

       Sometimes you might want a concrete plugin version, not the latest one.  Then  you  should
       use  image  tag in the form :ARCHITECTURE-VERSION.  For example, to install plugin version
       v1.56.2 on architecture arm64 you will use tag arm64-1.56.2 (note the removed  v)  so  the
       full image specification becomes rclone/docker-volume-rclone:arm64-1.56.2.

       We  also  provide  the  latest  plugin  tag,  but  since  docker  does  not support multi-
       architecture plugins as of the time of this writing, this tag is currently  an  alias  for
       amd64.   By  convention  the  latest  tag is the default one and can be omitted, thus both
       rclone/docker-volume-rclone:latest and just rclone/docker-volume-rclone will refer to  the
       latest plugin release for the amd64 platform.

       Also  the  amd64  part can be omitted from the versioned rclone plugin tags.  For example,
       rclone image reference  rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64-1.56.2  can  be  abbreviated  as
       rclone/docker-volume-rclone:1.56.2  for convenience.  However, for non-intel architectures
       you still have to use the full tag as amd64 or latest will fail to start.

       Managed plugin is in fact a special container running in a namespace separate from  normal
       docker  containers.  Inside it runs the rclone serve docker command.  The config and cache
       directories are bind-mounted into the container at start.  The docker daemon connects to a
       unix  socket  created  by the command inside the container.  The command creates on-demand
       remote mounts right inside, then docker machinery propagates  them  through  kernel  mount
       namespaces and bind-mounts into requesting user containers.

       You  can  tweak  a few plugin settings after installation when it’s disabled (not in use),
       for instance:

              docker plugin disable rclone
              docker plugin set rclone RCLONE_VERBOSE=2 config=/etc/rclone args="--vfs-cache-mode=writes --allow-other"
              docker plugin enable rclone
              docker plugin inspect rclone

       Note that if docker refuses to disable the plugin, you should find and remove  all  active
       volumes connected with it as well as containers and swarm services that use them.  This is
       rather tedious so please carefully plan in advance.

       You can tweak the  following  settings:  args,  config,  cache,  HTTP_PROXY,  HTTPS_PROXY,
       NO_PROXY  and RCLONE_VERBOSE.  It’s your task to keep plugin settings in sync across swarm
       cluster nodes.

       args sets command-line arguments for the rclone serve docker command  (none  by  default).
       Arguments  should be separated by space so you will normally want to put them in quotes on
       the docker plugin  set  (https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/plugin_set/)
       command            line.             Both           serve           docker           flags
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/#options)  and   generic   rclone   flags
       (https://rclone.org/flags/)  are supported, including backend parameters that will be used
       as defaults for volume creation.  Note that plugin will  fail  (due  to  this  docker  bug
       (https://github.com/moby/moby/blob/v20.10.7/plugin/v2/plugin.go#L195))  if  the args value
       is empty.  Use e.g. args="-v" as a workaround.

       config=/host/dir sets alternative host location for the  config  directory.   Plugin  will
       look  for  rclone.conf  here.  It’s not an error if the config file is not present but the
       directory must exist.  Please note that plugin can periodically rewrite the  config  file,
       for  example  when  it  renews  storage access tokens.  Keep this in mind and try to avoid
       races between the plugin and other instances of rclone on  the  host  that  might  try  to
       change  the  config  simultaneously  resulting in corrupted rclone.conf.  You can also put
       stuff like private key files for SFTP remotes in this  directory.   Just  note  that  it’s
       bind-mounted  inside  the  plugin  container  at  the  predefined  path /data/config.  For
       example, if your key file is named sftp-box1.key on the  host,  the  corresponding  volume
       config option should read -o sftp-key-file=/data/config/sftp-box1.key.

       cache=/host/dir  sets  alternative host location for the cache directory.  The plugin will
       keep VFS caches here.  Also it will create and maintain the  docker-plugin.state  file  in
       this directory.  When the plugin is restarted or reinstalled, it will look in this file to
       recreate any volumes that existed previously.  However, they will not be  re-mounted  into
       consuming  containers  after  restart.  Usually this is not a problem as the docker daemon
       normally will restart affected user containers after failures,  daemon  restarts  or  host
       reboots.

       RCLONE_VERBOSE  sets  plugin  verbosity from 0 (errors only, by default) to 2 (debugging).
       Verbosity can be also tweaked via args="-v [-v] ...".  Since arguments are  more  generic,
       you  will  rarely need this setting.  The plugin output by default feeds the docker daemon
       log on local host.  Log entries are reflected as errors in the docker log but retain their
       actual level assigned by rclone in the encapsulated message string.

       HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY, NO_PROXY customize the plugin proxy settings.

       You can set custom plugin options right when you install it, in one go:

              docker plugin remove rclone
              docker plugin install rclone/docker-volume-rclone:amd64 \
                     --alias rclone --grant-all-permissions \
                     args="-v --allow-other" config=/etc/rclone
              docker plugin inspect rclone

   Healthchecks
       The  docker  plugin volume protocol doesn’t provide a way for plugins to inform the docker
       daemon that a volume is (un-)available.  As a workaround you can setup  a  healthcheck  to
       verify that the mount is responding, for example:

              services:
                my_service:
                  image: my_image
                  healthcheck:
                    test: ls /path/to/rclone/mount || exit 1
                    interval: 1m
                    timeout: 15s
                    retries: 3
                    start_period: 15s

   Running Plugin under Systemd
       In  most cases you should prefer managed mode.  Moreover, MacOS and Windows do not support
       native Docker plugins.  Please use managed mode on these systems.  Proceed further only if
       you are on Linux.

       First,  install  rclone  (https://rclone.org/install/).   You can just run it (type rclone
       serve docker and hit enter) for the test.

       Install FUSE:

              sudo apt-get -y install fuse

       Download     two     systemd     configuration     files:     docker-volume-rclone.service
       (https://raw.githubusercontent.com/rclone/rclone/master/contrib/docker-
       plugin/systemd/docker-volume-rclone.service)        and        docker-volume-rclone.socket
       (https://raw.githubusercontent.com/rclone/rclone/master/contrib/docker-
       plugin/systemd/docker-volume-rclone.socket).

       Put them to the /etc/systemd/system/ directory:

              cp docker-volume-plugin.service /etc/systemd/system/
              cp docker-volume-plugin.socket  /etc/systemd/system/

       Please note that all commands in this section must be run as root but we omit sudo  prefix
       for brevity.  Now create directories required by the service:

              mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-volumes/rclone
              mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/config
              mkdir -p /var/lib/docker-plugins/rclone/cache

       Run the docker plugin service in the socket activated mode:

              systemctl daemon-reload
              systemctl start docker-volume-rclone.service
              systemctl enable docker-volume-rclone.socket
              systemctl start docker-volume-rclone.socket
              systemctl restart docker

       Or  run  the  service  directly:  - run systemctl daemon-reload to let systemd pick up new
       config - run systemctl enable docker-volume-rclone.service to make the new  service  start
       automatically  when  you  power  on  your  machine.   - run systemctl start docker-volume-
       rclone.service to start the service now.  - run systemctl restart docker to restart docker
       daemon  and  let  it  detect  the new plugin socket.  Note that this step is not needed in
       managed mode where docker knows about plugin state changes.

       The two methods are equivalent from the user perspective, but I personally  prefer  socket
       activation.

   Troubleshooting
       You  can  see  managed  plugin settings (https://docs.docker.com/engine/extend/#debugging-
       plugins) with

              docker plugin list
              docker plugin inspect rclone

       Note that docker (including latest 20.10.7) will not show actual values of args, just  the
       defaults.

       Use  journalctl  --unit  docker  to see managed plugin output as part of the docker daemon
       log.  Note that docker reflects plugin lines as errors but their actual level can be  seen
       from encapsulated message string.

       You  will usually install the latest version of managed plugin for your platform.  Use the
       following commands to print the actual installed version:

              PLUGID=$(docker plugin list --no-trunc | awk '/rclone/{print$1}')
              sudo runc --root /run/docker/runtime-runc/plugins.moby exec $PLUGID rclone version

       You can even use runc to run shell inside the plugin container:

              sudo runc --root /run/docker/runtime-runc/plugins.moby exec --tty $PLUGID bash

       Also you can use curl to check the plugin socket connectivity:

              docker plugin list --no-trunc
              PLUGID=123abc...
              sudo curl -H Content-Type:application/json -XPOST -d {} --unix-socket /run/docker/plugins/$PLUGID/rclone.sock http://localhost/Plugin.Activate

       though this is rarely needed.

   Caveats
       Finally I’d like to mention a caveat with updating volume settings.  Docker CLI  does  not
       have  a  dedicated command like docker volume update.  It may be tempting to invoke docker
       volume create with updated options on existing volume, but there is a gotcha.  The command
       will  do  nothing, it won’t even return an error.  I hope that docker maintainers will fix
       this some day.  In the  meantime  be  aware  that  you  must  remove  your  volume  before
       recreating it with new settings:

              docker volume remove my_vol
              docker volume create my_vol -d rclone -o opt1=new_val1 ...

       and verify that settings did update:

              docker volume list
              docker volume inspect my_vol

       If  docker refuses to remove the volume, you should find containers or swarm services that
       use it and stop them first.

   Getting started
       • Install rclone (https://rclone.org/install/) and setup your remotes.

       • Bisync  will  create  its  working  directory  at  ~/.cache/rclone/bisync  on  Linux  or
         C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\Local\rclone\bisync  on  Windows.  Make sure that this location
         is writable.

       • Run bisync with the --resync flag, specifying the paths to the  local  and  remote  sync
         directory roots.

       • For successive sync runs, leave off the --resync flag.

       • Consider  using  a filters file for excluding unnecessary files and directories from the
         sync.

       • Consider setting up the –check-access feature for safety.

       • On Linux, consider setting up a crontab entry.  bisync can safely run in concurrent cron
         jobs thanks to lock files it maintains.

       Here is a typical run log (with timestamps removed for clarity):

              rclone bisync /testdir/path1/ /testdir/path2/ --verbose
              INFO  : Synching Path1 "/testdir/path1/" with Path2 "/testdir/path2/"
              INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
              INFO  : - Path1    File is new                         - file11.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file2.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file5.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File is newer                       - file7.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file4.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file6.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    File was deleted                    - file8.txt
              INFO  : Path1:    7 changes:    1 new,    3 newer,    0 older,    3 deleted
              INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
              INFO  : - Path2    File is new                         - file10.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file1.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file5.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File is newer                       - file6.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file3.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file7.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    File was deleted                    - file8.txt
              INFO  : Path2:    7 changes:    1 new,    3 newer,    0 older,    3 deleted
              INFO  : Applying changes
              INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file11.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file2.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    Queue delete                        - /testdir/path2/file4.txt
              NOTICE: - WARNING  New or changed in both paths        - file5.txt
              NOTICE: - Path1    Renaming Path1 copy                 - /testdir/path1/file5.txt..path1
              NOTICE: - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file5.txt..path1
              NOTICE: - Path2    Renaming Path2 copy                 - /testdir/path2/file5.txt..path2
              NOTICE: - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file5.txt..path2
              INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file6.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - /testdir/path2/file7.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file1.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    Queue copy to Path1                 - /testdir/path1/file10.txt
              INFO  : - Path1    Queue delete                        - /testdir/path1/file3.txt
              INFO  : - Path2    Do queued copies to                 - Path1
              INFO  : - Path1    Do queued copies to                 - Path2
              INFO  : -          Do queued deletes on                - Path1
              INFO  : -          Do queued deletes on                - Path2
              INFO  : Updating listings
              INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/testdir/path1/" vs Path2 "/testdir/path2/"
              INFO  : Bisync successful

   Command line syntax
              $ rclone bisync --help
              Usage:
                rclone bisync remote1:path1 remote2:path2 [flags]

              Positional arguments:
                Path1, Path2  Local path, or remote storage with ':' plus optional path.
                              Type 'rclone listremotes' for list of configured remotes.

              Optional Flags:
                    --check-access            Ensure expected `RCLONE_TEST` files are found on
                                              both Path1 and Path2 filesystems, else abort.
                    --check-filename FILENAME Filename for `--check-access` (default: `RCLONE_TEST`)
                    --check-sync CHOICE       Controls comparison of final listings:
                                              `true | false | only` (default: true)
                                              If set to `only`, bisync will only compare listings
                                              from the last run but skip actual sync.
                    --filters-file PATH       Read filtering patterns from a file
                    --max-delete PERCENT      Safety check on maximum percentage of deleted files allowed.
                                              If exceeded, the bisync run will abort. (default: 50%)
                    --force                   Bypass `--max-delete` safety check and run the sync.
                                              Consider using with `--verbose`
                    --remove-empty-dirs       Remove empty directories at the final cleanup step.
                -1, --resync                  Performs the resync run.
                                              Warning: Path1 files may overwrite Path2 versions.
                                              Consider using `--verbose` or `--dry-run` first.
                    --localtime               Use local time in listings (default: UTC)
                    --no-cleanup              Retain working files (useful for troubleshooting and testing).
                    --workdir PATH            Use custom working directory (useful for testing).
                                              (default: `~/.cache/rclone/bisync`)
                -n, --dry-run                 Go through the motions - No files are copied/deleted.
                -v, --verbose                 Increases logging verbosity.
                                              May be specified more than once for more details.
                -h, --help                    help for bisync

       Arbitrary    rclone    flags    may    be   specified   on   the   bisync   command   line
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_bisync/), for example rclone  bisync  ./testdir/path1/
       gdrive:testdir/path2/  --drive-skip-gdocs  -v  -v  --timeout 10s Note that interactions of
       various rclone flags with bisync process flow has not been fully tested yet.

   Paths
       Path1 and Path2 arguments may be references to any mix of local directory paths  (absolute
       or  relative),  UNC  paths (//server/share/path), Windows drive paths (with a drive letter
       and  :)  or  configured  remotes  (https://rclone.org/docs/#syntax-of-remote-paths)   with
       optional  subdirectory  paths.   Cloud  references  are distinguished by having a : in the
       argument (see Windows support below).

       Path1 and Path2 are treated equally, in that neither has priority for  file  changes,  and
       access efficiency does not change whether a remote is on Path1 or Path2.

       The listings in bisync working directory (default: ~/.cache/rclone/bisync) are named based
       on the Path1 and Path2 arguments so that separate syncs to individual  directories  within
       the tree may be set up, e.g.: path_to_local_tree..dropbox_subdir.lst.

       Any  empty  directories  after  the  sync  on both the Path1 and Path2 filesystems are not
       deleted by default.  If the --remove-empty-dirs flag is specified, then  both  paths  will
       have any empty directories purged as the last step in the process.

   Command-line flags
   –resync
       This will effectively make both Path1 and Path2 filesystems contain a matching superset of
       all files.  Path2 files that do not exist in Path1  will  be  copied  to  Path1,  and  the
       process will then sync the Path1 tree to Path2.

       The  base  directories  on  the both Path1 and Path2 filesystems must exist or bisync will
       fail.  This is required for safety - that bisync can verify that both paths are valid.

       When using --resync a newer version of a file on the Path2 filesystem will be  overwritten
       by   the   Path1   filesystem   version.    Carefully   evaluate   deltas  using  –dry-run
       (https://rclone.org/flags/#non-backend-flags).

       For a resync run, one of the paths may be empty (no files in the path tree).   The  resync
       run should result in files on both paths, else a normal non-resync run will fail.

       For  a  non-resync  run,  either  path being empty (no files in the tree) fails with Empty
       current PathN listing. Cannot sync to an empty directory: X.pathN.lst  This  is  a  safety
       check  that  an  unexpected empty path does not result in deleting everything in the other
       path.

   –check-access
       Access check files are an additional safety measure against data loss.  bisync will ensure
       it  can  find  matching  RCLONE_TEST  files  in  the  same  places  in the Path1 and Path2
       filesystems.  Time stamps and  file  contents  are  not  important,  just  the  names  and
       locations.   Place one or more RCLONE_TEST files in the Path1 or Path2 filesystem and then
       do either a run without --check-access or  a  --resync  to  set  matching  files  on  both
       filesystems.   If  you  have  symbolic  links in your sync tree it is recommended to place
       RCLONE_TEST files in the linked-to directory tree to protect  against  bisync  assuming  a
       bunch  of  deleted  files  if  the  linked-to tree should not be accessible.  Also see the
       --check-filename flag.

   –max-delete
       As a safety check, if greater than the --max-delete  percent  of  files  were  deleted  on
       either  the  Path1  or  Path2  filesystem,  then bisync will abort with a warning message,
       without making any changes.  The default --max-delete is 50%.  One  way  to  trigger  this
       limit  is  to  rename  a  directory that contains more than half of your files.  This will
       appear to bisync as a bunch of deleted files and a bunch of new files.  This safety  check
       is  intended  to  block bisync from deleting all of the files on both filesystems due to a
       temporary network access issue, or if the user had inadvertently deleted the files on  one
       side  or  the  other.   To  force the sync either set a different delete percentage limit,
       e.g. --max-delete 75 (allows up to 75% deletion), or use --force to bypass the check.

       Also see the all files changed check.

   –filters-file
       By using rclone filter features you can exclude file types or directory sub-trees from the
       sync.      See     the     bisync     filters    section    and    generic    –filter-from
       (https://rclone.org/filtering/#filter-from-read-filtering-patterns-from-a-file)
       documentation.   An  example  filters  file  contains  filters  for  non-allowed files for
       synching with Dropbox.

       If you make changes to your filters file then bisync requires a run with  --resync.   This
       is  a  safety  feature,  which  avoids  existing files on the Path1 and/or Path2 side from
       seeming to disappear from view (since they are excluded in the new listings), which  would
       fool  bisync into seeing them as deleted (as compared to the prior run listings), and then
       bisync would proceed to delete them for real.

       To block this from happening bisync calculates an MD5 hash of the filters file and  stores
       the  hash  in  a  .md5 file in the same place as your filters file.  On the next runs with
       --filters-file set, bisync re-calculates the MD5 hash of  the  current  filters  file  and
       compares  it  to  the hash stored in .md5 file.  If they don’t match the run aborts with a
       critical error and thus forces you to do a --resync, likely avoiding a disaster.

   –check-sync
       Enabled by default, the check-sync function checks that all of the  same  files  exist  in
       both  the  Path1 and Path2 history listings.  This check-sync integrity check is performed
       at the end of the sync run by default.  Any untrapped failing copy/deletes between the two
       paths  might  result  in  differences  between  the two listings and in the untracked file
       content differences between the two paths.  A resync run would correct the error.

       Note that the default-enabled integrity check locally executes a load of  both  the  final
       Path1  and  Path2  listings,  and  thus  adds  to  the run time of a sync.  Using --check-
       sync=false will disable it and may significantly reduce the sync run times for very  large
       numbers of files.

       The  check  may  be run manually with --check-sync=only.  It runs only the integrity check
       and terminates without actually synching.

   Operation
   Runtime flow details
       bisync retains the listings of the Path1 and Path2 filesystems from  the  prior  run.   On
       each successive run it will:

       • list files on path1 and path2, and check for changes on each side.  Changes include New,
         Newer, Older, and Deleted files.

       • Propagate changes on path1 to path2, and vice-versa.

   Safety measures
       • Lock file prevents multiple  simultaneous  runs  when  taking  a  while.   This  can  be
         particularly useful if bisync is run by cron scheduler.

       • Handle change conflicts non-destructively by creating ..path1 and ..path2 file versions.

       • File system access health check using RCLONE_TEST files (see the --check-access flag).

       • Abort  on excessive deletes - protects against a failed listing being interpreted as all
         the files were deleted.  See the --max-delete and --force flags.

       • If something evil happens, bisync goes into a safe state to block damage by later  runs.
         (See Error Handling)

   Normal sync checks
       Type       Description                     Result             Implementation
       ────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       Path2      File is new on  Path2,  does    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
       new        not exist on Path1              survives           to Path1
       Path2      File  is  newer  on   Path2,    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
       newer      unchanged on Path1              survives           to Path1
       Path2      File is  deleted  on  Path2,    File is deleted    rclone     delete
       deleted    unchanged on Path1                                 Path1
       Path1      File  is  new on Path1, does    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
       new        not exist on Path2              survives           to Path2
       Path1      File   is  newer  on  Path1,    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
       newer      unchanged on Path2              survives           to Path2
       Path1      File   is  older  on  Path1,    Path1    version   rclone copy Path1
       older      unchanged on Path2              survives           to Path2
       Path2      File   is  older  on  Path2,    Path2    version   rclone copy Path2
       older      unchanged on Path1              survives           to Path1
       Path1      File  no  longer  exists  on    File is deleted    rclone     delete
       deleted    Path1                                              Path2

   Unusual sync checks
       Type                Description             Result                 Implementation
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       Path1   new   AND   File  is new on Path1   Files  renamed   to    rclone    copy
       Path2 new           AND new on Path2        _Path1 and _Path2      _Path2 file to
                                                                          Path1,  rclone
                                                                          copy    _Path1
                                                                          file to Path2
       Path2  newer  AND   File  is   newer   on   Files  renamed   to    rclone    copy
       Path1 changed       Path2     AND    also   _Path1 and _Path2      _Path2 file to
                           changed                                        Path1,  rclone
                           (newer/older/size) on                          copy    _Path1
                           Path1                                          file to Path2
       Path2  newer  AND   File  is   newer   on   Path2       version    rclone    copy
       Path1 deleted       Path2     AND    also   survives               Path2 to Path1
                           deleted on Path1
       Path2 deleted AND   File  is  deleted  on   Path1       version    rclone    copy
       Path1 changed       Path2   AND   changed   survives               Path1 to Path2
                           (newer/older/size) on
                           Path1
       Path1 deleted AND   File  is  deleted  on   Path2       version    rclone    copy
       Path2 changed       Path1   AND   changed   survives               Path2 to Path1
                           (newer/older/size) on
                           Path2

   All files changed check
       if all prior existing files on either of the  filesystems  have  changed  (e.g. timestamps
       have  changed due to changing the system’s timezone) then bisync will abort without making
       any changes.  Any new files are not considered for this check.  You could use  --force  to
       force  the  sync  (whichever  side  has the changed timestamp files wins).  Alternately, a
       --resync may be used (Path1 versions will be pushed to  Path2).   Consider  the  situation
       carefully and perhaps use --dry-run before you commit to the changes.

   Modification time
       Bisync  relies  on file timestamps to identify changed files and will refuse to operate if
       backend lacks the modification time support.

       If you or your application should change the  content  of  a  file  without  changing  the
       modification time then bisync will not notice the change, and thus will not copy it to the
       other side.

       Note that on some cloud storage systems it is not possible to have  file  timestamps  that
       match precisely between the local and other filesystems.

       Bisync’s  approach to this problem is by tracking the changes on each side separately over
       time with a local database of files in that side then applying the  resulting  changes  on
       the other side.

   Error handling
       Certain  bisync  critical  errors, such as file copy/move failing, will result in a bisync
       lockout of following runs.  The lockout is asserted because the sync status and history of
       the  Path1  and  Path2  filesystems cannot be trusted, so it is safer to block any further
       changes until someone checks things out.  The recovery is to do a --resync again.

       It is recommended to use --resync --dry-run --verbose initially and carefully review  what
       changes will be made before running the --resync without --dry-run.

       Most  of  these  events  come  up  due to a error status from an internal call.  On such a
       critical error the {...}.path1.lst  and  {...}.path2.lst  listing  files  are  renamed  to
       extension  .lst-err,  which blocks any future bisync runs (since the normal .lst files are
       not found).  Bisync keeps them under bisync subdirectory of the  rclone  cache  directory,
       typically at ${HOME}/.cache/rclone/bisync/ on Linux.

       Some  errors  are  considered  temporary  and  re-running  the bisync is not blocked.  The
       critical return blocks further bisync runs.

   Lock file
       When bisync is running, a lock file is created in the bisync working directory,  typically
       at  ~/.cache/rclone/bisync/PATH1..PATH2.lck on Linux.  If bisync should crash or hang, the
       lock file will remain in place and block any further runs of bisync for  the  same  paths.
       Delete the lock file as part of debugging the situation.  The lock file effectively blocks
       follow-on (e.g., scheduled by cron) runs when the prior invocation is taking a long  time.
       The lock file contains PID of the blocking process, which may help in debug.

       Note  that  while  concurrent  bisync  runs are allowed, be very cautious that there is no
       overlap in the trees being synched between  concurrent  runs,  lest  there  be  replicated
       files, deleted files and general mayhem.

   Return codes
       rclone bisync returns the following codes to calling program: - 0 on a successful run, - 1
       for a non-critical failing run (a rerun may be successful), - 2 for a  critically  aborted
       run (requires a --resync to recover).

   Limitations
   Supported backends
       Bisync  is  considered  BETA  and  has  been  tested  with the following backends: - Local
       filesystem - Google Drive - Dropbox - OneDrive - S3 - SFTP - Yandex Disk

       It has not been fully tested with other services yet.  If it works, or sorta works, please
       let  us  know and we’ll update the list.  Run the test suite to check for proper operation
       as described below.

       First release of rclone bisync requires that underlying backend supported the modification
       time feature and will refuse to run otherwise.  This limitation will be lifted in a future
       rclone bisync release.

   Concurrent modifications
       When using Local, FTP or SFTP remotes rclone  does  not  create  temporary  files  at  the
       destination  when  copying,  and  thus  if  the connection is lost the created file may be
       corrupt, which will likely propagate back to the original path on the next sync, resulting
       in  data  loss.   This  will  be solved in a future release, there is no workaround at the
       moment.

       Files that change during a bisync run may result in data loss.  This has been  seen  in  a
       highly  dynamic environment, where the filesystem is getting hammered by running processes
       during the sync.  The solution is to  sync  at  quiet  times  or  filter  out  unnecessary
       directories and files.

   Empty directories
       New  empty  directories on one path are not propagated to the other side.  This is because
       bisync (and rclone) natively works on files not directories.  The following sequence is  a
       workaround but will not propagate the delete of an empty directory to the other side:

              rclone bisync PATH1 PATH2
              rclone copy PATH1 PATH2 --filter "+ */" --filter "- **" --create-empty-src-dirs
              rclone copy PATH2 PATH2 --filter "+ */" --filter "- **" --create-empty-src-dirs

   Renamed directories
       Renaming  a  folder  on the Path1 side results is deleting all files on the Path2 side and
       then copying all files again from Path1 to Path2.  Bisync sees this as all  files  in  the
       old  directory name as deleted and all files in the new directory name as new.  Similarly,
       renaming a directory on both sides to the same name will result in  creating  ..path1  and
       ..path2  files  on  both  sides.   Currently  the  most  effective and efficient method of
       renaming a directory is to rename it on both sides, then do a --resync.

   Case sensitivity
       Synching with case-insensitive filesystems, such as Windows or Box,  can  result  in  file
       name  conflicts.   This will be fixed in a future release.  The near term workaround is to
       make sure that files on  both  sides  don’t  have  spelling  case  differences  (Smile.jpg
       vs. smile.jpg).

   Windows support
       Bisync  has  been  tested  on  Windows  8.1,  Windows  10 Pro 64-bit and on Windows GitHub
       runners.

       Drive letters are allowed, including drive letters mapped to network drives (rclone bisync
       J:\localsync  GDrive:).   If  a  drive  letter  is omitted, the shell current drive is the
       default.  Drive letters are a single character follows by :, so cloud names must  be  more
       than one character long.

       Absolute  paths  (with  or  without a drive letter), and relative paths (with or without a
       drive letter) are supported.

       Working directory is created at C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\Local\rclone\bisync.

       Note that bisync output may show a mix of forward / and back \ slashes.

       Be careful of case independent directory and file naming  on  Windows  vs. case  dependent
       Linux

   Filtering
       See  filtering  documentation  (https://rclone.org/filtering/)  for  how  filter rules are
       written and interpreted.

       Bisync’s   --filters-file   flag    slightly    extends    the    rclone’s    –filter-from
       (https://rclone.org/filtering/#filter-from-read-filtering-patterns-from-a-file)  filtering
       mechanism.  For a  given  bisync  run  you  may  provide  only  one  --filters-file.   The
       --include*, --exclude*, and --filter flags are also supported.

   How to filter directories
       Filtering portions of the directory tree is a critical feature for synching.

       Examples  of  directory  trees (always beneath the Path1/Path2 root level) you may want to
       exclude from your sync: - Directory trees  containing  only  software  build  intermediate
       files.   -  Directory  trees  containing  application temporary files and data such as the
       Windows C:\Users\MyLogin\AppData\ tree.  -  Directory  trees  containing  files  that  are
       large, less important, or are getting thrashed continuously by ongoing processes.

       On  the  other  hand, there may be only select directories that you actually want to sync,
       and  exclude  all  others.   See  the  Example  include-style  filters  for  Windows  user
       directories below.

   Filters file writing guidelines
       1. Begin with excluding directory trees:

           • e.g. - /AppData/**  on  the  end  is  not  necessary.  Once a given directory level is excluded then
             everything beneath it won’t be looked at by rclone.

           • Exclude such directories that are unneeded, are big, dynamically thrashed, or  where
             there may be access permission issues.

           • Excluding such dirs first will make rclone operations (much) faster.

           • Specific files may also be excluded, as with the Dropbox exclusions example below.

       2. Decide if its easier (or cleaner) to:

           • Include select directories and therefore exclude everything else – or –

           • Exclude select directories and therefore include everything else

       3. Include select directories:

           • Add lines like: + /Documents/PersonalFiles/** to select which directories to include
             in the sync.

           • ** on the end specifies to include the full depth of the specified tree.

           • With Include-style filters, files at the Path1/Path2 root are  not  included.   They
             may be included with + /*.

           • Place  RCLONE_TEST  files  within these included directory trees.  They will only be
             looked for in these directory trees.

           • Finish by excluding everything else by adding - ** at the end of the filters file.

           • Disregard step 4.

       4. Exclude select directories:

           • Add more lines like in step 1.  For example: -/Desktop/tempfiles/, or  -  /testdir/.
             Again, a ** on the end is not necessary.

           • Do  not add a - ** in the file.  Without this line, everything will be included that
             has not be explicitly excluded.

           • Disregard step 3.

       A few rules for  the  syntax  of  a  filter  file  expanding  on  filtering  documentation
       (https://rclone.org/filtering/):

       • Lines may start with spaces and tabs - rclone strips leading whitespace.

       • If  the  first  non-whitespace  character  is a # then the line is a comment and will be
         ignored.

       • Blank lines are ignored.

       • The first non-whitespace character on a filter line must be a + or -.

       • Exactly 1 space is allowed between the +/- and the path term.

       • Only forward slashes (/) are used in path terms, even on Windows.

       • The rest of the line is taken as the path term.  Trailing whitespace is taken literally,
         and probably is an error.

   Example include-style filters for Windows user directories
       This   Windows   include-style   example  is  based  on  the  sync  root  (Path1)  set  to
       C:\Users\MyLogin.  The strategy is to select specific directories to  be  synched  with  a
       network drive (Path2).

       • -  /AppData/  excludes  an entire tree of Windows stored stuff that need not be synched.
         In my case, AppData has >11 GB  of  stuff  I  don’t  care  about,  and  there  are  some
         subdirectories  beneath  AppData  that are not accessible to my user login, resulting in
         bisync critical aborts.

       • Windows  creates  cache  files  starting  with  both  upper  and  lowercase  NTUSER   at
         C:\Users\MyLogin.  These files may be dynamic, locked, and are generally don’t care.

       • There  are  just a few directories with my data that I do want synched, in the form of +
         /<path>.  By selecting only  the  directory  trees  I  want  to  avoid  the  dozen  plus
         directories that various apps make at C:\Users\MyLogin\Documents.

       • Include files in the root of the sync point, C:\Users\MyLogin, by adding the + /* line.

       • This  is  an  Include-style  filters  file,  therefore  it ends with - ** which excludes
         everything not explicitly included.

         - /AppData/
         - NTUSER*
         - ntuser*
         + /Documents/Family/**
         + /Documents/Sketchup/**
         + /Documents/Microcapture_Photo/**
         + /Documents/Microcapture_Video/**
         + /Desktop/**
         + /Pictures/**
         + /*
         - **

       Note also that Windows implements several  “library”  links  such  as  C:\Users\MyLogin\My
       Documents\My Music pointing to C:\Users\MyLogin\Music.  rclone sees these as links, so you
       must add --links to the bisync command line if you which to follow these  links.   I  find
       that  I get permission errors in trying to follow the links, so I don’t include the rclone
       --links flag, but then you get lots of Can't follow symlink... noise from rclone about not
       following  the  links.   This noise can be quashed by adding --quiet to the bisync command
       line.

   Example exclude-style filters files for use with Dropbox
       • Dropbox disallows synching the listed temporary and  configuration/data  files.   The  -
         <filename>  filters  exclude  these  files  where  ever they may occur in the sync tree.
         Consider adding similar exclusions for file types you don’t need to sync, such  as  core
         dump and software build files.

       • bisync  testing creates /testdir/ at the top level of the sync tree, and usually deletes
         the tree after the test.  If a normal sync should run while the  /testdir/  tree  exists
         the  --check-access phase may fail due to unbalanced RCLONE_TEST files.  The - /testdir/
         filter blocks this tree from being synched.  You don’t need this exclusion  if  you  are
         not doing bisync development testing.

       • Everything else beneath the Path1/Path2 root will be synched.

       • RCLONE_TEST files may be placed anywhere within the tree, including the root.

   Example filters file for Dropbox
              # Filter file for use with bisync
              # See https://rclone.org/filtering/ for filtering rules
              # NOTICE: If you make changes to this file you MUST do a --resync run.
              #         Run with --dry-run to see what changes will be made.

              # Dropbox wont sync some files so filter them away here.
              # See https://help.dropbox.com/installs-integrations/sync-uploads/files-not-syncing
              - .dropbox.attr
              - ~*.tmp
              - ~$*
              - .~*
              - desktop.ini
              - .dropbox

              # Used for bisync testing, so excluded from normal runs
              - /testdir/

              # Other example filters
              #- /TiBU/
              #- /Photos/

   How –check-access handles filters
       At  the  start  of a bisync run, listings are gathered for Path1 and Path2 while using the
       user’s --filters-file.  During the check access phase, bisync  scans  these  listings  for
       RCLONE_TEST  files.   Any  RCLONE_TEST  files  hidden by the --filters-file are not in the
       listings and thus not checked during the check access phase.

   Troubleshooting
   Reading bisync logs
       Here are two normal runs.  The first one has a newer file on the remote.  The  second  has
       no deltas between local and remote.

              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" with Path2 "dropbox:/"
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    File is new                         - file.txt
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path1:    1 changes:    1 new,    0 newer,    0 older,    0 deleted
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Applying changes
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    Queue copy to Path2                 - dropbox:/file.txt
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : - Path1    Do queued copies to                 - Path2
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Updating listings
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" vs Path2 "dropbox:/"
              2021/05/16 00:24:38 INFO  : Bisync successful

              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" with Path2 "dropbox:/"
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : No changes found
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Updating listings
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Validating listings for Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/" vs Path2 "dropbox:/"
              2021/05/16 00:36:52 INFO  : Bisync successful

   Dry run oddity
       The  --dry-run messages may indicate that it would try to delete some files.  For example,
       if a file is new on Path2 and does not exist on Path1 then it would normally be copied  to
       Path1,  but with --dry-run enabled those copies don’t happen, which leads to the attempted
       delete on the Path2, blocked again by –dry-run: ... Not deleting as --dry-run.

       This whole confusing situation is an artifact  of  the  --dry-run  flag.   Scrutinize  the
       proposed  deletes  carefully,  and  if  the files would have been copied to Path1 then the
       threatened deletes on Path2 may be disregarded.

   Retries
       Rclone has built in retries.  If you  run  with  --verbose  you’ll  see  error  and  retry
       messages  such  as  shown below.  This is usually not a bug.  If at the end of the run you
       see Bisync successful and not Bisync critical error or Bisync aborted  then  the  run  was
       successful, and you can ignore the error messages.

       The  following  run  shows  an intermittent fail.  Lines 5 and _6- are low level messages.
       Line 6 is a bubbled-up warning message, conveying  the  error.   Rclone  normally  retries
       failing commands, so there may be numerous such messages in the log.

       Since  there  are  no  final  error/warning  messages on line 7, rclone has recovered from
       failure after a retry, and the overall sync was successful.

              1: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree" with Path2 "dropbox:"
              2: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path1 checking for diffs
              3: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path2 checking for diffs
              4: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Path2:  113 changes:   22 new,    0 newer,    0 older,   91 deleted
              5: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 ERROR : /path/to/local/tree/objects/af: error listing: unexpected end of JSON input
              6: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 NOTICE: WARNING  listing try 1 failed.                 - dropbox:
              7: 2021/05/14 00:44:12 INFO  : Bisync successful

       This log shows a Critical failure which requires a --resync  to  recover  from.   See  the
       Runtime Error Handling section.

              2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': Waiting for checks to finish
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': Waiting for transfers to finish
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 INFO  : Google drive root '': not deleting files as there were IO errors
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Attempt 3/3 failed with 3 errors and: not deleting files as there were IO errors
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Failed to sync: not deleting files as there were IO errors
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 NOTICE: WARNING  rclone sync try 3 failed.           - /path/to/local/tree/
              2021/05/12 00:49:40 ERROR : Bisync aborted. Must run --resync to recover.

   Denied downloads of “infected” or “abusive” files
       Google  Drive  has a filter for certain file types (.exe, .apk, et cetera) that by default
       cannot be copied from Google Drive to the local filesystem.  If you are  having  problems,
       run  with  --verbose  to  see  specifically which files are generating complaints.  If the
       error is This file has been identified as  malware  or  spam  and  cannot  be  downloaded,
       consider   using   the   flag  –drive-acknowledge-abuse  (https://rclone.org/drive/#drive-
       acknowledge-abuse).

   Google Doc files
       Google docs exist as virtual files on Google Drive and  cannot  be  transferred  to  other
       filesystems  natively.  While it is possible to export a Google doc to a normal file (with
       .xlsx extension, for example), it is not possible to import a  normal  file  back  into  a
       Google document.

       Bisync’s  handling  of  Google  Doc files is to flag them in the run log output for user’s
       attention and ignore them for any file transfers, deletes, or syncs.  They  will  show  up
       with a length of -1 in the listings.  This bisync run is otherwise successful:

              2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : Synching Path1 "/path/to/local/tree/base/" with Path2 "GDrive:"
              2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : ...path2.lst-new: Ignoring incorrect line: "- -1 - - 2018-07-29T08:49:30.136000000+0000 GoogleDoc.docx"
              2021/05/11 08:23:15 INFO  : Bisync successful

   Usage examples
   Cron
       Rclone  does  not  yet  have  a  built-in  capability to monitor the local file system for
       changes and must be blindly run periodically.  On Windows this can be done  using  a  Task
       Scheduler, on Linux you can use Cron which is described below.

       The  1st  example  runs  a  sync every 5 minutes between a local directory and an OwnCloud
       server, with output logged to a runlog file:

              # Minute (0-59)
              #      Hour (0-23)
              #           Day of Month (1-31)
              #                Month (1-12 or Jan-Dec)
              #                     Day of Week (0-6 or Sun-Sat)
              #                         Command
                */5  *    *    *    *   /path/to/rclone bisync /local/files MyCloud: --check-access --filters-file /path/to/bysync-filters.txt --log-file /path/to//bisync.log

       See              crontab              syntax              (https://www.man7.org/linux/man-
       pages/man1/crontab.1p.html#INPUT_FILES)).   for  the  details  of  crontab  time  interval
       expressions.

       If you run rclone bisync as a cron job, redirect stdout/stderr to a file.  The 2nd example
       runs  a  sync to Dropbox every hour and logs all stdout (via the >>) and stderr (via 2>&1)
       to a log file.

              0 * * * * /path/to/rclone bisync /path/to/local/dropbox Dropbox: --check-access --filters-file /home/user/filters.txt >> /path/to/logs/dropbox-run.log 2>&1

   Sharing an encrypted folder tree between hosts
       bisync can keep a local folder in sync with a cloud service, but what  if  you  have  some
       highly sensitive files to be synched?

       Usage  of  a  cloud  service  is  for exchanging both routine and sensitive personal files
       between one’s home network, one’s personal notebook when on the road, and with one’s  work
       computer.  The routine data is not sensitive.  For the sensitive data, configure an rclone
       crypt remote (https://rclone.org/crypt/) to point to a subdirectory within the local  disk
       tree that is bisync’d to Dropbox, and then set up an bisync for this local crypt directory
       to a directory outside of the main sync tree.

   Linux server setup/path/to/DBoxroot is the root of my local sync tree.  There are numerous subdirectories.

       • /path/to/DBoxroot/crypt is the root subdirectory for files  that  are  encrypted.   This
         local  directory  target  is  setup  as  an  rclone  crypt remote named Dropcrypt:.  See
         rclone.conf snippet below.

       • /path/to/my/unencrypted/files is the root of my sensitive files  -  not  encrypted,  not
         within the tree synched to Dropbox.

       • To  sync  my  local unencrypted files with the encrypted Dropbox versions I manually run
         bisync /path/to/my/unencrypted/files DropCrypt:.  This step  could  be  bundled  into  a
         script  to  run  before  and  after  the  full  Dropbox tree sync in the last step, thus
         actively keeping the sensitive files in sync.

       • bisync /path/to/DBoxroot Dropbox: runs periodically via cron, keeping my full local sync
         tree in sync with Dropbox.

   Windows notebook setup
       • The  Dropbox  client runs keeping the local tree C:\Users\MyLogin\Dropbox always in sync
         with Dropbox.  I could have used rclone bisync instead.

       • A separate directory tree at  C:\Users\MyLogin\Documents\DropLocal  hosts  the  tree  of
         unencrypted files/folders.

       • To  sync  my  local unencrypted files with the encrypted Dropbox versions I manually run
         the following command: rclone bisync C:\Users\MyLogin\Documents\DropLocal Dropcrypt:.

       • The Dropbox client then syncs the changes with Dropbox.

   rclone.conf snippet
              [Dropbox]
              type = dropbox
              ...

              [Dropcrypt]
              type = crypt
              remote = /path/to/DBoxroot/crypt          # on the Linux server
              remote = C:\Users\MyLogin\Dropbox\crypt   # on the Windows notebook
              filename_encryption = standard
              directory_name_encryption = true
              password = ...
              ...

   Testing
       You should read this section only if you are developing for  rclone.   You  need  to  have
       rclone source code locally to work with bisync tests.

       Bisync  has  a  dedicated test framework implemented in the bisync_test.go file located in
       the rclone source tree.  The test suite is based on the go test command.  Series of  tests
       are  stored  in  subdirectories below the cmd/bisync/testdata directory.  Individual tests
       can be invoked by their directory name, e.g.  go test . -case basic -remote local -remote2
       gdrive: -v

       Tests  will make a temporary folder on remote and purge it afterwards.  If during test run
       there are intermittent errors and rclone  retries,  these  errors  will  be  captured  and
       flagged  as  invalid  MISCOMPAREs.   Rerunning  the  test will let it pass.  Consider such
       failures as noise.

   Test command syntax
              usage: go test ./cmd/bisync [options...]

              Options:
                -case NAME        Name(s) of the test case(s) to run. Multiple names should
                                  be separated by commas. You can remove the `test_` prefix
                                  and replace `_` by `-` in test name for convenience.
                                  If not `all`, the name(s) should map to a directory under
                                  `./cmd/bisync/testdata`.
                                  Use `all` to run all tests (default: all)
                -remote PATH1     `local` or name of cloud service with `:` (default: local)
                -remote2 PATH2    `local` or name of cloud service with `:` (default: local)
                -no-compare       Disable comparing test results with the golden directory
                                  (default: compare)
                -no-cleanup       Disable cleanup of Path1 and Path2 testdirs.
                                  Useful for troubleshooting. (default: cleanup)
                -golden           Store results in the golden directory (default: false)
                                  This flag can be used with multiple tests.
                -debug            Print debug messages
                -stop-at NUM      Stop test after given step number. (default: run to the end)
                                  Implies `-no-compare` and `-no-cleanup`, if the test really
                                  ends prematurely. Only meaningful for a single test case.
                -refresh-times    Force refreshing the target modtime, useful for Dropbox
                                  (default: false)
                -verbose          Run tests verbosely

       Note: unlike rclone flags which must be prefixed by double dash  (--),  the  test  command
       flags can be equally prefixed by a single - or double dash.

   Running testsgo  test  . -case basic -remote local -remote2 local runs the test_basic test case using
         only the local filesystem, synching one local directory with  another  local  directory.
         Test  script  output  is  to  the console, while commands within scenario.txt have their
         output sent to the .../workdir/test.log file, which is finally compared  to  the  golden
         copy.

       • The  first  argument after go test should be a relative name of the directory containing
         bisync source code.  If you run tests right from there, the argument will be .  (current
         directory)  as  in  most examples below.  If you run bisync tests from the rclone source
         directory, the command should be go test ./cmd/bisync ....

       • The test engine will mangle rclone output to ensure comparability with  golden  listings
         and logs.

       • Test  scenarios  are  located  in ./cmd/bisync/testdata.  The test -case argument should
         match the full name of a subdirectory under that  directory.   Every  test  subdirectory
         name  on  disk  must  start  with  test_, this prefix can be omitted on command line for
         brevity.  Also, underscores in the name can be replaced by dashes for convenience.

       • go test . -remote local -remote2 local -case all runs all tests.

       • Path1 and Path2 may either be the keyword local or may  be  names  of  configured  cloud
         services.   go  test  .  -remote gdrive: -remote2 dropbox: -case basic will run the test
         between these two services, without transferring any files to the local filesystem.

       • Test run stdout and stderr console output may be directed to a file,  e.g.   go  test  .
         -remote gdrive: -remote2 local -case all > runlog.txt 2>&1

   Test execution flow
       1. The  base  setup  in  the initial directory of the testcase is applied on the Path1 and
          Path2 filesystems (via rclone copy the initial directory to  Path1,  then  rclone  sync
          Path1 to Path2).

       2. The commands in the scenario.txt file are applied, with output directed to the test.log
          file in the test working  directory.   Typically,  the  first  actual  command  in  the
          scenario.txt  file  is to do a --resync, which establishes the baseline {...}.path1.lst
          and {...}.path2.lst files in the test working directory (.../workdir/ relative  to  the
          temporary  test directory).  Various commands and listing snapshots are done within the
          test.

       3. Finally, the contents of the test working directory are compared to the contents of the
          testcase’s golden directory.

   Notes about testing
       • Test  cases are in individual directories beneath ./cmd/bisync/testdata.  A command line
         reference to a test is understood  to  reference  a  directory  beneath  testdata.   For
         example, go test ./cmd/bisync -case dry-run -remote gdrive: -remote2 local refers to the
         test case in ./cmd/bisync/testdata/test_dry_run.

       • The test working directory is located  at  .../workdir  relative  to  a  temporary  test
         directory, usually under /tmp on Linux.

       • The local test sync tree is created at a temporary directory named like bisync.XXX under
         system temporary directory.

       • The  remote   test   sync   tree   is   located   at   a   temporary   directory   under
         <remote:>/bisync.XXX/.

       • path1  and/or  path2  subdirectories  are  created  in  a  temporary directory under the
         respective local or cloud test remote.

       • By default, the Path1 and Path2 test dirs and workdir will be deleted  after  each  test
         run.   The  -no-cleanup  flag  disables  purging  these  directories when validating and
         debugging a given test.  These directories will be flushed before running another  test,
         independent of the -no-cleanup usage.

       • You  will  likely  want  to add - /testdir/ to your normal bisync --filters-file so that
         normal syncs do not attempt to sync the  test  temporary  directories,  which  may  have
         RCLONE_TEST  miscompares in some testcases which would otherwise trip the --check-access
         system.  The --check-access mechanism is hard-coded to ignore RCLONE_TEST files  beneath
         bisync/testdata,  so  the  test  cases  may reside on the synched tree even if there are
         check file mismatches in the test tree.

       • Some Dropbox tests can fail,  notably  printing  the  following  message:  src  and  dst
         identical  but can't set mod time without deleting and re-uploading This is expected and
         happens due a way Dropbox handles modification times.  You should use the -refresh-times
         test flag to make up for this.

       • If   Dropbox   tests   hit   request   limit   for   you   and   print   error   message
         too_many_requests/...: Too many requests or write operations.  then follow  the  Dropbox
         App ID instructions (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#get-your-own-dropbox-app-id).

   Updating golden results
       Sometimes even a slight change in the bisync source can cause little changes spread around
       many log files.  Updating them manually would be a nightmare.

       The -golden flag will store the test.log and *.lst  listings  from  each  test  case  into
       respective  golden directories.  Golden results will automatically contain generic strings
       instead of local or cloud paths which means  that  they  should  match  when  run  with  a
       different cloud service.

       Your  normal  workflow  might  be  as follows: 1.  Git-clone the rclone sources locally 2.
       Modify bisync source and check that it builds  3.   Run  the  whole  test  suite  go  test
       ./cmd/bisync   -remote  local  4.   If  some  tests  show  log  difference,  recheck  them
       individually, e.g.: go test  ./cmd/bisync  -remote  local  -case  basic  5.   If  you  are
       convinced  with  the difference, goldenize all tests at once: go test ./cmd/bisync -remote
       local -golden 6.  Use word diff: git diff --word-diff ./cmd/bisync/testdata/.  Please note
       that  normal  line-level  diff  is  generally  useless  here.   7.   Check  the difference
       carefully!  8.  Commit the change (git commit) only if you are sure.  If unsure, save your
       code changes then wipe the log diffs from git: git reset [--hard].

   Structure of test scenarios<testname>/initial/  contains  a tree of files that will be set as the initial condition
         on both Path1 and Path2 testdirs.

       • <testname>/modfiles/ contains files that will be used to modify the Path1  and/or  Path2
         filesystems.

       • <testname>/golden/ contains the expected content of the test working directory (workdir)
         at the completion of the testcase.

       • <testname>/scenario.txt contains the body of the test, in the form of  various  commands
         to  modify  files,  run  bisync,  and  snapshot listings.  Output from these commands is
         captured to .../workdir/test.log for comparison to the golden files.

   Supported test commandstest <some message> Print the line to the console and to  the  test.log:  test  sync  is
         working correctly with options x, y, zcopy-listings  <prefix>  Save  a copy of all .lst listings in the test working directory
         with the specified prefix: save-listings exclude-pass-runmove-listings <prefix> Similar to copy-listings but removes the source

       • purge-children <dir> This will delete all child files and purge all child subdirs  under
         given  directory  but keep the parent intact.  This behavior is important for tests with
         Google Drive because removing and re-creating the parent would change its ID.

       • delete-file <file> Delete a single file.

       • delete-glob <dir> <pattern> Delete a group of files located one level deep in the  given
         directory with names maching a given glob pattern.

       • touch-glob YYYY-MM-DD <dir> <pattern> Change modification time on a group of files.

       • touch-copy  YYYY-MM-DD  <source-file> <dest-dir> Change file modification time then copy
         it to destination.

       • copy-file <source-file> <dest-dir> Copy a single file to given directory.

       • copy-as <source-file> <dest-file> Similar to above but  destination  must  include  both
         directory and the new file name at destination.

       • copy-dir  <src>  <dst>  and  sync-dir  <src> <dst> Copy/sync a directory.  Equivalent of
         rclone copy and rclone sync.

       • list-dirs <dir> Equivalent to rclone lsf -R --dirs-only <dir>bisync [options] Runs bisync against -remote and -remote2.

   Supported substitution terms{testdir/} - the root dir of the testcase

       • {datadir/} - the modfiles dir under the testcase root

       • {workdir/} - the temporary test working directory

       • {path1/} - the root of the Path1 test directory tree

       • {path2/} - the root of the Path2 test directory tree

       • {session} - base name of the test listings

       • {/} - OS-specific path separator

       • {spc}, {tab}, {eol} - whitespace

       • {chr:HH} - raw byte with given hexadecimal code

       Substitution results of the terms named like {dir/} will  end  with  /  (or  backslash  on
       Windows),  so  it  is not necessary to include slash in the usage, for example delete-file
       {path1/}file1.txt.

   Benchmarks
       This section is work in progress.

       Here are a few data points for scale, execution times, and memory usage.

       The first set of data was taken between  a  local  disk  to  Dropbox.   The  speedtest.net
       (https://speedtest.net)  download speed was ~170 Mbps, and upload speed was ~10 Mbps.  500
       files (~9.5 MB each) had been already synched.  50 files were added in  a  new  directory,
       each ~9.5 MB, ~475 MB total.

       Change                     Operations and times                  Overall run
                                                                        time
       ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       500    files     synched   1x listings for Path1 & Path2         1.5 sec
       (nothing to move)
       500  files  synched with   1x listings for Path1 & Path2         1.5 sec
       –check-access
       50 new files on remote     Queued 50 copies down: 27 sec         29 sec
       Moved local dir            Queued 50 copies up:  410  sec,  50   421 sec
                                  deletes up: 9 sec
       Moved remote dir           Queued  50  copies down: 31 sec, 50   33 sec
                                  deletes down: <1 sec
       Delete local dir           Queued 50 deletes up: 9 sec           13 sec

       This next data is from a user’s application.  They had ~400GB of data  over  1.96  million
       files  being  sync’ed  between  a Windows local disk and some remote cloud.  The file full
       path length was on average 35 characters (which factors into load time and RAM required).

       • Loading the prior listing into memory (1.96 million files, listing  file  size  140  MB)
         took ~30 sec and occupied about 1 GB of RAM.

       • Getting a fresh listing of the local file system (producing the 140 MB output file) took
         about XXX sec.

       • Getting a fresh listing of the remote file system (producing the  140  MB  output  file)
         took about XXX sec. The network download speed was measured at XXX Mb/s.

       • Once  the  prior and current Path1 and Path2 listings were loaded (a total of four to be
         loaded, two at a time), determining the deltas was pretty quick (a few seconds for  this
         test  case),  and  the  transfer  time  for  any files to be copied was dominated by the
         network bandwidth.

   References
       rclone’s    bisync    implementation    was     derived     from     the     rclonesync-V2
       (https://github.com/cjnaz/rclonesync-V2)   project,   including   documentation  and  test
       mechanisms, with @cjnaz (https://github.com/cjnaz)’s full support and encouragement.

       rclone bisync is similar in nature to a range of other projects:

       • unison (https://github.com/bcpierce00/unison)

       • syncthing (https://github.com/syncthing/syncthing)

       • cjnaz/rclonesync (https://github.com/cjnaz/rclonesync-V2)

       • ConorWilliams/rsinc (https://github.com/ConorWilliams/rsinc)

       • jwink3101/syncrclone (https://github.com/Jwink3101/syncrclone)

       • DavideRossi/upback (https://github.com/DavideRossi/upback)

       Bisync adopts the differential  synchronization  technique,  which  is  based  on  keeping
       history  of  changes  performed  by  both synchronizing sides.  See the Dual Shadow Method
       section in the Neil Fraser’s article (https://neil.fraser.name/writing/sync/).

       Also    note    a    number    of    academic    publications    by    Benjamin     Pierce
       (http://www.cis.upenn.edu/%7Ebcpierce/papers/index.shtml#File%20Synchronization)     about
       Unison and synchronization in general.

1Fichier

       This is a backend for the 1fichier (https://1fichier.com)  cloud  storage  service.   Note
       that a Premium subscription is required to use the API.

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The  initial  setup  for  1Fichier involves getting the API key from the website which you
       need to do in your browser.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / 1Fichier
                 \ "fichier"
              [snip]
              Storage> fichier
              ** See help for fichier backend at: https://rclone.org/fichier/ **

              Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              api_key> example_key

              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = fichier
              api_key = example_key
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your 1Fichier account

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your 1Fichier account

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a 1Fichier directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       1Fichier does not support modification times.  It supports the Whirlpool hash algorithm.

   Duplicated files
       1Fichier can have two files with exactly the same name and  path  (unlike  a  normal  file
       system).

       Duplicated  files  cause  problems  with  the syncing and you will see messages in the log
       about duplicates.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ”           0x22        "
       $           0x24        $
       `           0x60        `
       ’           0x27        '

       File names can also not start or end  with  the  following  characters.   These  only  get
       replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

   –fichier-api-key
       Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl.

       Properties:

       • Config: api_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_API_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

   –fichier-shared-folder
       If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter.

       Properties:

       • Config: shared_folder

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_SHARED_FOLDER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –fichier-file-password
       If you want to download a shared file that is password protected, add this parameter.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: file_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_FILE_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –fichier-folder-password
       If  you  want  to  list  the files in a shared folder that is password protected, add this
       parameter.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: folder_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_FOLDER_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –fichier-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       rclone about is not supported by the 1Fichier backend.  Backends without  this  capability
       cannot  determine  free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as a
       member of an rclone union remote.

       See     List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone      about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)          and         rclone         about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Alias

       The alias remote provides a new name for another remote.

       Paths may be as deep as required or a local  path,  e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory  or
       /directory/subdirectory.

       During  the  initial  setup  with  rclone  config you will specify the target remote.  The
       target remote can either be a local path or another remote.

       Subfolders can be used in target remote.  Assume an alias remote  named  backup  with  the
       target  mydrive:private/backup.   Invoking rclone mkdir backup:desktop is exactly the same
       as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

       There will be no special handling of paths containing ..  segments.  Invoking rclone mkdir
       backup:../desktop     is     exactly     the     same    as    invoking    rclone    mkdir
       mydrive:private/backup/../desktop.  The empty path is not allowed as a remote.   To  alias
       the current directory use . instead.

       The  target  remote  can also be a connection string (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-
       strings).  This can be used to modify the config of a remote for different uses, e.g.  the
       alias  myDriveTrash  with the target remote myDrive,trashed_only: can be used to only show
       the trashed files in myDrive.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make an alias called remote for local folder.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Alias for an existing remote
                 \ "alias"
              [snip]
              Storage> alias
              Remote or path to alias.
              Can be "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket", "myremote:" or "/local/path".
              remote> /mnt/storage/backup
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              remote = /mnt/storage/backup
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              remote               alias

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level in /mnt/storage/backup

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in /mnt/storage/backup

              rclone ls remote:

       Copy another local directory to the alias directory called source

              rclone copy /home/source remote:source

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to alias (Alias for an existing remote).

   –alias-remote
       Remote or path to alias.

       Can be “myremote:path/to/dir”, “myremote:bucket”, “myremote:” or “/local/path”.

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ALIAS_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

Amazon Drive

       Amazon Drive, formerly known as Amazon Cloud Drive, is a  cloud  storage  service  run  by
       Amazon for consumers.

   Status
       Important:  rclone  supports  Amazon  Drive  only  if  you  have your own set of API keys.
       Unfortunately the Amazon  Drive  developer  program  (https://developer.amazon.com/amazon-
       drive)  is now closed to new entries so if you don’t already have your own set of keys you
       will not be able to use rclone with Amazon Drive.

       For the history on why rclone no longer has a set of Amazon Drive API keys see  the  forum
       (https://forum.rclone.org/t/rclone-has-been-banned-from-amazon-drive/2314).

       If you happen to know anyone who works at Amazon then please ask them to re-instate rclone
       into the Amazon Drive developer program - thanks!

   Configuration
       The initial setup for Amazon Drive involves getting a token from Amazon which you need  to
       do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       The   configuration   process   for   Amazon  Drive  may  involve  using  an  oauth  proxy
       (https://github.com/ncw/oauthproxy).  This is used to keep the Amazon credentials  out  of
       the  source  code.   The  proxy  runs  in  Google’s very secure App Engine environment and
       doesn’t store any credentials which pass through it.

       Since rclone doesn’t currently have its own Amazon Drive credentials so  you  will  either
       need  to have your own client_id and client_secret with Amazon Drive, or use a third-party
       oauth proxy in which case you will need to enter client_id,  client_secret,  auth_url  and
       token_url.

       Note  also  if  you  are  not  using  Amazon’s  auth_url  and token_url, (ie you filled in
       something for those) then if setting up on a remote machine you can only use  the  copying
       the   config  method  of  configuration  (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/#configuring-by-
       copying-the-config-file) - rclone authorize will not work.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/r/c/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon Drive
                 \ "amazon cloud drive"
              [snip]
              Storage> amazon cloud drive
              Amazon Application Client Id - required.
              client_id> your client ID goes here
              Amazon Application Client Secret - required.
              client_secret> your client secret goes here
              Auth server URL - leave blank to use Amazon's.
              auth_url> Optional auth URL
              Token server url - leave blank to use Amazon's.
              token_url> Optional token URL
              Remote config
              Make sure your Redirect URL is set to "http://127.0.0.1:53682/" in your custom config.
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id = your client ID goes here
              client_secret = your client secret goes here
              auth_url = Optional auth URL
              token_url = Optional token URL
              token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2015-09-06T16:07:39.658438471+01:00"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set  it  up  on  a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned
       from Amazon.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment  you  get
       back  the  verification  code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require
       you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Amazon Drive

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Amazon Drive

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Amazon Drive directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and MD5SUMs
       Amazon Drive doesn’t allow modification times to be changed via the API so these won’t  be
       accurate or used for syncing.

       It does store MD5SUMs so for a more accurate sync, you can use the --checksum flag.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Deleting files
       Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash.  Amazon don’t provide an API to
       permanently  delete files, nor to empty the trash, so you will have to do that with one of
       Amazon’s apps or via the Amazon Drive  website.   As  of  November  17,  2016,  files  are
       automatically deleted by Amazon from the trash after 30 days.

   Using with non .com Amazon accounts
       Let’s  say  you  usually use amazon.co.uk.  When you authenticate with rclone it will take
       you to an amazon.com page to log in.  Your amazon.co.uk email  and  password  should  work
       here just fine.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

   –acd-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –acd-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

   –acd-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –acd-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –acd-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –acd-checkpoint
       Checkpoint for internal polling (debug).

       Properties:

       • Config: checkpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CHECKPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –acd-upload-wait-per-gb
       Additional time per GiB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears.

       Sometimes  Amazon  Drive  gives  an error when a file has been fully uploaded but the file
       appears anyway after a little while.  This happens sometimes for files over 1 GiB in  size
       and  nearly  every  time  for  files bigger than 10 GiB.  This parameter controls the time
       rclone waits for the file to appear.

       The default value for this parameter is 3 minutes per GiB, so by default it  will  wait  3
       minutes for every GiB uploaded to see if the file appears.

       You can disable this feature by setting it to 0.  This may cause conflict errors as rclone
       retries the failed upload but the file will most likely appear correctly eventually.

       These values were determined empirically by observing lots of uploads of big files  for  a
       range of file sizes.

       Upload with the “-v” flag to see more info about what rclone is doing in this situation.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_wait_per_gb

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_UPLOAD_WAIT_PER_GB

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 3m0s

   –acd-templink-threshold
       Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink.

       Files this size or more will be downloaded via their “tempLink”.  This is to work around a
       problem with Amazon Drive which blocks downloads of files bigger than about 10  GiB.   The
       default for this is 9 GiB which shouldn’t need to be changed.

       To  download  files above this threshold, rclone requests a “tempLink” which downloads the
       file through a temporary URL directly from the underlying S3 storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: templink_threshold

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TEMPLINK_THRESHOLD

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 9Gi

   –acd-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note that Amazon Drive is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and
       one called “hello.doc”.

       Amazon Drive has rate limiting so you may notice errors in the sync (429 errors).   rclone
       will  automatically  retry  the  sync  up to 3 times by default (see --retries flag) which
       should hopefully work around this problem.

       Amazon Drive has an internal limit of file sizes that can  be  uploaded  to  the  service.
       This limit is not officially published, but all files larger than this will fail.

       At  the  time  of  writing  (Jan 2016) is in the area of 50 GiB per file.  This means that
       larger files are likely to fail.

       Unfortunately there is no way for rclone to see that this failure is because of file size,
       so  it  will retry the operation, as any other failure.  To avoid this problem, use --max-
       size 50000M option to limit the maximum size of uploaded files.  Note that --max-size does
       not split files into segments, it only ignores files over this size.

       rclone  about  is  not  supported  by  the  Amazon  Drive  backend.  Backends without this
       capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy  mfs  (most  free
       space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Amazon S3 Storage Providers

       The S3 backend can be used with a number of different providers:

       • AWS S3

       • Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)

       • Ceph

       • China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

       • Cloudflare R2

       • Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

       • DigitalOcean Spaces

       • Dreamhost

       • Huawei OBS

       • IBM COS S3

       • IDrive e2

       • IONOS Cloud

       • Minio

       • Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)

       • RackCorp Object Storage

       • Scaleway

       • Seagate Lyve Cloud

       • SeaweedFS

       • StackPath

       • Storj

       • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

       • Wasabi

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:bucket  (or  remote:  for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

       Once you have made a remote (see the provider specific section above) you can use it  like
       this:

       See all buckets

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new bucket

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

       List the contents of a bucket

              rclone ls remote:bucket

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making an s3 configuration for the AWS S3 provider.  Most applies to
       the other providers as well, any differences are described below.

       First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
                 \ "s3"
              [snip]
              Storage> s3
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
                 \ "AWS"
               2 / Ceph Object Storage
                 \ "Ceph"
               3 / Digital Ocean Spaces
                 \ "DigitalOcean"
               4 / Dreamhost DreamObjects
                 \ "Dreamhost"
               5 / IBM COS S3
                 \ "IBMCOS"
               6 / Minio Object Storage
                 \ "Minio"
               7 / Wasabi Object Storage
                 \ "Wasabi"
               8 / Any other S3 compatible provider
                 \ "Other"
              provider> 1
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> 1
              AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              access_key_id> XXX
              AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              secret_access_key> YYY
              Region to connect to.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
                 / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
               1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
                 | Leave location constraint empty.
                 \ "us-east-1"
                 / US East (Ohio) Region
               2 | Needs location constraint us-east-2.
                 \ "us-east-2"
                 / US West (Oregon) Region
               3 | Needs location constraint us-west-2.
                 \ "us-west-2"
                 / US West (Northern California) Region
               4 | Needs location constraint us-west-1.
                 \ "us-west-1"
                 / Canada (Central) Region
               5 | Needs location constraint ca-central-1.
                 \ "ca-central-1"
                 / EU (Ireland) Region
               6 | Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.
                 \ "eu-west-1"
                 / EU (London) Region
               7 | Needs location constraint eu-west-2.
                 \ "eu-west-2"
                 / EU (Frankfurt) Region
               8 | Needs location constraint eu-central-1.
                 \ "eu-central-1"
                 / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region
               9 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
                 \ "ap-southeast-1"
                 / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region
              10 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.
                 \ "ap-southeast-2"
                 / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region
              11 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
                 \ "ap-northeast-1"
                 / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
              12 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.
                 \ "ap-northeast-2"
                 / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
              13 | Needs location constraint ap-south-1.
                 \ "ap-south-1"
                 / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region
              14 | Needs location constraint ap-east-1.
                 \ "ap-east-1"
                 / South America (Sao Paulo) Region
              15 | Needs location constraint sa-east-1.
                 \ "sa-east-1"
              region> 1
              Endpoint for S3 API.
              Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
              endpoint>
              Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
                 \ ""
               2 / US East (Ohio) Region.
                 \ "us-east-2"
               3 / US West (Oregon) Region.
                 \ "us-west-2"
               4 / US West (Northern California) Region.
                 \ "us-west-1"
               5 / Canada (Central) Region.
                 \ "ca-central-1"
               6 / EU (Ireland) Region.
                 \ "eu-west-1"
               7 / EU (London) Region.
                 \ "eu-west-2"
               8 / EU Region.
                 \ "EU"
               9 / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.
                 \ "ap-southeast-1"
              10 / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.
                 \ "ap-southeast-2"
              11 / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.
                 \ "ap-northeast-1"
              12 / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
                 \ "ap-northeast-2"
              13 / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
                 \ "ap-south-1"
              14 / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong)
                 \ "ap-east-1"
              15 / South America (Sao Paulo) Region.
                 \ "sa-east-1"
              location_constraint> 1
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ "private"
               2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ "public-read"
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
               3 | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
                 \ "public-read-write"
               4 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ "authenticated-read"
                 / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL. Bucket owner gets READ access.
               5 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
                 \ "bucket-owner-read"
                 / Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
               6 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
                 \ "bucket-owner-full-control"
              acl> 1
              The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / None
                 \ ""
               2 / AES256
                 \ "AES256"
              server_side_encryption> 1
              The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Default
                 \ ""
               2 / Standard storage class
                 \ "STANDARD"
               3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
                 \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
               4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
                 \ "STANDARD_IA"
               5 / One Zone Infrequent Access storage class
                 \ "ONEZONE_IA"
               6 / Glacier storage class
                 \ "GLACIER"
               7 / Glacier Deep Archive storage class
                 \ "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
               8 / Intelligent-Tiering storage class
                 \ "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
               9 / Glacier Instant Retrieval storage class
                 \ "GLACIER_IR"
              storage_class> 1
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = s3
              provider = AWS
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = XXX
              secret_access_key = YYY
              region = us-east-1
              endpoint =
              location_constraint =
              acl = private
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

   Modified time
       The modified time is stored as metadata on the  object  as  X-Amz-Meta-Mtime  as  floating
       point since the epoch, accurate to 1 ns.

       If  the modification time needs to be updated rclone will attempt to perform a server side
       copy to update the modification if the object can be copied in a single part.  In the case
       the  object is larger than 5Gb or is in Glacier or Glacier Deep Archive storage the object
       will be uploaded rather than copied.

       Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD request  as  the  metadata
       isn’t returned in object listings.

   Reducing costs
   Avoiding HEAD requests to read the modification time
       By  default,  rclone  will  use the modification time of objects stored in S3 for syncing.
       This is stored in object metadata which unfortunately takes an extra HEAD request to  read
       which can be expensive (in time and money).

       The modification time is used by default for all operations that require checking the time
       a file was last updated.   It  allows  rclone  to  treat  the  remote  more  like  a  true
       filesystem,  but it is inefficient on S3 because it requires an extra API call to retrieve
       the metadata.

       The extra API calls can be avoided when syncing (using rclone sync or rclone  copy)  in  a
       few different ways, each with its own tradeoffs.

       • --size-only

         • Only checks the size of files.

         • Uses no extra transactions.

         • If the file doesn’t change size then rclone won’t detect it has changed.

         • rclone sync --size-only /path/to/source s3:bucket--checksum

         • Checks the size and MD5 checksum of files.

         • Uses no extra transactions.

         • The most accurate detection of changes possible.

         • Will cause the source to read an MD5 checksum which, if it is a local disk, will cause
           lots of disk activity.

         • If the source and destination are both S3 this is the  recommended  flag  to  use  for
           maximum efficiency.

         • rclone sync --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket--update --use-server-modtime

         • Uses no extra transactions.

         • Modification time becomes the time the object was uploaded.

         • For many operations this is sufficient to determine if it needs uploading.

         • Using  --update along with --use-server-modtime, avoids the extra API call and uploads
           files whose local modification time is newer than the time it was last uploaded.

         • Files created with timestamps in the past will be missed by the sync.

         • rclone sync --update --use-server-modtime /path/to/source s3:bucket

       These flags can and should be used in combination with --fast-list - see below.

       If using rclone mount or any command using the VFS (eg rclone  serve)  commands  then  you
       might  want to consider using the VFS flag --no-modtime which will stop rclone reading the
       modification time for every object.  You could also use --use-server-modtime  if  you  are
       happy with the modification times of the objects being the time of upload.

   Avoiding GET requests to read directory listings
       Rclone’s  default  directory  traversal  is  to process each directory individually.  This
       takes one API call per directory.  Using the --fast-list flag will read all info about the
       objects into memory first using a smaller number of API calls (one per 1000 objects).  See
       the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more details.

              rclone sync --fast-list --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket

       --fast-list trades off API transactions for memory use.  As a rough guide rclone  uses  1k
       of  memory per object stored, so using --fast-list on a sync of a million objects will use
       roughly 1 GiB of RAM.

       If you are only copying a small number of files into a big  repository  then  using  --no-
       traverse  is  a  good  idea.   This  finds  objects  directly instead of through directory
       listings.  You can do a “top-up” sync very cheaply by using --max-age and --no-traverse to
       copy only recent files, eg

              rclone copy --max-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/source s3:bucket

       You’d then do a full rclone sync less often.

       Note that --fast-list isn’t required in the top-up sync.

   Avoiding HEAD requests after PUT
       By  default,  rclone  will HEAD every object it uploads.  It does this to check the object
       got uploaded correctly.

       You can disable this with the –s3-no-head option - see there for more details.

       Setting this flag increases the chance for undetected upload failures.

   Hashes
       For small objects which  weren’t  uploaded  as  multipart  uploads  (objects  sized  below
       --s3-upload-cutoff  if  uploaded  with  rclone)  rclone  uses  the  ETag: header as an MD5
       checksum.

       However for objects  which  were  uploaded  as  multipart  uploads  or  with  server  side
       encryption  (SSE-AWS  or  SSE-C)  the ETag header is no longer the MD5 sum of the data, so
       rclone adds an additional piece of metadata X-Amz-Meta-Md5chksum which is a base64 encoded
       MD5 hash (in the same format as is required for Content-MD5).

       For  large  objects, calculating this hash can take some time so the addition of this hash
       can be disabled with --s3-disable-checksum.  This will mean that these objects do not have
       an MD5 checksum.

       Note  that  reading  this from the object takes an additional HEAD request as the metadata
       isn’t returned in object listings.

   Versions
       When bucket versioning is enabled (this can be done with rclone with  the  rclone  backend
       versioning  command)  when rclone uploads a new version of a file it creates a new version
       of  it  (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/userguide/Versioning.html)   Likewise
       when you delete a file, the old version will be marked hidden and still be available.

       Old versions of files, where available, are visible using the --s3-versions flag.

       It  is  also  possible  to  view  a bucket as it was at a certain point in time, using the
       --s3-version-at flag.  This will show the file versions as they were at that time, showing
       files that have been deleted afterwards, and hiding files that were created since.

       If  you  wish  to remove all the old versions then you can use the rclone backend cleanup-
       hidden remote:bucket command which will delete all  the  old  hidden  versions  of  files,
       leaving  the  current ones intact.  You can also supply a path and only old versions under
       that    path    will    be    deleted,     e.g.      rclone     backend     cleanup-hidden
       remote:bucket/path/to/stuff.

       When  you purge a bucket, the current and the old versions will be deleted then the bucket
       will be deleted.

       However delete will cause the current versions of the files to become hidden old versions.

       Here is a session showing the listing and retrieval  of  an  old  version  followed  by  a
       cleanup of the old versions.

       Show current version and all the versions with --s3-versions flag.

              $ rclone -q ls s3:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

              $ rclone -q --s3-versions ls s3:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt
                      8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                     16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                     15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

       Retrieve an old version

              $ rclone -q --s3-versions copy s3:cleanup-test/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt /tmp

              $ ls -l /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
              -rw-rw-r-- 1 ncw ncw 16 Jul  2 17:46 /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt

       Clean up all the old versions and show that they’ve gone.

              $ rclone -q backend cleanup-hidden s3:cleanup-test

              $ rclone -q ls s3:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

              $ rclone -q --s3-versions ls s3:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

   Cleanup
       If  you  run  rclone  cleanup  s3:bucket then it will remove all pending multipart uploads
       older than 24 hours.  You can use the -i flag to see exactly what it will do.  If you want
       more  control over the expiry date then run rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket -o max-age=1h
       to expire all uploads older than one hour.  You can  use  rclone  backend  list-multipart-
       uploads s3:bucket to see the pending multipart uploads.

   Restricted filename characters
       S3 allows any valid UTF-8 string as a key.

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as they
       can’t be used in XML.

       The following characters are replaced since these are problematic when  dealing  with  the
       REST API:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /

       The  encoding  will  also  encode these file names as they don’t seem to work with the SDK
       properly:

       File name   Replacement
       ────────────────────────
       .               .
       ..             ..

   Multipart uploads
       rclone supports multipart uploads with S3 which means that it can upload files bigger than
       5 GiB.

       Note  that files uploaded both with multipart upload and through crypt remotes do not have
       MD5 sums.

       rclone switches from single part uploads to multipart uploads at the  point  specified  by
       --s3-upload-cutoff.   This  can be a maximum of 5 GiB and a minimum of 0 (ie always upload
       multipart files).

       The chunk sizes used in the multipart upload are  specified  by  --s3-chunk-size  and  the
       number of chunks uploaded concurrently is specified by --s3-upload-concurrency.

       Multipart  uploads  will use --transfers * --s3-upload-concurrency * --s3-chunk-size extra
       memory.  Single part uploads to not use extra memory.

       Single part transfers can be faster than multipart transfers or slower depending  on  your
       latency from S3 - the more latency, the more likely single part transfers will be faster.

       Increasing  --s3-upload-concurrency will increase throughput (8 would be a sensible value)
       and  increasing  --s3-chunk-size  also  increases  throughput  (16M  would  be  sensible).
       Increasing  either  of  these will use more memory.  The default values are high enough to
       gain most of the possible performance without using too much memory.

   Buckets and Regions
       With Amazon S3 you can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any region, but you can only access
       the  content  of  a  bucket from the region it was created in.  If you attempt to access a
       bucket from the wrong region, you will get an error, incorrect region, the bucket  is  not
       in 'XXX' region.

   Authentication
       There  are  a  number  of  ways  to  supply rclone with a set of AWS credentials, with and
       without using the environment.

       The different authentication methods are tried in this order:

       • Directly in the rclone configuration file (env_auth = false in the config file):

         • access_key_id and secret_access_key are required.

         • session_token can be optionally set when using AWS STS.

       • Runtime configuration (env_auth = true in the config file):

         • Export the following environment variables before running rclone:

           • Access Key ID: AWS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or AWS_ACCESS_KEY

           • Secret Access Key: AWS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or AWS_SECRET_KEY

           • Session Token: AWS_SESSION_TOKEN (optional)

         • Or,  use  a   named   profile   (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/cli/latest/userguide/cli-
           multiple-profiles.html):

           • Profile files are standard files used by AWS CLI tools

           • By  default  it will use the profile in your home directory (e.g. ~/.aws/credentials
             on unix based  systems)  file  and  the  “default”  profile,  to  change  set  these
             environment variables:

             • AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE to control which file.

             • AWS_PROFILE to control which profile to use.

         • Or, run rclone in an ECS task with an IAM role (AWS only).

         • Or, run rclone on an EC2 instance with an IAM role (AWS only).

         • Or,  run  rclone  in  an  EKS  pod  with an IAM role that is associated with a service
           account (AWS only).

       If none of these option actually end up providing rclone  with  AWS  credentials  then  S3
       interaction will be non-authenticated (see below).

   S3 Permissions
       When using the sync subcommand of rclone the following minimum permissions are required to
       be available on the bucket being written to:

       • ListBucketDeleteObjectGetObjectPutObjectPutObjectACL

       When using the lsd subcommand, the ListAllMyBuckets permission is required.

       Example policy:

              {
                  "Version": "2012-10-17",
                  "Statement": [
                      {
                          "Effect": "Allow",
                          "Principal": {
                              "AWS": "arn:aws:iam::USER_SID:user/USER_NAME"
                          },
                          "Action": [
                              "s3:ListBucket",
                              "s3:DeleteObject",
                              "s3:GetObject",
                              "s3:PutObject",
                              "s3:PutObjectAcl"
                          ],
                          "Resource": [
                            "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME/*",
                            "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME"
                          ]
                      },
                      {
                          "Effect": "Allow",
                          "Action": "s3:ListAllMyBuckets",
                          "Resource": "arn:aws:s3:::*"
                      }
                  ]
              }

       Notes on above:

       1. This is a policy that can be used when creating bucket.  It assumes that USER_NAME  has
          been created.

       2. The  Resource  entry must include both resource ARNs, as one implies the bucket and the
          other implies the bucket’s objects.

       For           reference,           here’s           an           Ansible            script
       (https://gist.github.com/ebridges/ebfc9042dd7c756cd101cfa807b7ae2b) that will generate one
       or more buckets that will work with rclone sync.

   Key Management System (KMS)
       If you are using server-side encryption with  KMS  then  you  must  make  sure  rclone  is
       configured  with  server_side_encryption  =  aws:kms  otherwise  you  will  find you can’t
       transfer small objects - these will create checksum errors.

   Glacier and Glacier Deep Archive
       You can upload objects using the glacier storage class or transition them to glacier using
       a    lifecycle    policy    (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/user-guide/create-
       lifecycle.html).  The bucket can still be synced or copied into normally,  but  if  rclone
       tries to access data from the glacier storage class you will see an error like below.

              2017/09/11 19:07:43 Failed to sync: failed to open source object: Object in GLACIER, restore first: path/to/file

       In   this  case  you  need  to  restore  (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/user-
       guide/restore-archived-objects.html) the object(s) in question before using rclone.

       Note that rclone only speaks the S3 API it does not speak the Glacier Vault API, so rclone
       cannot directly access Glacier Vaults.

   Object-lock enabled S3 bucket
       According       to       AWS’s       documentation       on       S3      Object      Lock
       (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/userguide/object-lock-overview.html#object-
       lock-permission):

              If you configure a default retention period on a bucket, requests to upload objects
              in such a bucket must include the Content-MD5 header.

       As mentioned in the Hashes section, small files that are not uploaded as multipart, use  a
       different  tag,  causing the upload to fail.  A simple solution is to set the --s3-upload-
       cutoff 0 and force all the files to be uploaded as multipart.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific  to  s3  (Amazon  S3  Compliant  Storage  Providers
       including  AWS,  Alibaba,  Ceph,  China  Mobile,  Cloudflare,  ArvanCloud,  Digital Ocean,
       Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive  e2,  IONOS  Cloud,  Lyve  Cloud,  Minio,  Netease,
       RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS, Qiniu and Wasabi).

   –s3-provider
       Choose your S3 provider.

       Properties:

       • Config: provider

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROVIDER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “AWS”

           • Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3

         • “Alibaba”

           • Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun

         • “Ceph”

           • Ceph Object Storage

         • “ChinaMobile”

           • China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)

         • “Cloudflare”

           • Cloudflare R2 Storage

         • “ArvanCloud”

           • Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS)

         • “DigitalOcean”

           • Digital Ocean Spaces

         • “Dreamhost”

           • Dreamhost DreamObjects

         • “HuaweiOBS”

           • Huawei Object Storage Service

         • “IBMCOS”

           • IBM COS S3

         • “IDrive”

           • IDrive e2

         • “IONOS”

           • IONOS Cloud

         • “LyveCloud”

           • Seagate Lyve Cloud

         • “Minio”

           • Minio Object Storage

         • “Netease”

           • Netease Object Storage (NOS)

         • “RackCorp”

           • RackCorp Object Storage

         • “Scaleway”

           • Scaleway Object Storage

         • “SeaweedFS”

           • SeaweedFS S3

         • “StackPath”

           • StackPath Object Storage

         • “Storj”

           • Storj (S3 Compatible Gateway)

         • “TencentCOS”

           • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)

         • “Wasabi”

           • Wasabi Object Storage

         • “Qiniu”

           • Qiniu Object Storage (Kodo)

         • “Other”

           • Any other S3 compatible provider

   –s3-env-auth
       Get  AWS  credentials  from  runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env
       vars).

       Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

       Properties:

       • Config: env_auth

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENV_AUTH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “false”

           • Enter AWS credentials in the next step.

         • “true”

           • Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).

   –s3-access-key-id
       AWS Access Key ID.

       Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_key_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACCESS_KEY_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-secret-access-key
       AWS Secret Access Key (password).

       Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

       Properties:

       • Config: secret_access_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “us-east-1”

           • The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

           • US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.

           • Leave location constraint empty.

         • “us-east-2”

           • US East (Ohio) Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-east-2.

         • “us-west-1”

           • US West (Northern California) Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-west-1.

         • “us-west-2”

           • US West (Oregon) Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-west-2.

         • “ca-central-1”

           • Canada (Central) Region.

           • Needs location constraint ca-central-1.

         • “eu-west-1”

           • EU (Ireland) Region.

           • Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.

         • “eu-west-2”

           • EU (London) Region.

           • Needs location constraint eu-west-2.

         • “eu-west-3”

           • EU (Paris) Region.

           • Needs location constraint eu-west-3.

         • “eu-north-1”

           • EU (Stockholm) Region.

           • Needs location constraint eu-north-1.

         • “eu-south-1”

           • EU (Milan) Region.

           • Needs location constraint eu-south-1.

         • “eu-central-1”

           • EU (Frankfurt) Region.

           • Needs location constraint eu-central-1.

         • “ap-southeast-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.

           • Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.

         • “ap-southeast-2”

           • Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.

           • Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.

         • “ap-northeast-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.

           • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.

         • “ap-northeast-2”

           • Asia Pacific (Seoul).

           • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.

         • “ap-northeast-3”

           • Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local).

           • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-3.

         • “ap-south-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Mumbai).

           • Needs location constraint ap-south-1.

         • “ap-east-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region.

           • Needs location constraint ap-east-1.

         • “sa-east-1”

           • South America (Sao Paulo) Region.

           • Needs location constraint sa-east-1.

         • “me-south-1”

           • Middle East (Bahrain) Region.

           • Needs location constraint me-south-1.

         • “af-south-1”

           • Africa (Cape Town) Region.

           • Needs location constraint af-south-1.

         • “cn-north-1”

           • China (Beijing) Region.

           • Needs location constraint cn-north-1.

         • “cn-northwest-1”

           • China (Ningxia) Region.

           • Needs location constraint cn-northwest-1.

         • “us-gov-east-1”

           • AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-gov-east-1.

         • “us-gov-west-1”

           • AWS GovCloud (US) Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-gov-west-1.

   –s3-region
       region - the location where your bucket will be created and your data stored.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: RackCorp

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “global”

           • Global CDN (All locations) Region

         • “au”

           • Australia (All states)

         • “au-nsw”

           • NSW (Australia) Region

         • “au-qld”

           • QLD (Australia) Region

         • “au-vic”

           • VIC (Australia) Region

         • “au-wa”

           • Perth (Australia) Region

         • “ph”

           • Manila (Philippines) Region

         • “th”

           • Bangkok (Thailand) Region

         • “hk”

           • HK (Hong Kong) Region

         • “mn”

           • Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Region

         • “kg”

           • Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Region

         • “id”

           • Jakarta (Indonesia) Region

         • “jp”

           • Tokyo (Japan) Region

         • “sg”

           • SG (Singapore) Region

         • “de”

           • Frankfurt (Germany) Region

         • “us”

           • USA (AnyCast) Region

         • “us-east-1”

           • New York (USA) Region

         • “us-west-1”

           • Freemont (USA) Region

         • “nz”

           • Auckland (New Zealand) Region

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: Scaleway

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “nl-ams”

           • Amsterdam, The Netherlands

         • “fr-par”

           • Paris, France

         • “pl-waw”

           • Warsaw, Poland

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.  - the location where your bucket will  be  created  and  your  data
       stored.  Need bo be same with your endpoint.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: HuaweiOBS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “af-south-1”

           • AF-Johannesburg

         • “ap-southeast-2”

           • AP-Bangkok

         • “ap-southeast-3”

           • AP-Singapore

         • “cn-east-3”

           • CN East-Shanghai1

         • “cn-east-2”

           • CN East-Shanghai2

         • “cn-north-1”

           • CN North-Beijing1

         • “cn-north-4”

           • CN North-Beijing4

         • “cn-south-1”

           • CN South-Guangzhou

         • “ap-southeast-1”

           • CN-Hong Kong

         • “sa-argentina-1”

           • LA-Buenos Aires1

         • “sa-peru-1”

           • LA-Lima1

         • “na-mexico-1”

           • LA-Mexico City1

         • “sa-chile-1”

           • LA-Santiago2

         • “sa-brazil-1”

           • LA-Sao Paulo1

         • “ru-northwest-2”

           • RU-Moscow2

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: Cloudflare

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “auto”

           • R2  buckets  are  automatically distributed across Cloudflare’s data centers for low
             latency.

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: Qiniu

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “cn-east-1”

           • The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

           • East China Region 1.

           • Needs location constraint cn-east-1.

         • “cn-east-2”

           • East China Region 2.

           • Needs location constraint cn-east-2.

         • “cn-north-1”

           • North China Region 1.

           • Needs location constraint cn-north-1.

         • “cn-south-1”

           • South China Region 1.

           • Needs location constraint cn-south-1.

         • “us-north-1”

           • North America Region.

           • Needs location constraint us-north-1.

         • “ap-southeast-1”

           • Southeast Asia Region 1.

           • Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.

         • “ap-northeast-1”

           • Northeast Asia Region 1.

           • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.

   –s3-region
       Region where your bucket will be created and your data stored.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider: IONOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “de”

           • Frankfurt, Germany

         • “eu-central-2”

           • Berlin, Germany

         • “eu-south-2”

           • Logrono, Spain

   –s3-region
       Region to connect to.

       Leave blank if you are using an S3 clone and you don’t have a region.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION

       • Provider:
         !AWS,Alibaba,ChinaMobile,Cloudflare,IONOS,ArvanCloud,Qiniu,RackCorp,Scaleway,Storj,TencentCOS,HuaweiOBS,IDrive

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Use this if unsure.

           • Will use v4 signatures and an empty region.

         • “other-v2-signature”

           • Use this only if v4 signatures don’t work.

           • E.g.  pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for S3 API.

       Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS) API.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: ChinaMobile

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

           • East China (Suzhou)

         • “eos-jinan-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • East China (Jinan)

         • “eos-ningbo-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • East China (Hangzhou)

         • “eos-shanghai-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • East China (Shanghai-1)

         • “eos-zhengzhou-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Central China (Zhengzhou)

         • “eos-hunan-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Central China (Changsha-1)

         • “eos-zhuzhou-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Central China (Changsha-2)

         • “eos-guangzhou-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • South China (Guangzhou-2)

         • “eos-dongguan-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • South China (Guangzhou-3)

         • “eos-beijing-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • North China (Beijing-1)

         • “eos-beijing-2.cmecloud.cn”

           • North China (Beijing-2)

         • “eos-beijing-4.cmecloud.cn”

           • North China (Beijing-3)

         • “eos-huhehaote-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • North China (Huhehaote)

         • “eos-chengdu-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Southwest China (Chengdu)

         • “eos-chongqing-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Southwest China (Chongqing)

         • “eos-guiyang-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Southwest China (Guiyang)

         • “eos-xian-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Nouthwest China (Xian)

         • “eos-yunnan.cmecloud.cn”

           • Yunnan China (Kunming)

         • “eos-yunnan-2.cmecloud.cn”

           • Yunnan China (Kunming-2)

         • “eos-tianjin-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Tianjin China (Tianjin)

         • “eos-jilin-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Jilin China (Changchun)

         • “eos-hubei-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Hubei China (Xiangyan)

         • “eos-jiangxi-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Jiangxi China (Nanchang)

         • “eos-gansu-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Gansu China (Lanzhou)

         • “eos-shanxi-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Shanxi China (Taiyuan)

         • “eos-liaoning-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Liaoning China (Shenyang)

         • “eos-hebei-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)

         • “eos-fujian-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Fujian China (Xiamen)

         • “eos-guangxi-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Guangxi China (Nanning)

         • “eos-anhui-1.cmecloud.cn”

           • Anhui China (Huainan)

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for Arvan Cloud Object Storage (AOS) API.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: ArvanCloud

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3.ir-thr-at1.arvanstorage.com”

           • The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.

           • Tehran Iran (Asiatech)

         • “s3.ir-tbz-sh1.arvanstorage.com”

           • Tabriz Iran (Shahriar)

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.

       Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: IBMCOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Endpoint

         • “s3.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint

         • “s3.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint

         • “s3.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint

         • “s3.private.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint

         • “s3.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Region East Endpoint

         • “s3.private.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Region East Private Endpoint

         • “s3.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Region South Endpoint

         • “s3.private.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • US Region South Private Endpoint

         • “s3.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Endpoint

         • “s3.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Frankfurt Endpoint

         • “s3.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Milan Endpoint

         • “s3.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Amsterdam Endpoint

         • “s3.private.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Frankfurt Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Milan Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Cross Region Amsterdam Private Endpoint

         • “s3.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Great Britain Endpoint

         • “s3.private.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Great Britain Private Endpoint

         • “s3.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Region DE Endpoint

         • “s3.private.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • EU Region DE Private Endpoint

         • “s3.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Endpoint

         • “s3.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Endpoint

         • “s3.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional HongKong Endpoint

         • “s3.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Seoul Endpoint

         • “s3.private.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional HongKong Private Endpoint

         • “s3.private.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Cross Regional Seoul Private Endpoint

         • “s3.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Region Japan Endpoint

         • “s3.private.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Region Japan Private Endpoint

         • “s3.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Region Australia Endpoint

         • “s3.private.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • APAC Region Australia Private Endpoint

         • “s3.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Amsterdam Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Amsterdam Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Chennai Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Chennai Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Melbourne Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Melbourne Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Oslo Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Oslo Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Toronto Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Seoul Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Seoul Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Montreal Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Montreal Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Mexico Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Mexico Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • San Jose Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • San Jose Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Milan Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Milan Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Hong Kong Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Hong Kong Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Paris Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Paris Single Site Private Endpoint

         • “s3.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Singapore Single Site Endpoint

         • “s3.private.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud”

           • Singapore Single Site Private Endpoint

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for IONOS S3 Object Storage.

       Specify the endpoint from the same region.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: IONOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com”

           • Frankfurt, Germany

         • “s3-eu-central-2.ionoscloud.com”

           • Berlin, Germany

         • “s3-eu-south-2.ionoscloud.com”

           • Logrono, Spain

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for OSS API.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: Alibaba

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “oss-accelerate.aliyuncs.com”

           • Global Accelerate

         • “oss-accelerate-overseas.aliyuncs.com”

           • Global Accelerate (outside mainland China)

         • “oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com”

           • East China 1 (Hangzhou)

         • “oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com”

           • East China 2 (Shanghai)

         • “oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com”

           • North China 1 (Qingdao)

         • “oss-cn-beijing.aliyuncs.com”

           • North China 2 (Beijing)

         • “oss-cn-zhangjiakou.aliyuncs.com”

           • North China 3 (Zhangjiakou)

         • “oss-cn-huhehaote.aliyuncs.com”

           • North China 5 (Hohhot)

         • “oss-cn-wulanchabu.aliyuncs.com”

           • North China 6 (Ulanqab)

         • “oss-cn-shenzhen.aliyuncs.com”

           • South China 1 (Shenzhen)

         • “oss-cn-heyuan.aliyuncs.com”

           • South China 2 (Heyuan)

         • “oss-cn-guangzhou.aliyuncs.com”

           • South China 3 (Guangzhou)

         • “oss-cn-chengdu.aliyuncs.com”

           • West China 1 (Chengdu)

         • “oss-cn-hongkong.aliyuncs.com”

           • Hong Kong (Hong Kong)

         • “oss-us-west-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • US West 1 (Silicon Valley)

         • “oss-us-east-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • US East 1 (Virginia)

         • “oss-ap-southeast-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • Southeast Asia Southeast 1 (Singapore)

         • “oss-ap-southeast-2.aliyuncs.com”

           • Asia Pacific Southeast 2 (Sydney)

         • “oss-ap-southeast-3.aliyuncs.com”

           • Southeast Asia Southeast 3 (Kuala Lumpur)

         • “oss-ap-southeast-5.aliyuncs.com”

           • Asia Pacific Southeast 5 (Jakarta)

         • “oss-ap-northeast-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • Asia Pacific Northeast 1 (Japan)

         • “oss-ap-south-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • Asia Pacific South 1 (Mumbai)

         • “oss-eu-central-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • Central Europe 1 (Frankfurt)

         • “oss-eu-west-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • West Europe (London)

         • “oss-me-east-1.aliyuncs.com”

           • Middle East 1 (Dubai)

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for OBS API.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: HuaweiOBS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • AF-Johannesburg

         • “obs.ap-southeast-2.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • AP-Bangkok

         • “obs.ap-southeast-3.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • AP-Singapore

         • “obs.cn-east-3.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN East-Shanghai1

         • “obs.cn-east-2.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN East-Shanghai2

         • “obs.cn-north-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN North-Beijing1

         • “obs.cn-north-4.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN North-Beijing4

         • “obs.cn-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN South-Guangzhou

         • “obs.ap-southeast-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • CN-Hong Kong

         • “obs.sa-argentina-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • LA-Buenos Aires1

         • “obs.sa-peru-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • LA-Lima1

         • “obs.na-mexico-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • LA-Mexico City1

         • “obs.sa-chile-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • LA-Santiago2

         • “obs.sa-brazil-1.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • LA-Sao Paulo1

         • “obs.ru-northwest-2.myhuaweicloud.com”

           • RU-Moscow2

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for Scaleway Object Storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: Scaleway

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud”

           • Amsterdam Endpoint

         • “s3.fr-par.scw.cloud”

           • Paris Endpoint

         • “s3.pl-waw.scw.cloud”

           • Warsaw Endpoint

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for StackPath Object Storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: StackPath

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3.us-east-2.stackpathstorage.com”

           • US East Endpoint

         • “s3.us-west-1.stackpathstorage.com”

           • US West Endpoint

         • “s3.eu-central-1.stackpathstorage.com”

           • EU Endpoint

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint of the Shared Gateway.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: Storj

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “gateway.eu1.storjshare.io”

           • EU1 Shared Gateway

         • “gateway.us1.storjshare.io”

           • US1 Shared Gateway

         • “gateway.ap1.storjshare.io”

           • Asia-Pacific Shared Gateway

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for Tencent COS API.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: TencentCOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com”

           • Beijing Region

         • “cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com”

           • Nanjing Region

         • “cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com”

           • Shanghai Region

         • “cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com”

           • Guangzhou Region

         • “cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com”

           • Nanjing Region

         • “cos.ap-chengdu.myqcloud.com”

           • Chengdu Region

         • “cos.ap-chongqing.myqcloud.com”

           • Chongqing Region

         • “cos.ap-hongkong.myqcloud.com”

           • Hong Kong (China) Region

         • “cos.ap-singapore.myqcloud.com”

           • Singapore Region

         • “cos.ap-mumbai.myqcloud.com”

           • Mumbai Region

         • “cos.ap-seoul.myqcloud.com”

           • Seoul Region

         • “cos.ap-bangkok.myqcloud.com”

           • Bangkok Region

         • “cos.ap-tokyo.myqcloud.com”

           • Tokyo Region

         • “cos.na-siliconvalley.myqcloud.com”

           • Silicon Valley Region

         • “cos.na-ashburn.myqcloud.com”

           • Virginia Region

         • “cos.na-toronto.myqcloud.com”

           • Toronto Region

         • “cos.eu-frankfurt.myqcloud.com”

           • Frankfurt Region

         • “cos.eu-moscow.myqcloud.com”

           • Moscow Region

         • “cos.accelerate.myqcloud.com”

           • Use Tencent COS Accelerate Endpoint

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for RackCorp Object Storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: RackCorp

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Global (AnyCast) Endpoint

         • “au.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Australia (Anycast) Endpoint

         • “au-nsw.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Sydney (Australia) Endpoint

         • “au-qld.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Brisbane (Australia) Endpoint

         • “au-vic.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Melbourne (Australia) Endpoint

         • “au-wa.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Perth (Australia) Endpoint

         • “ph.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Manila (Philippines) Endpoint

         • “th.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Bangkok (Thailand) Endpoint

         • “hk.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • HK (Hong Kong) Endpoint

         • “mn.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Endpoint

         • “kg.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Endpoint

         • “id.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Jakarta (Indonesia) Endpoint

         • “jp.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Tokyo (Japan) Endpoint

         • “sg.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • SG (Singapore) Endpoint

         • “de.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Frankfurt (Germany) Endpoint

         • “us.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • USA (AnyCast) Endpoint

         • “us-east-1.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • New York (USA) Endpoint

         • “us-west-1.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Freemont (USA) Endpoint

         • “nz.s3.rackcorp.com”

           • Auckland (New Zealand) Endpoint

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for Qiniu Object Storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: Qiniu

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com”

           • East China Endpoint 1

         • “s3-cn-east-2.qiniucs.com”

           • East China Endpoint 2

         • “s3-cn-north-1.qiniucs.com”

           • North China Endpoint 1

         • “s3-cn-south-1.qiniucs.com”

           • South China Endpoint 1

         • “s3-us-north-1.qiniucs.com”

           • North America Endpoint 1

         • “s3-ap-southeast-1.qiniucs.com”

           • Southeast Asia Endpoint 1

         • “s3-ap-northeast-1.qiniucs.com”

           • Northeast Asia Endpoint 1

   –s3-endpoint
       Endpoint for S3 API.

       Required when using an S3 clone.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT

       • Provider:
         !AWS,IBMCOS,IDrive,IONOS,TencentCOS,HuaweiOBS,Alibaba,ChinaMobile,ArvanCloud,Scaleway,StackPath,Storj,RackCorp,Qiniu

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “objects-us-east-1.dream.io”

           • Dream Objects endpoint

         • “nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com”

           • Digital Ocean Spaces New York 3

         • “ams3.digitaloceanspaces.com”

           • Digital Ocean Spaces Amsterdam 3

         • “sgp1.digitaloceanspaces.com”

           • Digital Ocean Spaces Singapore 1

         • “localhost:8333”

           • SeaweedFS S3 localhost

         • “s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com”

           • Seagate Lyve Cloud US East 1 (Virginia)

         • “s3.us-west-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com”

           • Seagate Lyve Cloud US West 1 (California)

         • “s3.ap-southeast-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com”

           • Seagate Lyve Cloud AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)

         • “s3.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi US East 1 (N.  Virginia)

         • “s3.us-east-2.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi US East 2 (N.  Virginia)

         • “s3.us-central-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi US Central 1 (Texas)

         • “s3.us-west-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi US West 1 (Oregon)

         • “s3.ca-central-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi CA Central 1 (Toronto)

         • “s3.eu-central-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi EU Central 1 (Amsterdam)

         • “s3.eu-central-2.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi EU Central 2 (Frankfurt)

         • “s3.eu-west-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi EU West 1 (London)

         • “s3.eu-west-2.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi EU West 2 (Paris)

         • “s3.ap-northeast-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi AP Northeast 1 (Tokyo) endpoint

         • “s3.ap-northeast-2.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi AP Northeast 2 (Osaka) endpoint

         • “s3.ap-southeast-1.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)

         • “s3.ap-southeast-2.wasabisys.com”

           • Wasabi AP Southeast 2 (Sydney)

         • “s3.ir-thr-at1.arvanstorage.com”

           • ArvanCloud Tehran Iran (Asiatech) endpoint

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

       Used when creating buckets only.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest

         • “us-east-2”

           • US East (Ohio) Region

         • “us-west-1”

           • US West (Northern California) Region

         • “us-west-2”

           • US West (Oregon) Region

         • “ca-central-1”

           • Canada (Central) Region

         • “eu-west-1”

           • EU (Ireland) Region

         • “eu-west-2”

           • EU (London) Region

         • “eu-west-3”

           • EU (Paris) Region

         • “eu-north-1”

           • EU (Stockholm) Region

         • “eu-south-1”

           • EU (Milan) Region

         • “EU”

           • EU Region

         • “ap-southeast-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region

         • “ap-southeast-2”

           • Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region

         • “ap-northeast-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region

         • “ap-northeast-2”

           • Asia Pacific (Seoul) Region

         • “ap-northeast-3”

           • Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local) Region

         • “ap-south-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Mumbai) Region

         • “ap-east-1”

           • Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region

         • “sa-east-1”

           • South America (Sao Paulo) Region

         • “me-south-1”

           • Middle East (Bahrain) Region

         • “af-south-1”

           • Africa (Cape Town) Region

         • “cn-north-1”

           • China (Beijing) Region

         • “cn-northwest-1”

           • China (Ningxia) Region

         • “us-gov-east-1”

           • AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region

         • “us-gov-west-1”

           • AWS GovCloud (US) Region

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must match endpoint.

       Used when creating buckets only.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: ChinaMobile

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “wuxi1”

           • East China (Suzhou)

         • “jinan1”

           • East China (Jinan)

         • “ningbo1”

           • East China (Hangzhou)

         • “shanghai1”

           • East China (Shanghai-1)

         • “zhengzhou1”

           • Central China (Zhengzhou)

         • “hunan1”

           • Central China (Changsha-1)

         • “zhuzhou1”

           • Central China (Changsha-2)

         • “guangzhou1”

           • South China (Guangzhou-2)

         • “dongguan1”

           • South China (Guangzhou-3)

         • “beijing1”

           • North China (Beijing-1)

         • “beijing2”

           • North China (Beijing-2)

         • “beijing4”

           • North China (Beijing-3)

         • “huhehaote1”

           • North China (Huhehaote)

         • “chengdu1”

           • Southwest China (Chengdu)

         • “chongqing1”

           • Southwest China (Chongqing)

         • “guiyang1”

           • Southwest China (Guiyang)

         • “xian1”

           • Nouthwest China (Xian)

         • “yunnan”

           • Yunnan China (Kunming)

         • “yunnan2”

           • Yunnan China (Kunming-2)

         • “tianjin1”

           • Tianjin China (Tianjin)

         • “jilin1”

           • Jilin China (Changchun)

         • “hubei1”

           • Hubei China (Xiangyan)

         • “jiangxi1”

           • Jiangxi China (Nanchang)

         • “gansu1”

           • Gansu China (Lanzhou)

         • “shanxi1”

           • Shanxi China (Taiyuan)

         • “liaoning1”

           • Liaoning China (Shenyang)

         • “hebei1”

           • Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)

         • “fujian1”

           • Fujian China (Xiamen)

         • “guangxi1”

           • Guangxi China (Nanning)

         • “anhui1”

           • Anhui China (Huainan)

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must match endpoint.

       Used when creating buckets only.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: ArvanCloud

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “ir-thr-at1”

           • Tehran Iran (Asiatech)

         • “ir-tbz-sh1”

           • Tabriz Iran (Shahriar)

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must match endpoint when using IBM Cloud Public.

       For on-prem COS, do not make a selection from this list, hit enter.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: IBMCOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “us-standard”

           • US Cross Region Standard

         • “us-vault”

           • US Cross Region Vault

         • “us-cold”

           • US Cross Region Cold

         • “us-flex”

           • US Cross Region Flex

         • “us-east-standard”

           • US East Region Standard

         • “us-east-vault”

           • US East Region Vault

         • “us-east-cold”

           • US East Region Cold

         • “us-east-flex”

           • US East Region Flex

         • “us-south-standard”

           • US South Region Standard

         • “us-south-vault”

           • US South Region Vault

         • “us-south-cold”

           • US South Region Cold

         • “us-south-flex”

           • US South Region Flex

         • “eu-standard”

           • EU Cross Region Standard

         • “eu-vault”

           • EU Cross Region Vault

         • “eu-cold”

           • EU Cross Region Cold

         • “eu-flex”

           • EU Cross Region Flex

         • “eu-gb-standard”

           • Great Britain Standard

         • “eu-gb-vault”

           • Great Britain Vault

         • “eu-gb-cold”

           • Great Britain Cold

         • “eu-gb-flex”

           • Great Britain Flex

         • “ap-standard”

           • APAC Standard

         • “ap-vault”

           • APAC Vault

         • “ap-cold”

           • APAC Cold

         • “ap-flex”

           • APAC Flex

         • “mel01-standard”

           • Melbourne Standard

         • “mel01-vault”

           • Melbourne Vault

         • “mel01-cold”

           • Melbourne Cold

         • “mel01-flex”

           • Melbourne Flex

         • “tor01-standard”

           • Toronto Standard

         • “tor01-vault”

           • Toronto Vault

         • “tor01-cold”

           • Toronto Cold

         • “tor01-flex”

           • Toronto Flex

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - the location where your bucket will be located and your data stored.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: RackCorp

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “global”

           • Global CDN Region

         • “au”

           • Australia (All locations)

         • “au-nsw”

           • NSW (Australia) Region

         • “au-qld”

           • QLD (Australia) Region

         • “au-vic”

           • VIC (Australia) Region

         • “au-wa”

           • Perth (Australia) Region

         • “ph”

           • Manila (Philippines) Region

         • “th”

           • Bangkok (Thailand) Region

         • “hk”

           • HK (Hong Kong) Region

         • “mn”

           • Ulaanbaatar (Mongolia) Region

         • “kg”

           • Bishkek (Kyrgyzstan) Region

         • “id”

           • Jakarta (Indonesia) Region

         • “jp”

           • Tokyo (Japan) Region

         • “sg”

           • SG (Singapore) Region

         • “de”

           • Frankfurt (Germany) Region

         • “us”

           • USA (AnyCast) Region

         • “us-east-1”

           • New York (USA) Region

         • “us-west-1”

           • Freemont (USA) Region

         • “nz”

           • Auckland (New Zealand) Region

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

       Used when creating buckets only.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider: Qiniu

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “cn-east-1”

           • East China Region 1

         • “cn-east-2”

           • East China Region 2

         • “cn-north-1”

           • North China Region 1

         • “cn-south-1”

           • South China Region 1

         • “us-north-1”

           • North America Region 1

         • “ap-southeast-1”

           • Southeast Asia Region 1

         • “ap-northeast-1”

           • Northeast Asia Region 1

   –s3-location-constraint
       Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.

       Leave blank if not sure.  Used when creating buckets only.

       Properties:

       • Config: location_constraint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT

       • Provider:
         !AWS,Alibaba,HuaweiOBS,ChinaMobile,Cloudflare,IBMCOS,IDrive,IONOS,ArvanCloud,Qiniu,RackCorp,Scaleway,StackPath,Storj,TencentCOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-acl
       Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

       This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn’t set,  for  creating  buckets
       too.

       For      more      info     visit     https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-
       overview.html#canned-acl

       Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3 doesn’t copy the  ACL
       from the source but rather writes a fresh one.

       Properties:

       • Config: acl

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACL

       • Provider: !Storj,Cloudflare

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “default”

           • Owner gets Full_CONTROL.

           • No one else has access rights (default).

         • “private”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • No one else has access rights (default).

         • “public-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ access.

         • “public-read-write”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

           • Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.

         • “authenticated-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

         • “bucket-owner-read”

           • Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • Bucket owner gets READ access.

           • If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.

         • “bucket-owner-full-control”

           • Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.

           • If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.

         • “private”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • No one else has access rights (default).

           • This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS.

         • “public-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ access.

           • This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS.

         • “public-read-write”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

           • This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS.

         • “authenticated-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

           • Not supported on Buckets.

           • This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS.

   –s3-server-side-encryption
       The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

       Properties:

       • Config: server_side_encryption

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SERVER_SIDE_ENCRYPTION

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

         • “AES256”

           • AES256

         • “aws:kms”

           • aws:kms

   –s3-sse-kms-key-id
       If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key.

       Properties:

       • Config: sse_kms_key_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_KMS_KEY_ID

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

         • “arn:aws:kms:us-east-1:*”

           • arn:aws:kms:*

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

         • “REDUCED_REDUNDANCY”

           • Reduced redundancy storage class

         • “STANDARD_IA”

           • Standard Infrequent Access storage class

         • “ONEZONE_IA”

           • One Zone Infrequent Access storage class

         • “GLACIER”

           • Glacier storage class

         • “DEEP_ARCHIVE”

           • Glacier Deep Archive storage class

         • “INTELLIGENT_TIERING”

           • Intelligent-Tiering storage class

         • “GLACIER_IR”

           • Glacier Instant Retrieval storage class

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: Alibaba

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

         • “GLACIER”

           • Archive storage mode

         • “STANDARD_IA”

           • Infrequent access storage mode

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in ChinaMobile.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: ChinaMobile

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

         • “GLACIER”

           • Archive storage mode

         • “STANDARD_IA”

           • Infrequent access storage mode

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in ArvanCloud.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: ArvanCloud

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: TencentCOS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

         • “ARCHIVE”

           • Archive storage mode

         • “STANDARD_IA”

           • Infrequent access storage mode

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: Scaleway

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default.

         • “STANDARD”

           • The Standard class for any upload.

           • Suitable for on-demand content like streaming or CDN.

         • “GLACIER”

           • Archived storage.

           • Prices are lower, but it needs to be restored first to be accessed.

   –s3-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing new objects in Qiniu.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Provider: Qiniu

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “STANDARD”

           • Standard storage class

         • “LINE”

           • Infrequent access storage mode

         • “GLACIER”

           • Archive storage mode

         • “DEEP_ARCHIVE”

           • Deep archive storage mode

   Advanced options
       Here  are  the  Advanced  options  specific  to  s3 (Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers
       including AWS,  Alibaba,  Ceph,  China  Mobile,  Cloudflare,  ArvanCloud,  Digital  Ocean,
       Dreamhost,  Huawei  OBS,  IBM  COS,  IDrive  e2,  IONOS Cloud, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease,
       RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS, Qiniu and Wasabi).

   –s3-bucket-acl
       Canned ACL used when creating buckets.

       For     more     info      visit      https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-
       overview.html#canned-acl

       Note that this ACL is applied when only when creating buckets.  If it isn’t set then “acl”
       is used instead.

       Properties:

       • Config: bucket_acl

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_BUCKET_ACL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “private”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • No one else has access rights (default).

         • “public-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ access.

         • “public-read-write”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.

           • Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.

         • “authenticated-read”

           • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.

           • The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

   –s3-requester-pays
       Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket.

       Properties:

       • Config: requester_pays

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REQUESTER_PAYS

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-sse-customer-algorithm
       If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

       Properties:

       • Config: sse_customer_algorithm

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_ALGORITHM

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

         • “AES256”

           • AES256

   –s3-sse-customer-key
       To use SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data.

       Alternatively you can provide –sse-customer-key-base64.

       Properties:

       • Config: sse_customer_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

   –s3-sse-customer-key-base64
       If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key  encoded  in  base64  format  to
       encrypt/decrypt your data.

       Alternatively you can provide –sse-customer-key.

       Properties:

       • Config: sse_customer_key_base64

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_BASE64

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

   –s3-sse-customer-key-md5
       If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional).

       If  you  leave  it  blank,  this  is  calculated  automatically  from the sse_customer_key
       provided.

       Properties:

       • Config: sse_customer_key_md5

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_MD5

       • Provider: AWS,Ceph,ChinaMobile,Minio

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • None

   –s3-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

       Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and
       the maximum is 5 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 200Mi

   –s3-chunk-size
       Chunk size to use for uploading.

       When  uploading  files  larger  than  upload_cutoff  or files with unknown size (e.g. from
       “rclone rcat” or uploaded with “rclone mount” or google photos or google docs)  they  will
       be uploaded as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

       Note  that  “–s3-upload-concurrency”  chunks  of  this  size  are  buffered  in memory per
       transfer.

       If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then
       increasing this will speed up the transfers.

       Rclone  will  automatically  increase  the chunk size when uploading a large file of known
       size to stay below the 10,000 chunks limit.

       Files of unknown size are uploaded with the  configured  chunk_size.   Since  the  default
       chunk size is 5 MiB and there can be at most 10,000 chunks, this means that by default the
       maximum size of a file you can stream upload is 48 GiB.  If  you  wish  to  stream  upload
       larger files then you will need to increase chunk_size.

       Increasing the chunk size decreases the accuracy of the progress statistics displayed with
       “-P” flag.  Rclone treats chunk as sent when it’s buffered by the AWS SDK, when in fact it
       may  still  be  uploading.  A bigger chunk size means a bigger AWS SDK buffer and progress
       reporting more deviating from the truth.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 5Mi

   –s3-max-upload-parts
       Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload.

       This option defines the maximum number of multipart chunks to use when doing  a  multipart
       upload.

       This  can  be  useful  if  a  service  does not support the AWS S3 specification of 10,000
       chunks.

       Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a large file of  a  known
       size to stay below this number of chunks limit.

       Properties:

       • Config: max_upload_parts

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MAX_UPLOAD_PARTS

       • Type: int

       • Default: 10000

   –s3-copy-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

       Any  files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of
       this size.

       The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_COPY_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 4.656Gi

   –s3-disable-checksum
       Don’t store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

       Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can
       add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integrity checking but can cause
       long delays for large files to start uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_checksum

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-shared-credentials-file
       Path to the shared credentials file.

       If env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file.

       If this variable is empty rclone  will  look  for  the  “AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE”  env
       variable.  If the env value is empty it will default to the current user’s home directory.

              Linux/OSX: "$HOME/.aws/credentials"
              Windows:   "%USERPROFILE%\.aws\credentials"

       Properties:

       • Config: shared_credentials_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-profile
       Profile to use in the shared credentials file.

       If  env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file.  This variable controls
       which profile is used in that file.

       If empty it will default to the environment variable “AWS_PROFILE” or  “default”  if  that
       environment variable is also not set.

       Properties:

       • Config: profile

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROFILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-session-token
       An AWS session token.

       Properties:

       • Config: session_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SESSION_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-upload-concurrency
       Concurrency for multipart uploads.

       This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

       If  you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads
       do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then  increasing  this  may  help  to  speed  up  the
       transfers.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 4

   –s3-force-path-style
       If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style.

       If this is true (the default) then rclone will use path style access, if false then rclone
       will     use     virtual     path     style.       See      the      AWS      S3      docs
       (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/UsingBucket.html#access-bucket-intro) for
       more info.

       Some providers (e.g. AWS, Aliyun OSS, Netease COS, or Tencent COS)  require  this  set  to
       false - rclone will do this automatically based on the provider setting.

       Properties:

       • Config: force_path_style

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_FORCE_PATH_STYLE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –s3-v2-auth
       If true use v2 authentication.

       If  this is false (the default) then rclone will use v4 authentication.  If it is set then
       rclone will use v2 authentication.

       Use this only if v4 signatures don’t work, e.g. pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

       Properties:

       • Config: v2_auth

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_V2_AUTH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-use-accelerate-endpoint
       If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint.

       See:               AWS               S3               Transfer                acceleration
       (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/transfer-acceleration-examples.html)

       Properties:

       • Config: use_accelerate_endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_ACCELERATE_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-leave-parts-on-error
       If  true  avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts
       on S3 for manual recovery.

       It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

       WARNING: Storing parts of an incomplete multipart upload counts towards space usage on  S3
       and will add additional costs if not cleaned up.

       Properties:

       • Config: leave_parts_on_error

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

       • Provider: AWS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-list-chunk
       Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request).

       This  option  is  also  known  as  “MaxKeys”,  “max-items”, or “page-size” from the AWS S3
       specification.  Most services truncate the response list to 1000 objects even if requested
       more  than  that.   In  AWS  S3 this is a global maximum and cannot be changed, see AWS S3
       (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/cli/latest/reference/s3/ls.html).   In  Ceph,  this  can   be
       increased with the “rgw list buckets max chunk” option.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_CHUNK

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1000

   –s3-list-version
       Version of ListObjects to use: 1,2 or 0 for auto.

       When  S3 originally launched it only provided the ListObjects call to enumerate objects in
       a bucket.

       However in  May  2016  the  ListObjectsV2  call  was  introduced.   This  is  much  higher
       performance and should be used if at all possible.

       If  set  to  the  default,  0,  rclone will guess according to the provider set which list
       objects method to call.  If it guesses wrong, then it may be set manually here.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_version

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_VERSION

       • Type: int

       • Default: 0

   –s3-list-url-encode
       Whether to url encode listings: true/false/unset

       Some providers support URL encoding listings and where this  is  available  this  is  more
       reliable  when  using  control  characters  in  file  names.  If this is set to unset (the
       default) then rclone will choose according to the provider setting what to apply, but  you
       can override rclone’s choice here.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_url_encode

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_URL_ENCODE

       • Type: Tristate

       • Default: unset

   –s3-no-check-bucket
       If set, don’t attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

       This  can  be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you
       know the bucket exists already.

       It can also be needed if the user you are using does not have bucket creation permissions.
       Before v1.52.0 this would have passed silently due to a bug.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_check_bucket

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-no-head
       If set, don’t HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity.

       This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does.

       Setting  it  means that if rclone receives a 200 OK message after uploading an object with
       PUT then it will assume that it got uploaded properly.

       In particular it will assume:

       • the metadata, including modtime, storage class and content type was as uploaded

       • the size was as uploaded

       It reads the following items from the response for a single part PUT:

       • the MD5SUM

       • The uploaded date

       For multipart uploads these items aren’t read.

       If an source object of unknown length is uploaded then rclone will do a HEAD request.

       Setting this flag increases the chance for undetected upload failures,  in  particular  an
       incorrect  size,  so it isn’t recommended for normal operation.  In practice the chance of
       an undetected upload failure is very small even with this flag.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_head

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_HEAD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-no-head-object
       If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_head_object

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_HEAD_OBJECT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   –s3-memory-pool-flush-time
       How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.

       Uploads  which  requires  additional  buffers  (f.e  multipart)  will  use memory pool for
       allocations.  This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_flush_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –s3-memory-pool-use-mmap
       Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-disable-http2
       Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends.

       There is currently an unsolved issue with the s3 (specifically minio) backend and  HTTP/2.
       HTTP/2  is enabled by default for the s3 backend but can be disabled here.  When the issue
       is solved this flag will be removed.

       See:                                         https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4673,
       https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_http2

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_HTTP2

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-download-url
       Custom  endpoint  for  downloads.   This  is usually set to a CloudFront CDN URL as AWS S3
       offers cheaper egress for data downloaded through the CloudFront network.

       Properties:

       • Config: download_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DOWNLOAD_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –s3-use-multipart-etag
       Whether to use ETag in multipart uploads for verification

       This should be true, false or left unset to use the default for the provider.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_multipart_etag

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_MULTIPART_ETAG

       • Type: Tristate

       • Default: unset

   –s3-use-presigned-request
       Whether to use a presigned request or PutObject for single part uploads

       If this is false rclone will use PutObject from the AWS SDK to upload an object.

       Versions of rclone < 1.59 use presigned requests  to  upload  a  single  part  object  and
       setting  this flag to true will re-enable that functionality.  This shouldn’t be necessary
       except in exceptional circumstances or for testing.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_presigned_request

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_PRESIGNED_REQUEST

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-versions
       Include old versions in directory listings.

       Properties:

       • Config: versions

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_VERSIONS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-version-at
       Show file versions as they were at the specified time.

       The parameter should be a date, “2006-01-02”, datetime “2006-01-02 15:04:05” or a duration
       for that long ago, eg “100d” or “1h”.

       Note  that  when  using  this  no file write operations are permitted, so you can’t upload
       files or delete them.

       See the time option docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#time-option) for valid formats.

       Properties:

       • Config: version_at

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_VERSION_AT

       • Type: Time

       • Default: off

   –s3-decompress
       If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects.

       It is possible to upload objects to S3 with “Content-Encoding: gzip” set.  Normally rclone
       will download these files as compressed objects.

       If  this flag is set then rclone will decompress these files with “Content-Encoding: gzip”
       as they are received.  This means that rclone can’t check the size and hash but  the  file
       contents will be decompressed.

       Properties:

       • Config: decompress

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DECOMPRESS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –s3-might-gzip
       Set this if the backend might gzip objects.

       Normally  providers will not alter objects when they are downloaded.  If an object was not
       uploaded with Content-Encoding: gzip then it won’t be set on download.

       However some providers may gzip objects  even  if  they  weren’t  uploaded  with  Content-
       Encoding: gzip (eg Cloudflare).

       A symptom of this would be receiving errors like

              ERROR corrupted on transfer: sizes differ NNN vs MMM

       If  you  set  this flag and rclone downloads an object with Content-Encoding: gzip set and
       chunked transfer encoding, then rclone will decompress the object on the fly.

       If this is set to unset (the default) then rclone will choose according  to  the  provider
       setting what to apply, but you can override rclone’s choice here.

       Properties:

       • Config: might_gzip

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MIGHT_GZIP

       • Type: Tristate

       • Default: unset

   –s3-no-system-metadata
       Suppress setting and reading of system metadata

       Properties:

       • Config: no_system_metadata

       • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_SYSTEM_METADATA

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Metadata
       User  metadata  is  stored as x-amz-meta- keys.  S3 metadata keys are case insensitive and
       are always returned in lower case.

       Here are the possible system metadata items for the s3 backend.

       Name          Help            Type          Example                               Read Only
       ───────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       btime         Time     of     RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   Y
                     file  birth
                     (creation)
                     read   from
                     Last-
                     Modified
                     header
       cache-        Cache-          string        no-cache                              N
       control       Control
                     header
       content-      Content-        string        inline                                N
       disposition   Disposition
                     header
       content-      Content-        string        gzip                                  N
       encoding      Encoding
                     header
       content-      Content-        string        en-US                                 N
       language      Language
                     header
       content-      Content-        string        text/plain                            N
       type          Type header
       mtime         Time     of     RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                     last
                     modification,
                     read   from
                     rclone
                     metadata
       tier          Tier  of  the   string        GLACIER                               Y
                     object

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the s3 backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These  can  be  run  on  a  running  backend  using   the   rc   command   backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   restore
       Restore objects from GLACIER to normal storage

              rclone backend restore remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command can be used to restore one or more objects from GLACIER to normal storage.

       Usage Examples:

              rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/object [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
              rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/directory [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
              rclone backend restore s3:bucket [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]

       This flag also obeys the filters.  Test first with -i/–interactive or –dry-run flags

              rclone -i backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

       All the objects shown will be marked for restore, then

              rclone backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

       It  returns a list of status dictionaries with Remote and Status keys.  The Status will be
       OK if it was successful or an error message if not.

              [
                  {
                      "Status": "OK",
                      "Path": "test.txt"
                  },
                  {
                      "Status": "OK",
                      "Path": "test/file4.txt"
                  }
              ]

       Options:

       • “description”: The optional description for the job.

       • “lifetime”: Lifetime of the active copy in days

       • “priority”: Priority of restore: Standard|Expedited|Bulk

   list-multipart-uploads
       List the unfinished multipart uploads

              rclone backend list-multipart-uploads remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command lists the unfinished multipart uploads in JSON format.

              rclone backend list-multipart s3:bucket/path/to/object

       It returns a dictionary of buckets with values as lists of unfinished multipart uploads.

       You can call it with no bucket in which case it lists all bucket, with a bucket or with  a
       bucket and path.

              {
                "rclone": [
                  {
                    "Initiated": "2020-06-26T14:20:36Z",
                    "Initiator": {
                      "DisplayName": "XXX",
                      "ID": "arn:aws:iam::XXX:user/XXX"
                    },
                    "Key": "KEY",
                    "Owner": {
                      "DisplayName": null,
                      "ID": "XXX"
                    },
                    "StorageClass": "STANDARD",
                    "UploadId": "XXX"
                  }
                ],
                "rclone-1000files": [],
                "rclone-dst": []
              }

   cleanup
       Remove unfinished multipart uploads.

              rclone backend cleanup remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This  command  removes  unfinished  multipart  uploads  of  age greater than max-age which
       defaults to 24 hours.

       Note that you can use -i/–dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

              rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket/path/to/object
              rclone backend cleanup -o max-age=7w s3:bucket/path/to/object

       Durations are parsed as per the rest of rclone, 2h, 7d, 7w etc.

       Options:

       • “max-age”: Max age of upload to delete

   cleanup-hidden
       Remove old versions of files.

              rclone backend cleanup-hidden remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command removes any old hidden versions of files on a versions enabled bucket.

       Note that you can use -i/–dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

              rclone backend cleanup-hidden s3:bucket/path/to/dir

   versioning
       Set/get versioning support for a bucket.

              rclone backend versioning remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command sets versioning support if a parameter is passed and then returns the current
       versioning status for the bucket supplied.

              rclone backend versioning s3:bucket # read status only
              rclone backend versioning s3:bucket Enabled
              rclone backend versioning s3:bucket Suspended

       It may return “Enabled”, “Suspended” or “Unversioned”.  Note that once versioning has been
       enabled the status can’t be set back to “Unversioned”.

   Anonymous access to public buckets
       If you want to use rclone to access a public bucket, configure with a blank  access_key_id
       and secret_access_key.  Your config should end up looking like this:

              [anons3]
              type = s3
              provider = AWS
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id =
              secret_access_key =
              region = us-east-1
              endpoint =
              location_constraint =
              acl = private
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

       Then use it as normal with the name of the public bucket, e.g.

              rclone lsd anons3:1000genomes

       You will be able to list and copy data but not upload it.

   Providers
   AWS S3
       This  is  the  provider  used  as  main example and described in the configuration section
       above.

   AWS Snowball Edge
       AWS  Snowball  (https://aws.amazon.com/snowball/)  is  a  hardware  appliance   used   for
       transferring bulk data back to AWS.  Its main software interface is S3 object storage.

       To  use rclone with AWS Snowball Edge devices, configure as standard for an `S3 Compatible
       Service'.

       If using rclone pre v1.59 be sure to set upload_cutoff = 0 otherwise  you  will  run  into
       authentication header issues as the snowball device does not support query parameter based
       authentication.

       With rclone v1.59 or later setting upload_cutoff should not be necessary.

       eg.

              [snowball]
              type = s3
              provider = Other
              access_key_id = YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
              secret_access_key = YOUR_SECRET_KEY
              endpoint = http://[IP of Snowball]:8080
              upload_cutoff = 0

   Ceph
       Ceph (https://ceph.com/) is an open-source, unified, distributed storage  system  designed
       for  excellent  performance,  reliability and scalability.  It has an S3 compatible object
       storage interface.

       To use rclone with Ceph, configure as above  but  leave  the  region  blank  and  set  the
       endpoint.  You should end up with something like this in your config:

              [ceph]
              type = s3
              provider = Ceph
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = XXX
              secret_access_key = YYY
              region =
              endpoint = https://ceph.endpoint.example.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

       If  you  are  using  an  older version of CEPH (e.g. 10.2.x Jewel) and a version of rclone
       before v1.59 then you may need to supply the parameter --s3-upload-cutoff 0 or put this in
       the  config  file  as upload_cutoff 0 to work around a bug which causes uploading of small
       files to fail.

       Note also that Ceph sometimes puts / in the passwords it gives users.   If  you  read  the
       secret access key using the command line tools you will get a JSON blob with the / escaped
       as \/.  Make sure you only write / in the secret access key.

       Eg the dump from Ceph looks something like this (irrelevant keys removed).

              {
                  "user_id": "xxx",
                  "display_name": "xxxx",
                  "keys": [
                      {
                          "user": "xxx",
                          "access_key": "xxxxxx",
                          "secret_key": "xxxxxx\/xxxx"
                      }
                  ],
              }

       Because this is a json dump, it is encoding the / as \/, so if you use the secret  key  as
       xxxxxx/xxxx it will work fine.

   Cloudflare R2
       Cloudflare  R2  (https://blog.cloudflare.com/r2-open-beta/)  Storage  allows developers to
       store large amounts  of  unstructured  data  without  the  costly  egress  bandwidth  fees
       associated with typical cloud storage services.

       Here is an example of making a Cloudflare R2 configuration.  First run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

       Note  that  all  buckets are private, and all are stored in the same “auto” region.  It is
       necessary to use Cloudflare workers to share the content of a bucket publicly.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> r2
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              ...
              XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
                 \ (s3)
              ...
              Storage> s3
              Option provider.
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
              ...
              XX / Cloudflare R2 Storage
                 \ (Cloudflare)
              ...
              provider> Cloudflare
              Option env_auth.
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth> 1
              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> ACCESS_KEY
              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
              Option region.
              Region to connect to.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / R2 buckets are automatically distributed across Cloudflare's data centers for low latency.
                 \ (auto)
              region> 1
              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint for S3 API.
              Required when using an S3 clone.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              endpoint> https://ACCOUNT_ID.r2.cloudflarestorage.com
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This will leave your config looking something like:

              [r2]
              type = s3
              provider = Cloudflare
              access_key_id = ACCESS_KEY
              secret_access_key = SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
              region = auto
              endpoint = https://ACCOUNT_ID.r2.cloudflarestorage.com
              acl = private

       Now run rclone lsf r2: to see your buckets and rclone  lsf  r2:bucket  to  look  within  a
       bucket.

   Dreamhost
       Dreamhost  DreamObjects  (https://www.dreamhost.com/cloud/storage/)  is  an object storage
       system based on CEPH.

       To use rclone with Dreamhost, configure as above but leave the region blank  and  set  the
       endpoint.  You should end up with something like this in your config:

              [dreamobjects]
              type = s3
              provider = DreamHost
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = your_access_key
              secret_access_key = your_secret_key
              region =
              endpoint = objects-us-west-1.dream.io
              location_constraint =
              acl = private
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

   DigitalOcean Spaces
       Spaces   (https://www.digitalocean.com/products/object-storage/)  is  an  S3-interoperable
       (https://developers.digitalocean.com/documentation/spaces/) object  storage  service  from
       cloud provider DigitalOcean.

       To  connect  to DigitalOcean Spaces you will need an access key and secret key.  These can
       be         retrieved         on         the          “Applications          &          API
       (https://cloud.digitalocean.com/settings/api/tokens)”  page  of  the  DigitalOcean control
       panel.  They will be needed when prompted by rclone  config  for  your  access_key_id  and
       secret_access_key.

       When  prompted  for a region or location_constraint, press enter to use the default value.
       The region must be included in the  endpoint  setting  (e.g. nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com).
       The default values can be used for other settings.

       Going  through  the  whole process of creating a new remote by running rclone config, each
       prompt should be answered as shown below:

              Storage> s3
              env_auth> 1
              access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
              secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY
              region>
              endpoint> nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
              location_constraint>
              acl>
              storage_class>

       The resulting configuration file should look like:

              [spaces]
              type = s3
              provider = DigitalOcean
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
              secret_access_key = YOUR_SECRET_KEY
              region =
              endpoint = nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

       Once configured, you can create a new Space and begin copying files.  For example:

              rclone mkdir spaces:my-new-space
              rclone copy /path/to/files spaces:my-new-space

   Huawei OBS
       Object Storage Service (OBS) provides stable, secure,  efficient,  and  easy-to-use  cloud
       storage  that  lets  you store virtually any volume of unstructured data in any format and
       access it from anywhere.

       OBS provides an S3 interface, you can copy and modify the following configuration and  add
       it to your rclone configuration file.

              [obs]
              type = s3
              provider = HuaweiOBS
              access_key_id = your-access-key-id
              secret_access_key = your-secret-access-key
              region = af-south-1
              endpoint = obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com
              acl = private

       Or you can also configure via the interactive command line:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> obs
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
               5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
                 \ (s3)
              [snip]
              Storage> 5
              Option provider.
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
              [snip]
               9 / Huawei Object Storage Service
                 \ (HuaweiOBS)
              [snip]
              provider> 9
              Option env_auth.
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth> 1
              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> your-access-key-id
              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> your-secret-access-key
              Option region.
              Region to connect to.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / AF-Johannesburg
                 \ (af-south-1)
               2 / AP-Bangkok
                 \ (ap-southeast-2)
              [snip]
              region> 1
              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint for OBS API.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / AF-Johannesburg
                 \ (obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com)
               2 / AP-Bangkok
                 \ (obs.ap-southeast-2.myhuaweicloud.com)
              [snip]
              endpoint> 1
              Option acl.
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
              This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               1 | No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ (private)
              [snip]
              acl> 1
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n>
              --------------------
              [obs]
              type = s3
              provider = HuaweiOBS
              access_key_id = your-access-key-id
              secret_access_key = your-secret-access-key
              region = af-south-1
              endpoint = obs.af-south-1.myhuaweicloud.com
              acl = private
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              obs                  s3

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

   IBM COS (S3)
       Information  stored  with  IBM  Cloud  Object  Storage  is  encrypted and dispersed across
       multiple geographic locations, and accessed through an implementation of the S3 API.  This
       service  makes  use of the distributed storage technologies provided by IBM’s Cloud Object
       Storage    System    (formerly    Cleversafe).     For     more     information     visit:
       (http://www.ibm.com/cloud/object-storage)

       To configure access to IBM COS S3, follow the steps below:

       1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

              2018/02/14 14:13:11 NOTICE: Config file "C:\\Users\\a\\.config\\rclone\\rclone.conf" not found - using defaults
              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n

       2. Enter the name for the configuration

              name> <YOUR NAME>

       3. Select “s3” storage.

          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              1 / Alias for an existing remote
              \ "alias"
              2 / Amazon Drive
              \ "amazon cloud drive"
              3 / Amazon S3 Complaint Storage Providers (Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Minio, IBM COS)
              \ "s3"
              4 / Backblaze B2
              \ "b2"
          [snip]
              23 / HTTP
              \ "http"
          Storage> 3

       4. Select IBM COS as the S3 Storage Provider.

          Choose the S3 provider.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Choose this option to configure Storage to AWS S3
                 \ "AWS"
               2 / Choose this option to configure Storage to Ceph Systems
               \ "Ceph"
               3 /  Choose this option to configure Storage to Dreamhost
               \ "Dreamhost"
             4 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to IBM COS S3
               \ "IBMCOS"
               5 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to Minio
               \ "Minio"
               Provider>4

       5. Enter the Access Key and Secret.

              AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              access_key_id> <>
              AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              secret_access_key> <>

       6. Specify  the  endpoint  for IBM COS.  For Public IBM COS, choose from the option below.
          For On Premise IBM COS, enter an endpoint address.

              Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.
              Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / US Cross Region Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
               2 / US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.dal.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
               3 / US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
               4 / US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
               5 / US Cross Region Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
               6 / US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.dal-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
               7 / US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
               8 / US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
               9 / US Region East Endpoint
                 \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
              10 / US Region East Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
              11 / US Region South Endpoint
          [snip]
              34 / Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint
                 \ "s3.tor01.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
              endpoint>1

       7. Specify a IBM COS Location Constraint.  The location  constraint  must  match  endpoint
          when  using IBM Cloud Public.  For on-prem COS, do not make a selection from this list,
          hit enter

               1 / US Cross Region Standard
                 \ "us-standard"
               2 / US Cross Region Vault
                 \ "us-vault"
               3 / US Cross Region Cold
                 \ "us-cold"
               4 / US Cross Region Flex
                 \ "us-flex"
               5 / US East Region Standard
                 \ "us-east-standard"
               6 / US East Region Vault
                 \ "us-east-vault"
               7 / US East Region Cold
                 \ "us-east-cold"
               8 / US East Region Flex
                 \ "us-east-flex"
               9 / US South Region Standard
                 \ "us-south-standard"
              10 / US South Region Vault
                 \ "us-south-vault"
          [snip]
              32 / Toronto Flex
                 \ "tor01-flex"
          location_constraint>1

       9. Specify a canned ACL.  IBM Cloud (Storage) supports “public-read” and  “private”.   IBM
          Cloud(Infra)  supports  all  the  canned  ACLs.  On-Premise COS supports all the canned
          ACLs.

          Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
          For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
                1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default). This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS
                \ "private"
                2  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS
                \ "public-read"
                3 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS
                \ "public-read-write"
                4  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access. Not supported on Buckets. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS
                \ "authenticated-read"
          acl> 1

       12. Review the displayed configuration and accept to save the  “remote”  then  quit.   The
           config file should look like this

               [xxx]
               type = s3
               Provider = IBMCOS
               access_key_id = xxx
               secret_access_key = yyy
               endpoint = s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net
               location_constraint = us-standard
               acl = private

       13. Execute rclone commands

               1)  Create a bucket.
                   rclone mkdir IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
               2)  List available buckets.
                   rclone lsd IBM-COS-XREGION:
                   -1 2017-11-08 21:16:22        -1 test
                   -1 2018-02-14 20:16:39        -1 newbucket
               3)  List contents of a bucket.
                   rclone ls IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
                   18685952 test.exe
               4)  Copy a file from local to remote.
                   rclone copy /Users/file.txt IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
               5)  Copy a file from remote to local.
                   rclone copy IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt .
               6)  Delete a file on remote.
                   rclone delete IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt

   IDrive e2
       Here  is  an  example  of  making an IDrive e2 (https://www.idrive.com/e2/) configuration.
       First run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n

              Enter name for new remote.
              name> e2

              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
                 \ (s3)
              [snip]
              Storage> s3

              Option provider.
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
              [snip]
              XX / IDrive e2
                 \ (IDrive)
              [snip]
              provider> IDrive

              Option env_auth.
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth>

              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY

              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY

              Option acl.
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
              This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               1 | No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ (private)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ (public-read)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               3 | The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
                 | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
                 \ (public-read-write)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               4 | The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ (authenticated-read)
                 / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               5 | Bucket owner gets READ access.
                 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
                 \ (bucket-owner-read)
                 / Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
               6 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
                 \ (bucket-owner-full-control)
              acl>

              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n>

              Configuration complete.
              Options:
              - type: s3
              - provider: IDrive
              - access_key_id: YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
              - secret_access_key: YOUR_SECRET_KEY
              - endpoint: q9d9.la12.idrivee2-5.com
              Keep this "e2" remote?
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   IONOS Cloud
       IONOS S3 Object  Storage  (https://cloud.ionos.com/storage/object-storage)  is  a  service
       offered  by IONOS for storing and accessing unstructured data.  To connect to the service,
       you will need an access key and a secret key.  These can  be  found  in  the  Data  Center
       Designer  (https://dcd.ionos.com/),  by  selecting  Manager resources > Object Storage Key
       Manager.

       Here is an example of a configuration.  First, run rclone  config.   This  will  walk  you
       through  an  interactive  setup  process.   Type n to add the new remote, and then enter a
       name:

              Enter name for new remote.
              name> ionos-fra

       Type s3 to choose the connection type:

              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, IONOS Cloud, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS and Wasabi
                 \ (s3)
              [snip]
              Storage> s3

       Type IONOS:

              Option provider.
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
              [snip]
              XX / IONOS Cloud
                 \ (IONOS)
              [snip]
              provider> IONOS

       Press Enter to choose the default option Enter AWS credentials in the next step:

              Option env_auth.
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth>

       Enter your Access Key and Secret key.  These can be retrieved in the Data Center  Designer
       (https://dcd.ionos.com/),  click  on  the  menu  “Manager resources” / “Object Storage Key
       Manager”.

              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY

              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY

       Choose the region where your bucket is located:

              Option region.
              Region where your bucket will be created and your data stored.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Frankfurt, Germany
                 \ (de)
               2 / Berlin, Germany
                 \ (eu-central-2)
               3 / Logrono, Spain
                 \ (eu-south-2)
              region> 2

       Choose the endpoint from the same region:

              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint for IONOS S3 Object Storage.
              Specify the endpoint from the same region.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Frankfurt, Germany
                 \ (s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com)
               2 / Berlin, Germany
                 \ (s3-eu-central-2.ionoscloud.com)
               3 / Logrono, Spain
                 \ (s3-eu-south-2.ionoscloud.com)
              endpoint> 1

       Press Enter to choose the default option or choose the desired ACL setting:

              Option acl.
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
              This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               1 | No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ (private)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
              [snip]
              acl>

       Press Enter to skip the advanced config:

              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n>

       Press Enter to save the configuration, and then q to quit the configuration process:

              Configuration complete.
              Options:
              - type: s3
              - provider: IONOS
              - access_key_id: YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
              - secret_access_key: YOUR_SECRET_KEY
              - endpoint: s3-eu-central-1.ionoscloud.com
              Keep this "ionos-fra" remote?
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Done!  Now you can try some commands (for macOS, use ./rclone instead of rclone).

       1) Create a bucket (the name must be unique within the whole IONOS S3)

          rclone mkdir ionos-fra:my-bucket

       2) List available buckets

          rclone lsd ionos-fra:

       4) Copy a file from local to remote

          rclone copy /Users/file.txt ionos-fra:my-bucket

       3) List contents of a bucket

          rclone ls ionos-fra:my-bucket

       5) Copy a file from remote to local

          rclone copy ionos-fra:my-bucket/file.txt

   Minio
       Minio (https://minio.io/)  is  an  object  storage  server  built  for  cloud  application
       developers and devops.

       It  is  very  easy  to  install  and provides an S3 compatible server which can be used by
       rclone.

       To     use     it,     install     Minio     following     the      instructions      here
       (https://docs.minio.io/docs/minio-quickstart-guide).

       When it configures itself Minio will print something like this

              Endpoint:  http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000
              AccessKey: USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
              SecretKey: MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
              Region:    us-east-1
              SQS ARNs:  arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:1:redis arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:2:redis

              Browser Access:
                 http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000

              Command-line Access: https://docs.minio.io/docs/minio-client-quickstart-guide
                 $ mc config host add myminio http://192.168.1.106:9000 USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03

              Object API (Amazon S3 compatible):
                 Go:         https://docs.minio.io/docs/golang-client-quickstart-guide
                 Java:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/java-client-quickstart-guide
                 Python:     https://docs.minio.io/docs/python-client-quickstart-guide
                 JavaScript: https://docs.minio.io/docs/javascript-client-quickstart-guide
                 .NET:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/dotnet-client-quickstart-guide

              Drive Capacity: 26 GiB Free, 165 GiB Total

       These  details  need to go into rclone config like this.  Note that it is important to put
       the region in as stated above.

              env_auth> 1
              access_key_id> USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
              secret_access_key> MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
              region> us-east-1
              endpoint> http://192.168.1.106:9000
              location_constraint>
              server_side_encryption>

       Which makes the config file look like this

              [minio]
              type = s3
              provider = Minio
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
              secret_access_key = MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
              region = us-east-1
              endpoint = http://192.168.1.106:9000
              location_constraint =
              server_side_encryption =

       So once set up, for example, to copy files into a bucket

              rclone copy /path/to/files minio:bucket

   Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo)
       Qiniu Cloud Object Storage (Kodo) (https://www.qiniu.com/en/products/kodo),  a  completely
       independent-researched core technology which is proven by repeated customer experience has
       occupied absolute leading market leader position.  Kodo can be widely applied to mass data
       management.

       To configure access to Qiniu Kodo, follow the steps below:

       1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

          rclone config
          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n

       2. Give the name of the configuration.  For example, name it `qiniu'.

          name> qiniu

       3. Select s3 storage.

          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / 1Fichier
             \ (fichier)
           2 / Akamai NetStorage
             \ (netstorage)
           3 / Alias for an existing remote
             \ (alias)
           4 / Amazon Drive
             \ (amazon cloud drive)
           5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, China Mobile, Cloudflare, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, IDrive e2, Lyve Cloud, Minio, Netease, RackCorp, Scaleway, SeaweedFS, StackPath, Storj, Tencent COS, Qiniu and Wasabi
             \ (s3)
          [snip]
          Storage> s3

       4. Select Qiniu provider.

          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
             \ "AWS"
          [snip]
          22 / Qiniu Object Storage (Kodo)
             \ (Qiniu)
          [snip]
          provider> Qiniu

       5. Enter your SecretId and SecretKey of Qiniu Kodo.

          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_key_id> AKIDxxxxxxxxxx
          AWS Secret Access Key (password)
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          secret_access_key> xxxxxxxxxxx

       6. Select endpoint for Qiniu Kodo.  This is the standard endpoint for different region.

             / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
           1 | East China Region 1.
             | Needs location constraint cn-east-1.
             \ (cn-east-1)
             / East China Region 2.
           2 | Needs location constraint cn-east-2.
             \ (cn-east-2)
             / North China Region 1.
           3 | Needs location constraint cn-north-1.
             \ (cn-north-1)
             / South China Region 1.
           4 | Needs location constraint cn-south-1.
             \ (cn-south-1)
             / North America Region.
           5 | Needs location constraint us-north-1.
             \ (us-north-1)
             / Southeast Asia Region 1.
           6 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
             \ (ap-southeast-1)
             / Northeast Asia Region 1.
           7 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
             \ (ap-northeast-1)
          [snip]
          endpoint> 1

          Option endpoint.
          Endpoint for Qiniu Object Storage.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / East China Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com)
           2 / East China Endpoint 2
             \ (s3-cn-east-2.qiniucs.com)
           3 / North China Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-cn-north-1.qiniucs.com)
           4 / South China Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-cn-south-1.qiniucs.com)
           5 / North America Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-us-north-1.qiniucs.com)
           6 / Southeast Asia Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-ap-southeast-1.qiniucs.com)
           7 / Northeast Asia Endpoint 1
             \ (s3-ap-northeast-1.qiniucs.com)
          endpoint> 1

          Option location_constraint.
          Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
          Used when creating buckets only.
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
          Press Enter to leave empty.
           1 / East China Region 1
             \ (cn-east-1)
           2 / East China Region 2
             \ (cn-east-2)
           3 / North China Region 1
             \ (cn-north-1)
           4 / South China Region 1
             \ (cn-south-1)
           5 / North America Region 1
             \ (us-north-1)
           6 / Southeast Asia Region 1
             \ (ap-southeast-1)
           7 / Northeast Asia Region 1
             \ (ap-northeast-1)
          location_constraint> 1

       7. Choose acl and storage class.

          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           1 | No one else has access rights (default).
             \ (private)
             / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
           2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
             \ (public-read)
          [snip]
          acl> 2
          The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Standard storage class
             \ (STANDARD)
           2 / Infrequent access storage mode
             \ (LINE)
           3 / Archive storage mode
             \ (GLACIER)
           4 / Deep archive storage mode
             \ (DEEP_ARCHIVE)
          [snip]
          storage_class> 1
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [qiniu]
          - type: s3
          - provider: Qiniu
          - access_key_id: xxx
          - secret_access_key: xxx
          - region: cn-east-1
          - endpoint: s3-cn-east-1.qiniucs.com
          - location_constraint: cn-east-1
          - acl: public-read
          - storage_class: STANDARD
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          qiniu                s3

   RackCorp
       RackCorp  Object  Storage (https://www.rackcorp.com/storage/s3storage) is an S3 compatible
       object storage platform from your friendly cloud provider RackCorp.  The service is  fast,
       reliable,  well  priced  and  located in many strategic locations unserviced by others, to
       ensure you can maintain data sovereignty.

       Before   you   can   use   RackCorp   Object   Storage,   you’ll   need   to   “sign    up
       (https://www.rackcorp.com/signup)”      for      an     account     on     our     “portal
       (https://portal.rackcorp.com)”.  Next you can create an  access  key,  a  secret  key  and
       buckets,  in  your  location of choice with ease.  These details are required for the next
       steps  of  configuration,  when  rclone   config   asks   for   your   access_key_id   and
       secret_access_key.

       Your config should end up looking a bit like this:

              [RCS3-demo-config]
              type = s3
              provider = RackCorp
              env_auth = true
              access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
              secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              region = au-nsw
              endpoint = s3.rackcorp.com
              location_constraint = au-nsw

   Scaleway
       Scaleway (https://www.scaleway.com/object-storage/) The Object Storage platform allows you
       to store anything from backups, logs and web assets to documents and photos.  Files can be
       dropped  from  the  Scaleway  console  or transferred through our API and CLI or using any
       S3-compatible tool.

       Scaleway provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this:

              [scaleway]
              type = s3
              provider = Scaleway
              env_auth = false
              endpoint = s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud
              access_key_id = SCWXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
              secret_access_key = 1111111-2222-3333-44444-55555555555555
              region = nl-ams
              location_constraint =
              acl = private
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

       C14 Cold Storage (https://www.online.net/en/storage/c14-cold-storage) is the  low-cost  S3
       Glacier  alternative  from  Scaleway  and  it works the same way as on S3 by accepting the
       “GLACIER” storage_class.  So you can  configure  your  remote  with  the  storage_class  =
       GLACIER  option to upload directly to C14.  Don’t forget that in this state you can’t read
       files back after, you will need to restore them to “STANDARD” storage_class  first  before
       being able to read them (see “restore” section above)

   Seagate Lyve Cloud
       Seagate   Lyve  Cloud  (https://www.seagate.com/gb/en/services/cloud/storage/)  is  an  S3
       compatible object  storage  platform  from  Seagate  (https://seagate.com/)  intended  for
       enterprise use.

       Here  is a config run through for a remote called remote - you may choose a different name
       of course.  Note that to create an access key and secret key you will  need  to  create  a
       service account first.

              $ rclone config
              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote

       Choose s3 backend

              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, RackCorp, SeaweedFS, and Tencent COS
                 \ (s3)
              [snip]
              Storage> s3

       Choose LyveCloud as S3 provider

              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
              [snip]
              XX / Seagate Lyve Cloud
                 \ (LyveCloud)
              [snip]
              provider> LyveCloud

       Take the default (just press enter) to enter access key and secret in the config file.

              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth>

              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> XXX

              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> YYY

       Leave region blank

              Region to connect to.
              Leave blank if you are using an S3 clone and you don't have a region.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Use this if unsure.
               1 | Will use v4 signatures and an empty region.
                 \ ()
                 / Use this only if v4 signatures don't work.
               2 | E.g. pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.
                 \ (other-v2-signature)
              region>

       Choose an endpoint from the list

              Endpoint for S3 API.
              Required when using an S3 clone.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Seagate Lyve Cloud US East 1 (Virginia)
                 \ (s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
               2 / Seagate Lyve Cloud US West 1 (California)
                 \ (s3.us-west-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
               3 / Seagate Lyve Cloud AP Southeast 1 (Singapore)
                 \ (s3.ap-southeast-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com)
              endpoint> 1

       Leave location constraint blank

              Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
              Leave blank if not sure. Used when creating buckets only.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              location_constraint>

       Choose default ACL (private).

              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
              This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               1 | No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ (private)
              [snip]
              acl>

       And the config file should end up looking like this:

              [remote]
              type = s3
              provider = LyveCloud
              access_key_id = XXX
              secret_access_key = YYY
              endpoint = s3.us-east-1.lyvecloud.seagate.com

   SeaweedFS
       SeaweedFS  (https://github.com/chrislusf/seaweedfs/)  is  a distributed storage system for
       blobs, objects, files, and data lake, with O(1) disk seek and  a  scalable  file  metadata
       store.   It  has  an  S3 compatible object storage interface.  SeaweedFS can also act as a
       gateway        to        remote         S3         compatible         object         store
       (https://github.com/chrislusf/seaweedfs/wiki/Gateway-to-Remote-Object-Storage)   to  cache
       data and metadata with asynchronous write back, for fast local speed and  minimize  access
       cost.

       Assuming the SeaweedFS are configured with weed shell as such:

              > s3.bucket.create -name foo
              > s3.configure -access_key=any -secret_key=any -buckets=foo -user=me -actions=Read,Write,List,Tagging,Admin -apply
              {
                "identities": [
                  {
                    "name": "me",
                    "credentials": [
                      {
                        "accessKey": "any",
                        "secretKey": "any"
                      }
                    ],
                    "actions": [
                      "Read:foo",
                      "Write:foo",
                      "List:foo",
                      "Tagging:foo",
                      "Admin:foo"
                    ]
                  }
                ]
              }

       To  use  rclone with SeaweedFS, above configuration should end up with something like this
       in your config:

              [seaweedfs_s3]
              type = s3
              provider = SeaweedFS
              access_key_id = any
              secret_access_key = any
              endpoint = localhost:8333

       So once set up, for example to copy files into a bucket

              rclone copy /path/to/files seaweedfs_s3:foo

   Wasabi
       Wasabi (https://wasabi.com) is a cloud-based object storage service for a broad  range  of
       applications  and  use  cases.   Wasabi is designed for individuals and organizations that
       require a high-performance, reliable, and secure data storage  infrastructure  at  minimal
       cost.

       Wasabi provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              n/s> n
              name> wasabi
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Minio)
                 \ "s3"
              [snip]
              Storage> s3
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> 1
              AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
              AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              Region to connect to.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
                 / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
               1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
                 | Leave location constraint empty.
                 \ "us-east-1"
              [snip]
              region> us-east-1
              Endpoint for S3 API.
              Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
              Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
              endpoint> s3.wasabisys.com
              Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
                 \ ""
              [snip]
              location_constraint>
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ "private"
              [snip]
              acl>
              The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / None
                 \ ""
               2 / AES256
                 \ "AES256"
              server_side_encryption>
              The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Default
                 \ ""
               2 / Standard storage class
                 \ "STANDARD"
               3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
                 \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
               4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
                 \ "STANDARD_IA"
              storage_class>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [wasabi]
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
              secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              region = us-east-1
              endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This will leave the config file looking like this.

              [wasabi]
              type = s3
              provider = Wasabi
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
              secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              region =
              endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

   Alibaba OSS
       Here     is     an    example    of    making    an    Alibaba    Cloud    (Aliyun)    OSS
       (https://www.alibabacloud.com/product/oss/) configuration.  First run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> oss
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
               4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
                 \ "s3"
              [snip]
              Storage> s3
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
                 \ "AWS"
               2 / Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun
                 \ "Alibaba"
               3 / Ceph Object Storage
                 \ "Ceph"
              [snip]
              provider> Alibaba
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> 1
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              access_key_id> accesskeyid
              AWS Secret Access Key (password)
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              secret_access_key> secretaccesskey
              Endpoint for OSS API.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / East China 1 (Hangzhou)
                 \ "oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com"
               2 / East China 2 (Shanghai)
                 \ "oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com"
               3 / North China 1 (Qingdao)
                 \ "oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com"
              [snip]
              endpoint> 1
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ "private"
               2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ "public-read"
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
              [snip]
              acl> 1
              The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Default
                 \ ""
               2 / Standard storage class
                 \ "STANDARD"
               3 / Archive storage mode.
                 \ "GLACIER"
               4 / Infrequent access storage mode.
                 \ "STANDARD_IA"
              storage_class> 1
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [oss]
              type = s3
              provider = Alibaba
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = accesskeyid
              secret_access_key = secretaccesskey
              endpoint = oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com
              acl = private
              storage_class = Standard
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)
       Here is an example  of  making  an  China  Mobile  Ecloud  Elastic  Object  Storage  (EOS)
       (https:///ecloud.10086.cn/home/product-introduction/eos/) configuration.  First run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> ChinaMobile
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
               ...
               5 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Lyve Cloud, Minio, RackCorp, SeaweedFS, and Tencent COS
                 \ (s3)
               ...
              Storage> s3
              Option provider.
              Choose your S3 provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               ...
               4 / China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS)
                 \ (ChinaMobile)
               ...
              provider> ChinaMobile
              Option env_auth.
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth>
              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> accesskeyid
              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> secretaccesskey
              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint for China Mobile Ecloud Elastic Object Storage (EOS) API.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
               1 | East China (Suzhou)
                 \ (eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
               2 / East China (Jinan)
                 \ (eos-jinan-1.cmecloud.cn)
               3 / East China (Hangzhou)
                 \ (eos-ningbo-1.cmecloud.cn)
               4 / East China (Shanghai-1)
                 \ (eos-shanghai-1.cmecloud.cn)
               5 / Central China (Zhengzhou)
                 \ (eos-zhengzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
               6 / Central China (Changsha-1)
                 \ (eos-hunan-1.cmecloud.cn)
               7 / Central China (Changsha-2)
                 \ (eos-zhuzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
               8 / South China (Guangzhou-2)
                 \ (eos-guangzhou-1.cmecloud.cn)
               9 / South China (Guangzhou-3)
                 \ (eos-dongguan-1.cmecloud.cn)
              10 / North China (Beijing-1)
                 \ (eos-beijing-1.cmecloud.cn)
              11 / North China (Beijing-2)
                 \ (eos-beijing-2.cmecloud.cn)
              12 / North China (Beijing-3)
                 \ (eos-beijing-4.cmecloud.cn)
              13 / North China (Huhehaote)
                 \ (eos-huhehaote-1.cmecloud.cn)
              14 / Southwest China (Chengdu)
                 \ (eos-chengdu-1.cmecloud.cn)
              15 / Southwest China (Chongqing)
                 \ (eos-chongqing-1.cmecloud.cn)
              16 / Southwest China (Guiyang)
                 \ (eos-guiyang-1.cmecloud.cn)
              17 / Nouthwest China (Xian)
                 \ (eos-xian-1.cmecloud.cn)
              18 / Yunnan China (Kunming)
                 \ (eos-yunnan.cmecloud.cn)
              19 / Yunnan China (Kunming-2)
                 \ (eos-yunnan-2.cmecloud.cn)
              20 / Tianjin China (Tianjin)
                 \ (eos-tianjin-1.cmecloud.cn)
              21 / Jilin China (Changchun)
                 \ (eos-jilin-1.cmecloud.cn)
              22 / Hubei China (Xiangyan)
                 \ (eos-hubei-1.cmecloud.cn)
              23 / Jiangxi China (Nanchang)
                 \ (eos-jiangxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
              24 / Gansu China (Lanzhou)
                 \ (eos-gansu-1.cmecloud.cn)
              25 / Shanxi China (Taiyuan)
                 \ (eos-shanxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
              26 / Liaoning China (Shenyang)
                 \ (eos-liaoning-1.cmecloud.cn)
              27 / Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)
                 \ (eos-hebei-1.cmecloud.cn)
              28 / Fujian China (Xiamen)
                 \ (eos-fujian-1.cmecloud.cn)
              29 / Guangxi China (Nanning)
                 \ (eos-guangxi-1.cmecloud.cn)
              30 / Anhui China (Huainan)
                 \ (eos-anhui-1.cmecloud.cn)
              endpoint> 1
              Option location_constraint.
              Location constraint - must match endpoint.
              Used when creating buckets only.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / East China (Suzhou)
                 \ (wuxi1)
               2 / East China (Jinan)
                 \ (jinan1)
               3 / East China (Hangzhou)
                 \ (ningbo1)
               4 / East China (Shanghai-1)
                 \ (shanghai1)
               5 / Central China (Zhengzhou)
                 \ (zhengzhou1)
               6 / Central China (Changsha-1)
                 \ (hunan1)
               7 / Central China (Changsha-2)
                 \ (zhuzhou1)
               8 / South China (Guangzhou-2)
                 \ (guangzhou1)
               9 / South China (Guangzhou-3)
                 \ (dongguan1)
              10 / North China (Beijing-1)
                 \ (beijing1)
              11 / North China (Beijing-2)
                 \ (beijing2)
              12 / North China (Beijing-3)
                 \ (beijing4)
              13 / North China (Huhehaote)
                 \ (huhehaote1)
              14 / Southwest China (Chengdu)
                 \ (chengdu1)
              15 / Southwest China (Chongqing)
                 \ (chongqing1)
              16 / Southwest China (Guiyang)
                 \ (guiyang1)
              17 / Nouthwest China (Xian)
                 \ (xian1)
              18 / Yunnan China (Kunming)
                 \ (yunnan)
              19 / Yunnan China (Kunming-2)
                 \ (yunnan2)
              20 / Tianjin China (Tianjin)
                 \ (tianjin1)
              21 / Jilin China (Changchun)
                 \ (jilin1)
              22 / Hubei China (Xiangyan)
                 \ (hubei1)
              23 / Jiangxi China (Nanchang)
                 \ (jiangxi1)
              24 / Gansu China (Lanzhou)
                 \ (gansu1)
              25 / Shanxi China (Taiyuan)
                 \ (shanxi1)
              26 / Liaoning China (Shenyang)
                 \ (liaoning1)
              27 / Hebei China (Shijiazhuang)
                 \ (hebei1)
              28 / Fujian China (Xiamen)
                 \ (fujian1)
              29 / Guangxi China (Nanning)
                 \ (guangxi1)
              30 / Anhui China (Huainan)
                 \ (anhui1)
              location_constraint> 1
              Option acl.
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
              This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
              doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               1 | No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ (private)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               2 | The AllUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ (public-read)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               3 | The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
                 | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
                 \ (public-read-write)
                 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
               4 | The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
                 \ (authenticated-read)
                 / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL.
              acl> private
              Option server_side_encryption.
              The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / None
                 \ ()
               2 / AES256
                 \ (AES256)
              server_side_encryption>
              Option storage_class.
              The storage class to use when storing new objects in ChinaMobile.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Default
                 \ ()
               2 / Standard storage class
                 \ (STANDARD)
               3 / Archive storage mode
                 \ (GLACIER)
               4 / Infrequent access storage mode
                 \ (STANDARD_IA)
              storage_class>
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [ChinaMobile]
              type = s3
              provider = ChinaMobile
              access_key_id = accesskeyid
              secret_access_key = secretaccesskey
              endpoint = eos-wuxi-1.cmecloud.cn
              location_constraint = wuxi1
              acl = private
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   ArvanCloud
       ArvanCloud    (https://www.arvancloud.com/en/products/cloud-storage)   ArvanCloud   Object
       Storage goes beyond the limited traditional file storage.  It gives you access  to  backup
       and  archived  files and allows sharing.  Files like profile image in the app, images sent
       by users or scanned documents can be stored securely and  easily  in  our  Object  Storage
       service.

       ArvanCloud provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              n/s> n
              name> ArvanCloud
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Minio)
                 \ "s3"
              [snip]
              Storage> s3
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> 1
              AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
              AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              Region to connect to.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
                 / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
               1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
                 | Leave location constraint empty.
                 \ "us-east-1"
              [snip]
              region>
              Endpoint for S3 API.
              Leave blank if using ArvanCloud to use the default endpoint for the region.
              Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
              endpoint> s3.arvanstorage.com
              Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Empty for Iran-Tehran Region.
                 \ ""
              [snip]
              location_constraint>
              Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
              For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
                 \ "private"
              [snip]
              acl>
              The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / None
                 \ ""
               2 / AES256
                 \ "AES256"
              server_side_encryption>
              The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Default
                 \ ""
               2 / Standard storage class
                 \ "STANDARD"
              storage_class>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [ArvanCloud]
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
              secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              region = ir-thr-at1
              endpoint = s3.arvanstorage.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This will leave the config file looking like this.

              [ArvanCloud]
              type = s3
              provider = ArvanCloud
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
              secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
              region =
              endpoint = s3.arvanstorage.com
              location_constraint =
              acl =
              server_side_encryption =
              storage_class =

   Tencent COS
       Tencent  Cloud  Object  Storage  (COS)  (https://intl.cloud.tencent.com/product/cos)  is a
       distributed storage service offered by Tencent Cloud for unstructured data.  It is secure,
       stable, massive, convenient, low-delay and low-cost.

       To configure access to Tencent COS, follow the steps below:

       1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.

          rclone config
          No remotes found, make a new one?
          n) New remote
          s) Set configuration password
          q) Quit config
          n/s/q> n

       2. Give the name of the configuration.  For example, name it `cos'.

          name> cos

       3. Select s3 storage.

          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          1 / 1Fichier
             \ "fichier"
           2 / Alias for an existing remote
             \ "alias"
           3 / Amazon Drive
             \ "amazon cloud drive"
           4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, ChinaMobile, ArvanCloud, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, Huawei OBS, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
             \ "s3"
          [snip]
          Storage> s3

       4. Select TencentCOS provider.

          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
             \ "AWS"
          [snip]
          11 / Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
             \ "TencentCOS"
          [snip]
          provider> TencentCOS

       5. Enter your SecretId and SecretKey of Tencent Cloud.

          Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
          Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
          Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
             \ "false"
           2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
             \ "true"
          env_auth> 1
          AWS Access Key ID.
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          access_key_id> AKIDxxxxxxxxxx
          AWS Secret Access Key (password)
          Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          secret_access_key> xxxxxxxxxxx

       6. Select endpoint for Tencent COS.  This is the standard endpoint for different region.

           1 / Beijing Region.
             \ "cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com"
           2 / Nanjing Region.
             \ "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"
           3 / Shanghai Region.
             \ "cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com"
           4 / Guangzhou Region.
             \ "cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com"
          [snip]
          endpoint> 4

       7. Choose acl and storage class.

          Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
          doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Owner gets Full_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
             \ "default"
          [snip]
          acl> 1
          The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / Default
             \ ""
          [snip]
          storage_class> 1
          Edit advanced config? (y/n)
          y) Yes
          n) No (default)
          y/n> n
          Remote config
          --------------------
          [cos]
          type = s3
          provider = TencentCOS
          env_auth = false
          access_key_id = xxx
          secret_access_key = xxx
          endpoint = cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com
          acl = default
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y
          Current remotes:

          Name                 Type
          ====                 ====
          cos                  s3

   Netease NOS
       For  Netease  NOS  configure  as  per  the configurator rclone config setting the provider
       Netease.  This will automatically set force_path_style = false which is necessary  for  it
       to run properly.

   Storj
       Storj is a decentralized cloud storage which can be used through its native protocol or an
       S3 compatible gateway.

       The S3 compatible gateway is configured using rclone config with a type of s3 and  with  a
       provider name of Storj.  Here is an example run of the configurator.

              Type of storage to configure.
              Storage> s3
              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
              Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own boolean value (true or false).
              Press Enter for the default (false).
               1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step.
                 \ (false)
               2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).
                 \ (true)
              env_auth> 1
              Option access_key_id.
              AWS Access Key ID.
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> XXXX (as shown when creating the access grant)
              Option secret_access_key.
              AWS Secret Access Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> XXXX (as shown when creating the access grant)
              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint of the Shared Gateway.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / EU1 Shared Gateway
                 \ (gateway.eu1.storjshare.io)
               2 / US1 Shared Gateway
                 \ (gateway.us1.storjshare.io)
               3 / Asia-Pacific Shared Gateway
                 \ (gateway.ap1.storjshare.io)
              endpoint> 1 (as shown when creating the access grant)
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n

       Note   that   s3   credentials   are   generated   when   you   create   an  access  grant
       (https://docs.storj.io/dcs/api-reference/s3-compatible-gateway#usage).

   Backend quirks--chunk-size is forced to be 64 MiB or greater.  This will  use  more  memory  than  the
         default of 5 MiB.

       • Server side copy is disabled as it isn’t currently supported in the gateway.

       • GetTier and SetTier are not supported.

   Backend bugs
       Due to issue #39 (https://github.com/storj/gateway-mt/issues/39) uploading multipart files
       via the S3 gateway causes them to lose their metadata.  For rclone’s  purpose  this  means
       that  the modification time is not stored, nor is any MD5SUM (if one is available from the
       source).

       This has the following consequences:

       • Using rclone rcat will fail as the medatada doesn’t match after upload

       • Uploading files with rclone mount will fail for the same reason

         • This can worked around by using --vfs-cache-mode writes or  --vfs-cache-mode  full  or
           setting --s3-upload-cutoff large

       • Files uploaded via a multipart upload won’t have their modtimes

         • This  will  mean  that rclone sync will likely keep trying to upload files bigger than
           --s3-upload-cutoff

         • This can be worked around with --checksum or --size-only or setting --s3-upload-cutoff
           large

         • The maximum value for --s3-upload-cutoff is 5GiB though

       One  general  purpose  workaround is to set --s3-upload-cutoff 5G.  This means that rclone
       will upload files smaller than 5GiB as single parts.  Note that this can  be  set  in  the
       config  file  with  upload_cutoff  =  5G  or  configured in the advanced settings.  If you
       regularly transfer files larger than 5G then using --checksum  or  --size-only  in  rclone
       sync is the recommended workaround.

   Comparison with the native protocol
       Use  the  the  native  protocol  to take advantage of client-side encryption as well as to
       achieve the best possible download performance.  Uploads will  be  erasure-coded  locally,
       thus a 1gb upload will result in 2.68gb of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the
       network.

       Use this backend and the S3 compatible Hosted Gateway to increase upload  performance  and
       reduce  the load on your systems and network.  Uploads will be encrypted and erasure-coded
       server-side, thus a 1GB upload will result in only  in  1GB  of  data  being  uploaded  to
       storage nodes across the network.

       For more detailed comparison please check the documentation of the storj backend.

   Limitations
       rclone  about is not supported by the S3 backend.  Backends without this capability cannot
       determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as  a  member
       of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Backblaze B2

       B2 is Backblaze’s cloud storage system (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/).

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:bucket  (or  remote:  for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a b2 configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.  To authenticate you will either
       need  your  Account ID (a short hex number) and Master Application Key (a long hex number)
       OR an Application Key, which is the recommended method.  See below for further details  on
       generating and using an Application Key.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              q) Quit config
              n/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Backblaze B2
                 \ "b2"
              [snip]
              Storage> b2
              Account ID or Application Key ID
              account> 123456789abc
              Application Key
              key> 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
              Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
              endpoint>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              account = 123456789abc
              key = 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
              endpoint =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all buckets

              rclone lsd remote:

       Create a new bucket

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

       List the contents of a bucket

              rclone ls remote:bucket

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

   Application Keys
       B2  supports  multiple  Application  Keys  for  different  access permission to B2 Buckets
       (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/application_keys.html).

       You can use these with rclone too; you will need to use rclone version 1.43 or later.

       Follow Backblaze’s docs to create an Application Key with the required permission and  add
       the applicationKeyId as the account and the Application Key itself as the key.

       Note  that  you  must  put  the applicationKeyId as the account – you can’t use the master
       Account ID.  If you try then B2 will return 401 errors.

   –fast-list
       This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer  transactions  in  exchange
       for  more  memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more
       details.

   Modified time
       The   modified   time   is   stored   as   metadata   on   the   object   as    X-Bz-Info-
       src_last_modified_millis  as  milliseconds  since  1970-01-01  in  the Backblaze standard.
       Other tools should be able to use this as a modified time.

       Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported.  Note that if  a  modification
       time needs to be updated on an object then it will create a new version of the object.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

       Note that in 2020-05 Backblaze started allowing  characters in file names.  Rclone  hasn’t
       changed  its  encoding as this could cause syncs to re-transfer files.  If you want rclone
       not to replace  then see the --b2-encoding flag below and remove the  BackSlash  from  the
       string.  This can be set in the config.

   SHA1 checksums
       The SHA1 checksums of the files are checked on upload and download and will be used in the
       syncing process.

       Large files (bigger than the limit in --b2-upload-cutoff) which  are  uploaded  in  chunks
       will  store  their  SHA1  on  the  object  as  X-Bz-Info-large_file_sha1 as recommended by
       Backblaze.

       For a large file to be uploaded with an SHA1 checksum, the source needs  to  support  SHA1
       checksums.  The local disk supports SHA1 checksums so large file transfers from local disk
       will have an SHA1.  See the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#features)  for  exactly
       which remotes support SHA1.

       Sources which don’t support SHA1, in particular crypt will upload large files without SHA1
       checksums.      This     may     be     fixed     in     the     future     (see     #1767
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1767)).

       Files sizes below --b2-upload-cutoff will always have an SHA1 regardless of the source.

   Transfers
       Backblaze  recommends  that you do lots of transfers simultaneously for maximum speed.  In
       tests from my SSD equipped laptop the optimum  setting  is  about  --transfers  32  though
       higher numbers may be used for a slight speed improvement.  The optimum number for you may
       vary depending on your hardware, how big the files are, how much you  want  to  load  your
       computer,  etc.   The  default  of  --transfers  4  is definitely too low for Backblaze B2
       though.

       Note that uploading big files (bigger than 200 MiB by default)  will  use  a  96  MiB  RAM
       buffer  by  default.   There  can be at most --transfers of these in use at any moment, so
       this sets the upper limit on the memory used.

   Versions
       When  rclone  uploads  a  new  version  of  a  file  it  creates  a  new  version  of   it
       (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/file_versions.html).   Likewise when you delete a file,
       the old version will be marked hidden and still be available.  Conversely, you may opt  in
       to  a “hard delete” of files with the --b2-hard-delete flag which would permanently remove
       the file instead of hiding it.

       Old versions of files, where available, are visible using the --b2-versions flag.

       It is also possible to view a bucket as it was at a  certain  point  in  time,  using  the
       --b2-version-at flag.  This will show the file versions as they were at that time, showing
       files that have been deleted afterwards, and hiding files that were created since.

       If you wish to  remove  all  the  old  versions  then  you  can  use  the  rclone  cleanup
       remote:bucket command which will delete all the old versions of files, leaving the current
       ones intact.  You can also supply a path and only old versions under  that  path  will  be
       deleted, e.g. rclone cleanup remote:bucket/path/to/stuff.

       Note  that  cleanup  will remove partially uploaded files from the bucket if they are more
       than a day old.

       When you purge a bucket, the current and the old versions will be deleted then the  bucket
       will be deleted.

       However delete will cause the current versions of the files to become hidden old versions.

       Here  is  a  session  showing  the  listing  and retrieval of an old version followed by a
       cleanup of the old versions.

       Show current version and all the versions with --b2-versions flag.

              $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

              $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt
                      8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                     16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                     15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

       Retrieve an old version

              $ rclone -q --b2-versions copy b2:cleanup-test/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt /tmp

              $ ls -l /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
              -rw-rw-r-- 1 ncw ncw 16 Jul  2 17:46 /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt

       Clean up all the old versions and show that they’ve gone.

              $ rclone -q cleanup b2:cleanup-test

              $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

              $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

   Data usage
       It is useful to know how many requests are sent to the server in different scenarios.

       All copy commands send the following 4 requests:

              /b2api/v1/b2_authorize_account
              /b2api/v1/b2_create_bucket
              /b2api/v1/b2_list_buckets
              /b2api/v1/b2_list_file_names

       The b2_list_file_names request will be sent once for every 1k files in  the  remote  path,
       providing  the  checksum  and  modification  time of the listed files.  As of version 1.33
       issue #818 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/818) causes extra requests to be  sent
       when  using  B2  with  Crypt.   When  a  copy  operation  does not require any files to be
       uploaded, no more requests will be sent.

       Uploading files that do not require chunking, will send 2 requests per file upload:

              /b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_url
              /b2api/v1/b2_upload_file/

       Uploading files requiring chunking, will send 2 requests (one each to start and finish the
       upload) and another 2 requests for each chunk:

              /b2api/v1/b2_start_large_file
              /b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_part_url
              /b2api/v1/b2_upload_part/
              /b2api/v1/b2_finish_large_file

   Versions
       Versions  can  be viewed with the --b2-versions flag.  When it is set rclone will show and
       act on older versions of files.  For example

       Listing without --b2-versions

              $ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt

       And with

              $ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
                      9 one.txt
                      8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
                     16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
                     15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

       Showing that the current version is unchanged but older versions can be seen.  These  have
       the  UTC date that they were uploaded to the server to the nearest millisecond appended to
       them.

       Note that when using --b2-versions no file write operations are permitted,  so  you  can’t
       upload files or delete them.

   B2 and rclone link
       Rclone  supports  generating  file share links for private B2 buckets.  They can either be
       for a file for example:

              ./rclone link B2:bucket/path/to/file.txt
              https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file.txt?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

       or if run on a directory you will get:

              ./rclone link B2:bucket/path
              https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

       you can then use the authorization token (the part of the url from the ?Authorization= on)
       on any file path under that directory.  For example:

              https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file1?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
              https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/file2?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
              https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/folder/file3?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

   –b2-account
       Account ID or Application Key ID.

       Properties:

       • Config: account

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ACCOUNT

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –b2-key
       Application Key.

       Properties:

       • Config: key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –b2-hard-delete
       Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files.

       Properties:

       • Config: hard_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_HARD_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

   –b2-endpoint
       Endpoint for the service.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –b2-test-mode
       A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging.

       This is for debugging purposes only.  Setting it to one of the strings below will cause b2
       to return specific errors:

       • “fail_some_uploads”

       • “expire_some_account_authorization_tokens”

       • “force_cap_exceeded”

       These will  be  set  in  the  “X-Bz-Test-Mode”  header  which  is  documented  in  the  b2
       integrations checklist (https://www.backblaze.com/b2/docs/integration_checklist.html).

       Properties:

       • Config: test_mode

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_TEST_MODE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –b2-versions
       Include old versions in directory listings.

       Note  that  when  using  this  no file write operations are permitted, so you can’t upload
       files or delete them.

       Properties:

       • Config: versions

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_VERSIONS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –b2-version-at
       Show file versions as they were at the specified time.

       Note that when using this no file write operations are  permitted,  so  you  can’t  upload
       files or delete them.

       Properties:

       • Config: version_at

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_VERSION_AT

       • Type: Time

       • Default: off

   –b2-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

       Files above this size will be uploaded in chunks of “–b2-chunk-size”.

       This value should be set no larger than 4.657 GiB (== 5 GB).

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 200Mi

   –b2-copy-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

       Any  files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of
       this size.

       The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 4.6 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_COPY_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 4Gi

   –b2-chunk-size
       Upload chunk size.

       When uploading large files, chunk the file into this size.

       Must fit in memory.  These chunks are buffered in memory and  there  might  a  maximum  of
       “–transfers” chunks in progress at once.

       5,000,000 Bytes is the minimum size.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 96Mi

   –b2-disable-checksum
       Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files.

       Normally  rclone  will  calculate the SHA1 checksum of the input before uploading it so it
       can add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integrity checking  but  can
       cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_checksum

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –b2-download-url
       Custom endpoint for downloads.

       This  is  usually  set  to  a  Cloudflare CDN URL as Backblaze offers free egress for data
       downloaded through the Cloudflare network.  Rclone works with private buckets  by  sending
       an   “Authorization”   header.    If   the  custom  endpoint  rewrites  the  requests  for
       authentication, e.g., in Cloudflare Workers, this header needs  to  be  handled  properly.
       Leave blank if you want to use the endpoint provided by Backblaze.

       The  URL  provided  here  SHOULD have the protocol and SHOULD NOT have a trailing slash or
       specify   the   /file/bucket   subpath    as    rclone    will    request    files    with
       “{download_url}/file/{bucket_name}/{path}”.

       Example: > https://mysubdomain.mydomain.tld (No trailing “/”, “file” or “bucket”)

       Properties:

       • Config: download_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –b2-download-auth-duration
       Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d.

       The  duration before the download authorization token will expire.  The minimum value is 1
       second.  The maximum value is one week.

       Properties:

       • Config: download_auth_duration

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_AUTH_DURATION

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1w

   –b2-memory-pool-flush-time
       How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.  Uploads which requires additional
       buffers  (f.e  multipart)  will use memory pool for allocations.  This option controls how
       often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_flush_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –b2-memory-pool-use-mmap
       Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –b2-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       rclone  about is not supported by the B2 backend.  Backends without this capability cannot
       determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as  a  member
       of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Box

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

       The  initial  setup  for  Box involves getting a token from Box which you can do either in
       your browser, or with a config.json downloaded from Box to use JWT authentication.  rclone
       config walks you through it.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Box
                 \ "box"
              [snip]
              Storage> box
              Box App Client Id - leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              Box App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Box App config.json location
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              box_config_file>
              Box App Primary Access Token
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              access_token>

              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("user").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Rclone should act on behalf of a user
                 \ "user"
               2 / Rclone should act on behalf of a service account
                 \ "enterprise"
              box_sub_type>
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"XXX"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from Box.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back
       the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you  to
       unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Box

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Box

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Box directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Using rclone with an Enterprise account with SSO
       If  you  have an “Enterprise” account type with Box with single sign on (SSO), you need to
       create a password to use Box with rclone.  This can be done at your Enterprise Box account
       by  going  to  Settings,  “Account” Tab, and then set the password in the “Authentication”
       field.

       Once you have done this, you  can  setup  your  Enterprise  Box  account  using  the  same
       procedure detailed above in the, using the password you have just set.

   Invalid refresh token
       According  to  the box docs (https://developer.box.com/v2.0/docs/oauth-20#section-6-using-
       the-access-and-refresh-tokens):

              Each refresh_token is valid for one use in 60 days.

       This means that if you

       • Don’t use the box remote for 60 days

       • Copy the config file with a box refresh token in and use it in two places

       • Get an error on a token refresh

       then rclone will return an error which includes the text Invalid refresh token.

       To fix this you will need to use oauth2 again to update the refresh token.   You  can  use
       the  methods  in the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/), bearing in mind
       that if you use the copy the config file method, you should not use  that  remote  on  the
       computer you did the authentication on.

       Here is how to do it.

              $ rclone config
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              remote               box

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> e
              Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
               1 > remote
              remote> remote
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = box
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2017-07-08T23:40:08.059167677+01:00"}
              --------------------
              Edit remote
              Value "client_id" = ""
              Edit? (y/n)>
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Value "client_secret" = ""
              Edit? (y/n)>
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Already have a token - refresh?
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = box
              token = {"access_token":"YYY","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"YYY","expiry":"2017-07-23T12:22:29.259137901+01:00"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Modified time and hashes
       Box  allows  modification  times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be
       used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

       Box supports SHA1 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \

       File names can also not end with the following characters.  These  only  get  replaced  if
       they are the last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Transfers
       For files above 50 MiB rclone will use a chunked  transfer.   Rclone  will  upload  up  to
       --transfers  chunks at the same time (shared among all the multipart uploads).  Chunks are
       buffered in memory and are normally 8 MiB so increasing --transfers will  increase  memory
       use.

   Deleting files
       Depending  on  the  enterprise  settings  for  your user, the item will either be actually
       deleted from Box or moved to the trash.

       Emptying the trash is supported via  the  rclone  however  cleanup  command  however  this
       deletes  every  trashed  file  and  folder  individually  so it may take a very long time.
       Emptying the trash via the WebUI does not have this limitation so it is advised  to  empty
       the trash via the WebUI.

   Root folder ID
       You  can  set  the  root_folder_id  for  rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its
       Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your Box drive.

       Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will  determine  the  correct  root  to  use
       itself.

       However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

       In  order  to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone
       to display.  This will be the last segment of the URL when you open the relevant folder in
       the Box web interface.

       So   if   the   folder   you   want   rclone   to   use   has   a  URL  which  looks  like
       https://app.box.com/folder/11xxxxxxxxx8 in the browser, then you use 11xxxxxxxxx8  as  the
       root_folder_id in the config.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to box (Box).

   –box-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-box-config-file
       Box App config.json location

       Leave blank normally.

       Leading  ~  will  be  expanded  in  the  file  name  as will environment variables such as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: box_config_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_CONFIG_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-access-token
       Box App Primary Access Token

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ACCESS_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-box-sub-type
       Properties:

       • Config: box_sub_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_SUB_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “user”

       • Examples:

         • “user”

           • Rclone should act on behalf of a user.

         • “enterprise”

           • Rclone should act on behalf of a service account.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to box (Box).

   –box-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-root-folder-id
       Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Default: “0”

   –box-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50 MiB).

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 50Mi

   –box-commit-retries
       Max number of times to try committing a multipart file.

       Properties:

       • Config: commit_retries

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_COMMIT_RETRIES

       • Type: int

       • Default: 100

   –box-list-chunk
       Size of listing chunk 1-1000.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_LIST_CHUNK

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1000

   –box-owned-by
       Only show items owned by the login (email address) passed in.

       Properties:

       • Config: owned_by

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_OWNED_BY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –box-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note  that  Box  is  case  insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and one
       called “hello.doc”.

       Box file names can’t have the \ character in.  rclone maps this to and from  an  identical
       looking unicode equivalent  (U+FF3C Fullwidth Reverse Solidus).

       Box only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

       rclone about is not supported by the Box backend.  Backends without this capability cannot
       determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as  a  member
       of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Cache (DEPRECATED)

       The  cache remote wraps another existing remote and stores file structure and its data for
       long running tasks like rclone mount.

   Status
       The cache backend code is working but it currently doesn’t have a maintainer so there  are
       outstanding                                                                           bugs
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+label%3Abug+label%3A%22Remote%3A+Cache%22)
       which aren’t getting fixed.

       The  cache  backend  is due to be phased out in favour of the VFS caching layer eventually
       which is more tightly integrated into rclone.

       Until this happens we recommend only using the cache backend if you find  you  can’t  work
       without  it.   There  are  many  docs  online  describing  the use of the cache backend to
       minimize API hits and by-and-large these are out of  date  and  the  cache  backend  isn’t
       needed in those scenarios any more.

   Configuration
       To  get  started  you  just  need  to have an existing remote which can be configured with
       cache.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called test-cache.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/r/c/s/q> n
              name> test-cache
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Cache a remote
                 \ "cache"
              [snip]
              Storage> cache
              Remote to cache.
              Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
              "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
              remote> local:/test
              Optional: The URL of the Plex server
              plex_url> http://127.0.0.1:32400
              Optional: The username of the Plex user
              plex_username> dummyusername
              Optional: The password of the Plex user
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank
              y/g/n> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              The size of a chunk. Lower value good for slow connections but can affect seamless reading.
              Default: 5M
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / 1 MiB
                 \ "1M"
               2 / 5 MiB
                 \ "5M"
               3 / 10 MiB
                 \ "10M"
              chunk_size> 2
              How much time should object info (file size, file hashes, etc.) be stored in cache. Use a very high value if you don't plan on changing the source FS from outside the cache.
              Accepted units are: "s", "m", "h".
              Default: 5m
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / 1 hour
                 \ "1h"
               2 / 24 hours
                 \ "24h"
               3 / 24 hours
                 \ "48h"
              info_age> 2
              The maximum size of stored chunks. When the storage grows beyond this size, the oldest chunks will be deleted.
              Default: 10G
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / 500 MiB
                 \ "500M"
               2 / 1 GiB
                 \ "1G"
               3 / 10 GiB
                 \ "10G"
              chunk_total_size> 3
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [test-cache]
              remote = local:/test
              plex_url = http://127.0.0.1:32400
              plex_username = dummyusername
              plex_password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              chunk_size = 5M
              info_age = 48h
              chunk_total_size = 10G

       You can then use it like this,

       List directories in top level of your drive

              rclone lsd test-cache:

       List all the files in your drive

              rclone ls test-cache:

       To start a cached mount

              rclone mount --allow-other test-cache: /var/tmp/test-cache

   Write Features
   Offline uploading
       In an effort to make writing through cache more reliable, the backend  now  supports  this
       feature which can be activated by specifying a cache-tmp-upload-path.

       A files goes through these states when using this feature:

       1. An upload is started (usually by copying a file on the cache remote)

       2. When  the  copy  to  the  temporary location is complete the file is part of the cached
          remote and looks and behaves like any other file (reading included)

       3. After cache-tmp-wait-time passes and the file is next in line, rclone move is  used  to
          move the file to the cloud provider

       4. Reading  the  file  still  works during the upload but most modifications on it will be
          prohibited

       5. Once the move is complete the file is unlocked for modifications as it becomes  as  any
          other regular file

       6. If  the  file is being read through cache when it’s actually deleted from the temporary
          path then cache will simply swap the source to the cloud provider without  interrupting
          the reading (small blip can happen though)

       Files  are  uploaded in sequence and only one file is uploaded at a time.  Uploads will be
       stored in a queue and be processed based on the order they were added.  The queue and  the
       temporary  storage  is  persistent  across restarts but can be cleared on startup with the
       --cache-db-purge flag.

   Write Support
       Writes are supported through cache.  One caveat is that a mounted cache  remote  does  not
       add  any  retry  or  fallback  mechanism to the upload operation.  This will depend on the
       implementation of the wrapped remote.   Consider  using  Offline  uploading  for  reliable
       writes.

       One  special  case is covered with cache-writes which will cache the file data at the same
       time as the upload when it is enabled making it available from the cache store immediately
       once the upload is finished.

   Read Features
   Multiple connections
       To  counter  the  high  latency  between  a  local  PC  where  rclone is running and cloud
       providers, the cache remote can split multiple requests to the cloud provider for  smaller
       file  chunks  and  combines  them  together  locally  where  they  can be available almost
       immediately before the reader usually needs them.

       This is similar to buffering when media files are played online.  Rclone will stay  around
       the current marker but always try its best to stay ahead and prepare the data before.

   Plex Integration
       There is a direct integration with Plex which allows cache to detect during reading if the
       file is in playback or not.  This helps cache to adapt how it queries the  cloud  provider
       depending on what is needed for.

       Scans  will  have a minimum amount of workers (1) while in a confirmed playback cache will
       deploy the configured number of workers.

       This integration opens the doorway to additional performance improvements  which  will  be
       explored in the near future.

       Note:  If Plex options are not configured, cache will function with its configured options
       without adapting any of its settings.

       How to enable?  Run rclone config and add all the Plex  options  (endpoint,  username  and
       password) in your remote and it will be automatically enabled.

       Affected  settings:  -  cache-workers: Configured value during confirmed playback or 1 all
       the other times

   Certificate Validation
       When the Plex server is configured to only accept secure connections, it  is  possible  to
       use  .plex.direct  URLs to ensure certificate validation succeeds.  These URLs are used by
       Plex internally to connect to the Plex server securely.

       The format for these URLs is the following:

       https://ip-with-dots-replaced.server-hash.plex.direct:32400/

       The ip-with-dots-replaced part can be any IPv4 address, where the dots have been  replaced
       with dashes, e.g. 127.0.0.1 becomes 127-0-0-1.

       To get the server-hash part, the easiest way is to visit

       https://plex.tv/api/resources?includeHttps=1&X-Plex-Token=your-plex-token

       This  page  will  list  all  the available Plex servers for your account with at least one
       .plex.direct link for each.  Copy one URL and replace the  IP  address  with  the  desired
       address.  This can be used as the plex_url value.

   Known issues
   Mount and –dir-cache-time
       –dir-cache-time  controls  the  first  layer of directory caching which works at the mount
       layer.  Being an independent caching mechanism from the cache backend, it will manage  its
       own entries based on the configured time.

       To  avoid getting in a scenario where dir cache has obsolete data and cache would have the
       correct one, try to set --dir-cache-time to a lower time than  --cache-info-age.   Default
       values are already configured in this way.

   Windows support - Experimental
       There  are  a  couple  of  issues with Windows mount functionality that still require some
       investigations.  It should be considered as experimental thus far as  fixes  come  in  for
       this OS.

       Most  of  the  issues  seem  to  be related to the difference between filesystems on Linux
       flavors and Windows as cache is heavily dependent on them.

       Any reports or feedback on how cache behaves on this OS is greatly appreciated.

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1935

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1907

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1834

   Risk of throttling
       Future iterations of the cache backend will make use of the pooling functionality  of  the
       cloud  provider  to synchronize and at the same time make writing through it more tolerant
       to failures.

       There are a couple of enhancements in track to add these but in the meantime  there  is  a
       valid  concern  that  the  expiring cache listings can lead to cloud provider throttles or
       bans due to repeated queries on it for very large mounts.

       Some recommendations: - don’t use a very small interval for  entry  information  (--cache-
       info-age)  -  while  writes  aren’t yet optimised, you can still write through cache which
       gives you the advantage of adding the file in the cache at the same time if configured  to
       do so.

       Future enhancements:

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1937

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1936

   cache and crypt
       One  common  scenario is to keep your data encrypted in the cloud provider using the crypt
       remote.  crypt uses a similar technique to wrap around an existing remote and handles this
       translation in a seamless way.

       There is an issue with wrapping the remotes in this order: cloud remote -> crypt -> cache

       During  testing, I experienced a lot of bans with the remotes in this order.  I suspect it
       might be related to how crypt opens files on the cloud provider which makes it think we’re
       downloading  the  full file instead of small chunks.  Organizing the remotes in this order
       yields better results: cloud remote -> cache -> crypt

   absolute remote paths
       cache can not differentiate between relative and absolute paths for  the  wrapped  remote.
       Any  path given in the remote config setting and on the command line will be passed to the
       wrapped remote as is, but for storing the chunks on disk the path will be made relative by
       removing any leading / character.

       This behavior is irrelevant for most backend types, but there are backends where a leading
       / changes the effective directory, e.g. in the sftp backend paths starting with  a  /  are
       relative  to  the  root  of the SSH server and paths without are relative to the user home
       directory.  As a result sftp:bin and sftp:/bin will share the same cache folder,  even  if
       they represent a different directory on the SSH server.

   Cache and Remote Control (–rc)
       Cache  supports  the  new  --rc  mode  in  rclone and can be remote controlled through the
       following end points: By default, the listener is disabled if you do not add the flag.

   rc cache/expire
       Purge a remote from the cache backend.   Supports  either  a  directory  or  a  file.   It
       supports both encrypted and unencrypted file names if cache is wrapped by crypt.

       Params: - remote = path to remote (required) - withData = true/false to delete cached data
       (chunks) as well (optional, false by default)

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

   –cache-remote
       Remote to cache.

       Normally should contain a `:' and a path,  e.g. “myremote:path/to/dir”,  “myremote:bucket”
       or maybe “myremote:” (not recommended).

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –cache-plex-url
       The URL of the Plex server.

       Properties:

       • Config: plex_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-plex-username
       The username of the Plex user.

       Properties:

       • Config: plex_username

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_USERNAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-plex-password
       The password of the Plex user.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: plex_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-chunk-size
       The size of a chunk (partial file data).

       Use lower numbers for slower connections.  If the chunk size is  changed,  any  downloaded
       chunks  will  be  invalid  and  cache-chunk-path will need to be cleared or unexpected EOF
       errors will occur.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 5Mi

       • Examples:

         • “1M”

           • 1 MiB

         • “5M”

           • 5 MiB

         • “10M”

           • 10 MiB

   –cache-info-age
       How long to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.).
       If  all  write  operations  are done through the cache then you can safely make this value
       very large as the cache store will also be updated in real time.

       Properties:

       • Config: info_age

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_INFO_AGE

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 6h0m0s

       • Examples:

         • “1h”

           • 1 hour

         • “24h”

           • 24 hours

         • “48h”

           • 48 hours

   –cache-chunk-total-size
       The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk.

       If the cache exceeds this value then it will start to delete the oldest  chunks  until  it
       goes under this value.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_total_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_TOTAL_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 10Gi

       • Examples:

         • “500M”

           • 500 MiB

         • “1G”

           • 1 GiB

         • “10G”

           • 10 GiB

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

   –cache-plex-token
       The plex token for authentication - auto set normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: plex_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-plex-insecure
       Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server.

       Properties:

       • Config: plex_insecure

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_INSECURE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-db-path
       Directory to store file structure metadata DB.

       The remote name is used as the DB file name.

       Properties:

       • Config: db_path

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PATH

       • Type: string

       • Default: “$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend”

   –cache-chunk-path
       Directory to cache chunk files.

       Path  to where partial file data (chunks) are stored locally.  The remote name is appended
       to the final path.

       This config follows the “–cache-db-path”.  If you specify a custom location  for  “–cache-
       db-path”  and  don’t specify one for “–cache-chunk-path” then “–cache-chunk-path” will use
       the same path as “–cache-db-path”.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_path

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_PATH

       • Type: string

       • Default: “$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend”

   –cache-db-purge
       Clear all the cached data for this remote on start.

       Properties:

       • Config: db_purge

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PURGE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –cache-chunk-clean-interval
       How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage.

       The default value should be ok for most people.  If you find  that  the  cache  goes  over
       “cache-chunk-total-size”  too  often  then  try to lower this value to force it to perform
       cleanups more often.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_clean_interval

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_CLEAN_INTERVAL

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –cache-read-retries
       How many times to retry a read from a cache storage.

       Since reading from a cache stream is independent from downloading file data,  readers  can
       get  to  a  point  where  there’s  no  more data in the cache.  Most of the times this can
       indicate a connectivity issue if cache isn’t able to provide file data anymore.

       For really slow connections, increase this to a point where the stream is able to  provide
       data but your experience will be very stuttering.

       Properties:

       • Config: read_retries

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_READ_RETRIES

       • Type: int

       • Default: 10

   –cache-workers
       How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks.

       Higher  values  will mean more parallel processing (better CPU needed) and more concurrent
       requests on the cloud provider.  This impacts several aspects like the cloud provider  API
       limits,  more  stress  on  the hardware that rclone runs on but it also means that streams
       will be more fluid and data will be available much more faster to readers.

       Note: If the optional Plex integration is enabled then this setting will adapt to the type
       of  reading  performed  and  the  value specified here will be used as a maximum number of
       workers to use.

       Properties:

       • Config: workers

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WORKERS

       • Type: int

       • Default: 4

   –cache-chunk-no-memory
       Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming.

       By default, cache will keep file data during streaming in RAM as well  to  provide  it  to
       readers as fast as possible.

       This  transient  data  is  evicted  as  soon as it is read and the number of chunks stored
       doesn’t exceed the number of workers.  However, depending on other settings  like  “cache-
       chunk-size”  and “cache-workers” this footprint can increase if there are parallel streams
       too (multiple files being read at the same time).

       If the hardware permits it, use this feature to  provide  an  overall  better  performance
       during streaming but it can also be disabled if RAM is not available on the local machine.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_no_memory

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_NO_MEMORY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –cache-rps
       Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable).

       This  setting  places a hard limit on the number of requests per second that cache will be
       doing to the cloud provider remote and try to respect that value by setting waits  between
       reads.

       If  you find that you’re getting banned or limited on the cloud provider through cache and
       know that a smaller number of requests per second will allow you to work with it then  you
       can use this setting for that.

       A  good  balance  of  all  the  other  settings should make this setting useless but it is
       available to set for more special cases.

       NOTE: This will limit the number of requests during streams but other  API  calls  to  the
       cloud provider like directory listings will still pass.

       Properties:

       • Config: rps

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_RPS

       • Type: int

       • Default: -1

   –cache-writes
       Cache file data on writes through the FS.

       If  you  need to read files immediately after you upload them through cache you can enable
       this flag to have their data stored in the cache store at the same time during upload.

       Properties:

       • Config: writes

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WRITES

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –cache-tmp-upload-path
       Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded.

       This is the path where cache will use as a temporary storage for new files that need to be
       uploaded to the cloud provider.

       Specifying  a  value  will enable this feature.  Without it, it is completely disabled and
       files will be uploaded directly to the cloud provider

       Properties:

       • Config: tmp_upload_path

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_UPLOAD_PATH

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –cache-tmp-wait-time
       How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded.

       This is the duration that a file must wait in the temporary location cache-tmp-upload-path
       before it is selected for upload.

       Note  that  only one file is uploaded at a time and it can take longer to start the upload
       if a queue formed for this purpose.

       Properties:

       • Config: tmp_wait_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_WAIT_TIME

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 15s

   –cache-db-wait-time
       How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited.

       Only one process can have the DB open at any one time, so rclone waits for  this  duration
       for the DB to become available before it gives an error.

       If you set it to 0 then it will wait forever.

       Properties:

       • Config: db_wait_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_WAIT_TIME

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1s

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the cache backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These  can  be  run  on  a  running  backend  using   the   rc   command   backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   stats
       Print stats on the cache backend in JSON format.

              rclone backend stats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

Chunker (BETA)

       The  chunker overlay transparently splits large files into smaller chunks during upload to
       wrapped remote and transparently assembles them back when the file  is  downloaded.   This
       allows to effectively overcome size limits imposed by storage providers.

   Configuration
       To use it, first set up the underlying remote following the configuration instructions for
       that remote.  You can also use a local pathname instead of a remote.

       First check your chosen remote is working - we’ll call it  remote:path  here.   Note  that
       anything  inside  remote:path will be chunked and anything outside won’t.  This means that
       if you are using a bucket-based remote (e.g. S3, B2, swift) then you should  probably  put
       the bucket in the remote s3:bucket.

       Now  configure  chunker using rclone config.  We will call this one overlay to separate it
       from the remote itself.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> overlay
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Transparently chunk/split large files
                 \ "chunker"
              [snip]
              Storage> chunker
              Remote to chunk/unchunk.
              Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
              "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              remote> remote:path
              Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.
              Enter a size with suffix K,M,G,T. Press Enter for the default ("2G").
              chunk_size> 100M
              Choose how chunker handles hash sums. All modes but "none" require metadata.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("md5").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files, return nothing otherwise
                 \ "none"
               2 / MD5 for composite files
                 \ "md5"
               3 / SHA1 for composite files
                 \ "sha1"
               4 / MD5 for all files
                 \ "md5all"
               5 / SHA1 for all files
                 \ "sha1all"
               6 / Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source falling back to SHA1 if unsupported
                 \ "md5quick"
               7 / Similar to "md5quick" but prefers SHA1 over MD5
                 \ "sha1quick"
              hash_type> md5
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [overlay]
              type = chunker
              remote = remote:bucket
              chunk_size = 100M
              hash_type = md5
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Specifying the remote
       In normal use, make sure the remote has a : in.  If you specify the  remote  without  a  :
       then  rclone  will  use  a  local  directory  of  that  name.   So  if you use a remote of
       /path/to/secret/files then rclone will chunk stuff in that directory.  If you use a remote
       of name then rclone will put files in a directory called name in the current directory.

   Chunking
       When  rclone starts a file upload, chunker checks the file size.  If it doesn’t exceed the
       configured chunk size, chunker will just pass the file to the wrapped remote.  If  a  file
       is  large,  chunker  will transparently cut data in pieces with temporary names and stream
       them one by one, on the fly.  Each data chunk will contain the specified number of  bytes,
       except  for  the  last  one  which may have less data.  If file size is unknown in advance
       (this is called a streaming upload), chunker will  internally  create  a  temporary  copy,
       record its size and repeat the above process.

       When  upload completes, temporary chunk files are finally renamed.  This scheme guarantees
       that operations can be run in parallel and look from outside as atomic.  A similar  method
       with hidden temporary chunks is used for other operations (copy/move/rename, etc.).  If an
       operation fails, hidden chunks are normally destroyed, and the target composite file stays
       intact.

       When  a  composite  file  download  is  requested,  chunker  transparently assembles it by
       concatenating data chunks in order.  As the split  is  trivial  one  could  even  manually
       concatenate data chunks together to obtain the original content.

       When  the  list  rclone  command  scans a directory on wrapped remote, the potential chunk
       files are accounted for, grouped and assembled  into  composite  directory  entries.   Any
       temporary chunks are hidden.

       List  and other commands can sometimes come across composite files with missing or invalid
       chunks, e.g. shadowed by like-named directory or another file.  This  usually  means  that
       wrapped  file  system  has  been  directly tampered with or damaged.  If chunker detects a
       missing chunk it will by default print warning, skip the whole incomplete group of  chunks
       but  proceed  with  current  command.   You  can  set the --chunker-fail-hard flag to have
       commands abort with error message in such cases.

   Chunk names
       The default chunk name format is *.rclone_chunk.###, hence  by  default  chunk  names  are
       BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.001,  BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.002  etc.   You  can configure
       another name format using the name_format configuration  file  option.   The  format  uses
       asterisk  *  as  a  placeholder  for  the  base file name and one or more consecutive hash
       characters # as a placeholder for sequential chunk number.  There must be one and only one
       asterisk.   The  number  of  consecutive  hash  characters defines the minimum length of a
       string representing a chunk number.  If decimal chunk number  has  less  digits  than  the
       number of hashes, it is left-padded by zeros.  If the decimal string is longer, it is left
       intact.  By default numbering starts from 1 but there is another option that  allows  user
       to start from 0, e.g. for compatibility with legacy software.

       For  example,  if  name  format  is  big_*-##.part  and original file name is data.txt and
       numbering starts from 0, then the first chunk will be named big_data.txt-00.part, the 99th
       chunk will be big_data.txt-98.part and the 302nd chunk will become big_data.txt-301.part.

       Note  that  list  assembles  composite  directory  entries only when chunk names match the
       configured format and treats non-conforming file names as normal non-chunked files.

       When using norename transactions, chunk names will additionally have a unique file version
       suffix.  For example, BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.001_bp562k.

   Metadata
       Besides  data  chunks chunker will by default create metadata object for a composite file.
       The object is named after the original file.  Chunker  allows  user  to  disable  metadata
       completely  (the  none  format).   Note  that  metadata  is normally not created for files
       smaller than the configured chunk size.  This may change in future rclone releases.

   Simple JSON metadata format
       This is the default format.  It supports hash sums  and  chunk  validation  for  composite
       files.  Meta objects carry the following fields:

       • ver - version of format, currently 1size - total size of composite file

       • nchunks - number of data chunks in file

       • md5 - MD5 hashsum of composite file (if present)

       • sha1 - SHA1 hashsum (if present)

       • txn - identifies current version of the file

       There  is no field for composite file name as it’s simply equal to the name of meta object
       on the wrapped remote.  Please refer to respective sections for details  on  hashsums  and
       modified time handling.

   No metadata
       You  can  disable  meta  objects  by setting the meta format option to none.  In this mode
       chunker will scan directory for all files that follow configured chunk name format,  group
       them by detecting chunks with the same base name and show group names as virtual composite
       files.  This method is more prone to missing chunk errors (especially missing last  chunk)
       than format with metadata enabled.

   Hashsums
       Chunker  supports  hashsums  only  when  a  compatible metadata is present.  Hence, if you
       choose metadata format of none, chunker will report hashsum as UNSUPPORTED.

       Please note that by default metadata is stored only for composite files.   If  a  file  is
       smaller  than  configured chunk size, chunker will transparently redirect hash requests to
       wrapped remote, so support depends on that.  You will see the empty string as a hashsum of
       requested type for small files if the wrapped remote doesn’t support it.

       Many  storage backends support MD5 and SHA1 hash types, so does chunker.  With chunker you
       can choose one or another but not both.  MD5 is set by default as the most supported type.
       Since  chunker  keeps hashes for composite files and falls back to the wrapped remote hash
       for non-chunked ones, we advise you to choose the same hash type as supported  by  wrapped
       remote so that your file listings look coherent.

       If your storage backend does not support MD5 or SHA1 but you need consistent file hashing,
       configure chunker with md5all or sha1all.  These two modes guarantee given  hash  for  all
       files.  If wrapped remote doesn’t support it, chunker will then add metadata to all files,
       even small.  However, this can double the amount of  small  files  in  storage  and  incur
       additional  service  charges.   You  can even use chunker to force md5/sha1 support in any
       other remote at expense of sidecar meta  objects  by  setting  e.g. chunk_type=sha1all  to
       force hashsums and chunk_size=1P to effectively disable chunking.

       Normally,  when  a  file is copied to chunker controlled remote, chunker will ask the file
       source for compatible file hash and revert to on-the-fly calculation  if  none  is  found.
       This  involves some CPU overhead but provides a guarantee that given hashsum is available.
       Also, chunker will reject a server-side copy or move operation if source  and  destination
       hashsum  types  are different resulting in the extra network bandwidth, too.  In some rare
       cases this may be undesired, so chunker  provides  two  optional  choices:  sha1quick  and
       md5quick.  If the source does not support primary hash type and the quick mode is enabled,
       chunker will try to fall back to the secondary type.  This will save CPU and bandwidth but
       can  result  in  empty  hashsums at destination.  Beware of consequences: the sync command
       will revert (sometimes silently) to time/size comparison if  compatible  hashsums  between
       source and target are not found.

   Modified time
       Chunker  stores  modification  times  using the wrapped remote so support depends on that.
       For a small non-chunked file the chunker overlay simply manipulates modification  time  of
       the  wrapped  remote  file.   For  a composite file with metadata chunker will get and set
       modification time of the metadata object on the wrapped remote.  If file  is  chunked  but
       metadata format is none then chunker will use modification time of the first data chunk.

   Migrations
       The  idiomatic  way  to migrate to a different chunk size, hash type, transaction style or
       chunk naming scheme is to:

       • Collect all your chunked files under a directory and have your chunker remote  point  to
         it.

       • Create  another  directory (most probably on the same cloud storage) and configure a new
         remote with desired metadata format, hash type, chunk naming etc.

       • Now run rclone sync -i oldchunks: newchunks: and all your  data  will  be  transparently
         converted  in  transfer.  This may take some time, yet chunker will try server-side copy
         if possible.

       • After checking data integrity you may remove configuration section of the old remote.

       If rclone gets killed during a long operation on a big composite  file,  hidden  temporary
       chunks may stay in the directory.  They will not be shown by the list command but will eat
       up your account quota.  Please note that the deletefile command deletes only active chunks
       of  a  file.   As a workaround, you can use remote of the wrapped file system to see them.
       An easy way to get rid of hidden garbage is to copy littered directory somewhere using the
       chunker  remote  and purge the original directory.  The copy command will copy only active
       chunks while the purge will remove everything including garbage.

   Caveats and Limitations
       Chunker requires wrapped remote to support server-side move (or copy + delete) operations,
       otherwise  it  will  explicitly  refuse  to  start.  This is because it internally renames
       temporary chunk files to their final names when an operation completes successfully.

       Chunker encodes chunk number in file name, so with default name_format setting it adds  17
       characters.   Also  chunker adds 7 characters of temporary suffix during operations.  Many
       file systems limit base file name without path by 255 characters.   Using  rclone’s  crypt
       remote  as  a  base  file  system  limits file name by 143 characters.  Thus, maximum name
       length is 231 for most files and 119 for chunker-over-crypt.  A user in  need  can  change
       name format to e.g. *.rcc## and save 10 characters (provided at most 99 chunks per file).

       Note  that  a  move implemented using the copy-and-delete method may incur double charging
       with some cloud storage providers.

       Chunker will not automatically rename existing chunks when you run rclone config on a live
       remote  and  change the chunk name format.  Beware that in result of this some files which
       have been treated as chunks before the change can pop up in directory listings  as  normal
       files and vice versa.  The same warning holds for the chunk size.  If you desperately need
       to change critical chunking settings, you should run data migration as described above.

       If wrapped remote is case insensitive, the chunker overlay will inherit that property  (so
       you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and “hello.doc” in the same directory).

       Chunker  included  in  rclone  releases  up to v1.54 can sometimes fail to detect metadata
       produced by recent versions of rclone.  We recommend users to keep  rclone  up-to-date  to
       avoid data corruption.

       Changing transactions is dangerous and requires explicit migration.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

   –chunker-remote
       Remote to chunk/unchunk.

       Normally  should  contain a `:' and a path, e.g. “myremote:path/to/dir”, “myremote:bucket”
       or maybe “myremote:” (not recommended).

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –chunker-chunk-size
       Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 2Gi

   –chunker-hash-type
       Choose how chunker handles hash sums.

       All modes but “none” require metadata.

       Properties:

       • Config: hash_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_HASH_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “md5”

       • Examples:

         • “none”

           • Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files.

           • Return nothing otherwise.

         • “md5”

           • MD5 for composite files.

         • “sha1”

           • SHA1 for composite files.

         • “md5all”

           • MD5 for all files.

         • “sha1all”

           • SHA1 for all files.

         • “md5quick”

           • Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source.

           • Falling back to SHA1 if unsupported.

         • “sha1quick”

           • Similar to “md5quick” but prefers SHA1 over MD5.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

   –chunker-name-format
       String format of chunk file names.

       The two placeholders are: base file name (*) and chunk number (#...).  There must  be  one
       and  only  one  asterisk and one or more consecutive hash characters.  If chunk number has
       less digits than the number of hashes, it is left-padded by  zeros.   If  there  are  more
       digits in the number, they are left as is.  Possible chunk files are ignored if their name
       does not match given format.

       Properties:

       • Config: name_format

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_NAME_FORMAT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “*.rclone_chunk.###”

   –chunker-start-from
       Minimum valid chunk number.  Usually 0 or 1.

       By default chunk numbers start from 1.

       Properties:

       • Config: start_from

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_START_FROM

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1

   –chunker-meta-format
       Format of the metadata object or “none”.

       By default “simplejson”.  Metadata is a small JSON file named after the composite file.

       Properties:

       • Config: meta_format

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_META_FORMAT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “simplejson”

       • Examples:

         • “none”

           • Do not use metadata files at all.

           • Requires hash type “none”.

         • “simplejson”

           • Simple JSON supports hash sums and chunk validation.

           • It has the following fields: ver, size, nchunks, md5, sha1.

   –chunker-fail-hard
       Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks.

       Properties:

       • Config: fail_hard

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_FAIL_HARD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Report errors and abort current command.

         • “false”

           • Warn user, skip incomplete file and proceed.

   –chunker-transactions
       Choose how chunker should handle temporary files during transactions.

       Properties:

       • Config: transactions

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_TRANSACTIONS

       • Type: string

       • Default: “rename”

       • Examples:

         • “rename”

           • Rename temporary files after a successful transaction.

         • “norename”

           • Leave temporary file names and write transaction ID to metadata file.

           • Metadata is required for no rename transactions (meta format cannot be “none”).

           • If you are using norename transactions you should be careful not to downgrade Rclone

           • as  older  versions  of  Rclone  don’t  support  this  transaction  style  and  will
             misinterpret

           • files manipulated by norename transactions.

           • This method is EXPERIMENTAL, don’t use on production systems.

         • “auto”

           • Rename or norename will be used depending on capabilities of the backend.

           • If meta format is set to “none”, rename transactions will always be used.

           • This method is EXPERIMENTAL, don’t use on production systems.

Citrix ShareFile

       Citrix  ShareFile  (https://sharefile.com)  is  a secure file sharing and transfer service
       aimed as business.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for Citrix ShareFile involves getting  a  token  from  Citrix  ShareFile
       which you can in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              XX / Citrix Sharefile
                 \ "sharefile"
              Storage> sharefile
              ** See help for sharefile backend at: https://rclone.org/sharefile/ **

              ID of the root folder

              Leave blank to access "Personal Folders".  You can use one of the
              standard values here or any folder ID (long hex number ID).
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Access the Personal Folders. (Default)
                 \ ""
               2 / Access the Favorites folder.
                 \ "favorites"
               3 / Access all the shared folders.
                 \ "allshared"
               4 / Access all the individual connectors.
                 \ "connectors"
               5 / Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.
                 \ "top"
              root_folder_id>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=XXX
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = sharefile
              endpoint = https://XXX.sharefile.com
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-09-30T19:41:45.878561877+01:00"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from Citrix ShareFile.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment
       you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and  this  it  may
       require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your ShareFile

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your ShareFile

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an ShareFile directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Modified time and hashes
       ShareFile allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will
       be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

       ShareFile supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

   Transfers
       For files above 128 MiB rclone will use a chunked transfer.   Rclone  will  upload  up  to
       --transfers  chunks at the same time (shared among all the multipart uploads).  Chunks are
       buffered in memory and are normally 64 MiB so increasing --transfers will increase  memory
       use.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \
       *           0x2A        *
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       :           0x3A        :
       |           0x7C        |
       ”           0x22        "

       File  names  can  also  not  start  or  end with the following characters.  These only get
       replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠
       .           0x2E        .

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

   –sharefile-root-folder-id
       ID of the root folder.

       Leave  blank to access “Personal Folders”.  You can use one of the standard values here or
       any folder ID (long hex number ID).

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Access the Personal Folders (default).

         • “favorites”

           • Access the Favorites folder.

         • “allshared”

           • Access all the shared folders.

         • “connectors”

           • Access all the individual connectors.

         • “top”

           • Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

   –sharefile-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to multipart upload.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 128Mi

   –sharefile-chunk-size
       Upload chunk size.

       Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

       Making this larger will improve performance, but note  that  each  chunk  is  buffered  in
       memory one per transfer.

       Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 64Mi

   –sharefile-endpoint
       Endpoint for API calls.

       This  is  usually auto discovered as part of the oauth process, but can be set manually to
       something like: https://XXX.sharefile.com

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sharefile-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note  that  ShareFile  is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and
       one called “hello.doc”.

       ShareFile only supports filenames up to 256 characters in length.

       rclone about is not supported by the Citrix  ShareFile  backend.   Backends  without  this
       capability  cannot  determine  free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free
       space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See     List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone      about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)          and         rclone         about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Crypt

       Rclone crypt remotes encrypt and decrypt other remotes.

       A remote of type crypt does not access  a  storage  system  (https://rclone.org/overview/)
       directly,  but  instead  wraps  another remote, which in turn accesses the storage system.
       This    is     similar     to     how     alias     (https://rclone.org/alias/),     union
       (https://rclone.org/union/),  chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) and a few others work.
       It makes the usage very flexible, as you can add a  layer,  in  this  case  an  encryption
       layer,  on  top of any other backend, even in multiple layers.  Rclone’s functionality can
       be   used   as    with    any    other    remote,    for    example    you    can    mount
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/) a crypt remote.

       Accessing  a  storage system through a crypt remote realizes client-side encryption, which
       makes it safe to keep your data in a location you do not trust will not  get  compromised.
       When  working  against  the  crypt  remote,  rclone  will  automatically  encrypt  (before
       uploading) and decrypt (after downloading) on your local system  as  needed  on  the  fly,
       leaving  the  data  encrypted  at  rest  in the wrapped remote.  If you access the storage
       system using an application other than rclone, or access the wrapped remote directly using
       rclone,  there  will  not  be any encryption/decryption: Downloading existing content will
       just give you the encrypted (scrambled) format, and anything you upload  will  not  become
       encrypted.

       The  encryption  is  a  secret-key  encryption  (also  called  symmetric  key  encryption)
       algorithm, where a password (or pass phrase) is used to generate real encryption key.  The
       password can be supplied by user, or you may chose to let rclone generate one.  It will be
       stored in the configuration  file,  in  a  lightly  obscured  form.   If  you  are  in  an
       environment  where  you  are  not  able to keep your configuration secured, you should add
       configuration    encryption     (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption)     as
       protection.  As long as you have this configuration file, you will be able to decrypt your
       data.  Without the configuration file, as long as you remember the password (or keep it in
       a  safe  place), you can re-create the configuration and gain access to the existing data.
       You may also configure a corresponding remote in a different installation  to  access  the
       same data.  See below for guidance to changing password.

       Encryption uses cryptographic salt (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Salt_(cryptography)), to
       permute the encryption key so that the same string may be  encrypted  in  different  ways.
       When  configuring  the  crypt  remote  it  is  optional  to enter a salt, or to let rclone
       generate a unique salt.  If omitted, rclone uses a built-in unique  string.   Normally  in
       cryptography,  the  salt is stored together with the encrypted content, and do not have to
       be memorized by the user.  This is not the case in rclone, because rclone does  not  store
       any  additional  information  on  the remotes.  Use of custom salt is effectively a second
       password that must be memorized.

       File     content     encryption      is      performed      using      NaCl      SecretBox
       (https://godoc.org/golang.org/x/crypto/nacl/secretbox),   based  on  XSalsa20  cipher  and
       Poly1305 for integrity.  Names (file- and directory names) are also encrypted by  default,
       but this has some implications and is therefore possible to turned off.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called secret.

       To  use  crypt, first set up the underlying remote.  Follow the rclone config instructions
       for the specific backend.

       Before configuring the crypt remote, check the underlying  remote  is  working.   In  this
       example the underlying remote is called remote.  We will configure a path path within this
       remote to contain the encrypted content.  Anything inside remote:path  will  be  encrypted
       and anything outside will not.

       Configure  crypt  using rclone config.  In this example the crypt remote is called secret,
       to differentiate it from the underlying remote.

       When you are done you can use the crypt remote named secret just as  you  would  with  any
       other  remote,  e.g. rclone copy D:\docs secret:\docs, and rclone will encrypt and decrypt
       as needed on the fly.  If you access the wrapped  remote  remote:path  directly  you  will
       bypass  the  encryption, and anything you read will be in encrypted form, and anything you
       write will be unencrypted.  To avoid issues it is best to configure a dedicated  path  for
       encrypted content, and access it exclusively through a crypt remote.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> secret
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Encrypt/Decrypt a remote
                 \ "crypt"
              [snip]
              Storage> crypt
              ** See help for crypt backend at: https://rclone.org/crypt/ **

              Remote to encrypt/decrypt.
              Normally should contain a ':' and a path, eg "myremote:path/to/dir",
              "myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              remote> remote:path
              How to encrypt the filenames.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("standard").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
                 / Encrypt the filenames.
               1 | See the docs for the details.
                 \ "standard"
               2 / Very simple filename obfuscation.
                 \ "obfuscate"
                 / Don't encrypt the file names.
               3 | Adds a ".bin" extension only.
                 \ "off"
              filename_encryption>
              Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

              NB If filename_encryption is "off" then this option will do nothing.
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Encrypt directory names.
                 \ "true"
               2 / Don't encrypt directory names, leave them intact.
                 \ "false"
              directory_name_encryption>
              Password or pass phrase for encryption.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Password or pass phrase for salt. Optional but recommended.
              Should be different to the previous password.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g/n> g
              Password strength in bits.
              64 is just about memorable
              128 is secure
              1024 is the maximum
              Bits> 128
              Your password is: JAsJvRcgR-_veXNfy_sGmQ
              Use this password? Please note that an obscured version of this
              password (and not the password itself) will be stored under your
              configuration file, so keep this generated password in a safe place.
              y) Yes (default)
              n) No
              y/n>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [secret]
              type = crypt
              remote = remote:path
              password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              password2 = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

       Important  The  crypt  password  stored  in  rclone.conf  is  lightly obscured.  That only
       protects it from cursory inspection.  It is not  secure  unless  configuration  encryption
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption) of rclone.conf is specified.

       A long passphrase is recommended, or rclone config can generate a random one.

       The  obscured  password  is  created  using AES-CTR with a static key.  The salt is stored
       verbatim at the beginning of the obscured password.  This static key is shared between all
       versions of rclone.

       If  you  reconfigure  rclone  with  the  same  passwords/passphrases  elsewhere it will be
       compatible, but the obscured version will be different due to the different salt.

       Rclone does not encrypt

       • file length - this can be calculated within 16 bytes

       • modification time - used for syncing

   Specifying the remote
       When configuring the remote to encrypt/decrypt, you may specify  any  string  that  rclone
       accepts as a source/destination of other commands.

       The  primary  use  case  is  to  specify  the  path  into  an  already  configured  remote
       (e.g. remote:path/to/dir or remote:bucket), such that data in a remote untrusted  location
       can be stored encrypted.

       You   may   also  specify  a  local  filesystem  path,  such  as  /path/to/dir  on  Linux,
       C:\path\to\dir on Windows.  By creating a crypt remote pointing to such a local filesystem
       path,  you can use rclone as a utility for pure local file encryption, for example to keep
       encrypted files on a removable USB drive.

       Note: A string which do not contain a : will by rclone be treated as a  relative  path  in
       the  local  filesystem.  For example, if you enter the name remote without the trailing :,
       it will be treated as a subdirectory of the current directory with name “remote”.

       If a path remote:path/to/dir is specified, rclone stores encrypted files in path/to/dir on
       the remote.  With file name encryption, files saved to secret:subdir/subfile are stored in
       the unencrypted path path/to/dir but the subdir/subpath element is encrypted.

       The path you specify does not have to exist, rclone will create it when needed.

       If you intend to use the wrapped remote both directly for keeping unencrypted content,  as
       well as through a crypt remote for encrypted content, it is recommended to point the crypt
       remote to a separate directory within the wrapped  remote.   If  you  use  a  bucket-based
       storage  system  (e.g. Swift, S3, Google Compute Storage, B2) it is generally advisable to
       wrap the crypt remote around a specific bucket (s3:bucket).  If wrapping around the entire
       root  of the storage (s3:), and use the optional file name encryption, rclone will encrypt
       the bucket name.

   Changing password
       Should the password, or the configuration file containing a lightly obscured form  of  the
       password,  be  compromised,  you  need to re-encrypt your data with a new password.  Since
       rclone uses secret-key encryption, where the encryption key is generated directly from the
       password  kept  on  the  client,  it is not possible to change the password/key of already
       encrypted content.  Just changing the password configured for  an  existing  crypt  remote
       means  you  will  no  longer able to decrypt any of the previously encrypted content.  The
       only possibility is to re-upload everything via a crypt remote configured  with  your  new
       password.

       Depending on the size of your data, your bandwidth, storage quota etc, there are different
       approaches you can take: - If you have everything in a different location, for example  on
       your  local system, you could remove all of the prior encrypted files, change the password
       for your configured crypt remote (or delete and re-create the  crypt  configuration),  and
       then  re-upload  everything  from the alternative location.  - If you have enough space on
       the storage system you can create a new crypt remote pointing to a separate  directory  on
       the same backend, and then use rclone to copy everything from the original crypt remote to
       the new, effectively decrypting everything on the fly  using  the  old  password  and  re-
       encrypting  using the new password.  When done, delete the original crypt remote directory
       and finally the rclone crypt configuration with  the  old  password.   All  data  will  be
       streamed  from  the  storage  system  and  back, so you will get half the bandwidth and be
       charged twice if you have upload and download quota on the storage system.

       Note: A security problem related to the random password  generator  was  fixed  in  rclone
       version  1.53.3  (released  2020-11-19).   Passwords generated by rclone config in version
       1.49.0 (released 2019-08-26) to 1.53.2 (released 2020-10-26) are not considered secure and
       should  be  changed.   If you made up your own password, or used rclone version older than
       1.49.0 or newer than 1.53.2 to generate it, you are not affected by this issue.  See issue
       #4783  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4783) for more details, and a tool you can
       use to check if you are affected.

   Example
       Create the following file structure using “standard” file name encryption.

              plaintext/
              ├── file0.txt
              ├── file1.txt
              └── subdir
                  ├── file2.txt
                  ├── file3.txt
                  └── subsubdir
                      └── file4.txt

       Copy these to the remote, and list them

              $ rclone -q copy plaintext secret:
              $ rclone -q ls secret:
                      7 file1.txt
                      6 file0.txt
                      8 subdir/file2.txt
                     10 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt
                      9 subdir/file3.txt

       The crypt remote looks like

              $ rclone -q ls remote:path
                     55 hagjclgavj2mbiqm6u6cnjjqcg
                     54 v05749mltvv1tf4onltun46gls
                     57 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/dlj7fkq4kdq72emafg7a7s41uo
                     58 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/7uu829995du6o42n32otfhjqp4/b9pausrfansjth5ob3jkdqd4lc
                     56 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/8njh1sk437gttmep3p70g81aps

       The directory structure is preserved

              $ rclone -q ls secret:subdir
                      8 file2.txt
                      9 file3.txt
                     10 subsubdir/file4.txt

       Without file name encryption .bin extensions are added to underlying names.  This prevents
       the cloud provider attempting to interpret file content.

              $ rclone -q ls remote:path
                     54 file0.txt.bin
                     57 subdir/file3.txt.bin
                     56 subdir/file2.txt.bin
                     58 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt.bin
                     55 file1.txt.bin

   File name encryption modes
       Off

       • doesn’t hide file names or directory structure

       • allows for longer file names (~246 characters)

       • can use sub paths and copy single files

       Standard

       • file names encrypted

       • file names can’t be as long (~143 characters)

       • can use sub paths and copy single files

       • directory structure visible

       • identical files names will have identical uploaded names

       • can use shortcuts to shorten the directory recursion

       Obfuscation

       This  is  a simple “rotate” of the filename, with each file having a rot distance based on
       the filename.  Rclone stores the distance at the beginning of the filename.  A file called
       “hello” may become “53.jgnnq”.

       Obfuscation  is not a strong encryption of filenames, but hinders automated scanning tools
       picking up on filename patterns.  It is an intermediate between “off” and “standard” which
       allows for longer path segment names.

       There  is a possibility with some unicode based filenames that the obfuscation is weak and
       may map lower case characters to upper case equivalents.

       Obfuscation cannot be relied upon for strong protection.

       • file names very lightly obfuscated

       • file names can be longer than standard encryption

       • can use sub paths and copy single files

       • directory structure visible

       • identical files names will have identical uploaded names

       Cloud storage systems have limits on file name length and total path length  which  rclone
       is more likely to breach using “Standard” file name encryption.  Where file names are less
       than 156 characters in length issues should not  be  encountered,  irrespective  of  cloud
       storage provider.

       An  experimental advanced option filename_encoding is now provided to address this problem
       to  a  certain  degree.   For  cloud  storage  systems  with  case  sensitive  file  names
       (e.g. Google  Drive),  base64  can  be used to reduce file name length.  For cloud storage
       systems using UTF-16 to store file names internally (e.g. OneDrive), base32768 can be used
       to drastically reduce file name length.

       An alternative, future rclone file name encryption mode may tolerate backend provider path
       length limits.

   Directory name encryption
       Crypt offers the option of encrypting dir names or leaving them  intact.   There  are  two
       options:

       True

       Encrypts  the whole file path including directory names Example: 1/12/123.txt is encrypted
       to p0e52nreeaj0a5ea7s64m4j72s/l42g6771hnv3an9cgc8cr2n1ng/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

       False

       Only encrypts file names, skips directory names  Example:  1/12/123.txt  is  encrypted  to
       1/12/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

   Modified time and hashes
       Crypt stores modification times using the underlying remote so support depends on that.

       Hashes  are not stored for crypt.  However the data integrity is protected by an extremely
       strong crypto authenticator.

       Use the rclone cryptcheck command to check the integrity of a crypted  remote  instead  of
       rclone check which can’t check the checksums properly.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

   –crypt-remote
       Remote to encrypt/decrypt.

       Normally  should  contain a `:' and a path, e.g. “myremote:path/to/dir”, “myremote:bucket”
       or maybe “myremote:” (not recommended).

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –crypt-filename-encryption
       How to encrypt the filenames.

       Properties:

       • Config: filename_encryption

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_FILENAME_ENCRYPTION

       • Type: string

       • Default: “standard”

       • Examples:

         • “standard”

           • Encrypt the filenames.

           • See the docs for the details.

         • “obfuscate”

           • Very simple filename obfuscation.

         • “off”

           • Don’t encrypt the file names.

           • Adds a “.bin” extension only.

   –crypt-directory-name-encryption
       Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

       NB If filename_encryption is “off” then this option will do nothing.

       Properties:

       • Config: directory_name_encryption

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_DIRECTORY_NAME_ENCRYPTION

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Encrypt directory names.

         • “false”

           • Don’t encrypt directory names, leave them intact.

   –crypt-password
       Password or pass phrase for encryption.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –crypt-password2
       Password or pass phrase for salt.

       Optional but recommended.  Should be different to the previous password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password2

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD2

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

   –crypt-server-side-across-configs
       Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different crypt configs.

       Normally this option is not what you want, but if you have two crypts pointing to the same
       backend you can use it.

       This  can  be  used, for example, to change file name encryption type without re-uploading
       all the data.  Just make two crypt backends pointing to two different directories with the
       single changed parameter and use rclone move to move the files between the crypt remotes.

       Properties:

       • Config: server_side_across_configs

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –crypt-show-mapping
       For all files listed show how the names encrypt.

       If  this  flag is set then for each file that the remote is asked to list, it will log (at
       level INFO) a line stating the decrypted file name and the encrypted file name.

       This is so you can work out which encrypted names are which decrypted names just  in  case
       you need to do something with the encrypted file names, or for debugging purposes.

       Properties:

       • Config: show_mapping

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SHOW_MAPPING

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –crypt-no-data-encryption
       Option to either encrypt file data or leave it unencrypted.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_data_encryption

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_NO_DATA_ENCRYPTION

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Don’t encrypt file data, leave it unencrypted.

         • “false”

           • Encrypt file data.

   –crypt-filename-encoding
       How to encode the encrypted filename to text string.

       This  option could help with shortening the encrypted filename.  The suitable option would
       depend on the way your remote count the filename length and if it’s case sensitive.

       Properties:

       • Config: filename_encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_FILENAME_ENCODING

       • Type: string

       • Default: “base32”

       • Examples:

         • “base32”

           • Encode using base32.  Suitable for all remote.

         • “base64”

           • Encode using base64.  Suitable for case sensitive remote.

         • “base32768”

           • Encode using base32768.  Suitable if your remote counts UTF-16 or

           • Unicode codepoint instead of UTF-8 byte length.  (Eg.  Onedrive)

   Metadata
       Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the crypt backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These   can   be   run   on  a  running  backend  using  the  rc  command  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   encode
       Encode the given filename(s)

              rclone backend encode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This encodes the filenames given as arguments returning a list of strings of  the  encoded
       results.

       Usage Example:

              rclone backend encode crypt: file1 [file2...]
              rclone rc backend/command command=encode fs=crypt: file1 [file2...]

   decode
       Decode the given filename(s)

              rclone backend decode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This  decodes  the filenames given as arguments returning a list of strings of the decoded
       results.  It will return an error if any of the inputs are invalid.

       Usage Example:

              rclone backend decode crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]
              rclone rc backend/command command=decode fs=crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]

   Backing up a crypted remote
       If you wish to backup a crypted remote, it is recommended that you use rclone sync on  the
       encrypted files, and make sure the passwords are the same in the new encrypted remote.

       This will have the following advantages

       • rclone sync will check the checksums while copying

       • you can use rclone check between the encrypted remotes

       • you don’t decrypt and encrypt unnecessarily

       For example, let’s say you have your original remote at remote: with the encrypted version
       at eremote: with path remote:crypt.  You would then set up the  new  remote  remote2:  and
       then  the  encrypted version eremote2: with path remote2:crypt using the same passwords as
       eremote:.

       To sync the two remotes you would do

              rclone sync -i remote:crypt remote2:crypt

       And to check the integrity you would do

              rclone check remote:crypt remote2:crypt

   File formats
   File encryption
       Files are encrypted 1:1 source file to destination object.  The file has a header  and  is
       divided into chunks.

   Header
       • 8 bytes magic string RCLONE\x00\x00

       • 24 bytes Nonce (IV)

       The  initial  nonce  is  generated  from the operating systems crypto strong random number
       generator.  The nonce is incremented for each chunk read making sure each nonce is  unique
       for  each  block written.  The chance of a nonce being re-used is minuscule.  If you wrote
       an exabyte of data (10¹⁸ bytes) you would have a probability of approximately  2×10⁻³²  of
       re-using a nonce.

   Chunk
       Each  chunk will contain 64 KiB of data, except for the last one which may have less data.
       The data chunk is in standard NaCl SecretBox format.  SecretBox uses XSalsa20 and Poly1305
       to encrypt and authenticate messages.

       Each chunk contains:

       • 16 Bytes of Poly1305 authenticator

       • 1 - 65536 bytes XSalsa20 encrypted data

       64k  chunk  size was chosen as the best performing chunk size (the authenticator takes too
       much time below this and the performance drops off due to cache effects above this).  Note
       that these chunks are buffered in memory so they can’t be too big.

       This uses a 32 byte (256 bit key) key derived from the user password.

   Examples
       1 byte file will encrypt to

       • 32 bytes header

       • 17 bytes data chunk

       49 bytes total

       1 MiB (1048576 bytes) file will encrypt to

       • 32 bytes header

       • 16 chunks of 65568 bytes

       1049120 bytes total (a 0.05% overhead).  This is the overhead for big files.

   Name encryption
       File  names  are  encrypted  segment  by  segment - the path is broken up into / separated
       strings and these are encrypted individually.

       File segments are padded using PKCS#7 to a multiple of 16 bytes before encryption.

       They are then encrypted with EME using AES with 256 bit key.  EME (ECB-Mix-ECB) is a wide-
       block  encryption  mode presented in the 2003 paper “A Parallelizable Enciphering Mode” by
       Halevi and Rogaway.

       This makes for deterministic encryption which is what we want -  the  same  filename  must
       encrypt to the same thing otherwise we can’t find it on the cloud storage system.

       This means that

       • filenames with the same name will encrypt the same

       • filenames which start the same won’t have a common prefix

       This  uses  a 32 byte key (256 bits) and a 16 byte (128 bits) IV both of which are derived
       from the user password.

       After encryption they are written out using a modified version of standard base32 encoding
       as described in RFC4648.  The standard encoding is modified in two ways:

       • it becomes lower case (no-one likes upper case filenames!)

       • we strip the padding character =

       base32  is  used  rather  than  the  more  efficient  base64 so rclone can be used on case
       insensitive remotes (e.g. Windows, Amazon Drive).

   Key derivation
       Rclone uses scrypt with parameters N=16384, r=8, p=1 with an optional user  supplied  salt
       (password2)  to  derive  the  32+32+16  =  80 bytes of key material required.  If the user
       doesn’t supply a salt then rclone uses an internal one.

       scrypt makes it impractical to mount a dictionary attack on rclone  encrypted  data.   For
       full protection against this you should always use a salt.

   SEE ALSO
       • rclone     cryptdecode    (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cryptdecode/)    -    Show
         forward/reverse mapping of encrypted filenames

Compress (Experimental)

   Warning
       This remote is currently experimental.  Things may break and data may be  lost.   Anything
       you  do with this remote is at your own risk.  Please understand the risks associated with
       using experimental code and don’t use this remote in critical applications.

       The Compress remote adds compression to another remote.  It  is  best  used  with  remotes
       containing many large compressible files.

   Configuration
       To use this remote, all you need to do is specify another remote and a compression mode to
       use:

              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              remote_to_press      sometype

              e) Edit existing remote
              $ rclone config
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
              name> compress
              ...
               8 / Compress a remote
                 \ "compress"
              ...
              Storage> compress
              ** See help for compress backend at: https://rclone.org/compress/ **

              Remote to compress.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              remote> remote_to_press:subdir
              Compression mode.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("gzip").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Gzip compression balanced for speed and compression strength.
                 \ "gzip"
              compression_mode> gzip
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [compress]
              type = compress
              remote = remote_to_press:subdir
              compression_mode = gzip
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Compression Modes
       Currently only gzip compression is supported.  It provides a decent balance between  speed
       and size and is well supported by other applications.  Compression strength can further be
       configured via an  advanced  setting  where  0  is  no  compression  and  9  is  strongest
       compression.

   File types
       If  you  open a remote wrapped by compress, you will see that there are many files with an
       extension corresponding to the compression algorithm you chose.  These files are  standard
       files  that  can be opened by various archive programs, but they have some hidden metadata
       that allows them to be used by rclone.  While you may download and decompress these  files
       at  will,  do  not  manually delete or rename files.  Files without correct metadata files
       will not be recognized by rclone.

   File names
       The compressed files will be named *.###########.gz where * is the base  file  and  the  #
       part  is  base64  encoded  size  of  the  uncompressed file.  The file names should not be
       changed by anything other than the rclone compression backend.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

   –compress-remote
       Remote to compress.

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –compress-mode
       Compression mode.

       Properties:

       • Config: mode

       • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_MODE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “gzip”

       • Examples:

         • “gzip”

           • Standard gzip compression with fastest parameters.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

   –compress-level
       GZIP compression level (-2 to 9).

       Generally -1  (default,  equivalent  to  5)  is  recommended.   Levels  1  to  9  increase
       compression at the cost of speed.  Going past 6 generally offers very little return.

       Level  -2  uses  Huffman encoding only.  Only use if you know what you are doing.  Level 0
       turns off compression.

       Properties:

       • Config: level

       • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_LEVEL

       • Type: int

       • Default: -1

   –compress-ram-cache-limit
       Some remotes don’t allow the upload  of  files  with  unknown  size.   In  this  case  the
       compressed file will need to be cached to determine it’s size.

       Files  smaller than this limit will be cached in RAM, files larger than this limit will be
       cached on disk.

       Properties:

       • Config: ram_cache_limit

       • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_RAM_CACHE_LIMIT

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 20Mi

   Metadata
       Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Combine

       The combine backend joins remotes together into a single directory tree.

       For example you might have a remote for images on one provider:

              $ rclone tree s3:imagesbucket
              /
              ├── image1.jpg
              └── image2.jpg

       And a remote for files on another:

              $ rclone tree drive:important/files
              /
              ├── file1.txt
              └── file2.txt

       The combine backend can join these together into  a  synthetic  directory  structure  like
       this:

              $ rclone tree combined:
              /
              ├── files
              │   ├── file1.txt
              │   └── file2.txt
              └── images
                  ├── image1.jpg
                  └── image2.jpg

       You’d do this by specifying an upstreams parameter in the config like this

              upstreams = images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files

       During  the  initial  setup with rclone config you will specify the upstreams remotes as a
       space separated list.  The upstream remotes can either be a local paths or other remotes.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a combine called remote for the  example  above.   First
       run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              ...
              XX / Combine several remotes into one
                 \ (combine)
              ...
              Storage> combine
              Option upstreams.
              Upstreams for combining
              These should be in the form
                  dir=remote:path dir2=remote2:path
              Where before the = is specified the root directory and after is the remote to
              put there.
              Embedded spaces can be added using quotes
                  "dir=remote:path with space" "dir2=remote2:path with space"
              Enter a fs.SpaceSepList value.
              upstreams> images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = combine
              upstreams = images=s3:imagesbucket files=drive:important/files
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Configuring for Google Drive Shared Drives
       Rclone  has  a  convenience feature for making a combine backend for all the shared drives
       you have access to.

       Assuming your main (non shared drive) Google drive remote is called drive: you would run

              rclone backend -o config drives drive:

       This would produce something like this:

              [My Drive]
              type = alias
              remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEF-01234567890,root_folder_id=:

              [Test Drive]
              type = alias
              remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl,root_folder_id=:

              [AllDrives]
              type = combine
              upstreams = "My Drive=My Drive:" "Test Drive=Test Drive:"

       If you then add that config to your config file (find it with rclone config file) then you
       can access all the shared drives in one place with the AllDrives: remote.

       See the Google Drive docs (https://rclone.org/drive/#drives) for full info.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to combine (Combine several remotes into one).

   –combine-upstreams
       Upstreams for combining

       These should be in the form

              dir=remote:path dir2=remote2:path

       Where before the = is specified the root directory and after is the remote to put there.

       Embedded spaces can be added using quotes

              "dir=remote:path with space" "dir2=remote2:path with space"

       Properties:

       • Config: upstreams

       • Env Var: RCLONE_COMBINE_UPSTREAMS

       • Type: SpaceSepList

       • Default:

   Metadata
       Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Dropbox

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Dropbox paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The  initial  setup for dropbox involves getting a token from Dropbox which you need to do
       in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Dropbox
                 \ "dropbox"
              [snip]
              Storage> dropbox
              Dropbox App Key - leave blank normally.
              app_key>
              Dropbox App Secret - leave blank normally.
              app_secret>
              Remote config
              Please visit:
              https://www.dropbox.com/1/oauth2/authorize?client_id=XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX&response_type=code
              Enter the code: XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXXXXXXXX
              --------------------
              [remote]
              app_key =
              app_secret =
              token = XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXX_XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       You can then use it like this,

       List directories in top level of your dropbox

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your dropbox

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a dropbox directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Dropbox for business
       Rclone supports Dropbox for business and Team Folders.

       When using Dropbox for  business  remote:  and  remote:path/to/file  will  refer  to  your
       personal folder.

       If  you  wish  to  see  Team  Folders  you must use a leading / in the path, so rclone lsd
       remote:/ will refer to the root and show you all Team Folders and your User Folder.

       You    can    then    use    team    folders    like    this    remote:/TeamFolder     and
       remote:/TeamFolder/path/to/file.

       A leading / for a Dropbox personal account will do nothing, but it will take an extra HTTP
       transaction so it should be avoided.

   Modified time and Hashes
       Dropbox supports modified times, but the only way to set a modification  time  is  to  re-
       upload the file.

       This  means  that  if  you uploaded your data with an older version of rclone which didn’t
       support the v2 API and modified times, rclone will decide to upload all your old  data  to
       fix  the  modification  times.   If  you  don’t  want  this  to  happen use --size-only or
       --checksum flag to stop it.

       Dropbox supports its own hash type  (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/reference/content-
       hash) which is checked for all transfers.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /
       DEL         0x7F         ␡
       \           0x5C        \

       File  names  can  also  not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if
       they are the last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Batch mode uploads
       Using  batch  mode  uploads  is very important for performance when using the Dropbox API.
       See the dropbox performance  guide  (https://developers.dropbox.com/dbx-performance-guide)
       for more info.

       There are 3 modes rclone can use for uploads.

   –dropbox-batch-mode off
       In  this  mode  rclone  will  not use upload batching.  This was the default before rclone
       v1.55.  It has the disadvantage that it is  very  likely  to  encounter  too_many_requests
       errors like this

              NOTICE: too_many_requests/.: Too many requests or write operations. Trying again in 15 seconds.

       When  rclone  receives  these  it  has to wait for 15s or sometimes 300s before continuing
       which really slows down transfers.

       This will happen especially if --transfers is large, so this mode isn’t recommended except
       for compatibility or investigating problems.

   –dropbox-batch-mode sync
       In  this  mode  rclone will batch up uploads to the size specified by --dropbox-batch-size
       and commit them together.

       Using this mode means you can use a much higher --transfers  parameter  (32  or  64  works
       fine) without receiving too_many_requests errors.

       This mode ensures full data integrity.

       Note  that  there  may  be  a pause when quitting rclone while rclone finishes up the last
       batch using this mode.

   –dropbox-batch-mode async
       In this mode rclone will batch up uploads to the size  specified  by  --dropbox-batch-size
       and commit them together.

       However  it  will not wait for the status of the batch to be returned to the caller.  This
       means rclone can use a much bigger batch size (much bigger than --transfers), at the  cost
       of not being able to check the status of the upload.

       This  provides  the  maximum  possible  upload  speed especially with lots of small files,
       however rclone can’t check the file got uploaded properly using this mode.

       If you are using this mode then using “rclone  check”  after  the  transfer  completes  is
       recommended.   Or you could do an initial transfer with --dropbox-batch-mode async then do
       a final transfer with --dropbox-batch-mode sync (the default).

       Note that there may be a pause when quitting rclone while  rclone  finishes  up  the  last
       batch using this mode.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

   –dropbox-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –dropbox-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

   –dropbox-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –dropbox-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –dropbox-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –dropbox-chunk-size
       Upload chunk size (< 150Mi).

       Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of this size.

       Note  that  chunks are buffered in memory (one at a time) so rclone can deal with retries.
       Setting this larger will increase the speed slightly (at most 10% for 128 MiB in tests) at
       the cost of using more memory.  It can be set smaller if you are tight on memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 48Mi

   –dropbox-impersonate
       Impersonate this user when using a business account.

       Note  that  if  you  want  to  use impersonate, you should make sure this flag is set when
       running “rclone config” as this will cause rclone  to  request  the  “members.read”  scope
       which  it  won’t  normally.   This  is  needed  to lookup a members email address into the
       internal ID that dropbox uses in the API.

       Using the “members.read” scope will require a Dropbox Team Admin  to  approve  during  the
       OAuth flow.

       You  will  have  to use your own App (setting your own client_id and client_secret) to use
       this  option  as  currently  rclone’s  default  set   of   permissions   doesn’t   include
       “members.read”.  This can be added once v1.55 or later is in use everywhere.

       Properties:

       • Config: impersonate

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_IMPERSONATE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –dropbox-shared-files
       Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files.

       In  this  mode  rclone’s  features  are  extremely  limited  -  only  list (ls, lsl, etc.)
       operations and read operations (e.g. downloading) are supported in this mode.   All  other
       operations will be disabled.

       Properties:

       • Config: shared_files

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FILES

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –dropbox-shared-folders
       Instructs rclone to work on shared folders.

       When this flag is used with no path only the List operation is supported and all available
       shared folders will be listed.  If you specify a path the first part will  be  interpreted
       as  the  name  of  shared  folder.   Rclone will then try to mount this shared to the root
       namespace.  On success shared folder rclone proceeds normally.  The shared folder  is  now
       pretty much a normal folder and all normal operations are supported.

       Note that we don’t unmount the shared folder afterwards so the –dropbox-shared-folders can
       be omitted after the first use of a particular shared folder.

       Properties:

       • Config: shared_folders

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FOLDERS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –dropbox-batch-mode
       Upload file batching sync|async|off.

       This sets the batch mode used by rclone.

       For full info see the main docs (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#batch-mode)

       This has 3 possible values

       • off - no batching

       • sync - batch uploads and check completion (default)

       • async - batch upload and don’t check completion

       Rclone will close any outstanding batches when it exits which may make a delay on quit.

       Properties:

       • Config: batch_mode

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_MODE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “sync”

   –dropbox-batch-size
       Max number of files in upload batch.

       This sets the batch size of files to upload.  It has to be less than 1000.

       By default this is 0 which means rclone which calculate the batch size  depending  on  the
       setting of batch_mode.

       • batch_mode: async - default batch_size is 100

       • batch_mode: sync - default batch_size is the same as –transfers

       • batch_mode: off - not in use

       Rclone will close any outstanding batches when it exits which may make a delay on quit.

       Setting this is a great idea if you are uploading lots of small files as it will make them
       a lot quicker.  You can use –transfers 32 to maximise throughput.

       Properties:

       • Config: batch_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_SIZE

       • Type: int

       • Default: 0

   –dropbox-batch-timeout
       Max time to allow an idle upload batch before uploading.

       If an upload batch is idle for more than this long then it will be uploaded.

       The default for this is 0 which means rclone will choose a sensible default based  on  the
       batch_mode in use.

       • batch_mode: async - default batch_timeout is 500ms

       • batch_mode: sync - default batch_timeout is 10s

       • batch_mode: off - not in use

       Properties:

       • Config: batch_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 0s

   –dropbox-batch-commit-timeout
       Max time to wait for a batch to finish committing

       Properties:

       • Config: batch_commit_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_BATCH_COMMIT_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 10m0s

   –dropbox-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note that Dropbox is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and  one
       called “hello.doc”.

       There  are  some  file names such as thumbs.db which Dropbox can’t store.  There is a full
       list    of    them    in    the    “Ignored    Files”    section    of    this    document
       (https://www.dropbox.com/en/help/145).   Rclone  will  issue  an  error  message File name
       disallowed - not uploading if it attempts to upload one of those file names, but the  sync
       won’t fail.

       Some errors may occur if you try to sync copyright-protected files because Dropbox has its
       own  copyright  detector  (https://techcrunch.com/2014/03/30/how-dropbox-knows-when-youre-
       sharing-copyrighted-stuff-without-actually-looking-at-your-stuff/) that prevents this sort
       of file being downloaded.  This will return the error ERROR :  /path/to/your/file:  Failed
       to copy: failed to open source object: path/restricted_content/.

       If  you  have  more  than  10,000  files in a directory then rclone purge dropbox:dir will
       return the error Failed to purge: There are too many files involved in this operation.  As
       a work-around do an rclone delete dropbox:dir followed by an rclone rmdir dropbox:dir.

       When  using  rclone  link  you’ll  need  to  set  --expire if using a non-personal account
       otherwise the visibility may not be correct.   (Note  that  --expire  isn’t  supported  on
       personal  accounts).   See  the  forum discussion (https://forum.rclone.org/t/rclone-link-
       dropbox-permissions/23211) and the dropbox SDK issue  (https://github.com/dropbox/dropbox-
       sdk-go-unofficial/issues/75).

   Get your own Dropbox App ID
       When  you  use rclone with Dropbox in its default configuration you are using rclone’s App
       ID.  This is shared between all the rclone users.

       Here is how to create your own Dropbox App ID for rclone:

       1. Log into the Dropbox App console (https://www.dropbox.com/developers/apps/create)  with
          your  Dropbox  Account  (It  need not to be the same account as the Dropbox you want to
          access)

       2. Choose an API => Usually this should be Dropbox API

       3. Choose the type of access you want to use => Full Dropbox or App Folder

       4. Name your App.  The app name is global, so you can’t use rclone for example

       5. Click the button Create App

       6. Switch  to  the  Permissions  tab.   Enable  at  least   the   following   permissions:
          account_info.read,   files.metadata.write,   files.content.write,   files.content.read,
          sharing.write.  The files.metadata.read and sharing.read checkboxes will be marked too.
          Click Submit

       7. Switch to the Settings tab.  Fill OAuth2 - Redirect URIs as http://localhost:53682/

       8. Find the App key and App secret values on the Settings tab.  Use these values in rclone
          config to add a new remote or edit an existing remote.  The App key setting corresponds
          to client_id in rclone config, the App secret corresponds to client_secret

Enterprise File Fabric

       This     backend    supports    Storage    Made    Easy’s    Enterprise    File    Fabric™
       (https://storagemadeeasy.com/about/) which provides a software solution to  integrate  and
       unify File and Object Storage accessible through a global file system.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for the Enterprise File Fabric backend involves getting a token from the
       Enterprise File Fabric which you need to do in your  browser.   rclone  config  walks  you
       through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Enterprise File Fabric
                 \ "filefabric"
              [snip]
              Storage> filefabric
              ** See help for filefabric backend at: https://rclone.org/filefabric/ **

              URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Storage Made Easy US
                 \ "https://storagemadeeasy.com"
               2 / Storage Made Easy EU
                 \ "https://eu.storagemadeeasy.com"
               3 / Connect to your Enterprise File Fabric
                 \ "https://yourfabric.smestorage.com"
              url> https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
              ID of the root folder
              Leave blank normally.

              Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              root_folder_id>
              Permanent Authentication Token

              A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the Enterprise File
              Fabric, on the users Dashboard under Security, there is an entry
              you'll see called "My Authentication Tokens". Click the Manage button
              to create one.

              These tokens are normally valid for several years.

              For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              permanent_token> xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = filefabric
              url = https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
              permanent_token = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Enterprise File Fabric

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Enterprise File Fabric

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Enterprise File Fabric directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       The  Enterprise  File  Fabric  allows  modification times to be set on files accurate to 1
       second.  These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

       The Enterprise File Fabric does not support any data hashes at this time.

   Restricted filename characters
       The default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)
       will be replaced.

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Empty files
       Empty files aren’t supported by the Enterprise File Fabric.  Rclone will therefore  upload
       an  empty file as a single space with a mime type of application/vnd.rclone.empty.file and
       files with that mime type are treated as empty.

   Root folder ID
       You can set the root_folder_id for rclone.  This  is  the  directory  (identified  by  its
       Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your Enterprise File Fabric.

       Normally  you  will  leave  this  blank  and rclone will determine the correct root to use
       itself.

       However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

       In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you  wish  rclone
       to  display.   These  aren’t displayed in the web interface, but you can use rclone lsf to
       find them, for example

              $ rclone lsf --dirs-only -Fip --csv filefabric:
              120673758,Burnt PDFs/
              120673759,My Quick Uploads/
              120673755,My Syncs/
              120673756,My backups/
              120673757,My contacts/
              120673761,S3 Storage/

       The ID for “S3 Storage” would be 120673761.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

   –filefabric-url
       URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

       • Examples:

         • “https://storagemadeeasy.com”

           • Storage Made Easy US

         • “https://eu.storagemadeeasy.com”

           • Storage Made Easy EU

         • “https://yourfabric.smestorage.com”

           • Connect to your Enterprise File Fabric

   –filefabric-root-folder-id
       ID of the root folder.

       Leave blank normally.

       Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –filefabric-permanent-token
       Permanent Authentication Token.

       A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the  Enterprise  File  Fabric,  on  the
       users  Dashboard  under  Security,  there is an entry you’ll see called “My Authentication
       Tokens”.  Click the Manage button to create one.

       These tokens are normally valid for several years.

       For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

       Properties:

       • Config: permanent_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_PERMANENT_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

   –filefabric-token
       Session Token.

       This is a session token which rclone caches in the config file.  It is usually valid for 1
       hour.

       Don’t set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –filefabric-token-expiry
       Token expiry time.

       Don’t set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_expiry

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN_EXPIRY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –filefabric-version
       Version read from the file fabric.

       Don’t set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

       Properties:

       • Config: version

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_VERSION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –filefabric-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

FTP

       FTP  is  the  File  Transfer  Protocol.   Rclone  FTP  support  is  provided   using   the
       github.com/jlaffaye/ftp (https://godoc.org/github.com/jlaffaye/ftp) package.

       Limitations of Rclone’s FTP backend

       Paths are specified as remote:path.  If the path does not begin with a / it is relative to
       the home directory of the  user.   An  empty  path  remote:  refers  to  the  user’s  home
       directory.

   Configuration
       To create an FTP configuration named remote, run

              rclone config

       Rclone  config  guides  you  through  an  interactive setup process.  A minimal rclone FTP
       remote definition only requires host, username and password.  For an anonymous FTP server,
       see below.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/r/c/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / FTP
                 \ "ftp"
              [snip]
              Storage> ftp
              ** See help for ftp backend at: https://rclone.org/ftp/ **

              FTP host to connect to
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to ftp.example.com
                 \ "ftp.example.com"
              host> ftp.example.com
              FTP username
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("$USER").
              user>
              FTP port number
              Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (21).
              port>
              FTP password
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Use FTP over TLS (Implicit)
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              tls>
              Use FTP over TLS (Explicit)
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              explicit_tls>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = ftp
              host = ftp.example.com
              pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       To see all directories in the home directory of remote

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new directory

              rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

       Sync  /home/local/directory  to  the  remote  directory,  deleting any excess files in the
       directory.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

   Anonymous FTP
       When connecting to a FTP server that allows anonymous  login,  you  can  use  the  special
       “anonymous”  username.  Traditionally, this user account accepts any string as a password,
       although it is common to use either the password “anonymous”  or  “guest”.   Some  servers
       require the use of a valid e-mail address as password.

       Using   on-the-fly   or  connection  string  (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings)
       remotes makes it easy to access such  servers,  without  requiring  any  configuration  in
       advance.  The following are examples of that:

              rclone lsf :ftp: --ftp-host=speedtest.tele2.net --ftp-user=anonymous --ftp-pass=$(rclone obscure dummy)
              rclone lsf :ftp,host=speedtest.tele2.net,user=anonymous,pass=$(rclone obscure dummy):

       The above examples work in Linux shells and in PowerShell, but not Windows Command Prompt.
       They execute the rclone obscure (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/)  command  to
       create  a  password  string  in  the  format  required  by the pass option.  The following
       examples are exactly the same, except use an already obscured string representation of the
       same password “dummy”, and therefore works even in Windows Command Prompt:

              rclone lsf :ftp: --ftp-host=speedtest.tele2.net --ftp-user=anonymous --ftp-pass=IXs2wc8OJOz7SYLBk47Ji1rHTmxM
              rclone lsf :ftp,host=speedtest.tele2.net,user=anonymous,pass=IXs2wc8OJOz7SYLBk47Ji1rHTmxM:

   Implicit TLS
       Rlone  FTP  supports  implicit FTP over TLS servers (FTPS).  This has to be enabled in the
       FTP backend config for the remote, or with --ftp-tls.  The default FTPS port is  990,  not
       21 and can be set with --ftp-port.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       File  names  cannot end with the following characters.  Replacement is limited to the last
       character in a file name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠

       Not all FTP servers can have all characters in file names, for example:

       FTP Server   Forbidden characters
       ──────────────────────────────────
       proftpd               *
       pureftpd            \ [ ]

       This backend’s interactive configuration wizard provides a selection of sensible  encoding
       settings  for  major  FTP servers: ProFTPd, PureFTPd, VsFTPd.  Just hit a selection number
       when prompted.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to ftp (FTP).

   –ftp-host
       FTP host to connect to.

       E.g.  “ftp.example.com”.

       Properties:

       • Config: host

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_HOST

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –ftp-user
       FTP username.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_USER

       • Type: string

       • Default: “$USER”

   –ftp-port
       FTP port number.

       Properties:

       • Config: port

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PORT

       • Type: int

       • Default: 21

   –ftp-pass
       FTP password.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –ftp-tls
       Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS).

       When  using implicit FTP over TLS the client connects using TLS right from the start which
       breaks compatibility with non-TLS-aware servers.  This is usually  served  over  port  990
       rather than port 21.  Cannot be used in combination with explicit FTP.

       Properties:

       • Config: tls

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_TLS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-explicit-tls
       Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS).

       When  using  explicit FTP over TLS the client explicitly requests security from the server
       in order to upgrade a plain text connection to  an  encrypted  one.   Cannot  be  used  in
       combination with implicit FTP.

       Properties:

       • Config: explicit_tls

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_EXPLICIT_TLS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to ftp (FTP).

   –ftp-concurrency
       Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited.

       Note that setting this is very likely to cause deadlocks so it should be used with care.

       If  you  are  doing  a sync or copy then make sure concurrency is one more than the sum of
       --transfers and --checkers.

       If you use --check-first then it just needs to be one more than the maximum of  --checkers
       and --transfers.

       So  for  concurrency  3 you’d use --checkers 2 --transfers 2 --check-first or --checkers 1
       --transfers 1.

       Properties:

       • Config: concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 0

   –ftp-no-check-certificate
       Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_check_certificate

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_NO_CHECK_CERTIFICATE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-disable-epsv
       Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_epsv

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_EPSV

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-disable-mlsd
       Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_mlsd

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_MLSD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-disable-utf8
       Disable using UTF-8 even if server advertises support.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_utf8

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_UTF8

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-writing-mdtm
       Use MDTM to set modification time (VsFtpd quirk)

       Properties:

       • Config: writing_mdtm

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_WRITING_MDTM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-force-list-hidden
       Use LIST -a to force listing of hidden files and folders.  This will disable  the  use  of
       MLSD.

       Properties:

       • Config: force_list_hidden

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_FORCE_LIST_HIDDEN

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-idle-timeout
       Max time before closing idle connections.

       If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will
       empty the connection pool.

       Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

       Properties:

       • Config: idle_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_IDLE_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –ftp-close-timeout
       Maximum time to wait for a response to close.

       Properties:

       • Config: close_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_CLOSE_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –ftp-tls-cache-size
       Size of TLS session cache for all control and data connections.

       TLS cache allows to resume TLS sessions and reuse PSK between  connections.   Increase  if
       default size is not enough resulting in TLS resumption errors.  Enabled by default.  Use 0
       to disable.

       Properties:

       • Config: tls_cache_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_TLS_CACHE_SIZE

       • Type: int

       • Default: 32

   –ftp-disable-tls13
       Disable TLS 1.3 (workaround for FTP servers with buggy TLS)

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_tls13

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_TLS13

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-shut-timeout
       Maximum time to wait for data connection closing status.

       Properties:

       • Config: shut_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_SHUT_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –ftp-ask-password
       Allow asking for FTP password when needed.

       If this is set and no password is supplied then rclone will ask for a password

       Properties:

       • Config: ask_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_ASK_PASSWORD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –ftp-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot

       • Examples:

         • “Asterisk,Ctl,Dot,Slash”

           • ProFTPd can’t handle ’*’ in file names

         • “BackSlash,Ctl,Del,Dot,RightSpace,Slash,SquareBracket”

           • PureFTPd can’t handle `[]' or ’*’ in file names

         • “Ctl,LeftPeriod,Slash”

           • VsFTPd can’t handle file names starting with dot

   Limitations
       FTP  servers  acting  as  rclone  remotes  must  support passive mode.  The mode cannot be
       configured as passive is the only supported  one.   Rclone’s  FTP  implementation  is  not
       compatible   with   active   mode   as   the   library   it   uses   doesn’t   support  it
       (https://github.com/jlaffaye/ftp/issues/29).  This will likely never be supported  due  to
       security concerns.

       Rclone’s FTP backend does not support any checksums but can compare file sizes.

       rclone about is not supported by the FTP backend.  Backends without this capability cannot
       determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as  a  member
       of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

       The implementation of : --dump headers, --dump bodies, --dump auth for debugging isn’t the
       same as for rclone HTTP based backends - it has less fine grained control.

       --timeout isn’t supported (but --contimeout is).

       --bind isn’t supported.

       Rclone’s FTP backend could support server-side move but does not at present.

       The ftp_proxy environment variable is not currently supported.

   Modified time
       File modification time (timestamps) is supported to 1  second  resolution  for  major  FTP
       servers:  ProFTPd, PureFTPd, VsFTPd, and FileZilla FTP server.  The VsFTPd server has non-
       standard  implementation  of  time  related  protocol  commands  and   needs   a   special
       configuration setting: writing_mdtm = true.

       Support  for  precise  file  time with other FTP servers varies depending on what protocol
       extensions they advertise.  If all the MLSD, MDTM and MFTM extensions are present,  rclone
       will  use  them  together to provide precise time.  Otherwise the times you see on the FTP
       server through rclone are those of the last file upload.

       You can use the following command to check whether rclone can use precise time  with  your
       FTP  server:  rclone  backend features your_ftp_remote: (the trailing colon is important).
       Look for the number in the line tagged by Precision designating the remote time  precision
       expressed  as  nanoseconds.   A  value  of  1000000000 means that file time precision of 1
       second is available.  A value of  3153600000000000000  (or  another  large  number)  means
       “unsupported”.

Google Cloud Storage

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:bucket  (or  remote:  for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for google cloud storage involves getting  a  token  from  Google  Cloud
       Storage which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)
                 \ "google cloud storage"
              [snip]
              Storage> google cloud storage
              Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Project number optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.
              project_number> 12345678
              Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
              service_account_file>
              Access Control List for new objects.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
                 \ "authenticatedRead"
               2 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get OWNER access.
                 \ "bucketOwnerFullControl"
               3 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get READER access.
                 \ "bucketOwnerRead"
               4 / Object owner gets OWNER access [default if left blank].
                 \ "private"
               5 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team members get access according to their roles.
                 \ "projectPrivate"
               6 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
                 \ "publicRead"
              object_acl> 4
              Access Control List for new buckets.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
                 \ "authenticatedRead"
               2 / Project team owners get OWNER access [default if left blank].
                 \ "private"
               3 / Project team members get access according to their roles.
                 \ "projectPrivate"
               4 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
                 \ "publicRead"
               5 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get WRITER access.
                 \ "publicReadWrite"
              bucket_acl> 2
              Location for the newly created buckets.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Empty for default location (US).
                 \ ""
               2 / Multi-regional location for Asia.
                 \ "asia"
               3 / Multi-regional location for Europe.
                 \ "eu"
               4 / Multi-regional location for United States.
                 \ "us"
               5 / Taiwan.
                 \ "asia-east1"
               6 / Tokyo.
                 \ "asia-northeast1"
               7 / Singapore.
                 \ "asia-southeast1"
               8 / Sydney.
                 \ "australia-southeast1"
               9 / Belgium.
                 \ "europe-west1"
              10 / London.
                 \ "europe-west2"
              11 / Iowa.
                 \ "us-central1"
              12 / South Carolina.
                 \ "us-east1"
              13 / Northern Virginia.
                 \ "us-east4"
              14 / Oregon.
                 \ "us-west1"
              location> 12
              The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Default
                 \ ""
               2 / Multi-regional storage class
                 \ "MULTI_REGIONAL"
               3 / Regional storage class
                 \ "REGIONAL"
               4 / Nearline storage class
                 \ "NEARLINE"
               5 / Coldline storage class
                 \ "COLDLINE"
               6 / Durable reduced availability storage class
                 \ "DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY"
              storage_class> 5
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine or Y didn't work
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = google cloud storage
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"x/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-07-17T20:49:14.929208288+01:00","Extra":null}
              project_number = 12345678
              object_acl = private
              bucket_acl = private
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned
       from Google if you use auto config mode.  This only runs from the  moment  it  opens  your
       browser   to   the   moment   you   get   back   the   verification   code.   This  is  on
       http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if  you  are
       running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all the buckets in your project

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new bucket

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

       List the contents of a bucket

              rclone ls remote:bucket

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

   Service Account support
       You  can set up rclone with Google Cloud Storage in an unattended mode, i.e. not tied to a
       specific end-user Google account.  This is useful when you want to synchronise files  onto
       machines that don’t have actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

       To    get    credentials    for    Google    Cloud    Platform    IAM   Service   Accounts
       (https://cloud.google.com/iam/docs/service-accounts), please head to the  Service  Account
       (https://console.cloud.google.com/permissions/serviceaccounts)   section   of  the  Google
       Developer Console.  Service Accounts behave just like normal User  permissions  in  Google
       Cloud  Storage  ACLs  (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/access-control),  so  you can
       limit their access (e.g. make them read only).  After creating an  account,  a  JSON  file
       containing the Service Account’s credentials will be downloaded onto your machines.  These
       credentials are what rclone will use for authentication.

       To use a Service Account instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter  the  path  to  your  Service
       Account  credentials  at  the service_account_file prompt and rclone won’t use the browser
       based authentication flow.  If you’d rather stuff the contents  of  the  credentials  file
       into  the  rclone  config  file,  you  can set service_account_credentials with the actual
       contents of the file instead, or set the equivalent environment variable.

   Anonymous Access
       For downloads of objects that permit  public  access  you  can  configure  rclone  to  use
       anonymous  access  by setting anonymous to true.  With unauthorized access you can’t write
       or create files but only read or list those buckets and  objects  that  have  public  read
       access.

   Application Default Credentials
       If  no  other  source  of  credentials  is  provided, rclone will fall back to Application
       Default                    Credentials                    (https://cloud.google.com/video-
       intelligence/docs/common/auth#authenticating_with_application_default_credentials) this is
       useful both when you already have configured authentication for your developer account, or
       in  production when running on a google compute host.  Note that if running in docker, you
       may need to run additional commands on  your  google  compute  machine  -  see  this  page
       (https://cloud.google.com/container-registry/docs/advanced-
       authentication#gcloud_as_a_docker_credential_helper).

       Note that in the case application default credentials  are  used,  there  is  no  need  to
       explicitly configure a project number.

   –fast-list
       This  remote  supports  --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange
       for more memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list)  for  more
       details.

   Custom upload headers
       You  can  set  custom  upload headers with the --header-upload flag.  Google Cloud Storage
       supports  the  headers  as  described  in  the   working   with   metadata   documentation
       (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/gsutil/addlhelp/WorkingWithObjectMetadata)

       • Cache-Control

       • Content-Disposition

       • Content-Encoding

       • Content-Language

       • Content-Type

       • X-Goog-Storage-Class


       • X-Goog-Meta-
       Eg --header-upload "Content-Type text/potato"

       Note that the last of these is for setting custom metadata in the form --header-upload "x-
       goog-meta-key: value"

   Modification time
       Google     Cloud     Storage     stores     md5sum     natively.      Google’s      gsutil
       (https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/gsutil)  tool  stores  modification  time with one-
       second precision as goog-reserved-file-mtime in file metadata.

       To ensure compatibility with  gsutil,  rclone  stores  modification  time  in  2  separate
       metadata  entries.   mtime  uses  RFC3339  format  with  one-nanosecond  precision.  goog-
       reserved-file-mtime  uses  Unix  timestamp  format  with  one-second  precision.   To  get
       modification  time from object metadata, rclone reads the metadata in the following order:
       mtime, goog-reserved-file-mtime, object updated time.

       Note that rclone’s default modify window is 1ns.  Files uploaded by  gsutil  only  contain
       timestamps with one-second precision.  If you use rclone to sync files previously uploaded
       by gsutil, rclone will attempt to update modification time for all these files.  To  avoid
       these possibly unnecessary updates, use --modify-window 1s.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       LF          0x0A         ␊
       CR          0x0D         ␍
       /           0x2F        /

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this
       is not Google Drive)).

   –gcs-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-project-number
       Project number.

       Optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.

       Properties:

       • Config: project_number

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_PROJECT_NUMBER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-service-account-file
       Service Account Credentials JSON file path.

       Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

       Leading  ~  will  be  expanded  in  the  file  name  as will environment variables such as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_account_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-service-account-credentials
       Service Account Credentials JSON blob.

       Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_account_credentials

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-anonymous
       Access public buckets and objects without credentials.

       Set to `true' if you just want to download files and don’t configure credentials.

       Properties:

       • Config: anonymous

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ANONYMOUS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gcs-object-acl
       Access Control List for new objects.

       Properties:

       • Config: object_acl

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_OBJECT_ACL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “authenticatedRead”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • All Authenticated Users get READER access.

         • “bucketOwnerFullControl”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • Project team owners get OWNER access.

         • “bucketOwnerRead”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • Project team owners get READER access.

         • “private”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • Default if left blank.

         • “projectPrivate”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • Project team members get access according to their roles.

         • “publicRead”

           • Object owner gets OWNER access.

           • All Users get READER access.

   –gcs-bucket-acl
       Access Control List for new buckets.

       Properties:

       • Config: bucket_acl

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_ACL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “authenticatedRead”

           • Project team owners get OWNER access.

           • All Authenticated Users get READER access.

         • “private”

           • Project team owners get OWNER access.

           • Default if left blank.

         • “projectPrivate”

           • Project team members get access according to their roles.

         • “publicRead”

           • Project team owners get OWNER access.

           • All Users get READER access.

         • “publicReadWrite”

           • Project team owners get OWNER access.

           • All Users get WRITER access.

   –gcs-bucket-policy-only
       Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies.

       If you want to upload objects to a bucket with Bucket Policy Only set then you  will  need
       to set this.

       When it is set, rclone:

       • ignores ACLs set on buckets

       • ignores ACLs set on objects

       • creates buckets with Bucket Policy Only set

       Docs: https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/bucket-policy-only

       Properties:

       • Config: bucket_policy_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_POLICY_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gcs-location
       Location for the newly created buckets.

       Properties:

       • Config: location

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_LOCATION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Empty for default location (US)

         • “asia”

           • Multi-regional location for Asia

         • “eu”

           • Multi-regional location for Europe

         • “us”

           • Multi-regional location for United States

         • “asia-east1”

           • Taiwan

         • “asia-east2”

           • Hong Kong

         • “asia-northeast1”

           • Tokyo

         • “asia-northeast2”

           • Osaka

         • “asia-northeast3”

           • Seoul

         • “asia-south1”

           • Mumbai

         • “asia-south2”

           • Delhi

         • “asia-southeast1”

           • Singapore

         • “asia-southeast2”

           • Jakarta

         • “australia-southeast1”

           • Sydney

         • “australia-southeast2”

           • Melbourne

         • “europe-north1”

           • Finland

         • “europe-west1”

           • Belgium

         • “europe-west2”

           • London

         • “europe-west3”

           • Frankfurt

         • “europe-west4”

           • Netherlands

         • “europe-west6”

           • Zürich

         • “europe-central2”

           • Warsaw

         • “us-central1”

           • Iowa

         • “us-east1”

           • South Carolina

         • “us-east4”

           • Northern Virginia

         • “us-west1”

           • Oregon

         • “us-west2”

           • California

         • “us-west3”

           • Salt Lake City

         • “us-west4”

           • Las Vegas

         • “northamerica-northeast1”

           • Montréal

         • “northamerica-northeast2”

           • Toronto

         • “southamerica-east1”

           • São Paulo

         • “southamerica-west1”

           • Santiago

         • “asia1”

           • Dual region: asia-northeast1 and asia-northeast2.

         • “eur4”

           • Dual region: europe-north1 and europe-west4.

         • “nam4”

           • Dual region: us-central1 and us-east1.

   –gcs-storage-class
       The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_class

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_STORAGE_CLASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “MULTI_REGIONAL”

           • Multi-regional storage class

         • “REGIONAL”

           • Regional storage class

         • “NEARLINE”

           • Nearline storage class

         • “COLDLINE”

           • Coldline storage class

         • “ARCHIVE”

           • Archive storage class

         • “DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY”

           • Durable reduced availability storage class

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this
       is not Google Drive)).

   –gcs-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-no-check-bucket
       If set, don’t attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

       This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does  if  you
       know the bucket exists already.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_check_bucket

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gcs-decompress
       If set this will decompress gzip encoded objects.

       It  is  possible  to  upload  objects  to GCS with “Content-Encoding: gzip” set.  Normally
       rclone will download these files as compressed objects.

       If this flag is set then rclone will decompress these files with “Content-Encoding:  gzip”
       as  they  are received.  This means that rclone can’t check the size and hash but the file
       contents will be decompressed.

       Properties:

       • Config: decompress

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_DECOMPRESS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gcs-endpoint
       Endpoint for the service.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gcs-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       rclone  about is not supported by the Google Cloud Storage backend.  Backends without this
       capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy  mfs  (most  free
       space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Google Drive

       Paths are specified as drive:path

       Drive paths may be as deep as required, e.g. drive:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The  initial  setup for drive involves getting a token from Google drive which you need to
       do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/r/c/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Google Drive
                 \ "drive"
              [snip]
              Storage> drive
              Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.
                 \ "drive"
               2 / Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.
                 \ "drive.readonly"
                 / Access to files created by rclone only.
               3 | These are visible in the drive website.
                 | File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.
                 \ "drive.file"
                 / Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.
               4 | This is not visible in the drive website.
                 \ "drive.appfolder"
                 / Allows read-only access to file metadata but
               5 | does not allow any access to read or download file content.
                 \ "drive.metadata.readonly"
              scope> 1
              Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
              service_account_file>
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine or Y didn't work
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              Configure this as a Shared Drive (Team Drive)?
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              scope = drive
              root_folder_id =
              service_account_file =
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  Google  if  you  use auto config mode.  This only runs from the moment it opens your
       browser  to  the  moment   you   get   back   the   verification   code.    This   is   on
       http://127.0.0.1:53682/  and  it  may  require  you  to  unblock it temporarily if you are
       running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

       You can then use it like this,

       List directories in top level of your drive

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your drive

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a drive directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Scopes
       Rclone allows you to select which scope you would like for rclone to  use.   This  changes
       what   type   of   token   is   granted   to   rclone.    The   scopes  are  defined  here
       (https://developers.google.com/drive/v3/web/about-auth).

       The scope are

   drive
       This is the default scope and allows full access to all files, except for the  Application
       Data Folder (see below).

       Choose this one if you aren’t sure.

   drive.readonly
       This  allows  read  only  access to all files.  Files may be listed and downloaded but not
       uploaded, renamed or deleted.

   drive.file
       With this scope rclone can read/view/modify only those files and folders it creates.

       So if you uploaded files to drive via the web interface (or any other means) they will not
       be visible to rclone.

       This  can  be  useful  if  you  are  using  rclone  to backup data and you want to be sure
       confidential data on your drive is not visible to rclone.

       Files created with this scope are visible in the web interface.

   drive.appfolder
       This gives rclone its own private area to store files.  Rclone will not be able to see any
       other  files  on  your  drive  and  you  won’t  be able to see rclone’s files from the web
       interface either.

   drive.metadata.readonly
       This allows read only access to file names only.  It does not allow rclone to download  or
       upload data, or rename or delete files or directories.

   Root folder ID
       This  option  has  been moved to the advanced section.  You can set the root_folder_id for
       rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers  to  be
       the root of your drive.

       Normally  you  will  leave  this  blank  and rclone will determine the correct root to use
       itself.

       However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy  or  to  access
       data  within  the  “Computers”  tab  on the drive web interface (where files from Google’s
       Backup and Sync desktop program go).

       In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you  wish  rclone
       to display.  This will be the last segment of the URL when you open the relevant folder in
       the drive web interface.

       So  if  the  folder  you   want   rclone   to   use   has   a   URL   which   looks   like
       https://drive.google.com/drive/folders/1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh  in  the browser,
       then you use 1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh as the root_folder_id in the config.

       NB folders under the “Computers” tab seem to be read only (drive gives a 500  error)  when
       using rclone.

       There  doesn’t  appear  to  be  an API to discover the folder IDs of the “Computers” tab -
       please contact us if you know otherwise!

       Note also that rclone can’t access any data under the “Backups” tab on  the  google  drive
       web interface yet.

   Service Account support
       You can set up rclone with Google Drive in an unattended mode, i.e. not tied to a specific
       end-user Google account.  This is useful when you want to synchronise files onto  machines
       that don’t have actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

       To  use  a  Service  Account  instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter the path to your Service
       Account credentials at the service_account_file prompt during  rclone  config  and  rclone
       won’t  use  the  browser based authentication flow.  If you’d rather stuff the contents of
       the credentials file into the rclone config file, you can set  service_account_credentials
       with the actual contents of the file instead, or set the equivalent environment variable.

   Use case - Google Apps/G-suite account and individual Drive
       Let’s  say  that you are the administrator of a Google Apps (old) or G-suite account.  The
       goal is to store data on an individual’s Drive account, who IS a  member  of  the  domain.
       We’ll call the domain example.com, and the user foo@example.com.

       There’s a few steps we need to go through to accomplish this:

   1. Create a service account for example.com
       • To  create  a  service  account  and  obtain its credentials, go to the Google Developer
         Console (https://console.developers.google.com).

       • You must have a project - create one if you don’t.

       • Then go to “IAM & admin” -> “Service Accounts”.

       • Use the “Create Credentials” button.  Fill in “Service account name” with something that
         identifies your client.  “Role” can be empty.

       • Tick “Furnish a new private key” - select “Key type JSON”.

       • Tick  “Enable  G  Suite  Domain-wide  Delegation”.   This  option  makes “impersonation”
         possible, as documented here: Delegating domain-wide authority to  the  service  account
         (https://developers.google.com/identity/protocols/OAuth2ServiceAccount#delegatingauthority)

       • These credentials are what rclone will use for authentication.   If  you  ever  need  to
         remove access, press the “Delete service account key” button.

   2. Allowing API access to example.com Google Drive
       • Go to example.com’s admin console

       • Go into “Security” (or use the search bar)

       • Select “Show more” and then “Advanced settings”

       • Select “Manage API client access” in the “Authentication” section

       • In  the  “Client Name” field enter the service account’s “Client ID” - this can be found
         in the Developer Console under “IAM & Admin” -> “Service Accounts”,  then  “View  Client
         ID” for the newly created service account.  It is a ~21 character numerical string.

       • In the next field, “One or More API Scopes”, enter https://www.googleapis.com/auth/drive
         to grant access to Google Drive specifically.

   3. Configure rclone, assuming a new install
              rclone config

              n/s/q> n         # New
              name>gdrive      # Gdrive is an example name
              Storage>         # Select the number shown for Google Drive
              client_id>       # Can be left blank
              client_secret>   # Can be left blank
              scope>           # Select your scope, 1 for example
              root_folder_id>  # Can be left blank
              service_account_file> /home/foo/myJSONfile.json # This is where the JSON file goes!
              y/n>             # Auto config, n

   4. Verify that it’s workingrclone -v --drive-impersonate foo@example.com lsf gdrive:backup

       • The arguments do:

         • -v - verbose logging

         • --drive-impersonate foo@example.com - this is what does the magic,  pretending  to  be
           user foo.

         • lsf - list files in a parsing friendly way

         • gdrive:backup - use the remote called gdrive, work in the folder named backup.

       Note:  in  case  you  configured  a specific root folder on gdrive and rclone is unable to
       access the contents of that folder when using --drive-impersonate, do this instead:  -  in
       the  gdrive  web  interface, share your root folder with the user/email of the new Service
       Account you created/selected at step #1 -  use  rclone  without  specifying  the  --drive-
       impersonate option, like this: rclone -v lsf gdrive:backup

   Shared drives (team drives)
       If you want to configure the remote to point to a Google Shared Drive (previously known as
       Team Drives) then answer y to the question Configure this as a Shared Drive (Team Drive)?.

       This will fetch the list of Shared Drives from google and allow you to configure which one
       you want to use.  You can also type in a Shared Drive ID if you prefer.

       For example:

              Configure this as a Shared Drive (Team Drive)?
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              Fetching Shared Drive list...
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Rclone Test
                 \ "xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx"
               2 / Rclone Test 2
                 \ "yyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyy"
               3 / Rclone Test 3
                 \ "zzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzz"
              Enter a Shared Drive ID> 1
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.x.xxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"1/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z","Extra":null}
              team_drive = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   –fast-list
       This  remote  supports  --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange
       for more memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list)  for  more
       details.

       It does this by combining multiple list calls into a single API request.

       This  works  by  combining  many '%s' in parents filters into one expression.  To list the
       contents of directories a, b and c, the following requests will be  send  by  the  regular
       List function:

              trashed=false and 'a' in parents
              trashed=false and 'b' in parents
              trashed=false and 'c' in parents

       These can now be combined into a single request:

              trashed=false and ('a' in parents or 'b' in parents or 'c' in parents)

       The  implementation  of ListR will put up to 50 parents filters into one request.  It will
       use the --checkers value to specify the number of requests to run in parallel.

       In tests, these batch requests were up to 20x faster than the regular method.  Running the
       following command against different sized folders gives:

              rclone lsjson -vv -R --checkers=6 gdrive:folder

       small folder (220 directories, 700 files):

       • without --fast-list: 38s

       • with --fast-list: 10s

       large folder (10600 directories, 39000 files):

       • without --fast-list: 22:05 min

       • with --fast-list: 58s

   Modified time
       Google drive stores modification times accurate to 1 ms.

   Restricted filename characters
       Only  Invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

       In contrast to other backends, / can also be used in names and . or .. are valid names.

   Revisions
       Google drive stores revisions of files.  When you upload a change to an existing  file  to
       google drive using rclone it will create a new revision of that file.

       Revisions follow the standard google policy which at time of writing was

       • They are deleted after 30 days or 100 revisions (whatever comes first).

       • They do not count towards a user storage quota.

   Deleting files
       By  default rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting files.  If deleting them
       permanently is required then use the --drive-use-trash=false flag, or set  the  equivalent
       environment variable.

   Shortcuts
       In  March  2020  Google  introduced  a  new feature in Google Drive called drive shortcuts
       (https://support.google.com/drive/answer/9700156)                                     (API
       (https://developers.google.com/drive/api/v3/shortcuts)).   These  will (by September 2020)
       replace  the  ability  for  files  or  folders  to  be  in  multiple   folders   at   once
       (https://cloud.google.com/blog/products/g-suite/simplifying-google-drives-folder-
       structure-and-sharing-models).

       Shortcuts are files that link to other files on Google Drive somewhat like  a  symlink  in
       unix, except they point to the underlying file data (e.g. the inode in unix terms) so they
       don’t break if the source is renamed or moved about.

       Be default rclone treats these as follows.

       For shortcuts pointing to files:

       • When listing a file shortcut appears as the destination file.

       • When downloading the contents of the destination file is downloaded.

       • When updating shortcut file with a non shortcut file, the shortcut is removed then a new
         file is uploaded in place of the shortcut.

       • When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination file.

       • When  server-side  copying  the  shortcut  is  copied, not the contents of the shortcut.
         (unless --drive-copy-shortcut-content is in use  in  which  case  the  contents  of  the
         shortcut gets copied).

       • When deleting the shortcut is deleted not the linked file.

       • When  setting  the  modification  time, the modification time of the linked file will be
         set.

       For shortcuts pointing to folders:

       • When listing the shortcut appears as a folder and that folder will contain the  contents
         of the linked folder appear (including any sub folders)

       • When downloading the contents of the linked folder and sub contents are downloaded

       • When uploading to a shortcut folder the file will be placed in the linked folder

       • When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination folder

       • When server-side copying the contents of the linked folder is copied, not the shortcut.

       • When  deleting  with rclone rmdir or rclone purge the shortcut is deleted not the linked
         folder.

       • NB When deleting with rclone remove or rclone mount the contents of  the  linked  folder
         will be deleted.

       The  rclone  backend  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command can be used to
       create shortcuts.

       Shortcuts  can  be  completely  ignored  with  the  --drive-skip-shortcuts  flag  or   the
       corresponding skip_shortcuts configuration setting.

   Emptying trash
       If  you wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command which will
       permanently delete all your trashed files.  This command does not take any path arguments.

       Note that Google Drive takes some time (minutes to days) to empty the  trash  even  though
       the  command  returns  within  a  few  seconds.   No output is echoed, so there will be no
       confirmation even using -v or -vv.

   Quota information
       To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display
       your  usage  limit  (quota), the usage in Google Drive, the size of all files in the Trash
       and the space used by other Google services such as Gmail.  This command does not take any
       path arguments.

   Import/Export of google documents
       Google documents can be exported from and uploaded to Google Drive.

       When  rclone  downloads  a  Google  doc it chooses a format to download depending upon the
       --drive-export-formats setting.  By default  the  export  formats  are  docx,xlsx,pptx,svg
       which are a sensible default for an editable document.

       When  choosing a format, rclone runs down the list provided in order and chooses the first
       file format the doc can be exported as from the list.  If the file can’t be exported to  a
       format on the formats list, then rclone will choose a format from the default list.

       If  you  prefer  an  archive copy then you might use --drive-export-formats pdf, or if you
       prefer openoffice/libreoffice formats you might use --drive-export-formats ods,odt,odp.

       Note that rclone adds the extension to the google doc, so if it is called  My  Spreadsheet
       on google docs, it will be exported as My Spreadsheet.xlsx or My Spreadsheet.pdf etc.

       When importing files into Google Drive, rclone will convert all files with an extension in
       --drive-import-formats to their associated document type.  rclone  will  not  convert  any
       files by default, since the conversion is lossy process.

       The  conversion  must  result  in  a file with the same extension when the --drive-export-
       formats rules are applied to the uploaded document.

       Here are some examples for allowed and prohibited conversions.

       export-formats      import-formats      Upload Ext      Document Ext     Allowed
       ───────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       odt                 odt                 odt             odt              Yes
       odt                 docx,odt            odt             odt              Yes
                           docx                docx            docx             Yes
                           odt                 odt             docx             No
       odt,docx            docx,odt            docx            odt              No
       docx,odt            docx,odt            docx            docx             Yes
       docx,odt            docx,odt            odt             docx             No

       This limitation can be  disabled  by  specifying  --drive-allow-import-name-change.   When
       using  this  flag,  rclone can convert multiple files types resulting in the same document
       type at once,  e.g. with  --drive-import-formats  docx,odt,txt,  all  files  having  these
       extension  would  result  in  a  document  represented  as  a  docx file.  This brings the
       additional risk of overwriting a document, if multiple files have  the  same  stem.   Many
       rclone  operations will not handle this name change in any way.  They assume an equal name
       when copying files and might copy the file again or delete them when the name changes.

       Here are the possible export extensions with their  corresponding  mime  types.   Most  of
       these  can  also  be used for importing, but there more that are not listed here.  Some of
       these additional ones might only be available  when  the  operating  system  provides  the
       correct MIME type entries.

       This list can be changed by Google Drive at any time and might not represent the currently
       available conversions.

       Extension              Mime Type                                         Description
       ────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       bmp                    image/bmp                                         Windows Bitmap format
       csv                    text/csv                                          Standard  CSV  format  for
                                                                                Spreadsheets
       doc                    application/msword                                Classic Word file
       docx                   application/vnd.openxmlformats-                   Microsoft Office Document
                              officedocument.wordprocessingml.document
       epub                   application/epub+zip                              E-book format
       html                   text/html                                         An HTML Document
       jpg                    image/jpeg                                        A JPEG Image File
       json                   application/vnd.google-apps.script+json           JSON   Text   Format   for
                                                                                Google Apps scripts
       odp                    application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.presentation   Openoffice Presentation
       ods                    application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.spreadsheet    Openoffice Spreadsheet
       ods                    application/x-                                    Openoffice Spreadsheet
                              vnd.oasis.opendocument.spreadsheet
       odt                    application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.text           Openoffice Document
       pdf                    application/pdf                                   Adobe PDF Format
       pjpeg                  image/pjpeg                                       Progressive JPEG Image
       png                    image/png                                         PNG Image Format
       pptx                   application/vnd.openxmlformats-                   Microsoft           Office
                              officedocument.presentationml.presentation        Powerpoint
       rtf                    application/rtf                                   Rich Text Format
       svg                    image/svg+xml                                     Scalable  Vector  Graphics
                                                                                Format
       tsv                    text/tab-separated-values                         Standard  TSV  format  for
                                                                                spreadsheets
       txt                    text/plain                                        Plain Text
       wmf                    application/x-msmetafile                          Windows Meta File
       xls                    application/vnd.ms-excel                          Classic Excel file
       xlsx                   application/vnd.openxmlformats-                   Microsoft           Office
                              officedocument.spreadsheetml.sheet                Spreadsheet
       zip                    application/zip                                   A ZIP file of HTML, Images
                                                                                CSS

       Google  documents  can  also  be  exported as link files.  These files will open a browser
       window for the Google Docs website of that document when opened.  The link file  extension
       has  to be specified as a --drive-export-formats parameter.  They will match all available
       Google Documents.

       Extension   Description                OS Support
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       desktop     freedesktop.org            Linux
                   specified desktop entry
       link.html   An  HTML Document with a   All
                   redirect
       url         INI style link file        macOS, Windows
       webloc      macOS    specific    XML   macOS
                   format

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to drive (Google Drive).

   –drive-client-id
       Google    Application    Client    Id    Setting    your    own   is   recommended.    See
       https://rclone.org/drive/#making-your-own-client-id for how to create your  own.   If  you
       leave this blank, it will use an internal key which is low performance.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-scope
       Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.

       Properties:

       • Config: scope

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SCOPE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “drive”

           • Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.

         • “drive.readonly”

           • Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.

         • “drive.file”

           • Access to files created by rclone only.

           • These are visible in the drive website.

           • File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.

         • “drive.appfolder”

           • Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.

           • This is not visible in the drive website.

         • “drive.metadata.readonly”

           • Allows read-only access to file metadata but

           • does not allow any access to read or download file content.

   –drive-service-account-file
       Service Account Credentials JSON file path.

       Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

       Leading  ~  will  be  expanded  in  the  file  name  as will environment variables such as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_account_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-alternate-export
       Deprecated: No longer needed.

       Properties:

       • Config: alternate_export

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALTERNATE_EXPORT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to drive (Google Drive).

   –drive-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-root-folder-id
       ID of the root folder.  Leave blank normally.

       Fill in to access “Computers” folders (see docs), or for rclone to use a non  root  folder
       as its starting point.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-service-account-credentials
       Service Account Credentials JSON blob.

       Leave blank normally.  Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_account_credentials

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-team-drive
       ID of the Shared Drive (Team Drive).

       Properties:

       • Config: team_drive

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TEAM_DRIVE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-auth-owner-only
       Only consider files owned by the authenticated user.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_owner_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_OWNER_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-use-trash
       Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently.

       Defaults  to  true,  namely  sending  files  to the trash.  Use --drive-use-trash=false to
       delete files permanently instead.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_trash

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –drive-copy-shortcut-content
       Server side copy contents of shortcuts instead of the shortcut.

       When doing server side copies, normally rclone will copy shortcuts as shortcuts.

       If this flag is used then rclone will copy the contents of shortcuts rather than shortcuts
       themselves when doing server side copies.

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_shortcut_content

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_COPY_SHORTCUT_CONTENT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-skip-gdocs
       Skip google documents in all listings.

       If given, gdocs practically become invisible to rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_gdocs

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_GDOCS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-skip-checksum-gphotos
       Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only.

       Use this if you get checksum errors when transferring Google photos or videos.

       Setting this flag will cause Google photos and videos to return a blank MD5 checksum.

       Google photos are identified by being in the “photos” space.

       Corrupted  checksums  are  caused by Google modifying the image/video but not updating the
       checksum.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_checksum_gphotos

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_CHECKSUM_GPHOTOS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-shared-with-me
       Only show files that are shared with me.

       Instructs rclone to operate on your “Shared with me” folder (where Google Drive  lets  you
       access the files and folders others have shared with you).

       This  works  both  with  the “list” (lsd, lsl, etc.)  and the “copy” commands (copy, sync,
       etc.), and with all other commands too.

       Properties:

       • Config: shared_with_me

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SHARED_WITH_ME

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-trashed-only
       Only show files that are in the trash.

       This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

       Properties:

       • Config: trashed_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TRASHED_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-starred-only
       Only show files that are starred.

       Properties:

       • Config: starred_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STARRED_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-formats
       Deprecated: See export_formats.

       Properties:

       • Config: formats

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_FORMATS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-export-formats
       Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs.

       Properties:

       • Config: export_formats

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_EXPORT_FORMATS

       • Type: string

       • Default: “docx,xlsx,pptx,svg”

   –drive-import-formats
       Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs.

       Properties:

       • Config: import_formats

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPORT_FORMATS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-allow-import-name-change
       Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs.

       E.g.  file.doc to file.docx.  This will confuse sync and reupload every time.

       Properties:

       • Config: allow_import_name_change

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALLOW_IMPORT_NAME_CHANGE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-use-created-date
       Use file created date instead of modified date.

       Useful when downloading data and you want the creation date used  in  place  of  the  last
       modified date.

       WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

       When  uploading  to  your  drive  all  files  will be overwritten unless they haven’t been
       modified since their creation.  And the inverse will occur while downloading.   This  side
       effect can be avoided by using the “–checksum” flag.

       This  feature  was implemented to retain photos capture date as recorded by google photos.
       You will first need to check the “Create a Google Photos folder”  option  in  your  google
       drive  settings.   You can then copy or move the photos locally and use the date the image
       was taken (created) set as the modification date.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_created_date

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_CREATED_DATE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-use-shared-date
       Use date file was shared instead of modified date.

       Note that, as with “–drive-use-created-date”, this flag may have  unexpected  consequences
       when uploading/downloading files.

       If both this flag and “–drive-use-created-date” are set, the created date is used.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_shared_date

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_SHARED_DATE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-list-chunk
       Size of listing chunk 100-1000, 0 to disable.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_LIST_CHUNK

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1000

   –drive-impersonate
       Impersonate this user when using a service account.

       Properties:

       • Config: impersonate

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPERSONATE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 8Mi

   –drive-chunk-size
       Upload chunk size.

       Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

       Making  this  larger  will  improve  performance,  but note that each chunk is buffered in
       memory one per transfer.

       Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 8Mi

   –drive-acknowledge-abuse
       Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded.

       If downloading a file returns the error “This file has been identified as malware or  spam
       and cannot be downloaded” with the error code “cannotDownloadAbusiveFile” then supply this
       flag to rclone to indicate you acknowledge the risks of downloading the  file  and  rclone
       will download it anyway.

       Properties:

       • Config: acknowledge_abuse

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ACKNOWLEDGE_ABUSE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-keep-revision-forever
       Keep new head revision of each file forever.

       Properties:

       • Config: keep_revision_forever

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_KEEP_REVISION_FOREVER

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-size-as-quota
       Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size.

       Show  the  size of a file as the storage quota used.  This is the current version plus any
       older versions that have been set to keep forever.

       WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

       It is not recommended to set this flag in your config - the recommended usage is using the
       flag form –drive-size-as-quota when doing rclone ls/lsl/lsf/lsjson/etc only.

       If  you  do  use this flag for syncing (not recommended) then you will need to use –ignore
       size also.

       Properties:

       • Config: size_as_quota

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SIZE_AS_QUOTA

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-v2-download-min-size
       If Object’s are greater, use drive v2 API to download.

       Properties:

       • Config: v2_download_min_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_V2_DOWNLOAD_MIN_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: off

   –drive-pacer-min-sleep
       Minimum time to sleep between API calls.

       Properties:

       • Config: pacer_min_sleep

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_MIN_SLEEP

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 100ms

   –drive-pacer-burst
       Number of API calls to allow without sleeping.

       Properties:

       • Config: pacer_burst

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_BURST

       • Type: int

       • Default: 100

   –drive-server-side-across-configs
       Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different drive configs.

       This can be useful if you wish to do a  server-side  copy  between  two  different  Google
       drives.   Note that this isn’t enabled by default because it isn’t easy to tell if it will
       work between any two configurations.

       Properties:

       • Config: server_side_across_configs

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-disable-http2
       Disable drive using http2.

       There is currently an unsolved issue with the google drive backend and HTTP/2.  HTTP/2  is
       therefore  disabled by default for the drive backend but can be re-enabled here.  When the
       issue is solved this flag will be removed.

       See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_http2

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_DISABLE_HTTP2

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –drive-stop-on-upload-limit
       Make upload limit errors be fatal.

       At the time of writing it is only possible to upload 750 GiB of data to Google Drive a day
       (this  is  an  undocumented  limit).   When  this limit is reached Google Drive produces a
       slightly different error message.  When this flag is set it  causes  these  errors  to  be
       fatal.  These will stop the in-progress sync.

       Note  that  this detection is relying on error message strings which Google don’t document
       so it may break in the future.

       See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3857

       Properties:

       • Config: stop_on_upload_limit

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_UPLOAD_LIMIT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-stop-on-download-limit
       Make download limit errors be fatal.

       At the time of writing it is only possible to download 10 TiB of data from Google Drive  a
       day  (this  is an undocumented limit).  When this limit is reached Google Drive produces a
       slightly different error message.  When this flag is set it  causes  these  errors  to  be
       fatal.  These will stop the in-progress sync.

       Note  that  this detection is relying on error message strings which Google don’t document
       so it may break in the future.

       Properties:

       • Config: stop_on_download_limit

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_DOWNLOAD_LIMIT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-skip-shortcuts
       If set skip shortcut files.

       Normally rclone dereferences shortcut files making them appear as if they are the original
       file  (see  the  shortcuts section).  If this flag is set then rclone will ignore shortcut
       files completely.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_shortcuts

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_SHORTCUTS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts
       If set skip dangling shortcut files.

       If this is set then rclone will not show any dangling shortcuts in listings.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_dangling_shortcuts

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_DANGLING_SHORTCUTS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –drive-resource-key
       Resource key for accessing a link-shared file.

       If you need to access files shared with a link like this

              https://drive.google.com/drive/folders/XXX?resourcekey=YYY&usp=sharing

       Then you will need to use the first part “XXX” as the “root_folder_id” and the second part
       “YYY”  as  the  “resource_key”  otherwise you will get 404 not found errors when trying to
       access the directory.

       See: https://developers.google.com/drive/api/guides/resource-keys

       This resource key requirement only applies to a subset of old files.

       Note also that opening the folder  once  in  the  web  interface  (with  the  user  you’ve
       authenticated rclone with) seems to be enough so that the resource key is no needed.

       Properties:

       • Config: resource_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_RESOURCE_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –drive-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: InvalidUtf8

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the drive backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These   can   be   run   on  a  running  backend  using  the  rc  command  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   get
       Get command for fetching the drive config parameters

              rclone backend get remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This is a get command which will be used to fetch the various drive config parameters

       Usage Examples:

              rclone backend get drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]
              rclone rc backend/command command=get fs=drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]

       Options:

       • “chunk_size”: show the current upload chunk size

       • “service_account_file”: show the current service account file

   set
       Set command for updating the drive config parameters

              rclone backend set remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This is a set command which will be used to update the various drive config parameters

       Usage Examples:

              rclone backend set drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]
              rclone rc backend/command command=set fs=drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]

       Options:

       • “chunk_size”: update the current upload chunk size

       • “service_account_file”: update the current service account file

   shortcut
       Create shortcuts from files or directories

              rclone backend shortcut remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command creates shortcuts from files or directories.

       Usage:

              rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item destination_shortcut
              rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item -o target=drive2: destination_shortcut

       In the first example this creates a shortcut from the “source_item” which can be a file or
       a    directory    to    the    “destination_shortcut”.     The   “source_item”   and   the
       “destination_shortcut” should be relative paths from “drive:”

       In the second example this creates a shortcut from the “source_item” relative to  “drive:”
       to  the  “destination_shortcut”  relative  to  “drive2:”.  This may fail with a permission
       error if the user authenticated with “drive2:” can’t read files from “drive:”.

       Options:

       • “target”: optional target remote for the shortcut destination

   drives
       List the Shared Drives available to this account

              rclone backend drives remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command lists the Shared Drives (Team Drives) available to this account.

       Usage:

              rclone backend [-o config] drives drive:

       This will return a JSON list of objects like this

              [
                  {
                      "id": "0ABCDEF-01234567890",
                      "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
                      "name": "My Drive"
                  },
                  {
                      "id": "0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl",
                      "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
                      "name": "Test Drive"
                  }
              ]

       With the -o config parameter it will output the list in a format suitable for adding to  a
       config file to make aliases for all the drives found and a combined drive.

              [My Drive]
              type = alias
              remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEF-01234567890,root_folder_id=:

              [Test Drive]
              type = alias
              remote = drive,team_drive=0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl,root_folder_id=:

              [AllDrives]
              type = combine
              upstreams = "My Drive=My Drive:" "Test Drive=Test Drive:"

       Adding  this  to the rclone config file will cause those team drives to be accessible with
       the aliases shown.  Any illegal characters will be  substituted  with  “_”  and  duplicate
       names  will have numbers suffixed.  It will also add a remote called AllDrives which shows
       all the shared drives combined into one directory tree.

   untrash
       Untrash files and directories

              rclone backend untrash remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command  untrashes  all  the  files  and  directories  in  the  directory  passed  in
       recursively.

       Usage:

       This takes an optional directory to trash which make this easier to use via the API.

              rclone backend untrash drive:directory
              rclone backend -i untrash drive:directory subdir

       Use the -i flag to see what would be restored before restoring it.

       Result:

              {
                  "Untrashed": 17,
                  "Errors": 0
              }

   copyid
       Copy files by ID

              rclone backend copyid remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command copies files by ID

       Usage:

              rclone backend copyid drive: ID path
              rclone backend copyid drive: ID1 path1 ID2 path2

       It  copies  the  drive file with ID given to the path (an rclone path which will be passed
       internally to rclone copyto).  The ID and path pairs can be repeated.

       The path should end with a / to indicate copy the file as named to this directory.  If  it
       doesn’t end with a / then the last path component will be used as the file name.

       If  the  destination  is  a  drive  backend  then server-side copying will be attempted if
       possible.

       Use the -i flag to see what would be copied before copying.

   exportformats
       Dump the export formats for debug purposes

              rclone backend exportformats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   importformats
       Dump the import formats for debug purposes

              rclone backend importformats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

   Limitations
       Drive has quite a lot of rate limiting.  This causes rclone to be limited to  transferring
       about 2 files per second only.  Individual files may be transferred much faster at 100s of
       MiB/s but lots of small files can take a long time.

       Server side copies are also subject to a separate rate limit.  If you see User rate  limit
       exceeded  errors,  wait  at  least 24 hours and retry.  You can disable server-side copies
       with --disable copy to download and upload the files if you prefer.

   Limitations of Google Docs
       Google docs will appear as size -1 in rclone ls,  rclone  ncdu  etc,  and  as  size  0  in
       anything  which  uses the VFS layer, e.g. rclone mount and rclone serve.  When calculating
       directory totals, e.g. in rclone size and rclone ncdu, they will be counted  in  as  empty
       files.

       This  is  because  rclone  can’t  find out the size of the Google docs without downloading
       them.

       Google docs will transfer correctly with rclone sync, rclone copy etc as rclone  knows  to
       ignore the size when doing the transfer.

       However  an unfortunate consequence of this is that you may not be able to download Google
       docs using rclone mount.  If it doesn’t work you will get a 0  sized  file.   If  you  try
       again  the doc may gain its correct size and be downloadable.  Whether it will work on not
       depends on the application accessing the mount and the OS you are running - experiment  to
       find out if it does work for you!

   Duplicated files
       Sometimes,  for  no  reason I’ve been able to track down, drive will duplicate a file that
       rclone uploads.  Drive unlike all the other remotes can have duplicated files.

       Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will  see  messages  in  the  log
       about duplicates.

       Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

       Note  that this isn’t just a problem with rclone, even Google Photos on Android duplicates
       files on drive sometimes.

   Rclone appears to be re-copying files it shouldn’t
       The most likely cause of this is the duplicated file issue above - run rclone  dedupe  and
       check your logs for duplicate object or directory messages.

       This  can also be caused by a delay/caching on google drive’s end when comparing directory
       listings.  Specifically with team drives used in combination with –fast-list.  Files  that
       were  uploaded  recently  may  not  appear on the directory list sent to rclone when using
       –fast-list.

       Waiting a moderate period of time between attempts (estimated to be approximately 1  hour)
       and/or not using –fast-list both seem to be effective in preventing the problem.

   Making your own client_id
       When  you use rclone with Google drive in its default configuration you are using rclone’s
       client_id.  This is shared between all the rclone users.  There is a global rate limit  on
       the number of queries per second that each client_id can do set by Google.  rclone already
       has a high quota and I will continue to make sure it is high enough by contacting Google.

       It is strongly recommended to use your own client ID as the default rclone ID  is  heavily
       used.  If you have multiple services running, it is recommended to use an API key for each
       service.  The default Google quota is 10 transactions per second so it is  recommended  to
       stay  under  that  number as if you use more than that, it will cause rclone to rate limit
       and make things slower.

       Here is how to create your own Google Drive client ID for rclone:

        1. Log into the Google API  Console  (https://console.developers.google.com/)  with  your
           Google  account.   It doesn’t matter what Google account you use.  (It need not be the
           same account as the Google Drive you want to access)

        2. Select a project or create a new project.

        3. Under “ENABLE APIS AND SERVICES” search for “Drive”,  and  enable  the  “Google  Drive
           API”.

        4. Click  “Credentials” in the left-side panel (not “Create credentials”, which opens the
           wizard), then “Create credentials”

        5. If you already configured an “Oauth Consent Screen”, then skip to the  next  step;  if
           not,  click  on  “CONFIGURE  CONSENT  SCREEN” button (near the top right corner of the
           right panel), then select “External” and click on “CREATE”; on the next screen,  enter
           an  “Application name” (“rclone” is OK); enter “User Support Email” (your own email is
           OK); enter “Developer Contact Email” (your own email is OK); then click on “Save” (all
           other data is optional).  Click again on “Credentials” on the left panel to go back to
           the “Credentials” screen.

           (PS: if you are a GSuite user, you could also select “Internal” instead of  “External”
           above, but this will restrict API use to Google Workspace users in your organisation).

        6. Click  on  the  “+  CREATE  CREDENTIALS”  button at the top of the screen, then select
           “OAuth client ID”.

        7. Choose an application type of “Desktop app” and click “Create”.  (the default name  is
           fine)

        8. It will show you a client ID and client secret.  Make a note of these.

           (If you selected “External” at Step 5 continue to “Publish App” in the Steps 9 and 10.
           If you chose “Internal” you don’t need to publish and can skip straight to Step 11.)

        9. Go to “Oauth consent screen” and press “Publish App”

       10. Click “OAuth consent screen”, then click “PUBLISH APP” button and confirm, or add your
           account under “Test users”.

       11. Provide the noted client ID and client secret to rclone.

       Be  aware  that,  due  to  the  “enhanced security” recently introduced by Google, you are
       theoretically expected to “submit your app for verification” and then wait a few  weeks(!)
       for  their  response; in practice, you can go right ahead and use the client ID and client
       secret with rclone, the only issue will be a very scary confirmation screen shown when you
       connect  via  your  browser  for  rclone  to be able to get its token-id (but as this only
       happens during the remote configuration, it’s not such a big deal).

       (Thanks to @balazer on github for these instructions.)

       Sometimes, creation of an OAuth consent in Google  API  Console  fails  due  to  an  error
       message  “The  request  failed  because changes to one of the field of the resource is not
       supported”.  As a convenient workaround, the necessary Google Drive API key can be created
       on  the  Python  Quickstart (https://developers.google.com/drive/api/v3/quickstart/python)
       page.  Just push the Enable the Drive API button to receive  the  Client  ID  and  Secret.
       Note that it will automatically create a new project in the API Console.

Google Photos

       The   rclone   backend  for  Google  Photos  (https://www.google.com/photos/about/)  is  a
       specialized backend for transferring photos and videos to and from Google Photos.

       NB The Google Photos API which rclone uses has quite a few limitations, so please read the
       limitations section carefully to make sure it is suitable for your use.

   Configuration
       The  initial  setup  for  google cloud storage involves getting a token from Google Photos
       which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Google Photos
                 \ "google photos"
              [snip]
              Storage> google photos
              ** See help for google photos backend at: https://rclone.org/googlephotos/ **

              Google Application Client Id
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_id>
              Google Application Client Secret
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_secret>
              Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

              If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only access
              to your photos, otherwise rclone will request full access.
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              read_only>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code

              *** IMPORTANT: All media items uploaded to Google Photos with rclone
              *** are stored in full resolution at original quality.  These uploads
              *** will count towards storage in your Google Account.

              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = google photos
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-06-28T17:38:04.644930156+01:00"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  Google  if  you  use auto config mode.  This only runs from the moment it opens your
       browser  to  the  moment   you   get   back   the   verification   code.    This   is   on
       http://127.0.0.1:53682/  and  this  may  require  you to unblock it temporarily if you are
       running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all the albums in your photos

              rclone lsd remote:album

       Make a new album

              rclone mkdir remote:album/newAlbum

       List the contents of an album

              rclone ls remote:album/newAlbum

       Sync /home/local/images to the Google Photos, removing any excess files in the album.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/image remote:album/newAlbum

   Layout
       As Google Photos is not a general purpose cloud storage system the backend is laid out  to
       help you navigate it.

       The directories under media show different ways of categorizing the media.  Each file will
       appear multiple times.  So if you want to make a backup of your google  photos  you  might
       choose  to  backup  remote:media/by-month.   (NB remote:media/by-day is rather slow at the
       moment so avoid for syncing.)

       Note that all your photos and videos will appear somewhere under media, but they  may  not
       appear under album unless you’ve put them into albums.

              /
              - upload
                  - file1.jpg
                  - file2.jpg
                  - ...
              - media
                  - all
                      - file1.jpg
                      - file2.jpg
                      - ...
                  - by-year
                      - 2000
                          - file1.jpg
                          - ...
                      - 2001
                          - file2.jpg
                          - ...
                      - ...
                  - by-month
                      - 2000
                          - 2000-01
                              - file1.jpg
                              - ...
                          - 2000-02
                              - file2.jpg
                              - ...
                      - ...
                  - by-day
                      - 2000
                          - 2000-01-01
                              - file1.jpg
                              - ...
                          - 2000-01-02
                              - file2.jpg
                              - ...
                      - ...
              - album
                  - album name
                  - album name/sub
              - shared-album
                  - album name
                  - album name/sub
              - feature
                  - favorites
                      - file1.jpg
                      - file2.jpg

       There  are two writable parts of the tree, the upload directory and sub directories of the
       album directory.

       The upload directory is for uploading files you don’t want to put into albums.  This  will
       be  empty  to start with and will contain the files you’ve uploaded for one rclone session
       only, becoming empty again when you restart rclone.  The use case for this would be if you
       have  a  load  of  files  you just want to once off dump into Google Photos.  For repeated
       syncing, uploading to album will work better.

       Directories within the  album  directory  are  also  writeable  and  you  may  create  new
       directories  (albums)  under album.  If you copy files with a directory hierarchy in there
       then rclone will create albums with the / character in them.  For example if you do

              rclone copy /path/to/images remote:album/images

       and the images directory contains

              images
                  - file1.jpg
                  dir
                      file2.jpg
                  dir2
                      dir3
                          file3.jpg

       Then rclone will create the following albums with the following files in

       • images

         • file1.jpg

       • images/dir

         • file2.jpg

       • images/dir2/dir3

         • file3.jpg

       This means that you can use the album path pretty much like a normal filesystem and it  is
       a good target for repeated syncing.

       The shared-album directory shows albums shared with you or by you.  This is similar to the
       Sharing tab in the Google Photos web interface.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

   –gphotos-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gphotos-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gphotos-read-only
       Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

       If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only  access  to  your  photos,
       otherwise rclone will request full access.

       Properties:

       • Config: read_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

   –gphotos-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gphotos-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gphotos-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –gphotos-read-size
       Set to read the size of media items.

       Normally  rclone  does  not  read  the  size  of  media  items  since  this  takes another
       transaction.  This isn’t necessary for syncing.  However rclone mount needs  to  know  the
       size  of files in advance of reading them, so setting this flag when using rclone mount is
       recommended if you want to read the media.

       Properties:

       • Config: read_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_SIZE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gphotos-start-year
       Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year.

       Properties:

       • Config: start_year

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_START_YEAR

       • Type: int

       • Default: 2000

   –gphotos-include-archived
       Also view and download archived media.

       By default, rclone does not request archived media.  Thus, when syncing, archived media is
       not visible in directory listings or transferred.

       Note that media in albums is always visible and synced, no matter their archive status.

       With this flag, archived media are always visible in directory listings and transferred.

       Without  this  flag, archived media will not be visible in directory listings and won’t be
       transferred.

       Properties:

       • Config: include_archived

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_INCLUDE_ARCHIVED

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –gphotos-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Only  images and videos can be uploaded.  If you attempt to upload non videos or images or
       formats that Google Photos doesn’t understand, rclone will upload the  file,  then  Google
       Photos will give an error when it is put turned into a media item.

       Note  that  all  media  items uploaded to Google Photos through the API are stored in full
       resolution at “original quality” and will count towards your storage quota in your  Google
       Account.  The API does not offer a way to upload in “high quality” mode..

       rclone  about  is  not  supported  by  the  Google  Photos backend.  Backends without this
       capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy  mfs  (most  free
       space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         See         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

   Downloading Images
       When Images are downloaded this strips EXIF location (according to the docs and my tests).
       This is a  limitation  of  the  Google  Photos  API  and  is  covered  by  bug  #112096115
       (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/112096115).

       The  current  google  API  does  not allow photos to be downloaded at original resolution.
       This is very important if you are, for example, relying on “Google Photos” as a backup  of
       your photos.  You will not be able to use rclone to redownload original images.  You could
       use `google takeout' to recover the original photos as a last resort

   Downloading Videos
       When videos are downloaded they are downloaded in a really compressed version of the video
       compared  to  downloading  it via the Google Photos web interface.  This is covered by bug
       #113672044 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/113672044).

   Duplicates
       If a file name is duplicated in a directory then rclone will add  the  file  ID  into  its
       name.   So  two  files  called  file.jpg  would  then appear as file {123456}.jpg and file
       {ABCDEF}.jpg (the actual IDs are a lot longer alas!).

       If you upload the same image (with the same binary data) twice  then  Google  Photos  will
       deduplicate  it.   However  it  will  retain  the filename from the first upload which may
       confuse rclone.  For example if you uploaded an image to upload  then  uploaded  the  same
       image  to  album/my_album  the filename of the image in album/my_album will be what it was
       uploaded with initially, not what you  uploaded  it  with  to  album.   In  practise  this
       shouldn’t cause too many problems.

   Modified time
       The  date  shown  of media in Google Photos is the creation date as determined by the EXIF
       information, or the upload date if that is not known.

       This is not changeable by rclone and is not the modification date of the  media  on  local
       disk.   This  means  that  rclone  cannot  use  the  dates  from Google Photos for syncing
       purposes.

   Size
       The Google Photos API does not return the size of media.  This means that when syncing  to
       Google Photos, rclone can only do a file existence check.

       It  is  possible  to read the size of the media, but this needs an extra HTTP HEAD request
       per media item so is very slow and uses up a lot of transactions.   This  can  be  enabled
       with the --gphotos-read-size option or the read_size = true config parameter.

       If  you  want  to  use  the  backend  with  rclone  mount you may need to enable this flag
       (depending on your OS and application using the photos) otherwise you may not be  able  to
       read  media  off  the mount.  You’ll need to experiment to see if it works for you without
       the flag.

   Albums
       Rclone can only upload files to albums it created.  This is a  limitation  of  the  Google
       Photos API (https://developers.google.com/photos/library/guides/manage-albums).

       Rclone can remove files it uploaded from albums it created only.

   Deleting files
       Rclone  can  remove files from albums it created, but note that the Google Photos API does
       not allow media to be deleted permanently so  this  media  will  still  remain.   See  bug
       #109759781 (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/109759781).

       Rclone cannot delete files anywhere except under album.

   Deleting albums
       The   Google   Photos   API  does  not  support  deleting  albums  -  see  bug  #135714733
       (https://issuetracker.google.com/issues/135714733).

Hasher (EXPERIMENTAL)

       Hasher is a special overlay backend to create remotes which  handle  checksums  for  other
       remotes.   It’s  main  functions include: - Emulate hash types unimplemented by backends -
       Cache checksums to help with slow hashing of  large  local  or  (S)FTP  files  -  Warm  up
       checksum cache from external SUM files

   Getting started
       To use Hasher, first set up the underlying remote following the configuration instructions
       for that remote.  You can also use a local pathname instead of a remote.  Check that  your
       base remote is working.

       Let’s  call  the  base remote myRemote:path here.  Note that anything inside myRemote:path
       will be handled by hasher and anything outside won’t.  This means that if you are using  a
       bucket  based  remote  (S3,  B2,  Swift)  then  you  should  put  the bucket in the remote
       s3:bucket.

       Now proceed to interactive or manual configuration.

   Interactive configuration
       Run rclone config:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> Hasher1
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Handle checksums for other remotes
                 \ "hasher"
              [snip]
              Storage> hasher
              Remote to cache checksums for, like myremote:mypath.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              remote> myRemote:path
              Comma separated list of supported checksum types.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("md5,sha1").
              hashsums> md5
              Maximum time to keep checksums in cache. 0 = no cache, off = cache forever.
              max_age> off
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [Hasher1]
              type = hasher
              remote = myRemote:path
              hashsums = md5
              max_age = off
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Manual configuration
       Run  rclone  config  path  to  see  the  path  of  current  active  config  file,  usually
       YOURHOME/.config/rclone/rclone.conf.   Open  it in your favorite text editor, find section
       for the base remote and create new section for hasher like in the following examples:

              [Hasher1]
              type = hasher
              remote = myRemote:path
              hashes = md5
              max_age = off

              [Hasher2]
              type = hasher
              remote = /local/path
              hashes = dropbox,sha1
              max_age = 24h

       Hasher takes basically the following parameters: - remote is required, - hashes is a comma
       separated  list  of supported checksums (by default md5,sha1), - max_age - maximum time to
       keep a checksum value in the cache, 0 will disable  caching  completely,  off  will  cache
       “forever” (that is until the files get changed).

       Make  sure  the  remote  has : (colon) in.  If you specify the remote without a colon then
       rclone will use a local directory of that name.  So if you use  a  remote  of  /local/path
       then  rclone  will  handle  hashes for that directory.  If you use remote = name literally
       then rclone will put files in a directory called name located under current directory.

   Usage
   Basic operations
       Now  you  can  use  it  as  Hasher2:subdir/file  instead  of  base  remote.   Hasher  will
       transparently  update  cache  with new checksums when a file is fully read or overwritten,
       like:

              rclone copy External:path/file Hasher:dest/path

              rclone cat Hasher:path/to/file > /dev/null

       The way to refresh all cached checksums (even unsupported  by  the  base  backend)  for  a
       subtree  is  to re-download all files in the subtree.  For example, use hashsum --download
       using any supported hashsum on the command line (we just care to re-read):

              rclone hashsum MD5 --download Hasher:path/to/subtree > /dev/null

              rclone backend dump Hasher:path/to/subtree

       You can print or drop hashsum cache using custom backend commands:

              rclone backend dump Hasher:dir/subdir

              rclone backend drop Hasher:

   Pre-Seed from a SUM File
       Hasher supports two backend  commands:  generic  SUM  file  import  and  faster  but  less
       consistent stickyimport.

              rclone backend import Hasher:dir/subdir SHA1 /path/to/SHA1SUM [--checkers 4]

       Instead  of  SHA1 it can be any hash supported by the remote.  The last argument can point
       to either a local or an other-remote:path text file in SUM format.  The command will parse
       the  SUM  file,  then  walk  down  the  path given by the first argument, snapshot current
       fingerprints and fill in the cache entries correspondingly.  - Paths in the SUM  file  are
       treated  as  relative  to  hasher:dir/subdir.   - The command will not check that supplied
       values are correct.  You must know what you are doing.  - This is a one-time action.   The
       SUM  file  will  not get “attached” to the remote.  Cache entries can still be overwritten
       later, should the object’s fingerprint change.  - The tree walk can take long depending on
       the tree size.  You can increase --checkers to make it faster.  Or use stickyimport if you
       don’t care about fingerprints and consistency.

              rclone backend stickyimport hasher:path/to/data sha1 remote:/path/to/sum.sha1

       stickyimport is similar to import but works much faster because it does not need  to  stat
       existing  files  and  skips  initial  tree walk.  Instead of binding cache entries to file
       fingerprints it creates sticky entries  bound  to  the  file  name  alone  ignoring  size,
       modification  time  etc.  Such hash entries can be replaced only by purge, delete, backend
       drop or by full re-read/re-write of the files.

   Configuration reference
   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to hasher (Better checksums for other remotes).

   –hasher-remote
       Remote to cache checksums for (e.g. myRemote:path).

       Properties:

       • Config: remote

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_REMOTE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –hasher-hashes
       Comma separated list of supported checksum types.

       Properties:

       • Config: hashes

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_HASHES

       • Type: CommaSepList

       • Default: md5,sha1

   –hasher-max-age
       Maximum time to keep checksums in cache (0 = no cache, off = cache forever).

       Properties:

       • Config: max_age

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_MAX_AGE

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: off

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to hasher (Better checksums for other remotes).

   –hasher-auto-size
       Auto-update checksum for files smaller than this size (disabled by default).

       Properties:

       • Config: auto_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HASHER_AUTO_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 0

   Metadata
       Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the hasher backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These   can   be   run   on  a  running  backend  using  the  rc  command  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   drop
       Drop cache

              rclone backend drop remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       Completely drop checksum cache.  Usage Example: rclone backend drop hasher:

   dump
       Dump the database

              rclone backend dump remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       Dump cache records covered by the current remote

   fulldump
       Full dump of the database

              rclone backend fulldump remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       Dump all cache records in the database

   import
       Import a SUM file

              rclone backend import remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       Amend hash cache from a SUM file and bind checksums to files by size/time.  Usage Example:
       rclone backend import hasher:subdir md5 /path/to/sum.md5

   stickyimport
       Perform fast import of a SUM file

              rclone backend stickyimport remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       Fill  hash  cache  from  a  SUM  file without verifying file fingerprints.  Usage Example:
       rclone backend stickyimport hasher:subdir md5 remote:path/to/sum.md5

   Implementation details (advanced)
       This section explains how various rclone operations work on a hasher remote.

       Disclaimer.  This section describes current implementation  which  can  change  in  future
       rclone versions!.

   Hashsum command
       The rclone hashsum (or md5sum or sha1sum) command will:

       1. if requested hash is supported by lower level, just pass it.

       2. if  object  size is below auto_size then download object and calculate requested hashes
          on the fly.

       3. if unsupported and the size is big enough, build object  fingerprint  (including  size,
          modtime if supported, first-found other hash if any).

       4. if the strict match is found in cache for the requested remote, return the stored hash.

       5. if remote found but fingerprint mismatched, then purge the entry and proceed to step 6.

       6. if  remote  not  found  or had no requested hash type or after step 5: download object,
          calculate all supported hashes on the fly and store in cache; return requested hash.

   Other operations
       • whenever a file is uploaded or downloaded in full, capture the stream to  calculate  all
         supported hashes on the fly and update database

       • server-side move will update keys of existing cache entries

       • deletefile will remove a single cache entry

       • purge will remove all cache entries under the purged path

       Note that setting max_age = 0 will disable checksum caching completely.

       If  you  set max_age = off, checksums in cache will never age, unless you fully rewrite or
       delete the file.

   Cache storage
       Cached checksums are stored as bolt database files under rclone cache  directory,  usually
       ~/.cache/rclone/kv/.    Databases   are  maintained  one  per  base  backend,  named  like
       BaseRemote~hasher.bolt.  Checksums for multiple alias-es into a single base  backend  will
       be  stored  in the single database.  All local paths are treated as aliases into the local
       backend (unless crypted or chunked) and  stored  in  ~/.cache/rclone/kv/local~hasher.bolt.
       Databases can be shared between multiple rclone processes.

HDFS

       HDFS                    (https://hadoop.apache.org/docs/stable/hadoop-project-dist/hadoop-
       hdfs/HdfsDesign.html)  is  a  distributed  file-system,  part   of   the   Apache   Hadoop
       (https://hadoop.apache.org/) framework.

       Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [skip]
              XX / Hadoop distributed file system
                 \ "hdfs"
              [skip]
              Storage> hdfs
              ** See help for hdfs backend at: https://rclone.org/hdfs/ **

              hadoop name node and port
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to host namenode at port 8020
                 \ "namenode:8020"
              namenode> namenode.hadoop:8020
              hadoop user name
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to hdfs as root
                 \ "root"
              username> root
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = hdfs
              namenode = namenode.hadoop:8020
              username = root
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              hadoop               hdfs

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all the top level directories

              rclone lsd remote:

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:directory

       Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

              rclone sync -i remote:directory /home/local/directory

   Setting up your own HDFS instance for testing
       You  may  start with a manual setup (https://hadoop.apache.org/docs/stable/hadoop-project-
       dist/hadoop-common/SingleCluster.html) or use the docker image from the tests:

       If you want to build the docker image

              git clone https://github.com/rclone/rclone.git
              cd rclone/fstest/testserver/images/test-hdfs
              docker build --rm -t rclone/test-hdfs .

       Or you can just use the latest one pushed

              docker run --rm --name "rclone-hdfs" -p 127.0.0.1:9866:9866 -p 127.0.0.1:8020:8020 --hostname "rclone-hdfs" rclone/test-hdfs

       NB it need few seconds to startup.

       For this docker image the remote needs to be configured like this:

              [remote]
              type = hdfs
              namenode = 127.0.0.1:8020
              username = root

       You can stop this image with docker kill rclone-hdfs (NB it does not use volumes,  so  all
       data uploaded will be lost.)

   Modified time
       Time accurate to 1 second is stored.

   Checksum
       No checksums are implemented.

   Usage information
       You  can  use  the  rclone  about  remote:  command which will display filesystem size and
       current usage.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       :           0x3A        :

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8).

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

   –hdfs-namenode
       Hadoop name node and port.

       E.g.  “namenode:8020” to connect to host namenode at port 8020.

       Properties:

       • Config: namenode

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_NAMENODE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –hdfs-username
       Hadoop user name.

       Properties:

       • Config: username

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_USERNAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “root”

           • Connect to hdfs as root.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

   –hdfs-service-principal-name
       Kerberos service principal name for the namenode.

       Enables KERBEROS authentication.  Specifies the Service Principal Name (SERVICE/FQDN)  for
       the  namenode.  E.g.  "hdfs/namenode.hadoop.docker" for namenode running as service `hdfs'
       with FQDN `namenode.hadoop.docker'.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_principal_name

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_NAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hdfs-data-transfer-protection
       Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy.

       Specifies whether or  not  authentication,  data  signature  integrity  checks,  and  wire
       encryption  is  required  when  communicating  the  the  datanodes.   Possible  values are
       `authentication', `integrity' and `privacy'.  Used only with KERBEROS enabled.

       Properties:

       • Config: data_transfer_protection

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_DATA_TRANSFER_PROTECTION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “privacy”

           • Ensure authentication, integrity and encryption enabled.

   –hdfs-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       • No server-side Move or DirMove.

       • Checksums not implemented.

HiDrive

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

       The  initial  setup for hidrive involves getting a token from HiDrive which you need to do
       in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found - make a new one
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / HiDrive
                 \ "hidrive"
              [snip]
              Storage> hidrive
              OAuth Client Id - Leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              OAuth Client Secret - Leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.
              Leave blank normally.
              scope_access>
              Edit advanced config?
              y/n> n
              Use auto config?
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = hidrive
              token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       You should be aware that OAuth-tokens can be used to access your account and hence  should
       not be shared with other persons. See the below section for more information.

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  HiDrive.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get
       back the verification code.  The webserver runs on http://127.0.0.1:53682/.  If local port
       53682  is  protected  by  a  firewall  you may need to temporarily unblock the firewall to
       complete authorization.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your HiDrive root folder

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your HiDrive filesystem

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a HiDrive directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Keeping your tokens safe
       Any OAuth-tokens  will  be  stored  by  rclone  in  the  remote’s  configuration  file  as
       unencrypted  text.  Anyone can use a valid refresh-token to access your HiDrive filesystem
       without knowing your password.  Therefore you should make sure no one else can access your
       configuration.

       It  is  possible  to  encrypt  rclone’s  configuration  file.  You can find information on
       securing  your  configuration  file  by  viewing   the   configuration   encryption   docs
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#configuration-encryption).

   Invalid refresh token
       As  can be verified here (https://developer.hidrive.com/basics-flows/), each refresh_token
       (for Native Applications) is valid for 60 days.  If used to access HiDrivei, its  validity
       will be automatically extended.

       This means that if you

       • Don’t use the HiDrive remote for 60 days

       then  rclone  will return an error which includes a text that implies the refresh token is
       invalid or expired.

       To fix this you will need to authorize rclone to access your HiDrive account again.

       Using

              rclone config reconnect remote:

       the process is very similar to the process of initial setup exemplified before.

   Modified time and hashes
       HiDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.

       HiDrive supports its own hash type (https://static.hidrive.com/dev/0001) which is used  to
       verify the integrity of file contents after successful transfers.

   Restricted filename characters
       HiDrive  cannot store files or folders that include / (0x2F) or null-bytes (0x00) in their
       name.  Any other characters can be used in the names of files or  folders.   Additionally,
       files or folders cannot be named either of the following: . or ..

       Therefore  rclone  will  automatically  replace  these characters, if files or folders are
       stored or accessed with such names.

       You can read about how this filename encoding works in general here.

       Keep in mind that HiDrive only supports  file  or  folder  names  with  a  length  of  255
       characters or less.

   Transfers
       HiDrive  limits  file sizes per single request to a maximum of 2 GiB.  To allow storage of
       larger files and allow for better upload performance,  the  hidrive  backend  will  use  a
       chunked  transfer  for files larger than 96 MiB.  Rclone will upload multiple parts/chunks
       of the file at the same time.  Chunks in the process of being  uploaded  are  buffered  in
       memory, so you may want to restrict this behaviour on systems with limited resources.

       You can customize this behaviour using the following options:

       • chunk_size: size of file parts

       • upload_cutoff: files larger or equal to this in size will use a chunked transfer

       • upload_concurrency: number of file-parts to upload at the same time

       See the below section about configuration options for more details.

   Root folder
       You can set the root folder for rclone.  This is the directory that rclone considers to be
       the root of your HiDrive.

       Usually, you will leave this blank, and rclone will use the root of the account.

       However, you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

       This works by prepending the contents of the root_prefix option to any paths  accessed  by
       rclone.  For example, the following two ways to access the home directory are equivalent:

              rclone lsd --hidrive-root-prefix="/users/test/" remote:path

              rclone lsd remote:/users/test/path

       See the below section about configuration options for more details.

   Directory member count
       By  default,  rclone  will  know the number of directory members contained in a directory.
       For example, rclone lsd uses this information.

       The acquisition of this information will result in additional  time  costs  for  HiDrive’s
       API.  When dealing with large directory structures, it may be desirable to circumvent this
       time cost, especially when this information is  not  explicitly  needed.   For  this,  the
       disable_fetching_member_count option can be used.

       See the below section about configuration options for more details.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to hidrive (HiDrive).

   –hidrive-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hidrive-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hidrive-scope-access
       Access permissions that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.

       Properties:

       • Config: scope_access

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_SCOPE_ACCESS

       • Type: string

       • Default: “rw”

       • Examples:

         • “rw”

           • Read and write access to resources.

         • “ro”

           • Read-only access to resources.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to hidrive (HiDrive).

   –hidrive-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hidrive-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hidrive-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –hidrive-scope-role
       User-level that rclone should use when requesting access from HiDrive.

       Properties:

       • Config: scope_role

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_SCOPE_ROLE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “user”

       • Examples:

         • “user”

           • User-level access to management permissions.

           • This will be sufficient in most cases.

         • “admin”

           • Extensive access to management permissions.

         • “owner”

           • Full access to management permissions.

   –hidrive-root-prefix
       The root/parent folder for all paths.

       Fill in to use the specified folder as the parent for all paths given to the remote.  This
       way rclone can use any folder as its starting point.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_prefix

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ROOT_PREFIX

       • Type: string

       • Default: “/”

       • Examples:

         • “/”

           • The topmost directory accessible by rclone.

           • This will be equivalent with “root” if rclone uses a regular HiDrive user account.

         • “root”

           • The topmost directory of the HiDrive user account

         • “”

           • This specifies that there is no root-prefix for your paths.

           • When using this you will always need to specify paths to this remote  with  a  valid
             parent e.g. “remote:/path/to/dir” or “remote:root/path/to/dir”.

   –hidrive-endpoint
       Endpoint for the service.

       This is the URL that API-calls will be made to.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “https://api.hidrive.strato.com/2.1”

   –hidrive-disable-fetching-member-count
       Do not fetch number of objects in directories unless it is absolutely necessary.

       Requests may be faster if the number of objects in subdirectories is not fetched.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_fetching_member_count

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_DISABLE_FETCHING_MEMBER_COUNT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –hidrive-chunk-size
       Chunksize for chunked uploads.

       Any files larger than the configured cutoff (or files of unknown size) will be uploaded in
       chunks of this size.

       The upper limit for this is 2147483647 bytes (about 2.000Gi).  That is the maximum  amount
       of bytes a single upload-operation will support.  Setting this above the upper limit or to
       a negative value will cause uploads to fail.

       Setting this to larger values may increase the upload speed at  the  cost  of  using  more
       memory.  It can be set to smaller values smaller to save on memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 48Mi

   –hidrive-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff/Threshold for chunked uploads.

       Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of the configured chunksize.

       The  upper limit for this is 2147483647 bytes (about 2.000Gi).  That is the maximum amount
       of bytes a single upload-operation will support.  Setting this above the upper limit  will
       cause uploads to fail.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 96Mi

   –hidrive-upload-concurrency
       Concurrency for chunked uploads.

       This is the upper limit for how many transfers for the same file are running concurrently.
       Setting this above to a value smaller than 1 will cause uploads to deadlock.

       If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these  uploads
       do  not  fully  utilize  your  bandwidth,  then  increasing  this may help to speed up the
       transfers.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 4

   –hidrive-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HIDRIVE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Dot

   Limitations
   Symbolic links
       HiDrive  is  able to store symbolic links (symlinks) by design, for example, when unpacked
       from a zip archive.

       There exists no direct mechanism to manage native  symlinks  in  remotes.   As  such  this
       implementation  has  chosen  to  ignore any native symlinks present in the remote.  rclone
       will not be able to access or show any symlinks stored in the hidrive-remote.  This  means
       symlinks  cannot be individually removed, copied, or moved, except when removing, copying,
       or moving the parent folder.

       This does not affect the .rclonelink-files that rclone uses to encode and  store  symbolic
       links.

   Sparse files
       It is possible to store sparse files in HiDrive.

       Note  that  copying a sparse file will expand the holes into null-byte (0x00) regions that
       will then consume disk space.  Likewise, when downloading a  sparse  file,  the  resulting
       file will have null-byte regions in the place of file holes.

HTTP

       The  HTTP  remote  is  a read only remote for reading files of a webserver.  The webserver
       should provide file listings which rclone will read and turn into a remote.  This has been
       tested  with  common  webservers such as Apache/Nginx/Caddy and will likely work with file
       listings from most web servers.  (If it doesn’t then please file an issue, or send a  pull
       request!)

       Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path.

       The  remote:  represents  the  configured  url, and any path following it will be resolved
       relative to this url,  according  to  the  URL  standard.   This  means  with  remote  url
       https://beta.rclone.org/branch    and    path    fix,    the    resolved   URL   will   be
       https://beta.rclone.org/branch/fix,  while  with  path  /fix  the  resolved  URL  will  be
       https://beta.rclone.org/fix as the absolute path is resolved from the root of the domain.

       If  the path following the remote: ends with / it will be assumed to point to a directory.
       If the path does not end with /, then a HEAD request is sent  and  the  response  used  to
       decide  if  it it is treated as a file or a directory (run with -vv to see details).  When
       –http-no-head is specified, a path without ending / is always assumed to be  a  file.   If
       rclone  incorrectly  assumes  the path is a file, the solution is to specify the path with
       ending /.  When you know the path is a directory, ending it with / is always better as  it
       avoids the initial HEAD request.

       To    just    download    a    single    file    it    is    easier    to    use   copyurl
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_copyurl/).

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / HTTP
                 \ "http"
              [snip]
              Storage> http
              URL of http host to connect to
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to example.com
                 \ "https://example.com"
              url> https://beta.rclone.org
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              url = https://beta.rclone.org
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              remote               http

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all the top level directories

              rclone lsd remote:

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:directory

       Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

              rclone sync -i remote:directory /home/local/directory

   Read only
       This remote is read only - you can’t upload files to an HTTP server.

   Modified time
       Most HTTP servers store time accurate to 1 second.

   Checksum
       No checksums are stored.

   Usage without a config file
       Since the http remote only has one config parameter it is easy to  use  without  a  config
       file:

              rclone lsd --http-url https://beta.rclone.org :http:

       or:

              rclone lsd :http,url='https://beta.rclone.org':

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to http (HTTP).

   –http-url
       URL of HTTP host to connect to.

       E.g.   “https://example.com”,  or  “https://user:pass@example.com”  to  use a username and
       password.

       Properties:

       • Config: url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to http (HTTP).

   –http-headers
       Set HTTP headers for all transactions.

       Use this to set additional HTTP headers for all transactions.

       The input format is comma separated  list  of  key,value  pairs.   Standard  CSV  encoding
       (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) may be used.

       For example, to set a Cookie use `Cookie,name=value', or `“Cookie”,“name=value”'.

       You can set multiple headers, e.g. `“Cookie”,“name=value”,“Authorization”,“xxx”'.

       Properties:

       • Config: headers

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_HEADERS

       • Type: CommaSepList

       • Default:

   –http-no-slash
       Set this if the site doesn’t end directories with /.

       Use this if your target website does not use / on the end of directories.

       A  /  on  the  end of a path is how rclone normally tells the difference between files and
       directories.  If this flag is set, then rclone will treat  all  files  with  Content-Type:
       text/html as directories and read URLs from them rather than downloading them.

       Note that this may cause rclone to confuse genuine HTML files with directories.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_slash

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_SLASH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –http-no-head
       Don’t use HEAD requests.

       HEAD  requests  are  mainly used to find file sizes in dir listing.  If your site is being
       very slow to load then you can try this option.  Normally rclone does a HEAD  request  for
       each potential file in a directory listing to:

       • find its size

       • check it really exists

       • check to see if it is a directory

       If  you  set  this  option,  rclone  will  not  do  the HEAD request.  This will mean that
       directory listings are much quicker, but rclone won’t have  the  times  or  sizes  of  any
       files, and some files that don’t exist may be in the listing.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_head

       • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_HEAD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Limitations
       rclone  about  is  not  supported  by  the HTTP backend.  Backends without this capability
       cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space)  as  a
       member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Internet Archive

       The Internet Archive backend utilizes Items on archive.org (https://archive.org/)

       Refer  to IAS3 API documentation (https://archive.org/services/docs/api/ias3.html) for the
       API this backend uses.

       Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote:  for  the  lsd  command.)   You  may  put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:item/path/to/dir.

       Unlike S3, listing up all items uploaded by you isn’t supported.

       Once you have made a remote, you can use it like this:

       Make a new item

              rclone mkdir remote:item

       List the contents of a item

              rclone ls remote:item

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote item, deleting any excess files in the item.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:item

   Notes
       Because  of Internet Archive’s architecture, it enqueues write operations (and extra post-
       processings)   in   a   per-item   queue.     You    can    check    item’s    queue    at
       https://catalogd.archive.org/history/item-name-here    .     Because    of    that,    all
       uploads/deletes will not show up immediately and takes some time  to  be  available.   The
       per-item  queue  is  enqueued  to an another queue, Item Deriver Queue.  You can check the
       status of Item Deriver Queue  here.  (https://catalogd.archive.org/catalog.php?whereami=1)
       This queue has a limit, and it may block you from uploading, or even deleting.  You should
       avoid uploading a lot of small files for better behavior.

       You can optionally wait for the server’s processing to finish, by setting  non-zero  value
       to  wait_archive key.  By making it wait, rclone can do normal file comparison.  Make sure
       to set a large enough value (e.g. 30m0s for smaller files) as it  can  take  a  long  time
       depending on server’s queue.

   About metadata
       This  backend  supports setting, updating and reading metadata of each file.  The metadata
       will appear as file metadata on Internet Archive.  However, some fields  are  reserved  by
       both Internet Archive and rclone.

       The  following  are  reserved  by Internet Archive: - name - source - size - md5 - crc32 -
       sha1 - format - old_version - viruscheck - summation

       Trying to set values to these keys is ignored with a warning.  Only setting  mtime  is  an
       exception.  Doing so make it the identical behavior as setting ModTime.

       rclone  reserves  all  the  keys starting with rclone-.  Setting value for these keys will
       give you warnings, but values are set according to request.

       If there are multiple values for a key, only  the  first  one  is  returned.   This  is  a
       limitation  of  rclone, that supports one value per one key.  It can be triggered when you
       did a server-side copy.

       Reading metadata will also provide custom (non-standard nor reserved) ones.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making an internetarchive configuration.  Most applies to the  other
       providers as well, any differences are described below.

       First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              XX / InternetArchive Items
                 \ (internetarchive)
              Storage> internetarchive
              Option access_key_id.
              IAS3 Access Key.
              Leave blank for anonymous access.
              You can find one here: https://archive.org/account/s3.php
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              access_key_id> XXXX
              Option secret_access_key.
              IAS3 Secret Key (password).
              Leave blank for anonymous access.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              secret_access_key> XXXX
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> y
              Option endpoint.
              IAS3 Endpoint.
              Leave blank for default value.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (https://s3.us.archive.org).
              endpoint>
              Option front_endpoint.
              Host of InternetArchive Frontend.
              Leave blank for default value.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (https://archive.org).
              front_endpoint>
              Option disable_checksum.
              Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.
              Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before
              uploading it so it can ask the server to check the object against checksum.
              This is great for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for
              large files to start uploading.
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default (true).
              disable_checksum> true
              Option encoding.
              The encoding for the backend.
              See the [encoding section in the overview](https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more info.
              Enter a encoder.MultiEncoder value. Press Enter for the default (Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot).
              encoding>
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = internetarchive
              access_key_id = XXXX
              secret_access_key = XXXX
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to internetarchive (Internet Archive).

   –internetarchive-access-key-id
       IAS3 Access Key.

       Leave     blank     for     anonymous     access.      You     can    find    one    here:
       https://archive.org/account/s3.php

       Properties:

       • Config: access_key_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ACCESS_KEY_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –internetarchive-secret-access-key
       IAS3 Secret Key (password).

       Leave blank for anonymous access.

       Properties:

       • Config: secret_access_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to internetarchive (Internet Archive).

   –internetarchive-endpoint
       IAS3 Endpoint.

       Leave blank for default value.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “https://s3.us.archive.org”

   –internetarchive-front-endpoint
       Host of InternetArchive Frontend.

       Leave blank for default value.

       Properties:

       • Config: front_endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_FRONT_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “https://archive.org”

   –internetarchive-disable-checksum
       Don’t ask the server to test against MD5 checksum calculated by rclone.   Normally  rclone
       will  calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can ask the server
       to check the object against checksum.  This is great for data integrity checking  but  can
       cause long delays for large files to start uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_checksum

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –internetarchive-wait-archive
       Timeout  for  waiting  the server’s processing tasks (specifically archive and book_op) to
       finish.  Only enable if you need to be guaranteed to be reflected after write  operations.
       0 to disable waiting.  No errors to be thrown in case of timeout.

       Properties:

       • Config: wait_archive

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_WAIT_ARCHIVE

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 0s

   –internetarchive-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_INTERNETARCHIVE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,LtGt,CrLf,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Metadata
       Metadata fields provided by Internet Archive.  If there are multiple  values  for  a  key,
       only  the  first one is returned.  This is a limitation of Rclone, that supports one value
       per one key.

       Owner is able to add custom keys.  Metadata feature grabs all the keys including them.

       Here are the possible system metadata items for the internetarchive backend.

       Name          Help                               Type          Example                                      Read Only
       ─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       crc32         CRC32                              string        01234567                                     Y
                     calculated
                     by Internet
                     Archive
       format        Name     of                        string        Comma-Separated                              Y
                     format                                           Values
                     identified
                     by Internet
                     Archive
       md5           MD5    hash                        string        01234567012345670123456701234567             Y
                     calculated
                     by Internet
                     Archive
       mtime         Time     of                        RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z               Y
                     last
                     modification,
                     managed  by
                     Rclone
       name          Full     file                      filename      backend/internetarchive/internetarchive.go   Y
                     path, without
                     the    bucket
                     part
       old_version   Whether   the                      boolean       true                                         Y
                     file      was
                     replaced  and
                     moved      by
                     keep-old-
                     version flag
       rclone-ia-    Time of  last                      RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z               N
       mtime         modification,
                     managed    by
                     Internet
                     Archive
       rclone-       Time  of last                      RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z               N
       mtime         modification,
                     managed    by
                     Rclone
       rclone-       Random  value                      string        aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa             N
       update-       used       by
       track         Rclone    for
                     tracking
                     changes
                     inside
                     Internet
                     Archive
       sha1          SHA1     hash                      string        0123456701234567012345670123456701234567     Y
                     calculated by
                     Internet
                     Archive
       size          File size  in                      decimal       123456                                       Y
                     bytes                              number
       source        The source of                      string        original                                     Y
                     the file
       summation     Check                              string        md5                                          Y
                     https://forum.rclone.org/t/31922
                     for how it is
                     used
       viruscheck    The last time viruscheck process   unixtime      1654191352                                   Y
                     was run for the file (?)

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

Jottacloud

       Jottacloud  is  a  cloud  storage service provider from a Norwegian company, using its own
       datacenters  in  Norway.   In  addition  to  the  official   service   at   jottacloud.com
       (https://www.jottacloud.com/),   it  also  provides  white-label  solutions  to  different
       companies, such as: * Telia * Telia Cloud (cloud.telia.se) * Telia  Sky  (sky.telia.no)  *
       Tele2  *  Tele2  Cloud  (mittcloud.tele2.se)  * Elkjøp (with subsidiaries): * Elkjøp Cloud
       (cloud.elkjop.no)  *  Elgiganten  Sweden  (cloud.elgiganten.se)   *   Elgiganten   Denmark
       (cloud.elgiganten.dk) * Giganti Cloud (cloud.gigantti.fi) * ELKO Cloud (cloud.elko.is)

       Most  of  the  white-label  versions  are  supported by this backend, although may require
       different authentication setup - described below.

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Authentication types
       Some of the whitelabel versions uses a different authentication method than  the  official
       service, and you have to choose the correct one when setting up the remote.

   Standard authentication
       The  standard authentication method used by the official service (jottacloud.com), as well
       as some of the whitelabel services, requires you to generate a single-use  personal  login
       token  from  the account security settings in the service’s web interface.  Log in to your
       account, go to “Settings” and then “Security”, or use the direct link presented to you  by
       rclone  when configuring the remote: <https://www.jottacloud.com/web/secure>.  Scroll down
       to the section “Personal login token”, and click the “Generate” button.  Note that if  you
       are  using  a  whitelabel service you probably can’t use the direct link, you need to find
       the same page in their dedicated web interface, and also it may be in a different location
       than described above.

       To  access  your  account from multiple instances of rclone, you need to configure each of
       them with a separate personal login token.  E.g.  you  create  a  Jottacloud  remote  with
       rclone  in  one  location,  and copy the configuration file to a second location where you
       also want to run rclone and access the same remote.  Then you need to  replace  the  token
       for        one        of        them,        using        the       config       reconnect
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_reconnect/)  command,  which  requires  you  to
       generate a new personal login token and supply as input.  If you do not do this, the token
       may easily end up being invalidated, resulting in both instances  failing  with  an  error
       message something along the lines of:

              oauth2: cannot fetch token: 400 Bad Request
              Response: {"error":"invalid_grant","error_description":"Stale token"}

       When this happens, you need to replace the token as described above to be able to use your
       remote again.

       All personal login tokens you have taken into use will be  listed  in  the  web  interface
       under  “My  logged in devices”, and from the right side of that list you can click the “X”
       button to revoke individual tokens.

   Legacy authentication
       If you are using one of the whitelabel versions (e.g. from Elkjøp) you may  not  have  the
       option   to  generate  a  CLI  token.   In  this  case  you’ll  have  to  use  the  legacy
       authentication.  To do this select yes when the setup asks for legacy  authentication  and
       enter  your  username  and  password.   The  rest of the setup is identical to the default
       setup.

   Telia Cloud authentication
       Similar to other whitelabel versions Telia Cloud doesn’t offer the option  of  creating  a
       CLI  token,  and  additionally  uses  a separate authentication flow where the username is
       generated  internally.   To  setup  rclone  to  use  Telia  Cloud,  choose   Telia   Cloud
       authentication in the setup.  The rest of the setup is identical to the default setup.

   Tele2 Cloud authentication
       As  Tele2-Com  Hem merger was completed this authentication can be used for former Com Hem
       Cloud and Tele2 Cloud customers as no  support  for  creating  a  CLI  token  exists,  and
       additionally  uses  a  separate  authentication  flow  where  the  username  is  generated
       internally.  To setup rclone to use Tele2 Cloud, choose Tele2 Cloud authentication in  the
       setup.  The rest of the setup is identical to the default setup.

   Configuration
       Here  is  an  example of how to make a remote called remote with the default setup.  First
       run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              XX / Jottacloud
                 \ (jottacloud)
              [snip]
              Storage> jottacloud
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Option config_type.
              Select authentication type.
              Choose a number from below, or type in an existing string value.
              Press Enter for the default (standard).
                 / Standard authentication.
               1 | Use this if you're a normal Jottacloud user.
                 \ (standard)
                 / Legacy authentication.
               2 | This is only required for certain whitelabel versions of Jottacloud and not recommended for normal users.
                 \ (legacy)
                 / Telia Cloud authentication.
               3 | Use this if you are using Telia Cloud.
                 \ (telia)
                 / Tele2 Cloud authentication.
               4 | Use this if you are using Tele2 Cloud.
                 \ (tele2)
              config_type> 1
              Personal login token.
              Generate here: https://www.jottacloud.com/web/secure
              Login Token> <your token here>
              Use a non-standard device/mountpoint?
              Choosing no, the default, will let you access the storage used for the archive
              section of the official Jottacloud client. If you instead want to access the
              sync or the backup section, for example, you must choose yes.
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> y
              Option config_device.
              The device to use. In standard setup the built-in Jotta device is used,
              which contains predefined mountpoints for archive, sync etc. All other devices
              are treated as backup devices by the official Jottacloud client. You may create
              a new by entering a unique name.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
              Press Enter for the default (DESKTOP-3H31129).
               1 > DESKTOP-3H31129
               2 > Jotta
              config_device> 2
              Option config_mountpoint.
              The mountpoint to use for the built-in device Jotta.
              The standard setup is to use the Archive mountpoint. Most other mountpoints
              have very limited support in rclone and should generally be avoided.
              Choose a number from below, or type in an existing string value.
              Press Enter for the default (Archive).
               1 > Archive
               2 > Shared
               3 > Sync
              config_mountpoint> 1
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = jottacloud
              configVersion = 1
              client_id = jottacli
              client_secret =
              tokenURL = https://id.jottacloud.com/auth/realms/jottacloud/protocol/openid-connect/token
              token = {........}
              username = 2940e57271a93d987d6f8a21
              device = Jotta
              mountpoint = Archive
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Jottacloud

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Jottacloud

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Jottacloud directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Devices and Mountpoints
       The official Jottacloud client registers a device for each computer you install it on, and
       shows  them  in  the backup section of the user interface.  For each folder you select for
       backup it will create a mountpoint within this device.  A built-in device called Jotta  is
       special,  and  contains  mountpoints Archive, Sync and some others, used for corresponding
       features in official clients.

       With rclone you’ll want to use the standard Jotta/Archive device/mountpoint in most cases.
       However,  you  may  for example want to access files from the sync or backup functionality
       provided by the official clients, and rclone therefore provides the option to select other
       devices and mountpoints during config.

       You  are  allowed  to create new devices and mountpoints.  All devices except the built-in
       Jotta device are treated as  backup  devices  by  official  Jottacloud  clients,  and  the
       mountpoints on them are individual backup sets.

       With  the built-in Jotta device, only existing, built-in, mountpoints can be selected.  In
       addition to the mentioned Archive and Sync, it may contain several other mountpoints  such
       as:  Latest,  Links,  Shared  and  Trash.   All  of  these  are special mountpoints with a
       different internal representation than the “regular” mountpoints.  Rclone will only  to  a
       very  limited degree support them.  Generally you should avoid these, unless you know what
       you are doing.

   –fast-list
       This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer  transactions  in  exchange
       for  more  memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more
       details.

       Note that the implementation in Jottacloud always uses only a single API  request  to  get
       the  entire  list, so for large folders this could lead to long wait time before the first
       results are shown.

       Note  also  that  with  rclone  version  1.58  and  newer  information  about  MIME  types
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#mime-type) are not available when using --fast-list.

   Modified time and hashes
       Jottacloud  allows  modification  times  to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These
       will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

       Jottacloud supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum flag.

       Note that Jottacloud requires the MD5 hash before upload so if the source does not have an
       MD5 checksum then the file will be cached temporarily on disk (in location given by –temp-
       dir (https://rclone.org/docs/#temp-dir-dir)) before it is uploaded.  Small files  will  be
       cached  in  memory - see the –jottacloud-md5-memory-limit flag.  When uploading from local
       disk the source checksum is always available, so  this  does  not  apply.   Starting  with
       rclone  version  1.52  the  same  is true for crypted remotes (in older versions the crypt
       backend would not calculate hashes for uploads from local disk, so the Jottacloud  backend
       had to do it as described above).

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       ”           0x22        "
       *           0x2A        *
       :           0x3A        :
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       |           0x7C        |

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in XML strings.

   Deleting files
       By default, rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting  files.   They  will  be
       permanently deleted automatically after 30 days.  You may bypass the trash and permanently
       delete files immediately by using the –jottacloud-hard-delete flag, or set the  equivalent
       environment    variable.     Emptying    the   trash   is   supported   by   the   cleanup
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_cleanup/) command.

   Versions
       Jottacloud supports file versioning.  When rclone uploads a  new  version  of  a  file  it
       creates  a  new  version  of  it.   Currently  rclone only supports retrieving the current
       version but older versions can be accessed via the Jottacloud Website.

       Versioning can be disabled  by  --jottacloud-no-versions  option.   This  is  achieved  by
       deleting  the  remote  file  prior to uploading a new version.  If the upload the fails no
       version of the file will be available in the remote.

   Quota information
       To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display
       your usage limit (unless it is unlimited) and the current usage.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to jottacloud (Jottacloud).

   –jottacloud-md5-memory-limit
       Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required.

       Properties:

       • Config: md5_memory_limit

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_MD5_MEMORY_LIMIT

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 10Mi

   –jottacloud-trashed-only
       Only show files that are in the trash.

       This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

       Properties:

       • Config: trashed_only

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_TRASHED_ONLY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –jottacloud-hard-delete
       Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

       Properties:

       • Config: hard_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_HARD_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –jottacloud-upload-resume-limit
       Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail’s.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_resume_limit

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_UPLOAD_RESUME_LIMIT

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 10Mi

   –jottacloud-no-versions
       Avoid server side versioning by deleting files and recreating files instead of overwriting
       them.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_versions

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_NO_VERSIONS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –jottacloud-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note  that  Jottacloud is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and
       one called “hello.doc”.

       There are quite a few characters that can’t be in Jottacloud file names.  Rclone will  map
       these  names  to  and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.  For example if a file
       has a ?  in it will be mapped to ? instead.

       Jottacloud only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

   Troubleshooting
       Jottacloud exhibits some inconsistent behaviours regarding deleted files and folders which
       may cause Copy, Move and DirMove operations to previously deleted paths to fail.  Emptying
       the trash should help in such cases.

Koofr

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for Koofr involves creating an application password for rclone.  You can
       do        that        by        opening        the       Koofr       web       application
       (https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password), giving the password  a  nice  name
       like rclone and clicking on generate.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called koofr.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> koofr
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
                 \ (koofr)
              [snip]
              Storage> koofr
              Option provider.
              Choose your storage provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
                 \ (koofr)
               2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
                 \ (digistorage)
               3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
                 \ (other)
              provider> 1
              Option user.
              Your user name.
              Enter a value.
              user> USERNAME
              Option password.
              Your password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password).
              Choose an alternative below.
              y) Yes, type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [koofr]
              type = koofr
              provider = koofr
              user = USERNAME
              password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       You  can  choose to edit advanced config in order to enter your own service URL if you use
       an on-premise or white label Koofr instance, or choose an  alternative  mount  instead  of
       your primary storage.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Koofr

              rclone lsd koofr:

       List all the files in your Koofr

              rclone ls koofr:

       To copy a local directory to an Koofr directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source koofr:backup

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in XML strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to koofr (Koofr,  Digi  Storage  and  other  Koofr-
       compatible storage providers).

   –koofr-provider
       Choose your storage provider.

       Properties:

       • Config: provider

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PROVIDER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “koofr”

           • Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/

         • “digistorage”

           • Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/

         • “other”

           • Any other Koofr API compatible storage service

   –koofr-endpoint
       The Koofr API endpoint to use.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_ENDPOINT

       • Provider: other

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –koofr-user
       Your user name.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –koofr-password
       Your          password         for         rclone         (generate         one         at
       https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password).

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

       • Provider: koofr

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –koofr-password
       Your     password     for     rclone     (generate     one     at     https://storage.rcs-
       rds.ro/app/admin/preferences/password).

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

       • Provider: digistorage

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –koofr-password
       Your password for rclone (generate one at your service’s settings page).

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD

       • Provider: other

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to koofr (Koofr,  Digi  Storage  and  other  Koofr-
       compatible storage providers).

   –koofr-mountid
       Mount ID of the mount to use.

       If omitted, the primary mount is used.

       Properties:

       • Config: mountid

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_MOUNTID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –koofr-setmtime
       Does the backend support setting modification time.

       Set this to false if you use a mount ID that points to a Dropbox or Amazon Drive backend.

       Properties:

       • Config: setmtime

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_SETMTIME

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –koofr-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note that Koofr is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called  “Hello.doc”  and  one
       called “hello.doc”.

   Providers
   Koofr
       This  is  the  original Koofr (https://koofr.eu) storage provider used as main example and
       described in the configuration section above.

   Digi Storage
       Digi Storage (https://www.digi.ro/servicii/online/digi-storage) is a cloud storage service
       run by Digi.ro (https://www.digi.ro/) that provides a Koofr API.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called ds.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> ds
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
                 \ (koofr)
              [snip]
              Storage> koofr
              Option provider.
              Choose your storage provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
                 \ (koofr)
               2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
                 \ (digistorage)
               3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
                 \ (other)
              provider> 2
              Option user.
              Your user name.
              Enter a value.
              user> USERNAME
              Option password.
              Your password for rclone (generate one at https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/app/admin/preferences/password).
              Choose an alternative below.
              y) Yes, type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [ds]
              type = koofr
              provider = digistorage
              user = USERNAME
              password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Other
       You may also want to use another, public or private storage provider that runs a Koofr API
       compatible service, by simply providing the base URL to connect to.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called other.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> other
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              22 / Koofr, Digi Storage and other Koofr-compatible storage providers
                 \ (koofr)
              [snip]
              Storage> koofr
              Option provider.
              Choose your storage provider.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              Press Enter to leave empty.
               1 / Koofr, https://app.koofr.net/
                 \ (koofr)
               2 / Digi Storage, https://storage.rcs-rds.ro/
                 \ (digistorage)
               3 / Any other Koofr API compatible storage service
                 \ (other)
              provider> 3
              Option endpoint.
              The Koofr API endpoint to use.
              Enter a value.
              endpoint> https://koofr.other.org
              Option user.
              Your user name.
              Enter a value.
              user> USERNAME
              Option password.
              Your password for rclone (generate one at your service's settings page).
              Choose an alternative below.
              y) Yes, type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [other]
              type = koofr
              provider = other
              endpoint = https://koofr.other.org
              user = USERNAME
              password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

Mail.ru Cloud

       Mail.ru Cloud (https://cloud.mail.ru/) is a cloud storage provided by a  Russian  internet
       company   Mail.Ru  Group  (https://mail.ru).   The  official  desktop  client  is  Disk-O:
       (https://disk-o.cloud/en), available on Windows and Mac OS.

       Currently it is recommended to disable 2FA on Mail.ru accounts intended for  rclone  until
       it gets eventually implemented.

   Features highlights
       • Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory

       • Files have a last modified time property, directories don’t

       • Deleted files are by default moved to the trash

       • Files and directories can be shared via public links

       • Partial uploads or streaming are not supported, file size must be known before upload

       • Maximum file size is limited to 2G for a free account, unlimited for paid accounts

       • Storage  keeps  hash  for  all  files  and  performs transparent deduplication, the hash
         algorithm is a modified SHA1

       • If a particular file is already present in storage, one can  quickly  submit  file  hash
         instead of long file upload (this optimization is supported by rclone)

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a mailru configuration.

       First create a Mail.ru Cloud account and choose a tariff.

       You  will need to log in and create an app password for rclone.  Rclone will not work with
       your normal username and password - it will give an error  like  oauth2:  server  response
       missing access_token.

       • Click on your user icon in the top right

       • Go to Security / “Пароль и безопасность”

       • Click password for apps / “Пароли для внешних приложений”

       • Add the password - give it a name - eg “rclone”

       • Copy the password and use this password below - your normal login password won’t work.

       Now run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Mail.ru Cloud
                 \ "mailru"
              [snip]
              Storage> mailru
              User name (usually email)
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              user> username@mail.ru
              Password

              This must be an app password - rclone will not work with your normal
              password. See the Configuration section in the docs for how to make an
              app password.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.
              This feature is called "speedup" or "put by hash". It is especially efficient
              in case of generally available files like popular books, video or audio clips
              [snip]
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enable
                 \ "true"
               2 / Disable
                 \ "false"
              speedup_enable> 1
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = mailru
              user = username@mail.ru
              pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              speedup_enable = true
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Configuration  of  this  backend  does  not  require a local web browser.  You can use the
       configured backend as shown below:

       See top level directories

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new directory

              rclone mkdir remote:directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:directory

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

   Modified time
       Files support a modification time attribute with up to 1 second precision.  Directories do
       not have a modification time, which is shown as “Jan 1 1970”.

   Hash checksums
       Hash  sums  use  a  custom  Mail.ru algorithm based on SHA1.  If file size is less than or
       equal to the SHA1 block size (20 bytes), its hash is simply  its  data  right-padded  with
       zero  bytes.   Hash  sum of a larger file is computed as a SHA1 sum of the file data bytes
       concatenated with a decimal representation of the data length.

   Emptying Trash
       Removing a file or directory actually moves it to the  trash,  which  is  not  visible  to
       rclone  but  can  be seen in a web browser.  The trashed file still occupies part of total
       quota.  If you wish to empty your trash and free  some  quota,  you  can  use  the  rclone
       cleanup  remote:  command,  which  will  permanently  delete all your trashed files.  This
       command does not take any path arguments.

   Quota information
       To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display
       your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       ”           0x22        "
       *           0x2A        *
       :           0x3A        :
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       \           0x5C        \
       |           0x7C        |

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

   –mailru-user
       User name (usually email).

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –mailru-pass
       Password.

       This must be an app password - rclone will not work with your normal  password.   See  the
       Configuration section in the docs for how to make an app password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –mailru-speedup-enable
       Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.

       This feature is called “speedup” or “put by hash”.  It is especially efficient in case  of
       generally  available  files  like  popular  books, video or audio clips, because files are
       searched by hash in all accounts of all mailru users.  It is meaningless  and  ineffective
       if  source file is unique or encrypted.  Please note that rclone may need local memory and
       disk space to calculate content  hash  in  advance  and  decide  whether  full  upload  is
       required.   Also,  if rclone does not know file size in advance (e.g. in case of streaming
       or partial uploads), it will not even try this optimization.

       Properties:

       • Config: speedup_enable

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_ENABLE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Enable

         • “false”

           • Disable

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

   –mailru-speedup-file-patterns
       Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash).

       Patterns are case insensitive and can contain ’*’ or `?' meta characters.

       Properties:

       • Config: speedup_file_patterns

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_FILE_PATTERNS

       • Type: string

       • Default: “.mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3,.zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf”

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Empty list completely disables speedup (put by hash).

         • “*”

           • All files will be attempted for speedup.

         • “.mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3”

           • Only common audio/video files will be tried for put by hash.

         • “.zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf”

           • Only common archives or PDF books will be tried for speedup.

   –mailru-speedup-max-disk
       This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files.

       Reason is that preliminary hashing can exhaust your RAM or disk space.

       Properties:

       • Config: speedup_max_disk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_DISK

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 3Gi

       • Examples:

         • “0”

           • Completely disable speedup (put by hash).

         • “1G”

           • Files larger than 1Gb will be uploaded directly.

         • “3G”

           • Choose this option if you have less than 3Gb free on local disk.

   –mailru-speedup-max-memory
       Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk.

       Properties:

       • Config: speedup_max_memory

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_MEMORY

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 32Mi

       • Examples:

         • “0”

           • Preliminary hashing will always be done in a temporary disk location.

         • “32M”

           • Do not dedicate more than 32Mb RAM for preliminary hashing.

         • “256M”

           • You have at most 256Mb RAM free for hash calculations.

   –mailru-check-hash
       What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid.

       Properties:

       • Config: check_hash

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_CHECK_HASH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Fail with error.

         • “false”

           • Ignore and continue.

   –mailru-user-agent
       HTTP user agent used internally by client.

       Defaults to “rclone/VERSION” or “–user-agent” provided on command line.

       Properties:

       • Config: user_agent

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER_AGENT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –mailru-quirks
       Comma separated list of internal maintenance flags.

       This option must not be used by an ordinary user.   It  is  intended  only  to  facilitate
       remote  troubleshooting  of backend issues.  Strict meaning of flags is not documented and
       not guaranteed to persist between releases.  Quirks will be removed when the backend grows
       stable.  Supported quirks: atomicmkdir binlist unknowndirs

       Properties:

       • Config: quirks

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_QUIRKS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –mailru-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       File  size  limits depend on your account.  A single file size is limited by 2G for a free
       account and unlimited for paid tariffs.  Please refer to the Mail.ru site  for  the  total
       uploaded size limits.

       Note  that  Mailru is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and one
       called “hello.doc”.

Mega

       Mega (https://mega.nz/) is a cloud storage and file hosting service known for its security
       feature  where  all  files  are encrypted locally before they are uploaded.  This prevents
       anyone (including employees of Mega) from accessing the files without knowledge of the key
       used for encryption.

       This is an rclone backend for Mega which supports the file transfer features of Mega using
       the same client side encryption.

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Mega
                 \ "mega"
              [snip]
              Storage> mega
              User name
              user> you@example.com
              Password.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank
              y/g/n> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = mega
              user = you@example.com
              pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       NOTE: The encryption keys need to have been already generated after a  regular  login  via
       the browser, otherwise attempting to use the credentials in rclone will fail.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Mega

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Mega

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Mega directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       Mega does not support modification times or hashes yet.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Duplicated files
       Mega can have two files with exactly the same name and path (unlike a normal file system).

       Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will  see  messages  in  the  log
       about duplicates.

       Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

   Failure to log-in
   Object not found
       If  you  are  connecting  to  your  Mega  remote  for  the  first time, to test access and
       synchronization, you may receive an error such as

              Failed to create file system for "my-mega-remote:":
              couldn't login: Object (typically, node or user) not found

       The     diagnostic     steps     often     recommended     in     the     rclone     forum
       (https://forum.rclone.org/search?q=mega)  start  with the MEGAcmd utility.  Note that this
       refers to the official C++ command from https://github.com/meganz/MEGAcmd and not  the  go
       language built command from t3rm1n4l/megacmd that is no longer maintained.

       Follow  the  instructions  for  installing  MEGAcmd  and try accessing your remote as they
       recommend.  You can establish whether or not you can log  in  using  MEGAcmd,  and  obtain
       diagnostic information to help you, and search or work with others in the forum.

              MEGA CMD> login me@example.com
              Password:
              Fetching nodes ...
              Loading transfers from local cache
              Login complete as me@example.com
              me@example.com:/$

       Note that some have found issues with passwords containing special characters.  If you can
       not log on with rclone, but MEGAcmd  logs  on  just  fine,  then  consider  changing  your
       password temporarily to pure alphanumeric characters, in case that helps.

   Repeated commands blocks access
       Mega remotes seem to get blocked (reject logins) under “heavy use”.  We haven’t worked out
       the exact blocking rules but it seems to be  related  to  fast  paced,  successive  rclone
       commands.

       For  example,  executing this command 90 times in a row rclone link remote:file will cause
       the remote to become “blocked”.  This is not an abnormal situation,  for  example  if  you
       wish to get the public links of a directory with hundred of files...  After more or less a
       week, the remote will remote accept rclone logins normally again.

       You can mitigate this issue by mounting the remote it with rclone mount.  This will log-in
       when  mounting  and  a log-out when unmounting only.  You can also run rclone rcd and then
       use rclone rc to run the commands over the API to avoid logging in each time.

       Rclone does not currently close mega sessions (you can see them  in  the  web  interface),
       however closing the sessions does not solve the issue.

       If  you  space rclone commands by 3 seconds it will avoid blocking the remote.  We haven’t
       identified the exact blocking rules, so perhaps one could execute  the  command  80  times
       without waiting and avoid blocking by waiting 3 seconds, then continuing...

       Note that this has been observed by trial and error and might not be set in stone.

       Other  tools  seem  not  to  produce this blocking effect, as they use a different working
       approach (state-based, using sessionIDs instead of log-in) which isn’t compatible with the
       current stateless rclone approach.

       Note that once blocked, the use of other tools (such as megacmd) is not a sure workaround:
       following megacmd login times have been observed  in  succession  for  blocked  remote:  7
       minutes, 20 min, 30min, 30 min, 30min.  Web access looks unaffected though.

       Investigation is continuing in relation to workarounds based on timeouts, pacers, retrials
       and tpslimits - if you discover something relevant, please post on the forum.

       So, if rclone was working nicely and suddenly you are unable to log-in and  you  are  sure
       the user and the password are correct, likely you have got the remote blocked for a while.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to mega (Mega).

   –mega-user
       User name.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –mega-pass
       Password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to mega (Mega).

   –mega-debug
       Output more debug from Mega.

       If this flag is set (along with -vv) it will print further debugging information from  the
       mega backend.

       Properties:

       • Config: debug

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_DEBUG

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –mega-hard-delete
       Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

       Normally  the  mega  backend will put all deletions into the trash rather than permanently
       deleting them.  If you specify this then rclone will permanently delete objects instead.

       Properties:

       • Config: hard_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_HARD_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –mega-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       This backend uses the go-mega go library (https://github.com/t3rm1n4l/go-mega) which is an
       opensource go library  implementing  the  Mega  API.   There  doesn’t  appear  to  be  any
       documentation     for     the     mega     protocol    beyond    the    mega    C++    SDK
       (https://github.com/meganz/sdk) source code so there are likely quite a few  errors  still
       remaining in this library.

       Mega allows duplicate files which may confuse rclone.

Memory

       The  memory  backend  is  an in RAM backend.  It does not persist its data - use the local
       backend for that.

       The memory backend behaves like a bucket-based remote (e.g. like s3).  Because it  has  no
       parameters you can just use it with the :memory: remote name.

   Configuration
       You can configure it as a remote like this with rclone config too if you want to:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Memory
                 \ "memory"
              [snip]
              Storage> memory
              ** See help for memory backend at: https://rclone.org/memory/ **

              Remote config

              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = memory
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Because  the  memory  backend  isn’t  persistent  it is most useful for testing or with an
       rclone server or rclone mount, e.g.

              rclone mount :memory: /mnt/tmp
              rclone serve webdav :memory:
              rclone serve sftp :memory:

   Modified time and hashes
       The memory backend supports MD5 hashes and modification times accurate to 1 nS.

   Restricted filename characters
       The    memory    backend    replaces    the    default    restricted    characters     set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters).

Akamai NetStorage

       Paths    are    specified    as    remote:    You   may   put   subdirectories   in   too,
       e.g. remote:/path/to/dir.  If you have a CP code you can use that as the folder after  the
       domain such as <domain>/<cpcode>/<internal directories within cpcode>.

       For  example,  this  is  commonly  configured with or without a CP code: * With a CP code.
       [your-domain-prefix]-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/subdirectory/ * Without a  CP  code.   [your-
       domain-prefix]-nsu.akamaihd.net

       See  all  buckets  rclone lsd remote: The initial setup for Netstorage involves getting an
       account and secret.  Use rclone config to walk you through the setup process.

   Configuration
       Here’s an example of how to make a remote called ns1.

       1. To begin the interactive configuration process, enter this command:

          rclone config

       2. Type n to create a new remote.

          n) New remote
          d) Delete remote
          q) Quit config
          e/n/d/q> n

       3. For this example, enter ns1 when you reach the name> prompt.

          name> ns1

       4. Enter netstorage as the type of storage to configure.

          Type of storage to configure.
          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
          XX / NetStorage
             \ "netstorage"
          Storage> netstorage

       5. Select between the HTTP or HTTPS protocol.  Most users should choose  HTTPS,  which  is
          the default.  HTTP is provided primarily for debugging purposes.

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
           1 / HTTP protocol
             \ "http"
           2 / HTTPS protocol
             \ "https"
          protocol> 1

       6. Specify  your  NetStorage  host,  CP  code,  and any necessary content paths using this
          format: <domain>/<cpcode>/<content>/

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          host> baseball-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/content/

       7. Set the netstorage account name

          Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
          account> username

       8. Set the Netstorage account  secret/G2O  key  which  will  be  used  for  authentication
          purposes.   Select the y option to set your own password then enter your secret.  Note:
          The secret is stored in the rclone.conf file with hex-encoded encryption.

          y) Yes type in my own password
          g) Generate random password
          y/g> y
          Enter the password:
          password:
          Confirm the password:
          password:

       9. View the summary and confirm your remote configuration.

          [ns1]
          type = netstorage
          protocol = http
          host = baseball-nsu.akamaihd.net/123456/content/
          account = username
          secret = *** ENCRYPTED ***
          --------------------
          y) Yes this is OK (default)
          e) Edit this remote
          d) Delete this remote
          y/e/d> y

       This remote is called ns1 and can now be used.

   Example operations
       Get started with rclone  and  NetStorage  with  these  examples.   For  additional  rclone
       commands, visit https://rclone.org/commands/.

   See contents of a directory in your project
              rclone lsd ns1:/974012/testing/

   Sync the contents local with remote
              rclone sync . ns1:/974012/testing/

   Upload local content to remote
              rclone copy notes.txt ns1:/974012/testing/

   Delete content on remote
              rclone delete ns1:/974012/testing/notes.txt

   Move or copy content between CP codes.
       Your  credentials  must have access to two CP codes on the same remote.  You can’t perform
       operations between different remotes.

              rclone move ns1:/974012/testing/notes.txt ns1:/974450/testing2/

   Features
   Symlink Support
       The Netstorage backend changes the rclone --links, -l behavior.  When  uploading,  instead
       of  creating  the  .rclonelink  file,  use  the  “symlink”  API  in  order  to  create the
       corresponding symlink on the remote.  The .rclonelink file will not be created, the upload
       will  be  intercepted  and only the symlink file that matches the source file name with no
       suffix will be created on the remote.

       This will effectively allow commands like copy/copyto, move/moveto and sync to upload from
       local  to  remote  and  download  from  remote to local directories with symlinks.  Due to
       internal rclone limitations, it is not possible to upload an individual  symlink  file  to
       any  remote backend.  You can always use the “backend symlink” command to create a symlink
       on the NetStorage server, refer to “symlink” section below.

       Individual symlink files on the remote can be used with the commands like “cat”  to  print
       the  destination  name, or “delete” to delete symlink, or copy, copy/to and move/moveto to
       download from the remote to local.  Note: individual symlink files on the remote should be
       specified including the suffix .rclonelink.

       Note:  No file with the suffix .rclonelink should ever exist on the server since it is not
       possible to actually upload/create a file with .rclonelink suffix with rclone, it can only
       exist if it is manually created through a non-rclone method on the remote.

   Implicit vs. Explicit Directories
       With NetStorage, directories can exist in one of two forms:

       1. Explicit  Directory.   This is an actual, physical directory that you have created in a
          storage group.

       2. Implicit Directory.  This refers to a  directory  within  a  path  that  has  not  been
          physically  created.   For example, during upload of a file, nonexistent subdirectories
          can be specified in the target path.  NetStorage creates these as “implicit.” While the
          directories  aren’t  physically  created,  they  exist implicitly and the noted path is
          connected with the uploaded file.

       Rclone will intercept all file uploads and mkdir commands for the  NetStorage  remote  and
       will  explicitly  issue  the mkdir command for each directory in the uploading path.  This
       will help with the interoperability with the other Akamai services such as  SFTP  and  the
       Content  Management  Shell (CMShell).  Rclone will not guarantee correctness of operations
       with implicit directories which might have been created as a result of using an upload API
       directly.

   --fast-list / ListR support
       NetStorage  remote supports the ListR feature by using the “list” NetStorage API action to
       return a lexicographical list of all objects within the specified CP code, recursing  into
       subdirectories as they’re encountered.

       • Rclone  will use the ListR method for some commands by default.  Commands such as lsf -R
         will use ListR by default.  To disable this, include the --disable listR option  to  use
         the non-recursive method of listing objects.

       • Rclone will not use the ListR method for some commands.  Commands such as sync don’t use
         ListR by default.  To force using the ListR method, include the --fast-list option.

       There are pros and  cons  of  using  the  ListR  method,  refer  to  rclone  documentation
       (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list).   In general, the sync command over an existing deep
       tree on the remote will run faster with the “–fast-list” flag but with extra memory  usage
       as  a  side effect.  It might also result in higher CPU utilization but the whole task can
       be completed faster.

       Note: There is a known limitation that “lsf -R”  will  display  number  of  files  in  the
       directory  and  directory size as -1 when ListR method is used.  The workaround is to pass
       “–disable listR” flag if these numbers are important in the output.

   Purge
       NetStorage remote supports the purge feature by using the  “quick-delete”  NetStorage  API
       action.   The  quick-delete  action is disabled by default for security reasons and can be
       enabled for the account through the Akamai portal.  Rclone will first try  to  use  quick-
       delete  action  for the purge command and if this functionality is disabled then will fall
       back to a standard delete method.

       Note:     Read     the     NetStorage     Usage     API      (https://learn.akamai.com/en-
       us/webhelp/netstorage/netstorage-http-api-developer-guide/GUID-15836617-9F50-405A-833C-
       EA2556756A30.html) for considerations when using “quick-delete”.  In general, using quick-
       delete  method  will not delete the tree immediately and objects targeted for quick-delete
       may still be accessible.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to netstorage (Akamai NetStorage).

   –netstorage-host
       Domain+path of NetStorage host to connect to.

       Format should be <domain>/<internal folders>

       Properties:

       • Config: host

       • Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_HOST

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –netstorage-account
       Set the NetStorage account name

       Properties:

       • Config: account

       • Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_ACCOUNT

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –netstorage-secret
       Set the NetStorage account secret/G2O key for authentication.

       Please choose the `y' option to set your own password then enter your secret.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to netstorage (Akamai NetStorage).

   –netstorage-protocol
       Select between HTTP or HTTPS protocol.

       Most  users  should  choose  HTTPS,  which is the default.  HTTP is provided primarily for
       debugging purposes.

       Properties:

       • Config: protocol

       • Env Var: RCLONE_NETSTORAGE_PROTOCOL

       • Type: string

       • Default: “https”

       • Examples:

         • “http”

           • HTTP protocol

         • “https”

           • HTTPS protocol

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the netstorage backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These   can   be   run   on  a  running  backend  using  the  rc  command  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   du
       Return disk usage information for a specified directory

              rclone backend du remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       The usage information returned, includes the targeted  directory  as  well  as  all  files
       stored in any sub-directories that may exist.

   symlink
       You can create a symbolic link in ObjectStore with the symlink action.

              rclone backend symlink remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       The desired path location (including applicable sub-directories) ending in the object that
       will be the target  of  the  symlink  (for  example,  /links/mylink).   Include  the  file
       extension for the object, if applicable.  rclone backend symlink <src> <path>

Microsoft Azure Blob Storage

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:container (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g.  remote:container/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a Microsoft Azure Blob Storage configuration.  For  a  remote
       called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Microsoft Azure Blob Storage
                 \ "azureblob"
              [snip]
              Storage> azureblob
              Storage Account Name
              account> account_name
              Storage Account Key
              key> base64encodedkey==
              Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
              endpoint>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              account = account_name
              key = base64encodedkey==
              endpoint =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See all containers

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new container

              rclone mkdir remote:container

       List the contents of a container

              rclone ls remote:container

       Sync  /home/local/directory  to  the  remote  container,  deleting any excess files in the
       container.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:container

   –fast-list
       This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer  transactions  in  exchange
       for  more  memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more
       details.

   Modified time
       The modified time is stored as metadata on the object with the mtime key.   It  is  stored
       using  RFC3339  Format  time  with  nanosecond precision.  The metadata is supplied during
       directory listings so there is no overhead to using it.

   Performance
       When uploading large files, increasing the value  of  --azureblob-upload-concurrency  will
       increase  performance  at  the  cost of using more memory.  The default of 16 is set quite
       conservatively to use less memory.  It maybe be necessary raise it  to  64  or  higher  to
       fully utilize a 1 GBit/s link with a single file transfer.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       /           0x2F        /
       \           0x5C        \

       File  names  can  also  not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if
       they are the last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       .           0x2E        .

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Hashes
       MD5 hashes are stored with blobs.  However blobs that were uploaded in chunks only have an
       MD5 if the source remote was capable of MD5 hashes, e.g. the local disk.

   Authenticating with Azure Blob Storage
       Rclone has 3 ways of authenticating with Azure Blob Storage:

   Account and Key
       This is the most straight forward and least flexible way.  Just fill in  the  account  and
       key lines and leave the rest blank.

   SAS URL
       This can be an account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL.

       To use it leave account, key blank and fill in sas_url.

       An  account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL can be obtained from the Azure portal
       or the Azure Storage Explorer.  To get  a  container  level  SAS  URL  right  click  on  a
       container in the Azure Blob explorer in the Azure portal.

       If you use a container level SAS URL, rclone operations are permitted only on a particular
       container, e.g.

              rclone ls azureblob:container

       You can also list the single container from the root.  This will only show  the  container
       specified by the SAS URL.

              $ rclone lsd azureblob:
              container/

       Note that you can’t see or access any other containers - this will fail

              rclone ls azureblob:othercontainer

       Container  level  SAS  URLs  are useful for temporarily allowing third parties access to a
       single container or putting credentials into an untrusted environment such as a  CI  build
       server.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

   –azureblob-account
       Storage Account Name.

       Leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator.

       Properties:

       • Config: account

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCOUNT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-service-principal-file
       Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal.

       Leave  blank  normally.   Needed  only  if  you want to use a service principal instead of
       interactive login.

              $ az ad sp create-for-rbac --name "<name>" \
                --role "Storage Blob Data Owner" \
                --scopes "/subscriptions/<subscription>/resourceGroups/<resource-group>/providers/Microsoft.Storage/storageAccounts/<storage-account>/blobServices/default/containers/<container>" \
                > azure-principal.json

       See    “Create    an    Azure    service    principal”     (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-
       us/cli/azure/create-an-azure-service-principal-azure-cli)  and  “Assign  an Azure role for
       access to blob data”  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/storage/common/storage-auth-
       aad-rbac-cli) pages for more details.

       Properties:

       • Config: service_principal_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-key
       Storage Account Key.

       Leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator.

       Properties:

       • Config: key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-sas-url
       SAS URL for container level access only.

       Leave blank if using account/key or Emulator.

       Properties:

       • Config: sas_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SAS_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-use-msi
       Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure).

       When  true, use a managed service identity (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-
       directory/managed-identities-azure-resources/) to authenticate to Azure Storage instead of
       a SAS token or account key.

       If  the VM(SS) on which this program is running has a system-assigned identity, it will be
       used by default.  If the resource has no system-assigned  but  exactly  one  user-assigned
       identity,  the  user-assigned  identity  will  be  used  by  default.  If the resource has
       multiple user-assigned identities, the identity to use must be explicitly specified  using
       exactly one of the msi_object_id, msi_client_id, or msi_mi_res_id parameters.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_msi

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_MSI

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –azureblob-use-emulator
       Uses local storage emulator if provided as `true'.

       Leave blank if using real azure storage endpoint.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_emulator

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_EMULATOR

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

   –azureblob-msi-object-id
       Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

       Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

       Properties:

       • Config: msi_object_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_OBJECT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-msi-client-id
       Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

       Leave blank if msi_object_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

       Properties:

       • Config: msi_client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-msi-mi-res-id
       Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any.

       Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_object_id specified.

       Properties:

       • Config: msi_mi_res_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_MI_RES_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-endpoint
       Endpoint for the service.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256 MiB) (deprecated).

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-chunk-size
       Upload chunk size.

       Note  that  this  is  stored  in memory and there may be up to “–transfers” * “–azureblob-
       upload-concurrency” chunks stored at once in memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 4Mi

   –azureblob-upload-concurrency
       Concurrency for multipart uploads.

       This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

       If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these  uploads
       do  not  fully  utilize  your  bandwidth,  then  increasing  this may help to speed up the
       transfers.

       In tests, upload speed increases almost linearly with upload concurrency.  For example  to
       fill a gigabit pipe it may be necessary to raise this to 64.  Note that this will use more
       memory.

       Note that chunks are stored in memory and there may be up to “–transfers”  *  “–azureblob-
       upload-concurrency” chunks stored at once in memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 16

   –azureblob-list-chunk
       Size of blob list.

       This  sets  the  number of blobs requested in each listing chunk.  Default is the maximum,
       5000.  “List blobs” requests are permitted 2 minutes per  megabyte  to  complete.   If  an
       operation  is  taking  longer  than  2 minutes per megabyte on average, it will time out (
       source    (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/rest/api/storageservices/setting-timeouts-for-
       blob-service-operations#exceptions-to-default-timeout-interval)  ).   This  can be used to
       limit the number of blobs items to return, to avoid the time out.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_LIST_CHUNK

       • Type: int

       • Default: 5000

   –azureblob-access-tier
       Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive.

       Archived blobs can be restored by setting access tier to hot or cool.  Leave blank if  you
       intend to use default access tier, which is set at account level

       If  there  is  no “access tier” specified, rclone doesn’t apply any tier.  rclone performs
       “Set Tier” operation on blobs while uploading, if objects  are  not  modified,  specifying
       “access  tier”  to new one will have no effect.  If blobs are in “archive tier” at remote,
       trying to perform data transfer operations from remote will not be allowed.   User  should
       first restore by tiering blob to “Hot” or “Cool”.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_tier

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCESS_TIER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –azureblob-archive-tier-delete
       Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting.

       Archive  tier  blobs cannot be updated.  So without this flag, if you attempt to update an
       archive tier blob, then rclone will produce the error:

              can't update archive tier blob without --azureblob-archive-tier-delete

       With this flag set then before rclone attempts to overwrite an archive tier blob, it  will
       delete  the  existing  blob  before uploading its replacement.  This has the potential for
       data loss if the upload fails (unlike updating a normal blob) and also may cost more since
       deleting archive tier blobs early may be chargable.

       Properties:

       • Config: archive_tier_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ARCHIVE_TIER_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –azureblob-disable-checksum
       Don’t store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

       Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can
       add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integrity checking but can cause
       long delays for large files to start uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_checksum

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time
       How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.

       Uploads  which  requires  additional  buffers  (f.e  multipart)  will  use memory pool for
       allocations.  This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_flush_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap
       Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

       Properties:

       • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –azureblob-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8

   –azureblob-public-access
       Public access level of a container: blob or container.

       Properties:

       • Config: public_access

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_PUBLIC_ACCESS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • The container and its blobs can be accessed only with an authorized request.

           • It’s a default value.

         • “blob”

           • Blob data within this container can be read via anonymous request.

         • “container”

           • Allow full public read access for container and blob data.

   –azureblob-no-head-object
       If set, do not do HEAD before GET when getting objects.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_head_object

       • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_NO_HEAD_OBJECT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Limitations
       MD5  sums  are  only  uploaded with chunked files if the source has an MD5 sum.  This will
       always be the case for a local to azure copy.

       rclone about is not supported by the  Microsoft  Azure  Blob  storage  backend.   Backends
       without  this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs
       (most free space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See     List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone      about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)          and         rclone         about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

   Azure Storage Emulator Support
       You can run rclone with storage emulator (usually azurite).

       To do this, just set up a new remote with rclone config following  instructions  described
       in  introduction  and set use_emulator config as true.  You do not need to provide default
       account name neither an account key.

       Also, if you want to access a storage emulator instance running on  a  different  machine,
       you   can   override   Endpoint   parameter   in   advanced   settings,   setting   it  to
       http(s)://<host>:<port>/devstoreaccount1 (e.g. http://10.254.2.5:10000/devstoreaccount1).

Microsoft OneDrive

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for OneDrive involves getting a token from Microsoft which you  need  to
       do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Microsoft OneDrive
                 \ "onedrive"
              [snip]
              Storage> onedrive
              Microsoft App Client Id
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_id>
              Microsoft App Client Secret
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_secret>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
               1 / OneDrive Personal or Business
                 \ "onedrive"
               2 / Sharepoint site
                 \ "sharepoint"
               3 / Type in driveID
                 \ "driveid"
               4 / Type in SiteID
                 \ "siteid"
               5 / Search a Sharepoint site
                 \ "search"
              Your choice> 1
              Found 1 drives, please select the one you want to use:
              0: OneDrive (business) id=b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
              Chose drive to use:> 0
              Found drive 'root' of type 'business', URL: https://org-my.sharepoint.com/personal/you/Documents
              Is that okay?
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = onedrive
              token = {"access_token":"youraccesstoken","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"yourrefreshtoken","expiry":"2018-08-26T22:39:52.486512262+08:00"}
              drive_id = b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
              drive_type = business
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  Microsoft.   This  only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you
       get back the verification code.  This  is  on  http://127.0.0.1:53682/  and  this  it  may
       require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your OneDrive

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your OneDrive

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an OneDrive directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Getting your own Client ID and Key
       rclone  uses  a  default  Client ID when talking to OneDrive, unless a custom client_id is
       specified in the config.  The default Client ID and Key are shared  by  all  rclone  users
       when performing requests.

       You may choose to create and use your own Client ID, in case the default one does not work
       well for you.  For example, you might see throttling.

   Creating Client ID for OneDrive Personal
       To create your own Client ID, please follow these steps:

       1. Open https://portal.azure.com/#blade/Microsoft_AAD_RegisteredApps/ApplicationsListBlade
          and then click New registration.

       2. Enter a name for your app, choose account type Accounts in any organizational directory
          (Any Azure AD directory - Multitenant) and personal  Microsoft  accounts  (e.g.  Skype,
          Xbox),   select   Web   in   Redirect   URI,   then   type  (do  not  copy  and  paste)
          http://localhost:53682/ and click Register.  Copy and keep the Application (client)  ID
          under the app name for later use.

       3. Under  manage  select  Certificates  &  secrets,  click  New  client  secret.   Enter a
          description (can be anything) and set Expires to 24 months.  Copy and keep that  secret
          Value for later use (you won’t be able to see this value afterwards).

       4. Under  manage select API permissions, click Add a permission and select Microsoft Graph
          then select delegated permissions.

       5. Search   and   select   the   following   permissions:   Files.Read,   Files.ReadWrite,
          Files.Read.All,  Files.ReadWrite.All,  offline_access, User.Read and Sites.Read.All (if
          custom access  scopes  are  configured,  select  the  permissions  accordingly).   Once
          selected click Add permissions at the bottom.

       Now  the  application is complete.  Run rclone config to create or edit a OneDrive remote.
       Supply the app ID and password as Client ID and Secret, respectively.   rclone  will  walk
       you through the remaining steps.

       The access_scopes option allows you to configure the permissions requested by rclone.  See
       Microsoft    Docs     (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/graph/permissions-reference#files-
       permissions) for more information about the different scopes.

       The  Sites.Read.All  permission  is  required  if you need to search SharePoint sites when
       configuring the remote  (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/pull/5883).   However,  if  that
       permission  is not assigned, you need to exclude Sites.Read.All from your access scopes or
       set disable_site_permission option to true in the advanced options.

   Creating Client ID for OneDrive Business
       The steps for OneDrive Personal may or may not work for OneDrive  Business,  depending  on
       the  security  settings  of the organization.  A common error is that the publisher of the
       App is not verified.

       You  may  try  to  verify  you   account   (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-
       directory/develop/publisher-verification-overview),  or  try  to  limit  the  App  to your
       organization only, as shown below.

       1. Make sure to create the App with your business account.

       2. Follow the steps above to create an App.  However, we need  a  different  account  type
          here:  Accounts in this organizational directory only (*** - Single tenant).  Note that
          you can also change the account type after creating the App.

       3. Find      the      tenant      ID       (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/active-
          directory/fundamentals/active-directory-how-to-find-tenant) of your organization.

       4. In          the          rclone         config,         set         auth_url         to
          https://login.microsoftonline.com/YOUR_TENANT_ID/oauth2/v2.0/authorize.

       5. In         the         rclone         config,         set         token_url          to
          https://login.microsoftonline.com/YOUR_TENANT_ID/oauth2/v2.0/token.

       Note:  If  you have a special region, you may need a different host in step 4 and 5.  Here
       are                                       some                                       hints
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/bc23bf11db1c78c6ebbf8ea538fbebf7058b4176/backend/onedrive/onedrive.go#L86).

   Modification time and hashes
       OneDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These  will
       be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

       OneDrive  personal supports SHA1 type hashes.  OneDrive for business and Sharepoint Server
       support      QuickXorHash       (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/onedrive/developer/code-
       snippets/quickxorhash).

       For all types of OneDrive you can use the --checksum flag.

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       ”           0x22        "
       *           0x2A        *
       :           0x3A        :
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       \           0x5C        \
       |           0x7C        |

       File  names  can  also  not end with the following characters.  These only get replaced if
       they are the last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠
       .           0x2E        .

       File names can also not begin with the following characters.  These only get  replaced  if
       they are the first character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠
       ~           0x7E        ~

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Deleting files
       Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash.  Microsoft doesn’t  provide  an
       API  to permanently delete files, nor to empty the trash, so you will have to do that with
       one of Microsoft’s apps or via the OneDrive website.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

   –onedrive-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-region
       Choose national cloud region for OneDrive.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_REGION

       • Type: string

       • Default: “global”

       • Examples:

         • “global”

           • Microsoft Cloud Global

         • “us”

           • Microsoft Cloud for US Government

         • “de”

           • Microsoft Cloud Germany

         • “cn”

           • Azure and Office 365 operated by Vnet Group in China

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

   –onedrive-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-chunk-size
       Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes).

       Above this size files will be chunked - must be  multiple  of  320k  (327,680  bytes)  and
       should    not    exceed    250M    (262,144,000    bytes)    else    you   may   encounter
       "Microsoft.SharePoint.Client.InvalidClientQueryException: The request message is too big."
       Note that the chunks will be buffered into memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 10Mi

   –onedrive-drive-id
       The ID of the drive to use.

       Properties:

       • Config: drive_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-drive-type
       The type of the drive (personal | business | documentLibrary).

       Properties:

       • Config: drive_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-root-folder-id
       ID of the root folder.

       This isn’t normally needed, but in special circumstances you might know the folder ID that
       you wish to access but not be able to get there through a path traversal.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-access-scopes
       Set scopes to be requested by rclone.

       Choose or manually enter a custom space separated list with all scopes, that rclone should
       request.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_scopes

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ACCESS_SCOPES

       • Type: SpaceSepList

       • Default:  Files.Read  Files.ReadWrite  Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All Sites.Read.All
         offline_access

       • Examples:

         • “Files.Read   Files.ReadWrite   Files.Read.All   Files.ReadWrite.All    Sites.Read.All
           offline_access”

           • Read and write access to all resources

         • “Files.Read Files.Read.All Sites.Read.All offline_access”

           • Read only access to all resources

         • “Files.Read Files.ReadWrite Files.Read.All Files.ReadWrite.All offline_access”

           • Read  and  write  access  to all resources, without the ability to browse SharePoint
             sites.

           • Same as if disable_site_permission was set to true

   –onedrive-disable-site-permission
       Disable the request for Sites.Read.All permission.

       If set to true, you will  no  longer  be  able  to  search  for  a  SharePoint  site  when
       configuring  drive  ID, because rclone will not request Sites.Read.All permission.  Set it
       to true if your organization didn’t assign Sites.Read.All permission to  the  application,
       and your organization disallows users to consent app permission request on their own.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_site_permission

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DISABLE_SITE_PERMISSION

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –onedrive-expose-onenote-files
       Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings.

       By  default,  rclone will hide OneNote files in directory listings because operations like
       “Open” and “Update” won’t work on them.  But this behaviour  may  also  prevent  you  from
       deleting  them.   If you want to delete OneNote files or otherwise want them to show up in
       directory listing, set this option.

       Properties:

       • Config: expose_onenote_files

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_EXPOSE_ONENOTE_FILES

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –onedrive-server-side-across-configs
       Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different onedrive configs.

       This will only work if you are copying between two OneDrive Personal drives AND the  files
       to  copy are already shared between them.  In other cases, rclone will fall back to normal
       copy (which will be slightly slower).

       Properties:

       • Config: server_side_across_configs

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –onedrive-list-chunk
       Size of listing chunk.

       Properties:

       • Config: list_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LIST_CHUNK

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1000

   –onedrive-no-versions
       Remove all versions on modifying operations.

       Onedrive for business creates versions  when  rclone  uploads  new  files  overwriting  an
       existing one and when it sets the modification time.

       These versions take up space out of the quota.

       This  flag checks for versions after file upload and setting modification time and removes
       all but the last version.

       NB Onedrive personal can’t currently delete versions so don’t use this flag there.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_versions

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_NO_VERSIONS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –onedrive-link-scope
       Set the scope of the links created by the link command.

       Properties:

       • Config: link_scope

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_SCOPE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “anonymous”

       • Examples:

         • “anonymous”

           • Anyone with the link has access, without needing to sign in.

           • This may include people outside of your organization.

           • Anonymous link support may be disabled by an administrator.

         • “organization”

           • Anyone signed into your organization (tenant) can use the link to get access.

           • Only available in OneDrive for Business and SharePoint.

   –onedrive-link-type
       Set the type of the links created by the link command.

       Properties:

       • Config: link_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “view”

       • Examples:

         • “view”

           • Creates a read-only link to the item.

         • “edit”

           • Creates a read-write link to the item.

         • “embed”

           • Creates an embeddable link to the item.

   –onedrive-link-password
       Set the password for links created by the link command.

       At the time of writing this only works with OneDrive personal paid accounts.

       Properties:

       • Config: link_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –onedrive-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       If  you  don’t  use rclone for 90 days the refresh token will expire.  This will result in
       authorization problems.  This is easy to  fix  by  running  the  rclone  config  reconnect
       remote: command to get a new token and refresh token.

   Naming
       Note that OneDrive is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and one
       called “hello.doc”.

       There are quite a few characters that can’t be in OneDrive file names.  These can’t  occur
       on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows platforms they are common.  Rclone will map these
       names to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.  For example if a file has a  ?
       in it will be mapped to  instead.

   File sizes
       The  largest  allowed  file  size  is  250 GiB for both OneDrive Personal and OneDrive for
       Business (Updated 13 Jan  2021)  (https://support.microsoft.com/en-us/office/invalid-file-
       names-and-file-types-in-onedrive-and-
       sharepoint-64883a5d-228e-48f5-b3d2-eb39e07630fa?ui=en-us&rs=en-
       us&ad=us#individualfilesize).

   Path length
       The  entire  path,  including  the  file  name, must contain fewer than 400 characters for
       OneDrive, OneDrive for Business and SharePoint Online.  If you  are  encrypting  file  and
       folder  names  with  rclone,  you may want to pay attention to this limitation because the
       encrypted names are typically longer than the original ones.

   Number of files
       OneDrive seems to be OK with at least 50,000 files in a folder, but at 100,000 rclone will
       get  errors  listing  the  directory  like  couldn’t list files: UnknownError:.  See #2707
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2707) for more info.

       An official document about the limitations for different types of OneDrive  can  be  found
       here       (https://support.office.com/en-us/article/invalid-file-names-and-file-types-in-
       onedrive-onedrive-for-business-and-sharepoint-64883a5d-228e-48f5-b3d2-eb39e07630fa).

   Versions
       Every change in a file OneDrive causes the service to create a new version  of  the  file.
       This  counts  against a users quota.  For example changing the modification time of a file
       creates a second version, so the file apparently uses twice the space.

       For example the copy command is affected by this  as  rclone  copies  the  file  and  then
       afterwards sets the modification time to match the source file which uses another version.

       You can use the rclone cleanup command (see below) to remove all old versions.

       Or  you  can  set  the no_versions parameter to true and rclone will remove versions after
       operations which create new versions.  This takes extra transactions so only enable it  if
       you need it.

       Note  At  the  time of writing Onedrive Personal creates versions (but not for setting the
       modification time) but the API for removing them returns “API not found”  so  cleanup  and
       no_versions should not be used on Onedrive Personal.

   Disabling versioning
       Starting  October  2018,  users  will  no longer be able to disable versioning by default.
       This       is       because       Microsoft       has       brought       an        update
       (https://techcommunity.microsoft.com/t5/Microsoft-OneDrive-Blog/New-Updates-to-OneDrive-
       and-SharePoint-Team-Site-Versioning/ba-p/204390) to the mechanism.   To  change  this  new
       default setting, a PowerShell command is required to be run by a SharePoint admin.  If you
       are an admin, you can run these commands in PowerShell to change that setting:

       1. Install-Module  -Name  Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell  (in  case  you   haven’t
          installed this already)

       2. Import-Module Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell -DisableNameChecking

       3. Connect-SPOService      -Url      https://YOURSITE-admin.sharepoint.com     -Credential
          YOU@YOURSITE.COM (replacing YOURSITE, YOU, YOURSITE.COM with the  actual  values;  this
          will prompt for your credentials)

       4. Set-SPOTenant -EnableMinimumVersionRequirement $False

       5. Disconnect-SPOService (to disconnect from the server)

       Below  are  the  steps  for  normal users to disable versioning.  If you don’t see the “No
       Versioning” option, make sure the above requirements are met.

       User Weropol (https://github.com/Weropol) has found a  method  to  disable  versioning  on
       OneDrive

       1. Open  the  settings  menu  by  clicking  on  the gear symbol at the top of the OneDrive
          Business page.

       2. Click Site settings.

       3. Once on the Site settings page, navigate to Site Administration >  Site  libraries  and
          lists.

       4. Click Customize “Documents”.

       5. Click General Settings > Versioning Settings.

       6. Under  Document  Version  History  select  the  option  No versioning.  Note: This will
          disable the creation of new file versions, but will not remove any  previous  versions.
          Your documents are safe.

       7. Apply the changes by clicking OK.

       8. Use rclone to upload or modify files.  (I also use the –no-update-modtime flag)

       9. Restore the versioning settings after using rclone.  (Optional)

   Cleanup
       OneDrive  supports rclone cleanup which causes rclone to look through every file under the
       path supplied and delete all version but  the  current  version.   Because  this  involves
       traversing  all  the  files,  then  querying  each file for versions it can be quite slow.
       Rclone does --checkers tests in parallel.  The command also supports -i which is  a  great
       way to see what it would do.

              rclone cleanup -i remote:path/subdir # interactively remove all old version for path/subdir
              rclone cleanup remote:path/subdir    # unconditionally remove all old version for path/subdir

       NB Onedrive personal can’t currently delete versions

   Troubleshooting
   Excessive throttling or blocked on SharePoint
       If  you experience excessive throttling or is being blocked on SharePoint then it may help
       to   set   the   user   agent   explicitly   with   a   flag   like   this:   --user-agent
       "ISV|rclone.org|rclone/v1.55.1"

       The  specific  details  can be found in the Microsoft document: Avoid getting throttled or
       blocked  in  SharePoint  Online  (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/sharepoint/dev/general-
       development/how-to-avoid-getting-throttled-or-blocked-in-sharepoint-online#how-to-
       decorate-your-http-traffic-to-avoid-throttling)

   Unexpected file size/hash differences on Sharepoint
       It         is         a          known          (https://github.com/OneDrive/onedrive-api-
       docs/issues/935#issuecomment-441741631)  issue  that  Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive
       for Business) silently modifies uploaded files, mainly Office files (.docx, .xlsx,  etc.),
       causing  file  size  and  hash  checks to fail.  There are also other situations that will
       cause OneDrive to report inconsistent file sizes.  To use rclone with such affected  files
       on Sharepoint, you may disable these checks with the following command line arguments:

              --ignore-checksum --ignore-size

       Alternatively,  if  you have write access to the OneDrive files, it may be possible to fix
       this problem for certain files, by attempting the steps below.  Open the web interface for
       OneDrive  (https://onedrive.live.com)  and  find  the affected files (which will be in the
       error messages/log for rclone).  Simply click on each of these files, causing OneDrive  to
       open them on the web.  This will cause each file to be converted in place to a format that
       is functionally equivalent but which will no longer trigger the  size  discrepancy.   Once
       all problematic files are converted you will no longer need the ignore options above.

   Replacing/deleting existing files on Sharepoint gets “item not found”
       It  is  a  known  (https://github.com/OneDrive/onedrive-api-docs/issues/1068)  issue  that
       Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive for Business) may return “item not found” errors when
       users  try  to  replace or delete uploaded files; this seems to mainly affect Office files
       (.docx, .xlsx, etc.)  and web files (.html, .aspx, etc.).  As a workaround,  you  may  use
       the  --backup-dir  <BACKUP_DIR>  command  line  argument  so  rclone moves the files to be
       replaced/deleted into a given backup directory  (instead  of  directly  replacing/deleting
       them).   For  example,  to  instruct  rclone  to move the files into the directory rclone-
       backup-dir on backend mysharepoint, you may use:

              --backup-dir mysharepoint:rclone-backup-dir

   access_denied (AADSTS65005)
              Error: access_denied
              Code: AADSTS65005
              Description: Using application 'rclone' is currently not supported for your organization [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] because it is in an unmanaged state. An administrator needs to claim ownership of the company by DNS validation of [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] before the application rclone can be provisioned.

       This means that rclone can’t use the OneDrive for Business API  with  your  account.   You
       can’t do much about it, maybe write an email to your admins.

       However,  there are other ways to interact with your OneDrive account.  Have a look at the
       WebDAV backend: https://rclone.org/webdav/#sharepoint

   invalid_grant (AADSTS50076)
              Error: invalid_grant
              Code: AADSTS50076
              Description: Due to a configuration change made by your administrator, or because you moved to a new location, you must use multi-factor authentication to access '...'.

       If you see the error above after enabling multi-factor authentication  for  your  account,
       you can fix it by refreshing your OAuth refresh token.  To do that, run rclone config, and
       choose to edit your OneDrive backend.  Then, you don’t need to actually make  any  changes
       until you reach this question: Already have a token - refresh?.  For this question, answer
       y and go through the process to refresh your token, just like the first time  the  backend
       is configured.  After this, rclone should work again for this backend.

   Invalid request when making public links
       On  Sharepoint  and  OneDrive  for  Business,  rclone link may return an “Invalid request”
       error.  A possible cause is that the organisation admin didn’t allow public  links  to  be
       made  for the organisation/sharepoint library.  To fix the permissions as an admin, take a
       look at the docs: 1 (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/sharepoint/turn-external-sharing-on-
       or-off),      2      (https://support.microsoft.com/en-us/office/set-up-and-manage-access-
       requests-94b26e0b-2822-49d4-929a-8455698654b3).

OpenDrive

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / OpenDrive
                 \ "opendrive"
              [snip]
              Storage> opendrive
              Username
              username>
              Password
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              --------------------
              [remote]
              username =
              password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       List directories in top level of your OpenDrive

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your OpenDrive

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an OpenDrive directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and MD5SUMs
       OpenDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will
       be used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /
       ”           0x22        "
       *           0x2A        *
       :           0x3A        :
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       \           0x5C        \
       |           0x7C        |

       File  names  can  also  not  begin  or  end with the following characters.  These only get
       replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠
       HT          0x09         ␉
       LF          0x0A         ␊
       VT          0x0B         ␋
       CR          0x0D         ␍

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

   –opendrive-username
       Username.

       Properties:

       • Config: username

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_USERNAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –opendrive-password
       Password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

   –opendrive-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   –opendrive-chunk-size
       Files will be uploaded in chunks this size.

       Note that these chunks are buffered in memory so increasing them will increase memory use.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 10Mi

   Limitations
       Note  that  OpenDrive  is case insensitive so you can’t have a file called “Hello.doc” and
       one called “hello.doc”.

       There are quite a few characters that can’t be in OpenDrive file names.  These can’t occur
       on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows platforms they are common.  Rclone will map these
       names to and from an identical looking unicode equivalent.  For example if a file has a  ?
       in it will be mapped to  instead.

       rclone  about is not supported by the OpenDrive backend.  Backends without this capability
       cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space)  as  a
       member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Oracle Object Storage

       Oracle         Object         Storage         Overview        (https://docs.oracle.com/en-
       us/iaas/Content/Object/Concepts/objectstorageoverview.htm)

       Oracle Object Storage FAQ (https://www.oracle.com/cloud/storage/object-storage/faq/)

       Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote:  for  the  lsd  command.)   You  may  put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here  is an example of making an oracle object storage configuration.  rclone config walks
       you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n

              Enter name for new remote.
              name> remote

              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              [snip]
              XX / Oracle Cloud Infrastructure Object Storage
                 \ (oracleobjectstorage)
              Storage> oracleobjectstorage

              Option provider.
              Choose your Auth Provider
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
              Press Enter for the default (env_auth).
               1 / automatically pickup the credentials from runtime(env), first one to provide auth wins
                 \ (env_auth)
                 / use an OCI user and an API key for authentication.
               2 | you’ll need to put in a config file your tenancy OCID, user OCID, region, the path, fingerprint to an API key.
                 | https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/API/Concepts/sdkconfig.htm
                 \ (user_principal_auth)
                 / use instance principals to authorize an instance to make API calls.
               3 | each instance has its own identity, and authenticates using the certificates that are read from instance metadata.
                 | https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/Identity/Tasks/callingservicesfrominstances.htm
                 \ (instance_principal_auth)
               4 / use resource principals to make API calls
                 \ (resource_principal_auth)
               5 / no credentials needed, this is typically for reading public buckets
                 \ (no_auth)
              provider> 2

              Option namespace.
              Object storage namespace
              Enter a value.
              namespace> idbamagbg734

              Option compartment.
              Object storage compartment OCID
              Enter a value.
              compartment> ocid1.compartment.oc1..aaaaaaaapufkxc7ame3sthry5i7ujrwfc7ejnthhu6bhanm5oqfjpyasjkba

              Option region.
              Object storage Region
              Enter a value.
              region> us-ashburn-1

              Option endpoint.
              Endpoint for Object storage API.
              Leave blank to use the default endpoint for the region.
              Enter a value. Press Enter to leave empty.
              endpoint>

              Option config_file.
              Path to OCI config file
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
              Press Enter for the default (~/.oci/config).
               1 / oci configuration file location
                 \ (~/.oci/config)
              config_file> /etc/oci/dev.conf

              Option config_profile.
              Profile name inside OCI config file
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own string value.
              Press Enter for the default (Default).
               1 / Use the default profile
                 \ (Default)
              config_profile> Test

              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n

              Configuration complete.
              Options:
              - type: oracleobjectstorage
              - namespace: idbamagbg734
              - compartment: ocid1.compartment.oc1..aaaaaaaapufkxc7ame3sthry5i7ujrwfc7ejnthhu6bhanm5oqfjpyasjkba
              - region: us-ashburn-1
              - provider: user_principal_auth
              - config_file: /etc/oci/dev.conf
              - config_profile: Test
              Keep this "remote" remote?
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See all buckets

              rclone lsd remote:

       Create a new bucket

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

       List the contents of a bucket

              rclone ls remote:bucket
              rclone ls remote:bucket --max-depth 1

   Modified time
       The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as opc-meta-mtime as floating  point
       since the epoch, accurate to 1 ns.

       If  the modification time needs to be updated rclone will attempt to perform a server side
       copy to update the modification if the object can be copied in a single part.  In the case
       the object is larger than 5Gb, the object will be uploaded rather than copied.

       Note  that  reading  this from the object takes an additional HEAD request as the metadata
       isn’t returned in object listings.

   Multipart uploads
       rclone supports multipart uploads with OOS which means that it  can  upload  files  bigger
       than 5 GiB.

       Note  that files uploaded both with multipart upload and through crypt remotes do not have
       MD5 sums.

       rclone switches from single part uploads to multipart uploads at the  point  specified  by
       --oos-upload-cutoff.   This can be a maximum of 5 GiB and a minimum of 0 (ie always upload
       multipart files).

       The chunk sizes used in the multipart upload are specified  by  --oos-chunk-size  and  the
       number of chunks uploaded concurrently is specified by --oos-upload-concurrency.

       Multipart uploads will use --transfers * --oos-upload-concurrency * --oos-chunk-size extra
       memory.  Single part uploads to not use extra memory.

       Single part transfers can be faster than multipart transfers or slower depending  on  your
       latency from oos - the more latency, the more likely single part transfers will be faster.

       Increasing --oos-upload-concurrency will increase throughput (8 would be a sensible value)
       and increasing  --oos-chunk-size  also  increases  throughput  (16M  would  be  sensible).
       Increasing  either  of  these will use more memory.  The default values are high enough to
       gain most of the possible performance without using too much memory.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to oracleobjectstorage (Oracle Cloud Infrastructure
       Object Storage).

   –oos-provider
       Choose your Auth Provider

       Properties:

       • Config: provider

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_PROVIDER

       • Type: string

       • Default: “env_auth”

       • Examples:

         • “env_auth”

           • automatically  pickup  the  credentials from runtime(env), first one to provide auth
             wins

         • “user_principal_auth”

           • use an OCI user and an API key for authentication.

           • you’ll need to put in a config file your tenancy OCID, user OCID, region, the  path,
             fingerprint to an API key.

           • https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/Content/API/Concepts/sdkconfig.htm

         • “instance_principal_auth”

           • use instance principals to authorize an instance to make API calls.

           • each  instance  has  its own identity, and authenticates using the certificates that
             are read from instance metadata.

           • https://docs.oracle.com/en-
             us/iaas/Content/Identity/Tasks/callingservicesfrominstances.htm

         • “resource_principal_auth”

           • use resource principals to make API calls

         • “no_auth”

           • no credentials needed, this is typically for reading public buckets

   –oos-namespace
       Object storage namespace

       Properties:

       • Config: namespace

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_NAMESPACE

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –oos-compartment
       Object storage compartment OCID

       Properties:

       • Config: compartment

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COMPARTMENT

       • Provider: !no_auth

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –oos-region
       Object storage Region

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_REGION

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –oos-endpoint
       Endpoint for Object storage API.

       Leave blank to use the default endpoint for the region.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –oos-config-file
       Path to OCI config file

       Properties:

       • Config: config_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CONFIG_FILE

       • Provider: user_principal_auth

       • Type: string

       • Default: “~/.oci/config”

       • Examples:

         • “~/.oci/config”

           • oci configuration file location

   –oos-config-profile
       Profile name inside the oci config file

       Properties:

       • Config: config_profile

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CONFIG_PROFILE

       • Provider: user_principal_auth

       • Type: string

       • Default: “Default”

       • Examples:

         • “Default”

           • Use the default profile

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to oracleobjectstorage (Oracle Cloud Infrastructure
       Object Storage).

   –oos-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

       Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and
       the maximum is 5 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 200Mi

   –oos-chunk-size
       Chunk size to use for uploading.

       When  uploading  files  larger  than  upload_cutoff  or files with unknown size (e.g. from
       “rclone rcat” or uploaded with “rclone mount” or google photos or google docs)  they  will
       be uploaded as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

       Note that “upload_concurrency” chunks of this size are buffered in memory per transfer.

       If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then
       increasing this will speed up the transfers.

       Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a  large  file  of  known
       size to stay below the 10,000 chunks limit.

       Files  of  unknown  size  are  uploaded with the configured chunk_size.  Since the default
       chunk size is 5 MiB and there can be at most 10,000 chunks, this means that by default the
       maximum  size  of  a  file  you can stream upload is 48 GiB.  If you wish to stream upload
       larger files then you will need to increase chunk_size.

       Increasing the chunk size decreases the accuracy of the progress statistics displayed with
       “-P” flag.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 5Mi

   –oos-upload-concurrency
       Concurrency for multipart uploads.

       This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

       If  you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads
       do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then  increasing  this  may  help  to  speed  up  the
       transfers.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 10

   –oos-copy-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to multipart copy.

       Any  files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be copied in chunks of
       this size.

       The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COPY_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 4.656Gi

   –oos-copy-timeout
       Timeout for copy.

       Copy is an asynchronous operation, specify timeout to wait for copy to succeed

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_COPY_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –oos-disable-checksum
       Don’t store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

       Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before uploading it so it can
       add it to metadata on the object.  This is great for data integrity checking but can cause
       long delays for large files to start uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_checksum

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_DISABLE_CHECKSUM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –oos-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   –oos-leave-parts-on-error
       If  true  avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts
       on S3 for manual recovery.

       It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

       WARNING: Storing parts of an incomplete multipart upload counts  towards  space  usage  on
       object storage and will add additional costs if not cleaned up.

       Properties:

       • Config: leave_parts_on_error

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –oos-no-check-bucket
       If set, don’t attempt to check the bucket exists or create it.

       This  can  be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions rclone does if you
       know the bucket exists already.

       It can also be needed if the user you are using does not have bucket creation permissions.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_check_bucket

       • Env Var: RCLONE_OOS_NO_CHECK_BUCKET

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the oracleobjectstorage backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These   can   be   run   on  a  running  backend  using  the  rc  command  backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   rename
       change the name of an object

              rclone backend rename remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command can be used to rename a object.

       Usage Examples:

              rclone backend rename oos:bucket relative-object-path-under-bucket object-new-name

   list-multipart-uploads
       List the unfinished multipart uploads

              rclone backend list-multipart-uploads remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This command lists the unfinished multipart uploads in JSON format.

              rclone backend list-multipart-uploads oos:bucket/path/to/object

       It returns a dictionary of buckets with values as lists of unfinished multipart uploads.

       You can call it with no bucket in which case it lists all bucket, with a bucket or with  a
       bucket and path.

              {
                "test-bucket": [
                          {
                                  "namespace": "test-namespace",
                                  "bucket": "test-bucket",
                                  "object": "600m.bin",
                                  "uploadId": "51dd8114-52a4-b2f2-c42f-5291f05eb3c8",
                                  "timeCreated": "2022-07-29T06:21:16.595Z",
                                  "storageTier": "Standard"
                          }
                  ]

   cleanup
       Remove unfinished multipart uploads.

              rclone backend cleanup remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This  command  removes  unfinished  multipart  uploads  of  age greater than max-age which
       defaults to 24 hours.

       Note that you can use -i/–dry-run with this command to see what it would do.

              rclone backend cleanup oos:bucket/path/to/object
              rclone backend cleanup -o max-age=7w oos:bucket/path/to/object

       Durations are parsed as per the rest of rclone, 2h, 7d, 7w etc.

       Options:

       • “max-age”: Max age of upload to delete

QingStor

       Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote:  for  the  lsd  command.)   You  may  put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making an QingStor configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/r/c/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / QingStor Object Storage
                 \ "qingstor"
              [snip]
              Storage> qingstor
              Get QingStor credentials from runtime. Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter QingStor credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> 1
              QingStor Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              access_key_id> access_key
              QingStor Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
              secret_access_key> secret_key
              Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.
              Leave blank will use the default value "https://qingstor.com:443"
              endpoint>
              Zone connect to. Default is "pek3a".
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
                 / The Beijing (China) Three Zone
               1 | Needs location constraint pek3a.
                 \ "pek3a"
                 / The Shanghai (China) First Zone
               2 | Needs location constraint sh1a.
                 \ "sh1a"
              zone> 1
              Number of connection retry.
              Leave blank will use the default value "3".
              connection_retries>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              env_auth = false
              access_key_id = access_key
              secret_access_key = secret_key
              endpoint =
              zone = pek3a
              connection_retries =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all buckets

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new bucket

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

       List the contents of a bucket

              rclone ls remote:bucket

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess files in the bucket.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

   –fast-list
       This  remote  supports  --fast-list which allows you to use fewer transactions in exchange
       for more memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list)  for  more
       details.

   Multipart uploads
       rclone  supports  multipart  uploads  with  QingStor  which means that it can upload files
       bigger than 5 GiB.  Note that files uploaded with multipart upload don’t have an MD5SUM.

       Note that incomplete multipart uploads older than 24 hours  can  be  removed  with  rclone
       cleanup  remote:bucket  just  for  one  bucket  rclone  cleanup  remote:  for all buckets.
       QingStor does not ever remove incomplete multipart uploads so it may be necessary  to  run
       this from time to time.

   Buckets and Zone
       With  QingStor  you  can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any zone, but you can only access
       the content of a bucket from the zone it was created in.   If  you  attempt  to  access  a
       bucket  from  the  wrong zone, you will get an error, incorrect zone, the bucket is not in
       'XXX' zone.

   Authentication
       There are two ways to supply rclone with a set  of  QingStor  credentials.   In  order  of
       precedence:

       • Directly in the rclone configuration file (as configured by rclone config)

         • set access_key_id and secret_access_key

       • Runtime configuration:

         • set env_auth to true in the config file

         • Exporting the following environment variables before running rclone

           • Access Key ID: QS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or QS_ACCESS_KEY

           • Secret Access Key: QS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or QS_SECRET_KEY

   Restricted filename characters
       The  control  characters  0x00-0x1F  and  /  are  replaced  as  in  the default restricted
       characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters).  Note  that  0x7F  is
       not replaced.

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

   –qingstor-env-auth
       Get QingStor credentials from runtime.

       Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

       Properties:

       • Config: env_auth

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENV_AUTH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “false”

           • Enter QingStor credentials in the next step.

         • “true”

           • Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM).

   –qingstor-access-key-id
       QingStor Access Key ID.

       Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_key_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ACCESS_KEY_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –qingstor-secret-access-key
       QingStor Secret Access Key (password).

       Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

       Properties:

       • Config: secret_access_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –qingstor-endpoint
       Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.

       Leave blank will use the default value “https://qingstor.com:443”.

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENDPOINT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –qingstor-zone
       Zone to connect to.

       Default is “pek3a”.

       Properties:

       • Config: zone

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ZONE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “pek3a”

           • The Beijing (China) Three Zone.

           • Needs location constraint pek3a.

         • “sh1a”

           • The Shanghai (China) First Zone.

           • Needs location constraint sh1a.

         • “gd2a”

           • The Guangdong (China) Second Zone.

           • Needs location constraint gd2a.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

   –qingstor-connection-retries
       Number of connection retries.

       Properties:

       • Config: connection_retries

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CONNECTION_RETRIES

       • Type: int

       • Default: 3

   –qingstor-upload-cutoff
       Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

       Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.  The minimum is 0 and
       the maximum is 5 GiB.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_cutoff

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CUTOFF

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 200Mi

   –qingstor-chunk-size
       Chunk size to use for uploading.

       When  uploading files larger than upload_cutoff they will be uploaded as multipart uploads
       using this chunk size.

       Note that “–qingstor-upload-concurrency” chunks of this size are buffered  in  memory  per
       transfer.

       If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have enough memory, then
       increasing this will speed up the transfers.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 4Mi

   –qingstor-upload-concurrency
       Concurrency for multipart uploads.

       This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded concurrently.

       NB if you set this to > 1 then the checksums of multipart uploads  become  corrupted  (the
       uploads themselves are not corrupted though).

       If  you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links and these uploads
       do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then  increasing  this  may  help  to  speed  up  the
       transfers.

       Properties:

       • Config: upload_concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 1

   –qingstor-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

   Limitations
       rclone about is not supported by the qingstor backend.  Backends without  this  capability
       cannot  determine  free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space) as a
       member of an rclone union remote.

       See     List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone      about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)          and         rclone         about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Sia

       Sia (sia.tech (https://sia.tech/)) is a decentralized cloud storage platform based on  the
       blockchain (https://wikipedia.org/wiki/Blockchain) technology.  With rclone you can use it
       like any other remote filesystem or mount Sia folders locally.  The technology  behind  it
       involves  a  number of new concepts such as Siacoins and Wallet, Blockchain and Consensus,
       Renting and Hosting, and so on.  If you are new to  it,  you’d  better  first  familiarize
       yourself using their excellent support documentation (https://support.sia.tech/).

   Introduction
       Before you can use rclone with Sia, you will need to have a running copy of Sia-UI or siad
       (the Sia daemon) locally on your computer or on local network (e.g. a NAS).  Please follow
       the Get started (https://sia.tech/get-started) guide and install one.

       rclone   interacts   with  Sia  network  by  talking  to  the  Sia  daemon  via  HTTP  API
       (https://sia.tech/docs/) which is usually available on port 9980.  By default you will run
       the  daemon locally on the same computer so it’s safe to leave the API password blank (the
       API URL will be http://127.0.0.1:9980 making external access impossible).

       However, if you want to access Sia daemon running on another  node,  for  example  due  to
       memory  constraints  or because you want to share single daemon between several rclone and
       Sia-UI instances, you’ll need to make a few more provisions: - Ensure you have Sia  daemon
       installed         directly         or         in         a         docker        container
       (https://github.com/SiaFoundation/siad/pkgs/container/siad)  because   Sia-UI   does   not
       support  this  mode natively.  - Run it on externally accessible port, for example provide
       --api-addr :9980 and --disable-api-security arguments  on  the  daemon  command  line.   -
       Enforce API password for the siad daemon via environment variable SIA_API_PASSWORD or text
       file named apipassword in the daemon directory.  - Set rclone backend option  api_password
       taking it from above locations.

       Notes:  1.   If  your wallet is locked, rclone cannot unlock it automatically.  You should
       either unlock it in advance by using Sia-UI  or  via  command  line  siac  wallet  unlock.
       Alternatively  you  can make siad unlock your wallet automatically upon startup by running
       it  with  environment  variable  SIA_WALLET_PASSWORD.   2.   If  siad  cannot   find   the
       SIA_API_PASSWORD  variable  or  the  apipassword  file  in  the SIA_DIR directory, it will
       generate  a  random  password  and  store  in  the  text  file  named  apipassword   under
       YOUR_HOME/.sia/  directory  on Unix or C:\Users\YOUR_HOME\AppData\Local\Sia\apipassword on
       Windows.  Remember this when you configure password in rclone.  3.  The only  way  to  use
       siad  without  API  password  is  to  run  it  on  localhost  with  command  line argument
       --authorize-api=false, but this is insecure and strongly discouraged.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a sia remote called mySia.  First, run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> mySia
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              ...
              29 / Sia Decentralized Cloud
                 \ "sia"
              ...
              Storage> sia
              Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980.
              Note that siad must run with --disable-api-security to open API port for other hosts (not recommended).
              Keep default if Sia daemon runs on localhost.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("http://127.0.0.1:9980").
              api_url> http://127.0.0.1:9980
              Sia Daemon API Password.
              Can be found in the apipassword file located in HOME/.sia/ or in the daemon directory.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g/n> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              --------------------
              [mySia]
              type = sia
              api_url = http://127.0.0.1:9980
              api_password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Once configured, you can then use rclone like this:

       • List directories in top level of your Sia storage

         rclone lsd mySia:

       • List all the files in your Sia storage

         rclone ls mySia:

       • Upload a local directory to the Sia directory called backup

         rclone copy /home/source mySia:backup

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to sia (Sia Decentralized Cloud).

   –sia-api-url
       Sia daemon API URL, like http://sia.daemon.host:9980.

       Note that siad must run with –disable-api-security to open API port for other  hosts  (not
       recommended).  Keep default if Sia daemon runs on localhost.

       Properties:

       • Config: api_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_API_URL

       • Type: string

       • Default: “http://127.0.0.1:9980”

   –sia-api-password
       Sia Daemon API Password.

       Can be found in the apipassword file located in HOME/.sia/ or in the daemon directory.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: api_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_API_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to sia (Sia Decentralized Cloud).

   –sia-user-agent
       Siad User Agent

       Sia daemon requires the `Sia-Agent' user agent by default for security

       Properties:

       • Config: user_agent

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_USER_AGENT

       • Type: string

       • Default: “Sia-Agent”

   –sia-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SIA_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Question,Hash,Percent,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       • Modification times not supported

       • Checksums not supported

       • rclone about not supported

       • rclone  can  work  only  with  Siad  or  Sia-UI  at the moment, the SkyNet daemon is not
         supported yet.

       • Sia does not allow control characters or symbols like question and pound signs  in  file
         names.   rclone  will  transparently encode (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) them
         for you, but you’d better be aware

Swift

       Swift  refers  to  OpenStack  Object  Storage  (https://docs.openstack.org/swift/latest/).
       Commercial implementations of that being:

       • Rackspace Cloud Files (https://www.rackspace.com/cloud/files/)

       • Memset Memstore (https://www.memset.com/cloud/storage/)

       • OVH Object Storage (https://www.ovh.co.uk/public-cloud/storage/object-storage/)

       • Oracle   Cloud   Storage  (https://docs.oracle.com/en-us/iaas/integration/doc/configure-
         object-storage.html)

       • IBM             Bluemix              Cloud              ObjectStorage              Swift
         (https://console.bluemix.net/docs/infrastructure/objectstorage-swift/index.html)

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:container (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:container/path/to/dir.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a swift configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)
                 \ "swift"
              [snip]
              Storage> swift
              Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Enter swift credentials in the next step
                 \ "false"
               2 / Get swift credentials from environment vars. Leave other fields blank if using this.
                 \ "true"
              env_auth> true
              User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).
              user>
              API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).
              key>
              Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Rackspace US
                 \ "https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
               2 / Rackspace UK
                 \ "https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
               3 / Rackspace v2
                 \ "https://identity.api.rackspacecloud.com/v2.0"
               4 / Memset Memstore UK
                 \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v1.0"
               5 / Memset Memstore UK v2
                 \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v2.0"
               6 / OVH
                 \ "https://auth.cloud.ovh.net/v3"
              auth>
              User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).
              user_id>
              User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
              domain>
              Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
              tenant>
              Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
              tenant_id>
              Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
              tenant_domain>
              Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
              region>
              Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
              storage_url>
              Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
              auth_token>
              AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
              auth_version>
              Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE)
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Public (default, choose this if not sure)
                 \ "public"
               2 / Internal (use internal service net)
                 \ "internal"
               3 / Admin
                 \ "admin"
              endpoint_type>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [test]
              env_auth = true
              user =
              key =
              auth =
              user_id =
              domain =
              tenant =
              tenant_id =
              tenant_domain =
              region =
              storage_url =
              auth_token =
              auth_version =
              endpoint_type =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

       See all containers

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new container

              rclone mkdir remote:container

       List the contents of a container

              rclone ls remote:container

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote container,  deleting  any  excess  files  in  the
       container.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:container

   Configuration from an OpenStack credentials file
       An  OpenStack  credentials file typically looks something something like this (without the
       comments)

              export OS_AUTH_URL=https://a.provider.net/v2.0
              export OS_TENANT_ID=ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff
              export OS_TENANT_NAME="1234567890123456"
              export OS_USERNAME="123abc567xy"
              echo "Please enter your OpenStack Password: "
              read -sr OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
              export OS_PASSWORD=$OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
              export OS_REGION_NAME="SBG1"
              if [ -z "$OS_REGION_NAME" ]; then unset OS_REGION_NAME; fi

       The config file needs to look something like this where $OS_USERNAME represents the  value
       of the OS_USERNAME variable - 123abc567xy in the example above.

              [remote]
              type = swift
              user = $OS_USERNAME
              key = $OS_PASSWORD
              auth = $OS_AUTH_URL
              tenant = $OS_TENANT_NAME

       Note that you may (or may not) need to set region too - try without first.

   Configuration from the environment
       If  you  prefer  you  can  configure rclone to use swift using a standard set of OpenStack
       environment variables.

       When you run through the config,  make  sure  you  choose  true  for  env_auth  and  leave
       everything else blank.

       rclone  will  then  set  any  empty  config parameters from the environment using standard
       OpenStack   environment   variables.    There    is    a    list    of    the    variables
       (https://godoc.org/github.com/ncw/swift#Connection.ApplyEnvironment)  in  the docs for the
       swift library.

   Using an alternate authentication method
       If your OpenStack installation uses a non-standard authentication method that might not be
       yet  supported  by rclone or the underlying swift library, you can authenticate externally
       (e.g. calling manually the openstack commands to get a token).  Then,  you  just  need  to
       pass  the  two  configuration  variables  auth_token  and  storage_url.   If they are both
       provided, the other variables are ignored.   rclone  will  not  try  to  authenticate  but
       instead  assume  it  is  already  authenticated  and use these two variables to access the
       OpenStack installation.

   Using rclone without a config file
       You can use rclone with swift without a config file, if desired, like this:

              source openstack-credentials-file
              export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_TYPE=swift
              export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_ENV_AUTH=true
              rclone lsd myremote:

   –fast-list
       This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer  transactions  in  exchange
       for  more  memory.   See  the  rclone  docs  (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for more
       details.

   –update and –use-server-modtime
       As noted below, the modified time is stored on metadata on the  object.   It  is  used  by
       default  for  all  operations  that require checking the time a file was last updated.  It
       allows rclone to treat the remote more like a  true  filesystem,  but  it  is  inefficient
       because it requires an extra API call to retrieve the metadata.

       For  many operations, the time the object was last uploaded to the remote is sufficient to
       determine if it is “dirty”.  By using --update along with  --use-server-modtime,  you  can
       avoid  the  extra  API  call and simply upload files whose local modtime is newer than the
       time it was last uploaded.

   Modified time
       The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as X-Object-Meta-Mtime  as  floating
       point since the epoch accurate to 1 ns.

       This  is  a de facto standard (used in the official python-swiftclient amongst others) for
       storing the modification time for an object.

   Restricted filename characters
       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here  are  the Standard options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files,
       Memset Memstore, OVH)).

   –swift-env-auth
       Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.

       Properties:

       • Config: env_auth

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENV_AUTH

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “false”

           • Enter swift credentials in the next step.

         • “true”

           • Get swift credentials from environment vars.

           • Leave other fields blank if using this.

   –swift-user
       User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-key
       API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).

       Properties:

       • Config: key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-auth
       Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).

       Properties:

       • Config: auth

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0”

           • Rackspace US

         • “https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0”

           • Rackspace UK

         • “https://identity.api.rackspacecloud.com/v2.0”

           • Rackspace v2

         • “https://auth.storage.memset.com/v1.0”

           • Memset Memstore UK

         • “https://auth.storage.memset.com/v2.0”

           • Memset Memstore UK v2

         • “https://auth.cloud.ovh.net/v3”

           • OVH

   –swift-user-id
       User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3  auth)
       (OS_USER_ID).

       Properties:

       • Config: user_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-domain
       User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)

       Properties:

       • Config: domain

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_DOMAIN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-tenant
       Tenant  name  - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME
       or OS_PROJECT_NAME).

       Properties:

       • Config: tenant

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-tenant-id
       Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID).

       Properties:

       • Config: tenant_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-tenant-domain
       Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME).

       Properties:

       • Config: tenant_domain

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_DOMAIN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-region
       Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME).

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_REGION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-storage-url
       Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL).

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-auth-token
       Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN).

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-application-credential-id
       Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID).

       Properties:

       • Config: application_credential_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-application-credential-name
       Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME).

       Properties:

       • Config: application_credential_name

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-application-credential-secret
       Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET).

       Properties:

       • Config: application_credential_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –swift-auth-version
       AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION).

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_version

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_VERSION

       • Type: int

       • Default: 0

   –swift-endpoint-type
       Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE).

       Properties:

       • Config: endpoint_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENDPOINT_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Default: “public”

       • Examples:

         • “public”

           • Public (default, choose this if not sure)

         • “internal”

           • Internal (use internal service net)

         • “admin”

           • Admin

   –swift-storage-policy
       The storage policy to use when creating a new container.

       This applies the specified storage policy when  creating  a  new  container.   The  policy
       cannot  be  changed afterwards.  The allowed configuration values and their meaning depend
       on your Swift storage provider.

       Properties:

       • Config: storage_policy

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_POLICY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “”

           • Default

         • “pcs”

           • OVH Public Cloud Storage

         • “pca”

           • OVH Public Cloud Archive

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace  Cloud  Files,
       Memset Memstore, OVH)).

   –swift-leave-parts-on-error
       If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure.

       It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

       Properties:

       • Config: leave_parts_on_error

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –swift-chunk-size
       Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.

       Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.  The default for this is
       5 GiB which is its maximum value.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 5Gi

   –swift-no-chunk
       Don’t chunk files during streaming upload.

       When doing streaming uploads (e.g. using rcat or mount) setting this flag will  cause  the
       swift backend to not upload chunked files.

       This will limit the maximum upload size to 5 GiB.  However non chunked files are easier to
       deal with and have an MD5SUM.

       Rclone will still chunk files bigger than chunk_size when doing normal copy operations.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_chunk

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_NO_CHUNK

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –swift-no-large-objects
       Disable support for static and dynamic large objects

       Swift cannot transparently store files bigger than 5 GiB.  There are two schemes for doing
       that,  static  or  dynamic  large  objects, and the API does not allow rclone to determine
       whether a file is a static or dynamic large object without doing a  HEAD  on  the  object.
       Since  these  need to be treated differently, this means rclone has to issue HEAD requests
       for objects for example when reading checksums.

       When no_large_objects is set, rclone will assume that there are no static or dynamic large
       objects stored.  This means it can stop doing the extra HEAD calls which in turn increases
       performance greatly especially when doing a swift to swift transfer with --checksum set.

       Setting this option implies no_chunk and also that no files will be uploaded in chunks, so
       files bigger than 5 GiB will just fail on upload.

       If  you set this option and there are static or dynamic large objects, then this will give
       incorrect hashes for them.  Downloads will succeed, but other operations  such  as  Remove
       and Copy will fail.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_large_objects

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_NO_LARGE_OBJECTS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –swift-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8

   Limitations
       The Swift API doesn’t return a correct MD5SUM for segmented files (Dynamic or Static Large
       Objects) so rclone won’t check or use the MD5SUM for these.

   Troubleshooting
   Rclone gives Failed to create file system for “remote:”: Bad Request
       Due  to  an  oddity of the underlying swift library, it gives a “Bad Request” error rather
       than a more sensible error when the authentication fails for Swift.

       So this most likely means your username / password is wrong.  You can investigate  further
       with the --dump-bodies flag.

       This may also be caused by specifying the region when you shouldn’t have (e.g. OVH).

   Rclone gives Failed to create file system: Response didn’t have storage url and auth token
       This  is  most  likely caused by forgetting to specify your tenant when setting up a swift
       remote.

   OVH Cloud Archive
       To use rclone with OVH cloud archive, first use rclone config to set up  a  swift  backend
       with OVH, choosing pca as the storage_policy.

   Uploading Objects
       Uploading  objects to OVH cloud archive is no different to object storage, you just simply
       run the command you like (move, copy or sync) to upload the objects.   Once  uploaded  the
       objects will show in a “Frozen” state within the OVH control panel.

   Retrieving Objects
       To  retrieve objects use rclone copy as normal.  If the objects are in a frozen state then
       rclone will ask for them all to be unfrozen and it will wait at the end of the output with
       a message like the following:

       2019/03/23    13:06:33   NOTICE:   Received   retry   after   error   -   sleeping   until
       2019-03-23T13:16:33.481657164+01:00 (9m59.99985121s)

       Rclone will wait for the time specified then retry the copy.

pCloud

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for pCloud involves getting a token from pCloud which you need to do  in
       your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Pcloud
                 \ "pcloud"
              [snip]
              Storage> pcloud
              Pcloud App Client Id - leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              Pcloud App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  pCloud.   This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get
       back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this  it  may  require
       you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your pCloud

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your pCloud

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a pCloud directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       pCloud allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1 second.  These will be
       used to detect whether objects need syncing or not.  In order to set a  Modification  time
       pCloud requires the object be re-uploaded.

       pCloud supports MD5 and SHA1 hashes in the US region, and SHA1 and SHA256 hashes in the EU
       region, so you can use the --checksum flag.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Deleting files
       Deleted files will be moved to the trash.  Your subscription level will determine how long
       items stay in the trash.  rclone cleanup can be used to empty the trash.

   Emptying the trash
       Due to an API limitation, the rclone cleanup command  will  only  work  if  you  set  your
       username  and  password in the advanced options for this backend.  Since we generally want
       to avoid storing user passwords in the rclone config file, we advise you to only set  this
       up if you need the rclone cleanup command to work.

   Root folder ID
       You  can  set  the  root_folder_id  for  rclone.  This is the directory (identified by its
       Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root of your pCloud drive.

       Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will  determine  the  correct  root  to  use
       itself.

       However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder hierarchy.

       In  order  to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the directory you wish rclone
       to display.  This will be the folder field of the URL when you open the relevant folder in
       the pCloud web interface.

       So   if   the   folder   you   want   rclone   to   use   has   a  URL  which  looks  like
       https://my.pcloud.com/#page=filemanager&folder=5xxxxxxxx8&tpl=foldergrid in  the  browser,
       then you use 5xxxxxxxx8 as the root_folder_id in the config.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

   –pcloud-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –pcloud-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

   –pcloud-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –pcloud-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –pcloud-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –pcloud-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   –pcloud-root-folder-id
       Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_folder_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ROOT_FOLDER_ID

       • Type: string

       • Default: “d0”

   –pcloud-hostname
       Hostname to connect to.

       This is normally set when rclone initially does the oauth  connection,  however  you  will
       need to set it by hand if you are using remote config with rclone authorize.

       Properties:

       • Config: hostname

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_HOSTNAME

       • Type: string

       • Default: “api.pcloud.com”

       • Examples:

         • “api.pcloud.com”

           • Original/US region

         • “eapi.pcloud.com”

           • EU region

   –pcloud-username
       Your pcloud username.

       This  is  only  required  when  you  want to use the cleanup command.  Due to a bug in the
       pcloud API the required API does not support OAuth authentication so we have  to  rely  on
       user password authentication for it.

       Properties:

       • Config: username

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_USERNAME

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –pcloud-password
       Your pcloud password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_PASSWORD

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

premiumize.me

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for premiumize.me (https://premiumize.me/) involves getting a token from
       premiumize.me which you need to do in your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / premiumize.me
                 \ "premiumizeme"
              [snip]
              Storage> premiumizeme
              ** See help for premiumizeme backend at: https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/ **

              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = premiumizeme
              token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2029-08-07T18:44:15.548915378+01:00"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

       See  the  remote  setup  docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set it up on a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token  as  returned
       from  premiumize.me.   This  only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment
       you get back the verification code.  This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and  this  it  may
       require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your premiumize.me

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your premiumize.me

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an premiumize.me directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       premiumize.me  does  not  support  modification  times  or  hashes, therefore syncing will
       default to --size-only checking.  Note that using --update will work.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \
       ”           0x22        "

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

   –premiumizeme-api-key
       API Key.

       This is not normally used - use oauth instead.

       Properties:

       • Config: api_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_API_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

   –premiumizeme-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Note that premiumize.me is case insensitive so you can’t have a  file  called  “Hello.doc”
       and one called “hello.doc”.

       premiumize.me  file  names  can’t have the \ or " characters in.  rclone maps these to and
       from an identical looking unicode equivalents  and 

       premiumize.me only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

put.io

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       put.io paths may be as deep as required, e.g.  remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for put.io involves getting a token from put.io which you need to do  in
       your browser.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> putio
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Put.io
                 \ "putio"
              [snip]
              Storage> putio
              ** See help for putio backend at: https://rclone.org/putio/ **

              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [putio]
              type = putio
              token = {"access_token":"XXXXXXXX","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              putio                putio

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

       Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned
       from Google if you use auto config mode.  This only runs from the  moment  it  opens  your
       browser   to   the   moment   you   get   back   the   verification   code.   This  is  on
       http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock it temporarily if  you  are
       running a host firewall, or use manual mode.

       You can then use it like this,

       List directories in top level of your put.io

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your put.io

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to a put.io directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Restricted filename characters
       In       addition       to       the      default      restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) the  following  characters  are  also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       \           0x5C        \

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to putio (Put.io).

   –putio-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_PUTIO_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       put.io  has  rate  limiting.   When  you  hit  a limit, rclone automatically retries after
       waiting the amount of time requested by the server.

       If you want to avoid ever hitting these limits, you may use the --tpslimit flag with a low
       number.   Note  that the imposed limits may be different for different operations, and may
       change over time.

Seafile

       This is a backend for the Seafile (https://www.seafile.com/) storage service: -  It  works
       with  both the free community edition or the professional edition.  - Seafile versions 6.x
       and 7.x are all supported.  - Encrypted libraries are also supported.  - It  supports  2FA
       enabled users

   Configuration
       There  are  two  distinct  modes you can setup your remote: - you point your remote to the
       root of the server, meaning you don’t specify a library during  the  configuration:  Paths
       are    specified    as    remote:library.     You   may   put   subdirectories   in   too,
       e.g. remote:library/path/to/dir.  - you point your remote to a specific library during the
       configuration:  Paths  are  specified as remote:path/to/dir.  This is the recommended mode
       when using encrypted libraries.  (This mode is possibly  slightly  faster  than  the  root
       mode)

   Configuration in root mode
       Here  is  an  example  of  making  a  seafile  configuration for a user with no two-factor
       authentication.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.  To authenticate you  will  need
       the URL of your server, your email (or username) and your password.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> seafile
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Seafile
                 \ "seafile"
              [snip]
              Storage> seafile
              ** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

              URL of seafile host to connect to
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
                 \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
              url> http://my.seafile.server/
              User name (usually email address)
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              user> me@example.com
              Password
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              2fa> false
              Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              library>
              Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g/n> n
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Two-factor authentication is not enabled on this account.
              --------------------
              [seafile]
              type = seafile
              url = http://my.seafile.server/
              user = me@example.com
              pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              2fa = false
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This  remote  is called seafile.  It’s pointing to the root of your seafile server and can
       now be used like this:

       See all libraries

              rclone lsd seafile:

       Create a new library

              rclone mkdir seafile:library

       List the contents of a library

              rclone ls seafile:library

       Sync /home/local/directory to the  remote  library,  deleting  any  excess  files  in  the
       library.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory seafile:library

   Configuration in library mode
       Here’s  an  example of a configuration in library mode with a user that has the two-factor
       authentication enabled.  Your 2FA code will be asked at the end of the configuration,  and
       will attempt to authenticate you:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> seafile
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Seafile
                 \ "seafile"
              [snip]
              Storage> seafile
              ** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

              URL of seafile host to connect to
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
                 \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
              url> http://my.seafile.server/
              User name (usually email address)
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              user> me@example.com
              Password
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              2fa> true
              Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              library> My Library
              Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g/n> n
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Two-factor authentication: please enter your 2FA code
              2fa code> 123456
              Authenticating...
              Success!
              --------------------
              [seafile]
              type = seafile
              url = http://my.seafile.server/
              user = me@example.com
              pass =
              2fa = true
              library = My Library
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       You’ll  notice your password is blank in the configuration.  It’s because we only need the
       password to authenticate you once.

       You specified My Library during the configuration.  The root of the remote is pointing  at
       the root of the library My Library:

       See all files in the library:

              rclone lsd seafile:

       Create a new directory inside the library

              rclone mkdir seafile:directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls seafile:directory

       Sync  /home/local/directory  to  the  remote  library,  deleting  any  excess files in the
       library.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory seafile:

   –fast-list
       Seafile version 7+ supports --fast-list which allows you  to  use  fewer  transactions  in
       exchange  for  more  memory.  See the rclone docs (https://rclone.org/docs/#fast-list) for
       more details.  Please note this is not supported on seafile server version 6.x

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       /           0x2F        /
       ”           0x22        "
       \           0x5C        \

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Seafile and rclone link
       Rclone  supports generating share links for non-encrypted libraries only.  They can either
       be for a file or a directory:

              rclone link seafile:seafile-tutorial.doc
              http://my.seafile.server/f/fdcd8a2f93f84b8b90f4/

       or if run on a directory you will get:

              rclone link seafile:dir
              http://my.seafile.server/d/9ea2455f6f55478bbb0d/

       Please note a share link is unique for each file or directory.  If you run a link  command
       on a file/dir that has already been shared, you will get the exact same link.

   Compatibility
       It     has     been     actively     tested     using    the    seafile    docker    image
       (https://github.com/haiwen/seafile-docker) of these versions: - 6.3.4 community edition  -
       7.0.5 community edition - 7.1.3 community edition

       Versions  below  6.0  are not supported.  Versions between 6.0 and 6.3 haven’t been tested
       and might not work properly.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to seafile (seafile).

   –seafile-url
       URL of seafile host to connect to.

       Properties:

       • Config: url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

       • Examples:

         • “https://cloud.seafile.com/”

           • Connect to cloud.seafile.com.

   –seafile-user
       User name (usually email address).

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –seafile-pass
       Password.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –seafile-2fa
       Two-factor authentication (`true' if the account has 2FA enabled).

       Properties:

       • Config: 2fa

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_2FA

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –seafile-library
       Name of the library.

       Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.

       Properties:

       • Config: library

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –seafile-library-key
       Library password (for encrypted libraries only).

       Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: library_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –seafile-auth-token
       Authentication token.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_AUTH_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to seafile (seafile).

   –seafile-create-library
       Should rclone create a library if it doesn’t exist.

       Properties:

       • Config: create_library

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_CREATE_LIBRARY

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –seafile-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

SFTP

       SFTP      is      the      Secure      (or      SSH)      File      Transfer      Protocol
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SSH_File_Transfer_Protocol).

       The SFTP backend can be used with a number of different providers:

       • Hetzner Storage Box

       • rsync.net

       SFTP runs over SSH v2 and is installed as standard with most modern SSH installations.

       Paths are specified as remote:path.  If the path does not begin with a / it is relative to
       the  home  directory  of  the  user.   An  empty  path  remote:  refers to the user’s home
       directory.  For example, rclone lsd remote: would list the  home  directory  of  the  user
       configured in the rclone remote config (i.e /home/sftpuser).  However, rclone lsd remote:/
       would list the root directory for remote machine (i.e. /)

       Note that some SFTP servers will need the leading / - Synology is a good example of  this.
       rsync.net and Hetzner, on the other hand, requires users to OMIT the leading /.

       Note  that  by  default rclone will try to execute shell commands on the server, see shell
       access considerations.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making an SFTP configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / SSH/SFTP
                 \ "sftp"
              [snip]
              Storage> sftp
              SSH host to connect to
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to example.com
                 \ "example.com"
              host> example.com
              SSH username
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("$USER").
              user> sftpuser
              SSH port number
              Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (22).
              port>
              SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank
              y/g/n> n
              Path to unencrypted PEM-encoded private key file, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
              key_file>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              host = example.com
              user = sftpuser
              port =
              pass =
              key_file =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       This remote is called remote and can now be used like this:

       See all directories in the home directory

              rclone lsd remote:

       See all directories in the root directory

              rclone lsd remote:/

       Make a new directory

              rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote directory,  deleting  any  excess  files  in  the
       directory.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

       Mount the remote path /srv/www-data/ to the local path /mnt/www-data

              rclone mount remote:/srv/www-data/ /mnt/www-data

   SSH Authentication
       The SFTP remote supports three authentication methods:

       • Password

       • Key file, including certificate signed keys

       • ssh-agent

       Key  files should be PEM-encoded private key files.  For instance /home/$USER/.ssh/id_rsa.
       Only unencrypted OpenSSH or PEM encrypted files are supported.

       The key file can be specified in either an external file (key_file)  or  contained  within
       the  rclone  config file (key_pem).  If using key_pem in the config file, the entry should
       be on a single line with new line (`' or `') separating lines.  i.e.


              key_pem = -----BEGIN RSA PRIVATE KEY-----\nMaMbaIXtE\n0gAMbMbaSsd\nMbaass\n-----END RSA PRIVATE KEY-----
       This will generate it correctly for key_pem for use in the config:

              awk '{printf "%s\\n", $0}' < ~/.ssh/id_rsa

       If you don’t specify pass, key_file, or key_pem or ask_password then rclone  will  attempt
       to contact an ssh-agent.  You can also specify key_use_agent to force the usage of an ssh-
       agent.  In this case key_file or key_pem can also be specified to force  the  usage  of  a
       specific key in the ssh-agent.

       Using an ssh-agent is the only way to load encrypted OpenSSH keys at the moment.

       If  you  set the ask_password option, rclone will prompt for a password when needed and no
       password has been configured.

   Certificate-signed keys
       With traditional key-based authentication, you configure your private key  only,  and  the
       public key built into it will be used during the authentication process.

       If  you have a certificate you may use it to sign your public key, creating a separate SSH
       user certificate that should be used instead of the plain public key  extracted  from  the
       private  key.   Then  you must provide the path to the user certificate public key file in
       pubkey_file.

       Note: This is not the traditional public key paired with your private key, typically saved
       as /home/$USER/.ssh/id_rsa.pub.  Setting this path in pubkey_file will not work.

       Example:

              [remote]
              type = sftp
              host = example.com
              user = sftpuser
              key_file = ~/id_rsa
              pubkey_file = ~/id_rsa-cert.pub

       If  you concatenate a cert with a private key then you can specify the merged file in both
       places.

       Note: the cert must come first in the file.  e.g.

              cat id_rsa-cert.pub id_rsa > merged_key

   Host key validation
       By default rclone will not check the server’s host key for validation.  This can allow  an
       attacker  to  replace  a server with their own and if you use password authentication then
       this can lead to that password being exposed.

       Host key matching, using standard known_hosts files can  be  turned  on  by  enabling  the
       known_hosts_file option.  This can point to the file maintained by OpenSSH or can point to
       a unique file.

       e.g. using the OpenSSH known_hosts file:

              [remote]
              type = sftp
              host = example.com
              user = sftpuser
              pass =
              known_hosts_file = ~/.ssh/known_hosts

       Alternatively you can create your own known hosts file like this:

              ssh-keyscan -t dsa,rsa,ecdsa,ed25519 example.com >> known_hosts

       There are some limitations:

       • rclone will not manage this file for you.  If the key  is  missing  or  wrong  then  the
         connection will be refused.

       • If  the  server  is  set up for a certificate host key then the entry in the known_hosts
         file must be the @cert-authority entry for the CA

       If the host key provided by the server does not match the one in the file (or is  missing)
       then the connection will be aborted and an error returned such as

              NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key mismatch

       or

              NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key is unknown

       If you see an error such as

              NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: ssh: no authorities for hostname: example.com:22

       then  it is likely the server has presented a CA signed host certificate and you will need
       to add the appropriate @cert-authority entry.

       The known_hosts_file setting can be set during rclone config as an advanced option.

   ssh-agent on macOS
       Note that there seem to be various problems with using an ssh-agent on macOS due to recent
       changes  in  the  OS.  The most effective work-around seems to be to start an ssh-agent in
       each session, e.g.

              eval `ssh-agent -s` && ssh-add -A

       And then at the end of the session

              eval `ssh-agent -k`

       These commands can be used in scripts of course.

   Shell access
       Some functionality of the SFTP backend relies on remote shell access, and the  possibility
       to  execute  commands.   This  includes checksum, and in some cases also about.  The shell
       commands that must be executed may be different on different  type  of  shells,  and  also
       quoting/escaping  of  file  path arguments containing special characters may be different.
       Rclone therefore needs to know what type of shell it is, and if shell access is  available
       at all.

       Most  servers  run  on  some  version of Unix, and then a basic Unix shell can be assumed,
       without further distinction.  Windows 10, Server 2019,  and  later  can  also  run  a  SSH
       server,    which    is    a   port   of   OpenSSH   (see   official   installation   guide
       (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows-
       server/administration/openssh/openssh_install_firstuse)).   On  a Windows server the shell
       handling is different: Although it  can  also  be  set  up  to  use  a  Unix  type  shell,
       e.g. Cygwin  bash,  the default is to use Windows Command Prompt (cmd.exe), and PowerShell
       is a recommended alternative.  All of these have behave  differently,  which  rclone  must
       handle.

       Rclone  tries  to  auto-detect  what  type  of shell is used on the server, first time you
       access the SFTP remote.  If a remote shell session is successfully created, it  will  look
       for indications that it is CMD or PowerShell, with fall-back to Unix if not something else
       is detected.  If unable to  even  create  a  remote  shell  session,  then  shell  command
       execution   will  be  disabled  entirely.   The  result  is  stored  in  the  SFTP  remote
       configuration, in option shell_type, so that the auto-detection only have to be  performed
       once.   If  you  manually set a value for this option before first run, the auto-detection
       will be skipped, and if you set a different value later this will override  any  existing.
       Value  none  can be set to avoid any attempts at executing shell commands, e.g. if this is
       not allowed on the server.

       When the server is rclone serve sftp (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_sftp/), the
       rclone  SFTP  remote  will  detect  this  as  a Unix type shell - even if it is running on
       Windows.  This server does not actually have  a  shell,  but  it  accepts  input  commands
       matching  the  specific  ones that the SFTP backend relies on for Unix shells, e.g. md5sum
       and df.  Also it handles the string escape rules used for Unix shell.  Treating  it  as  a
       Unix  type  shell  from  a  SFTP  remote will therefore always be correct, and support all
       features.

   Shell access considerations
       The shell type auto-detection logic, described above, means that by  default  rclone  will
       try to run a shell command the first time a new sftp remote is accessed.  If you configure
       a sftp remote without a config file, e.g. an on the fly (https://rclone.org/docs/#backend-
       path-to-dir%5D)  remote,  rclone will have nowhere to store the result, and it will re-run
       the command on every access.  To avoid this  you  should  explicitly  set  the  shell_type
       option  to  the correct value, or to none if you want to prevent rclone from executing any
       remote shell commands.

       It is also important to note that, since the shell type decides how quoting  and  escaping
       of  file  paths  used as command-line arguments are performed, configuring the wrong shell
       type may leave you exposed to command injection exploits.  Make sure to confirm the  auto-
       detected  shell  type,  or  explicitly  set the shell type you know is correct, or disable
       shell access until you know.

   Checksum
       SFTP does not  natively  support  checksums  (file  hash),  but  rclone  is  able  to  use
       checksumming  if  the  same  login  has shell access, and can execute remote commands.  If
       there is a command that can calculate compatible checksums on the  remote  system,  Rclone
       can  then  be  configured to execute this whenever a checksum is needed, and read back the
       results.  Currently MD5 and SHA-1 are supported.

       Normally this requires an external utility being available  on  the  server.   By  default
       rclone  will  try  commands md5sum, md5 and rclone md5sum for MD5 checksums, and the first
       one found usable will be picked.  Same with sha1sum, sha1 and rclone sha1sum commands  for
       SHA-1 checksums.  These utilities normally need to be in the remote’s PATH to be found.

       In  some  cases  the  shell  itself is capable of calculating checksums.  PowerShell is an
       example of such a shell.  If rclone detects that the remote  shell  is  PowerShell,  which
       means  it  most  probably is a Windows OpenSSH server, rclone will use a predefined script
       block to produce the checksums when no external checksum commands  are  found  (see  shell
       access).  This assumes PowerShell version 4.0 or newer.

       The  options  md5sum_command  and  sha1_command can be used to customize the command to be
       executed for calculation of checksums.  You can for example set a specific path  to  where
       md5sum  and  sha1sum executables are located, or use them to specify some other tools that
       print checksums in compatible format.  The value can include  command-line  arguments,  or
       even   shell   script   blocks   as   with  PowerShell.   Rclone  has  subcommands  md5sum
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_md5sum/)                  and                  sha1sum
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_sha1sum/)  that  use compatible format, which means if
       you have an rclone executable on the server it can be used.  As mentioned above, they will
       be  automatically  picked  up  if  found  in  PATH,  but if not you can set something like
       /path/to/rclone md5sum as the value of option  md5sum_command  to  make  sure  a  specific
       executable is used.

       Remote  checksumming  is recommended and enabled by default.  First time rclone is using a
       SFTP remote, if options md5sum_command or sha1_command are not set, it will check  if  any
       of  the  default  commands  for each of them, as described above, can be used.  The result
       will be saved in the remote configuration, so next time it will use the same.  Value  none
       will  be  set  if none of the default commands could be used for a specific algorithm, and
       this algorithm will not be supported by the remote.

       Disabling the checksumming may be required if you are connecting to SFTP servers which are
       not under your control, and to which the execution of remote shell commands is prohibited.
       Set the configuration option disable_hashcheck to true to disable  checksumming  entirely,
       or  set  shell_type  to  none  to  disable all functionality based on remote shell command
       execution.

   Modified time
       Modified times are stored on the server to 1 second precision.

       Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported.

       Some SFTP servers disable setting/modifying the file modification time after  upload  (for
       example,  certain configurations of ProFTPd with mod_sftp).  If you are using one of these
       servers, you can set the option set_modtime = false in your RClone  backend  configuration
       to disable this behaviour.

   About command
       The  about  command  returns the total space, free space, and used space on the remote for
       the disk of the specified path on the remote or, if not set, the disk of the root  on  the
       remote.

       SFTP  usually  supports the about (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/) command, but
       it depends on the server.  If the server implements  the  vendor-specific  VFS  statistics
       extension,  which  is  normally the case with OpenSSH instances, it will be used.  If not,
       but the same login has access to a Unix shell, where the df command is available  (e.g. in
       the  remote’s  PATH),  then this will be used instead.  If the server shell is PowerShell,
       probably with a Windows OpenSSH server, rclone will use  a  built-in  shell  command  (see
       shell access).  If none of the above is applicable, about will fail.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP).

   –sftp-host
       SSH host to connect to.

       E.g.  “example.com”.

       Properties:

       • Config: host

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_HOST

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –sftp-user
       SSH username.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USER

       • Type: string

       • Default: “$USER”

   –sftp-port
       SSH port number.

       Properties:

       • Config: port

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PORT

       • Type: int

       • Default: 22

   –sftp-pass
       SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-key-pem
       Raw PEM-encoded private key.

       If specified, will override key_file parameter.

       Properties:

       • Config: key_pem

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_PEM

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-key-file
       Path to PEM-encoded private key file.

       Leave blank or set key-use-agent to use ssh-agent.

       Leading ~ will be expanded in  the  file  name  as  will  environment  variables  such  as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: key_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-key-file-pass
       The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file.

       Only  PEM  encrypted  key files (old OpenSSH format) are supported.  Encrypted keys in the
       new OpenSSH format can’t be used.

       NB    Input    to    this    must     be     obscured     -     see     rclone     obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: key_file_pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-pubkey-file
       Optional path to public key file.

       Set this if you have a signed certificate you want to use for authentication.

       Leading  ~  will  be  expanded  in  the  file  name  as will environment variables such as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: pubkey_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PUBKEY_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-key-use-agent
       When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent.

       When key-file is also set, the “.pub” file of the specified key-file is read and only  the
       associated  key  is  requested  from  the  ssh-agent.   This  allows  to  avoid  Too  many
       authentication failures for *username* errors when the ssh-agent contains many keys.

       Properties:

       • Config: key_use_agent

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_USE_AGENT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-use-insecure-cipher
       Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods.

       This enables the use of the following insecure ciphers and key exchange methods:

       • aes128-cbc

       • aes192-cbc

       • aes256-cbc

       • 3des-cbc

       • diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256

       • diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1

       Those algorithms are insecure and may allow plaintext data to be recovered by an attacker.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_insecure_cipher

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_INSECURE_CIPHER

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “false”

           • Use default Cipher list.

         • “true”

           • Enables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher  and  diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256,
             diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1 key exchange.

   –sftp-disable-hashcheck
       Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available.

       Leave  blank  or  set  to  false  to  enable hashing (recommended), set to true to disable
       hashing.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_hashcheck

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_HASHCHECK

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP).

   –sftp-known-hosts-file
       Optional path to known_hosts file.

       Set this value to enable server host key validation.

       Leading ~ will be expanded in  the  file  name  as  will  environment  variables  such  as
       ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

       Properties:

       • Config: known_hosts_file

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KNOWN_HOSTS_FILE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “~/.ssh/known_hosts”

           • Use OpenSSH’s known_hosts file.

   –sftp-ask-password
       Allow asking for SFTP password when needed.

       If  this  is  set and no password is supplied then rclone will: - ask for a password - not
       contact the ssh agent

       Properties:

       • Config: ask_password

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_ASK_PASSWORD

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-path-override
       Override path used by SSH shell commands.

       This allows checksum calculation when SFTP  and  SSH  paths  are  different.   This  issue
       affects among others Synology NAS boxes.

       E.g.  if shared folders can be found in directories representing volumes:

              rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/directory --sftp-path-override /volume2/directory

       E.g.  if home directory can be found in a shared folder called “home”:

              rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/home/directory --sftp-path-override /volume1/homes/USER/directory

       Properties:

       • Config: path_override

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PATH_OVERRIDE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-set-modtime
       Set the modified time on the remote if set.

       Properties:

       • Config: set_modtime

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SET_MODTIME

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –sftp-shell-type
       The type of SSH shell on remote server, if any.

       Leave blank for autodetect.

       Properties:

       • Config: shell_type

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SHELL_TYPE

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “none”

           • No shell access

         • “unix”

           • Unix shell

         • “powershell”

           • PowerShell

         • “cmd”

           • Windows Command Prompt

   –sftp-md5sum-command
       The command used to read md5 hashes.

       Leave blank for autodetect.

       Properties:

       • Config: md5sum_command

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_MD5SUM_COMMAND

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-sha1sum-command
       The command used to read sha1 hashes.

       Leave blank for autodetect.

       Properties:

       • Config: sha1sum_command

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SHA1SUM_COMMAND

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-skip-links
       Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_links

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SKIP_LINKS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-subsystem
       Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host.

       Properties:

       • Config: subsystem

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SUBSYSTEM

       • Type: string

       • Default: “sftp”

   –sftp-server-command
       Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host.

       The subsystem option is ignored when server_command is defined.

       Properties:

       • Config: server_command

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SERVER_COMMAND

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sftp-use-fstat
       If set use fstat instead of stat.

       Some  servers  limit the amount of open files and calling Stat after opening the file will
       throw an error from the server.  Setting this flag will call Fstat instead of  Stat  which
       is called on an already open file handle.

       It   has   been  found  that  this  helps  with  IBM  Sterling  SFTP  servers  which  have
       “extractability” level set to 1 which means only 1 file can be opened at any given time.

       Properties:

       • Config: use_fstat

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_FSTAT

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-disable-concurrent-reads
       If set don’t use concurrent reads.

       Normally concurrent reads are safe to use and not using them will degrade performance,  so
       this option is disabled by default.

       Some  servers limit the amount number of times a file can be downloaded.  Using concurrent
       reads can trigger this limit, so if you have a server which returns

              Failed to copy: file does not exist

       Then you may need to enable this flag.

       If concurrent reads are disabled, the use_fstat option is ignored.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_concurrent_reads

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_CONCURRENT_READS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-disable-concurrent-writes
       If set don’t use concurrent writes.

       Normally rclone uses concurrent writes to upload files.   This  improves  the  performance
       greatly, especially for distant servers.

       This option disables concurrent writes should that be necessary.

       Properties:

       • Config: disable_concurrent_writes

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_CONCURRENT_WRITES

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –sftp-idle-timeout
       Max time before closing idle connections.

       If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will
       empty the connection pool.

       Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

       Properties:

       • Config: idle_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_IDLE_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –sftp-chunk-size
       Upload and download chunk size.

       This controls the maximum size of payload in SFTP protocol packets.  The RFC  limits  this
       to  32768  bytes  (32k),  which  is the default.  However, a lot of servers support larger
       sizes, typically limited to a maximum total package size of 256k, and  setting  it  larger
       will  increase  transfer speed dramatically on high latency links.  This includes OpenSSH,
       and, for example, using the value of 255k works well, leaving plenty of room for  overhead
       while still being within a total packet size of 256k.

       Make  sure to test thoroughly before using a value higher than 32k, and only use it if you
       always connect to the same server or after sufficiently broad testing.  If you get  errors
       such  as “failed to send packet payload: EOF”, lots of “connection lost”, or “corrupted on
       transfer”, when copying a larger file, try lowering the value.  The server run  by  rclone
       serve sftp sends packets with standard 32k maximum payload so you must not set a different
       chunk_size when downloading files, but it accepts packets up to the 256k  total  size,  so
       for uploads the chunk_size can be set as for the OpenSSH example above.

       Properties:

       • Config: chunk_size

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_CHUNK_SIZE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 32Ki

   –sftp-concurrency
       The maximum number of outstanding requests for one file

       This controls the maximum number of outstanding requests for one file.  Increasing it will
       increase throughput on high latency links at the cost of using more memory.

       Properties:

       • Config: concurrency

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_CONCURRENCY

       • Type: int

       • Default: 64

   –sftp-set-env
       Environment variables to pass to sftp and commands

       Set environment variables in the form:

              VAR=value

       to be passed to the sftp client and to any commands run (eg md5sum).

       Pass multiple variables space separated, eg

              VAR1=value VAR2=value

       and pass variables with spaces in in quotes, eg

              "VAR3=value with space" "VAR4=value with space" VAR5=nospacehere

       Properties:

       • Config: set_env

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SET_ENV

       • Type: SpaceSepList

       • Default:

   Limitations
       On some SFTP servers (e.g. Synology) the paths are different  for  SSH  and  SFTP  so  the
       hashes can’t be calculated properly.  For them using disable_hashcheck is a good idea.

       The only ssh agent supported under Windows is Putty’s pageant.

       The  Go  SSH library disables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher by default, due to security
       concerns.   This  can  be  re-enabled  on  a   per-connection   basis   by   setting   the
       use_insecure_cipher  setting  in  the  configuration file to true.  Further details on the
       insecurity     of     this     cipher     can     be     found     in      this      paper
       (http://www.isg.rhul.ac.uk/~kp/SandPfinal.pdf).

       SFTP isn’t supported under plan9 until this issue (https://github.com/pkg/sftp/issues/156)
       is fixed.

       Note that since SFTP isn’t HTTP based the following flags  don’t  work  with  it:  --dump-
       headers, --dump-bodies, --dump-auth.

       Note that --timeout and --contimeout are both supported.

   rsync.net
       rsync.net is supported through the SFTP backend.

       See          rsync.net’s          documentation         of         rclone         examples
       (https://www.rsync.net/products/rclone.html).

   Hetzner Storage Box
       Hetzner Storage Boxes are supported through the SFTP backend on port 23.

       See   Hetzner’s   documentation   for   details   (https://docs.hetzner.com/robot/storage-
       box/access/access-ssh-rsync-borg#rclone)

SMB

       SMB     is     a     communication     protocol    to    share    files    over    network
       (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Server_Message_Block).

       This   relies   on   go-smb2   library   (https://github.com/hirochachacha/go-smb2/)   for
       communication with SMB protocol.

       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:sharename (or remote: for the lsd command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:item/path/to/dir.

   Notes
       The first path segment must be the name of the share, which you entered when  you  started
       to share on Windows.  On smbd, it’s the section title in smb.conf (usually in /etc/samba/)
       file.  You can find shares by quering the root if you’re unsure (e.g. rclone lsd remote:).

       You can’t access to the shared printers from rclone, obviously.

       You can’t use Anonymous access for logging in.  You have to use the  guest  user  with  an
       empty  password  instead.  The rclone client tries to avoid 8.3 names when uploading files
       by  encoding  trailing   spaces   and   periods.    Alternatively,   the   local   backend
       (https://rclone.org/local/#paths-on-windows)  on  Windows can access SMB servers using UNC
       paths, by \\server\share.  This doesn’t apply to  non-Windows  OSes,  such  as  Linux  and
       macOS.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a SMB configuration.

       First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Option Storage.
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value.
              XX / SMB / CIFS
                 \ (smb)
              Storage> smb

              Option host.
              Samba hostname to connect to.
              E.g. "example.com".
              Enter a value.
              host> localhost

              Option user.
              Samba username.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (lesmi).
              user> guest

              Option port.
              Samba port number.
              Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default (445).
              port>

              Option pass.
              Samba password.
              Choose an alternative below. Press Enter for the default (n).
              y) Yes, type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No, leave this optional password blank (default)
              y/g/n> g
              Password strength in bits.
              64 is just about memorable
              128 is secure
              1024 is the maximum
              Bits> 64
              Your password is: XXXX
              Use this password? Please note that an obscured version of this
              password (and not the password itself) will be stored under your
              configuration file, so keep this generated password in a safe place.
              y) Yes (default)
              n) No
              y/n> y

              Option domain.
              Domain name for NTLM authentication.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default (WORKGROUP).
              domain>

              Edit advanced config?
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n

              Configuration complete.
              Options:
              - type: samba
              - host: localhost
              - user: guest
              - pass: *** ENCRYPTED ***
              Keep this "remote" remote?
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> d

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to smb (SMB / CIFS).

   –smb-host
       SMB server hostname to connect to.

       E.g.  “example.com”.

       Properties:

       • Config: host

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_HOST

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –smb-user
       SMB username.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_USER

       • Type: string

       • Default: “$USER”

   –smb-port
       SMB port number.

       Properties:

       • Config: port

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_PORT

       • Type: int

       • Default: 445

   –smb-pass
       SMB password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –smb-domain
       Domain name for NTLM authentication.

       Properties:

       • Config: domain

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_DOMAIN

       • Type: string

       • Default: “WORKGROUP”

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to smb (SMB / CIFS).

   –smb-idle-timeout
       Max time before closing idle connections.

       If no connections have been returned to the connection pool in the time given, rclone will
       empty the connection pool.

       Set to 0 to keep connections indefinitely.

       Properties:

       • Config: idle_timeout

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_IDLE_TIMEOUT

       • Type: Duration

       • Default: 1m0s

   –smb-hide-special-share
       Hide special shares (e.g. print$) which users aren’t supposed to access.

       Properties:

       • Config: hide_special_share

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_HIDE_SPECIAL_SHARE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –smb-case-insensitive
       Whether the server is configured to be case-insensitive.

       Always true on Windows shares.

       Properties:

       • Config: case_insensitive

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_CASE_INSENSITIVE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: true

   –smb-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SMB_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default:
         Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Storj

       Storj (https://storj.io) is  an  encrypted,  secure,  and  cost-effective  object  storage
       service  that  enables  you  to  store,  back  up,  and archive large amounts of data in a
       decentralized manner.

   Backend options
       Storj can be used both with this native backend and with the s3 backend using the Storj S3
       compatible gateway (https://rclone.org/s3/#storj) (shared or private).

       Use  this  backend  to  take advantage of client-side encryption as well as to achieve the
       best possible download performance.  Uploads will be erasure-coded  locally,  thus  a  1gb
       upload will result in 2.68gb of data being uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

       Use  the  s3  backend  and  one  of  the  S3 compatible Hosted Gateways to increase upload
       performance and reduce the load on your systems and network.  Uploads  will  be  encrypted
       and  erasure-coded server-side, thus a 1GB upload will result in only in 1GB of data being
       uploaded to storage nodes across the network.

       Side by side comparison with more details:

       • Characteristics:

         • Storj backend: Uses native RPC protocol, connects directly to the storage nodes  which
           hosts  the  data.   Requires  more  CPU  resource of encoding/decoding and has network
           amplification (especially during the upload), uses lots of TCP connections

         • S3 backend: Uses S3 compatible HTTP Rest API via the shared  gateways.   There  is  no
           network  amplification,  but performance depends on the shared gateways and the secret
           encryption key is shared with the gateway.

       • Typical usage:

         • Storj backend: Server environments and desktops with enough resources, internet  speed
           and connectivity - and applications where storjs client-side encryption is required.

         • S3   backend:   Desktops  and  similar  with  limited  resources,  internet  speed  or
           connectivity.

       • Security:

         • Storj backend: strong.  Private  encryption  key  doesn’t  need  to  leave  the  local
           computer.

         • S3     backend:     weaker.      Private     encryption    key    is    shared    with
           (https://docs.storj.io/dcs/api-reference/s3-compatible-gateway#security-and-
           encryption)  the  authentication  service  of  the  hosted  gateway, where it’s stored
           encrypted.  It can be stronger when combining with the rclone crypt backend.

       • Bandwidth usage (upload):

         • Storj backend: higher.  As data is erasure coded on the client side both the  original
           data  and  the parities should be uploaded.  About ~2.7 times more data is required to
           be uploaded.  Client may start to upload with even higher number of nodes (~3.7  times
           more) and abandon/stop the slow uploads.

         • S3  backend:  normal.   Only  the  raw data is uploaded, erasure coding happens on the
           gateway.

       • Bandwidth usage (download)

         • Storj backend: almost normal.  Only the minimal number of data  is  required,  but  to
           avoid very slow data providers a few more sources are used and the slowest are ignored
           (max 1.2x overhead).

         • S3 backend: normal.  Only the raw data is downloaded, erasure coding  happens  on  the
           shared gateway.

       • CPU usage:

         • Storj  backend:  higher, but more predictable.  Erasure code and encryption/decryption
           happens locally which requires significant CPU usage.

         • S3 backend: less.   Erasure  code  and  encryption/decryption  happens  on  shared  s3
           gateways (and as is, it depends on the current load on the gateways)

       • TCP connection usage:

         • Storj  backend:  high.   A  direct  connection  is required to each of the Storj nodes
           resulting in 110 connections on upload and 35 on download per 64 MB segment.  Not  all
           the  connections  are  actively  used (slow ones are pruned), but they are all opened.
           Adjusting the max open  file  limit  (https://rclone.org/storj/#known-issues)  may  be
           required.

         • S3 backend: normal.  Only one connection per download/upload thread is required to the
           shared gateway.

       • Overall performance:

         • Storj backend: with enough resources (CPU and bandwidth)  storj  backend  can  provide
           even  2x  better  performance.   Data is directly downloaded to / uploaded from to the
           client instead of the gateway.

         • S3 backend: Can be faster on edge devices where CPU and network bandwidth  is  limited
           as  the  shared  S3  compatible gateways take care about the encrypting/decryption and
           erasure coding and no download/upload amplification.

       • Decentralization:

         • Storj backend: high.  Data is  downloaded  directly  from  the  distributed  cloud  of
           storage providers.

         • S3 backend: low.  Requires a running S3 gateway (either self-hosted or Storj-hosted).

       • Limitations:

         • Storj  backend: rclone checksum is not possible without download, as checksum metadata
           is not calculated during upload

         • S3 backend: secret encryption key is shared with the gateway

   Configuration
       To make a new Storj configuration you need one of  the  following:  *  Access  Grant  that
       someone   else  shared  with  you.   *  API  Key  (https://documentation.storj.io/getting-
       started/uploading-your-first-object/create-an-api-key) of a Storj project you are a member
       of.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

   Setup with access grant
              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage
                 \ "storj"
              [snip]
              Storage> storj
              ** See help for storj backend at: https://rclone.org/storj/ **

              Choose an authentication method.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Use an existing access grant.
                 \ "existing"
               2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
                 \ "new"
              provider> existing
              Access Grant.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              access_grant> your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = storj
              access_grant = your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Setup with API key and passphrase
              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage
                 \ "storj"
              [snip]
              Storage> storj
              ** See help for storj backend at: https://rclone.org/storj/ **

              Choose an authentication method.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Use an existing access grant.
                 \ "existing"
               2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
                 \ "new"
              provider> new
              Satellite Address. Custom satellite address should match the format: `<nodeid>@<address>:<port>`.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("us-central-1.storj.io").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / US Central 1
                 \ "us-central-1.storj.io"
               2 / Europe West 1
                 \ "europe-west-1.storj.io"
               3 / Asia East 1
                 \ "asia-east-1.storj.io"
              satellite_address> 1
              API Key.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              api_key> your-api-key-for-your-storj-project
              Encryption Passphrase. To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              passphrase> your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = storj
              satellite_address = 12EayRS2V1kEsWESU9QMRseFhdxYxKicsiFmxrsLZHeLUtdps3S@us-central-1.tardigrade.io:7777
              api_key = your-api-key-for-your-storj-project
              passphrase = your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
              access_grant = the-access-grant-generated-from-the-api-key-and-passphrase
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to storj (Storj Decentralized Cloud Storage).

   –storj-provider
       Choose an authentication method.

       Properties:

       • Config: provider

       • Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_PROVIDER

       • Type: string

       • Default: “existing”

       • Examples:

         • “existing”

           • Use an existing access grant.

         • “new”

           • Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.

   –storj-access-grant
       Access grant.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_grant

       • Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_ACCESS_GRANT

       • Provider: existing

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –storj-satellite-address
       Satellite address.

       Custom satellite address should match the format: <nodeid>@<address>:<port>.

       Properties:

       • Config: satellite_address

       • Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_SATELLITE_ADDRESS

       • Provider: new

       • Type: string

       • Default: “us-central-1.storj.io”

       • Examples:

         • “us-central-1.storj.io”

           • US Central 1

         • “europe-west-1.storj.io”

           • Europe West 1

         • “asia-east-1.storj.io”

           • Asia East 1

   –storj-api-key
       API key.

       Properties:

       • Config: api_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_API_KEY

       • Provider: new

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –storj-passphrase
       Encryption passphrase.

       To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.

       Properties:

       • Config: passphrase

       • Env Var: RCLONE_STORJ_PASSPHRASE

       • Provider: new

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Usage
       Paths  are  specified  as  remote:bucket  (or  remote:  for the lsf command.)  You may put
       subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this.

   Create a new bucket
       Use the mkdir command to create new bucket, e.g. bucket.

              rclone mkdir remote:bucket

   List all buckets
       Use the lsf command to list all buckets.

              rclone lsf remote:

       Note the colon (:) character at the end of the command line.

   Delete a bucket
       Use the rmdir command to delete an empty bucket.

              rclone rmdir remote:bucket

       Use the purge command to delete a non-empty bucket with all its content.

              rclone purge remote:bucket

   Upload objects
       Use the copy command to upload an object.

              rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/file.ext remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

       The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you  don’t  need
       this information.

       Use a folder in the local path to upload all its objects.

              rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

       Only modified files will be copied.

   List objects
       Use the ls command to list recursively all objects in a bucket.

              rclone ls remote:bucket

       Add the folder to the remote path to list recursively all objects in this folder.

              rclone ls remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

       Use the lsf command to list non-recursively all objects in a bucket or a folder.

              rclone lsf remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Download objects
       Use the copy command to download an object.

              rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext /home/local/directory/

       The  --progress  flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you don’t need
       this information.

       Use a folder in the remote path to download all its objects.

              rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

   Delete objects
       Use the deletefile command to delete a single object.

              rclone deletefile remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext

       Use the delete command to delete all object in a folder.

              rclone delete remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Print the total size of objects
       Use the size command to print the total size of objects in a bucket or a folder.

              rclone size remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Sync two Locations
       Use the sync command to sync the source to the destination, changing the destination only,
       deleting any excess files.

              rclone sync -i --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

       The  --progress  flag is for displaying progress information.  Remove it if you don’t need
       this information.

       Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run flag  to  see  exactly  what
       would be copied and deleted.

       The sync can be done also from Storj to the local file system.

              rclone sync -i --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

       Or between two Storj buckets.

              rclone sync -i --progress remote-us:bucket/path/to/dir/ remote-europe:bucket/path/to/dir/

       Or even between another cloud storage and Storj.

              rclone sync -i --progress s3:bucket/path/to/dir/ storj:bucket/path/to/dir/

   Limitations
       rclone  about  is  not  supported  by  the  rclone  Storj  backend.  Backends without this
       capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy  mfs  (most  free
       space) as a member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

   Known issues
       If  you  get  errors like too many open files this usually happens when the default ulimit
       for system max open files is exceeded.  Native Storj protocol opens a large number of  TCP
       connections  (each  of  which is counted as an open file).  For a single upload stream you
       can expect 110 TCP connections to be opened.  For a single download stream you can  expect
       35.  This batch of connections will be opened for every 64 MiB segment and you should also
       expect TCP connections to be reused.  If you do  many  transfers  you  eventually  open  a
       connection to most storage nodes (thousands of nodes).

       To  fix these, please raise your system limits.  You can do this issuing a ulimit -n 65536
       just before you run rclone.  To change the limits more permanently you  can  add  this  to
       your  shell  startup  script, e.g. $HOME/.bashrc, or change the system-wide configuration,
       usually /etc/sysctl.conf  and/or  /etc/security/limits.conf,  but  please  refer  to  your
       operating system manual.

SugarSync

       SugarSync  (https://sugarsync.com)  is a cloud service that enables active synchronization
       of files across computers and other devices for file backup, access, syncing, and sharing.

   Configuration
       The initial setup for SugarSync involves getting a token from SugarSync which you  can  do
       with rclone.  rclone config walks you through it.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Sugarsync
                 \ "sugarsync"
              [snip]
              Storage> sugarsync
              ** See help for sugarsync backend at: https://rclone.org/sugarsync/ **

              Sugarsync App ID.
              Leave blank to use rclone's.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              app_id>
              Sugarsync Access Key ID.
              Leave blank to use rclone's.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              access_key_id>
              Sugarsync Private Access Key
              Leave blank to use rclone's.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              private_access_key>
              Permanently delete files if true
              otherwise put them in the deleted files.
              Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
              hard_delete>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Username (email address)> nick@craig-wood.com
              Your Sugarsync password is only required during setup and will not be stored.
              password:
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = sugarsync
              refresh_token = https://api.sugarsync.com/app-authorization/XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Note that the config asks for your email and password but doesn’t store them, it only uses
       them to get the initial token.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories (sync folders) in top level of your SugarSync

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your SugarSync folder “Test”

              rclone ls remote:Test

       To copy a local directory to an SugarSync folder called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

       NB you can’t create files in the top level folder you  have  to  create  a  folder,  which
       rclone will create as a “Sync Folder” with SugarSync.

   Modified time and hashes
       SugarSync does not support modification times or hashes, therefore syncing will default to
       --size-only checking.  Note that using --update will work as  rclone  can  read  the  time
       files were uploaded.

   Restricted filename characters
       SugarSync       replaces       the       default       restricted      characters      set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters) except for DEL.

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in XML strings.

   Deleting files
       Deleted files will be moved to the “Deleted items” folder by default.

       However  you  can  supply  the  flag  --sugarsync-hard-delete  or set the config parameter
       hard_delete = true if you would like files to be deleted straight away.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

   –sugarsync-app-id
       Sugarsync App ID.

       Leave blank to use rclone’s.

       Properties:

       • Config: app_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_APP_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-access-key-id
       Sugarsync Access Key ID.

       Leave blank to use rclone’s.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_key_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ACCESS_KEY_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-private-access-key
       Sugarsync Private Access Key.

       Leave blank to use rclone’s.

       Properties:

       • Config: private_access_key

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_PRIVATE_ACCESS_KEY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-hard-delete
       Permanently delete files if true otherwise put them in the deleted files.

       Properties:

       • Config: hard_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_HARD_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

   –sugarsync-refresh-token
       Sugarsync refresh token.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: refresh_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_REFRESH_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-authorization
       Sugarsync authorization.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: authorization

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-authorization-expiry
       Sugarsync authorization expiry.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: authorization_expiry

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION_EXPIRY

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-user
       Sugarsync user.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-root-id
       Sugarsync root id.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: root_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ROOT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-deleted-id
       Sugarsync deleted folder id.

       Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

       Properties:

       • Config: deleted_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_DELETED_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –sugarsync-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       rclone  about is not supported by the SugarSync backend.  Backends without this capability
       cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or use policy mfs (most free space)  as  a
       member of an rclone union remote.

       See      List     of     backends     that     do     not     support     rclone     about
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#optional-features)         and         rclone          about
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_about/)

Tardigrade

       The    Tardigrade    backend    has    been    renamed    to    be   the   Storj   backend
       (https://rclone.org/storj/).  Old configuration files will continue to work.

Uptobox

       This is a Backend for Uptobox file storage service.  Uptobox  is  closer  to  a  one-click
       hoster  than a traditional cloud storage provider and therefore not suitable for long term
       storage.

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       To configure an Uptobox backend you’ll need your personal api token.  You’ll  find  it  in
       your account settings (https://uptobox.com/my_account)

       Here  is  an  example of how to make a remote called remote with the default setup.  First
       run:

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              TestUptobox          uptobox

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
              name> uptobox
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [...]
              37 / Uptobox
                 \ "uptobox"
              [...]
              Storage> uptobox
              ** See help for uptobox backend at: https://rclone.org/uptobox/ **

              Your API Key, get it from https://uptobox.com/my_account
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              api_key> xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [uptobox]
              type = uptobox
              api_key = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your Uptobox

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your Uptobox

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an Uptobox directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       Uptobox supports neither modified times nor checksums.

   Restricted filename characters
       In      addition      to      the      default       restricted       characters       set
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)  the  following  characters  are also
       replaced:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       ”           0x22        "
       `           0x41        `

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in XML strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to uptobox (Uptobox).

   –uptobox-access-token
       Your access token.

       Get it from https://uptobox.com/my_account.

       Properties:

       • Config: access_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UPTOBOX_ACCESS_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to uptobox (Uptobox).

   –uptobox-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UPTOBOX_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,BackQuote,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       Uptobox will delete inactive files that have not been accessed in 60 days.

       rclone about is not supported by this backend an overview of used space can  however  been
       seen in the uptobox web interface.

Union

       The union remote provides a unification similar to UnionFS using other remotes.

       Paths  may  be  as deep as required or a local path, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory or
       /directory/subdirectory.

       During the initial setup with rclone config you will specify the  upstream  remotes  as  a
       space separated list.  The upstream remotes can either be a local paths or other remotes.

       Attribute  :ro  and :nc can be attach to the end of path to tag the remote as read only or
       no create, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory:ro or remote:directory/subdirectory:nc.

       Subfolders can be used in upstream remotes.  Assume a union remote named backup  with  the
       remotes  mydrive:private/backup.  Invoking rclone mkdir backup:desktop is exactly the same
       as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

       There will be no special handling of paths containing ..  segments.  Invoking rclone mkdir
       backup:../desktop     is     exactly     the     same    as    invoking    rclone    mkdir
       mydrive:private/backup/../desktop.

   Configuration
       Here is an example of how to make a union called remote for local folders.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Union merges the contents of several remotes
                 \ "union"
              [snip]
              Storage> union
              List of space separated upstreams.
              Can be 'upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', '\"upstreama:test/space:ro dir\" upstreamb:', etc.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              upstreams> remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
              Policy to choose upstream on ACTION class.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epall").
              action_policy>
              Policy to choose upstream on CREATE class.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epmfs").
              create_policy>
              Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH class.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("ff").
              search_policy>
              Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds). This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.
              Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default ("120").
              cache_time>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = union
              upstreams = remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y
              Current remotes:

              Name                 Type
              ====                 ====
              remote               union

              e) Edit existing remote
              n) New remote
              d) Delete remote
              r) Rename remote
              c) Copy remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

              rclone ls remote:

       Copy another local directory to the union directory called source, which  will  be  placed
       into remote3:dir3

              rclone copy C:\source remote:source

   Behavior / Policies
       The     behavior     of     union     backend    is    inspired    by    trapexit/mergerfs
       (https://github.com/trapexit/mergerfs).  All functions  are  grouped  into  3  categories:
       action,  create and search.  These functions and categories can be assigned a policy which
       dictates what file or directory is chosen when performing that behavior.  Any  policy  can
       be assigned to a function or category though some may not be very useful in practice.  For
       instance: rand (random) may be useful for file creation (create) but could  lead  to  very
       odd behavior if used for delete if there were more than one copy of the file.

   Function / Category classifications
       Category   Description       Functions
       ───────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       action     Writing           move, rmdir, rmdirs, delete, purge and copy, sync
                  Existing file     (as destination when file exist)
       create     Create     non-   copy, sync (as destination when file not exist)
                  existing file
       search     Reading     and   ls, lsd, lsl, cat, md5sum, sha1sum and copy, sync
                  listing file      (as source)
       N/A                          size, about

   Path Preservation
       Policies,  as  described  below,  are  of  two  basic types.  path preserving and non-path
       preserving.

       All policies which start with ep (epff, eplfs, eplus, epmfs, eprand) are path  preserving.
       ep stands for existing path.

       A  path  preserving  policy  will  only  consider  upstreams where the relative path being
       accessed already exists.

       When using non-path preserving policies paths will  be  created  in  target  upstreams  as
       necessary.

   Quota Relevant Policies
       Some  policies  rely  on  quota  information.   These policies should be used only if your
       upstreams support the respective quota fields.

       Policy       Required Field
       ────────────────────────────
       lfs, eplfs   Free
       mfs, epmfs   Free
       lus, eplus   Used
       lno, eplno   Objects

       To check if your upstream supports the field, run rclone about remote: [flags] and see  if
       the required field exists.

   Filters
       Policies  basically  search  upstream  remotes  and  create  a  list  of files / paths for
       functions to work on.  The policy is responsible for filtering and  sorting.   The  policy
       type defines the sorting but filtering is mostly uniform as described below.

       • No search policies filter.

       • All action policies will filter out remotes which are tagged as read-only.

       • All create policies will filter out remotes which are tagged read-only or no-create.

       If all remotes are filtered an error will be returned.

   Policy descriptions
       The       policies       definition       are      inspired      by      trapexit/mergerfs
       (https://github.com/trapexit/mergerfs) but not exactly the same.  Some  policy  definition
       could be different due to the much larger latency of remote file systems.

       Policy             Description
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       all                Search category: same as epall.  Action category: same
                          as epall.  Create category: act on all upstreams.
       epall  (existing   Search  category:  Given this order configured, act on
       path, all)         the first one found where the  relative  path  exists.
                          Action category: apply to all found.  Create category:
                          act on all upstreams where the relative path exists.
       epff   (existing   Act on the first one  found,  by  the  time  upstreams
       path,      first   reply, where the relative path exists.
       found)
       eplfs  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
       path, least free   choose the one with the least free space.
       space)
       eplus  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
       path, least used   choose the one with the least used space.
       space)
       eplno  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
       path,      least   choose the one with the least number of objects.
       number        of
       objects)
       epmfs  (existing   Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists
       path, most  free   choose the one with the most free space.
       space)
       eprand (existing   Calls  epall  and  then  randomizes.  Returns only one
       path, random)      upstream.
       ff (first found)   Search category: same as epff.  Action category:  same
                          as  epff.  Create category: Act on the first one found
                          by the time upstreams reply.
       lfs (least  free   Search category: same as eplfs.  Action category: same
       space)             as eplfs.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                          least available free space.

       lus  (least used   Search category: same as eplus.  Action category: same
       space)             as eplus.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                          least used space.
       lno       (least   Search category: same as eplno.  Action category: same
       number        of   as eplno.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
       objects)           least number of objects.
       mfs  (most  free   Search category: same as epmfs.  Action category: same
       space)             as epmfs.  Create category: Pick the upstream with the
                          most available free space.
       newest             Pick the file / directory with the largest mtime.
       rand (random)      Calls  all  and  then  randomizes.   Returns  only one
                          upstream.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to union (Union  merges  the  contents  of  several
       upstream fs).

   –union-upstreams
       List of space separated upstreams.

       Can be `upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', `“upstreama:test/space:ro dir” upstreamb:', etc.

       Properties:

       • Config: upstreams

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_UPSTREAMS

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –union-action-policy
       Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category.

       Properties:

       • Config: action_policy

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_ACTION_POLICY

       • Type: string

       • Default: “epall”

   –union-create-policy
       Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category.

       Properties:

       • Config: create_policy

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CREATE_POLICY

       • Type: string

       • Default: “epmfs”

   –union-search-policy
       Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category.

       Properties:

       • Config: search_policy

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_SEARCH_POLICY

       • Type: string

       • Default: “ff”

   –union-cache-time
       Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds).

       This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.

       Properties:

       • Config: cache_time

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CACHE_TIME

       • Type: int

       • Default: 120

   Advanced options
       Here  are  the  Advanced  options  specific to union (Union merges the contents of several
       upstream fs).

   –union-min-free-space
       Minimum viable free space for lfs/eplfs policies.

       If a remote has less than this much free space then it won’t be considered for use in  lfs
       or eplfs policies.

       Properties:

       • Config: min_free_space

       • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_MIN_FREE_SPACE

       • Type: SizeSuffix

       • Default: 1Gi

   Metadata
       Any metadata supported by the underlying remote is read and written.

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

WebDAV

       Paths are specified as remote:path

       Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Configuration
       To  configure  the  WebDAV  remote  you will need to have a URL for it, and a username and
       password.  If you know what kind of system you are connecting to then  rclone  can  enable
       extra features.

       Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote.  First run:

               rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              q) Quit config
              n/s/q> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / WebDAV
                 \ "webdav"
              [snip]
              Storage> webdav
              URL of http host to connect to
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Connect to example.com
                 \ "https://example.com"
              url> https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
              Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / Nextcloud
                 \ "nextcloud"
               2 / Owncloud
                 \ "owncloud"
               3 / Sharepoint Online, authenticated by Microsoft account.
                 \ "sharepoint"
               4 / Sharepoint with NTLM authentication. Usually self-hosted or on-premises.
                 \ "sharepoint-ntlm"
               5 / Other site/service or software
                 \ "other"
              vendor> 1
              User name
              user> user
              Password.
              y) Yes type in my own password
              g) Generate random password
              n) No leave this optional password blank
              y/g/n> y
              Enter the password:
              password:
              Confirm the password:
              password:
              Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
              bearer_token>
              Remote config
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = webdav
              url = https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
              vendor = nextcloud
              user = user
              pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
              bearer_token =
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       List directories in top level of your WebDAV

              rclone lsd remote:

       List all the files in your WebDAV

              rclone ls remote:

       To copy a local directory to an WebDAV directory called backup

              rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

   Modified time and hashes
       Plain  WebDAV  does  not  support  modified  times.   However  when  used with Owncloud or
       Nextcloud rclone will support modified times.

       Likewise plain WebDAV does  not  support  hashes,  however  when  used  with  Owncloud  or
       Nextcloud  rclone  will  support  SHA1  and MD5 hashes.  Depending on the exact version of
       Owncloud or Nextcloud hashes may appear on all objects, or only on  objects  which  had  a
       hash uploaded with them.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to webdav (WebDAV).

   –webdav-url
       URL of http host to connect to.

       E.g.  https://example.com.

       Properties:

       • Config: url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: true

   –webdav-vendor
       Name of the WebDAV site/service/software you are using.

       Properties:

       • Config: vendor

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_VENDOR

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “nextcloud”

           • Nextcloud

         • “owncloud”

           • Owncloud

         • “sharepoint”

           • Sharepoint Online, authenticated by Microsoft account

         • “sharepoint-ntlm”

           • Sharepoint with NTLM authentication, usually self-hosted or on-premises

         • “other”

           • Other site/service or software

   –webdav-user
       User name.

       In case NTLM authentication is used, the username should be in the format `Domain'.

       Properties:

       • Config: user

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_USER

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –webdav-pass
       Password.

       NB     Input     to     this     must     be     obscured    -    see    rclone    obscure
       (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_obscure/).

       Properties:

       • Config: pass

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_PASS

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –webdav-bearer-token
       Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon).

       Properties:

       • Config: bearer_token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to webdav (WebDAV).

   –webdav-bearer-token-command
       Command to run to get a bearer token.

       Properties:

       • Config: bearer_token_command

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN_COMMAND

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –webdav-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for  more
       info.

       Default                                     encoding                                    is
       Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Hash,Percent,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8
       for sharepoint-ntlm or identity otherwise.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_ENCODING

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –webdav-headers
       Set HTTP headers for all transactions.

       Use this to set additional HTTP headers for all transactions

       The  input  format  is  comma  separated  list  of key,value pairs.  Standard CSV encoding
       (https://godoc.org/encoding/csv) may be used.

       For example, to set a Cookie use `Cookie,name=value', or `“Cookie”,“name=value”'.

       You can set multiple headers, e.g. `“Cookie”,“name=value”,“Authorization”,“xxx”'.

       Properties:

       • Config: headers

       • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_HEADERS

       • Type: CommaSepList

       • Default:

   Provider notes
       See below for notes on specific providers.

   Owncloud
       Click on the settings cog in the bottom right of the page and this will  show  the  WebDAV
       URL   that   rclone   needs   in   the   config   step.    It  will  look  something  like
       https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/.

       Owncloud supports modified times using the X-OC-Mtime header.

   Nextcloud
       This is configured in an identical way to Owncloud.  Note that Nextcloud initially did not
       support    streaming    of    files    (rcat)    whereas    Owncloud    did,    but   this
       (https://github.com/nextcloud/nextcloud-snap/issues/365)  seems  to   be   fixed   as   of
       2020-11-27 (tested with rclone v1.53.1 and Nextcloud Server v19).

   Sharepoint Online
       Rclone  can  be  used  with  Sharepoint  provided  by  OneDrive  for Business or Office365
       Education Accounts.  This feature is only needed for  a  few  of  these  Accounts,  mostly
       Office365  Education  ones.  These accounts are sometimes not verified by the domain owner
       github#1975 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/1975)

       This means that these accounts can’t be added  using  the  official  API  (other  Accounts
       should  work  with  the  “onedrive” option).  However, it is possible to access them using
       webdav.

       To use a sharepoint remote with rclone, add it like this: First,  you  need  to  get  your
       remote’s URL:

       • Go here (https://onedrive.live.com/about/en-us/signin/) to open your OneDrive or to sign
         in

       • Now take a look at your address bar, the  URL  should  look  like  this:  https://[YOUR-
         DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/_layouts/15/onedrive.aspx

       You’ll only need this URL up to the email address.  After that, you’ll most likely want to
       add “/Documents”.  That subdirectory contains the actual data stored on your OneDrive.

       Add  the  remote  to   rclone   like   this:   Configure   the   url   as   https://[YOUR-
       DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents  and  use  your  normal  account
       email and password for user and pass.  If you have 2FA enabled, you have  to  generate  an
       app password.  Set the vendor to sharepoint.

       Your config file should look like this:

              [sharepoint]
              type = webdav
              url = https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents
              vendor = sharepoint
              user = YourEmailAddress
              pass = encryptedpassword

   Sharepoint with NTLM Authentication
       Use this option in case your (hosted) Sharepoint is not tied to OneDrive accounts and uses
       NTLM authentication.

       To get the url configuration, similarly to  the  above,  first  navigate  to  the  desired
       directory  in  your  browser  to  get the URL, then strip everything after the name of the
       opened directory.

       Example:                 If                  the                  URL                  is:
       https://example.sharepoint.com/sites/12345/Documents/Forms/AllItems.aspx

       The configuration to use would be: https://example.sharepoint.com/sites/12345/Documents

       Set the vendor to sharepoint-ntlm.

       NTLM   uses   domain   and   user   name  combination  for  authentication,  set  user  to
       DOMAIN\username.

       Your config file should look like this:

              [sharepoint]
              type = webdav
              url = https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]/some-path-to/Documents
              vendor = sharepoint-ntlm
              user = DOMAIN\user
              pass = encryptedpassword

   Required Flags for SharePoint
       As SharePoint does some special things with uploaded documents, you won’t be able  to  use
       the  documents  size or the documents hash to compare if a file has been changed since the
       upload / which file is newer.

       For Rclone calls copying files (especially  Office  files  such  as  .docx,  .xlsx,  etc.)
       from/to SharePoint (like copy, sync, etc.), you should append these flags to ensure Rclone
       uses the “Last Modified” datetime property to compare your documents:

              --ignore-size --ignore-checksum --update

   dCache
       dCache is a storage system that supports many protocols  and  authentication/authorisation
       schemes.   For  WebDAV clients, it allows users to authenticate with username and password
       (BASIC),   X.509,   Kerberos,   and   various   bearer   tokens,    including    Macaroons
       (https://www.dcache.org/manuals/workshop-2017-05-29-Umea/000-Final/anupam_macaroons_v02.pdf)
       and OpenID-Connect (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/OpenID_Connect) access tokens.

       Configure as normal using the other type.  Don’t enter a  username  or  password,  instead
       enter your Macaroon as the bearer_token.

       The config will end up looking something like this.

              [dcache]
              type = webdav
              url = https://dcache...
              vendor = other
              user =
              pass =
              bearer_token = your-macaroon

       There  is  a script (https://github.com/sara-nl/GridScripts/blob/master/get-macaroon) that
       obtains a Macaroon from a dCache WebDAV endpoint, and creates an rclone config file.

       Macaroons may also be obtained from  the  dCacheView  web-browser/JavaScript  client  that
       comes with dCache.

   OpenID-Connect
       dCache  also supports authenticating with OpenID-Connect access tokens.  OpenID-Connect is
       a protocol (based  on  OAuth  2.0)  that  allows  services  to  identify  users  who  have
       authenticated with some central service.

       Support  for OpenID-Connect in rclone is currently achieved using another software package
       called oidc-agent (https://github.com/indigo-dc/oidc-agent).  This is a command-line  tool
       that  facilitates  obtaining  an  access  token.  Once installed and configured, an access
       token is obtained by running the  oidc-token  command.   The  following  example  shows  a
       (shortened) access token obtained from the XDC OIDC Provider.

              paul@celebrimbor:~$ oidc-token XDC
              eyJraWQ[...]QFXDt0
              paul@celebrimbor:~$

       Note  Before  the  oidc-token command will work, the refresh token must be loaded into the
       oidc agent.  This is done with  the  oidc-add  command  (e.g.,  oidc-add  XDC).   This  is
       typically  done  once  per  login session.  Full details on this and how to register oidc-
       agent  with  your  OIDC  Provider   are   provided   in   the   oidc-agent   documentation
       (https://indigo-dc.gitbooks.io/oidc-agent/).

       The  rclone  bearer_token_command  configuration  option is used to fetch the access token
       from oidc-agent.

       Configure as a normal WebDAV endpoint, using the `other' vendor, leaving the username  and
       password  empty.   When prompted, choose to edit the advanced config and enter the command
       to get a bearer token (e.g., oidc-agent XDC).

       The following example config shows a WebDAV endpoint that uses  oidc-agent  to  supply  an
       access token from the XDC OIDC Provider.

              [dcache]
              type = webdav
              url = https://dcache.example.org/
              vendor = other
              bearer_token_command = oidc-token XDC

Yandex Disk

       Yandex  Disk  (https://disk.yandex.com)  is  a  cloud  storage  solution created by Yandex
       (https://yandex.com).

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a yandex configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              n/s> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Yandex Disk
                 \ "yandex"
              [snip]
              Storage> yandex
              Yandex Client Id - leave blank normally.
              client_id>
              Yandex Client Secret - leave blank normally.
              client_secret>
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes
              n) No
              y/n> y
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              --------------------
              [remote]
              client_id =
              client_secret =
              token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"OAuth","expiry":"2016-12-29T12:27:11.362788025Z"}
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d> y

       See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set  it  up  on  a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Note  that  rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the token as returned
       from Yandex Disk.  This only runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment  you
       get  back  the  verification  code.   This  is  on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may
       require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       See top level directories

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new directory

              rclone mkdir remote:directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:directory

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

       Yandex paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Modified time
       Modified times are supported and are stored accurate to 1 ns  in  custom  metadata  called
       rclone_modified in RFC3339 with nanoseconds format.

   MD5 checksums
       MD5 checksums are natively supported by Yandex Disk.

   Emptying Trash
       If  you wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command which will
       permanently delete all your trashed files.  This command does not take any path arguments.

   Quota information
       To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display
       your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

   Restricted filename characters
       The default restricted characters set (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-characters)
       are replaced.

       Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8),  as
       they can’t be used in JSON strings.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

   –yandex-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –yandex-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

   –yandex-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –yandex-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –yandex-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –yandex-hard-delete
       Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

       Properties:

       • Config: hard_delete

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_HARD_DELETE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –yandex-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

   Limitations
       When uploading very large files (bigger than about 5 GiB) you will need  to  increase  the
       --timeout  parameter.   This is because Yandex pauses (perhaps to calculate the MD5SUM for
       the entire file) before returning confirmation that  the  file  has  been  uploaded.   The
       default handling of timeouts in rclone is to assume a 5 minute pause is an error and close
       the connection - you’ll see net/http: timeout awaiting response headers errors in the logs
       if  this is happening.  Setting the timeout to twice the max size of file in GiB should be
       enough, so if you want to upload a 30 GiB file set a timeout of 2 *  30  =  60m,  that  is
       --timeout 60m.

       Having  a  Yandex  Mail  account  is mandatory to use the Yandex.Disk subscription.  Token
       generation will work without a mail account, but Rclone won’t  be  able  to  complete  any
       actions.

              [403 - DiskUnsupportedUserAccountTypeError] User account type is not supported.

Zoho Workdrive

       Zoho  WorkDrive  (https://www.zoho.com/workdrive/)  is a cloud storage solution created by
       Zoho (https://zoho.com).

   Configuration
       Here is an example of making a zoho configuration.  First run

              rclone config

       This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

              No remotes found, make a new one?
              n) New remote
              s) Set configuration password
              n/s> n
              name> remote
              Type of storage to configure.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
              [snip]
              XX / Zoho
                 \ "zoho"
              [snip]
              Storage> zoho
              ** See help for zoho backend at: https://rclone.org/zoho/ **

              OAuth Client Id
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_id>
              OAuth Client Secret
              Leave blank normally.
              Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
              client_secret>
              Edit advanced config? (y/n)
              y) Yes
              n) No (default)
              y/n> n
              Remote config
              Use auto config?
               * Say Y if not sure
               * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
              y) Yes (default)
              n) No
              y/n>
              If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=LVn0IHzxej1ZkmQw31d0wQ
              Log in and authorize rclone for access
              Waiting for code...
              Got code
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / MyTeam
                 \ "4u28602177065ff22426787a6745dba8954eb"
              Enter a Team ID> 1
              Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
               1 / General
                 \ "4u2869d2aa6fca04f4f2f896b6539243b85b1"
              Enter a Workspace ID> 1
              --------------------
              [remote]
              type = zoho
              token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"Zoho-oauthtoken","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2020-10-12T00:54:52.370275223+02:00"}
              root_folder_id = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
              --------------------
              y) Yes this is OK (default)
              e) Edit this remote
              d) Delete this remote
              y/e/d>

       See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for how to set  it  up  on  a
       machine with no Internet browser available.

       Rclone  runs  a  webserver  on your local computer to collect the authorization token from
       Zoho Workdrive.  This is only from the moment your browser is opened until  the  token  is
       returned.   The  webserver  runs  on  http://127.0.0.1:53682/.   If  local  port  53682 is
       protected by a firewall you may need to  temporarily  unblock  the  firewall  to  complete
       authorization.

       Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

       See top level directories

              rclone lsd remote:

       Make a new directory

              rclone mkdir remote:directory

       List the contents of a directory

              rclone ls remote:directory

       Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any excess files in the path.

              rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

       Zoho paths may be as deep as required, eg remote:directory/subdirectory.

   Modified time
       Modified times are currently not supported for Zoho Workdrive

   Checksums
       No checksums are supported.

   Usage information
       To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote: command which will display
       your current usage.

   Restricted filename characters
       Only control characters and invalid UTF-8 are replaced.  In addition  most  Unicode  full-
       width  characters  are  not  supported  at  all  and will be removed from filenames during
       upload.

   Standard options
       Here are the Standard options specific to zoho (Zoho).

   –zoho-client-id
       OAuth Client Id.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_id

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_CLIENT_ID

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –zoho-client-secret
       OAuth Client Secret.

       Leave blank normally.

       Properties:

       • Config: client_secret

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_CLIENT_SECRET

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –zoho-region
       Zoho region to connect to.

       You’ll have to use the region your organization is registered in.  If  not  sure  use  the
       same top level domain as you connect to in your browser.

       Properties:

       • Config: region

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_REGION

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

       • Examples:

         • “com”

           • United states / Global

         • “eu”

           • Europe

         • “in”

           • India

         • “jp”

           • Japan

         • “com.cn”

           • China

         • “com.au”

           • Australia

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to zoho (Zoho).

   –zoho-token
       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

       Properties:

       • Config: token

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_TOKEN

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –zoho-auth-url
       Auth server URL.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: auth_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_AUTH_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –zoho-token-url
       Token server url.

       Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

       Properties:

       • Config: token_url

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_TOKEN_URL

       • Type: string

       • Required: false

   –zoho-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

   Setting up your own client_id
       For Zoho we advise you to set up your own client_id.  To do so you have  to  complete  the
       following steps.

       1. Log in to the Zoho API Console (https://api-console.zoho.com)

       2. Create  a  new  client  of type “Server-based Application”.  The name and website don’t
          matter, but you must add the redirect URL http://localhost:53682/.

       3. Once the client is created, you can go to the settings  tab  and  enable  it  in  other
          regions.

       The client id and client secret can now be used with rclone.

Local Filesystem

       Local paths are specified as normal filesystem paths, e.g. /path/to/wherever, so

              rclone sync -i /home/source /tmp/destination

       Will sync /home/source to /tmp/destination.

   Configuration
       For  consistencies  sake one can also configure a remote of type local in the config file,
       and access the local filesystem using rclone remote  paths,  e.g. remote:path/to/wherever,
       but it is probably easier not to.

   Modified time
       Rclone  reads  and  writes  the  modified  time  using  an  accuracy determined by the OS.
       Typically this is 1ns on Linux, 10 ns on Windows and 1 Second on OS X.

   Filenames
       Filenames should be encoded in UTF-8 on disk.  This is the normal case for Windows and  OS
       X.

       There  is a bit more uncertainty in the Linux world, but new distributions will have UTF-8
       encoded files names.  If you are using an old Linux filesystem with non UTF-8  file  names
       (e.g. latin1)  then  you can use the convmv tool to convert the filesystem to UTF-8.  This
       tool is available in most distributions’ package managers.

       If an invalid (non-UTF8) filename is read, the invalid characters will be replaced with  a
       quoted  representation  of  the  invalid  bytes.   The name gro\xdf will be transferred as
       gro‛DF.  rclone will emit a debug message in this case (use -v to see), e.g.

              Local file system at .: Replacing invalid UTF-8 characters in "gro\xdf"

   Restricted characters
       With the local backend, restrictions  on  the  characters  that  are  usable  in  file  or
       directory  names  depend  on  the  operating system.  To check what rclone will replace by
       default on your system, run rclone help flags local-encoding.

       On non Windows platforms the following characters are replaced when handling file names.

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       /           0x2F        /

       When running on Windows the following characters are replaced.  This list is based on  the
       Windows        file        naming        conventions       (https://docs.microsoft.com/de-
       de/windows/desktop/FileIO/naming-a-file#naming-conventions).

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       NUL         0x00         ␀
       SOH         0x01         ␁
       STX         0x02         ␂
       ETX         0x03         ␃
       EOT         0x04         ␄
       ENQ         0x05         ␅
       ACK         0x06         ␆
       BEL         0x07         ␇
       BS          0x08         ␈
       HT          0x09         ␉
       LF          0x0A         ␊
       VT          0x0B         ␋
       FF          0x0C         ␌
       CR          0x0D         ␍
       SO          0x0E         ␎
       SI          0x0F         ␏
       DLE         0x10         ␐
       DC1         0x11         ␑
       DC2         0x12         ␒
       DC3         0x13         ␓
       DC4         0x14         ␔
       NAK         0x15         ␕
       SYN         0x16         ␖
       ETB         0x17         ␗
       CAN         0x18         ␘
       EM          0x19         ␙
       SUB         0x1A         ␚
       ESC         0x1B         ␛
       FS          0x1C         ␜
       GS          0x1D         ␝
       RS          0x1E         ␞
       US          0x1F         ␟
       /           0x2F        /
       ”           0x22        "
       *           0x2A        *
       :           0x3A        :
       <           0x3C        <
       >           0x3E        >
       ?           0x3F        ?
       \           0x5C        \
       |           0x7C        |

       File names on Windows can also not end with the  following  characters.   These  only  get
       replaced if they are the last character in the name:

       Character   Value   Replacement
       ────────────────────────────────
       SP          0x20         ␠
       .           0x2E        .

       Invalid  UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced (https://rclone.org/overview/#invalid-utf8), as
       they can’t be converted to UTF-16.

   Paths on Windows
       On Windows there are many ways of specifying a path to  a  file  system  resource.   Local
       paths  can  be absolute, like C:\path\to\wherever, or relative, like ..\wherever.  Network
       paths in UNC format, \\server\share, are also supported.  Path separator can be  either  \
       (as  in  C:\path\to\wherever) or / (as in C:/path/to/wherever).  Length of these paths are
       limited to 259 characters for files and 247 characters for directories, but  there  is  an
       alternative  extended-length  path  format  increasing the limit to (approximately) 32,767
       characters.   This  format  requires  absolute  paths  and  the  use   of   prefix   \\?\,
       e.g. \\?\D:\some\very\long\path.    For  convenience  rclone  will  automatically  convert
       regular paths into the corresponding extended-length paths, so in most cases  you  do  not
       have to worry about this (read more below).

       Note  that  Windows  supports  using  the  same  prefix  \\?\  to  specify path to volumes
       identified                by                their                GUID,                e.g.
       \\?\Volume{b75e2c83-0000-0000-0000-602f00000000}\some\path.   This  is  not  supported  in
       rclone, due to an issue (https://github.com/golang/go/issues/39785) in go.

   Long paths
       Rclone handles long paths automatically, by converting all paths to  extended-length  path
       format           (https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/fileio/maximum-file-path-
       limitation), which allows paths up to 32,767 characters.

       This conversion will ensure paths are absolute and prefix them with the \\?\.  This is why
       you  will  see  that your paths, for instance .\files is shown as path \\?\C:\files in the
       output, and \\server\share as \\?\UNC\server\share.

       However, in rare cases this may cause problems with buggy file system drivers  like  EncFS
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/261).   To  disable  UNC conversion globally, add
       this to your .rclone.conf file:

              [local]
              nounc = true

       If you want to selectively disable UNC, you can add it to a separate entry like this:

              [nounc]
              type = local
              nounc = true

       And use rclone like this:

       rclone copy c:\src nounc:z:\dst

       This will use UNC paths on c:\src but not on z:\dst.  Of course this will  cause  problems
       if the absolute path length of a file exceeds 259 characters on z, so only use this option
       if you have to.

   Symlinks / Junction points
       Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave like symlinks  under
       Windows).

       If  you supply --copy-links or -L then rclone will follow the symlink and copy the pointed
       to file or directory.  Note that this flag is incompatible with --links / -l.

       This flag applies to all commands.

       For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

              $ tree /tmp/a
              /tmp/a
              ├── b -> ../b
              ├── expected -> ../expected
              ├── one
              └── two
                  └── three

       Then you can see the difference with and without the flag like this

              $ rclone ls /tmp/a
                      6 one
                      6 two/three

       and

              $ rclone -L ls /tmp/a
                   4174 expected
                      6 one
                      6 two/three
                      6 b/two
                      6 b/one

   –links, -l
       Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave like symlinks  under
       Windows).

       If  you  supply this flag then rclone will copy symbolic links from the local storage, and
       store them as text files, with a `.rclonelink' suffix in the remote storage.

       The text file will contain the target of the symbolic link (see example).

       This flag applies to all commands.

       For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

              $ tree /tmp/a
              /tmp/a
              ├── file1 -> ./file4
              └── file2 -> /home/user/file3

       Copying the entire directory with `-l'

              $ rclone copyto -l /tmp/a/file1 remote:/tmp/a/

       The remote files are created with a `.rclonelink' suffix

              $ rclone ls remote:/tmp/a
                     5 file1.rclonelink
                    14 file2.rclonelink

       The remote files will contain the target of the symbolic links

              $ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file1.rclonelink
              ./file4

              $ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file2.rclonelink
              /home/user/file3

       Copying them back with `-l'

              $ rclone copyto -l remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

              $ tree /tmp/b
              /tmp/b
              ├── file1 -> ./file4
              └── file2 -> /home/user/file3

       However, if copied back without `-l'

              $ rclone copyto remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

              $ tree /tmp/b
              /tmp/b
              ├── file1.rclonelink
              └── file2.rclonelink

       Note that this flag is incompatible with -copy-links / -L.

   Restricting filesystems with –one-file-system
       Normally rclone will recurse through filesystems as mounted.

       However if you set --one-file-system or -x this tells rclone to  stay  in  the  filesystem
       specified by the root and not to recurse into different file systems.

       For example if you have a directory hierarchy like this

              root
              ├── disk1     - disk1 mounted on the root
              │   └── file3 - stored on disk1
              ├── disk2     - disk2 mounted on the root
              │   └── file4 - stored on disk12
              ├── file1     - stored on the root disk
              └── file2     - stored on the root disk

       Using rclone --one-file-system copy root remote: will only copy file1 and file2.  Eg

              $ rclone -q --one-file-system ls root
                      0 file1
                      0 file2

              $ rclone -q ls root
                      0 disk1/file3
                      0 disk2/file4
                      0 file1
                      0 file2

       NB Rclone (like most unix tools such as du, rsync and tar) treats a bind mount to the same
       device as being on the same filesystem.

       NB This flag is only available on Unix based systems.  On systems where it isn’t supported
       (e.g. Windows) it will be ignored.

   Advanced options
       Here are the Advanced options specific to local (Local Disk).

   –local-nounc
       Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows.

       Properties:

       • Config: nounc

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NOUNC

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

       • Examples:

         • “true”

           • Disables long file names.

   –copy-links / -L
       Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item.

       Properties:

       • Config: copy_links

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_COPY_LINKS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –links / -l
       Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a `.rclonelink' extension.

       Properties:

       • Config: links

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_LINKS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –skip-links
       Don’t warn about skipped symlinks.

       This  flag  disables  warning  messages  on  skipped  symlinks  or junction points, as you
       explicitly acknowledge that they should be skipped.

       Properties:

       • Config: skip_links

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-zero-size-links
       Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead) (deprecated).

       Rclone used to use the Stat size of links as the link size, but this fails in quite a  few
       places:

       • Windows

       • On some virtual filesystems (such ash LucidLink)

       • Android

       So rclone now always reads the link.

       Properties:

       • Config: zero_size_links

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ZERO_SIZE_LINKS

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-unicode-normalization
       Apply unicode NFC normalization to paths and filenames.

       This flag can be used to normalize file names into unicode NFC form that are read from the
       local filesystem.

       Rclone does not normally touch the encoding of file names it reads from the file system.

       This can be useful when using macOS as it normally provides decomposed (NFD) unicode which
       in some language (eg Korean) doesn’t display properly on some OSes.

       Note that rclone compares filenames with unicode normalization in the sync routine so this
       flag shouldn’t normally be used.

       Properties:

       • Config: unicode_normalization

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_UNICODE_NORMALIZATION

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-no-check-updated
       Don’t check to see if the files change during upload.

       Normally rclone checks the size and modification time of files as they are being  uploaded
       and  aborts with a message which starts “can’t copy - source file is being updated” if the
       file changes during upload.

       However on some file systems this modification time check may fail (e.g.  Glusterfs  #2206
       (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/2206))  so  this  check can be disabled with this
       flag.

       If this flag is set, rclone will use its best efforts to transfer a file  which  is  being
       updated.   If  the file is only having things appended to it (e.g. a log) then rclone will
       transfer the log file with the size it had the first time rclone saw it.

       If the file is being modified throughout (not just appended to) then the transfer may fail
       with a hash check failure.

       In detail, once the file has had stat() called on it for the first time we:

       • Only transfer the size that stat gave

       • Only checksum the size that stat gave

       • Don’t update the stat info for the file

       Properties:

       • Config: no_check_updated

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_CHECK_UPDATED

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –one-file-system / -x
       Don’t cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only).

       Properties:

       • Config: one_file_system

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ONE_FILE_SYSTEM

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-case-sensitive
       Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive.

       Normally  the  local backend declares itself as case insensitive on Windows/macOS and case
       sensitive for everything else.  Use this flag to override the default choice.

       Properties:

       • Config: case_sensitive

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_SENSITIVE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-case-insensitive
       Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive.

       Normally the local backend declares itself as case insensitive on Windows/macOS  and  case
       sensitive for everything else.  Use this flag to override the default choice.

       Properties:

       • Config: case_insensitive

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_INSENSITIVE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-no-preallocate
       Disable preallocation of disk space for transferred files.

       Preallocation of disk space helps prevent filesystem fragmentation.  However, some virtual
       filesystem layers (such as Google Drive File Stream) may incorrectly set the  actual  file
       size  equal to the preallocated space, causing checksum and file size checks to fail.  Use
       this flag to disable preallocation.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_preallocate

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_PREALLOCATE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-no-sparse
       Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads.

       On Windows platforms rclone will make sparse  files  when  doing  multi-thread  downloads.
       This  avoids long pauses on large files where the OS zeros the file.  However sparse files
       may be undesirable as they cause disk fragmentation and can be slow to work with.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_sparse

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SPARSE

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-no-set-modtime
       Disable setting modtime.

       Normally rclone updates modification time of files after they are  done  uploading.   This
       can  cause  permissions  issues on Linux platforms when the user rclone is running as does
       not own the file uploaded, such as when copying to a CIFS mount owned by another user.  If
       this option is enabled, rclone will no longer update the modtime after copying a file.

       Properties:

       • Config: no_set_modtime

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SET_MODTIME

       • Type: bool

       • Default: false

   –local-encoding
       The encoding for the backend.

       See  the encoding section in the overview (https://rclone.org/overview/#encoding) for more
       info.

       Properties:

       • Config: encoding

       • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ENCODING

       • Type: MultiEncoder

       • Default: Slash,Dot

   Metadata
       Depending on which OS is in use the local backend may  return  only  some  of  the  system
       metadata.   Setting  system metadata is supported on all OSes but setting user metadata is
       only supported on linux, freebsd, netbsd, macOS and  Solaris.   It  is  not  supported  on
       Windows yet (see pkg/attrs#47 (https://github.com/pkg/xattr/issues/47)).

       User  metadata  is  stored  as extended attributes (which may not be supported by all file
       systems) under the “user.*” prefix.

       Here are the possible system metadata items for the local backend.

       Name          Help           Type          Example                               Read Only
       ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
       atime         Time     of    RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                     last access
       btime         Time     of    RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                     file  birth
                     (creation)
       gid           Group ID of    decimal       500                                   N
                     owner          number
       mode          File   type    octal, unix   0100664                               N
                     and mode       style
       mtime         Time     of    RFC 3339      2006-01-02T15:04:05.999999999Z07:00   N
                     last
                     modification
       rdev          Device    ID   hexadecimal   1abc                                  N
                     (if  special
                     file)
       uid           User  ID  of   decimal       500                                   N
                     owner          number

       See the metadata (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata) docs for more info.

   Backend commands
       Here are the commands specific to the local backend.

       Run them with

              rclone backend COMMAND remote:

       The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

       See the backend (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_backend/) command for more info on how
       to pass options and arguments.

       These  can  be  run  on  a  running  backend  using   the   rc   command   backend/command
       (https://rclone.org/rc/#backend-command).

   noop
       A null operation for testing backend commands

              rclone backend noop remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

       This is a test command which has some options you can try to change the output.

       Options:

       • “echo”: echo the input arguments

       • “error”: return an error based on option value

Changelog

   v1.60.1 - 2022-11-17
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.60.0...v1.60.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • lib/cache: Fix alias backend shutting down too soon (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • wasm: Fix walltime link error by adding up-to-date wasm_exec.js (João Henrique Franco)

         • docs

           • Update faq.md with bisync (Samuel Johnson)

           • Corrected download links in windows install docs (coultonluke)

           • Add direct download link for windows arm64 (albertony)

           • Remove link to rclone slack as it is no longer supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Faq: how to use a proxy server that requires a username and password (asdffdsazqqq)

           • Oracle-object-storage: doc fix (Manoj Ghosh)

           • Fix typo remove in rclone_serve_restic command (Joda Stößer)

           • Fix character that was incorrectly interpreted as markdown (Clément Notin)

       • VFS

         • Fix deadlock caused by cache cleaner and upload finishing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Clean absolute paths (albertony)

         • Fix -L/–copy-links with filters missing directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mailru

         • Note that an app password is now needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Allow timestamps to be before the epoch 1970-01-01 (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Add  provider  quirk  --s3-might-gzip to fix corrupted on transfer: sizes differ (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Allow Storj to server side copy since it seems to work now (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix for unchecked err value in s3 listv2 (Aaron Gokaslan)

         • Add additional Wasabi locations (techknowlogick)

       • Smb

         • Fix Failed to sync: context canceled at the end of syncs (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Fix Move/Copy/DirMove when using -server-side-across-configs (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.60.0 - 2022-10-21
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.0...v1.60.0)

       • New backends

         • Oracle object storage (https://rclone.org/oracleobjectstorage/) (Manoj Ghosh)

         • SMB (https://rclone.org/smb/) / CIFS (Windows file sharing) (Lesmiscore)

         • New S3 providers

           • IONOS Cloud Storage (https://rclone.org/s3/#ionos) (Dmitry Deniskin)

           • Qiniu KODO (https://rclone.org/s3/#qiniu) (Bachue Zhou)

       • New Features

         • build

           • Update to go1.19 and make go1.17 the minimum required version (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Install.sh: fix arm-v7 download (Ole Frost)

         • fs: Warn the user when using an existing remote name without a colon (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • httplib: Add --xxx-min-tls-version option to  select  minimum  TLS  version  for  HTTP
           servers (Robert Newson)

         • librclone: Add PHP bindings and test program (Jordi Gonzalez Muñoz)

         • operations

           • Add --server-side-across-configs global flag for any backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Optimise --copy-dest and --compare-dest (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc: add job/stopgroup to stop group (Evan Spensley)

         • serve dlna

           • Add --announce-interval to control SSDP Announce Interval (YanceyChiew)

           • Add --interface to Specify SSDP interface names line (Simon Bos)

           • Add support for more external subtitles (YanceyChiew)

           • Add verification of addresses (YanceyChiew)

         • sync: Optimise --copy-dest and --compare-dest (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • doc  updates  (albertony,  Alexander Knorr, anonion, João Henrique Franco, Josh Soref,
           Lorenzo Milesi, Marco Molteni, Mark  Trolley,  Ole  Frost,  partev,  Ryan  Morey,  Tom
           Mombourquette, YFdyh000)

       • Bug Fixes

         • filter

           • Fix  incorrect  filtering  with  UseFilter  context flag and wrapping backends (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Make sure we check --files-from when looking for a single file (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Fix  mount/listmounts  not  returning  the  full  Fs  entered  in  mount/mount  (Tom
             Mombourquette)

           • Handle external unmount when mounting (Isaac Aymerich)

           • Validate Daemon option is not set when mounting a volume via RC (Isaac Aymerich)

         • sync: Update docs and error messages to reflect fixes to overlap checks (Nick Naumann)

       • VFS

         • Reduce memory use by embedding sync.Cond (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Reduce memory usage by re-ordering commonly used structures (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix excess CPU used by VFS cache cleaner looping (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Obey file filters in listing to fix errors on excluded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix  “Failed  to  read  metadata: function not implemented” on old Linux kernels (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Compress

         • Fix crash due to nil metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix error handling to not use or return nil objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Make --drive-stop-on-upload-limit obey quota exceeded error (Steve Kowalik)

       • FTP

         • Add --ftp-force-list-hidden option to show hidden items (Øyvind Heddeland Instefjord)

         • Fix hang when using ExplicitTLS to certain servers.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add --gcs-endpoint flag and config parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Hubic

         • Remove backend as service has now shut down (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Rename Onedrive(cn) 21Vianet to Vnet Group (Yen Hu)

         • Disable change notify in China region since it is not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Implement --s3-versions flag to show old versions of objects if enabled  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Implement  --s3-version-at flag to show versions of objects at a particular time (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Implement backend versioning command to get/set bucket versioning (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement Purge to purge versions and backend cleanup-hidden (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-decompress flag to decompress gzip-encoded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-sse-customer-key-base64 to supply keys with binary data (Richard Bateman)

         • Try to keep the maximum precision in ModTime with --user-server-modtime  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Drop binary metadata with an ERROR message as it can’t be stored (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-no-system-metadata to suppress read and write of system metadata (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Fix directory creation races (Lesmiscore)

       • Swift

         • Add --swift-no-large-objects to reduce HEAD requests (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Union

         • Propagate SlowHash feature to fix hasher interaction (Lesmiscore)

   v1.59.2 - 2022-09-15
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.1...v1.59.2)

       • Bug Fixes

         • config: Move locking to fix fatal error: concurrent  map  read  and  map  write  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Disable  xattr  support  if the filesystems indicates it is not supported (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix chunksize calculations producing too many parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.59.1 - 2022-08-08
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.59.0...v1.59.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix panic in core/stats-reset with unknown group (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build: Fix android build after GitHub actions change (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dlna: Fix SOAP action header parsing (Joram Schrijver)

         • docs: Fix links to mount command from install docs (albertony)

         • dropbox: Fix ChangeNotify was unable to decrypt errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fs: Fix parsing of times and durations of the form “YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS” (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • serve sftp: Fix checksum detection (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • sync: Add accidentally missed filter-sensitivity to –backup-dir option (Nick Naumann)

       • Combine

         • Fix docs showing remote= instead of upstreams= (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Throw error if duplicate directory name is specified (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix errors with backends shutting down while in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Fix hang on quit with –dropbox-batch-mode off (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix infinite loop on uploading a corrupted file (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Internetarchive

         • Ignore checksums for files using the different method (Lesmiscore)

         • Handle hash symbol in the middle of filename (Lesmiscore)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix working with whitelabel Elgiganten Cloud

         • Do not store username in config when using standard auth (albertony)

       • Mega

         • Fix nil pointer exception when bad node received (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix  –s3-no-head  panic:  reflect: Elem of invalid type s3.PutObjectInput (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Fix issue with WS_FTP by working around failing RealPath (albertony)

       • Union

         • Fix duplicated files when using directories with leading / (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix multiple files being uploaded when roots don’t exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix panic due to misalignment of struct field in 32 bit architectures (r-ricci)

   v1.59.0 - 2022-07-09
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.58.0...v1.59.0)

       • New backends

         • Combine multiple remotes in one directory tree (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Hidrive (https://rclone.org/hidrive/) (Ovidiu Victor Tatar)

         • Internet Archive (https://rclone.org/internetarchive/) (Lesmiscore (Naoya Ozaki))

         • New S3 providers

           • ArvanCloud AOS (https://rclone.org/s3/#arvan-cloud) (ehsantdy)

           • Cloudflare R2 (https://rclone.org/s3/#cloudflare-r2) (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Huawei OBS (https://rclone.org/s3/#huawei-obs) (m00594701)

           • IDrive e2 (https://rclone.org/s3/#idrive-e2) (vyloy)

       • New commands

         • test makefile  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_makefile/):  Create  a  single
           file for testing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • Metadata  framework  (https://rclone.org/docs/#metadata)  to read and write system and
           user metadata on backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implemented initially for local, s3 and internetarchive backends

           • --metadata/-M flag to control whether metadata is copied

           • --metadata-set flag to specify metadata for uploads

           • Thanks to Manz Solutions (https://manz-solutions.at/) for sponsoring this work.

         • build

           • Update to go1.18 and make go1.16 the minimum required version (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update android go build to 1.18.x and NDK to 23.1.7779620 (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • All windows binaries now no longer CGO (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add linux/arm/v6 to docker images (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • A huge number of fixes found with staticcheck (https://staticcheck.io/) (albertony)

           • Configurable version suffix independent of version number (albertony)

         • check: Implement --no-traverse and --no-unicode-normalization (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: Readability improvements (albertony)

         • copyurl: Add --header-filename to honor the HTTP header filename directive (J-P Treen)

         • filter: Allow multiple --exclude-if-present flags (albertony)

         • fshttp: Add --disable-http-keep-alives to disable HTTP Keep Alives (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • install.sh

           • Set the modes on the files and/or directories on macOS (Michael  C  Tiernan  -  MIT-
             Research Computing Project)

           • Pre  verify  sudo  authorization  -v before calling curl.  (Michael C Tiernan - MIT-
             Research Computing Project)

         • lib/encoder: Add Semicolon encoding (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsf: Add metadata support with M flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson: Add --metadata/-M flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • ncdu

           • Implement multi selection (CrossR)

           • Replace termbox with tcell’s termbox wrapper (eNV25)

           • Display correct path in delete confirmation dialog (Roberto Ricci)

         • operations

           • Speed up hash checking by aborting the other hash if  first  returns  nothing  (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Use correct src/dst in some log messages (zzr93)

         • rcat: Check checksums by default like copy does (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • selfupdate:  Replace  deprecated  x/crypto/openpgp  package  with ProtonMail/go-crypto
           (albertony)

         • serve ftp: Check --passive-port arguments are correct (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • size: Warn about inaccurate results when objects with unknown size (albertony)

         • sync: Overlap check is now  filter-sensitive  so  --backup-dir  can  be  in  the  root
           provided it is filtered (Nick)

         • test  info: Check file name lengths using 1,2,3,4 byte unicode characters (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • test makefile(s): --sparse, --zero, --pattern, --ascii,  --chargen  flags  to  control
           file contents (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make sure we call the Shutdown method on backends (Martin Czygan)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix unknown length file transfers counting 3 transfers each (buda)

         • ncdu: Fix issue where dir size is summed when file sizes are -1 (albertony)

         • sync/copy/move

           • Fix --fast-list --create-empty-src-dirs and --exclude (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix --max-duration and --cutoff-mode soft (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix fs cache unpin (Martin Czygan)

         • Set  proper  exit  code for errors that are not low-level retried (e.g. size/timestamp
           changing) (albertony)

       • Mount

         • Support    windows/arm64    (may     still     be     problems     -     see     #5828
           (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/5828)) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Log IO errors at ERROR level (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Ignore _netdev mount argument (Hugal31)

       • VFS

         • Add --vfs-fast-fingerprint for less accurate but faster fingerprints (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add  --vfs-disk-space-total-size  option to manually set the total disk space (Claudio
           Maradonna)

         • vfscache: Fix fatal error: sync: unlock of unlocked mutex error (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Fix parsing of --local-nounc flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add Metadata support (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Calculate Chunksize/blocksize to stay below maxUploadParts (Leroy van Logchem)

         • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

         • Case insensitive access tier (Rob Pickerill)

         • Allow remote emulator (azurite) (Lorenzo Maiorfi)

       • B2

         • Add --b2-version-at flag to show file versions at time specified (SwazRGB)

         • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

       • Chunker

         • Mark as not supporting metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Compress

         • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Make backend config -o config add a combined AllDrives: remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make --drive-shared-with-me work with shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --drive-resource-key for accessing link-shared files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add backend commands exportformats and importformats for debugging (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix 404 errors on copy/server side copy objects from public folder (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update Internal OAuth consent screen docs (Phil Shackleton)

         • Moved root_folder_id to advanced section (Abhiraj)

       • Dropbox

         • Migrate from deprecated api (m8rge)

         • Add logs to show when poll interval limits are exceeded (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix nil pointer exception on dropbox impersonate user not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Parse api error codes and them accordingly (buengese)

       • FTP

         • Add support for disable_utf8 option (Jason Zheng)

         • Revert to upstream github.com/jlaffaye/ftp from our fork (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add --gcs-no-check-bucket to minimise transactions and perms (Nick Gooding)

         • Add --gcs-decompress flag to decompress gzip-encoded files (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • by default these will be downloaded compressed (which previously failed)

       • Hasher

         • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • HTTP

         • Fix missing response when using custom auth handler (albertony)

       • Jottacloud

         • Add support for upload to custom device and mountpoint (albertony)

         • Always store username in config and use it to avoid initial API request (albertony)

         • Fix issue with server-side copy when destination is in trash (albertony)

         • Fix listing output of remote with special characters (albertony)

       • Mailru

         • Fix timeout by using int instead  of  time.Duration  for  keeping  number  of  seconds
           (albertony)

       • Mega

         • Document using MEGAcmd to help with login failures (Art M.  Gallagher)

       • Onedrive

         • Implement --poll-interval for onedrive (Hugo Laloge)

         • Add access scopes option (Sven Gerber)

       • Opendrive

         • Resolve lag and truncate bugs (Scott Grimes)

       • Pcloud

         • Fix about with no free space left (buengese)

         • Fix cleanup (buengese)

       • S3

         • Use  PUT  Object  instead of presigned URLs to upload single part objects (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Backend restore command to skip non-GLACIER objects (Vincent Murphy)

         • Use chunksize lib to determine chunksize dynamically (Derek Battams)

         • Retry RequestTimeout errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement reading and writing of metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Add support for about and hashsum on windows server (albertony)

         • Use vendor-specific VFS statistics extension for about if available (albertony)

         • Add --sftp-chunk-size to control packets sizes for high  latency  links  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add --sftp-concurrency to improve high latency transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --sftp-set-env option to set environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add Hetzner Storage Boxes to supported sftp backends (Anthrazz)

       • Storj

         • Fix put which lead to the file being unreadable when using mount (Erik van Velzen)

       • Union

         • Add min_free_space option for lfs/eplfs policies (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix uploading files to union of all bucket based remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix get free space for remotes which don’t support it (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix eplus policy to select correct entry for existing files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Support metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Uptobox

         • Fix root path handling (buengese)

       • WebDAV

         • Add SharePoint in other specific regions support (Noah Hsu)

       • Yandex

         • Handle api error on server-side move (albertony)

       • Zoho

         • Add Japan and China regions (buengese)

   v1.58.1 - 2022-04-29
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.58.0...v1.58.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • build: Update github.com/billziss-gh to github.com/winfsp (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • filter:  Fix  timezone  of  --min-age/-max-age  from  UTC to local as documented (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • rc/js: Correct RC method names (Sơn Trần-Nguyễn)

         • docs

           • Fix some links to command pages (albertony)

           • Add --multi-thread-streams note to --transfers.  (Zsolt Ero)

       • Mount

         • Fix --devname and fusermount: unknown option  `fsname'  when  mounting  via  rc  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Remove wording which suggests VFS is only for mounting (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Fix retries of multipart uploads with incorrect_offset error (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Use the s3 pacer to speed up transactions (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • pacer: Default the Google pacer to a burst of 100 to fix gcs pacing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix scope in token request (albertony)

       • Netstorage

         • Fix unescaped HTML in documentation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make levels of headings consistent (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add support contacts to netstorage doc (Nil Alexandrov)

       • Onedrive

         • Note that sharepoint also changes web files (.html, .aspx) (GH)

       • Putio

         • Handle rate limit errors (Berkan Teber)

         • Fix multithread download and other ranged requests (rafma0)

       • S3

         • Add ChinaMobile EOS to provider list (GuoXingbin)

         • Sync providers in config description with providers (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Fix OpenSSH 8.8+ RSA keys incompatibility (KARBOWSKI Piotr)

         • Note that Scaleway C14 is deprecating SFTP in favor of S3 (Adrien Rey-Jarthon)

       • Storj

         • Fix bucket creation on Move (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Don’t override Referer if user sets it (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.58.0 - 2022-03-18
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.57.0...v1.58.0)

       • New backends

         • Akamai Netstorage (Nil Alexandrov)

         • Seagate Lyve (https://rclone.org/s3/#lyve), SeaweedFS, Storj, RackCorp via s3 backend

         • Storj  (https://rclone.org/storj/)  (renamed  from  Tardigrade - your old config files
           will continue working)

       • New commands

         • bisync (https://rclone.org/bisync/) -  experimental  bidirectional  cloud  sync  (Ivan
           Andreev, Chris Nelson)

       • New Features

         • build

           • Add windows/arm64 build (rclone mount not supported yet) (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Raise minimum go version to go1.15 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: Allow dot in remote names and improve config editing (albertony)

         • dedupe: Add quit as a choice in interactive mode (albertony)

         • dlna: Change icons to the newest ones.  (Alain Nussbaumer)

         • filter:  Add  {{  regexp  }}  syntax (https://rclone.org/filtering/#regexp) to pattern
           matches (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Add prometheus metrics for HTTP status code (Michał Matczuk)

         • hashsum: Support creating hash from data received on stdin (albertony)

         • librclone

           • Allow empty string or null input instead of empty json object (albertony)

           • Add support for mount commands (albertony)

         • operations: Add server-side moves to stats (Ole Frost)

         • rc: Allow user to disable authentication for web gui (negative0)

         • tree: Remove obsolete --human replaced by global --human-readable (albertony)

         • version: Report correct friendly-name for newer Windows 10/11 versions (albertony)

       • Bug Fixes

         • build

           • Fix ARM architecture version in .deb packages after nfpm change (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Hard fork github.com/jlaffaye/ftp  to  fix  go  get  github.com/rclone/rclone  (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

         • oauthutil: Fix crash when webbrowser requests /robots.txt (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations: Fix goroutine leak in case of copy retry (Ankur Gupta)

         • rc:

           • Fix operations/publiclink default for expires parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix missing computation of transferQueueSize when summing up statistics group (Carlo
             Mion)

           • Fix missing StatsInfo fields in the computation of the group sum (Carlo Mion)

         • sync: Fix --max-duration so it doesn’t retry  when  the  duration  is  exceeded  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • touch: Fix issue where a directory is created instead of a file (albertony)

       • Mount

         • Add --devname to set the device name sent to FUSE for mount display (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Add vfs/stats remote control to show statistics (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix failed to _ensure cache internal error: downloaders is nil error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix handling of special characters in file names (Bumsu Hyeon)

       • Local

         • Fix hash invalidation which caused errors with local crypt mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Add base64 and base32768 filename encoding options (Max Sum, Sinan Tan)

       • Azure Blob

         • Implement --azureblob-upload-concurrency parameter to speed uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove 100MB upper limit on chunk_size as it is no longer needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Raise --azureblob-upload-concurrency to 16 by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix crash with SAS URL and no container (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Compress

         • Fix crash if metadata upload failed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix memory leak (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Added --drive-copy-shortcut-content (Abhiraj)

         • Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • See  the  deprecation  note (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-
             flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

         • Add --drive-skip-dangling-shortcuts flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • When using a link type --drive-export-formats shows all doc types (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Speed up directory listings by specifying 1000 items in a chunk (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Save an API request when at the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Implemented About functionality (Gourav T)

       • FTP

         • Add --ftp-ask-password to prompt for password when needed (Borna Butkovic)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add missing regions (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • See the  deprecation  note  (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-
             flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

       • Googlephotos

         • Disable OAuth OOB flow (copy a token) due to Google deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • See  the  deprecation  note (https://developers.googleblog.com/2022/02/making-oauth-
             flows-safer.html#disallowed-oob).

       • Hasher

         • Fix crash on object not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Hdfs

         • Add file (Move) and directory move (DirMove) support (Andy Jackson)

       • HTTP

         • Improved recognition of URL pointing to a single file (albertony)

       • Jottacloud

         • Change API used by recursive list (ListR) (Kim)

         • Add support for Tele2 Cloud (Fredric Arklid)

       • Koofr

         • Add Digistorage service as a Koofr provider.  (jaKa)

       • Mailru

         • Fix int32 overflow on arm32 (Ivan Andreev)

       • Onedrive

         • Add config option for oauth scope Sites.Read.All (Charlie Jiang)

         • Minor optimization of quickxorhash (Isaac Levy)

         • Add --onedrive-root-folder-id flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Do not retry on 400 pathIsTooLong error (ctrl-q)

       • Pcloud

         • Add support for recursive list (ListR) (Niels van de Weem)

         • Fix pre-1970 time stamps (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Use ListObjectsV2 for faster listings (Felix Bünemann)

           • Fallback to ListObject v1 on unsupported providers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use the ETag on multipart transfers to verify the transfer was OK (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add --s3-use-multipart-etag provider quirk to disable this on unsupported  providers
             (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • New Providers

           • RackCorp object storage (bbabich)

           • Seagate Lyve Cloud storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • SeaweedFS (Chris Lu)

           • Storj Shared gateways (Márton Elek, Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add Wasabi AP Northeast 2 endpoint info (lindwurm)

         • Add GLACIER_IR storage class (Yunhai Luo)

         • Document Content-MD5 workaround for object-lock enabled buckets (Paulo Martins)

         • Fix multipart upload with --no-head flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Simplify content length processing in s3 with download url (Logeshwaran Murugesan)

       • SFTP

         • Add rclone to list of supported md5sum/sha1sum commands to look for (albertony)

         • Refactor so we only have one way of running remote commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix timeout on hashing large files by sending keepalives (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix unnecessary seeking when uploading and downloading files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update docs on how to create known_hosts file (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Storj

         • Rename tardigrade backend to storj backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement server side Move for files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update docs to explain differences between s3 and this backend (Elek, Márton)

       • Swift

         • Fix About so it shows info about the current container only (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Union

         • Fix treatment of remotes with // in (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix deadlock when one part of a multi-upload fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix eplus policy returned nil (Vitor Arruda)

       • Yandex

         • Add permanent deletion support (deinferno)

   v1.57.0 - 2021-11-01
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.0...v1.57.0)

       • New backends

         • Sia: for Sia decentralized cloud (Ian Levesque, Matthew Sevey, Ivan Andreev)

         • Hasher:  caches  hashes  and  enable hashes for backends that don’t support them (Ivan
           Andreev)

       • New commands

         • lsjson –stat: to get info about a single file/dir and operations/stat api (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • config paths: show configured paths (albertony)

       • New Features

         • about: Make human-readable output more consistent with other commands (albertony)

         • build

           • Use go1.17 for building and make go1.14 the minimum supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update Go to 1.16 and NDK to 22b for Android builds (x0b)

         • config

           • Support hyphen in remote name from environment variable (albertony)

           • Make temporary directory user-configurable (albertony)

           • Convert --cache-dir value to an absolute path (albertony)

           • Do not override MIME types from OS defaults (albertony)

         • docs

           • Toc styling and header levels cleanup (albertony)

           • Extend documentation on valid remote names (albertony)

           • Mention make for building and cmount tag for macos (Alex Chen)

           • ...and many more contributions to numerous to mention!

         • fs: Move with --ignore-existing will not delete skipped files (Nathan Collins)

         • hashsum

           • Treat hash values in sum file as case insensitive (Ivan Andreev)

           • Don’t put ERROR or UNSUPPORTED in output (Ivan Andreev)

         • lib/encoder: Add encoding of square brackets (Ivan Andreev)

         • lib/file:  Improve error message when attempting to create dir on nonexistent drive on
           windows (albertony)

         • lib/http: Factor password hash salt into options with default (Nolan Woods)

         • lib/kv: Add key-value database api (Ivan Andreev)

         • librclone

           • Add RcloneFreeString function (albertony)

           • Free strings in python example (albertony)

         • log: Optionally print pid in logs (Ivan Andreev)

         • ls: Introduce --human-readable global option to print human-readable sizes (albertony)

         • ncdu: Introduce key u to toggle human-readable (albertony)

         • operations: Add rmdirs -v output (Justin Winokur)

         • serve sftp

           • Generate an ECDSA server key as well as RSA (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Generate an Ed25519 server key as well as ECDSA and RSA (albertony)

         • serve docker

           • Allow to customize proxy settings of docker plugin (Ivan Andreev)

           • Build docker plugin for multiple platforms (Thomas Stachl)

         • size: Include human-readable count (albertony)

         • touch: Add support for touching files in directory, with recursive  option,  filtering
           and --dry-run/-i (albertony)

         • tree:  Option  to  print  human-readable  sizes  removed  in  favor  of  global option
           (albertony)

       • Bug Fixes

         • lib/http

           • Fix bad username check in single auth secret provider (Nolan Woods)

           • Fix handling of SSL credentials (Nolan Woods)

         • serve ftp: Ensure modtime is passed as UTC  always  to  fix  timezone  oddities  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • serve sftp: Fix generation of server keys on windows (albertony)

         • serve docker: Fix octal umask (Ivan Andreev)

       • Mount

         • Enable rclone to be run as mount helper direct from the fstab (Ivan Andreev)

         • Use procfs to validate mount on linux (Ivan Andreev)

         • Correctly daemonize for compatibility with automount (Ivan Andreev)

       • VFS

         • Ensure names used in cache path are legal on current OS (albertony)

         • Ignore  ECLOSED  when  truncating file handles to fix intermittent bad file descriptor
           error (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Refactor  default  OS  encoding  out  from  local  backend  into  shared  encoder  lib
           (albertony)

       • Crypt

         • Return wrapped object even with --crypt-no-data-encryption (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix uploads with --crypt-no-data-encryption (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Add --azureblob-no-head-object (Tatsuya Noyori)

       • Box

         • Make listings of heavily used directories more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • When doing cleanup delete as much as possible (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --box-list-chunk to control listing chunk size (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Delete items in parallel in cleanup using --checkers threads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --box-owned-by to only show items owned by the login passed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Retry operation_blocked_temporary errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Chunker

         • Md5all must create metadata if base hash is slow (Ivan Andreev)

       • Drive

         • Speed  up directory listings by constraining the API listing using the current filters
           (fotile96, Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix buffering for single request upload for files smaller  than  --drive-upload-cutoff
           (YenForYang)

         • Add  -o  config  option  to  backend drives to make config for all shared drives (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add --dropbox-batch-commit-timeout to control batch timeout (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Filefabric

         • Make backoff exponential for error_background to fix errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix directory move after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Enable tls session cache by default (Ivan Andreev)

         • Add option to disable tls13 (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix timeout after long uploads (Ivan Andreev)

         • Add support for precise time (Ivan Andreev)

         • Enable CI for ProFtpd, PureFtpd, VsFtpd (Ivan Andreev)

       • Googlephotos

         • Use encoder for album names to fix albums with control characters (Parth Shukla)

       • Jottacloud

         • Implement SetModTime to support modtime-only changes (albertony)

         • Improved error handling with SetModTime and corrupt files in general (albertony)

         • Add support for UserInfo (rclone config userinfo) feature (albertony)

         • Return direct download link from rclone link command (albertony)

       • Koofr

         • Create direct share link (Dmitry Bogatov)

       • Pcloud

         • Add sha256 support (Ken Enrique Morel)

       • Premiumizeme

         • Fix directory listing after API changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix server side move after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix server side directory move after API changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Add support to use CDN URL to download the file (Logeshwaran)

         • Add AWS Snowball Edge to providers examples (r0kk3rz)

         • Use a combination of SDK retries and rclone retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix IAM Role for Service Account not working and other auth problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix shared_credentials_file auth after reverting incorrect fix (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix corrupted on transfer: sizes differ 0 vs xxxx with Ceph (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Seafile

         • Fix error when not configured for 2fa (Fred)

       • SFTP

         • Fix timeout when doing MD5SUM of large file (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Update OCI URL (David Liu)

         • Document OVH Cloud Archive (HNGamingUK)

       • Union

         • Fix rename not working with union of local disk and bucket based remote  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

   v1.56.2 - 2021-10-01
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.1...v1.56.2)

       • Bug Fixes

         • serve http: Re-add missing auth to http service (Nolan Woods)

         • build:  Update golang.org/x/sys to fix crash on macOS when compiled with go1.17 (Herby
           Gillot)

       • FTP

         • Fix deadlock after failed update when concurrency=1 (Ivan Andreev)

   v1.56.1 - 2021-09-19
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.56.0...v1.56.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix maximum bwlimit by scaling scale max token bucket  size  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • rc: Fix speed does not update in core/stats (negative0)

         • selfupdate: Fix --quiet option, not quite quiet (yedamo)

         • serve http: Fix serve http exiting directly after starting (Cnly)

         • build

           • Apply gofmt from golang 1.17 (Ivan Andreev)

           • Update Go to 1.16 and NDK to 22b for android/any (x0b)

       • Mount

         • Fix --daemon mode (Ivan Andreev)

       • VFS

         • Fix duplicates on rename (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix crash when truncating a just uploaded object (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix issue where empty dirs would build up in cache meta dir (albertony)

       • Drive

         • Fix instructions for auto config (Greg Sadetsky)

         • Fix lsf example without drive-impersonate (Greg Sadetsky)

       • Onedrive

         • Handle HTTP 400 better in PublicLink (Alex Chen)

         • Clarification of the process for creating custom client_id (Mariano Absatz)

       • Pcloud

         • Return an early error when Put is called with an unknown size (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Try harder to delete a failed upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Add Wasabi’s AP-Northeast endpoint info (hota)

         • Fix typo in s3 documentation (Greg Sadetsky)

       • Seafile

         • Fix 2fa config state machine (Fred)

       • SFTP

         • Remove spurious error message on --sftp-disable-concurrent-reads (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Sugarsync

         • Fix initial connection after config re-arrangement (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.56.0 - 2021-07-20
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.55.0...v1.56.0)

       • New backends

         • Uptobox (https://rclone.org/uptobox/) (buengese)

       • New commands

         • serve docker (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_serve_docker/) (Antoine GIRARD) (Ivan
           Andreev)

           • and accompanying docker volume plugin (https://rclone.org/docker/)

         • checksum (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_checksum/) to check files against a  file
           of checksums (Ivan Andreev)

           • this is also available as rclone md5sum -C etc

         • config  touch (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_touch/): ensure config exists
           at configured location (albertony)

         • test changenotify (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test_changenotify/): command  to
           help debugging changenotify (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Deprecations

         • dbhashsum: Remove command deprecated a year ago (Ivan Andreev)

         • cache: Deprecate cache backend (Ivan Andreev)

       • New Features

         • rework config system so it can be used non-interactively via cli and rc API.

           • See docs in config create (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_config_create/)

           • This  is  a very big change to all the backends so may cause breakages - please file
             bugs!

         • librclone - export the rclone RC as a C library (lewisxy) (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Link a C-API rclone shared object into your project

           • Use the RC as an in memory interface

           • Python example supplied

           • Also supports Android and gomobile

         • fs

           • Add --disable-http2 for global http2 disable (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make --dump imply -vv (Alex Chen)

           • Use binary prefixes for size and rate units (albertony)

           • Use decimal prefixes for counts (albertony)

           • Add google search widget to rclone.org (Ivan Andreev)

         • accounting: Calculate rolling average speed (Haochen Tong)

         • atexit: Terminate with non-zero status after receiving signal (Michael Hanselmann)

         • build

           • Only run event-based  workflow  scripts  under  rclone  repo  with  manual  override
             (Mathieu Carbou)

           • Add Android build with gomobile (x0b)

         • check: Log the hash in use like cryptcheck does (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • version: Print os/version, kernel and bitness (Ivan Andreev)

         • config

           • Prevent use of Windows reserved names in config file name (albertony)

           • Create config file in windows appdata directory by default (albertony)

           • Treat any config file paths with filename notfound as memory-only config (albertony)

           • Delay load config file (albertony)

           • Replace defaultConfig with a thread-safe in-memory implementation (Chris Macklin)

           • Allow config create and friends to take key=value parameters (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fixed issues with flags/options set by environment vars.  (Ole Frost)

         • fshttp: Implement graceful DSCP error handling (Tyson Moore)

         • lib/http  -  provides  an abstraction for a central http server that services can bind
           routes to (Nolan Woods)

           • Add --template config and flags to serve/data (Nolan Woods)

           • Add default 404 handler (Nolan Woods)

         • link: Use “off” value for unset expiry (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • oauthutil: Raise fatal error if token expired without refresh token (Alex Chen)

         • rcat: Add --size flag for more efficient uploads of known size (Nazar Mishturak)

         • serve sftp: Add --stdio flag to serve via stdio (Tom)

         • sync: Don’t warn about --no-traverse when --files-from is set (Nick Gaya)

         • test makefiles

           • Add --seed flag and make data generated repeatable (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add log levels and speed summary (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix startTime of statsGroups.sum (Haochen Tong)

         • cmd/ncdu: Fix out of range panic in delete (buengese)

         • config

           • Fix issues with memory-only config file paths (albertony)

           • Fix in memory config not saving on the fly backend config (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Fix address parsing for DSCP (Tyson Moore)

         • ncdu: Update termbox-go library to fix crash (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • oauthutil: Fix old authorize result not recognised (Cnly)

         • operations: Don’t update timestamps of files in --compare-dest (Nick Gaya)

         • selfupdate: fix archive name on macos (Ivan Andreev)

       • Mount

         • Refactor before adding serve docker (Antoine GIRARD)

       • VFS

         • Add cache reset for --vfs-cache-max-size handling at cache poll interval (Leo Luan)

         • Fix modtime changing when reading file into cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Avoid unnecessary subdir in cache path (albertony)

         • Fix that umask option cannot be set as environment variable (albertony)

         • Do not print notice about missing poll-interval support when set to 0 (albertony)

       • Local

         • Always use readlink to read symlink size for better compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --local-unicode-normalization (and remove --local-no-unicode-normalization)  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Skip entries removed concurrently with List() (Ivan Andreev)

       • Crypt

         • Support timestamped filenames from --b2-versions (Dominik Mydlil)

       • B2

         • Don’t include the bucket name in public link file prefixes (Jeffrey Tolar)

         • Fix versions and .files with no extension (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Factor version handling into lib/version (Dominik Mydlil)

       • Box

         • Use upload preflight check to avoid listings in file uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Return errors instead of calling log.Fatal with them (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Switch to the Drives API for looking up shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix some google docs being treated as files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add --dropbox-batch-mode flag to speed up uploading (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Read the batch mode (https://rclone.org/dropbox/#batch-mode) docs for more info

         • Set visibility in link sharing when --expire is set (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Simplify chunked uploads (Alexey Ivanov)

         • Improve “own App IP” instructions (Ivan Andreev)

       • Fichier

         • Check if more than one upload link is returned (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Support downloading password protected files and folders (Florian Penzkofer)

         • Make error messages report text from the API (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix move of files in the same directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Check that we actually got a download token and retry if we didn’t (buengese)

       • Filefabric

         • Fix listing after change of from field from “int” to int.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Make upload error 250 indicate success (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • GCS

         • Make compatible with gsutil’s mtime metadata (database64128)

         • Clean up time format constants (database64128)

       • Google Photos

         • Fix read only scope not being used properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • HTTP

         • Replace httplib with lib/http (Nolan Woods)

         • Clean up Bind to better use middleware (Nolan Woods)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix legacy auth with state based config system (buengese)

         • Fix invalid url in output from link command (albertony)

         • Add no versions option (buengese)

       • Onedrive

         • Add list_chunk option (Nick Gaya)

         • Also report root error if unable to cancel multipart upload (Cnly)

         • Fix failed to configure: empty token found error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make link return direct download link (Xuanchen Wu)

       • S3

         • Add --s3-no-head-object (Tatsuya Noyori)

         • Remove WebIdentityRoleProvider to fix crash on auth (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t check to see if remote is object if it ends with / (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add SeaweedFS (Chris Lu)

         • Update Alibaba OSS endpoints (Chuan Zh)

       • SFTP

         • Fix performance regression by re-enabling concurrent writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Expand tilde and environment variables in configured known_hosts_file (albertony)

       • Tardigrade

         • Upgrade to uplink v1.4.6 (Caleb Case)

         • Use negative offset (Caleb Case)

         • Add warning about too many open files (acsfer)

       • WebDAV

         • Fix sharepoint auth over http (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add headers option (Antoon Prins)

   v1.55.1 - 2021-04-26
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.55.0...v1.55.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • selfupdate

           • Dont detect FUSE if build is static (Ivan Andreev)

           • Add build tag noselfupdate (Ivan Andreev)

         • sync: Fix incorrect error reported by graceful cutoff (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • install.sh: fix macOS arm64 download (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build: Fix version numbers in android branch builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs

           • Contributing.md: update setup instructions for go1.16 (Nick Gaya)

           • WinFsp 2021 is out of beta (albertony)

           • Minor cleanup of space around code section (albertony)

           • Fixed some typos (albertony)

       • VFS

         • Fix  a  code path which allows dirty data to be removed causing data loss (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • Compress

         • Fix compressed name regexp (buengese)

       • Drive

         • Fix backend copyid of google doc to directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t open browser when service account...  (Ansh Mittal)

       • Dropbox

         • Add missing team_data.member scope for use with –impersonate (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix About after scopes changes - rclone config reconnect needed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix Unable to decrypt returned paths from changeNotify (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Fix implicit TLS (Ivan Andreev)

       • Onedrive

         • Work around for random “Unable to initialize RPS” errors (OleFrost)

       • SFTP

         • Revert sftp library to v1.12.0 from v1.13.0 to fix performance regression (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix Update ReadFrom failed: failed to send packet: EOF errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Zoho

         • Fix error when region isn’t set (buengese)

         • Do not ask for mountpoint twice when using headless setup (buengese)

   v1.55.0 - 2021-03-31
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.54.0...v1.55.0)

       • New commands

         • selfupdate (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_selfupdate/) (Ivan Andreev)

           • Allows rclone to update itself in-place or via a package (using --package flag)

           • Reads cryptographically signed signatures for non beta releases

           • Works on all OSes.

         • test  (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_test/)  - these are test commands - use with
           care!

           • histogram - Makes a histogram of file name characters.

           • info - Discovers file name or other limitations for paths.

           • makefiles - Make a random file hierarchy for testing.

           • memory - Load all the objects at remote:path into memory and report memory stats.

       • New Features

         • Connection strings (https://rclone.org/docs/#connection-strings)

           • Config parameters can now be passed as part of  the  remote  name  as  a  connection
             string.

           • For    example,    to    do    the    equivalent   of   --drive-shared-with-me   use
             drive,shared_with_me:

           • Make sure we don’t save on the fly remote config to the  config  file  (Nick  Craig-
             Wood)

           • Make  sure  backends  with additional config have a different name for caching (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • This   work   was   sponsored   by   CERN,   through   the   CS3MESH4EOSC    Project
             (https://cs3mesh4eosc.eu/).

             • CS3MESH4EOSC has received funding from the European Union’s Horizon 2020

             • research and innovation programme under Grant Agreement no.  863353.

         • build

           • Update  go  build  version  to  go1.16  and raise minimum go version to go1.13 (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Make a macOS ARM64 build to support Apple Silicon (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Install macfuse 4.x instead of osxfuse 3.x (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Use GO386=softfloat instead of deprecated GO386=387 for 386 builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Disable IOS builds for the time being (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Androids builds made with up to date NDK (x0b)

           • Add an rclone user to the Docker image but don’t use it by default (cynthia kwok)

         • dedupe: Make largest directory primary to minimize data moved (Saksham Khanna)

         • config

           • Wrap config library in an interface (Fionera)

           • Make config file system pluggable (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • --config "" or "/notfound" for in memory config only (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Clear fs cache of stale entries when altering config (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copyurl: Add option to print resulting auto-filename (albertony)

         • delete: Make --rmdirs obey the filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs - many fixes and reworks from edwardxml, albertony, pvalls,  Ivan  Andreev,  Evan
           Harris, buengese, Alexey Tabakman

         • encoder/filename - add SCSU as tables (Klaus Post)

         • Add multiple paths support to --compare-dest and --copy-dest flag (K265)

         • filter: Make --exclude "dir/" equivalent to --exclude "dir/**" (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Add DSCP support with --dscp for QoS with differentiated services (Max Sum)

         • lib/cache: Add Delete and DeletePrefix methods (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lib/file

           • Make pre-allocate detect disk full errors and return them (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Don’t run preallocate concurrently (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Retry preallocate on EINTR (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations: Made copy and sync operations obey a RetryAfterError (Ankur Gupta)

         • rc

           • Add string alternatives for setting options over the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add options/local to see the options configured in the context (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add _config parameter to set global config for just this rc call (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implement passing filter config with _filter parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add fscache/clear and fscache/entries to control the fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Avoid +Inf value for speed in core/stats (albertony)

           • Add a full set of stats to core/stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Allow fs= params to be a JSON blob (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rcd: Added systemd notification during the rclone rcd command.  (Naveen Honest Raj)

         • rmdirs: Make --rmdirs obey the filters (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • version: Show build tags and type of executable (Ivan Andreev)

       • Bug Fixes

         • install.sh: make it fail on download errors (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix excessive retries missing --max-duration timeout (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix crash when --low-level-retries=0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix failed token refresh on mounts created via the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Fix bandwidth limiting after bad merge (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lib/atexit

           • Unregister  interrupt  handler  once it has fired so users can interrupt again (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Fix occasional failure to unmount with CTRL-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix deadlock calling Finalise while Run is running (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lib/rest: Fix multipart uploads not stopping on context cancel (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Allow mounting to root directory on windows (albertony)

         • Improved handling of relative paths on windows (albertony)

         • Fix unicode issues with accented characters on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Docs: document the new FileSecurity option in WinFsp 2021 (albertony)

         • Docs: add note about volume path syntax on windows (albertony)

         • Fix caching of old directories after renaming them (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update cgofuse to the latest version to bring in macfuse 4 fix (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • --vfs-used-is-size to report used space using recursive scan (tYYGH)

         • Don’t set modification time if it was already correct (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix Create causing windows explorer to truncate files on CTRL-C  CTRL-V  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix modtimes not updating when writing via cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix modtimes changing by fractional seconds after upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix modtime set if --vfs-cache-mode writes/full and no write (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Rename files in cache and cancel uploads on directory rename (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix directory renaming by renaming dirs cached in memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Add flag --local-no-preallocate (David Sze)

         • Make nounc an advanced option except on Windows (albertony)

         • Don’t ignore preallocate disk full errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Add --fs-cache-expire-duration to control the fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Add option to not encrypt data (Vesnyx)

         • Log hash ok on upload (albertony)

       • Azure Blob

         • Add container public access level support.  (Manish Kumar)

       • B2

         • Fix HTML files downloaded via cloudflare (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Box

         • Fix transfers getting stuck on token expiry after API change (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Chunker

         • Partially implement no-rename transactions (Maxwell Calman)

       • Drive

         • Don’t stop server side copy if couldn’t read description (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Pass context on to drive SDK - to help with cancellation (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add polling for changes support (Robert Thomas)

         • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Raise priority of rate limited message to INFO to make it more noticeable (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Implement copy & move (buengese)

         • Implement public link (buengese)

       • FTP

         • Implement Shutdown method (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Close idle connections after --ftp-idle-timeout (1m by default) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --ftp-close-timeout flag for use with awkward ftp servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Retry connections and logins on 421 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Hdfs

         • Fix permissions for when directory is created (Lucas Messenger)

       • Onedrive

         • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix --s3-profile which wasn’t working (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Close idle connections after --sftp-idle-timeout (1m by default) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix “file not found” errors for read once servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix SetModTime stat failed:  object  not  found  with  --sftp-set-modtime=false  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Update github.com/ncw/swift to v2.0.0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement copying large objects (nguyenhuuluan434)

       • Union

         • Fix crash when using epff policy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix union attempting to update files on a read only file system (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Refactor to use fspath.SplitFs instead of fs.ParseRemote (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix initialisation broken in refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Add support for sharepoint with NTLM authentication (Rauno Ots)

         • Make sharepoint-ntlm docs more consistent (Alex Chen)

         • Improve terminology in sharepoint-ntlm docs (Ivan Andreev)

         • Disable HTTP/2 for NTLM authentication (georne)

         • Fix sharepoint-ntlm error 401 for parallel actions (Ivan Andreev)

         • Check that purged directory really exists (Ivan Andreev)

       • Yandex

         • Make --timeout 0 work properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Zoho

         • Replace client id - you will need to rclone config reconnect after this (buengese)

         • Add  forgotten  setupRegion()  to  NewFs  -  this  finally fixes regions other than EU
           (buengese)

   v1.54.1 - 2021-03-08
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.54.0...v1.54.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix –bwlimit when up or down is off (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs

           • Fix nesting of brackets and backticks in ftp docs (edwardxml)

           • Fix broken link in sftp page (edwardxml)

           • Fix typo in crypt.md (Romeo Kienzler)

           • Changelog: Correct link to digitalis.io (Alex JOST)

           • Replace #file-caching with #vfs-file-caching (Miron Veryanskiy)

           • Convert bogus example link to code (edwardxml)

           • Remove dead link from rc.md (edwardxml)

         • rc: Sync,copy,move: document createEmptySrcDirs parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson: Fix unterminated JSON in the presence of errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Fix mount dropping on macOS by setting –daemon-timeout 10m (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Document simultaneous usage with the same cache shouldn’t be used (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Automatically raise upload cutoff to avoid spurious error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix failed to create file system with application key limited to a prefix (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • Drive

         • Refer to Shared Drives instead of Team Drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add scopes to oauth request and optionally “members.read” (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix  failed  to  create  file system with folder level permissions policy (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix Wasabi HEAD requests returning stale data by using only 1 transport  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix shared_credentials_file auth (Dmitry Chepurovskiy)

         • Add –s3-no-head to reducing costs docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Union

         • Fix mkdir at root with remote:/ (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Zoho

         • Fix custom client id’s (buengese)

   v1.54.0 - 2021-02-02
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.0...v1.54.0)

       • New backends

         • Compression remote (experimental) (buengese)

         • Enterprise File Fabric (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • This work was sponsored by Storage Made Easy (https://storagemadeeasy.com/)

         • HDFS (Hadoop Distributed File System) (Yury Stankevich)

         • Zoho workdrive (buengese)

       • New Features

         • Deglobalise the config (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Global config now read from the context

           • This will enable passing of global config via the rc

           • This work was sponsored by Digitalis (https://digitalis.io/)

         • Add --bwlimit for upload and download (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Obey bwlimit in http Transport for better limiting

         • Enhance systemd integration (Hekmon)

           • log  level  identification,  manual  activation  with flag, automatic systemd launch
             detection

           • Don’t compile systemd log integration for non unix systems (Benjamin Gustin)

         • Add a --download flag to md5sum/sha1sum/hashsum to force rclone to download  and  hash
           files locally (lostheli)

         • Add --progress-terminal-title to print ETA to terminal title (LaSombra)

         • Make backend env vars show in help as the defaults for backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Raise minimum go version to go1.12 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dedupe

           • Add --by-hash to dedupe on content hash not file name (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add --dedupe-mode list to just list dupes, changing nothing (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add warning if used on a remote which can’t have duplicate names (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fs

           • Add Shutdown optional method for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • When using --files-from check files concurrently (zhucan)

           • Accumulate stats when using --dry-run (Ingo Weiss)

           • Always show stats when using --dry-run or --interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add support for flag --no-console on windows to hide the console window (albertony)

         • genautocomplete: Add support to output to stdout (Ingo)

         • ncdu

           • Highlight read errors instead of aborting (Claudio Bantaloukas)

           • Add sort by average size in directory (Adam Plánský)

           • Add toggle option for average s3ize in directory - key `a' (Adam Plánský)

           • Add empty folder flag into ncdu browser (Adam Plánský)

           • Add ! (error) and . (unreadable) file flags to go with e (empty) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • obscure: Make rclone obscure - ignore newline at end of line (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations

           • Add logs when need to upload files to set mod times (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Move and copy log name of the destination object in verbose (Adam Plánský)

           • Add size if known to skipped items and JSON log (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Prefer actual listener address if using “:port” or “addr:0” only (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add listener for finished jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • serve ftp: Add options to enable TLS (Deepak Sah)

         • serve http/webdav: Redirect requests to the base url without the / (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve restic: Implement object cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • stats: Add counter for deleted directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • sync: Only print “There was nothing to transfer” if no errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • webui

           • Prompt user for updating webui if an update is available (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Fix plugins initialization (negative0)

       • Bug Fixes

         • fs

           • Fix nil pointer on copy & move operations directly to remote (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

           • Fix parsing of ..  when joining remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • log: Fix enabling systemd logging when using --log-file (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • check

           • Make the error count match up in the log message (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • move: Fix data loss when source and destination are the same object (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations

           • Fix --cutoff-mode hard not cutting off immediately (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix --immutable error message (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • sync

           • Fix  --cutoff-mode soft & cautious so it doesn’t end the transfer early (Nick Craig-
             Wood)

           • Fix --immutable errors retrying many times (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Docs

         • Many fixes and a rewrite of the filtering docs (edwardxml)

         • Many spelling and grammar fixes (Josh Soref)

         • Doc fixes for commands delete, purge, rmdir, rmdirs and mount (albertony)

         • And thanks to these people for many doc fixes too numerous to list

           • Ameer Dawood, Antoine GIRARD, Bob Bagwill, Christopher Stewart

           • CokeMine, David, Dov Murik, Durval Menezes, Evan Harris, gtorelly

           • Ilyess Bachiri, Janne Johansson, Kerry Su, Marcin Zelent,

           • Martin Michlmayr, Milly, Sơn Trần-Nguyễn

       • Mount

         • Update systemd status with cache stats (Hekmon)

         • Disable bazil/fuse based mount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make rclone mount actually run rclone cmount under macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement mknod to make NFS file creation work (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make sure we don’t call umount more than once (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • More user friendly mounting as network drive on windows (albertony)

         • Detect if uid or gid are set in same option string: -o uid=123,gid=456 (albertony)

         • Don’t attempt to unmount if fs has been destroyed already (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Fix virtual entries causing deleted files to still appear (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix “file already exists” error for stale cache files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix file leaks with --vfs-cache-mode full and --buffer-size 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix invalid cache path on windows when using :backend: as remote (albertony)

       • Local

         • Continue listing files/folders when a circular symlink is detected (Manish Gupta)

         • New flag --local-zero-size-links to fix sync on  some  virtual  filesystems  (Riccardo
           Iaconelli)

       • Azure Blob

         • Add support for service principals (James Lim)

         • Add support for managed identities (Brad Ackerman)

         • Add examples for access tier (Bob Pusateri)

         • Utilize the streaming capabilities from the SDK for multipart uploads (Denis Neuling)

         • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix crash when listing outside a SAS URL’s root (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Delete  archive  tier  blobs  before  update  if --azureblob-archive-tier-delete (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Fix crash on startup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix memory usage by upgrading the SDK to v0.13.0 and  implementing  a  TransferManager
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Require go1.14+ to compile due to SDK changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Make NewObject use less expensive API calls (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • This will improve --files-from and restic serve in particular

         • Fixed crash on an empty file name (lluuaapp)

       • Box

         • Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Chunker

         • Skip long local hashing, hash in-transit (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

         • Set Features ReadMimeType to false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix case-insensitive NewObject, test metadata detection (Ivan Andreev)

       • Drive

         • Implement rclone backend copyid command for copying files by ID (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added flag --drive-stop-on-download-limit to stop transfers when the download limit is
           exceeded (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

         • Implement CleanUp workaround for team drives (buengese)

         • Allow shortcut resolution and creation to be retried (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Log that emptying the trash can take some time (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add xdg office icons to xdg desktop files (Pau Rodriguez-Estivill)

       • Dropbox

         • Add support for viewing shared files and folders (buengese)

         • Enable short lived access tokens (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement IDer on Objects so rclone lsf etc can read the IDs (buengese)

         • Set Features ReadMimeType to false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make malformed_path errors from too long files not retriable (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Test file name length before upload to fix upload loop (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Set Features ReadMimeType to true as Object.MimeType is supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Add --ftp-disable-msld option to ignore MLSD for really old servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Storage class object header support (Laurens Janssen)

         • Fix anonymous client to use rclone’s HTTP client (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix Entry doesn't belong in directory "" (same as directory) - ignoring  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

       • Googlephotos

         • New flag --gphotos-include-archived to show archived photos as well (Nicolas Rueff)

       • Jottacloud

         • Don’t erroneously report support for writing mime types (buengese)

         • Add support for Telia Cloud (Patrik Nordlén)

       • Mailru

         • Accept special folders eg camera-upload (Ivan Andreev)

         • Avoid prehashing of large local files (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix range requests after June 2020 changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

         • Remove deprecated protocol quirks (Ivan Andreev)

       • Memory

         • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Add  support  for  China  region  operated  by  21vianet  and other regional suppliers
           (NyaMisty)

         • Warn on gateway timeout errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fall back to normal copy if server-side copy unavailable (Alex Chen)

         • Fix server-side copy completely disabled on OneDrive for Business (Cnly)

         • (business only) workaround to replace existing file on server-side copy (Alex Chen)

         • Enhance link creation with expiry, scope, type and password (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove % and # from the set of encoded characters (Alex Chen)

         • Support addressing site by server-relative URL (kice)

       • Opendrive

         • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Pcloud

         • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Premiumizeme

         • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Qingstor

         • Fix error propagation in CleanUp (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Added --s3-disable-http2 to disable http/2 (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

         • Complete SSE-C implementation (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix hashes on small files with AWS:KMS and SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add MD5 metadata to objects uploaded with SSE-AWS/SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-no-head parameter to minimise transactions on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update docs with a Reducing Costs section (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added error handling for error code 429 indicating  too  many  requests  (Anagh  Kumar
           Baranwal)

         • Add requester pays option (kelv)

         • Fix copy multipart with v2 auth failing with `SignatureDoesNotMatch' (Louis Koo)

       • SFTP

         • Allow cert based auth via optional pubkey (Stephen Harris)

         • Allow user to optionally check server hosts key to add security (Stephen Harris)

         • Defer asking for user passwords until the SSH connection succeeds (Stephen Harris)

         • Remember entered password in AskPass mode (Stephen Harris)

         • Implement Shutdown method (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement keyboard interactive authentication (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement --sftp-use-fstat for unusual SFTP servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Sugarsync

         • Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Fix deletion of parts of Static Large Object (SLO) (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

         • Ensure partially uploaded large files are uploaded unless --swift-leave-parts-on-error
           (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

       • Tardigrade

         • Upgrade to uplink v1.4.1 (Caleb Case)

       • WebDAV

         • Updated docs to show streaming to nextcloud is working (Durval Menezes)

       • Yandex

         • Set Features WriteMimeType to false as Yandex ignores mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.53.4 - 2021-01-20
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.3...v1.53.4)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix data race in Transferred() (Maciej Zimnoch)

         • build

           • Stop tagged releases making a current beta (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Upgrade docker buildx action (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

           • Add -buildmode to cross-compile.go (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix docker build by upgrading ilteoood/docker_buildx (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Revert GitHub actions brew fix since this is now fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix brew install –cask syntax for macOS build (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update nfpm syntax to fix build of .deb/.rpm packages (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix for Windows build errors (Ivan Andreev)

         • fs: Parseduration: fixed tests to use UTC time (Ankur Gupta)

         • fshttp: Prevent overlap of HTTP headers in logs (Nathan Collins)

         • rc

           • Fix core/command giving 500 internal error (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add Copy method to rc.Params (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix 500 error when marshalling errors from core/command (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • plugins: Create plugins files only if webui is enabled.  (negative0)

         • serve http: Fix serving files of unknown length (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve sftp: Fix authentication on one connection blocking others (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Add optional brew tag to throw an error when using mount in the binaries installed via
           Homebrew (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

         • Add “.” and “..” to directories to match cmount and expectations (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Make cache dir absolute before using it to fix path too long errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Chunker

         • Improve detection of incompatible metadata (Ivan Andreev)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix server side copy of large objects (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix token renewer to fix long uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix token refresh failed: is not a regular file error (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Pcloud

         • Only use SHA1 hashes in EU region (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Sharefile

         • Undo Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Fix Open Range requests to fix 4shared mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add “Depth: 0” to GET requests to fix bitrix (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.53.3 - 2020-11-19
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.2...v1.53.3)

       • Bug Fixes

         • random:  Fix  incorrect  use  of math/rand instead of crypto/rand CVE-2020-28924 (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

           • Passwords you have generated with rclone config may be insecure

           • See issue #4783 (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4783) for more details  and
             a checking tool

         • random: Seed math/rand in one place with crypto strong seed (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Fix vfs/refresh calls with fs= parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Sharefile

         • Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.53.2 - 2020-10-26
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.1...v1.53.2)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Fix incorrect speed and transferTime in core/stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Stabilize display order of transfers on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations

           • Fix use of –suffix without –backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix  spurious  “–checksum is in use but the source and destination have no hashes in
             common” (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Work around GitHub actions brew problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Stop using set-env and set-path in the GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • mount2: Fix the swapped UID / GID values (Russell Cattelan)

       • VFS

         • Detect and recover from a file being removed externally from the  cache  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix a deadlock vulnerability in downloaders.Close (Leo Luan)

         • Fix a race condition in retryFailedResets (Leo Luan)

         • Fix missed concurrency control between some item operations and reset (Leo Luan)

         • Add exponential backoff during ENOSPC retries (Leo Luan)

         • Add a missed update of used cache space (Leo Luan)

         • Fix –no-modtime to not attempt to set modtimes (as documented) (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Fix sizes and syncing with –links option on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Chunker

         • Disable ListR to fix missing files on GDrive (workaround) (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix upload over crypt (Ivan Andreev)

       • Fichier

         • Increase maximum file size from 100GB to 300GB (gyutw)

       • Jottacloud

         • Remove   clientSecret  from  config  when  upgrading  to  token  based  authentication
           (buengese)

         • Avoid double url escaping of device/mountpoint (albertony)

         • Remove DirMove workaround as it’s not required anymore - also (buengese)

       • Mailru

         • Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix range requests after june changes on server (Ivan Andreev)

         • Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)

       • Onedrive

         • Fix disk usage for sharepoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Add missing regions for AWS (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

       • Seafile

         • Fix accessing libraries > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Muffin King)

       • SFTP

         • Always convert the checksum to lower case (buengese)

       • Union

         • Create root directories if none exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.53.1 - 2020-09-13
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.53.0...v1.53.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Remove new line from end of –stats-one-line display (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • check

           • Add back missing –download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs

           • Note –log-file does append (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add full stops for consistency in rclone –help (edwardxml)

           • Add Tencent COS to s3 provider list (wjielai)

           • Updated mount command to reflect that it requires Go 1.13 or newer (Evan Harris)

           • jottacloud: Mention that uploads from local disk will not need  to  cache  files  to
             disk for md5 calculation (albertony)

           • Fix formatting of rc docs page (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Include vendor tar ball in release and fix startdev (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix “Illegal instruction” error for ARMv6 builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix architecture name in ARMv7 build (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Fix spurious error “vfs cache: failed to _ensure cache EOF” (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Re-adds special oauth help text (Tim Gallant)

       • Opendrive

         • Do not retry 400 errors (Evan Harris)

   v1.53.0 - 2020-09-02
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.0...v1.53.0)

       • New Features

         • The  VFS layer (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#vfs-virtual-file-system) was
           heavily reworked for this release - see below for more details

         • Interactive   mode    -i/–interactive    (https://rclone.org/docs/#interactive)    for
           destructive operations (fishbullet)

         • Add –bwlimit-file (https://rclone.org/docs/#bwlimit-file-bandwidth-spec) flag to limit
           speeds of individual file transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Transfers are sorted by start time in the stats and progress output (Max Sum)

         • Make sure backends expand ~ and environment vars in file names they use  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add  –refresh-times  (https://rclone.org/docs/#refresh-times)  flag to set modtimes on
           hashless backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Remove vendor directory in favour of Go modules (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Build with go1.15.x by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Drop macOS 386 build as it is no longer supported by go1.15 (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add ARMv7 to the supported builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Enable rclone cmount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make rclone build with gccgo (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make rclone build with wasm (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Change beta numbering to be semver compatible (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add file properties and icon to Windows executable (albertony)

           • Add experimental interface for integrating rclone into browsers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lib: Add file name compression (Klaus Post)

         • rc

           • Allow installation and use of plugins and test plugins with rclone-webui  (Chaitanya
             Bankanhal)

           • Add reverse proxy pluginsHandler for serving plugins (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Add mount/listmounts option for listing current mounts (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Add operations/uploadfile to upload a file through rc using encoding multipart/form-
             data (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Add core/command to execute rclone terminal commands.  (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

         • rclone check

           • Add reporting of filenames for same/missing/changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make check command obey --dry-run/-i/--interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make check do --checkers files concurrently (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Retry downloads if they fail when using the --download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make it show stats by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone obscure: Allow obscure command to accept password on STDIN (David Ibarra)

         • rclone config

           • Set RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR for use in config files and subprocesses (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Reject remote names starting with a dash.  (jtagcat)

         • rclone cryptcheck: Add reporting of filenames for  same/missing/changed  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • rclone  dedupe: Make it obey the --size-only flag for duplicate detection (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • rclone link: Add --expire and --unlink flags (Roman Kredentser)

         • rclone mkdir: Warn when using mkdir on remotes  which  can’t  have  empty  directories
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone rc: Allow JSON parameters to simplify command line usage (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone serve ftp

           • Don’t compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add error message if auth proxy fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Use refactored goftp.io/server library for binary shrink (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone  serve  restic:  Expose interfaces so that rclone can be used as a library from
           within restic (Jack)

         • rclone sync: Add --track-renames-strategy leaf (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone touch: Add ability to set nanosecond resolution times (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone tree: Remove -i shorthand for --noindent as it conflicts with  -i/--interactive
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Fix documentation for speed/speedAvg (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix elapsed time not show actual time since beginning (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Fix deadlock in stats printing (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Fix file handle leak in GitHub release tool (Garrett Squire)

         • rclone check: Fix successful retries with --download counting errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rclone dedupe: Fix logging to be easier to understand (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Warn macOS users that mount implementation is changing (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • to test the new implementation use rclone cmount instead of rclone mount

           • this is because the library rclone uses has dropped macOS support

         • rc interface

           • Add call for unmount all (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Make mount/mount remote control take vfsOpt option (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add mountOpt to mount/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add VFS and Mount options to mount/listmounts (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Catch panics in cgofuse initialization and turn into error messages (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Always supply stat information in Readdir (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add  support  for  reading unknown length files using direct IO (Windows) (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix On Windows don’t add -o uid/gid=-1 if user supplies -o uid/gid.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix macOS losing directory contents in cmount (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix volume name broken in recent refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Implement partial reads for --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --vfs-writeback option to delay writes back to cloud storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --vfs-read-ahead parameter for use with --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Restart pending uploads on restart of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Support synchronous cache space recovery upon ENOSPC (Leo Luan)

         • Allow ReadAt and WriteAt to run concurrently with themselves (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Change modtime of file before upload to current (Rob Calistri)

         • Recommend --vfs-cache-modes writes on backends which can’t stream (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add an optional fs parameter to vfs rc methods (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix errors when using > 260 char files in the cache in Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix renaming of items while they are being uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix very high load caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix renamed files not being uploaded with --vfs-cache-mode minimal (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix directory locking caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix saving from chrome without --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Add --local-no-updated to provide a consistent view of changing objects  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add --local-no-set-modtime option to prevent modtime changes (tyhuber1)

         • Fix race conditions updating and reading Object metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix dedupe on caches wrapping drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Add --crypt-server-side-across-configs flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Alias

         • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Don’t compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Implement server-side copy for files > 5GB (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Note that b2’s encoding now allows  but rclone’s hasn’t changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix transfers when using download_url (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Box

         • Implement rclone cleanup (buengese)

         • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Allow authentication with access token (David)

       • Chunker

         • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Add rclone backend drives to list shared drives (teamdrives) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement rclone backend untrash (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Work around drive bug which didn’t set modtime of copied docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added --drive-starred-only to only show starred files (Jay McEntire)

         • Deprecate --drive-alternate-export as it is no longer needed (themylogin)

         • Fix duplication of Google docs on server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix “panic: send on closed channel” when recycling dir entries (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add copyright detector info in limitations section in the docs (Alex Guerrero)

         • Fix rclone link by removing expires parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Detect Flood detected: IP Locked error and sleep for 30s (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Add explicit TLS support (Heiko Bornholdt)

         • Add support for --dump bodies and --dump auth for debugging (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix interoperation with pure-ftpd (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add support for anonymous access (Kai Lüke)

       • Jottacloud

         • Bring back legacy authentication for use with whitelabel versions (buengese)

         • Switch  to  new  api  root  -  also  implement  a very ugly workaround for the DirMove
           failures (buengese)

       • Onedrive

         • Rework cancel of multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --onedrive-no-versions flag to remove old versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Pcloud

         • Implement rclone link for public link creation (buengese)

       • Qingstor

         • Cancel in progress multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Preserve metadata when doing multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add rclone link for public link sharing (Roman Kredentser)

         • Add rclone backend restore command to restore objects from GLACIER (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add rclone cleanup and rclone backend cleanup to clean  unfinished  multipart  uploads
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add  rclone  backend list-multipart-uploads to list unfinished multipart uploads (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-max-upload-parts support (Kamil Trzciński)

         • Add --s3-no-check-bucket for minimising rclone transactions  and  perms  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add --s3-profile and --s3-shared-credentials-file options (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use regional s3 us-east-1 endpoint (David)

         • Add Scaleway provider (Vincent Feltz)

         • Update IBM COS endpoints (Egor Margineanu)

         • Reduce  the  default  --s3-copy-cutoff  to  < 5GB for Backblaze S3 compatibility (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Fix detection of bucket existing (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Use the  absolute  path  instead  of  the  relative  path  for  listing  for  improved
           compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --sftp-subsystem and --sftp-server-command options (aus)

       • Swift

         • Fix dangling large objects breaking the listing (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix purge not deleting directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix update multipart object removing all of its own parts (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix missing hash from object returned from upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Tardigrade

         • Upgrade to uplink v1.2.0 (Kaloyan Raev)

       • Union

         • Fix writing with the all policy (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Fix directory creation with 4shared (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.52.3 - 2020-08-07
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.2...v1.52.3)

       • Bug Fixes

         • docs

           • Disable smart typography (e.g. en-dash) in MANUAL.* and man page (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update install.md to reflect minimum Go version (Evan Harris)

           • Update install from source instructions (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • make_manual: Support SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH (Morten Linderud)

         • log: Fix –use-json-log going to stderr not –log-file on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve dlna: Fix file list on Samsung Series 6+ TVs (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

         • sync: Fix deadlock with –track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Fix moveto/copyto remote:file remote:file2 (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Stop using root_folder_id as a cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make dangling shortcuts appear in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Drop “Disabling ListR” messages down to debug (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Workaround and policy for Google Drive API (Dmitry Ustalov)

       • FTP

         • Add note to docs about home vs root directory selection (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Fix reverting to Copy when Move would have worked (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Avoid comma rendered in URL in onedrive.md (Kevin)

       • Pcloud

         • Fix oauth on European region “eapi.pcloud.com” (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix bucket Region auto detection when Region unset in config (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.52.2 - 2020-06-24
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.1...v1.52.2)

       • Bug Fixes

         • build

           • Fix docker release build action (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix custom timezone in Docker image (NoLooseEnds)

         • check: Fix misleading message which printed errors instead of differences (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • errors: Add WSAECONNREFUSED and more to the list of  retriable  Windows  errors  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • rcd: Fix incorrect prometheus metrics (Gary Kim)

         • serve restic: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve webdav: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • sync: Fix –track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Fix not being able to delete a directory with a trashed shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix creating a directory inside a shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix –drive-impersonate with cached root_folder_id (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Fix SSH key PEM loading (Zac Rubin)

       • Swift

         • Speed up deletes by not retrying segment container deletes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Tardigrade

         • Upgrade to uplink v1.1.1 (Caleb Case)

       • WebDAV

         • Fix free/used display for rclone about/df for certain backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.52.1 - 2020-06-10
       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.52.0...v1.52.1)

       • Bug Fixes

         • lib/file:  Fix  SetSparse  on  Windows  7 which fixes downloads of files > 250MB (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Update go.mod to go1.14 to enable -mod=vendor build (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Remove quicktest from Dockerfile (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Build Docker images with GitHub actions (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)

           • Update Docker build workflows (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Set user_allow_other in /etc/fuse.conf in the Docker image (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix xgo build after go1.14 go.mod update (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs

           • Add link to source and modified time to footer of every page (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Remove manually set dates and use git dates instead (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Minor  tense,  punctuation,  brevity  and  positivity  changes  for  the  home  page
             (edwardxml)

           • Remove leading slash in page reference in footer when present (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Note commands which need obscured input in the docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • obscure: Write more help as we are referencing it elsewhere (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Fix OS vs Unix path confusion - fixes ChangeNotify on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Fix missing items when listing using –fast-list / ListR (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Putio

         • Fix panic on Object.Open (Cenk Alti)

       • S3

         • Fix upload of single files into buckets without create permission (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix –header-upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Tardigrade

         • Fix listing bug by upgrading to v1.0.7

         • Set UserAgent to rclone (Caleb Case)

   v1.52.0 - 2020-05-27
       Special  thanks  to  Martin  Michlmayr  for  proof reading and correcting all the docs and
       Edward Barker for helping re-write the front page.

       See commits (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/compare/v1.51.0...v1.52.0)

       • New backends

         • Tardigrade (https://rclone.org/tardigrade/) backend for use with storj.io (Caleb Case)

         • Union (https://rclone.org/union/) re-write to have multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)

         • Seafile for Seafile server (Fred @creativeprojects)

       • New commands

         • backend: command for backend-specific commands (see backends) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • cachestats: Deprecate in favour of rclone backend stats cache: (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dbhashsum: Deprecate in favour of rclone hashsum DropboxHash (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • Add  --header-download  and  --header-upload  flags  for  setting  HTTP  headers  when
           uploading/downloading (Tim Gallant)

         • Add --header flag to add HTTP headers to every HTTP transaction (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --check-first to do all checking before starting transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add  --track-renames-strategy  for  configurable matching criteria for --track-renames
           (Bernd Schoolmann)

         • Add --cutoff-mode hard,soft,cautious (Shing Kit Chan & Franklyn Tackitt)

         • Filter flags (e.g. --files-from -) can read from stdin (fishbullet)

         • Add --error-on-no-transfer option (Jon Fautley)

         • Implement --order-by xxx,mixed for copying some small and some big files (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Allow --max-backlog to be negative meaning as large as possible (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added --no-unicode-normalization flag to allow Unicode filenames to remain unique (Ben
           Zenker)

         • Allow --min-age/--max-age to take a date as well as a duration (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add rename statistics for file and directory renames (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add statistics output to JSON log (reddi)

         • Make stats be printed on non-zero exit code (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • When running --password-command allow use of stdin (Sébastien Gross)

         • Stop empty strings being a valid remote path (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • accounting: support WriterTo for less memory copying (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Update to use go1.14 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add -trimpath to release build for reproduceable builds (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Remove GOOS and GOARCH from Dockerfile (Brandon Philips)

         • config

           • Fsync the config file after writing to save more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add --obscure and --no-obscure flags to config create/update (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make config show take remote: as well as remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copyurl: Add --no-clobber flag (Denis)

         • delete: Added --rmdirs flag to delete directories as well (Kush)

         • filter: Added --files-from-raw flag (Ankur Gupta)

         • genautocomplete: Add support for fish shell (Matan Rosenberg)

         • log: Add support for syslog LOCAL facilities (Patryk Jakuszew)

         • lsjson: Add --hash-type parameter and use it in lsf to speed up hashing  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • rc

           • Add -o/--opt and -a/--arg for more structured input (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implement  backend/command  for  running  backend-specific  commands  remotely (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Add mount/mount command for starting rclone mount via the API (Chaitanya)

         • rcd: Add Prometheus metrics support (Gary Kim)

         • serve http

           • Added a --template flag for user defined markup (calistri)

           • Add Last-Modified headers to files and directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve sftp: Add support for multiple host keys by repeating --key flag (Maxime Suret)

         • touch: Add --localtime flag to make --timestamp localtime not UTC (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Restore “Max number of stats groups reached” log line (Michał Matczuk)

           • Correct exitcode on Transfer Limit Exceeded flag.  (Anuar Serdaliyev)

           • Reset bytes read during copy retry (Ankur Gupta)

           • Fix race clearing stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copy: Only create empty directories when  they  don’t  exist  on  the  remote  (Ishuah
           Kariuki)

         • dedupe: Stop dedupe deleting files with identical IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • oauth

           • Use  custom  http  client  so  that --no-check-certificate is honored by oauth token
             fetch (Mark Spieth)

           • Replace deprecated oauth2.NoContext (Lars Lehtonen)

         • operations

           • Fix setting the timestamp on Windows for multithread copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make rcat obey --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make --max-transfer more accurate (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Fix dropped error (Lars Lehtonen)

           • Fix misplaced http server config (Xiaoxing Ye)

           • Disable duplicate log (ElonH)

         • serve dlna

           • Cds: don’t specify childCount at all when unknown (Dan Walters)

           • Cds: use modification time as date in dlna metadata (Dan Walters)

         • serve restic: Fix tests after restic project removed vendoring (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • sync

           • Fix incorrect “nothing to transfer” message using --delete-before (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Only create empty directories when they don’t exist on the remote (Ishuah Kariuki)

       • Mount

         • Add --async-read flag to disable asynchronous reads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Ignore --allow-root flag with a warning as it has been removed upstream  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Warn if --allow-non-empty used on Windows and clarify docs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Constrain  to  go1.13  or above otherwise bazil.org/fuse fails to compile (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix fail because of too long volume name (evileye)

         • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Map more rclone errors into file systems errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix disappearing cwd problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use ReaddirPlus on Windows to improve directory listing performance (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Send a hint as to whether the filesystem is case insensitive or not (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add rc command mount/types (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Change maximum leaf name length to 1024 bytes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Add  --vfs-read-wait  and  --vfs-write-wait  flags  to  control  time  waiting  for  a
           sequential read/write (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Change  default --vfs-read-wait to 20ms (it was 5ms and not configurable) (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Make df output more consistent on a rclone mount.  (Yves G)

         • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix race condition caused by unlocked reading of Dir.path (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make File lock and Dir lock not overlap to avoid deadlock (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement lock ordering between File and Dir to eliminate deadlocks (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Factor the vfs cache into its own package (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Pin the Fs in use in the Fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add SetSys() methods to Node to allow caching stuff on a node (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Ignore file not found errors from Hash in Read.Release (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix hang in read wait code (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Speed up multi thread downloads by using sparse files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement --local-no-sparse flag for disabling sparse files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement rclone backend noop for testing purposes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix “file not found” errors on post transfer Hash calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Implement rclone backend stats command (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix Server Side Copy with Temp Upload (Brandon McNama)

         • Remove Unused Functions (Lars Lehtonen)

         • Disable race tests until bbolt is fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Move methods used for testing into test file (greatroar)

         • Add Pin and Unpin and canonicalised lookup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use proper import path go.etcd.io/bbolt (Robert-André Mauchin)

       • Crypt

         • Calculate hashes for uploads from local disk (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • This allows crypted Jottacloud uploads without using local disk

           • This means crypted s3/b2 uploads will now have hashes

         • Added rclone backend decode/encode commands to replicate functionality of  cryptdecode
           (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

         • Get rid of the unused Cipher interface as it obfuscated the code (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Implement streaming of unknown sized files so rcat is now supported (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement memory pooling to control memory use (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --azureblob-disable-checksum flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Retry  InvalidBlobOrBlock  error  as  it may indicate block concurrency problems (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Remove unused Object.parseTimeString() (Lars Lehtonen)

         • Fix permission error on SAS URL limited to container (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Force the case of the SHA1 to lowercase (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove unused largeUpload.clearUploadURL() (Lars Lehtonen)

       • Box

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Implement About to read size used (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add token renew function for jwt auth (David Bramwell)

         • Added support for interchangeable root folder for Box backend (Sunil Patra)

         • Remove unnecessary iat from jws claims (David)

       • Drive

         • Follow shortcuts by default, skip with --drive-skip-shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement rclone backend shortcut command for creating shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added rclone backend command to  change  service_account_file  and  chunk_size  (Anagh
           Kumar Baranwal)

         • Fix missing files when using --fast-list and --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix duplicate items when using --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Extend --drive-stop-on-upload-limit to respond to teamDriveFileLimitExceeded.  (harry)

         • Don’t delete files with multiple parents to avoid data loss (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Server side copy docs use default description if empty (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Make error insufficient space to be fatal (harry)

         • Add info about required redirect url (Elan Ruusamäe)

       • Fichier

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Implement custom pacer to deal with the new rate limiting (buengese)

       • FTP

         • Fix lockup when using concurrency limit on failed connections (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix lockup on failed upload when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix lockup on Close failures when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Work around pureftp sending spurious 150 messages (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add ARCHIVE storage class to help (Adam Stroud)

         • Ignore directory markers at the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Googlephotos

         • Make the start year configurable (Daven)

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Create feature/favorites directory (Brandon Philips)

         • Fix “concurrent map write” error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t put an image in error message (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • HTTP

         • Improved directory listing with new template from Caddy project (calisro)

       • Jottacloud

         • Implement --jottacloud-trashed-only (buengese)

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Use RawURLEncoding when decoding base64 encoded login token (buengese)

         • Implement cleanup (buengese)

         • Update  docs regarding cleanup, removed remains from old auth, and added warning about
           special mountpoints.  (albertony)

       • Mailru

         • Describe 2FA requirements (valery1707)

       • Onedrive

         • Implement --onedrive-server-side-across-configs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Fix occasional 416 errors on multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added maximum chunk size limit warning in the docs (Harry)

         • Fix missing drive on config (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make error quotaLimitReached to be fatal (harry)

       • Opendrive

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

       • Pcloud

         • Added support for interchangeable root folder for pCloud backend (Sunil Patra)

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Fix initial config “Auth state doesn’t match” message (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Premiumizeme

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Prune unused functions (Lars Lehtonen)

       • Putio

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make downloading files use the rclone http Client (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix parsing of remotes with leading and trailing / (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Qingstor

         • Make rclone cleanup remove pending multipart uploads older than 24h (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Try harder to cancel failed multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Prune multiUploader.list() (Lars Lehtonen)

         • Lint fix (Lars Lehtonen)

       • S3

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Use memory pool for buffer allocations (Maciej Zimnoch)

         • Add SSE-C support for AWS, Ceph, and MinIO (Jack Anderson)

         • Fail fast multipart upload (Michał Matczuk)

         • Report errors on bucket creation (mkdir) correctly (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Specify that Minio supports URL encoding in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added 500 as retryErrorCode (Michał Matczuk)

         • Use --low-level-retries as the number of SDK retries (Aleksandar Janković)

         • Fix multipart abort context (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • Replace deprecated session.New() with session.NewSession() (Lars Lehtonen)

         • Use the provided size parameter when allocating a new  memory  pool  (Joachim  Brandon
           LeBlanc)

         • Use  rclone’s low level retries instead of AWS SDK to fix listing retries (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use single memory pool (Michał Matczuk)

         • Do not resize buf on put to memBuf (Michał Matczuk)

         • Improve docs for --s3-disable-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t leak memory or tokens in edge cases for multipart upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Seafile

         • Implement 2FA (Fred)

       • SFTP

         • Added --sftp-pem-key to support inline key files (calisro)

         • Fix post transfer copies failing with 0 size when using set_modtime=false (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

       • Sharefile

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

       • Sugarsync

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

       • Swift

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix cosmetic issue in error message (Martin Michlmayr)

       • Union

         • Implement multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)

         • Fix server-side copy (Max Sum)

         • Implement ListR (Max Sum)

         • Enable ListR when upstreams contain local (Max Sum)

       • WebDAV

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

         • Fix X-OC-Mtime header for Transip compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Report full and consistent usage with about (Yves G)

       • Yandex

         • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

   v1.51.0 - 2020-02-01
       • New backends

         • Memory (https://rclone.org/memory/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Sugarsync (https://rclone.org/sugarsync/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • Adjust all backends to have --backend-encoding parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • this enables the encoding for special characters to be adjusted or disabled

         • Add --max-duration flag to control the maximum duration of a transfer session (boosh)

         • Add --expect-continue-timeout flag, default 1s (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --no-check-dest flag for copying without testing the destination (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement --order-by flag to order transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • accounting

           • Don’t show entries in both transferring and checking (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add option to delete stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • build

           • Compress the test builds with gzip (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implement a framework for starting test servers during tests (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • cmd: Always print elapsed time to tenth place seconds in progress (Gary Kim)

         • config

           • Add --password-command to allow dynamic config password (Damon Permezel)

           • Give config questions default values (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Check a remote exists when creating a new one (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copyurl: Add --stdout flag to write to stdout (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dedupe: Implement keep smallest too (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • hashsum: Add flag --base64 flag (landall)

         • lsf: Speed up on s3/swift/etc by not reading mimetype by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson: Add --no-mimetype flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc: Add methods to turn on blocking and mutex profiling (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rcd

           • Adding group parameter to stats (Chaitanya)

           • Move webgui apart; option to disable browser (Xiaoxing Ye)

         • serve sftp: Add support for public key with auth proxy (Paul Tinsley)

         • stats: Show deletes in stats and hide zero stats (anuar45)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Fix error counter counting multiple times (Ankur Gupta)

           • Fix error count shown as checks (Cnly)

           • Clear finished transfer in stats-reset (Maciej Zimnoch)

           • Added StatsInfo locking in statsGroups sum function (Michał Matczuk)

         • asyncreader: Fix EOF error (buengese)

         • check: Fix --one-way recursing more directories than it needs to (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • chunkedreader: Disable hash calculation for first segment (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config

           • Do not open browser on headless on drive/gcs/google photos (Xiaoxing Ye)

           • SetValueAndSave ignore error if config section does not exist yet (buengese)

         • cmd: Fix completion with an encrypted config (Danil Semelenov)

         • dbhashsum: Stop it returning UNSUPPORTED on dropbox (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dedupe: Add missing modes to help string (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations

           • Fix dedupe continuing on errors like insufficientFilePersimmon (SezalAgrawal)

           • Clear accounting before low level retry (Maciej Zimnoch)

           • Write debug message when hashes could not be checked (Ole Schütt)

           • Move interface assertion to tests to remove pflag dependency (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make NewOverrideObjectInfo public and factor uses (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • proxy: Replace use of bcrypt with sha256 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • vendor

           • Update bazil.org/fuse to fix FreeBSD 12.1 (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update  github.com/t3rm1n4l/go-mega  to  fix mega “illegal base64 data at input byte
             22” (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update termbox-go to fix ncdu command on FreeBSD (Kuang-che Wu)

           • Update t3rm1n4l/go-mega - fixes mega: couldn’t login: crypto/aes: invalid key size 0
             (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Enable async reads for a 20% speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Replace use of WriteAt with Write for cache mode >= writes and O_APPEND (Brett Dutro)

         • Make sure we call unmount when exiting (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t build on go1.10 as bazil/fuse no longer supports it (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • When setting dates discard out of range dates (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Add a newly created file straight into the directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Only calculate one hash for reads for a speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make  ReadAt  for  non cached files work better with non-sequential reads (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix edge cases when reading ModTime from file (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make sure existing files opened for write show correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t cache the path in RW file objects to fix renaming (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix rename of open files when using the VFS cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • When renaming files in the cache, rename the cache item in  memory  too  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix open file renaming on drive when using --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix  incorrect  modtime  for  mv into mount with --vfs-cache-modes writes (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • On rename, rename in cache too if the file exists (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

       • Local

         • Make source file being updated errors be NoLowLevelRetry errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix update of hidden files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Follow move of upstream library github.com/coreos/bbolt github.com/etcd-io/bbolt (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Fix fatal error: concurrent map writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Reorder the filename encryption options (Thomas Eales)

         • Correctly handle trailing dot (buengese)

       • Chunker

         • Reduce length of temporary suffix (Ivan Andreev)

       • Drive

         • Add  --drive-stop-on-upload-limit  flag  to stop syncs when upload limit reached (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Add --drive-use-shared-date to use date file  was  shared  instead  of  modified  date
           (Garry McNulty)

         • Make sure invalid auth for teamdrives always reports an error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix --fast-list when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use multipart resumable uploads for streaming and uploads in mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Log an ERROR if an incomplete search is returned (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Hide dangerous config from the configurator (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Treat insufficient_space errors as non retriable errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Use new auth method used by official client (buengese)

         • Add URL to generate Login Token to config wizard (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add support whitelabel versions (buengese)

       • Koofr

         • Use rclone HTTP client.  (jaKa)

       • Onedrive

         • Add Sites.Read.All permission (Benjamin Richter)

         • Add support “Retry-After” header (Motonori IWAMURO)

       • Opendrive

         • Implement --opendrive-chunk-size (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Re-implement multipart upload to fix memory issues (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-copy-cutoff for size to switch to multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add new region Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) (Outvi V)

         • Reduce  memory  usage  streaming files by reducing max stream upload size (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add --s3-list-chunk option for bucket listing (Thomas Kriechbaumer)

         • Force path style bucket access to off for AWS deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use AWS web identity role provider if available (Tennix)

         • Add StackPath Object Storage Support (Dave Koston)

         • Fix ExpiryWindow value (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • Fix DisableChecksum condition (Aleksandar Janković)

         • Fix URL decoding of NextMarker (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Add --sftp-skip-links to skip symlinks and non regular files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Retry Creation of Connection (Sebastian Brandt)

         • Fix “failed to parse private key file: ssh: not an encrypted key” error  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Open files for update write only to fix AWS SFTP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Reserve  segments  of  dynamic  large object when delete objects in container what was
           enabled versioning.  (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)

         • Fix parsing of X-Object-Manifest (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update OVH API endpoint (unbelauscht)

       • WebDAV

         • Make nextcloud only upload SHA1 checksums (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix case of “Bearer” in Authorization: header to agree with RFC (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add Referer header to fix problems with WAFs (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.50.2 - 2019-11-19
       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix memory leak on retries operations (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Fix listing of the root directory with drive.files scope (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix –drive-root-folder-id with team/shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.50.1 - 2019-11-02
       • Bug Fixes

         • hash: Fix accidentally changed hash names for DropboxHash and CRC-32 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Fix error reporting on tpslimit token bucket errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • fshttp: Don’t print token bucket errors on context cancelled (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Fix listings of .  on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Fix DirMove/Move after Onedrive change (Xiaoxing Ye)

   v1.50.0 - 2019-10-26
       • New backends

         • Citrix Sharefile (https://rclone.org/sharefile/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Chunker (https://rclone.org/chunker/) - an overlay backend to split files into smaller
           parts (Ivan Andreev)

         • Mail.ru Cloud (https://rclone.org/mailru/) (Ivan Andreev)

       • New Features

         • encodings (Fabian Möller & Nick Craig-Wood)

           • All  backends  now  use file name encoding to ensure any file name can be written to
             any backend.

           • See  the  restricted  file   name   docs   (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-
             filenames) for more info and the local backend docs.

           • Some file names may look different in rclone if you are using any control characters
             in          names          or          unicode           FULLWIDTH           symbols
             (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Halfwidth_and_Fullwidth_Forms_(Unicode_block)).

         • build

           • Update to use go1.13 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Drop support for go1.9 (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Build rclone with GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Convert python scripts to python3 (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Swap Azure/go-ansiterm for mattn/go-colorable (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Dockerfile fixes (Matei David)

           • Add                                  plugin                                  support
             (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/blob/master/CONTRIBUTING.md#writing-a-plugin)  for
             backends and commands (Richard Patel)

         • config

           • Use alternating Red/Green in config to make more obvious (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • contrib

           • Add sample DLNA server Docker Compose manifest.  (pataquets)

           • Add sample WebDAV server Docker Compose manifest.  (pataquets)

         • copyurl

           • Add --auto-filename flag for using file name from URL in destination path (Denis)

         • serve dlna:

           • Many compatibility improvements (Dan Walters)

           • Support for external srt subtitles (Dan Walters)

         • rc

           • Added command core/quit (Saksham Khanna)

       • Bug Fixes

         • sync

           • Make --update/-u not transfer files that haven’t changed (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Free  objects  after  they come out of the transfer pipe to save memory (Nick Craig-
             Wood)

           • Fix --files-from without --no-traverse doing a recursive scan (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations

           • Fix accounting for server-side copies (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Display `All duplicates removed' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)

           • Display `Deleted X extra copies' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)

         • accounting

           • Only allow up to 100 completed transfers in the accounting list to save memory (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Cull the old time ranges when possible to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix panic due to server-side copy fallback (Ivan Andreev)

           • Fix  memory  leak  noticeable for transfers of large numbers of objects (Nick Craig-
             Wood)

           • Fix total duration calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • cmd

           • Fix environment variables not setting command line flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Make autocomplete compatible with bash’s posix mode for macOS (Danil Semelenov)

           • Make --progress work in git bash on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix `compopt: command not found' on autocomplete on macOS (Danil Semelenov)

         • config

           • Fix setting of non top level flags from environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Check config names more carefully and report errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Remove error: can’t use --size-only and --ignore-size together.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • filter: Prevent mixing options when --files-from is in use (Michele Caci)

         • serve sftp: Fix crash on unsupported operations (e.g. Readlink) (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Allow files of unknown size to be read properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Skip tests on <= 2 CPUs to avoid lockup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix panic on File.Open (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix “mount_fusefs: -o timeout=: option not supported” on FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t pass huge filenames (>4k) to FUSE as it can’t cope (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Add flag --vfs-case-insensitive for windows/macOS mounts (Ivan Andreev)

         • Make objects of unknown size readable through the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Move writeback of dirty data out of close() method into its own  method  (FlushWrites)
           and remove close() call from Flush() (Brett Dutro)

         • Stop empty dirs disappearing when renamed on bucket-based remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Stop change notify polling clearing so much of the directory cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Disable logging to the Windows event log (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Remove  unverified:  prefix  on  sha1  to  improve interop (e.g. with CyberDuck) (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Box

         • Add options to get access token via JWT auth (David)

       • Drive

         • Disable HTTP/2 by default to work around INTERNAL_ERROR problems (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make sure that drive root ID is always canonical (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix --drive-shared-with-me from the root with lsand --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix ChangeNotify polling for shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix change notify polling when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Make disallowed filenames errors not retry (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix nil pointer exception on restricted files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Fichier

         • Fix accessing files > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Allow disabling EPSV mode (Jon Fautley)

       • HTTP

         • HEAD directory entries in parallel to speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --http-no-head to stop rclone doing HEAD in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Putio

         • Add ability to resume uploads (Cenk Alti)

       • S3

         • Fix signature v2_auth headers (Anthony Rusdi)

         • Fix encoding for control characters (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Only ask for URL encoded directory listings if we need them on Ceph (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add option for multipart failure behaviour (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • Support for multipart copy (庄天翼)

         • Fix nil pointer reference if no metadata returned for object (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Fix --sftp-ask-password trying to contact the ssh agent (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix hashes of files with backslashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Include more ciphers with --sftp-use-insecure-cipher (Carlos Ferreyra)

       • WebDAV

         • Parse and return Sharepoint error response (Henning Surmeier)

   v1.49.5 - 2019-10-05
       • Bug Fixes

         • Revert back to go1.12.x for the v1.49.x builds as go1.13.x was  causing  issues  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Fix rpm packages by using master builds of nfpm (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix macOS build after brew changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.49.4 - 2019-09-29
       • Bug Fixes

         • cmd/rcd: Address ZipSlip vulnerability (Richard Patel)

         • accounting: Fix file handle leak on errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • oauthutil:  Fix security problem when running with two users on the same machine (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Fix listing of an empty root returning: error dir not found (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix SetModTime on GLACIER/ARCHIVE objects and implement set/get tier (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.49.3 - 2019-09-15
       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Fix total duration calculation (Aleksandar Jankovic)

           • Fix “file already closed” on transfer retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.49.2 - 2019-09-08
       • New Features

         • build: Add Docker workflow support (Alfonso Montero)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix locking in Transfer to avoid deadlock  with  --progress  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • docs: Fix template argument for mktemp in install.sh (Cnly)

         • operations:  Fix  -u/--update  with google photos / files of unknown size (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • rc: Fix docs for config/create /update /password (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix need for elevated permissions on SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.49.1 - 2019-08-28
       • Bug Fixes

         • config: Fix generated passwords being stored as empty password (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rcd: Added missing parameter for web-gui info logs.  (Chaitanya)

       • Googlephotos

         • Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.49.0 - 2019-08-26
       • New backends

         • 1fichier (https://rclone.org/fichier/) (Laura Hausmann)

         • Google Photos (https://rclone.org/googlephotos/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Putio (https://rclone.org/putio/) (Cenk Alti)

         • premiumize.me (https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/) (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • Experimental web GUI (https://rclone.org/gui/) (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

         • Implement --compare-dest & --copy-dest (yparitcher)

         • Implement --suffix without --backup-dir for backup to current dir (yparitcher)

         • config reconnect to re-login (re-run the oauth login) for the backend.   (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • config userinfo to discover which user you are logged in as.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config disconnect to disconnect you (log out) from the backend.  (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --use-json-log for JSON logging (justinalin)

         • Add context propagation to rclone (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • Reworking  internal  statistics  interfaces  so  they  work  with  rc jobs (Aleksandar
           Jankovic)

         • Add Higher units for ETA (AbelThar)

         • Update rclone logos to new design (Andreas Chlupka)

         • hash: Add CRC-32 support (Cenk Alti)

         • help showbackend: Fixed advanced option category when there are  no  standard  options
           (buengese)

         • ncdu: Display/Copy to Clipboard Current Path (Gary Kim)

         • operations:

           • Run hashing operations in parallel (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Don’t calculate checksums when using --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Check transfer hashes when using --size-only mode (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Disable multi thread copy for local to local copies (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Debug successful hashes as well as failures (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Add ability to stop async jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)

           • Return current settings if core/bwlimit called without parameters (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Rclone-WebUI integration with rclone (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Added  command line parameter to control the cross origin resource sharing (CORS) in
             the rcd.  (Security Improvement) (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Add anchor tags to the docs so links are consistent (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Remove _async key from input parameters after parsing so later operations won’t  get
             confused (buengese)

           • Add call to clear stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • rcd

           • Auto-login for web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

           • Implement --baseurl for rcd and web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)

         • serve dlna

           • Only select interfaces which can multicast for SSDP (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add more builtin mime types to cover standard audio/video (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix missing mime types on Android causing missing videos (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve ftp

           • Refactor to bring into line with other serve commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implement --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve http: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve restic: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve sftp

           • Implement auth proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix detection of whether server is authorized (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve webdav

           • Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Support --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • Make “bad record MAC” a retriable error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copyurl: Fix copying files that return HTTP errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • march: Fix checking sub-directories when using --no-traverse (buengese)

         • rc

           • Fix  unmarshalable  http.AuthFn  in options and put in test for marshalability (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

           • Move job expire flags to rc to fix initialization problem (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix --loopback with rc/list and others (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rcat: Fix slowdown on systems with multiple hashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rcd: Fix permissions problems on cache directory with web gui  download  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

       • Mount

         • Default --daemon-timeout to 15 minutes on macOS and FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update docs to show mounting from root OK for bucket-based (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove nonseekable flag from write files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Make write without cache more efficient (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix --vfs-cache-mode minimal and writes ignoring cached files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Add --local-case-sensitive and --local-case-insensitive (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Avoid  polluting  page  cache  when  uploading  local files to remote backends (Michał
           Matczuk)

         • Don’t calculate any hashes by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fadvise run syscall on a dedicated go routine (Michał Matczuk)

       • Azure Blob

         • Azure Storage Emulator support (Sandeep)

         • Updated config help details to remove connection string references (Sandeep)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Implement link sharing (yparitcher)

         • Enable server-side copy to copy between buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Fix server-side copy of big files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Update API for teamdrive use (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add error for purge with --drive-trashed-only (ginvine)

       • Fichier

         • Make FolderID int and adjust related code (buengese)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Reduce oauth scope requested as suggested by Google (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • HTTP

         • Add --http-headers flag for setting arbitrary headers (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Use new api for retrieving internal username (buengese)

         • Refactor configuration and minor cleanup (buengese)

       • Koofr

         • Support setting modification times on Koofr backend.  (jaKa)

       • Opendrive

         • Refactor to use existing lib/rest facilities for uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Qingstor

         • Upgrade to v3 SDK and fix listing loop (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Add INTELLIGENT_TIERING storage class (Matti Niemenmaa)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Add missing interface check and fix About (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Completely ignore all modtime checks if SetModTime=false (Jon Fautley)

         • Support md5/sha1 with rsync.net (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Save the md5/sha1 command in use to the config file for efficiency (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Opt-in support for diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256 diffie-hellman-group-exchange-
           sha1 (Yi FU)

       • Swift

         • Use FixRangeOption to fix 0 length files via the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix upload when using no_chunk to return the correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix segments leak during failed large file uploads.  (nguyenhuuluan434)

       • WebDAV

         • Add --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Refresh token when it expires with --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add docs for using bearer_token_command with oidc-agent (Paul Millar)

   v1.48.0 - 2019-06-15
       • New commands

         • serve sftp: Serve an rclone remote over SFTP (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • Multi threaded downloads to local storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • controlled with --multi-thread-cutoff and --multi-thread-streams

         • Use rclone.conf from rclone executable directory to enable portable use (albertony)

         • Allow sync of a file and a directory with the same name (forgems)

           • this is common on bucket-based remotes, e.g. s3, gcs

         • Add --ignore-case-sync for forced case insensitivity (garry415)

         • Implement --stats-one-line-date and --stats-one-line-date-format (Peter Berbec)

         • Log an ERROR for all commands which exit with non-zero status (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Use go-homedir to read the home directory more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Enable   creating  encrypted  config  through  external  script  invocation  (Wojciech
           Smigielski)

         • build: Drop support for go1.8 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: Make config create/update encrypt passwords where necessary (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • copyurl: Honor --no-check-certificate (Stefan Breunig)

         • install: Linux skip man pages if no mandb (didil)

         • lsf: Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson

           • Added EncryptedPath to output (calisro)

           • Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add IsBucket field for bucket-based remote listing of the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Add --loopback flag to run commands directly without a server (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Skip auth for OPTIONS request (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • cmd/providers: Add DefaultStr, ValueStr and Type fields (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • jobs: Make job expiry timeouts configurable (Aleksandar Jankovic)

         • serve dlna reworked and improved (Dan Walters)

         • serve ftp: add --ftp-public-ip flag to specify public IP (calistri)

         • serve restic: Add support for --private-repos in serve restic (Florian Apolloner)

         • serve webdav: Combine serve webdav and serve http (Gary Kim)

         • size: Ignore negative sizes when calculating total (Garry McNulty)

       • Bug Fixes

         • Make move and copy individual files obey --backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • If --ignore-checksum is in effect, don’t calculate checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • moveto: Fix case-insensitive same remote move (Gary Kim)

         • rc: Fix serving bucket-based objects with --rc-serve (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve webdav: Fix serveDir not being updated with changes from webdav (Gary Kim)

       • Mount

         • Fix poll interval documentation (Animosity022)

       • VFS

         • Make WriteAt for non cached files work with non-sequential writes (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Only calculate the required hashes for big speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Log errors when listing instead of returning an error (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix preallocate warning on Linux with ZFS (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Make rclone dedupe work through crypt (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix wrapping of ChangeNotify to decrypt directories properly (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Support PublicLink (rclone link) of underlying backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement Optional methods SetTier, GetTier (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Implement server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Fix move and copy from TeamDrive to GDrive (Fionera)

         • Add notes that cleanup works in the background on drive (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add  --drive-server-side-across-configs  to  default  back  to  old  server-side  copy
           semantics by default (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --drive-size-as-quota to show storage quota usage for file size (Garry McNulty)

       • FTP

         • Add FTP List timeout (Jeff Quinn)

         • Add FTP over TLS support (Gary Kim)

         • Add --ftp-no-check-certificate option for FTPS (Gary Kim)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix upload errors when uploading pre 1970 files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Add support for selecting device and mountpoint.  (buengese)

       • Mega

         • Add cleanup support (Gary Kim)

       • Onedrive

         • More accurately check if root is found (Cnly)

       • S3

         • Support S3 Accelerated endpoints with --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add config info for Wasabi’s EU Central endpoint (Robert Marko)

         • Make SetModTime work for GLACIER while syncing (Philip Harvey)

       • SFTP

         • Add About support (Gary Kim)

         • Fix about parsing of df results so it can cope with -ve results (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Send custom client version and debug server version (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Retry on 423 Locked errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.47.0 - 2019-04-13
       • New backends

         • Backend for Koofr cloud storage service.  (jaKa)

       • New Features

         • Resume downloads if the reader fails in copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • this means rclone will restart transfers if the source has an error

           • this is most useful for downloads or cloud to cloud copies

         • Use  --fast-list  for  listing  operations where it won’t use more memory (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

           • this should speed up the following operations on remotes which support ListRdedupe, serve restic lsf, ls, lsl, lsjson,  lsd,  md5sum,  sha1sum,  hashsum,  size,
             delete, cat, settier

           • use --disable ListR to get old behaviour if required

         • Make  --files-from  traverse  the destination unless --no-traverse is set (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

           • this fixes --files-from with Google drive and excessive API use in general.

         • Make server-side copy account bytes and obey --max-transfer (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --create-empty-src-dirs flag and default to not creating empty dirs (ishuah)

         • Add client side TLS/SSL flags --ca-cert/--client-cert/--client-key (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Implement --suffix-keep-extension for use with --suffix (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • build:

           • Switch to semver compliant version tags to be go modules compliant (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update to use go1.12.x for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve dlna: Add connection manager service description to improve  compatibility  (Dan
           Walters)

         • lsf: Add `e' format to show encrypted names and `o' for original IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson: Added --files-only and --dirs-only flags (calistri)

         • rc: Implement operations/publiclink the equivalent of rclone link (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting: Fix total ETA when --stats-unit bits is in effect (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Bash TAB completion

           • Use private custom func to fix clash between rclone and kubectl (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix for remotes with underscores in their names (Six)

           • Fix completion of remotes (Florian Gamböck)

           • Fix autocompletion of remote paths with spaces (Danil Semelenov)

         • serve dlna: Fix root XML service descriptor (Dan Walters)

         • ncdu: Fix display corruption with Chinese characters (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add SIGTERM to signals which run the exit handlers on unix (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc: Reload filter when the options are set via the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS / Mount

         • Fix  FreeBSD:  Ignore  Truncate if called with no readers and already the correct size
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Read directory and check for a file before mkdir (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Shorten the locking window for vfs/refresh (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Enable MD5 checksums when uploading files bigger than the “Cutoff” (Dr.Rx)

         • Fix SAS URL support (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Allow manual configuration of backblaze downloadUrl (Vince)

         • Ignore already_hidden error on remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Ignore malformed src_last_modified_millis (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Drive

         • Add --skip-checksum-gphotos to ignore  incorrect  checksums  on  Google  Photos  (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • Allow server-side move/copy between different remotes.  (Fionera)

         • Add docs on team drives and --fast-list eventual consistency (Nestar47)

         • Fix imports of text files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix range requests on 0 length files (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix creation of duplicates with server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Retry blank errors to fix long listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Add --ftp-concurrency to limit maximum number of connections (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fall back to default application credentials (marcintustin)

         • Allow bucket policy only buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • HTTP

         • Add --http-no-slash for websites with directories with no slashes (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove duplicates from listings (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix socket leak on 404 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix token refresh (Sebastian Bünger)

         • Add device registration (Oliver Heyme)

       • Onedrive

         • Implement graceful cancel of multipart uploads if rclone is interrupted (Cnly)

         • Always add trailing colon to path when addressing items, (Cnly)

         • Return errors instead of panic for invalid uploads (Fabian Möller)

       • S3

         • Add support for “Glacier Deep Archive” storage class (Manu)

         • Update Dreamhost endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Note incompatibility with CEPH Jewel (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • SFTP

         • Allow custom ssh client config (Alexandru Bumbacea)

       • Swift

         • Obey Retry-After to enable OVH restore from cold storage (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Work around token expiry on CEPH (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Allow IsCollection property to be integer or boolean (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix race when creating directories (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix About/df when reading the available/total returns 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.46 - 2019-02-09
       • New backends

         • Support Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) OSS via the s3 backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New commands

         • serve dlna: serves a remove via DLNA for the local network (nicolov)

       • New Features

         • copy, move: Restore deprecated --no-traverse flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • This  is  useful  for  when  transferring  a  small  number  of  files  into a large
             destination

         • genautocomplete: Add remote path completion for bash completion (Christopher  Peterson
           & Danil Semelenov)

         • Buffer memory handling reworked to return memory to the OS better (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Buffer recycling library to replace sync.Pool

           • Optionally use memory mapped memory for better memory shrinking

           • Enable with --use-mmap if having memory problems - not default yet

         • Parallelise reading of files specified by --files-from (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • check: Add stats showing total files matched.  (Dario Guzik)

         • Allow rename/delete open files under Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • lsjson:  Use  exactly the correct number of decimal places in the seconds (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Add cookie support with cmdline switch --use-cookies for all HTTP based remotes (qip)

         • Warn if --checksum is set but there are no hashes available (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Rework rate limiting (pacer) to be more accurate and allow bursting (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Improve error reporting for too many/few arguments in commands (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • listremotes: Remove -l short flag as it conflicts with the new global flag (weetmuts)

         • Make http serving with auth generate INFO messages on auth fail (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix layout of stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix --progress crash under Windows Jenkins (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix transfer of google/onedrive docs by calling Rcat in Copy when size is -1 (Cnly)

         • copyurl: Fix checking of --dry-run (Denis Skovpen)

       • Mount

         • Check that mountpoint and local directory to mount don’t overlap (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix mount size under 32 bit Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Implement renaming of directories for backends without DirMove (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • now all backends except b2 support renaming directories

         • Implement --vfs-cache-max-size to limit the total size of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --dir-perms and --file-perms flags to set default permissions (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix deadlock on concurrent operations on a directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix deadlock between RWFileHandle.close and File.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix renaming/deleting open files with cache mode “writes” under Windows  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix panic on rename with --dry-run set (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix vfs/refresh with recurse=true needing the --fast-list flag

       • Local

         • Add support for -l/--links (symbolic link translation) (yair@unicorn)

           • this  works  by  showing  links as link.rclonelink - see local backend docs for more
             info

           • this errors if used with -L/--copy-links

         • Fix renaming/deleting open files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Check for maximum length before decrypting filename to fix panic (Garry McNulty)

       • Azure Blob

         • Allow building azureblob backend on *BSD (themylogin)

         • Use the rclone HTTP client to support --dump headers, --tpslimit, etc.   (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Use the s3 pacer for 0 delay in non error conditions (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Ignore directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Stop Mkdir attempting to create existing containers (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • cleanup: will remove unfinished large files >24hrs old (Garry McNulty)

         • For a bucket limited application key check the bucket name (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • before  this,  rclone  would use the authorised bucket regardless of what you put on
             the command line

         • Added --b2-disable-checksum flag (Wojciech Smigielski)

           • this enables large files to be uploaded without a SHA-1 hash for speed reasons

       • Drive

         • Set default pacer to 100ms for 10 tps (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • This fits the Google defaults much better and reduces the 403 errors massively

           • Add --drive-pacer-min-sleep and --drive-pacer-burst to control the pacer

         • Improve ChangeNotify support for items with multiple parents (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix ListR for items with multiple parents  -  this  fixes  oddities  with  vfs/refresh
           (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix using --drive-impersonate and appfolders (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix google docs in rclone mount for some (not all) applications (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Retry-After support for Dropbox backend (Mathieu Carbou)

       • FTP

         • Wait for 60 seconds for a connection to Close then declare it dead (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • helps with indefinite hangs on some FTP servers

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Update google cloud storage endpoints (weetmuts)

       • HTTP

         • Add  an  example  with  username and password which is supported but wasn’t documented
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix backend with --files-from and nonexistent files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Hubic

         • Make error message more informative if authentication fails (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Resume and deduplication support (Oliver Heyme)

         • Use token auth for all API requests Don’t store password anymore (Sebastian Bünger)

         • Add support for 2-factor authentication (Sebastian Bünger)

       • Mega

         • Implement v2 account login which fixes logins for newer  Mega  accounts  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Return error if an unknown length file is attempted to be uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add new error codes for better error reporting (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Fix broken support for “shared with me” folders (Alex Chen)

         • Fix root ID not normalised (Cnly)

         • Return err instead of panic on unknown-sized uploads (Cnly)

       • Qingstor

         • Fix go routine leak on multipart upload errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add upload chunk size/concurrency/cutoff control (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Default --qingstor-upload-concurrency to 1 to work around bug (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Implement --s3-upload-cutoff for single part uploads below this (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Change --s3-upload-concurrency default to 4 to increase performance (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-bucket-acl to control bucket ACL (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Auto detect region for buckets on operation failure (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add GLACIER storage class (William Cocker)

         • Add Scaleway to s3 documentation (Rémy Léone)

         • Add AWS endpoint eu-north-1 (weetmuts)

       • SFTP

         • Add support for PEM encrypted private keys (Fabian Möller)

         • Add option to force the usage of an ssh-agent (Fabian Möller)

         • Perform environment variable expansion on key-file (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix rmdir on Windows based servers (e.g. CrushFTP) (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix rmdir deleting directory contents on some SFTP servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix error on dangling symlinks (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Add --swift-no-chunk to disable segmented uploads in rcat/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Introduce application credential auth support (kayrus)

         • Fix memory usage by slimming Object (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix extra requests on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix reauth on big files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Union

         • Fix poll-interval not working (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Support  About  which  means rclone mount will show the correct disk size (Nick Craig-
           Wood)

         • Support MD5 and SHA1 hashes with Owncloud and Nextcloud (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fail soft on time parsing errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix infinite loop on failed directory creation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix identification of directories for Bitrix Site Manager (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix upload of 0 length files on some servers (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix if MKCOL fails with 423 Locked assume the directory exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.45 - 2018-11-24
       • New backends

         • The Yandex backend was re-written - see below for details (Sebastian Bünger)

       • New commands

         • rcd: New command just to serve the remote control API (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • New Features

         • The remote control API (rc) was greatly expanded to allow  full  control  over  rclone
           (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • sensitive operations require authorization or the --rc-no-auth flag

           • config/* operations to configure rclone

           • options/* for reading/setting command line flags

           • operations/* for all low level operations, e.g. copy file, list directory

           • sync/* for sync, copy and move

           • --rc-files flag to serve files on the rc http server

             • this is for building web native GUIs for rclone

           • Optionally serving objects on the rc http server

           • Ensure rclone fails to start up if the --rc port is in use already

           • See the rc docs (https://rclone.org/rc/) for more info

         • sync/copy/move

           • Make  --files-from  only read the objects specified and don’t scan directories (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

             • This is a huge speed improvement for destinations with lots of files

         • filter: Add --ignore-case flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • ncdu: Add remove function (`d' key) (Henning Surmeier)

         • rc command

           • Add --json flag for structured JSON input (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add --user and --pass flags and  interpret  --rc-user,  --rc-pass,  --rc-addr  (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Require go1.8 or later for compilation (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Enable softfloat on MIPS arch (Scott Edlund)

           • Integration  test  framework  revamped with a better report and better retries (Nick
             Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • cmd: Make --progress update the stats correctly at the end (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: Create config directory on save if it is missing (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • dedupe: Check for existing filename before renaming a dupe file (ssaqua)

         • move: Don’t create directories with --dry-run (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • operations: Fix Purge and Rmdirs when dir is not the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • serve http/webdav/restic: Ensure rclone exits if the port is in use (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Mount

         • Make --volname work for Windows and macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Avoid context deadline exceeded error by setting a large TryTimeout value (brused27)

         • Fix erroneous Rmdir error “directory not empty” (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Wait for up to 60s to create a just deleted container (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Dropbox

         • Add dropbox impersonate support (Jake Coggiano)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix bug in --fast-list handing of empty folders (albertony)

       • Opendrive

         • Fix transfer of files with + and & in (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix retries of upload chunks (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Set ACL for server-side copies to that provided by the user (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix role_arn, credential_source, ...  (Erik Swanson)

         • Add config info for Wasabi’s US-West endpoint (Henry Ptasinski)

       • SFTP

         • Ensure file hash checking is really disabled (Jon Fautley)

       • Swift

         • Add pacer for retries to make swift more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Add Content-Type to PUT requests (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix config parsing so --webdav-user and --webdav-pass flags work (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add RFC3339 date format (Ralf Hemberger)

       • Yandex

         • The yandex backend was re-written (Sebastian Bünger)

           • This implements low level retries (Sebastian Bünger)

           • Copy, Move, DirMove, PublicLink and About optional interfaces (Sebastian Bünger)

           • Improved general error handling (Sebastian Bünger)

           • Removed ListR for now due to inconsistent behaviour (Sebastian Bünger)

   v1.44 - 2018-10-15
       • New commands

         • serve ftp: Add ftp server (Antoine GIRARD)

         • settier: perform storage tier changes on supported remotes (sandeepkru)

       • New Features

         • Reworked command line help

           • Make default help less verbose (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Split flags up into global and backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Implement specialised help for flags and backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Show URL of backend help page when starting config (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • stats: Long names now split in center (Joanna Marek)

         • Add --log-format flag for more control over log output (dcpu)

         • rc: Add support for OPTIONS and basic CORS (frenos)

         • stats: show FatalErrors and NoRetryErrors in stats (Cédric Connes)

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix -P not ending with a new line (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: don’t create default config dir when user supplies --config (albertony)

         • Don’t print non-ASCII characters with --progress on windows (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Correct logs for excluded items (ssaqua)

       • Mount

         • Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Fix race condition detected by serve ftp tests (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add vfs/poll-interval rc command (Fabian Möller)

         • Enable rename for nearly all remotes using server-side Move or Copy (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Reduce directory cache cleared by poll-interval (Fabian Möller)

         • Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Local

         • Skip bad symlinks in dir listing with -L enabled (Cédric Connes)

         • Preallocate files on Windows to reduce fragmentation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Preallocate files on linux with fallocate(2) (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Add cache/fetch rc function (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix worker scale down (Fabian Möller)

         • Improve performance by not sending info requests for cached chunks (dcpu)

         • Fix error return value of cache/fetch rc method (Fabian Möller)

         • Documentation fix for cache-chunk-total-size (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

         • Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)

         • Add plex_insecure option to skip certificate validation (Fabian Möller)

         • Remove entries that no longer exist in the source (dcpu)

       • Crypt

         • Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)

       • Alias

         • Fix handling of Windows network paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Add --azureblob-list-chunk parameter (Santiago Rodríguez)

         • Implemented settier command support on azureblob remote.  (sandeepkru)

         • Work around SDK bug which causes errors for chunk-sized files (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Box

         • Implement link sharing.  (Sebastian Bünger)

       • Drive

         • Add --drive-import-formats - google docs can now be imported (Fabian Möller)

           • Rewrite mime type and extension handling (Fabian Möller)

           • Add document links (Fabian Möller)

           • Add support for multipart document extensions (Fabian Möller)

           • Add support for apps-script to json export (Fabian Möller)

           • Fix escaped chars in documents during list (Fabian Möller)

         • Add --drive-v2-download-min-size a workaround for slow downloads (Fabian Möller)

         • Improve directory notifications in ChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)

         • When listing team drives in config, continue on failure (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • FTP

         • Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix service_account_file being ignored (Fabian Möller)

       • Jottacloud

         • Minor improvement in quota info (omit if unlimited) (albertony)

         • Add --fast-list support (albertony)

         • Add permanent delete support: --jottacloud-hard-delete (albertony)

         • Add link sharing support (albertony)

         • Fix handling of reserved characters.  (Sebastian Bünger)

         • Fix socket leak on Object.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Rework to support Microsoft Graph (Cnly)

           • NB this will require re-authenticating the remote

         • Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads (Oliver Heyme)

         • Use single-part upload for empty files (Cnly)

         • Fix new fields not saved when editing old config (Alex Chen)

         • Fix sometimes special chars in filenames not replaced (Alex Chen)

         • Ignore OneNote files by default (Alex Chen)

         • Add link sharing support (jackyzy823)

       • S3

         • Use custom pacer, to retry operations when reasonable (Craig Miskell)

         • Use  configured  server-side-encryption  and  storage  class  options   when   calling
           CopyObject() (Paul Kohout)

         • Make --s3-v2-auth flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix v2 auth on files with spaces (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Union

         • Implement union backend which reads from multiple backends (Felix Brucker)

         • Implement optional interfaces (Move, DirMove, Copy, etc.)  (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix ChangeNotify to support multiple remotes (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix --backup-dir on union backend (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Add another time format (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add workaround for missing mtime (buergi)

         • Sharepoint: Renew cookies after 12hrs (Henning Surmeier)

       • Yandex

         • Remove redundant nil checks (teresy)

   v1.43.1 - 2018-09-07
       Point release to fix hubic and azureblob backends.

       • Bug Fixes

         • ncdu: Return error instead of log.Fatal in Show (Fabian Möller)

         • cmd: Fix crash with --progress and --stats 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • docs: Tidy website display (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)

       • Azure Blob:

         • Fix multi-part uploads.  (sandeepkru)

       • Hubic

         • Fix uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Retry auth fetching if it fails to make hubic more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.43 - 2018-09-01
       • New backends

         • Jottacloud (Sebastian Bünger)

       • New commands

         • copyurl: copies a URL to a remote (Denis)

       • New Features

         • Reworked config for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • All backend config can now be supplied by command line, env var or config file

           • Advanced section in the config wizard for the optional items

           • A large step towards rclone backends being usable in other go software

           • Allow on the fly remotes with :backend: syntax

         • Stats revamp

           • Add --progress/-P flag to show interactive progress (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Show the total progress of the sync in the stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Add --stats-one-line flag for single line stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Added weekday schedule into --bwlimit (Mateusz)

         • lsjson: Add option to show the original object IDs (Fabian Möller)

         • serve  webdav:  Make  Content-Type  without reading the file and add --etag-hash (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

         • build

           • Build macOS with native compiler (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Update to use go1.11 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • rc

           • Added core/stats to return the stats (reddi1)

         • version --check: Prints the current release and beta versions (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Bug Fixes

         • accounting

           • Fix time to completion estimates (Nick Craig-Wood)

           • Fix moving average speed for file stats (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • config: Fix error reading password from piped input (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • move: Fix --delete-empty-src-dirs flag to delete all empty dirs on move (ishuah)

       • Mount

         • Implement --daemon-timeout flag for OSXFUSE (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix mount --daemon not working with encrypted config (Alex Chen)

         • Clip the number of blocks to 2^32-1 on macOS - fixes borg backup (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • VFS

         • Enable vfs-read-chunk-size by default (Fabian Möller)

         • Add the vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)

         • Add non recursive mode to vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)

         • Try to seek buffer on read only files (Fabian Möller)

       • Local

         • Fix crash when deprecated --local-no-unicode-normalization is  supplied  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

         • Fix  mkdir  error  when  trying  to copy files to the root of a drive on windows (Nick
           Craig-Wood)

       • Cache

         • Fix nil pointer deref when using lsjson on cached directory (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix nil pointer deref for occasional crash on playback (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Crypt

         • Fix accounting when checking hashes on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Amazon Cloud Drive

         • Make very clear in the docs that rclone has no ACD keys (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Azure Blob

         • Add connection string and SAS URL auth (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • List the container to see if it exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Port new Azure Blob Storage SDK (sandeepkru)

         • Added blob tier, tier between Hot, Cool and Archive.  (sandeepkru)

         • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • B2

         • Support Application Keys (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Box

         • Fix upload of > 2GB files on 32 bit platforms (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Make --box-commit-retries flag defaulting to 100 to fix  large  uploads  (Nick  Craig-
           Wood)

       • Drive

         • Add --drive-keep-revision-forever flag (lewapm)

         • Handle gdocs when filtering file names in list (Fabian Möller)

         • Support using --fast-list for large speedups (Fabian Möller)

       • FTP

         • Fix Put mkParentDir failed: 521 for BunnyCDN (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Jottacloud

         • Fix MD5 error check (Oliver Heyme)

         • Handle empty time values (Martin Polden)

         • Calculate missing MD5s (Oliver Heyme)

         • Docs, fixes and tests for MD5 calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add optional MimeTyper interface.  (Sebastian Bünger)

         • Implement optional About interface (for df support).  (Sebastian Bünger)

       • Mega

         • Wait for events instead of arbitrary sleeping (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --mega-hard-delete flag (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix failed logins with upper case chars in email (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Onedrive

         • Shared folder support (Yoni Jah)

         • Implement DirMove (Cnly)

         • Fix rmdir sometimes deleting directories with contents (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Pcloud

         • Delete half uploaded files on upload error (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Qingstor

         • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • S3

         • Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add --s3-force-path-style (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add support for KMS Key ID (bsteiss)

         • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Swift

         • Add storage_policy (Ruben Vandamme)

         • Make it so just storage_url or auth_token can be overridden (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Fix server-side copy bug for unusual file names (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • WebDAV

         • Ensure we call MKCOL with a URL with a trailing / for QNAP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • If root ends with / then don’t check if it is a file (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Don’t accept redirects when reading metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Add bearer token (Macaroon) support for dCache (Nick Craig-Wood)

         • Document dCache and Macaroons (Onno Zweers)

         • Sharepoint recursion with different depth (Henning)

         • Attempt to remove failed uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)

       • Yandex

         • Fix listing/deleting files in the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

   v1.42 - 2018-06-16
       • New backends

         • OpenDrive (Oliver Heyme, Jakub Karlicek, ncw)

       • New commands

         • deletefile command (Filip Bartodziej)

       • New Features

         • copy, move: Copy single files directly, don’t use --files-from work-around

           • this makes them much more efficient

         • Implement --max-transfer flag to quit transferring at a limit

           • make exit code 8 for --max-transfer exceeded

         • copy: copy empty source directories to destination (Ishuah Kariuki)

         • check: Add --one-way flag (Kasper Byrdal Nielsen)

         • Add siginfo handler for macOS for ctrl-T stats (kubatasiemski)

         • rc

           • add core/gc to run a garbage collection on demand

           • enable go profiling by default on the --rc port

           • return error from remote on failure

         • lsf

           • Add --absolute flag to add a leading / onto path names

           • Add --csv flag for compliant CSV output

           • Add `m' format specifier to show the MimeType

           • Implement `i' format for showing object ID

         • lsjson

           • Add MimeType to the output

           • Add ID field to output to show Object ID

         • Add --retries-sleep flag (Benjamin Joseph Dag)

         • Oauth tidy up web page and error handling (Henning Surmeier)

       • Bug Fixes

         • Password prompt output with --log-file fixed for unix (Filip Bartodziej)

         • Calculate ModifyWindow each time on the fly to fix various problems (Stefan Breunig)

       • Mount

         • Only print “File.rename error” if there actually is an error (Stefan Breunig)

         • Delay rename if file has open writers instead of failing outright (Stefan Breunig)

         • Ensure atexit gets run on interrupt

         • macOS enhancements

           • Make --noappledouble --noapplexattr

           • Add --volname flag and remove special chars from it

           • Make Get/List/Set/Remove xattr return ENOSYS for efficiency

           • Make --daemon work for macOS without CGO

       • VFS

         • Add --vfs-read-chunk-size and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix ChangeNotify for new or changed folders (Fabian Möller)

       • Local

         • Fix symlink/junction point directory handling under Windows

           • NB you will need to add -L to your command line to copy files with reparse points

       • Cache

         • Add non cached dirs on notifications (Remus Bunduc)

         • Allow root to be expired from rc (Remus Bunduc)

         • Clean remaining empty folders from temp upload path (Remus Bunduc)

         • Cache lists using batch writes (Remus Bunduc)

         • Use secure websockets for HTTPS Plex addresses (John Clayton)

         • Reconnect plex websocket on failures (Remus Bunduc)

         • Fix panic when running without plex configs (Remus Bunduc)

         • Fix root folder caching (Remus Bunduc)

       • Crypt

         • Check the crypted hash of files when uploading for extra data security

       • Dropbox

         • Make Dropbox for business folders accessible using an initial / in the path

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Low level retry all operations if necessary

       • Google Drive

         • Add --drive-acknowledge-abuse to download flagged files

         • Add --drive-alternate-export to fix large doc export

         • Don’t attempt to choose Team Drives when using rclone config create

         • Fix change list polling with team drives

         • Fix ChangeNotify for folders (Fabian Möller)

         • Fix about (and df on a mount) for team drives

       • Onedrive

         • Errorhandler for onedrive for business requests (Henning Surmeier)

       • S3

         • Adjust upload concurrency with --s3-upload-concurrency (themylogin)

         • Fix --s3-chunk-size which was always using the minimum

       • SFTP

         • Add --ssh-path-override flag (Piotr Oleszczyk)

         • Fix slow downloads for long latency connections

       • Webdav

         • Add workarounds for biz.mail.ru

         • Ignore Reason-Phrase in status line to fix 4shared (Rodrigo)

         • Better error message generation

   v1.41 - 2018-04-28
       • New backends

         • Mega support added

         • Webdav now supports SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)

       • New commands

         • link: create public link to files and folders (Stefan Breunig)

         • about: gets quota info from a remote (a-roussos, ncw)

         • hashsum: a generic tool for any hash to produce md5sum like output

       • New Features

         • lsd: Add -R flag and fix and update docs for all ls commands

         • ncdu: added a “refresh” key - CTRL-L (Keith Goldfarb)

         • serve restic: Add append-only mode (Steve Kriss)

         • serve restic: Disallow overwriting files in append-only mode (Alexander Neumann)

         • serve restic: Print actual listener address (Matt Holt)

         • size: Add –json flag (Matthew Holt)

         • sync: implement –ignore-errors (Mateusz Pabian)

         • dedupe: Add dedupe largest functionality (Richard Yang)

         • fs: Extend SizeSuffix to include TB and PB for rclone about

         • fs: add –dump goroutines and –dump openfiles for debugging

         • rc: implement core/memstats to print internal memory usage info

         • rc: new call rc/pid (Michael P.  Dubner)

       • Compile

         • Drop support for go1.6

       • Release

         • Fix make tarball (Chih-Hsuan Yen)

       • Bug Fixes

         • filter: fix –min-age and –max-age together check

         • fs: limit MaxIdleConns and MaxIdleConnsPerHost in transport

         • lsd,lsf: make sure all times we output are in local time

         • rc: fix setting bwlimit to unlimited

         • rc: take note of the –rc-addr flag too as per the docs

       • Mount

         • Use About to return the correct disk total/used/free (e.g. in df)

         • Set --attr-timeout default to 1s - fixes:

           • rclone using too much memory

           • rclone not serving files to samba

           • excessive time listing directories

         • Fix df -i (upstream fix)

       • VFS

         • Filter files . and .. from directory listing

         • Only make the VFS cache if –vfs-cache-mode > Off

       • Local

         • Add –local-no-check-updated to disable updated file checks

         • Retry remove on Windows sharing violation error

       • Cache

         • Flush the memory cache after close

         • Purge file data on notification

         • Always forget parent dir for notifications

         • Integrate with Plex websocket

         • Add rc cache/stats (seuffert)

         • Add info log on notification

       • Box

         • Fix failure reading large directories - parse file/directory size as float

       • Dropbox

         • Fix crypt+obfuscate on dropbox

         • Fix repeatedly uploading the same files

       • FTP

         • Work around strange response from box FTP server

         • More workarounds for FTP servers to fix mkParentDir error

         • Fix no error on listing nonexistent directory

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)

         • Detect bucket presence by listing it - minimises permissions needed

         • Ignore zero length directory markers

       • Google Drive

         • Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)

         • Fix directory move leaving a hardlinked directory behind

         • Return proper google errors when Opening files

         • When  initialized  with a filepath, optional features used incorrect root path (Stefan
           Breunig)

       • HTTP

         • Fix sync for servers which don’t return Content-Length in HEAD

       • Onedrive

         • Add QuickXorHash support for OneDrive for business

         • Fix socket leak in multipart session upload

       • S3

         • Look in S3 named profile files for credentials

         • Add --s3-disable-checksum to disable checksum uploading (Chris Redekop)

         • Hierarchical configuration support (Giri Badanahatti)

         • Add in config for all the supported S3 providers

         • Add One Zone Infrequent Access storage class (Craig Rachel)

         • Add –use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)

         • Add –s3-chunk-size option to control multipart uploads

         • Ignore zero length directory markers

       • SFTP

         • Update docs to match code, fix typos and clarify disable_hashcheck prompt (Michael  G.
           Noll)

         • Update docs with Synology quirks

         • Fail soft with a debug on hash failure

       • Swift

         • Add –use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)

       • Webdav

         • Support SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)

         • Strip leading and trailing / off root

   v1.40 - 2018-03-19
       • New backends

         • Alias backend to create aliases for existing remote names (Fabian Möller)

       • New commands

         • lsf: list for parsing purposes (Jakub Tasiemski)

           • by default this is a simple non recursive list of files and directories

           • it can be configured to add more info in an easy to parse way

         • serve restic: for serving a remote as a Restic REST endpoint

           • This enables restic to use any backends that rclone can access

           • Thanks Alexander Neumann for help, patches and review

         • rc: enable the remote control of a running rclone

           • The running rclone must be started with –rc and related flags.

           • Currently there is support for bwlimit, and flushing for mount and cache.

       • New Features

         • --max-delete flag to add a delete threshold (Bjørn Erik Pedersen)

         • All backends now support RangeOption for ranged Open

           • cat: Use RangeOption for limited fetches to make more efficient

           • cryptcheck: make reading of nonce more efficient with RangeOption

         • serve http/webdav/restic

           • support SSL/TLS

           • add --user --pass and --htpasswd for authentication

         • copy/move: detect file size change during copy/move and abort transfer (ishuah)

         • cryptdecode: added option to return encrypted file names.  (ishuah)

         • lsjson: add --encrypted to show encrypted name (Jakub Tasiemski)

         • Add  --stats-file-name-length  to specify the printed file name length for stats (Will
           Gunn)

       • Compile

         • Code base was shuffled and factored

           • backends moved into a backend directory

           • large packages split up

           • See the CONTRIBUTING.md doc for info as to what lives where now

         • Update to using go1.10 as the default go version

         • Implement daily full integration tests (https://pub.rclone.org/integration-tests/)

       • Release

         • Include a source tarball and sign it and the binaries

         • Sign the git tags as part of the release process

         • Add .deb and .rpm packages as part of the build

         • Make a beta release for all branches on the main repo (but not pull requests)

       • Bug Fixes

         • config: fixes errors on nonexistent config by loading config file only on first access

         • config: retry saving the config after failure (Mateusz)

         • sync: when using --backup-dir don’t delete files if we can’t set their modtime

           • this fixes odd behaviour with Dropbox and --backup-dir

         • fshttp: fix idle timeouts for HTTP connections

         • serve http: fix serving files with : in - fixes

         • Fix --exclude-if-present to ignore directories which it doesn’t  have  permission  for
           (Iakov Davydov)

         • Make accounting work properly with crypt and b2

         • remove --no-traverse flag because it is obsolete

       • Mount

         • Add --attr-timeout flag to control attribute caching in kernel

           • this now defaults to 0 which is correct but less efficient

           • see the mount docs (https://rclone.org/commands/rclone_mount/#attribute-caching) for
             more info

         • Add --daemon flag to allow mount to run in the background (ishuah)

         • Fix: Return ENOSYS rather than EIO on attempted link

           • This fixes FileZilla accessing an rclone mount served over sftp.

         • Fix setting modtime twice

         • Mount tests now run on CI for Linux (mount & cmount)/Mac/Windows

         • Many bugs fixed in the VFS layer - see below

       • VFS

         • Many fixes for --vfs-cache-mode writes and above

           • Update cached copy if we know it has changed (fixes stale data)

           • Clean path names before using them in the cache

           • Disable cache cleaner if --vfs-cache-poll-interval=0

           • Fill and clean the cache immediately on startup

         • Fix Windows opening every file when it stats the file

         • Fix applying modtime for an open Write Handle

         • Fix creation of files when truncating

         • Write 0 bytes when flushing unwritten handles to avoid race conditions in FUSE

         • Downgrade “poll-interval is not supported” message to Info

         • Make OpenFile and friends return EINVAL if O_RDONLY and O_TRUNC

       • Local

         • Downgrade “invalid cross-device link: trying copy” to debug

         • Make DirMove return fs.ErrorCantDirMove to allow fallback to Copy for cross device

         • Fix race conditions updating the hashes

       • Cache

         • Add support for polling - cache will update when remote changes on supported backends

         • Reduce log level for Plex api

         • Fix dir cache issue

         • Implement --cache-db-wait-time flag

         • Improve efficiency with RangeOption and RangeSeek

         • Fix dirmove with temp fs enabled

         • Notify vfs when using temp fs

         • Offline uploading

         • Remote control support for path flushing

       • Amazon cloud drive

         • Rclone no longer has any working keys - disable integration tests

         • Implement DirChangeNotify to notify cache/vfs/mount of changes

       • Azureblob

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

         • Improve accounting for chunked uploads

       • Backblaze B2

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

       • Box

         • Improve accounting for chunked uploads

       • Dropbox

         • Fix custom oauth client parameters

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

       • Google Drive

         • Migrate to api v3 (Fabian Möller)

         • Add scope configuration and root folder selection

         • Add --drive-impersonate for service accounts

           • thanks to everyone who tested, explored and contributed docs

         • Add --drive-use-created-date to use created date as modified date (nbuchanan)

         • Request the export formats only when required

           • This makes rclone quicker when there are no google docs

         • Fix finding paths with latin1 chars (a workaround for a drive bug)

         • Fix copying of a single Google doc file

         • Fix --drive-auth-owner-only to look in all directories

       • HTTP

         • Fix handling of directories with & in

       • Onedrive

         • Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads

           • this stops the creation of multiple versions on business onedrive

         • Overwrite object size value with real size when reading file.  (Victor)

           • this fixes oddities when onedrive misreports the size of images

       • Pcloud

         • Remove unused chunked upload flag and code

       • Qingstor

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

       • S3

         • Support hashes for multipart files (Chris Redekop)

         • Initial support for IBM COS (S3) (Giri Badanahatti)

         • Update docs to discourage use of v2 auth with CEPH and others

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

         • Fix server-side copy and set modtime on files with + in

       • SFTP

         • Add option to disable remote hash check command execution (Jon Fautley)

         • Add --sftp-ask-password flag to prompt for password when needed (Leo R.  Lundgren)

         • Add set_modtime configuration option

         • Fix following of symlinks

         • Fix reading config file outside of Fs setup

         • Fix reading $USER in username fallback not $HOME

         • Fix running under crontab - Use correct OS way of reading username

       • Swift

         • Fix refresh of authentication token

           • in v1.39 a bug was introduced which ignored new tokens - this fixes it

         • Fix extra HEAD transaction when uploading a new file

         • Don’t check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK

           • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation

       • Webdav

         • Add new time formats to support mydrive.ch and others

   v1.39 - 2017-12-23
       • New backends

         • WebDAV

           • tested with nextcloud, owncloud, put.io and others!

         • Pcloud

         • cache - wraps a cache around other backends (Remus Bunduc)

           • useful in combination with mount

           • NB this feature is in beta so use with care

       • New commands

         • serve command with subcommands:

           • serve webdav: this implements a webdav server for any rclone remote.

           • serve http: command to serve a remote over HTTP

         • config: add sub commands for full config file management

           • create/delete/dump/edit/file/password/providers/show/update

         • touch: to create or update the timestamp of a file (Jakub Tasiemski)

       • New Features

         • curl install for rclone (Filip Bartodziej)

         • –stats now shows percentage, size, rate and ETA in condensed form (Ishuah Kariuki)

         • –exclude-if-present to exclude a directory if a file is present (Iakov Davydov)

         • rmdirs: add –leave-root flag (lewapm)

         • move: add –delete-empty-src-dirs flag to remove dirs after move (Ishuah Kariuki)

         • Add –dump flag, introduce –dump requests,  responses  and  remove  –dump-auth,  –dump-
           filters

           • Obscure X-Auth-Token: from headers when dumping too

         • Document and implement exit codes for different failure modes (Ishuah Kariuki)

       • Compile

       • Bug Fixes

         • Retry lots more different types of errors to make multipart transfers more reliable

         • Save the config before asking for a token, fixes disappearing oauth config

         • Warn the user if –include and –exclude are used together (Ernest Borowski)

         • Fix duplicate files (e.g. on Google drive) causing spurious copies

         • Allow trailing and leading whitespace for passwords (Jason Rose)

         • ncdu: fix crashes on empty directories

         • rcat: fix goroutine leak

         • moveto/copyto: Fix to allow copying to the same name

       • Mount

         • –vfs-cache mode to make writes into mounts more reliable.

           • this requires caching files on the disk (see –cache-dir)

           • As this is a new feature, use with care

         • Use sdnotify to signal systemd the mount is ready (Fabian Möller)

         • Check if directory is not empty before mounting (Ernest Borowski)

       • Local

         • Add error message for cross file system moves

         • Fix equality check for times

       • Dropbox

         • Rework multipart upload

           • buffer the chunks when uploading large files so they can be retried

           • change default chunk size to 48MB now we are buffering them in memory

           • retry every error after the first chunk is done successfully

         • Fix error when renaming directories

       • Swift

         • Fix crash on bad authentication

       • Google Drive

         • Add service account support (Tim Cooijmans)

       • S3

         • Make it work properly with Digital Ocean Spaces (Andrew Starr-Bochicchio)

         • Fix crash if a bad listing is received

         • Add support for ECS task IAM roles (David Minor)

       • Backblaze B2

         • Fix multipart upload retries

         • Fix –hard-delete to make it work 100% of the time

       • Swift

         • Allow authentication with storage URL and auth key (Giovanni Pizzi)

         • Add new fields for swift configuration to support IBM Bluemix Swift (Pierre Carlson)

         • Add OS_TENANT_ID and OS_USER_ID to config

         • Allow configs with user id instead of user name

         • Check if swift segments container exists before creating (John Leach)

         • Fix memory leak in swift transfers (upstream fix)

       • SFTP

         • Add option to enable the use of aes128-cbc cipher (Jon Fautley)

       • Amazon cloud drive

         • Fix download of large files failing with “Only one auth mechanism allowed”

       • crypt

         • Option to encrypt directory names or leave them intact

         • Implement DirChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)

       • onedrive

         • Add  option  to  choose  resourceURL during setup of OneDrive Business account if more
           than one is available for user

   v1.38 - 2017-09-30
       • New backends

         • Azure Blob Storage (thanks Andrei Dragomir)

         • Box

         • Onedrive for Business (thanks Oliver Heyme)

         • QingStor from QingCloud (thanks wuyu)

       • New commands

         • rcat - read from standard input and stream upload

         • tree - shows a nicely formatted recursive listing

         • cryptdecode - decode crypted file names (thanks ishuah)

         • config show - print the config file

         • config file - print the config file location

       • New Features

         • Empty directories are deleted on syncdedupe - implement merging of duplicate directories

         • check and cryptcheck made more consistent and use less memory

         • cleanup for remaining remotes (thanks ishuah)

         • --immutable for ensuring that files don’t change (thanks Jacob McNamee)

         • --user-agent option (thanks Alex McGrath Kraak)

         • --disable flag to disable optional features

         • --bind flag for choosing the local addr on outgoing connections

         • Support for zsh auto-completion (thanks bpicode)

         • Stop normalizing file names but do a normalized compare in sync

       • Compile

         • Update to using go1.9 as the default go version

         • Remove snapd build due to maintenance problems

       • Bug Fixes

         • Improve retriable error detection which makes multipart uploads better

         • Make check obey --ignore-size

         • Fix bwlimit toggle in conjunction with schedules (thanks cbruegg)

         • config ensures newly written config is on the same mount

       • Local

         • Revert to copy when moving file across file system boundaries

         • --skip-links to suppress symlink warnings (thanks Zhiming Wang)

       • Mount

         • Re-use rcat internals to support uploads from all remotes

       • Dropbox

         • Fix “entry doesn’t belong in directory” error

         • Stop using deprecated API methods

       • Swift

         • Fix server-side copy to empty container with --fast-list

       • Google Drive

         • Change the default for --drive-use-trash to true

       • S3

         • Set session token when using STS (thanks Girish Ramakrishnan)

         • Glacier docs and error messages (thanks Jan Varho)

         • Read 1000 (not 1024) items in dir listings to fix Wasabi

       • Backblaze B2

         • Fix SHA1 mismatch when downloading files with no SHA1

         • Calculate missing hashes on the fly instead of spooling

         • --b2-hard-delete to permanently delete (not hide) files (thanks John Papandriopoulos)

       • Hubic

         • Fix creating containers - no longer have to use the default container

       • Swift

         • Optionally configure from a standard set of OpenStack environment vars

         • Add endpoint_type config

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix bucket creation to work with limited permission users

       • SFTP

         • Implement connection pooling for multiple ssh connections

         • Limit new connections per second

         • Add support for MD5 and SHA1 hashes where available (thanks Christian Brüggemann)

       • HTTP

         • Fix URL encoding issues

         • Fix directories with : in

         • Fix panic with URL encoded content

   v1.37 - 2017-07-22
       • New backends

         • FTP - thanks to Antonio Messina

         • HTTP - thanks to Vasiliy Tolstov

       • New commands

         • rclone ncdu - for exploring a remote with a text based user interface.

         • rclone lsjson - for listing with a machine-readable output

         • rclone dbhashsum - to show Dropbox style hashes of files (local or Dropbox)

       • New Features

         • Implement –fast-list flag

           • This allows remotes to list recursively if they can

           • This uses less transactions (important if you pay for them)

           • This may or may not be quicker

           • This will use more memory as it has to hold the listing in memory

           • –old-sync-method deprecated - the remaining uses are covered by –fast-list

           • This involved a major re-write of all the listing code

         • Add –tpslimit and –tpslimit-burst to limit transactions per second

           • this is useful in conjunction with rclone mount to limit external apps

         • Add –stats-log-level so can see –stats without -v

         • Print password prompts to stderr - Hraban Luyat

         • Warn about duplicate files when syncing

         • Oauth improvements

           • allow auth_url and token_url to be set in the config file

           • Print redirection URI if using own credentials.

         • Don’t Mkdir at the start of sync to save transactions

       • Compile

         • Update build to go1.8.3

         • Require go1.6 for building rclone

         • Compile 386 builds with “GO386=387” for maximum compatibility

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix menu selection when no remotes

         • Config saving reworked to not kill the file if disk gets full

         • Don’t delete remote if name does not change while renaming

         • moveto, copyto: report transfers and checks as per move and copy

       • Local

         • Add –local-no-unicode-normalization flag - Bob Potter

       • Mount

         • Now supported on Windows using cgofuse and WinFsp - thanks to Bill  Zissimopoulos  for
           much help

         • Compare checksums on upload/download via FUSE

         • Unmount when program ends with SIGINT (Ctrl+C) or SIGTERM - Jérôme Vizcaino

         • On read only open of file, make open pending until first read

         • Make –read-only reject modify operations

         • Implement ModTime via FUSE for remotes that support it

         • Allow modTime to be changed even before all writers are closed

         • Fix panic on renames

         • Fix hang on errored upload

       • Crypt

         • Report the name:root as specified by the user

         • Add an “obfuscate” option for filename encryption - Stephen Harris

       • Amazon Drive

         • Fix initialization order for token renewer

         • Remove revoked credentials, allow oauth proxy config and update docs

       • B2

         • Reduce minimum chunk size to 5MB

       • Drive

         • Add team drive support

         • Reduce bandwidth by adding fields for partial responses - Martin Kristensen

         • Implement –drive-shared-with-me flag to view shared with me files - Danny Tsai

         • Add –drive-trashed-only to read only the files in the trash

         • Remove obsolete –drive-full-list

         • Add missing seek to start on retries of chunked uploads

         • Fix stats accounting for upload

         • Convert / in names to a unicode equivalent (/)

         • Poll for Google Drive changes when mounted

       • OneDrive

         • Fix the uploading of files with spaces

         • Fix initialization order for token renewer

         • Display speeds accurately when uploading - Yoni Jah

         • Swap to using http://localhost:53682/ as redirect URL - Michael Ledin

         • Retry on token expired error, reset upload body on retry - Yoni Jah

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Add ability to specify location and storage class via config and command line - thanks
           gdm85

         • Create container if necessary on server-side copy

         • Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance

         • Obtain a refresh token for GCS - Steven Lu

       • Yandex

         • Fix the name reported in log messages (was empty)

         • Correct error return for listing empty directory

       • Dropbox

         • Rewritten to use the v2 API

           • Now supports ModTime

             • Can only set by uploading the file again

             • If you uploaded with an old rclone, rclone may upload everything again

             • Use --size-only or --checksum to avoid this

           • Now supports the Dropbox content hashing scheme

           • Now supports low level retries

       • S3

         • Work around eventual consistency in bucket creation

         • Create container if necessary on server-side copy

         • Add us-east-2 (Ohio) and eu-west-2 (London) S3 regions - Zahiar Ahmed

       • Swift, Hubic

         • Fix zero length directory markers showing in the subdirectory listing

           • this caused lots of duplicate transfers

         • Fix paged directory listings

           • this caused duplicate directory errors

         • Create container if necessary on server-side copy

         • Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance

         • Make sensible error if the user forgets the container

       • SFTP

         • Add support for using ssh key files

         • Fix under Windows

         • Fix ssh agent on Windows

         • Adapt to latest version of library - Igor Kharin

   v1.36 - 2017-03-18
       • New Features

         • SFTP remote (Jack Schmidt)

         • Re-implement sync routine to work a directory at a time reducing memory usage

         • Logging revamped to be more inline with rsync - now  much  quieter  *  -v  only  shows
           transfers * -vv is for full debug * –syslog to log to syslog on capable platforms

         • Implement –backup-dir and –suffix

         • Implement –track-renames (initial implementation by Bjørn Erik Pedersen)

         • Add time-based bandwidth limits (Lukas Loesche)

         • rclone cryptcheck: checks integrity of crypt remotes

         • Allow all config file variables and options to be set from environment variables

         • Add –buffer-size parameter to control buffer size for copy

         • Make –delete-after the default

         • Add –ignore-checksum flag (fixed by Hisham Zarka)

         • rclone check: Add –download flag to check all the data, not just hashes

         • rclone cat: add –head, –tail, –offset, –count and –discard

         • rclone config: when choosing from a list, allow the value to be entered too

         • rclone config: allow rename and copy of remotes

         • rclone   obscure:  for  generating  encrypted  passwords  for  rclone’s  config  (T.C.
           Ferguson)

         • Comply with XDG Base Directory specification (Dario Giovannetti)

           • this moves the default location of the config file in a backwards compatible way

         • Release changes

           • Ubuntu snap support (Dedsec1)

           • Compile with go 1.8

           • MIPS/Linux big and little endian support

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix copyto copying things to the wrong place if the destination dir didn’t exist

         • Fix parsing of remotes in moveto and copyto

         • Fix –delete-before deleting files on copy

         • Fix –files-from with an empty file copying everything

         • Fix sync: don’t update mod times if –dry-run set

         • Fix MimeType propagation

         • Fix filters to add ** rules to directory rules

       • Local

         • Implement -L, –copy-links flag to allow rclone to follow symlinks

         • Open files in write only mode so rclone can write to an rclone mount

         • Fix unnormalised unicode causing problems reading directories

         • Fix interaction between -x flag and –max-depth

       • Mount

         • Implement proper directory handling (mkdir, rmdir, renaming)

         • Make include and exclude filters apply to mount

         • Implement read and write async buffers - control with –buffer-size

         • Fix fsync on for directories

         • Fix retry on network failure when reading off crypt

       • Crypt

         • Add –crypt-show-mapping to show encrypted file mapping

         • Fix crypt writer getting stuck in a loop

           • IMPORTANT this bug had the potential to cause data corruption when

             • reading data from a network based remote and

             • writing to a crypt on Google Drive

           • Use the cryptcheck command to validate your data if you are concerned

           • If syncing two crypt remotes, sync the unencrypted remote

       • Amazon Drive

         • Fix panics on Move (rename)

         • Fix panic on token expiry

       • B2

         • Fix inconsistent listings and rclone check

         • Fix uploading empty files with go1.8

         • Constrain memory usage when doing multipart uploads

         • Fix upload url not being refreshed properly

       • Drive

         • Fix Rmdir on directories with trashed files

         • Fix “Ignoring unknown object” when downloading

         • Add –drive-list-chunk

         • Add –drive-skip-gdocs (Károly Oláh)

       • OneDrive

         • Implement Move

         • Fix Copy

           • Fix overwrite detection in Copy

           • Fix waitForJob to parse errors correctly

         • Use token renewer to stop auth errors on long uploads

         • Fix uploading empty files with go1.8

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Fix depth 1 directory listings

       • Yandex

         • Fix single level directory listing

       • Dropbox

         • Normalise the case for single level directory listings

         • Fix depth 1 listing

       • S3

         • Added ca-central-1 region (Jon Yergatian)

   v1.35 - 2017-01-02
       • New Features

         • moveto and copyto commands for choosing a destination name on copy/move

         • rmdirs command to recursively delete empty directories

         • Allow repeated –include/–exclude/–filter options

         • Only show transfer stats on commands which transfer stuff

           • show stats on any command using the --stats flag

         • Allow overlapping directories in move when server-side dir move is supported

         • Add –stats-unit option - thanks Scott McGillivray

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix the config file being overwritten when two rclone instances are running

         • Make rclone lsd obey the filters properly

         • Fix compilation on mips

         • Fix not transferring files that don’t differ in size

         • Fix panic on nil retry/fatal error

       • Mount

         • Retry reads on error - should help with reliability a lot

         • Report the modification times for directories from the remote

         • Add bandwidth accounting and limiting (fixes –bwlimit)

         • If –stats provided will show stats and which files are transferring

         • Support R/W files if truncate is set.

         • Implement statfs interface so df works

         • Note that write is now supported on Amazon Drive

         • Report number of blocks in a file - thanks Stefan Breunig

       • Crypt

         • Prevent the user pointing crypt at itself

         • Fix failed to authenticate decrypted block errors

           • these will now return the underlying unexpected EOF instead

       • Amazon Drive

         • Add support for server-side move and directory move - thanks Stefan Breunig

         • Fix nil pointer deref on size attribute

       • B2

         • Use new prefix and delimiter parameters in directory listings

           • This makes –max-depth 1 dir listings as used in mount much faster

         • Reauth the account while doing uploads too - should help with token expiry

       • Drive

         • Make DirMove more efficient and complain about moving the root

         • Create destination directory on Move()

   v1.34 - 2016-11-06
       • New Features

         • Stop single file and --files-from operations iterating through the source bucket.

         • Stop removing failed upload to cloud storage remotes

         • Make ContentType be preserved for cloud to cloud copies

         • Add support to toggle bandwidth limits via SIGUSR2 - thanks Marco Paganini

         • rclone check shows count of hashes that couldn’t be checked

         • rclone listremotes command

         • Support linux/arm64 build - thanks Fredrik Fornwall

         • Remove Authorization: lines from --dump-headers output

       • Bug Fixes

         • Ignore files with control characters in the names

         • Fix rclone move command

           • Delete src files which already existed in dst

           • Fix deletion of src file when dst file older

         • Fix rclone check on crypted file systems

         • Make failed uploads not count as “Transferred”

         • Make sure high level retries show with -q

         • Use a vendor directory with godep for repeatable builds

       • rclone mount - FUSE

         • Implement FUSE mount options

           • --no-modtime, --debug-fuse, --read-only, --allow-non-empty,  --allow-root,  --allow-
             other--default-permissions, --write-back-cache, --max-read-ahead, --umask, --uid, --gid

         • Add --dir-cache-time to control caching of directory entries

         • Implement seek for files opened for read (useful for video players)

           • with -no-seek flag to disable

         • Fix crash on 32 bit ARM (alignment of 64 bit counter)

         • ...and many more internal fixes and improvements!

       • Crypt

         • Don’t show encrypted password in configurator to stop confusion

       • Amazon Drive

         • New wait for upload option --acd-upload-wait-per-gb

           • upload timeouts scale by file size and can be disabled

         • Add 502 Bad Gateway to list of errors we retry

         • Fix overwriting a file with a zero length file

         • Fix ACD file size warning limit - thanks Felix Bünemann

       • Local

         • Unix: implement -x/--one-file-system to stay on a single file system

           • thanks Durval Menezes and Luiz Carlos Rumbelsperger Viana

         • Windows: ignore the symlink bit on files

         • Windows: Ignore directory-based junction points

       • B2

         • Make sure each upload has at least one upload slot - fixes strange upload stats

         • Fix uploads when using crypt

         • Fix download of large files (sha1 mismatch)

         • Return error when we try to create a bucket which someone else owns

         • Update B2 docs with Data usage, and Crypt section - thanks Tomasz Mazur

       • S3

         • Command line and config file support for

           • Setting/overriding ACL - thanks Radek Šenfeld

           • Setting storage class - thanks Asko Tamm

       • Drive

         • Make exponential backoff work exactly as per Google specification

         • add .epub, .odp and .tsv as export formats.

       • Swift

         • Don’t read metadata for directory marker objects

   v1.33 - 2016-08-24
       • New Features

         • Implement encryption

           • data encrypted in NACL secretbox format

           • with optional file name encryption

         • New commands

           • rclone mount - implements FUSE mounting of remotes (EXPERIMENTAL)

             • works on Linux, FreeBSD and OS X (need testers for the last 2!)

           • rclone cat - outputs remote file or files to the terminal

           • rclone genautocomplete - command to make a bash completion script for rclone

         • Editing a remote using rclone config now goes through the wizard

         • Compile with go 1.7 - this fixes rclone on macOS Sierra and on 386 processors

         • Use cobra for sub commands and docs generation

       • drive

         • Document how to make your own client_id

       • s3

         • User-configurable Amazon S3 ACL (thanks Radek Šenfeld)

       • b2

         • Fix stats accounting for upload - no more jumping to 100% done

         • On cleanup delete hide marker if it is the current file

         • New B2 API endpoint (thanks Per Cederberg)

         • Set maximum backoff to 5 Minutes

       • onedrive

         • Fix URL escaping in file names - e.g. uploading files with + in them.

       • amazon cloud drive

         • Fix token expiry during large uploads

         • Work around 408 REQUEST_TIMEOUT and 504 GATEWAY_TIMEOUT errors

       • local

         • Fix filenames with invalid UTF-8 not being uploaded

         • Fix problem with some UTF-8 characters on OS X

   v1.32 - 2016-07-13
       • Backblaze B2

         • Fix upload of files large files not in root

   v1.31 - 2016-07-13
       • New Features

         • Reduce memory on sync by about 50%

         • Implement –no-traverse flag to stop copy traversing the destination remote.

           • This can be used to reduce memory usage down to the smallest possible.

           • Useful to copy a small number of files into a large destination folder.

         • Implement cleanup command for emptying trash / removing old versions of files

           • Currently B2 only

         • Single file handling improved

           • Now copied with –files-from

           • Automatically sets –no-traverse when copying a single file

         • Info on using installing with ansible - thanks Stefan Weichinger

         • Implement –no-update-modtime flag to stop rclone fixing the remote modified times.

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix move command - stop it running for overlapping Fses - this was causing data loss.

       • Local

         • Fix incomplete hashes - this was causing problems for B2.

       • Amazon Drive

         • Rename Amazon Cloud Drive to Amazon Drive - no changes to config file needed.

       • Swift

         • Add support for non-default project domain - thanks Antonio Messina.

       • S3

         • Add instructions on how to use rclone with minio.

         • Add ap-northeast-2 (Seoul) and ap-south-1 (Mumbai) regions.

         • Skip setting the modified time for objects > 5GB as it isn’t possible.

       • Backblaze B2

         • Add –b2-versions flag so old versions can be listed and retrieved.

         • Treat 403 errors (e.g. cap exceeded) as fatal.

         • Implement cleanup command for deleting old file versions.

         • Make error handling compliant with B2 integrations notes.

         • Fix handling of token expiry.

         • Implement –b2-test-mode to set X-Bz-Test-Mode header.

         • Set cutoff for chunked upload to 200MB as per B2 guidelines.

         • Make upload multi-threaded.

       • Dropbox

         • Don’t retry 461 errors.

   v1.30 - 2016-06-18
       • New Features

         • Directory  listing  code reworked for more features and better error reporting (thanks
           to Klaus Post for help).  This enables

           • Directory include filtering for efficiency

           • –max-depth parameter

           • Better error reporting

           • More to come

         • Retry more errors

         • Add –ignore-size flag - for uploading images to onedrive

         • Log -v output to stdout by default

         • Display the transfer stats in more human-readable form

         • Make 0 size files specifiable with --max-size 0b

         • Add b suffix so we can specify bytes in –bwlimit, –min-size, etc.

         • Use “password:” instead of “password>” prompt - thanks Klaus Post and Leigh Klotz

       • Bug Fixes

         • Fix retry doing one too many retries

       • Local

         • Fix problems with OS X and UTF-8 characters

       • Amazon Drive

         • Check a file exists before uploading to help with 408 Conflict errors

         • Reauth on 401 errors - this has been causing a lot of problems

         • Work around spurious 403 errors

         • Restart directory listings on error

       • Google Drive

         • Check a file exists before uploading to help with duplicates

         • Fix retry of multipart uploads

       • Backblaze B2

         • Implement large file uploading

       • S3

         • Add AES256 server-side encryption for - thanks Justin R.  Wilson

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Make sure we don’t use conflicting content types on upload

         • Add service account support - thanks Michal Witkowski

       • Swift

         • Add auth version parameter

         • Add domain option for openstack (v3 auth) - thanks Fabian Ruff

   v1.29 - 2016-04-18
       • New Features

         • Implement -I, --ignore-times for unconditional upload

         • Improve dedupecommand

           • Now removes identical copies without asking

           • Now obeys --dry-run

           • Implement --dedupe-mode for non interactive running

             • --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive the default.

             • --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.

             • --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.

             • --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.

             • --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.

             • --dedupe-mode rename - removes  identical  files  then  renames  the  rest  to  be
               different.

       • Bug fixes

         • Make rclone check obey the --size-only flag.

         • Use “application/octet-stream” if discovered mime type is invalid.

         • Fix missing “quit” option when there are no remotes.

       • Google Drive

         • Increase default chunk size to 8 MB - increases upload speed of big files

         • Speed up directory listings and make more reliable

         • Add missing retries for Move and DirMove - increases reliability

         • Preserve mime type on file update

       • Backblaze B2

         • Enable mod time syncing

           • This means that B2 will now check modification times

           • It will upload new files to update the modification times

           • (there isn’t an API to just set the mod time.)

           • If you want the old behaviour use --size-only.

         • Update API to new version

         • Fix parsing of mod time when not in metadata

       • Swift/Hubic

         • Don’t return an MD5SUM for static large objects

       • S3

         • Fix uploading files bigger than 50GB

   v1.28 - 2016-03-01
       • New Features

         • Configuration file encryption - thanks Klaus Post

         • Improve rclone config adding more help and making it easier to understand

         • Implement -u/--update so creation times can be used on all remotes

         • Implement --low-level-retries flag

         • Optionally disable gzip compression on downloads with --no-gzip-encoding

       • Bug fixes

         • Don’t make directories if --dry-run set

         • Fix and document the move command

         • Fix redirecting stderr on unix-like OSes when using --log-file

         • Fix delete command to wait until all finished - fixes missing deletes.

       • Backblaze B2

         • Use one upload URL per go routine fixes more than one upload using auth token

         • Add pacing, retries and reauthentication - fixes token expiry problems

         • Upload without using a temporary file from local (and remotes which support SHA1)

         • Fix reading metadata for all files when it shouldn’t have been

       • Drive

         • Fix listing drive documents at root

         • Disable copy and move for Google docs

       • Swift

         • Fix uploading of chunked files with non ASCII characters

         • Allow setting of storage_url in the config - thanks Xavier Lucas

       • S3

         • Allow IAM role and credentials from environment variables - thanks Brian Stengaard

         • Allow  low privilege users to use S3 (check if directory exists during Mkdir) - thanks
           Jakub Gedeon

       • Amazon Drive

         • Retry on more things to make directory listings more reliable

   v1.27 - 2016-01-31
       • New Features

         • Easier headless configuration with rclone authorize

         • Add support for multiple hash types - we now check SHA1 as well as MD5 hashes.

         • delete command which does obey the filters (unlike purge)

         • dedupe command to deduplicate a remote.  Useful with Google Drive.

         • Add --ignore-existing flag to skip all files that exist on destination.

         • Add --delete-before, --delete-during, --delete-after flags.

         • Add --memprofile flag to debug memory use.

         • Warn the user about files with same name but different case

         • Make --include rules add their implicit exclude * at the end of the filter list

         • Deprecate compiling with go1.3

       • Amazon Drive

         • Fix download of files > 10 GB

         • Fix directory traversal (“Next token is expired”) for large directory listings

         • Remove 409 conflict from error codes we will retry - stops very long pauses

       • Backblaze B2

         • SHA1 hashes now checked by rclone core

       • Drive

         • Add --drive-auth-owner-only to only consider files owned by the user  -  thanks  Björn
           Harrtell

         • Export Google documents

       • Dropbox

         • Make file exclusion error controllable with -q

       • Swift

         • Fix upload from unprivileged user.

       • S3

         • Fix updating of mod times of files with + in.

       • Local

         • Add local file system option to disable UNC on Windows.

   v1.26 - 2016-01-02
       • New Features

         • Yandex storage backend - thank you Dmitry Burdeev (“dibu”)

         • Implement Backblaze B2 storage backend

         • Add –min-age and –max-age flags - thank you Adriano Aurélio Meirelles

         • Make ls/lsl/md5sum/size/check obey includes and excludes

       • Fixes

         • Fix crash in http logging

         • Upload releases to github too

       • Swift

         • Fix sync for chunked files

       • OneDrive

         • Re-enable server-side copy

         • Don’t mask HTTP error codes with JSON decode error

       • S3

         • Fix corrupting Content-Type on mod time update (thanks Joseph Spurrier)

   v1.25 - 2015-11-14
       • New features

         • Implement Hubic storage system

       • Fixes

         • Fix deletion of some excluded files without –delete-excluded

           • This could have deleted files unexpectedly on sync

           • Always check first with --dry-run!

       • Swift

         • Stop SetModTime losing metadata (e.g. X-Object-Manifest)

           • This could have caused data loss for files > 5GB in size

         • Use ContentType from Object to avoid lookups in listings

       • OneDrive

         • disable server-side copy as it seems to be broken at Microsoft

   v1.24 - 2015-11-07
       • New features

         • Add support for Microsoft OneDrive

         • Add --no-check-certificate option to disable server certificate verification

         • Add async readahead buffer for faster transfer of big files

       • Fixes

         • Allow spaces in remotes and check remote names for validity at creation time

         • Allow `&' and disallow `:' in Windows filenames.

       • Swift

         • Ignore directory marker objects where appropriate - allows working with Hubic

         • Don’t delete the container if fs wasn’t at root

       • S3

         • Don’t delete the bucket if fs wasn’t at root

       • Google Cloud Storage

         • Don’t delete the bucket if fs wasn’t at root

   v1.23 - 2015-10-03
       • New features

         • Implement rclone size for measuring remotes

       • Fixes

         • Fix headless config for drive and gcs

         • Tell the user they should try again if the webserver method failed

         • Improve output of --dump-headers

       • S3

         • Allow anonymous access to public buckets

       • Swift

         • Stop chunked operations logging “Failed to read info: Object Not Found”

         • Use Content-Length on uploads for extra reliability

   v1.22 - 2015-09-28
       • Implement rsync like include and exclude flags

       • swift

         • Support files > 5GB - thanks Sergey Tolmachev

   v1.21 - 2015-09-22
       • New features

         • Display individual transfer progress

         • Make lsl output times in localtime

       • Fixes

         • Fix allowing user to override credentials again in Drive, GCS and ACD

       • Amazon Drive

         • Implement compliant pacing scheme

       • Google Drive

         • Make directory reads concurrent for increased speed.

   v1.20 - 2015-09-15
       • New features

         • Amazon Drive support

         • Oauth support redone - fix many bugs and improve usability

           • Use “golang.org/x/oauth2” as oauth library of choice

           • Improve oauth usability for smoother initial signup

           • drive, googlecloudstorage: optionally use auto config for the oauth token

         • Implement –dump-headers and –dump-bodies debug flags

         • Show multiple matched commands if abbreviation too short

         • Implement server-side move where possible

       • local

         • Always use UNC paths internally on Windows - fixes a lot of bugs

       • dropbox

         • force use of our custom transport which makes timeouts work

       • Thanks to Klaus Post for lots of help with this release

   v1.19 - 2015-08-28
       • New features

         • Server side copies for s3/swift/drive/dropbox/gcs

         • Move command - uses server-side copies if it can

         • Implement –retries flag - tries 3 times by default

         • Build for plan9/amd64 and solaris/amd64 too

       • Fixes

         • Make a current version download with a fixed URL for scripting

         • Ignore rmdir in limited fs rather than throwing error

       • dropbox

         • Increase chunk size to improve upload speeds massively

         • Issue an error message when trying to upload bad file name

   v1.18 - 2015-08-17
       • drive

         • Add --drive-use-trash flag so rclone trashes instead of deletes

         • Add “Forbidden to download” message for files with no downloadURL

       • dropbox

         • Remove datastore

           • This was deprecated and it caused a lot of problems

           • Modification times and MD5SUMs no longer stored

         • Fix uploading files > 2GB

       • s3

         • use official AWS SDK from github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go

         • NB will most likely require you to delete and recreate remote

         • enable multipart upload which enables files > 5GB

         • tested with Ceph / RadosGW / S3 emulation

         • many  thanks  to  Sam Liston and Brian Haymore at the Utah Center for High Performance
           Computing (https://www.chpc.utah.edu/) for a Ceph test account

       • misc

         • Show errors when reading the config file

         • Do not print stats in quiet mode - thanks Leonid Shalupov

         • Add FAQ

         • Fix created directories not obeying umask

         • Linux installation instructions - thanks Shimon Doodkin

   v1.17 - 2015-06-14
       • dropbox: fix case insensitivity issues - thanks Leonid Shalupov

   v1.16 - 2015-06-09
       • Fix uploading big files which was causing timeouts or panics

       • Don’t check md5sum after download with –size-only

   v1.15 - 2015-06-06
       • Add –checksum flag to only discard transfers by MD5SUM - thanks Alex Couper

       • Implement –size-only flag to sync on size not checksum & modtime

       • Expand docs and remove duplicated information

       • Document rclone’s limitations with directories

       • dropbox: update docs about case insensitivity

   v1.14 - 2015-05-21
       • local: fix encoding of non utf-8 file names - fixes a duplicate file problem

       • drive: docs about rate limiting

       • google cloud storage: Fix compile after API change in “google.golang.org/api/storage/v1”

   v1.13 - 2015-05-10
       • Revise documentation (especially sync)

       • Implement –timeout and –conntimeout

       • s3: ignore etags from multipart uploads which aren’t md5sums

   v1.12 - 2015-03-15
       • drive: Use chunked upload for files above a certain size

       • drive: add –drive-chunk-size and –drive-upload-cutoff parameters

       • drive: switch to insert from update when a failed copy deletes the upload

       • core: Log duplicate files if they are detected

   v1.11 - 2015-03-04
       • swift: add region parameter

       • drive: fix crash on failed to update remote mtime

       • In remote paths, change native directory separators to /

       • Add synchronization to ls/lsl/lsd output to stop corruptions

       • Ensure all stats/log messages to go stderr

       • Add –log-file flag to log everything (including panics) to file

       • Make it possible to disable stats printing with –stats=0

       • Implement –bwlimit to limit data transfer bandwidth

   v1.10 - 2015-02-12
       • s3: list an unlimited number of items

       • Fix getting stuck in the configurator

   v1.09 - 2015-02-07
       • windows: Stop drive letters (e.g. C:) getting mixed up with remotes (e.g. drive:)

       • local: Fix directory separators on Windows

       • drive: fix rate limit exceeded errors

   v1.08 - 2015-02-04
       • drive: fix subdirectory listing to not list entire drive

       • drive: Fix SetModTime

       • dropbox: adapt code to recent library changes

   v1.07 - 2014-12-23
       • google cloud storage: fix memory leak

   v1.06 - 2014-12-12
       • Fix “Couldn’t find home directory” on OSX

       • swift: Add tenant parameter

       • Use new location of Google API packages

   v1.05 - 2014-08-09
       • Improved tests and consequently lots of minor fixes

       • core: Fix race detected by go race detector

       • core: Fixes after running errcheck

       • drive: reset root directory on Rmdir and Purge

       • fs: Document that Purger returns error on empty directory, test and fix

       • google cloud storage: fix ListDir on subdirectory

       • google cloud storage: re-read metadata in SetModTime

       • s3: make reading metadata more reliable to work around eventual consistency problems

       • s3: strip trailing / from ListDir()

       • swift: return directories without / in ListDir

   v1.04 - 2014-07-21
       • google cloud storage: Fix crash on Update

   v1.03 - 2014-07-20
       • swift, s3, dropbox: fix updated files being marked as corrupted

       • Make compile with go 1.1 again

   v1.02 - 2014-07-19
       • Implement Dropbox remote

       • Implement Google Cloud Storage remote

       • Verify Md5sums and Sizes after copies

       • Remove times from “ls” command - lists sizes only

       • Add add “lsl” - lists times and sizes

       • Add “md5sum” command

   v1.01 - 2014-07-04
       • drive: fix transfer of big files using up lots of memory

   v1.00 - 2014-07-03
       • drive: fix whole second dates

   v0.99 - 2014-06-26
       • Fix –dry-run not working

       • Make compatible with go 1.1

   v0.98 - 2014-05-30
       • s3: Treat missing Content-Length as 0 for some ceph installations

       • rclonetest: add file with a space in

   v0.97 - 2014-05-05
       • Implement copying of single files

       • s3 & swift: support paths inside containers/buckets

   v0.96 - 2014-04-24
       • drive: Fix multiple files of same name being created

       • drive: Use o.Update and fs.Put to optimise transfers

       • Add version number, -V and –version

   v0.95 - 2014-03-28
       • rclone.org: website, docs and graphics

       • drive: fix path parsing

   v0.94 - 2014-03-27
       • Change remote format one last time

       • GNU style flags

   v0.93 - 2014-03-16
       • drive: store token in config file

       • cross compile other versions

       • set strict permissions on config file

   v0.92 - 2014-03-15
       • Config fixes and –config option

   v0.91 - 2014-03-15
       • Make config file

   v0.90 - 2013-06-27
       • Project named rclone

   v0.00 - 2012-11-18
       • Project started

Bugs and Limitations

   Limitations
   Directory timestamps aren’t preserved
       Rclone doesn’t currently preserve the timestamps of directories.  This is  because  rclone
       only really considers objects when syncing.

   Rclone struggles with millions of files in a directory/bucket
       Currently  rclone loads each directory/bucket entirely into memory before using it.  Since
       each rclone object takes 0.5k-1k of memory this can take a very long time and use a  large
       amount of memory.

       Millions  of files in a directory tends to occur on bucket-based remotes (e.g. S3 buckets)
       since those remotes do not segregate subdirectories within the bucket.

   Bucket-based remotes and folders
       Bucket-based remotes (e.g. S3/GCS/Swift/B2) do not have a concept of directories.   Rclone
       therefore  cannot  create  directories  in  them  which  means that empty directories on a
       bucket-based remote will tend to disappear.

       Some software creates empty keys ending in / as directory markers.  Rclone doesn’t do this
       as  it  potentially creates more objects and costs more.  This ability may be added in the
       future (probably via a flag/option).

   Bugs
       Bugs are stored in rclone’s GitHub project:

       • Reported                                                                            bugs
         (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+label%3Abug)

       • Known                                                                             issues
         (https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues?q=is%3Aopen+is%3Aissue+milestone%3A%22Known+Problem%22)

Frequently Asked Questions

   Do all cloud storage systems support all rclone commands
       Yes they do.  All the rclone commands (e.g. sync, copy, etc.)  will work on all the remote
       storage systems.

   Can I copy the config from one machine to another
       Sure!  Rclone stores all of its config in a single file.  If you want to find  this  file,
       run rclone config file which will tell you where it is.

       See the remote setup docs (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/) for more info.

   How do I configure rclone on a remote / headless box with no browser?
       This     has     now     been    documented    in    its    own    remote    setup    page
       (https://rclone.org/remote_setup/).

   Can rclone sync directly from drive to s3
       Rclone can sync between two remote cloud storage systems just fine.

       Note that it effectively downloads the file and uploads it  again,  so  the  node  running
       rclone would need to have lots of bandwidth.

       The syncs would be incremental (on a file by file basis).

       e.g.

              rclone sync -i drive:Folder s3:bucket

   Using rclone from multiple locations at the same time
       You  can  use  rclone  from  multiple  places  at  the  same  time if you choose different
       subdirectory for the output, e.g.

              Server A> rclone sync -i /tmp/whatever remote:ServerA
              Server B> rclone sync -i /tmp/whatever remote:ServerB

       If you sync to the same directory then you  should  use  rclone  copy  otherwise  the  two
       instances of rclone may delete each other’s files, e.g.

              Server A> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup
              Server B> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup

       The  file  names  you  upload from Server A and Server B should be different in this case,
       otherwise some file systems (e.g. Drive) may make duplicates.

   Why doesn’t rclone support partial transfers / binary diffs like rsync?
       Rclone stores each file you transfer as a  native  object  on  the  remote  cloud  storage
       system.   This  means  that you can see the files you upload as expected using alternative
       access methods (e.g. using the Google Drive  web  interface).   There  is  a  1:1  mapping
       between files on your hard disk and objects created in the cloud storage system.

       Cloud  storage  systems  (at  least  none  I’ve  come  across yet) don’t support partially
       uploading an object.  You can’t take an existing object, and  change  some  bytes  in  the
       middle of it.

       It  would  be  possible  to  make a sync system which stored binary diffs instead of whole
       objects like rclone does, but that would break the 1:1 mapping of files on your hard  disk
       to objects in the remote cloud storage system.

       All  the  cloud  storage  systems  support  partial  downloads  of content, so it would be
       possible to make partial downloads work.  However to make this work efficiently this would
       require  storing a significant amount of metadata, which breaks the desired 1:1 mapping of
       files to objects.

   Can rclone do bi-directional sync?
       Yes, since  rclone  v1.58.0,  bidirectional  cloud  sync  (https://rclone.org/bisync/)  is
       available.

   Can I use rclone with an HTTP proxy?
       Yes.   rclone  will follow the standard environment variables for proxies, similar to cURL
       and other programs.

       In general the variables are called  http_proxy  (for  services  reached  over  http)  and
       https_proxy  (for services reached over https).  Most public services will be using https,
       but you may wish to set both.

       The content of the variable is protocol://server:port.  The protocol value is the one used
       to talk to the proxy server, itself, and is commonly either http or socks5.

       Slightly  annoyingly,  there  is  no  standard  for  the  name;  some applications may use
       http_proxy but another one HTTP_PROXY.  The Go libraries used  by  rclone  will  try  both
       variations,  but you may wish to set all possibilities.  So, on Linux, you may end up with
       code similar to

              export http_proxy=http://proxyserver:12345
              export https_proxy=$http_proxy
              export HTTP_PROXY=$http_proxy
              export HTTPS_PROXY=$http_proxy

       Note: If the proxy server requires a username and password, then use

              export http_proxy=http://username:password@proxyserver:12345
              export https_proxy=$http_proxy
              export HTTP_PROXY=$http_proxy
              export HTTPS_PROXY=$http_proxy

       The NO_PROXY allows you to disable the proxy for specific  hosts.   Hosts  must  be  comma
       separated,  and  can  contain  domains  or  parts.   For  instance  “foo.com” also matches
       “bar.foo.com”.

       e.g.

              export no_proxy=localhost,127.0.0.0/8,my.host.name
              export NO_PROXY=$no_proxy

       Note that the FTP backend does not support ftp_proxy yet.

   Rclone gives x509: failed to load system roots and no roots provided error
       This means that rclone can’t find the SSL  root  certificates.   Likely  you  are  running
       rclone on a NAS with a cut-down Linux OS, or possibly on Solaris.

       Rclone  (via  the  Go  runtime)  tries  to load the root certificates from these places on
       Linux.

              "/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt", // Debian/Ubuntu/Gentoo etc.
              "/etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt",   // Fedora/RHEL
              "/etc/ssl/ca-bundle.pem",             // OpenSUSE
              "/etc/pki/tls/cacert.pem",            // OpenELEC

       So doing something like this should fix the problem.  It  also  sets  the  time  which  is
       important for SSL to work properly.

              mkdir -p /etc/ssl/certs/
              curl -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt
              ntpclient -s -h pool.ntp.org

       The  two  environment  variables  SSL_CERT_FILE  and  SSL_CERT_DIR,  mentioned in the x509
       package (https://godoc.org/crypto/x509), provide an additional way to provide the SSL root
       certificates.

       Note that you may need to add the --insecure option to the curl command line if it doesn’t
       work without.

              curl --insecure -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt

   Rclone gives Failed to load config file: function not implemented error
       Likely this means that you are running rclone on Linux version not  supported  by  the  go
       runtime, ie earlier than version 2.6.23.

       See     the     system     requirements     section     in    the    go    install    docs
       (https://golang.org/doc/install) for full details.

   All my uploaded docx/xlsx/pptx files appear as archive/zip
       This is caused by uploading these files from a  Windows  computer  which  hasn’t  got  the
       Microsoft  Office  suite  installed.  The easiest way to fix is to install the Word viewer
       and the Microsoft Office Compatibility Pack for Word, Excel, and PowerPoint 2007 and later
       versions’ file formats

   tcp lookup some.domain.com no such host
       This  happens  when  rclone  cannot resolve a domain.  Please check that your DNS setup is
       generally working, e.g.

              # both should print a long list of possible IP addresses
              dig www.googleapis.com          # resolve using your default DNS
              dig www.googleapis.com @8.8.8.8 # resolve with Google's DNS server

       If you are using systemd-resolved (default on Arch Linux), ensure it is at version 233  or
       higher.   Previous  releases  contain  a  bug  which causes not all domains to be resolved
       properly.

       Additionally with the GODEBUG=netdns= environment variable the Go resolver decision can be
       influenced.  This also allows to resolve certain issues with DNS resolution.  See the name
       resolution section in the go docs (https://golang.org/pkg/net/#hdr-Name_Resolution).

   The total size reported in the stats for a sync is wrong and keeps changing
       It is likely you have more than 10,000 files that need to be synced.  By  default,  rclone
       only  gets  10,000  files  ahead  in  a sync so as not to use up too much memory.  You can
       change this default with the –max-backlog (https://rclone.org/docs/#max-backlog-n) flag.

   Rclone is using too much memory or appears to have a memory leak
       Rclone is written in Go which uses a garbage collector.   The  default  settings  for  the
       garbage collector mean that it runs when the heap size has doubled.

       However  it  is  possible to tune the garbage collector to use less memory by setting GOGC
       (https://dave.cheney.net/tag/gogc) to a lower value, say export GOGC=20.  This  will  make
       the garbage collector work harder, reducing memory size at the expense of CPU usage.

       The  most common cause of rclone using lots of memory is a single directory with thousands
       or millions of files in.  Rclone has to load this entirely into memory as rclone  objects.
       Each rclone object takes 0.5k-1k of memory.

   Rclone changes fullwidth Unicode punctuation marks in file names
       For  example:  On a Windows system, you have a file with name Test:1.jpg, where  is the
       Unicode fullwidth colon symbol.  When using rclone to copy this to your Google Drive,  you
       will  notice  that the file gets renamed to Test:1.jpg, where : is the regular (halfwidth)
       colon.

       The reason for such renames is the  way  rclone  handles  different  restricted  filenames
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-filenames)  on  different  cloud storage systems.
       It tries to avoid ambiguous file names as much and allow moving files between  many  cloud
       storage  systems  transparently,  by  replacing  invalid  characters  with similar looking
       Unicode characters when transferring to one storage system, and replacing back again  when
       transferring  to  a  different storage system where the original characters are supported.
       When the same Unicode characters are intentionally used in file  names,  this  replacement
       strategy       leads       to       unwanted       renames.       Read      more      here
       (https://rclone.org/overview/#restricted-filenames-caveats).

License

       This is free software under the terms of the MIT license (check the COPYING file  included
       with the source code).

              Copyright (C) 2019 by Nick Craig-Wood https://www.craig-wood.com/nick/

              Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
              of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
              in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
              to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
              copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
              furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:

              The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
              all copies or substantial portions of the Software.

              THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
              IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
              FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
              AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
              LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
              OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
              THE SOFTWARE.

Authors and contributors

   Authors
       • Nick Craig-Wood <nick@craig-wood.com>

   Contributors
       {{<  rem email addresses removed from here need to be addeed to bin/.ignore-emails to make
       sure update-authors.py doesn't immediately put them back in again.  >}}

       • Alex Couper <amcouper@gmail.com>

       • Leonid Shalupov <leonid@shalupov.com> <shalupov@diverse.org.ru>

       • Shimon Doodkin <helpmepro1@gmail.com>

       • Colin Nicholson <colin@colinn.com>

       • Klaus Post <klauspost@gmail.com>

       • Sergey Tolmachev <tolsi.ru@gmail.com>

       • Adriano Aurélio Meirelles <adriano@atinge.com>

       • C.  Bess <cbess@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dmitry Burdeev <dibu28@gmail.com>

       • Joseph Spurrier <github@josephspurrier.com>

       • Björn Harrtell <bjorn@wololo.org>

       • Xavier Lucas <xavier.lucas@corp.ovh.com>

       • Werner Beroux <werner@beroux.com>

       • Brian Stengaard <brian@stengaard.eu>

       • Jakub Gedeon <jgedeon@sofi.com>

       • Jim Tittsler <jwt@onjapan.net>

       • Michal Witkowski <michal@improbable.io>

       • Fabian Ruff <fabian.ruff@sap.com>

       • Leigh Klotz <klotz@quixey.com>

       • Romain Lapray <lapray.romain@gmail.com>

       • Justin R.  Wilson <jrw972@gmail.com>

       • Antonio Messina <antonio.s.messina@gmail.com>

       • Stefan G.  Weichinger <office@oops.co.at>

       • Per Cederberg <cederberg@gmail.com>

       • Radek Šenfeld <rush@logic.cz>

       • Fredrik Fornwall <fredrik@fornwall.net>

       • Asko Tamm <asko@deekit.net>

       • xor-zz <xor@gstocco.com>

       • Tomasz Mazur <tmazur90@gmail.com>

       • Marco Paganini <paganini@paganini.net>

       • Felix Bünemann <buenemann@louis.info>

       • Durval Menezes <jmrclone@durval.com>

       • Luiz Carlos Rumbelsperger Viana <maxd13_luiz_carlos@hotmail.com>

       • Stefan Breunig <stefan-github@yrden.de>

       • Alishan Ladhani <ali-l@users.noreply.github.com>

       • 0xJAKE <0xJAKE@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Thibault Molleman <thibaultmol@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Scott McGillivray <scott.mcgillivray@gmail.com>

       • Bjørn Erik Pedersen <bjorn.erik.pedersen@gmail.com>

       • Lukas Loesche <lukas@mesosphere.io>

       • emyarod <allllaboutyou@gmail.com>

       • T.C.  Ferguson <tcf909@gmail.com>

       • Brandur <brandur@mutelight.org>

       • Dario Giovannetti <dev@dariogiovannetti.net>

       • Károly Oláh <okaresz@aol.com>

       • Jon Yergatian <jon@macfanatic.ca>

       • Jack Schmidt <github@mowsey.org>

       • Dedsec1 <Dedsec1@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Hisham Zarka <hzarka@gmail.com>

       • Jérôme Vizcaino <jerome.vizcaino@gmail.com>

       • Mike Tesch <mjt6129@rit.edu>

       • Marvin Watson <marvwatson@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Danny Tsai <danny8376@gmail.com>

       • Yoni Jah <yonjah+git@gmail.com> <yonjah+github@gmail.com>

       • Stephen Harris <github@spuddy.org> <sweharris@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Ihor Dvoretskyi <ihor.dvoretskyi@gmail.com>

       • Jon Craton <jncraton@gmail.com>

       • Hraban Luyat <hraban@0brg.net>

       • Michael Ledin <mledin89@gmail.com>

       • Martin Kristensen <me@azgul.com>

       • Too Much IO <toomuchio@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Anisse Astier <anisse@astier.eu>

       • Zahiar Ahmed <zahiar@live.com>

       • Igor Kharin <igorkharin@gmail.com>

       • Bill Zissimopoulos <billziss@navimatics.com>

       • Bob Potter <bobby.potter@gmail.com>

       • Steven Lu <tacticalazn@gmail.com>

       • Sjur Fredriksen <sjurtf@ifi.uio.no>

       • Ruwbin <hubus12345@gmail.com>

       • Fabian Möller <fabianm88@gmail.com> <f.moeller@nynex.de>

       • Edward Q.  Bridges <github@eqbridges.com>

       • Vasiliy Tolstov <v.tolstov@selfip.ru>

       • Harshavardhana <harsha@minio.io>

       • sainaen <sainaen@gmail.com>

       • gdm85 <gdm85@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Yaroslav Halchenko <debian@onerussian.com>

       • John Papandriopoulos <jpap@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Zhiming Wang <zmwangx@gmail.com>

       • Andy Pilate <cubox@cubox.me>

       • Oliver       Heyme       <olihey@googlemail.com>       <olihey@users.noreply.github.com>
         <de8olihe@lego.com>

       • wuyu <wuyu@yunify.com>

       • Andrei Dragomir <adragomi@adobe.com>

       • Christian Brüggemann <mail@cbruegg.com>

       • Alex McGrath Kraak <amkdude@gmail.com>

       • bpicode <bjoern.pirnay@googlemail.com>

       • Daniel Jagszent <daniel@jagszent.de>

       • Josiah White <thegenius2009@gmail.com>

       • Ishuah Kariuki <kariuki@ishuah.com> <ishuah91@gmail.com>

       • Jan Varho <jan@varho.org>

       • Girish Ramakrishnan <girish@cloudron.io>

       • LingMan <LingMan@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Jacob McNamee <jacobmcnamee@gmail.com>

       • jersou <jertux@gmail.com>

       • thierry <thierry@substantiel.fr>

       • Simon Leinen <simon.leinen@gmail.com> <ubuntu@s3-test.novalocal>

       • Dan Dascalescu <ddascalescu+github@gmail.com>

       • Jason Rose <jason@jro.io>

       • Andrew Starr-Bochicchio <a.starr.b@gmail.com>

       • John Leach <john@johnleach.co.uk>

       • Corban Raun <craun@instructure.com>

       • Pierre Carlson <mpcarl@us.ibm.com>

       • Ernest Borowski <er.borowski@gmail.com>

       • Remus Bunduc <remus.bunduc@gmail.com>

       • Iakov Davydov <iakov.davydov@unil.ch> <dav05.gith@myths.ru>

       • Jakub Tasiemski <tasiemski@gmail.com>

       • David Minor <dminor@saymedia.com>

       • Tim Cooijmans <cooijmans.tim@gmail.com>

       • Laurence <liuxy6@gmail.com>

       • Giovanni Pizzi <gio.piz@gmail.com>

       • Filip Bartodziej <filipbartodziej@gmail.com>

       • Jon Fautley <jon@dead.li>

       • lewapm <32110057+lewapm@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Yassine Imounachen <yassine256@gmail.com>

       • Chris Redekop <chris-redekop@users.noreply.github.com> <chris.redekop@gmail.com>

       • Jon Fautley <jon@adenoid.appstal.co.uk>

       • Will Gunn <WillGunn@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Lucas Bremgartner <lucas@bremis.ch>

       • Jody Frankowski <jody.frankowski@gmail.com>

       • Andreas Roussos <arouss1980@gmail.com>

       • nbuchanan <nbuchanan@utah.gov>

       • Durval Menezes <rclone@durval.com>

       • Victor <vb-github@viblo.se>

       • Mateusz <pabian.mateusz@gmail.com>

       • Daniel Loader <spicypixel@gmail.com>

       • David0rk <davidork@gmail.com>

       • Alexander Neumann <alexander@bumpern.de>

       • Giri Badanahatti <gbadanahatti@us.ibm.com@Giris-MacBook-Pro.local>

       • Leo R.  Lundgren <leo@finalresort.org>

       • wolfv <wolfv6@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dave Pedu <dave@davepedu.com>

       • Stefan Lindblom <lindblom@spotify.com>

       • seuffert <oliver@seuffert.biz>

       • gbadanahatti <37121690+gbadanahatti@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Keith Goldfarb <barkofdelight@gmail.com>

       • Steve Kriss <steve@heptio.com>

       • Chih-Hsuan Yen <yan12125@gmail.com>

       • Alexander Neumann <fd0@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Matt Holt <mholt@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Eri Bastos <bastos.eri@gmail.com>

       • Michael P.  Dubner <pywebmail@list.ru>

       • Antoine GIRARD <sapk@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Mateusz Piotrowski <mpp302@gmail.com>

       • Animosity022 <animosity22@users.noreply.github.com> <earl.texter@gmail.com>

       • Peter Baumgartner <pete@lincolnloop.com>

       • Craig Rachel <craig@craigrachel.com>

       • Michael G.  Noll <miguno@users.noreply.github.com>

       • hensur <me@hensur.de>

       • Oliver Heyme <de8olihe@lego.com>

       • Richard Yang <richard@yenforyang.com>

       • Piotr Oleszczyk <piotr.oleszczyk@gmail.com>

       • Rodrigo <rodarima@gmail.com>

       • NoLooseEnds <NoLooseEnds@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Jakub Karlicek <jakub@karlicek.me>

       • John Clayton <john@codemonkeylabs.com>

       • Kasper Byrdal Nielsen <byrdal76@gmail.com>

       • Benjamin Joseph Dag <bjdag1234@users.noreply.github.com>

       • themylogin <themylogin@gmail.com>

       • Onno Zweers <onno.zweers@surfsara.nl>

       • Jasper Lievisse Adriaanse <jasper@humppa.nl>

       • sandeepkru <sandeep.ummadi@gmail.com> <sandeepkru@users.noreply.github.com>

       • HerrH <atomtigerzoo@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Andrew <4030760+sparkyman215@users.noreply.github.com>

       • dan smith <XX1011@gmail.com>

       • Oleg Kovalov <iamolegkovalov@gmail.com>

       • Ruben Vandamme <github-com-00ff86@vandamme.email>

       • Cnly <minecnly@gmail.com>

       • Andres Alvarez <1671935+kir4h@users.noreply.github.com>

       • reddi1 <xreddi@gmail.com>

       • Matt Tucker <matthewtckr@gmail.com>

       • Sebastian Bünger <buengese@gmail.com> <buengese@protonmail.com>

       • Martin Polden <mpolden@mpolden.no>

       • Alex Chen <Cnly@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Denis <deniskovpen@gmail.com>

       • bsteiss <35940619+bsteiss@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Cédric Connes <cedric.connes@gmail.com>

       • Dr. Tobias Quathamer <toddy15@users.noreply.github.com>

       • dcpu <42736967+dcpu@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Sheldon Rupp <me@shel.io>

       • albertony <12441419+albertony@users.noreply.github.com>

       • cron410 <cron410@gmail.com>

       • Anagh Kumar Baranwal <6824881+darthShadow@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Felix Brucker <felix@felixbrucker.com>

       • Santiago Rodríguez <scollazo@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Craig Miskell <craig.miskell@fluxfederation.com>

       • Antoine GIRARD <sapk@sapk.fr>

       • Joanna Marek <joanna.marek@u2i.com>

       • frenos <frenos@users.noreply.github.com>

       • ssaqua <ssaqua@users.noreply.github.com>

       • xnaas <me@xnaas.info>

       • Frantisek Fuka <fuka@fuxoft.cz>

       • Paul Kohout <pauljkohout@yahoo.com>

       • dcpu <43330287+dcpu@users.noreply.github.com>

       • jackyzy823 <jackyzy823@gmail.com>

       • David Haguenauer <ml@kurokatta.org>

       • teresy <hi.teresy@gmail.com>

       • buergi <patbuergi@gmx.de>

       • Florian Gamboeck <mail@floga.de>

       • Ralf Hemberger <10364191+rhemberger@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Scott Edlund <sedlund@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Erik Swanson <erik@retailnext.net>

       • Jake Coggiano <jake@stripe.com>

       • brused27 <brused27@noemailaddress>

       • Peter Kaminski <kaminski@istori.com>

       • Henry Ptasinski <henry@logout.com>

       • Alexander <kharkovalexander@gmail.com>

       • Garry McNulty <garrmcnu@gmail.com>

       • Mathieu Carbou <mathieu.carbou@gmail.com>

       • Mark Otway <mark@otway.com>

       • William Cocker <37018962+WilliamCocker@users.noreply.github.com>

       • François Leurent <131.js@cloudyks.org>

       • Arkadius Stefanski <arkste@gmail.com>

       • Jay <dev@jaygoel.com>

       • andrea rota <a@xelera.eu>

       • nicolov <nicolov@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dario Guzik <dario@guzik.com.ar>

       • qip <qip@users.noreply.github.com>

       • yair@unicorn <yair@unicorn>

       • Matt Robinson <brimstone@the.narro.ws>

       • kayrus <kay.diam@gmail.com>

       • Rémy Léone <remy.leone@gmail.com>

       • Wojciech Smigielski <wojciech.hieronim.smigielski@gmail.com>

       • weetmuts <oehrstroem@gmail.com>

       • Jonathan <vanillajonathan@users.noreply.github.com>

       • James Carpenter <orbsmiv@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Vince <vince0villamora@gmail.com>

       • Nestar47 <47841759+Nestar47@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Six <brbsix@gmail.com>

       • Alexandru Bumbacea <alexandru.bumbacea@booking.com>

       • calisro <robert.calistri@gmail.com>

       • Dr.Rx <david.rey@nventive.com>

       • marcintustin <marcintustin@users.noreply.github.com>

       • jaKa Močnik <jaka@koofr.net>

       • Fionera <fionera@fionera.de>

       • Dan Walters <dan@walters.io>

       • Danil Semelenov <sgtpep@users.noreply.github.com>

       • xopez <28950736+xopez@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Ben Boeckel <mathstuf@gmail.com>

       • Manu <manu@snapdragon.cc>

       • Kyle E.  Mitchell <kyle@kemitchell.com>

       • Gary Kim <gary@garykim.dev>

       • Jon <jonathn@github.com>

       • Jeff Quinn <jeffrey.quinn@bluevoyant.com>

       • Peter Berbec <peter@berbec.com>

       • didil <1284255+didil@users.noreply.github.com>

       • id01 <gaviniboom@gmail.com>

       • Robert Marko <robimarko@gmail.com>

       • Philip Harvey <32467456+pharveybattelle@users.noreply.github.com>

       • JorisE <JorisE@users.noreply.github.com>

       • garry415 <garry.415@gmail.com>

       • forgems <forgems@gmail.com>

       • Florian Apolloner <florian@apolloner.eu>

       • Aleksandar Janković <office@ajankovic.com> <ajankovic@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Maran <maran@protonmail.com>

       • nguyenhuuluan434 <nguyenhuuluan434@gmail.com>

       • Laura Hausmann <zotan@zotan.pw> <laura@hausmann.dev>

       • yparitcher <y@paritcher.com>

       • AbelThar <abela.tharen@gmail.com>

       • Matti Niemenmaa <matti.niemenmaa+git@iki.fi>

       • Russell Davis <russelldavis@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Yi FU <yi.fu@tink.se>

       • Paul Millar <paul.millar@desy.de>

       • justinalin <justinalin@qnap.com>

       • EliEron <subanimehd@gmail.com>

       • justina777 <chiahuei.lin@gmail.com>

       • Chaitanya Bankanhal <bchaitanya15@gmail.com>

       • Michał Matczuk <michal@scylladb.com>

       • Macavirus <macavirus@zoho.com>

       • Abhinav Sharma <abhi18av@outlook.com>

       • ginvine <34869051+ginvine@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Patrick Wang <mail6543210@yahoo.com.tw>

       • Cenk Alti <cenkalti@gmail.com>

       • Andreas Chlupka <andy@chlupka.com>

       • Alfonso Montero <amontero@tinet.org>

       • Ivan Andreev <ivandeex@gmail.com>

       • David Baumgold <david@davidbaumgold.com>

       • Lars Lehtonen <lars.lehtonen@gmail.com>

       • Matei David <matei.david@gmail.com>

       • David <david.bramwell@endemolshine.com>

       • Anthony Rusdi <33247310+antrusd@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Richard Patel <me@terorie.dev>

       • 庄天翼 <zty0826@gmail.com>

       • SwitchJS <dev@switchjs.com>

       • Raphael <PowershellNinja@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Sezal Agrawal <sezalagrawal@gmail.com>

       • Tyler <TylerNakamura@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Brett Dutro <brett.dutro@gmail.com>

       • Vighnesh SK <booterror99@gmail.com>

       • Arijit Biswas <dibbyo456@gmail.com>

       • Michele Caci <michele.caci@gmail.com>

       • AlexandrBoltris <ua2fgb@gmail.com>

       • Bryce Larson <blarson@saltstack.com>

       • Carlos Ferreyra <crypticmind@gmail.com>

       • Saksham Khanna <sakshamkhanna@outlook.com>

       • dausruddin <5763466+dausruddin@users.noreply.github.com>

       • zero-24 <zero-24@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Xiaoxing Ye <ye@xiaoxing.us>

       • Barry Muldrey <barry@muldrey.net>

       • Sebastian Brandt <sebastian.brandt@friday.de>

       • Marco Molteni <marco.molteni@mailbox.org>

       • Ankur Gupta <7876747+ankur0493@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Maciej Zimnoch <maciej@scylladb.com>

       • anuar45 <serdaliyev.anuar@gmail.com>

       • Fernando <ferferga@users.noreply.github.com>

       • David Cole <david.cole@sohonet.com>

       • Wei He <git@weispot.com>

       • Outvi V <19144373+outloudvi@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Thomas Kriechbaumer <thomas@kriechbaumer.name>

       • Tennix <tennix@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Ole Schütt <ole@schuett.name>

       • Kuang-che Wu <kcwu@csie.org>

       • Thomas Eales <wingsuit@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Paul Tinsley <paul.tinsley@vitalsource.com>

       • Felix Hungenberg <git@shiftgeist.com>

       • Benjamin Richter <github@dev.telepath.de>

       • landall <cst_zf@qq.com>

       • thestigma <thestigma@gmail.com>

       • jtagcat <38327267+jtagcat@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Damon Permezel <permezel@me.com>

       • boosh <boosh@users.noreply.github.com>

       • unbelauscht <58393353+unbelauscht@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Motonori IWAMURO <vmi@nifty.com>

       • Benjapol Worakan <benwrk@live.com>

       • Dave Koston <dave.koston@stackpath.com>

       • Durval Menezes <DurvalMenezes@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Tim Gallant <me@timgallant.us>

       • Frederick Zhang <frederick888@tsundere.moe>

       • valery1707 <valery1707@gmail.com>

       • Yves G <theYinYeti@yalis.fr>

       • Shing Kit Chan <chanshingkit@gmail.com>

       • Franklyn Tackitt <franklyn@tackitt.net>

       • Robert-André Mauchin <zebob.m@gmail.com>

       • evileye <48332831+ibiruai@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Joachim Brandon LeBlanc <brandon@leblanc.codes>

       • Patryk Jakuszew <patryk.jakuszew@gmail.com>

       • fishbullet <shindu666@gmail.com>

       • greatroar <@>

       • Bernd Schoolmann <mail@quexten.com>

       • Elan Ruusamäe <glen@pld-linux.org>

       • Max Sum <max@lolyculture.com>

       • Mark Spieth <mspieth@users.noreply.github.com>

       • harry <me@harry.plus>

       • Samantha McVey <samantham@posteo.net>

       • Jack Anderson <jack.anderson@metaswitch.com>

       • Michael G <draget@speciesm.net>

       • Brandon Philips <brandon@ifup.org>

       • Daven <dooven@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Martin Stone <martin@d7415.co.uk>

       • David Bramwell <13053834+dbramwell@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Sunil Patra <snl_su@live.com>

       • Adam Stroud <adam.stroud@gmail.com>

       • Kush <kushsharma@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Matan Rosenberg <matan129@gmail.com>

       • gitch1 <63495046+gitch1@users.noreply.github.com>

       • ElonH <elonhhuang@gmail.com>

       • Fred <fred@creativeprojects.tech>

       • Sébastien Gross <renard@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Maxime Suret <11944422+msuret@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Caleb Case <caleb@storj.io> <calebcase@gmail.com>

       • Ben Zenker <imbenzenker@gmail.com>

       • Martin Michlmayr <tbm@cyrius.com>

       • Brandon McNama <bmcnama@pagerduty.com>

       • Daniel Slyman <github@skylayer.eu>

       • Alex Guerrero <guerrero@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Matteo Pietro Dazzi <matteopietro.dazzi@gft.com>

       • edwardxml <56691903+edwardxml@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Roman Kredentser <shareed2k@gmail.com>

       • Kamil Trzciński <ayufan@ayufan.eu>

       • Zac Rubin <z-0@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Vincent Feltz <psycho@feltzv.fr>

       • Heiko Bornholdt <bornholdt@informatik.uni-hamburg.de>

       • Matteo Pietro Dazzi <matteopietro.dazzi@gmail.com>

       • jtagcat <gitlab@c7.ee>

       • Petri Salminen <petri@salminen.dev>

       • Tim Burke <tim.burke@gmail.com>

       • Kai Lüke <kai@kinvolk.io>

       • Garrett Squire <github@garrettsquire.com>

       • Evan Harris <eharris@puremagic.com>

       • Kevin <keyam@microsoft.com>

       • Morten Linderud <morten@linderud.pw>

       • Dmitry Ustalov <dmitry.ustalov@gmail.com>

       • Jack <196648+jdeng@users.noreply.github.com>

       • kcris <cristian.tarsoaga@gmail.com>

       • tyhuber1 <68970760+tyhuber1@users.noreply.github.com>

       • David Ibarra <david.ibarra@realty.com>

       • Tim Gallant <tim@lilt.com>

       • Kaloyan Raev <kaloyan@storj.io>

       • Jay McEntire <jay.mcentire@gmail.com>

       • Leo Luan <leoluan@us.ibm.com>

       • aus <549081+aus@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Aaron Gokaslan <agokaslan@fb.com>

       • Egor Margineanu <egmar@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Lucas Kanashiro <lucas.kanashiro@canonical.com>

       • WarpedPixel <WarpedPixel@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Sam Edwards <sam@samedwards.ca>

       • wjielai <gouki0123@gmail.com>

       • Muffin King <jinxz_k@live.com>

       • Christopher Stewart <6573710+1f47a@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Russell Cattelan <cattelan@digitalelves.com>

       • gyutw <30371241+gyutw@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Hekmon <edouardhur@gmail.com>

       • LaSombra <lasombra@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dov Murik <dov.murik@gmail.com>

       • Ameer Dawood <ameer1234567890@gmail.com>

       • Dan Hipschman <dan.hipschman@opendoor.com>

       • Josh Soref <jsoref@users.noreply.github.com>

       • David <david@staron.nl>

       • Ingo <ingo@hoffmann.cx>

       • Adam Plánský <adamplansky@users.noreply.github.com> <adamplansky@gmail.com>

       • Manish Gupta <manishgupta.ait@gmail.com>

       • Deepak Sah <sah.sslpu@gmail.com>

       • Marcin Zelent <marcin@zelent.net>

       • zhucan <zhucan.k8s@gmail.com>

       • James Lim <james.lim@samsara.com>

       • Laurens Janssen <BD69BM@insim.biz>

       • Bob Bagwill <bobbagwill@gmail.com>

       • Nathan Collins <colli372@msu.edu>

       • lostheli

       • kelv <kelvin@acks.org>

       • Milly <milly.ca@gmail.com>

       • gtorelly <gtorelly@gmail.com>

       • Brad Ackerman <brad@facefault.org>

       • Mitsuo Heijo <mitsuo.heijo@gmail.com>

       • Claudio Bantaloukas <rockdreamer@gmail.com>

       • Benjamin Gustin <gustin.ben@gmail.com>

       • Ingo Weiss <ingo@redhat.com>

       • Kerry Su <me@sshockwave.net>

       • Ilyess Bachiri <ilyess.bachiri@sonder.com>

       • Yury Stankevich <urykhy@gmail.com>

       • kice <wslikerqs@gmail.com>

       • Denis Neuling <denisneuling@gmail.com>

       • Janne Johansson <icepic.dz@gmail.com>

       • Patrik Nordlén <patriki@gmail.com>

       • CokeMine <aptx4561@gmail.com>

       • Sơn Trần-Nguyễn <github@sntran.com>

       • lluuaapp <266615+lluuaapp@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Zach Kipp <kipp.zach@gmail.com>

       • Riccardo Iaconelli <riccardo@kde.org>

       • Sakuragawa Misty <gyc990326@gmail.com>

       • Nicolas Rueff <nicolas@rueff.fr>

       • Pau Rodriguez-Estivill <prodrigestivill@gmail.com>

       • Bob Pusateri <BobPusateri@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Alex JOST <25005220+dimejo@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Alexey Tabakman <samosad.ru@gmail.com>

       • David Sze <sze.david@gmail.com>

       • cynthia kwok <cynthia.m.kwok@gmail.com>

       • Miron Veryanskiy <MironVeryanskiy@gmail.com>

       • K265 <k.265@qq.com>

       • Vesnyx <Vesnyx@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dmitry Chepurovskiy <me@dm3ch.net>

       • Rauno Ots <rauno.ots@cgi.com>

       • Georg Neugschwandtner <georg.neugschwandtner@gmx.net>

       • pvalls <polvallsrue@gmail.com>

       • Robert Thomas <31854736+wolveix@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Romeo Kienzler <romeo.kienzler@gmail.com>

       • tYYGH <tYYGH@users.noreply.github.com>

       • georne <77802995+georne@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Maxwell Calman <mcalman@MacBook-Pro.local>

       • Naveen Honest Raj <naveendurai19@gmail.com>

       • Lucas Messenger <lmesseng@cisco.com>

       • Manish Kumar <krmanish260@gmail.com>

       • x0b <x0bdev@gmail.com>

       • CERN through the CS3MESH4EOSC Project

       • Nick Gaya <nicholasgaya+github@gmail.com>

       • Ashok Gelal <401055+ashokgelal@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Dominik Mydlil <dominik.mydlil@outlook.com>

       • Nazar Mishturak <nazarmx@gmail.com>

       • Ansh Mittal <iamAnshMittal@gmail.com>

       • noabody <noabody@yahoo.com>

       • OleFrost <82263101+olefrost@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Kenny Parsons <kennyparsons93@gmail.com>

       • Jeffrey Tolar <tolar.jeffrey@gmail.com>

       • jtagcat <git-514635f7@jtag.cat>

       • Tatsuya Noyori <63089076+public-tatsuya-noyori@users.noreply.github.com>

       • lewisxy <lewisxy@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Nolan Woods <nolan_w@sfu.ca>

       • Gautam Kumar <25435568+gautamajay52@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Chris Macklin <chris.macklin@10xgenomics.com>

       • Antoon Prins <antoon.prins@surfsara.nl>

       • Alexey Ivanov <rbtz@dropbox.com>

       • Serge Pouliquen <sp31415@free.fr>

       • acsfer <carlos@reendex.com>

       • Tom <tom@tom-fitzhenry.me.uk>

       • Tyson Moore <tyson@tyson.me>

       • database64128 <free122448@hotmail.com>

       • Chris Lu <chrislusf@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Reid Buzby <reid@rethink.software>

       • darrenrhs <darrenrhs@gmail.com>

       • Florian Penzkofer <fp@nullptr.de>

       • Xuanchen Wu <117010292@link.cuhk.edu.cn>

       • partev <petrosyan@gmail.com>

       • Dmitry Sitnikov <fo2@inbox.ru>

       • Haochen Tong <i@hexchain.org>

       • Michael Hanselmann <public@hansmi.ch>

       • Chuan Zh <zhchuan7@gmail.com>

       • Antoine GIRARD <antoine.girard@sapk.fr>

       • Justin Winokur (Jwink3101) <Jwink3101@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Mariano Absatz (git) <scm@baby.com.ar>

       • Greg Sadetsky <lepetitg@gmail.com>

       • yedamo <logindaveye@gmail.com>

       • hota <lindwurm.q@gmail.com>

       • vinibali <vinibali1@gmail.com>

       • Ken Enrique Morel <ken.morel.santana@gmail.com>

       • Justin Hellings <justin.hellings@gmail.com>

       • Parth Shukla <pparth@pparth.net>

       • wzl <wangzl31@outlook.com>

       • HNGamingUK <connor@earnshawhome.co.uk>

       • Jonta <359397+Jonta@users.noreply.github.com>

       • YenForYang <YenForYang@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Joda Stößer <stoesser@yay-digital.de> <services+github@simjo.st>

       • Logeshwaran <waranlogesh@gmail.com>

       • Rajat Goel <rajat@dropbox.com>

       • r0kk3rz <r0kk3rz@gmail.com>

       • Matthew Sevey <mjsevey@gmail.com>

       • Filip Rysavy <fil@siasky.net>

       • Ian Levesque <ian@ianlevesque.org>

       • Thomas Stachl <thomas@stachl.me>

       • Dmitry Bogatov <git#v1@kaction.cc>

       • thomae <4493560+thomae@users.noreply.github.com>

       • trevyn <trevyn-git@protonmail.com>

       • David Liu <david.yx.liu@oracle.com>

       • Chris Nelson <stuff@cjnaz.com>

       • Felix Bünemann <felix.buenemann@gmail.com>

       • Atílio Antônio <atiliodadalto@hotmail.com>

       • Roberto Ricci <ricci@disroot.org>

       • Carlo Mion <mion00@gmail.com>

       • Chris Lu <chris.lu@gmail.com>

       • Vitor Arruda <vitor.pimenta.arruda@gmail.com>

       • bbabich <bbabich@datamossa.com>

       • David <dp.davide.palma@gmail.com>

       • Borna Butkovic <borna@favicode.net>

       • Fredric Arklid <fredric.arklid@consid.se>

       • Andy Jackson <Andrew.Jackson@bl.uk>

       • Sinan Tan <i@tinytangent.com>

       • deinferno <14363193+deinferno@users.noreply.github.com>

       • rsapkf <rsapkfff@pm.me>

       • Will Holtz <wholtz@gmail.com>

       • GGG KILLER <gggkiller2@gmail.com>

       • Logeshwaran Murugesan <logeshwaran@testpress.in>

       • Lu Wang <coolwanglu@gmail.com>

       • Bumsu Hyeon <ksitht@gmail.com>

       • Shmz Ozggrn <98463324+ShmzOzggrn@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Kim <kim@jotta.no>

       • Niels van de Weem <n.van.de.weem@smile.nl>

       • Koopa <codingkoopa@gmail.com>

       • Yunhai Luo <yunhai-luo@hotmail.com>

       • Charlie Jiang <w@chariri.moe>

       • Alain Nussbaumer <alain.nussbaumer@alleluia.ch>

       • Vanessasaurus <814322+vsoch@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Isaac Levy <isaac.r.levy@gmail.com>

       • Gourav T <workflowautomation@protonmail.com>

       • Paulo Martins <paulo.pontes.m@gmail.com>

       • viveknathani <viveknathani2402@gmail.com>

       • Eng Zer Jun <engzerjun@gmail.com>

       • Abhiraj <abhiraj.official15@gmail.com>

       • Márton Elek <elek@apache.org> <elek@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Vincent Murphy <vdm@vdm.ie>

       • ctrl-q <34975747+ctrl-q@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Nil Alexandrov <nalexand@akamai.com>

       • GuoXingbin <101376330+guoxingbin@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Berkan Teber <berkan@berkanteber.com>

       • Tobias Klauser <tklauser@distanz.ch>

       • KARBOWSKI Piotr <piotr.karbowski@gmail.com>

       • GH <geeklihui@foxmail.com>

       • rafma0 <int.main@gmail.com>

       • Adrien Rey-Jarthon <jobs@adrienjarthon.com>

       • Nick Gooding <73336146+nickgooding@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Leroy van Logchem <lr.vanlogchem@gmail.com>

       • Zsolt Ero <zsolt.ero@gmail.com>

       • Lesmiscore <nao20010128@gmail.com>

       • ehsantdy <ehsan.tadayon@arvancloud.com>

       • SwazRGB <65694696+swazrgb@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Mateusz Puczyński <mati6095@gmail.com>

       • Michael C Tiernan - MIT-Research Computing Project <mtiernan@mit.edu>

       • Kaspian <34658474+KaspianDev@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Werner <EvilOlaf@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Hugal31 <hugo.laloge@gmail.com>

       • Christian Galo <36752715+cgalo5758@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Erik van Velzen <erik@evanv.nl>

       • Derek Battams <derek@battams.ca>

       • SimonLiu <simonliu009@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Hugo Laloge <hla@lescompanions.com>

       • Mr-Kanister <68117355+Mr-Kanister@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Rob Pickerill <r.pickerill@gmail.com>

       • Andrey <to.merge@gmail.com>

       • Eric Wolf <19wolf@gmail.com>

       • Nick <nick.naumann@mailbox.tu-dresden.de>

       • Jason Zheng <jszheng17@gmail.com>

       • Matthew Vernon <mvernon@wikimedia.org>

       • Noah Hsu <i@nn.ci>

       • m00594701 <mengpengbo@huawei.com>

       • Art M.  Gallagher <artmg50@gmail.com>

       • Sven Gerber <49589423+svengerber@users.noreply.github.com>

       • CrossR <r.cross@lancaster.ac.uk>

       • Maciej Radzikowski <maciej@radzikowski.com.pl>

       • Scott Grimes <scott.grimes@spaciq.com>

       • Phil Shackleton <71221528+philshacks@users.noreply.github.com>

       • eNV25 <env252525@gmail.com>

       • Caleb <inventor96@users.noreply.github.com>

       • J-P Treen <jp@wraptious.com>

       • Martin Czygan <53705+miku@users.noreply.github.com>

       • buda <sandrojijavadze@protonmail.com>

       • mirekphd <36706320+mirekphd@users.noreply.github.com>

       • vyloy <vyloy@qq.com>

       • Anthrazz <25553648+Anthrazz@users.noreply.github.com>

       • zzr93 <34027824+zzr93@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Paul Norman <penorman@mac.com>

       • Lorenzo Maiorfi <maiorfi@gmail.com>

       • Claudio Maradonna <penguyman@stronzi.org>

       • Ovidiu Victor Tatar <ovi.tatar@googlemail.com>

       • Evan Spensley <epspensley@gmail.com>

       • Yen Hu <61753151+0x59656e@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Steve Kowalik <steven@wedontsleep.org>

       • Jordi Gonzalez Muñoz <jordigonzm@gmail.com>

       • Joram Schrijver <i@joram.io>

       • Mark Trolley <marktrolley@gmail.com>

       • João Henrique Franco <joaohenrique.franco@gmail.com>

       • anonion <aman207@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Ryan Morey <4590343+rmorey@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Simon Bos <simonbos9@gmail.com>

       • YFdyh000 <yfdyh000@gmail.com> * Josh Soref <2119212+jsoref@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Øyvind Heddeland Instefjord <instefjord@outlook.com>

       • Dmitry Deniskin <110819396+ddeniskin@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Alexander Knorr <106825+opexxx@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Richard Bateman <richard@batemansr.us>

       • Dimitri Papadopoulos Orfanos <3234522+DimitriPapadopoulos@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Lorenzo Milesi <lorenzo.milesi@yetopen.com>

       • Isaac Aymerich <isaac.aymerich@gmail.com>

       • YanceyChiew <35898533+YanceyChiew@users.noreply.github.com>

       • Manoj Ghosh <msays2000@gmail.com>

       • Bachue Zhou <bachue.shu@gmail.com>

       • Manoj Ghosh <manoj.ghosh@oracle.com>

       • Tom Mombourquette <tom@devnode.com>

       • Robert Newson <rnewson@apache.org>

Contact the rclone project

   Forum
       Forum for questions and general discussion:

       • https://forum.rclone.org

   GitHub repository
       The project’s repository is located at:

       • https://github.com/rclone/rclone

       There you can file bug reports or contribute with pull requests.

   Twitter
       You can also follow me on twitter for rclone announcements:

       • @njcw (https://twitter.com/njcw)

   Email
       Or  if  all  else  fails  or  you want to ask something private or confidential email Nick
       Craig-Wood (mailto:nick@craig-wood.com).  Please don’t email me requests for help -  those
       are better directed to the forum.  Thanks!

AUTHORS

       Nick Craig-Wood.